UNITED STATES
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
Washington, D.C. 20549
  Form 10-K
Annual Report Pursuant to Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934
For the fiscal year ended December 31, 2018             Commission File Number 001‑2979
WELLS FARGO & COMPANY
(Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter)
Delaware                                                        No. 41-0449260
(State of incorporation)                      (I.R.S. Employer Identification No.)
420 Montgomery Street, San Francisco, California 94163
(Address of principal executive offices) (Zip code)
Registrant’s telephone number, including area code:  1-866-878-5865

Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act:
Title of Each Class
Name of Each Exchange
on Which Registered
Common Stock, par value $1-2/3
New York Stock Exchange (NYSE)
7.5% Non-Cumulative Perpetual Convertible Class A Preferred Stock, Series L
NYSE
Depositary Shares, each representing a 1/1000th interest in a share of Non-Cumulative Perpetual Class A Preferred Stock, Series N
NYSE
Depositary Shares, each representing a 1/1000th interest in a share of Non-Cumulative Perpetual Class A Preferred Stock, Series O
NYSE
Depositary Shares, each representing a 1/1000th interest in a share of Non-Cumulative Perpetual Class A Preferred Stock, Series P
NYSE
Depositary Shares, each representing a 1/1000th interest in a share of 5.85% Fixed-to-Floating Rate Non-Cumulative Perpetual Class A Preferred Stock, Series Q
NYSE
Depositary Shares, each representing a 1/1000th interest in a share of 6.625% Fixed-to-Floating Rate Non-Cumulative Perpetual Class A Preferred Stock, Series R
NYSE
Depositary Shares, each representing a 1/1000th interest in a share of Non-Cumulative Perpetual Class A Preferred Stock, Series T
NYSE
Depositary Shares, each representing a 1/1000th interest in a share of Non-Cumulative Perpetual Class A Preferred Stock, Series V
NYSE
Depositary Shares, each representing a 1/1000th interest in a share of Non-Cumulative Perpetual Class A Preferred Stock, Series W
NYSE
Depositary Shares, each representing a 1/1000th interest in a share of Non-Cumulative Perpetual Class A Preferred Stock, Series X
NYSE
Depositary Shares, each representing a 1/1000th interest in a share of Non-Cumulative Perpetual Class A Preferred Stock, Series Y
NYSE
Guarantee of 5.80% Fixed-to-Floating Rate Normal Wachovia Income Trust Securities of Wachovia Capital Trust III
NYSE
Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act:
Dividend Equalization Preferred Shares, no par value

Indicate by check mark if the registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act.    Yes ¨    No þ
Indicate by check mark if the registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or Section 15(d) of the Act.    Yes ¨    No þ    
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days.        Yes þ    No ¨
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has submitted electronically every Interactive Data File required to be submitted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T ( § 232.405 of this chapter) during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to submit such files).                    Yes þ    No ¨    
Indicate by check mark if disclosure of delinquent filers pursuant to Item 405 of Regulation S-K ( § 229.405 of this chapter) is not contained herein, and will not be contained, to the best of registrant’s knowledge, in definitive proxy or information statements incorporated by reference in Part III of this Form 10-K or any amendment to this Form 10-K.                                      þ  
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer, a smaller reporting company, or an emerging growth company. See the definitions of “large accelerated filer,” “accelerated filer,” “smaller reporting company,” and “emerging growth company” in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act.
Large accelerated filer  þ                      Accelerated filer  ¨  
Non-accelerated filer  ¨                        Smaller reporting company  ¨
Emerging growth company  ¨
If an emerging growth company, indicate by check mark if the registrant has elected not to use the extended transition period for complying with any new or revised financial accounting standards provided pursuant to Section 13(a) of the Exchange Act.                 ¨  
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell Company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Act).        Yes ¨    No þ     
At June 29, 2018 , the aggregate market value of common stock held by non-affiliates was approximately $268.2 billion , based on a closing price of $55.44. At February 18, 2019 , 4,549,421,815 shares of common stock were outstanding.
Documents Incorporated by Reference in Form 10-K
Incorporated Documents
Where incorporated in Form 10-K
1.    Portions of the Company’s Annual Report to Shareholders for the year ended December 31, 2018 (“2018 Annual Report to Shareholders”)
Part I – Items 1, 1A, 1B, 2, 3 and 4; Part II – Items 5, 6, 7,
7A, 8, 9A and 9B; and Part IV– Item 15.
2.    Portions of the Company’s Proxy Statement for the Annual
Meeting of Shareholders to be held April 23, 2019 (“2019 Proxy Statement”)
Part III – Items 10, 11, 12, 13 and 14




PART I.
ITEM 1.
BUSINESS
 
Wells Fargo & Company is a corporation organized under the laws of Delaware and a financial holding company and a bank holding company registered under the Bank Holding Company Act of 1956, as amended (BHC Act). Its principal business is to act as a holding company for its subsidiaries. References in this report to “the Parent” mean the holding company. References to “we,” “our,” “us” or “the Company” mean the holding company and its subsidiaries that are consolidated for financial reporting purposes.
At December 31, 2018 , we had assets of $1.9 trillion , loans of $953 billion , deposits of $1.3 trillion and stockholders’ equity of $196 billion . Based on assets, we were the fourth largest bank holding company in the United States. At December 31, 2018 , Wells Fargo Bank, N.A. was the Company’s principal subsidiary with assets of $1.7 trillion, or 89% of the Company’s assets.
At December 31, 2018 , we had 258,700 active, full-time equivalent team members.
Our annual reports on Form 10-K, quarterly reports on Form 10-Q, current reports on Form 8-K, and amendments to those reports, are available for free at www.wellsfargo.com/about/investor-relations/filings as soon as reasonably practicable after they are electronically filed with or furnished to the Securities and Exchange Commission (SEC). They are also available for free on the SEC’s website at www.sec.gov

DESCRIPTION OF BUSINESS
 
General
 
We are a diversified financial services company. We provide retail, commercial and corporate banking services through banking locations and offices, the internet (www.wellsfargo.com) and other distribution channels to individuals, businesses and institutions in all 50 states, the District of Columbia and in other countries. We provide other financial services through subsidiaries engaged in various businesses, principally: wholesale banking, mortgage banking, consumer finance, equipment leasing, agricultural finance, commercial finance, securities brokerage and investment banking, computer and data processing services, trust services, investment advisory services, mortgage-backed securities servicing and venture capital investment.
We have three operating segments for management reporting purposes: Community Banking; Wholesale Banking; and Wealth and Investment Management. The 2018 Annual Report to Shareholders includes financial information and descriptions of these operating segments.
 
Competition
 
The financial services industry is highly competitive. Our subsidiaries compete with financial services providers such as banks, savings and loan associations, credit unions, finance companies, mortgage banking companies, insurance companies, investment banks and mutual fund companies. They also face increased competition from nonbank institutions such as brokerage houses, private equity firms and online lending companies, as well as from financial services
 
subsidiaries of commercial and manufacturing companies. Many of these competitors enjoy fewer regulatory constraints and some may have lower cost structures.
Securities firms and insurance companies that elect to become financial holding companies may acquire banks and other financial institutions. Combinations of this type could significantly change the competitive environment in which we conduct business. The financial services industry is also likely to become more competitive as further technological advances enable more companies to provide financial services. These technological advances may diminish the importance of depository institutions and other financial intermediaries in the transfer of funds between parties.
REGULATION AND SUPERVISION
 
We describe below, and in Note 3 (Cash, Loan and Dividend Restrictions) and Note 28 (Regulatory and Agency Capital Requirements) to Financial Statements included in the 2018 Annual Report to Shareholders, the material elements of the regulatory framework applicable to us. Banking statutes, regulations and policies are continually under review by Congress and state legislatures and federal and state regulatory agencies, as well as foreign governments and financial regulators, and a change in them, including changes in how they are interpreted or implemented, could have a material effect on our business. The regulatory framework applicable to bank holding companies is intended to protect depositors, federal deposit insurance funds, consumers and the banking system as a whole, and not necessarily investors in bank holding companies such as the Company.
Statutes, regulations and policies could restrict our ability to diversify into other areas of financial services, acquire depository institutions, and pay dividends on our capital stock. They may also require us to provide financial support to one or more of our subsidiary banks, maintain capital balances in excess of amounts desired by management, and pay higher deposit insurance premiums as a result of a general deterioration in the financial condition of depository institutions. See the “Regulatory Matters” and "Risk Factors" sections in the 2018 Annual Report to Shareholders for additional information.
 
General
 
Parent Bank Holding Company.  As a bank holding company, the Parent is subject to regulation under the BHC Act and to inspection, examination and supervision by its primary regulator, the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System (Federal Reserve Board or FRB). The Parent is also subject to the disclosure and regulatory requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, and the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, both as administered by the SEC. As a company with securities listed on the New York Stock Exchange (NYSE), the Parent is subject to the rules of the NYSE for listed companies.
 
Subsidiary Banks.   Our subsidiary national banks, and their subsidiaries, are subject to regulation and examination primarily by the Office of the Comptroller of the Currency (OCC) and also by the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation (FDIC), the FRB, the Consumer Financial Protection Bureau (CFPB), the SEC and the Commodities Futures Trading Commission (CFTC). The foreign branches and representative

1



offices of our subsidiary national banks are subject to regulation and examination by their respective foreign financial regulators as well as by the OCC and the FRB. Foreign subsidiaries of our national bank subsidiaries may be subject to the laws and regulations of the foreign countries in which they conduct business. Our state-chartered bank is subject to primary federal regulation and examination by the FDIC and, in addition, is regulated and examined by its state banking department.
 
Nonbank Subsidiaries.  Many of our nonbank subsidiaries are also subject to regulation by the FRB and other applicable federal and state agencies. Our insurance subsidiaries are subject to regulation by applicable state insurance regulatory agencies, as well as the FRB. Our brokerage subsidiaries are regulated by the SEC, the Financial Industry Regulatory Authority (FINRA) and, in some cases, the CFTC and the Municipal Securities Rulemaking Board, and state securities regulators. Our other nonbank subsidiaries may be subject to the laws and regulations of the federal government and/or the various states as well as foreign countries in which they conduct business.
 
Parent Bank Holding Company Activities
 
“Financial in Nature” Requirement.  We became a financial holding company effective March 13, 2000. We continue to maintain our status as a bank holding company for purposes of other FRB regulations. As a bank holding company that has elected to become a financial holding company pursuant to the BHC Act, we may affiliate with securities firms and insurance companies and engage in other activities that are financial in nature or incidental or complementary to activities that are financial in nature. “Financial in nature” activities include securities underwriting, dealing and market making; sponsoring mutual funds and investment companies; insurance underwriting and agency; merchant banking; and activities that the FRB, in consultation with the Secretary of the U.S. Treasury, determines to be financial in nature or incidental to such financial activity. “Complementary activities” are activities that the FRB determines upon application to be complementary to a financial activity and do not pose a safety and soundness risk.
FRB approval is generally not required for us to acquire a company (other than a bank holding company, bank or savings association) engaged in activities that are financial in nature or incidental to activities that are financial in nature, as determined by the FRB. Prior notice to the FRB may be required, however, if the company to be acquired has total consolidated assets of $10 billion or more. Prior FRB approval is required before we may acquire the beneficial ownership or control of more than 5% of the voting shares or substantially all of the assets of a bank holding company, bank or savings association. In addition, the FRB has implemented a final rule under the Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act (Dodd-Frank Act) that also prohibits our ability to merge, acquire all or substantially all of the assets of, or acquire control of another company if our total resulting consolidated liabilities would exceed 10% of the aggregate consolidated liabilities of all financial companies.
Because we are a financial holding company, if any of our subsidiary banks receives a rating under the Community Reinvestment Act of 1977, as amended (CRA), of less than satisfactory, we will be prohibited, until the rating is raised to satisfactory or better, from engaging in new activities or
 
acquiring companies other than bank holding companies, banks or savings associations, except that we could engage in new activities, or acquire companies engaged in activities, that are closely related to banking under the BHC Act. In March 2017, we announced that the OCC had downgraded our most recent CRA rating, which covers the years 2009-2012, to "Needs to Improve" due to previously issued regulatory consent orders and, thus, we are subject to, among other things, the prohibitions noted above. In addition, if the FRB finds that the Company or any one of our subsidiary banks is not well capitalized or well managed, we would be required to enter into an agreement with the FRB to comply with all applicable capital and management requirements and which may contain additional limitations or conditions. Until corrected, we could be prohibited from engaging in any new activity or acquiring companies engaged in activities that are not closely related to banking under the BHC Act without prior FRB approval. If we fail to correct any such condition within a prescribed period, the FRB could order us to divest our banking subsidiaries or, in the alternative, to cease engaging in activities other than those closely related to banking under the BHC Act. For more information about our CRA rating, see the "Regulatory Matters" and "Risk Factors" sections of the 2018 Annual Report to Shareholders.

Interstate Banking .  Under the Riegle-Neal Interstate Banking and Branching Act (Riegle-Neal Act), a bank holding company may acquire banks in states other than its home state, subject to any state requirement that the bank has been organized and operating for a minimum period of time, not to exceed five years, and the requirement that the bank holding company not control, prior to or following the proposed acquisition, more than 10% of the total amount of deposits of insured depository institutions nationwide or, unless the acquisition is the bank holding company’s initial entry into the state, more than 30% of such deposits in the state (or such lesser or greater amount set by the state). The Riegle-Neal Act also authorizes banks to merge across state lines, subject to the same deposit limits noted above, thereby creating interstate branches. Banks are also permitted to acquire and to establish new branches in other states.
 
Regulatory Approval.  In determining whether to approve a proposed bank acquisition, federal banking regulators will consider, among other factors, the effect of the acquisition on competition, financial condition, and future prospects including current and projected capital ratios and levels, the competence, experience, and integrity of management and record of compliance with laws and regulations, the convenience and needs of the communities to be served, including the acquiring institution’s record of compliance under the CRA, the effectiveness of the acquiring institution in combating money laundering activities and the risk to the stability of the United States banking system.
 
Dividend Restrictions
 
The Parent is a legal entity separate and distinct from its subsidiary banks and other subsidiaries. A significant source of funds to pay dividends on our common and preferred stock and principal and interest on our debt is dividends from the Parent’s subsidiaries. Various federal and state statutory provisions and regulations limit the amount of dividends the Parent’s subsidiary banks and certain other subsidiaries may pay without regulatory approval. Federal banking regulators

2



have the authority to prohibit the Parent’s subsidiary banks from engaging in unsafe or unsound practices in conducting their businesses. The payment of dividends, depending on the financial condition of the bank in question, could be deemed an unsafe or unsound practice. The ability of the Parent’s subsidiary banks to pay dividends in the future is currently, and could be further, influenced by bank regulatory policies and capital guidelines. For information about the restrictions applicable to the Parent’s subsidiary banks, see Note 3 (Cash, Loan and Dividend Restrictions) to Financial Statements included in the 2018 Annual Report to Shareholders.
Furthermore, under a Support Agreement (the “Support Agreement”) dated June 28, 2017 among the Parent, WFC Holdings, LLC, an intermediate holding company and subsidiary of the Parent (the “IHC”), and Wells Fargo Bank, N.A., Wells Fargo Securities, LLC, and Wells Fargo Clearing Services, LLC, each an indirect subsidiary of the Parent, the IHC may be restricted from making dividend payments to the Parent if certain liquidity and/or capital metrics fall below defined triggers. Any such restriction could materially and adversely impact the Parent’s liquidity and its ability to satisfy its debt and other obligations, as well as its ability to make dividend payments on its common and preferred stock. See the “Regulatory Matters” and “Risk Factors” sections of the 2018 Annual Report to Shareholders for additional information on the Support Agreement.
In addition to these restrictions on the ability of our subsidiary banks to pay dividends to us, the FRB requires large bank holding companies (BHCs), including Wells Fargo, to submit annual capital plans and to obtain regulatory approval before making capital distributions, such as the payment of dividends. The FRB also finalized rules implementing in the United States the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision’s regulatory capital guidelines, including the reforms known as Basel III, which established various capital requirements for U.S. banking organizations. Moreover, federal banking regulators have finalized a rule that enhances the supplementary leverage ratio requirements for large BHCs, like Wells Fargo, and their insured depository institutions. We are also subject to the FRB's rule implementing an additional capital surcharge on those U.S. banking organizations, such as the Company, that are designated as global systemically important banks (G-SIBs). The failure to maintain any of these minimum capital ratios, leverage ratios or buffers could result in limitations or restrictions on our ability to make capital distributions.
In addition, the FRB's enhanced supervision regulations for large BHCs, like Wells Fargo, impose capital distribution restrictions, including on the payment of dividends, upon the occurrence of capital, stress test, risk management, or liquidity risk management triggers. For more information on regulations or arrangements that may impose capital distribution restrictions on the Company and its subsidiaries, see the “Capital Management,” “Regulatory Matters” and “Risk Factors” sections of the 2018 Annual Report to Shareholders.
 
Holding Company Structure
 
Transfer of Funds from Subsidiary Banks.   The Parent’s subsidiary banks are subject to restrictions under federal law that limit the transfer of funds or other items of value from such subsidiaries to the Parent and its nonbank subsidiaries (including affiliates) in so-called “covered transactions.” In general, covered transactions include loans and other extensions of credit, investments and asset purchases, as well
 
as certain other transactions involving the transfer of value from a subsidiary bank to an affiliate or for the benefit of an affiliate. Unless an exemption applies, covered transactions by a subsidiary bank with a single affiliate are limited to 10% of the subsidiary bank’s capital and surplus and, with respect to all covered transactions with affiliates in the aggregate, to 20% of the subsidiary bank’s capital and surplus. Also, loans and extensions of credit to affiliates generally are required to be secured by qualifying collateral. A bank’s transactions with its nonbank affiliates are also generally required to be on arm’s length terms.
 
Source of Strength.  The FRB has a policy that a BHC is expected to act as a source of financial and managerial strength to each of its subsidiary banks and, under appropriate circumstances, to commit resources to support each such subsidiary bank. This support may be required at times when the BHC may not have the resources to provide the support.
The OCC may order an assessment of the Parent if the capital of one of its national bank subsidiaries were to become impaired. If the Parent failed to pay the assessment within three months, the OCC could order the sale of the Parent’s stock in the national bank to cover the deficiency.
 
Depositor Preference.   In the event of the “liquidation or other resolution” of an insured depository institution, the claims of deposits payable in the United States (including the claims of the FDIC as subrogee of insured depositors) and certain claims for administrative expenses of the FDIC as a receiver will have priority over other general unsecured claims against the institution. If an insured depository institution fails, claims of insured and uninsured U.S. depositors, along with claims of the FDIC, will have priority in payment ahead of unsecured creditors, including the Parent, and depositors whose deposits are solely payable at such insured depository institution’s non-U.S. offices.
 
Liability of Commonly Controlled Institutions.   All of the Company’s subsidiary banks are insured by the FDIC. FDIC-insured depository institutions can be held liable for any loss incurred, or reasonably expected to be incurred, by the FDIC due to the default of an FDIC-insured depository institution controlled by the same bank holding company, and for any assistance provided by the FDIC to an FDIC-insured depository institution that is in danger of default and that is controlled by the same bank holding company. “Default” means generally the appointment of a conservator or receiver. “In danger of default” means generally the existence of certain conditions indicating that a default is likely to occur in the absence of regulatory assistance.
 
Dodd-Frank Act  
 
The Dodd-Frank Act, enacted on July 21, 2010, has resulted in broad changes to the U.S. financial system and is the most significant financial reform legislation since the 1930s. The Dodd-Frank Act and the numerous rules to implement its provisions have resulted in enhanced regulation and supervision of large BHCs, such as Wells Fargo. This includes, among other things, rules to promote financial stability and prevent or mitigate the risks that may arise from the material distress or failure of a large BHC; enhance consumer protections; prohibit proprietary trading; and implement enhanced prudential requirements for large BHCs regarding risk-based capital and leverage, risk and liquidity management,

3



stress testing, and recovery and resolution planning. The Dodd-Frank Act, including current and future rules implementing its provisions and the interpretation of those rules, has affected, and we expect will continue to affect, most of our businesses in some way, either directly through regulation of specific activities or indirectly through regulation of concentration risks, capital or liquidity. For more information about the Dodd-Frank Act and its effect on our business, see the “Regulatory Matters” and "Risk Factors" sections of the 2018 Annual Report to Shareholders.
   
Capital Requirements and Planning
 
The Company and each of our insured depository institutions are subject to various regulatory capital adequacy requirements administered by federal banking regulators. These capital rules, among other things, establish required minimum ratios relating capital to different categories of assets and exposures. Federal banking regulators have also finalized rules to impose a supplementary leverage ratio on large BHCs like Wells Fargo and our insured depository institutions and to implement a liquidity coverage ratio. The FRB has also finalized rules to address the amount of equity and unsecured long-term debt a G-SIB must hold to improve its resolvability and resiliency, often referred to as total loss absorbing capacity.
From time to time, the FRB and the Federal Financial Institutions Examination Council (FFIEC) propose changes and amendments to, and issue interpretations of, risk-based capital guidelines and related reporting instructions. In addition, the FRB closely monitors capital levels of the institutions it supervises and may require such institutions to modify capital levels based on FRB determinations. Such determinations, proposals or interpretations could, if implemented in the future, affect our reported capital ratios and net risk-adjusted assets.
As an additional means to identify problems in the financial management of depository institutions, the Federal Deposit Insurance Act (FDI Act) requires federal banking regulators to establish certain non-capital safety and soundness standards for institutions for which they are the primary federal regulator. The standards relate generally to operations and management, asset quality, interest rate exposure, executive compensation and risk management. The agencies are authorized to take action against institutions that fail to meet such standards.
The FDI Act requires federal banking regulators to take “prompt corrective action” with respect to FDIC-insured depository institutions that do not meet minimum capital requirements. A depository institution’s treatment for purposes of the prompt corrective action provisions will depend upon how its capital levels compare to various capital measures and certain other factors, as established by regulation.
In addition, the FRB's capital plan rule requires large BHCs to submit capital plans annually for review to determine if the FRB has any objections before making any capital distributions. The rule requires updates to capital plans in the event of material changes in a BHC’s risk profile, including as a result of any significant acquisitions. Federal banking regulators also require stress tests to evaluate whether an institution has sufficient capital to continue to operate during periods of adverse economic and financial conditions.
For more information on our capital requirements and planning, see the “Capital Management” section of the 2018 Annual Report to Shareholders.
 
 
Deposit Insurance Assessments
 
Our subsidiary banks, including Wells Fargo Bank, N.A., are members of the Deposit Insurance Fund (DIF) maintained by the FDIC. Through the DIF, the FDIC insures the deposits of our banks up to prescribed limits for each depositor and funds the DIF through assessments on member banks. To maintain the DIF, member institutions are assessed an insurance premium based on an assessment base and an assessment rate.
The Dodd-Frank Act gave the FDIC greater discretion to manage the DIF, changed the assessment base from domestic deposits to consolidated average assets less average tangible equity, and mandated a minimum Designated Reserve Ratio (reserve ratio or DRR) of 1.35%. The FDIC Board adopted a Restoration Plan to ensure that the DIF reserve ratio reaches 1.35% by September 30, 2020, as required by the Dodd-Frank Act, and, in March 2016, issued a final rule to meet this DRR level. The final rule, which became effective on July 1, 2016, imposed on insured depository institutions with $10 billion or more in assets, such as Wells Fargo, a surcharge of 4.5 cents per $100 of their assessment base, after making certain adjustments. The surcharge was in addition to the base assessments paid by the affected institutions. The surcharge was completed in third quarter 2018. In addition to ensuring that the DIF reserve ratio reached the statutory minimum of 1.35% by September 30, 2020, the FDIC Board also finalized a comprehensive, long-range plan for DIF management, whereby the DRR has been targeted at 2%.
In addition to the base assessments and any surcharge, all FDIC-insured depository institutions must also pay a quarterly assessment towards interest payments on bonds (commonly referred to as FICO bonds) issued by the Financing Corporation, a federal corporation chartered under the authority of the Federal Housing Finance Board. This assessment was 0.46% of the assessable deposit base for first quarter 2018 , 0.44% for second quarter 2018, and was 0.32% for the third and fourth quarters of 2018 . For the year ended December 31, 2018 , the Company’s FDIC deposit insurance assessments, including FICO assessments, totaled $1.1 billion.
The FDIC may terminate a depository institution’s deposit insurance upon a finding that the institution’s financial condition is unsafe or unsound or that the institution has engaged in unsafe or unsound practices or has violated any applicable rule, regulation, order or condition enacted or imposed by the institution’s regulatory agency. The termination of deposit insurance for one or more of our bank subsidiaries could have a material adverse effect on our earnings, depending on the collective size of the particular banks involved.
 
Fiscal and Monetary Policies
 
Our business and earnings are affected significantly by the fiscal and monetary policies of the federal government and its agencies. We are particularly affected by the policies of the FRB, which regulates the supply of money and credit in the United States. Among the instruments of monetary policy available to the FRB are (a) conducting open market operations in United States government securities, (b) changing the discount rates of borrowings of depository institutions, (c) imposing or changing reserve requirements against depository institutions’ deposits, and (d) imposing or changing reserve requirements against certain borrowings by banks and their affiliates. These methods are used in varying degrees and combinations to directly affect the availability of bank loans

4



and deposits, as well as the interest rates charged on loans and paid on deposits. The policies of the FRB may have a material effect on our business, results of operations and financial condition.
 
Privacy Provisions of the Gramm-Leach-Bliley Act and Restrictions on Affiliate Marketing
 
Federal banking regulators, as required under the Gramm-Leach-Bliley Act (the GLB Act), have adopted rules limiting the ability of banks and other financial institutions to disclose nonpublic information about consumers to nonaffiliated third parties. The rules require disclosure of privacy policies to consumers and, in some circumstances, allow consumers to prevent disclosure of certain personal information to nonaffiliated third parties. The privacy provisions of the GLB Act affect how consumer information is transmitted through diversified financial services companies and conveyed to outside vendors. Federal financial regulators have issued regulations under the Fair and Accurate Credit Transactions Act that have the effect of increasing the length of the waiting period, after privacy disclosures are provided to new customers, before information can be shared among different affiliated companies for the purpose of marketing products and services by those affiliated companies. 

Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002
 
The Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 (Sarbanes-Oxley) implemented a broad range of corporate governance and accounting measures to increase corporate responsibility, to provide for enhanced penalties for accounting and auditing improprieties at publicly traded companies, and to protect investors by improving the accuracy and reliability of disclosures under federal securities laws. We are subject to Sarbanes-Oxley because we are required to file periodic reports with the SEC under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934. Among other things, Sarbanes-Oxley and/or its implementing regulations established membership requirements and additional responsibilities for our audit committee, imposed restrictions on the relationship between us and our outside auditors (including restrictions on the types of non-audit services our auditors may provide to us), imposed additional responsibilities for our external financial statements on our chief executive officer and chief financial officer, expanded the disclosure requirements for our corporate insiders, required our management to evaluate our disclosure controls and procedures and our internal control over financial reporting, and required our independent registered public accounting firm to issue a report on our internal control over financial reporting.
 
Patriot Act
 
The Uniting and Strengthening America by Providing Appropriate Tools Required to Intercept and Obstruct Terrorism Act of 2001 (Patriot Act) is intended to strengthen the ability of U.S. law enforcement agencies and intelligence communities to work together to combat terrorism on a variety of fronts. The Patriot Act has significant implications for depository institutions, brokers, dealers and other businesses involved in the transfer of money. The Patriot Act requires the implementation of policies and procedures relating to anti‑money laundering, compliance, suspicious activities, and currency transaction reporting and due diligence on customers.
 
The Patriot Act also requires federal banking regulators to evaluate the effectiveness of an applicant in combating money laundering in determining whether to approve a proposed bank acquisition.
 
Future Legislation or Regulation
 
Economic, market and political conditions during the past few years have led to a significant amount of legislation and regulation in the U.S. and abroad affecting the financial services industry, as well as heightened expectations and scrutiny of financial services companies from banking regulators. Further legislative changes and additional regulations may change our operating environment in substantial and unpredictable ways. Such legislation and regulations could increase our cost of doing business, affect our compensation structure, restrict or expand the activities in which we may engage or affect the competitive balance among banks, savings associations, credit unions, and other financial institutions. We cannot predict whether future legislative proposals will be enacted and, if enacted, the effect that they, or any implementing regulations, would have on our business, results of operations or financial condition.

ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
 
Additional information in response to this Item 1 can be found in the 2018 Annual Report to Shareholders under “Financial Review” and under “Financial Statements.” That information is incorporated into this item by reference.
ITEM 1A.
RISK FACTORS

Information in response to this Item 1A can be found in this report on pages 2-6 and in the 2018 Annual Report to Shareholders under “Financial Review – Risk Factors.” That information is incorporated into this item by reference.
 
ITEM 1B.
UNRESOLVED STAFF COMMENTS
 
Not applicable.

5



ITEM 2.
PROPERTIES

December 31, 2018
  
Approximate square footage
(in millions)
We currently occupy properties in:
 
 
 
 
 
United States
 
 
San Francisco, California
  
 
420 Montgomery Street (corporate headquarters)
 
0.3
All other San Francisco locations
 
3.9
Total San Francisco, California
 
4.2
 
 
 
Top 10 other U.S. locations:
 
 
Charlotte-Concord-Gastonia, NC-SC
 
7.9
Minneapolis-St. Paul-Bloomington, MN-WI
  
5.7
Los Angeles-Long Beach-Anaheim, CA
  
4.0
Phoenix-Mesa-Scottsdale, AZ
  
3.5
New York-Newark-Jersey City, NY-NJ-PA
  
3.5
Des Moines-West Des Moines, IA
  
3.3
St. Louis, MO-IL
  
2.5
Philadelphia-Camden-Wilmington, PA-NJ-DE-MD
  
2.1
Dallas-Fort Worth-Arlington, TX
  
1.7
Miami-Fort Lauderdale-West Palm Beach, FL
  
1.7
All other U.S. locations
  
45.0
Total United States
  
85.1
 
  
 
Top 5 International locations:
  
 
India
  
2.2
Philippines
  
1.0
United Kingdom
 
0.2
Canada
 
0.2
China
 
0.2
All other international locations
  
0.2
Total International
  
4.0
 
 
 
Total square footage property occupied
 
89.1
As of December 31, 2018 , we provided banking, investment and mortgage products and services, as well as consumer and commercial finance, through approximately 7,800 locations under ownership and lease agreements. We continue to evaluate our owned and leased properties and may determine from time to time that certain of our properties are no longer necessary for our operations. There is no assurance that we will be able to dispose of any excess properties or that we will not incur charges in connection with such dispositions, which could be material to our operating results in a given period.

ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
 
Additional information in response to this Item 2 can be found in the 2018 Annual Report to Shareholders under “Financial Statements – Notes to Financial Statements – Note 7 (Premises, Equipment, Lease Commitments and Other Assets).” That information is incorporated into this item by reference.

 
ITEM 3.
LEGAL PROCEEDINGS

Information in response to this Item 3 can be found in the 2018 Annual Report to Shareholders under “Financial Statements – Notes to Financial Statements – Note 16 (Legal Actions).” That information is incorporated into this item by reference.
ITEM 4.
MINE SAFETY DISCLOSURES
 
Not applicable.

6



PART II
ITEM 5.
MARKET FOR REGISTRANT’S COMMON EQUITY, RELATED STOCKHOLDER MATTERS AND ISSUER PURCHASES OF EQUITY SECURITIES
 
MARKET INFORMATION
 
The Company’s common stock is listed on the NYSE (symbol “WFC”). The “Stock Performance” section of the 2018 Annual Report to Shareholders provides stockholder return comparisons and is incorporated herein by reference. At February 19,  2019 , there were 173,797 holders of record of the Company’s common stock.
 
DIVIDENDS
 
The dividend restrictions discussions on page 3 of this report and in the 2018 Annual Report to Shareholders under “Financial Statements – Notes to Financial Statements – Note 3 (Cash, Loan and Dividend Restrictions)” are incorporated into this item by reference.

 
REPURCHASES OF EQUITY SECURITIES
 
In January 2018, our Board of Directors authorized the repurchase of 350 million shares of our common stock. In October 2018, our Board of Directors authorized the repurchase of an additional 350 million shares of our common stock. The authorizations cover shares repurchased to meet team member benefit plan requirements. The Company maintains a variety of retirement plans for its team members and typically is a net issuer of shares of common stock to these plans. From time to time, it also purchases shares of common stock from these plans to accommodate team member preferences. Share repurchases are subtracted from the Company’s repurchase authority without offset for share issuances. Shares may be repurchased as part of employee stock option exercises, from the different benefit plans or in the open market, subject to regulatory approval.
The amount and timing of stock repurchases will be based on various factors, including our capital requirements, the number of shares we expect to issue for employee benefit plans and acquisitions, market conditions (including the trading price of our stock), and regulatory and legal considerations. In June 2010, our Board of Directors also authorized the repurchase of up to $1 billion of warrants to purchase our common stock. The amount and timing of warrant repurchases were based on various factors including market conditions. The warrants expired on October 29, 2018. See the “Capital Management” section in the 2018  Annual Report to Shareholders for additional information about our common stock and warrant repurchases.
The following table shows Company repurchases of its common stock for each calendar month in the quarter ended December 31, 2018.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
 
 
Maximum number of 

  
 
  
 
Total number 

 
 
 
shares that may yet 

  
 
  
 
of shares 

 
Weighted-average

 
be repurchased under 

Calendar month
 
repurchased (1) 

 
price paid per share

 
the authorizations

October
 
16,714,696

 
$
52.49

 
521,271,489

November
 
51,737,904

 
53.01

 
469,533,585

December (2)
 
74,199,170

 
49.58

 
395,334,415

  
 
Total
 
142,651,770

 
  
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(1)
All shares were repurchased under an authorization covering up to 350 million shares of common stock approved by the Board of Directors and publicly announced by the Company on January 23, 2018. In addition, the Company publicly announced on October 23, 2018, that the Board of Directors authorized the repurchase of an additional 350 million shares of common stock. Unless modified or revoked by the Board, these authorizations do not expire.
(2)
December includes a private repurchase transaction of 19,264,045 shares at a weighted-average price per share of $51.91.

The following table shows Company repurchases of the warrants for each calendar month in the quarter ended December 31, 2018.
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
  
 
  
 
Total number 

 
  

 
Maximum dollar value 

  
 
  
 
of warrants 

 
Average price 

 
of warrants that 

Calendar month
 
repurchased (1) 

 
paid per warrant 

 
may yet be repurchased 

October
 

 
$

 

November
 

 

 

December
 

 

 

  
 
Total
 

 
  
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(1)
All outstanding warrants expired on October 29, 2018.


7



ITEM 6.
SELECTED FINANCIAL DATA
 
Information in response to this Item 6 can be found in the 2018  Annual Report to Shareholders under “Financial Review” in Table 1. That information is incorporated into this item by reference.
ITEM 7.
MANAGEMENT'S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS
 
Information in response to this Item 7 can be found in the 2018  Annual Report to Shareholders under “Financial Review.” That information is incorporated into this item by reference.
ITEM 7A.
QUANTITATIVE AND QUALITATIVE DISCLOSURES ABOUT MARKET RISK
 
Information in response to this Item 7A can be found in the 2018 Annual Report to Shareholders under “Financial Review – Risk Management – Asset/Liability Management.” That information is incorporated into this item by reference.

 
ITEM 8.
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS AND SUPPLEMENTARY DATA
 
Information in response to this Item 8 can be found in the 2018 Annual Report to Shareholders under “Financial Statements,” under “Notes to Financial Statements” and under “Quarterly Financial Data.” That information is incorporated into this item by reference.

ITEM 9.
CHANGES IN AND DISAGREEMENTS WITH ACCOUNTANTS ON ACCOUNTING AND FINANCIAL DISCLOSURE
 
Not applicable.
ITEM 9A.
CONTROLS AND PROCEDURES
 
Information in response to this Item 9A can be found in the
2018 Annual Report to Shareholders under “Controls and
Procedures.” That information is incorporated into this item by reference.
ITEM 9B.
OTHER INFORMATION
 
Not applicable.

8



PART III
 


ITEM 10.
DIRECTORS, EXECUTIVE OFFICERS AND CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
 
EXECUTIVE OFFICERS OF THE REGISTRANT
 
David C. Galloreese (age 39)
Senior Executive Vice President since January 2019, Executive Vice President from July 2018 to January 2019, and Human Resources Director since July 2018;
Senior Vice President and Head of Talent at Walmart Inc., a multinational retailer, from October 2017 to June 2018;
Senior Vice President and Chief Human Resources Officer at Sam’s Club (Walmart Inc.) from October 2016 to June 2018;
Vice President and Head of Human Resources at Medallia Inc., an international software company, from May 2012 to October 2016.
Mr. Galloreese has served with the Company for less than 1 year.

Richard D. Levy (age 61)
Executive Vice President and Controller since February 2007.
Mr. Levy has served with the Company for 16 years.

Mary T. Mack (age 56)
Senior Executive Vice President (Consumer Lending) since December 2017 and Senior Executive Vice President (Community Banking) since November 2016;
Executive Vice President (Wells Fargo Clearing Services, LLC, f/k/a Wells Fargo Advisors, LLC) from December 2009 to November 2016.
Ms. Mack has served with the Company or its predecessors for 34 years.

Avid Modjtabai (age 57)
Senior Executive Vice President (Payments, Virtual Solutions and Innovation) since November 2016;
Senior Executive Vice President (Consumer Lending) from July 2011 to November 2016.
Ms. Modjtabai has served with the Company or its predecessors for 25 years. 

Amanda G. Norton (age 52)
Senior Executive Vice President and Chief Risk Officer since June 2018;
Chief Risk Officer of Consumer and Community Banking at JPMorgan Chase & Co., a financial services company, from November 2013 to June 2018.
Ms. Norton has served with the Company for less than 1 year.

C. Allen Parker (age 63)
Senior Executive Vice President and General Counsel since March 2017;
Presiding Partner at the law firm of Cravath, Swaine & Moore LLP from January 2013 to December 2016;
Deputy Presiding Partner at Cravath, Swaine & Moore LLP from January 2007 to December 2012;
Partner in the Corporate Department at Cravath, Swaine & Moore LLP from June 1990 to March 2017.
Mr. Parker has served with the Company for 2 years.

Perry G. Pelos (age 55)
Senior Executive Vice President (Wholesale Banking) since November 2016;
Executive Vice President (Commercial Banking Services Group) from January 2016 to November 2016;
Executive Vice President (Commercial Banking, f/k/a Middle Market Banking) from May 2009 to January 2016.
Mr. Pelos has served with the Company or its predecessors for 31 years.
 
John R. Shrewsberry (age 53)
Senior Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer since May 2014;
President and Chief Executive Officer (Wells Fargo Securities, LLC) from November 2009 to May 2014.
Mr. Shrewsberry has served with the Company or its predecessors for 20 years.

Timothy J. Sloan (age 58)
President since November 2015 and Chief Executive Officer since October 2016;
Chief Operating Officer from November 2015 to October 2016;
Senior Executive Vice President (Wholesale Banking) from May 2014 to November 2015;
Senior Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer from February 2011 to May 2014.
Mr. Sloan has served with the Company or its predecessors for 31 years.
 

9



Jonathan G. Weiss (age 61)
Senior Executive Vice President (Wealth and Investment Management) since July 2017;
President and Chief Executive Officer of Wells Fargo Securities, LLC from May 2014 to June 2017;
Managing Director of Wells Fargo Securities, LLC (Investment Banking, Securities & Markets, f/k/a Investment Banking & Capital Markets) from June 2008 to May 2014.
Mr. Weiss has served with the Company for 13 years.
 
There is no family relationship between any of the Company’s executive officers or directors. All executive officers serve at the pleasure of the Board of Directors.
AUDIT COMMITTEE INFORMATION
 
The Audit and Examination Committee is a standing audit committee of the Board of Directors established in accordance with Section 3(a)(58)(A) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934. The Committee has four members: John D. Baker II, Theodore F. Craver, Jr., James H. Quigley (Chair), and Ronald L. Sargent. Each member is independent, as independence for audit committee members is defined by NYSE rules. The Board of Directors has determined, in its business judgment, that each member of the Audit and Examination Committee is financially literate, as required by NYSE rules, and that each qualifies as an “audit committee financial expert” as defined by SEC regulations.

CODE OF ETHICS AND BUSINESS
CONDUCT
 
The Company’s Code of Ethics and Business Conduct applicable to team members (including executive officers) as well as directors, the Company’s corporate governance guidelines, and the charters for the Audit and Examination, Governance and Nominating, Human Resources, Corporate Responsibility, Credit, Finance, and Risk Committees are available at www.wellsfargo.com/about/corporate/governance .

ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
 
Additional information in response to this Item 10 can be found in the Company’s 2019 Proxy Statement under “Ownership of Our Common Stock – Directors and Executive Officers – Section 16(a) Beneficial Ownership Reporting Compliance,” under “Corporate Governance – Item 1 – Election of Directors – Director Nominees for Election,” and “Corporate Governance – Director Election Standard and Nomination Process – Director Nomination Process.” That information is incorporated into this item by reference.

ITEM 11.
EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION
 
Information in response to this Item 11 can be found in the Company’s 2019 Proxy Statement under “Corporate Governance – Compensation Committee Interlocks and Insider Participation,” under “Corporate Governance – Director Compensation,” under “Information About Related Persons – Related Person Transactions,” and under “Executive Compensation – Compensation Committee Report,” “Executive Compensation – Compensation Discussion and Analysis,” “Executive Compensation – Executive Compensation Tables,” and “Human Capital Management – Performance Management and Compensation – Incentive Compensation
 
Risk Management,” and “Human Capital Management – Our Workforce – CEO Pay Ratio and Annual Median Total Compensation.” That information is incorporated into this item by reference.
ITEM 12.
SECURITY OWNERSHIP OF CERTAIN BENEFICIAL OWNERS AND MANAGEMENT AND RELATED STOCKHOLDER MATTERS
 
Information in response to this Item 12 can be found in the Company’s 2019 Proxy Statement under “Ownership of Our Common Stock – Directors and Executive Officers – Director and Executive Officer Stock Ownership Table,” “Ownership of Our Common Stock – Principal Shareholders,” and “Executive Compensation – Equity Compensation Plan Information.” That information is incorporated into this item by reference.

ITEM 13.
CERTAIN RELATIONSHIPS AND RELATED TRANSACTIONS, AND DIRECTOR INDEPENDENCE
 
Information in response to this Item 13 can be found in the Company’s 2019 Proxy Statement under “Corporate Governance – Item 1 – Election of Directors – Director Independence” and under “Information About Related Persons.” That information is incorporated into this item by reference.
ITEM 14.
PRINCIPAL ACCOUNTING FEES AND SERVICES
 
Information in response to this Item 14 can be found in the Company’s 2019 Proxy Statement under “Audit Matters – Item 4 – Ratify Appointment of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm for 2019 – KPMG Fees” and “Audit Matters – Item 4 – Ratify Appointment of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm for 2019 – Audit and Examination Committee Pre-Approval Policies and Procedures.” That information is incorporated into this item by reference.

10



PART IV

ITEM 15.
EXHIBITS AND FINANCIAL STATEMENT SCHEDULES
 
1.  FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
 
The Company’s consolidated financial statements, including the notes thereto, and the report of the independent registered public accounting firm thereon, are set forth in the 2018 Annual Report to Shareholders, and are incorporated into this item by reference.
 
2.  FINANCIAL STATEMENT SCHEDULES
 
All financial statement schedules for the Company have been included in the consolidated financial statements or the related footnotes, or are either inapplicable or not required.
 


11



3.  EXHIBITS
 
A list of exhibits to this Form 10-K is set forth below. Shareholders may obtain a copy of any of the following exhibits, upon payment of a reasonable fee, by writing to Wells Fargo & Company, Office of the Corporate Secretary, MAC D1130-117, 301 S. Tryon Street, 11th Floor, Charlotte, North Carolina 28202.
 
The Company’s SEC file number is 001-2979. On and before November 2, 1998, the Company filed documents with the SEC under the name Norwest Corporation. The former Wells Fargo & Company filed documents under SEC file number 001-6214. The former Wachovia Corporation filed documents under SEC file number 001-10000.
Exhibit
Number
 
Description
 
Location
3(a) 
 
 
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3(a) to the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended September 30, 2018.
3(b) 
 
 
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.1 to the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed March 1, 2018.
4(a) 
 
See Exhibits 3(a) and 3(b).
 
 
4(b) 
 
The Company agrees to furnish upon request to the Commission a copy of each instrument defining the rights of holders of senior and subordinated debt of the Company.
 
 
10(a)*
 
 
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(b) to the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed April 26, 2013.
 
 
 
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(a) to the Company's Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2015.
 
 
 
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(a) to the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 2009.
 
 
Forms of Performance Share Award Agreement:
 
 
 
 
 
Filed herewith.
 
 
 
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(a) to the Company's Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2017.
 
 
 
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(a) to the Company's Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2016.
 
 
 
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(a) to the Company's Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2015.
 
 
 
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(a) to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2014.
 
 
 
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(a) to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2012.
 
 
Forms of Restricted Share Rights Award Agreement:
 
 
 
 
 
Filed herewith.
 
 
 
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(a) to the Company's Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2017.
 
 
 
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(a) to the Company's Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 2017.
Management contract or compensatory plan or arrangement.
 
 

12



Exhibit
Number
 
Description
 
Location
 
 
 
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(a) to the Company's Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2015.
 
 
 
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(a) to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2014.
 
 
 
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(a) to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2012.
 
 
 
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(b) to the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 2013.
 
 
 
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(a) to the Company's Current Report on Form 8-K filed September 28, 2016.
10(b)*

 
Wells Fargo Bonus Plan, as amended effective January 1, 2018.
 
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(a) to the Company's Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 2018.
 
 
 
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 1o(b) to the Company's Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 2017.
10(c)*
 
 
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(f) to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2009.
 
 
 
Filed herewith.
 
 
 
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(c) to the Company's Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 2017.
 
 
 
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(d) to the Company's Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2016.
 
 
 
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(a) to the Company's Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 2016.
 
 
 
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(e) to the Company's Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2015.
 
 
 
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(a) to the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 2014.
 
 
 
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(e) to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2012.
 
 
 
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(a) to the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 2011.
 
 
 
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(f) to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2009.
10(d)*
 
 
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(f) to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2007.

13



Exhibit
Number
 
Description
 
Location
 
 
 
 
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(a) to the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 2013.
 
 
 
 
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(a) to the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended March 31, 2013.
 
 
 
 
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(f) to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2011.
 
 
 
 
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(d) to the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended March 31, 2011.
 
 
 
 
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(a) to the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended March 31, 2009.
 
 
 
 
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(a) to the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended September 30, 2008.
 
 
 
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(f) to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2007.
 
 
 
 
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(f) to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2006.
 
 
 
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(b) to the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 2013.
10(e)*
 
 
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(c) to the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended September 30, 1999.
 
 
 
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(a) to the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended September 30, 2003.
 
 
 
Filed as paragraph (4) of Exhibit 10(ff) to the Company's Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2000.
10(f)*
 
 
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(d) to the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended September 30, 1999.
 
 
 
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(c) to the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended September 30, 2003.
 
 
 
Filed as paragraph (5) of Exhibit 10(ff) to the Company's Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2000.
10(g)*
 
 
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(e) to the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended September 30, 1999.

14



Exhibit
Number
 
Description
 
Location
 
 
 
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(b) to the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended September 30, 2003.
 
 
 
Filed as paragraph (6) of Exhibit 10(ff) to the Company's Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2000.
10(h)*
 
 
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(b) to the former Wells Fargo’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 1997.
 
 
 
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(d) to the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended September 30, 2003.
10(i)*
 
 
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(c) to the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed May 4, 2009.
 
 
 
Filed herewith.
 
 
 
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(d) to the Company's Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 2017.
 
 
 
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(b) to the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 2014.
10(j)*
 
 
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(b) to the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed May 4, 2009.
 
 
 
Filed herewith.
 
 
 
Filed herewith.
 
 
 
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(e) to the Company's Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 2017.
10(k)*
 
Supplemental Long-Term Disability Plan.
 
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(f) to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 1990.
 
 
Amendment to Supplemental Long-Term Disability Plan.
 
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(g) to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 1992.
10(l)*
 
 
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(y) to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2003.
10(m)*
 
 
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(w) to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2008.
10(n)*
 
 
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(q) to the Company's Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2015.
10(o)*
 
 
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(s) to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2014.

15



Exhibit
Number
 
Description
 
Location
10(p)*
 
 
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit (10)(f) to Wachovia Corporation’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed December 29, 2008.
 
 
 
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(aa) to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2009.
10(q)*
 
 
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit (10)(d) to Wachovia   Corporation’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 1997.
10(r)*
 
 
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit (99) to Wachovia Corporation’s   Current Report on Form 8-K filed January 5, 2005.
10(s)*
 
 
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(b) to Wachovia Corporation's Current Report on Form 8-K filed December 29, 2008.
 
 
 
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit (10)(gg) to Wachovia   Corporation’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2002.
 
 
 
Filed herewith.
 
 
 
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(f) to the Company's Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 2017.
 
 
 
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(b) to the Company's Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 2016.
 
 
 
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit (10)(c) to Wachovia Corporation’s   Current Report on Form 8-K filed December 29, 2008.
 
 
 
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit (10)(b) to Wachovia   Corporation’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed December 20, 2007.
10(t)*
 
 
Incorporated by reference to Appendix E to Wachovia Corporation’s   Registration Statement on Form S-4 (Reg. No. 333-134656) filed   on July 24, 2006.
 
 
 
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(b) to the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended March 31, 2009.
 
 
 
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(ss) to Wachovia Corporation's Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2004.
 
 
 
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(g) to the Company's Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 2017.
10(u)*
 
 
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(bb) to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2014.
10(v)*
 
 
Filed herewith.

16



Exhibit
Number
 
Description
 
Location
13
 
 
Filed herewith. 
21
 
 
Filed herewith.
23
 
 
Filed herewith.
24
 
 
Filed herewith.
31(a)
 
 
Filed herewith.
31(b)
 
 
Filed herewith.
32(a)
 
 
Furnished herewith.
32(b)
 
 
Furnished herewith.
 
99
 
 
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99 to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2013.
101.INS
 
XBRL Instance Document.
 
Filed herewith.
101.SCH
 
XBRL Taxonomy Extension Schema Document.
 
Filed herewith.
101.CAL
 
XBRL Taxonomy Extension Calculation Linkbase Document.
 
Filed herewith.
101.LAB
 
XBRL Taxonomy Extension Label Linkbase Document.
 
Filed herewith.
101.PRE
 
XBRL Taxonomy Extension Presentation Linkbase Document.
 
Filed herewith.
101.DEF
 
XBRL Taxonomy Extension Definitions Linkbase Document.
 
Filed herewith.


17



SIGNATURES
 
Pursuant to the requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the registrant has duly caused this report to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, on February 27, 2019 .
 
WELLS FARGO & COMPANY
 
 
By:     
/s/ TIMOTHY J. SLOAN
Timothy J. Sloan
President and Chief Executive Officer
 
Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, this report has been signed below by the following persons on behalf of the registrant and in the capacities and on the dates indicated.
 
 
By:      
/s/ TIMOTHY J. SLOAN
Timothy J. Sloan
President and Chief Executive Officer
(Principal Executive Officer)
February 27, 2019
  
By:     
/s/ JOHN R. SHREWSBERRY
John R. Shrewsberry
Senior Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer
(Principal Financial Officer)
February 27, 2019
  
By:     
/s/ RICHARD D. LEVY
Richard D. Levy
Executive Vice President and Controller
(Principal Accounting Officer)
February 27, 2019
 
 
The Directors of Wells Fargo & Company listed below have duly executed powers of attorney empowering James H. Quigley to sign this document on their behalf.
 
John D. Baker II
Wayne M. Hewett
Karen B. Peetz
Ronald L. Sargent
Celeste A. Clark
Donald M. James
Juan A. Pujadas
Timothy J. Sloan
Theodore F. Craver, Jr.
Maria R. Morris
James H. Quigley
Suzanne M. Vautrinot
Elizabeth A. Duke
 
 
 
  
By:     
/s/ JAMES H. QUIGLEY
James H. Quigley
Director and Attorney-in-fact
February 27, 2019
 


18


Exhibit 10(a)

Form of Performance Share Award Agreement for Grants on or after February 26, 2019
Brackets identify provisions that may vary depending on the particular grant, grant recipient
and/or other relevant factor.

WELLS FARGO & COMPANY
LONG-TERM INCENTIVE COMPENSATION PLAN
PERFORMANCE SHARE AWARD AGREEMENT

1.
Award. Wells Fargo & Company (the “Company”) has awarded you Performance Shares to provide an incentive for you to remain in the employment of the Company or an Affiliate and provide valuable services to the Company or an Affiliate. The target number of Performance Shares (“Target Award Number”) awarded you is identified as the “Total Granted” on the acknowledgement screen for your grant on this website. The Target Award Number is subject to upward and downward adjustments based on Company performance during the [ performance period ] (the “Performance Period”) as set forth on Exhibit A. The “Final Award Number” is the number of Performance Shares awarded to you under this Award Agreement after adjusting the Target Award Number in accordance with Exhibit A. This Award Agreement also grants Performance Shares with respect to dividend equivalents as provided in paragraph 4. Each Performance Share entitles you to receive one share of Wells Fargo & Company common stock ("Common Stock") contingent upon earning such Performance Share based on the Company performance criteria set forth on Exhibit A, vesting as set forth in paragraph 2 and subject to the other terms and conditions set forth in the Company’s Long‑Term Incentive Compensation Plan, as may be amended from time to time (the “Plan”) and this Award Agreement, including the performance conditions in paragraph 8, [and] Exhibits A and B hereto [and the attached Wells Fargo Agreement Regarding Trade Secrets, Confidential Information, Non-Solicitation and Assignment of Inventions].

2.
Vesting. Except as otherwise provided in this Award Agreement, the Final Award Number of Performance Shares will vest on the Determination Date as set forth on Exhibit A (“Determination Date”), subject to the performance conditions in paragraph 8, which apply through the Settlement Date. Shares of Common Stock will be issued to you or, in case of your death, your Beneficiary determined in accordance with the Plan. You will have no rights as a stockholder of the Company with respect to your Performance Shares (including any Performance Shares with respect to dividend equivalents as provided below) until settlement. However, you may be entitled to dividend equivalents as set forth in paragraph 4. Except as otherwise provided in the Plan or this Award Agreement, vested Performance Shares will be settled and distributed in shares of Common Stock on [ applicable date] (the “Settlement Date”).

3.
Termination.
(a)
If prior to [ end of Performance Period ] you cease to be an Employee due to your death, the Target Award Number of Performance Shares under this Award Agreement after giving effect to any Net Operating Loss adjustments determined in accordance with Exhibit A for any years in the Performance Period completed prior to the year in which you die (and any Performance Shares with respect to dividend equivalents as provided below) will immediately vest upon the date of your death and will be distributed to your Beneficiary in shares of Common Stock between January 2 and March 1 of the year following the year in which you die. If you cease to be an Employee due to your death on or after [ end of Performance Period ] and prior to the Determination Date, the Final Award Number of Performance Shares under this Award Agreement (and any Performance Shares with respect to dividend equivalents as provided below) will vest upon the Determination Date and will be distributed to your Beneficiary on [ applicable date ]. Notwithstanding the foregoing, if by the applicable last payment date set forth herein your Beneficiary has not presented evidence deemed satisfactory by the Company to allow transfer of the shares of Common Stock to the Beneficiary under applicable laws, the Company may treat all Performance Shares awarded hereby as forfeited, in which case the Company shall have no obligation to issue shares of Common Stock or benefits in lieu of such shares to your Beneficiary and shall have no liability therefor.

1




(b)
If prior to the Determination Date you have an involuntary Separation from Service due to [(i)] application of the Company’s Extended Absence Policy to you in connection with a Disability[, (ii) your displacement and receipt of an immediate lump sum severance benefit, placement on a Salary Continuation Leave of Absence or placement on another leave of absence which will result in your receipt of a severance benefit in connection with that leave, or (iii) the Company or an Affiliate entering into a corporate transaction with another company (the “buyer”) (including a transaction where the buyer acquires all or any portion of the assets, stock or operations of the Company or Affiliate) and pursuant to the terms of the transaction you are continuing in employment with the buyer after completion of the transaction], then the Final Award Number of Performance Shares under this Award Agreement (and any Performance Shares with respect to dividend equivalents as provided below) will vest upon the Determination Date and will be distributed to you (or your Beneficiary if you have died before such distribution) in shares of Common Stock on [ applicable date ], subject to the performance conditions in paragraphs 7 and 8 below. For purposes of this Award, the term “Separation from Service” is determined by the Company in accordance with Section 409A (as defined in paragraph 12 below) and in accordance with the definition set forth on Exhibit B to this Award Agreement, which definition is incorporated by reference herein. For purposes of this Award, the term “Disability” is defined as set forth on Exhibit B to this Award Agreement, which definition is incorporated by reference herein. Notwithstanding the foregoing, if you die following any such involuntary Separation from Service and prior to [ end of Performance Period ], the Target Award Number of Performance Shares under this Award Agreement after giving effect to any Net Operating Loss adjustments determined in accordance with Exhibit A for any years in the Performance Period completed prior to the year in which you die (and any Performance Shares with respect to dividend equivalents as provided below) will immediately vest and will be distributed to your Beneficiary in accordance with paragraph 3(a) above.

(c)
[If prior to the Determination Date, the Affiliate that employs you incurs a Change in Control and you continue employment with the buyer immediately after the Change in Control, then the Final Award Number of Performance Shares under this Award Agreement (and any Performance Shares with respect to dividend equivalents as provided below) will continue to vest upon the Determination Date and will be distributed to you (or your Beneficiary if you have died before such distribution) in shares of Common Stock on [ applicable date ], subject to the conditions and restrictions in paragraphs 7 and 8 below. For purposes of this Award, the term “Change in Control” is defined as set forth on Exhibit B to this Award Agreement, which definition is incorporated by reference herein. Notwithstanding the foregoing, if you die following such event and prior to [ end of Performance Period ], the Target Award Number of Performance Shares under this Award Agreement after giving effect to any Net Operating Loss adjustments determined in accordance with Exhibit A for any years in the Performance Period completed prior to the year in which you die (and any Performance Shares with respect to dividend equivalents as provided below) will immediately vest and will be distributed to your Beneficiary in accordance with paragraph 3(a) above.]

(d)
[If prior to the Determination Date you have a Separation from Service for a reason other than Cause and you have satisfied the definition of Retirement under the Plan on your Separation from Service date or you satisfy the definition of Retirement following your Separation from Service date at the end of an approved leave of absence not to exceed six months, the Final Award Number of Performance Shares under this Award Agreement (and any Performance Shares with respect to dividend equivalents as provided below) will continue to vest upon the Determination Date and will be distributed to you (or your Beneficiary if you have died before such distribution) in shares of Common Stock on [ applicable date ] subject to the conditions and restrictions in paragraphs 7, 8 and 9 below, and provided that beginning immediately after you cease to be an Employee and continuing until the Determination Date you satisfy each of the following conditions (“vesting conditions”): (i) you comply with the terms of the attached Wells Fargo Agreement Regarding Trade Secrets, Confidential Information, Non-Solicitation and Assignment of Inventions, which agreement is incorporated by reference herein, (ii) you do not express any derogatory or damaging statements about the Company or any Affiliate, the management or the board of directors of the Company or any Affiliate, the products, services or the business condition of the Company or any Affiliate in any public way or to anyone who could make those statements public, and (iii) to the fullest extent enforceable under the applicable state law, you do not perform services as an officer, director, employee, consultant or otherwise for any

2



business which is in competition with any line of business of the Company or any Affiliate for which you had executive responsibilities while you were employed by the Company or any Affiliate (including predecessors thereof) and which does business in any location in the geographic footprint of the Company or any Affiliate in which you had executive responsibilities. For purposes of this Award, the term “Cause” is defined as set forth on Exhibit B to this Award Agreement, which definition is incorporated by reference herein. Notwithstanding the foregoing, if you die following your Retirement and prior to [ end of Performance Period ] and have satisfied the vesting conditions set forth above through your date of death, the Target Award Number of Performance Shares under this Award Agreement after giving effect to any Net Operating Loss adjustments determined in accordance with Exhibit A for any years in the Performance Period completed prior to the year in which you die (and any Performance Shares with respect to dividend equivalents as provided below) will immediately vest and will be distributed to your Beneficiary in accordance with paragraph 3(a) above.

Notwithstanding the foregoing, nothing contained in this Award Agreement prohibits or restricts you (or your attorney) from initiating communications directly with, or responding to any inquiry from, or providing testimony before, the Securities and Exchange Commission, the Financial Industry Regulatory Authority, the National Labor Relations Board, the Equal Employment Opportunity Commission, or any self regulatory organization or governmental authority charged with the enforcement of any laws.]
(e)
If prior to the Determination Date you incur a Separation from Service other than for a reason described in paragraph 3(a), [or] 3(b), [3(c) or 3(d),] or you fail to comply with any applicable vesting condition [(including the vesting conditions set forth in paragraph 3(d))], any then unvested Performance Shares awarded hereby (including any Performance Shares with respect to dividend equivalents as provided below) will immediately terminate without notice to you and will be forfeited. For avoidance of doubt, a “Separation from Service other than as described in paragraph 3(a), [or] 3(b)[, 3(c) or 3(d)]” includes, without limitation, a voluntary Separation from Service [that does not constitute a Retirement] and an involuntary Separation from Service [for Cause] [other than due to death or application of the Company’s Extended Absence Policy to you in connection with Disability].

4.
Dividend Equivalents. During the period beginning on the Grant Date and ending on the Settlement Date for the Performance Shares or the date the Performance Shares are forfeited, whichever occurs first, if the Company pays a dividend on the Common Stock, you will automatically receive, as of the payment date for such dividend, dividend equivalents in the form of additional Performance Shares based on the amount or number of shares that would have been paid on the Final Award Number of Performance Shares (or the NOL Adjusted Target Award Number of Performance Shares as applicable under paragraphs 3(a)[, and] 3(b)[, 3(c) and 3(d)]) had they been issued and outstanding shares of Common Stock as of the record date and, if a cash dividend, the closing price of the Common Stock on the New York Stock Exchange as of the dividend payment date. You will also automatically receive dividend equivalents with respect to such additional Performance Shares, to be determined in the same manner. Performance Shares granted with respect to dividend equivalents will be subject to the same vesting schedule and other terms and conditions as the underlying Performance Shares, including the Company’s right of recoupment or forfeiture, and will be distributed in shares of Common Stock when, and if, the underlying Performance Shares are settled and distributed.

5.
Tax Withholding. The Company will withhold from the number of shares of Common Stock otherwise issuable hereunder (including with respect to dividend equivalents) a number of shares necessary to satisfy any and all applicable federal, state, local and foreign tax withholding obligations and employment-related tax requirements (“Tax-Related Items”). In addition, the Company (or your employer, if different) will withhold from your compensation any and all applicable Tax-Related Items in the event all or a portion of the Performance Shares are treated as taxable prior to or other than on the vesting date set forth in paragraph 2 above and the number of shares of Common Stock otherwise issuable (if any) is insufficient to satisfy such Tax-Related Items withholding obligations. Finally, you shall pay to the Company (or your employer, if different) any amount of Tax-Related Items that the Company or your employer may be required to withhold or account for as a result of your participation in the Plan that cannot be satisfied by the means previously described. The Company may refuse to issue or deliver the shares of Common Stock if you fail to comply with your obligations in connection with the Tax-Related Items.

3



6.
Nontransferable. Unless the Committee provides otherwise, (i) no rights under this Award will be assignable or transferable, and neither you nor your Beneficiary will have any power to anticipate, alienate, dispose of, pledge or encumber any rights under this Award, and (ii) the rights and the benefits of this Award may be exercised and received during your lifetime only by you or your legal representative.

7.
Other Restrictions; Amendment. The issuance of Common Stock hereunder is subject to compliance by the Company and you with all legal requirements applicable thereto, including compliance with the requirements of 12 C.F.R. Part 359, orders issued under 12. U.S.C. § 1818(b) (together with any agreements related thereto, “orders”)
8.
and tax withholding obligations, and with all applicable regulations of any stock exchange on which the Common Stock may be listed at the time of issuance. For the avoidance of doubt, regulatory approval under Part 359 or any orders to which the Company is a party may be required for the issuance of Common Stock hereunder in certain circumstances, and the Company cannot provide any assurance that it will be able to request such approval in accordance with the requirements of Part 359 or the applicable order or that any requested approval will be received. Subject to paragraphs 12 and 13 below, the Committee may, in its sole discretion and without your consent, reduce, delay vesting, modify, revoke, cancel, impose additional conditions and restrictions on or recover all or a portion of this Award if the Committee deems it necessary or advisable to comply with applicable laws, rules and regulations. This Award is subject to any applicable recoupment or “clawback” policies of the Company, as in effect from time to time, and any applicable recoupment or clawback requirements imposed under laws, rules and regulations.

8.
Performance Conditions. The Award is fully conditioned on and subject to performance adjustments, which include the right of the Committee to cause you to forfeit all or any unpaid portion of an Award, if the Committee determines in its sole discretion that:
You engage in misconduct which has or might reasonably be expected to have reputational or other harm to the Company or any conduct that constitutes Cause;
You engage in misconduct or commit a material error that causes or might reasonably be expected to cause significant financial or reputational harm to the Company or your business group;
The Award was based on materially inaccurate performance metrics, whether or not you were responsible for the inaccuracy;
You improperly or with gross negligence, including in a supervisory capacity, fail to identify, escalate, monitor, or manage, in a timely manner and as reasonably expected, risks material to the Company or your business group; or
The Company or your business group suffers a material downturn in its financial performance or suffers a material failure of risk management.

This Award is also subject to additional performance adjustments, including the forfeiture or cancellation of all or any unpaid portion of the Award, in the Committee’s discretion, based on your role and responsibility for progress on resolving outstanding consent orders and other regulatory matters.
The Committee may consider any factors it determines necessary or appropriate for purposes of making a determination whether a performance adjustment is appropriate and the amount of the adjustment based on the particular facts and circumstances. All determinations by the Committee will be final and binding.
9.
Stock Ownership Provision . In accordance with the terms of the Company’s stock ownership policy, as may be amended from time to time: (a) if you are an Executive Officer of the Company or a member of its Operating Committee, as a condition to receiving this Award, you agree to hold, while employed by the Company or any Affiliate and for a period of one year after your Retirement, a number of shares of Common Stock equal to at least 50% of the after-tax shares of Common Stock (assuming a 50% tax rate) acquired upon vesting and settlement of Company stock-based awards or pursuant to the exercise of Company stock options (if applicable), subject to a maximum holding requirement of shares with a value equal to ten (10) times your cash salary; and (b) if you are not an Executive Officer or member of the Operating Committee, you are expected to hold that number of shares while employed by the Company or any Affiliate.
10.
Additional Provisions. This Award Agreement is subject to the provisions of the Plan. Capitalized terms not defined in this Award Agreement or by reference to another document are used as defined in the Plan. If the Plan

4



and this Award Agreement conflict, the provisions of the Plan will govern. Interpretations of the Plan and this Award Agreement by the Committee are binding on you and the Company.
11.
No Employment Agreement. Neither the award to you of the Performance Shares nor the delivery to you of this Award Agreement or any other document relating to the Performance Shares will confer on you the right to continued employment with the Company or any Affiliate. You understand that your employment with the Company or any Affiliate is “at will” and nothing in this document changes, alters or modifies your “at will” status or your obligation to comply with all policies, procedures and rules of the Company, as they may be adopted or amended from time to time.
12.
Section 409A . This Award is intended to be exempt from or comply with the requirements of Section 409A of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended, and the applicable Treasury regulations or other binding guidance thereunder (“Section 409A”). Accordingly, all provisions included in this Award Agreement, or incorporated by reference, will be interpreted and administered in accordance with that intent. If any provision of the Plan or this Award Agreement would otherwise conflict with or frustrate this intent, that provision will be interpreted and deemed amended or limited so as to avoid the conflict; provided, however, that the Company makes no representation that the Award is exempt from or complies with Section 409A and makes no undertaking to preclude Section 409A from applying to the Award. The Company will have no liability to you or to any other party if the Award or payment of the Award that is intended to be exempt from or compliant with Section 409A is not so exempt or compliant or for any action taken by the Committee with respect thereto.
13.
Six-month Delay . Notwithstanding any provision of the Plan or this Award Agreement to the contrary, if, upon your Separation from Service for any reason, the Company determines that you are a “Specified Employee” for purposes of Section 409A and in accordance with the definition set forth on Exhibit B to this Award Agreement, which definition is incorporated by reference herein, your Performance Shares, if subject to settlement upon your Separation from Service and if required pursuant to Section 409A, will not settle before the date that is the first business day following the six-month anniversary of such Separation from Service, or, if earlier, upon your death.
14.
No Fractional Shares. The number of Performance Shares to be distributed to you under this Award Agreement will be rounded down to the nearest whole share.
15.
Severability and Judicial Modification. If any provision of this Award Agreement is held to be invalid or unenforceable under pertinent state law or otherwise or the Company elects not to enforce such restriction, the remaining provisions shall remain in full force and effect and the invalid or unenforceable provision shall be modified only to the extent necessary to render that provision valid and enforceable to the fullest extent permitted by law. If the invalid or unenforceable provision cannot be, or is not, modified, that provision shall be severed from this Award Agreement and all other provisions shall remain valid and enforceable.
16.
Applicable Law. This Award Agreement and the award of Performance Shares evidenced hereby will be governed by, and construed in accordance with the laws of the state of Delaware (without regard to its choice-of-law provisions), except to the extent Federal law would apply.
17.
Imposition of Other Requirements. The Company reserves the right to impose other requirements on your participation in the Plan, on the Award and on any shares of Common Stock acquired under the Plan, to the extent the Company determines it is necessary or advisable in order to comply with applicable law or facilitate the administration of the Plan and provided the imposition of the term or condition will not result in adverse accounting expense to the Company, and to require you to sign any additional agreements or undertakings that may be necessary to accomplish the foregoing.
18.
Electronic Delivery and Acceptance. The Company is electronically delivering documents related to current or future participation in the Plan and is requesting your consent to participate in the Plan by electronic means. You hereby consent to receive such documents by electronic delivery and agree to participate in the Plan through the current plan administrator’s on-line system, or any other on-line system or electronic means that the Company may decide, in its sole discretion, to use in the future.
19.
Entire Agreement. The Plan is incorporated herein by reference.  The Plan and this Award Agreement (including Exhibits A and B attached hereto) constitute the entire agreement of the parties with respect to the Award and

5



supersede in their entirety all prior proposals, undertakings and agreements, written or oral, and all other communications between you and the Company with respect to the Award.

[Insert requirement to acknowledge and accept grant terms]



WELLS FARGO & COMPANY
LONG-TERM INCENTIVE COMPENSATION PLAN
PERFORMANCE SHARE AWARD AGREEMENT

Exhibit A to Performance Share Award Agreement

This Exhibit A sets forth the manner in which the Final Award Number will be determined.

Definitions

Capitalized terms used but not defined herein (including, but not limited to, Return on Realized Common Equity) shall have the same meanings assigned to them in the Plan and the Award Agreement. In addition, the following terms used in the text of this Exhibit A shall have the meanings set forth below:

“Average Return on Realized Common Equity” means for each of the Financial Performance Group Companies the sum of such company’s Return on Realized Common Equity for each of the 12-month periods ending [ applicable dates during the Performance Period ], which sum is then divided by [ applicable divisor ], rounded to two decimals.

“Company Return on Realized Common Equity Ranking” means the rank of the Company’s Average Return on Realized Common Equity relative to the Average Return on Realized Common Equity achieved by each of the other Financial Performance Group Companies.

“Final Award Number Percentage” means the “Final Award Number Percentage” determined in accordance with the Determination of Final Award Number section of this Exhibit A.

“Financial Performance Group Companies” means, in addition to the Company, the companies listed below provided that any such company for which financial data as of [ end of Performance Period ], is not publicly available shall be eliminated as a Financial Performance Group Company.

[ Financial Performance Group Companies ]

“Net Operating Loss” means for any year in the Performance Period a loss that results from adjusting a net loss as reported in the Company's consolidated financial statements to eliminate the effect of the following items, each determined based on generally accepted accounting principles: (1) losses resulting from discontinued operations; (2) the cumulative effect of changes in generally accepted accounting principles; and (3) any other unusual or infrequent loss which is separately identified and quantified.

“Company Total Stockholder Return Ranking” means the rank of the Company’s Total Stockholder Return relative to the Total Stockholder Return achieved by each of the other [Financial Performance Group Companies] [Stockholder Return Group Companies].

[“Stockholder Return Group Companies” means, in addition to the Company, the companies listed below provided that any such company for which financial data as of [ end of Performance Period ] is not publicly available shall be eliminated as a Stockholder Return Group Company.]

[ Stockholder Return Group Companies ]

6




“Total Stockholder Return” means for each of the [Financial Performance Group Companies] [Stockholder Return Group Companies] (a)(i) the company’s [ applicable period ] average closing price of a share of common stock (as reported in The Wall Street Journal or such other reliable source as determined by the Committee, in its sole discretion), with the last of such [ applicable period ], plus the value of any dividends declared on such common stock in respect of an [ applicable date ], as adjusted assuming such dividends were reinvested in shares of common stock of the company on such [ applicable date ], minus (ii) the company’s [ applicable period ] average closing price of a share of common stock (as reported in The Wall Street Journal or such other reliable source as determined by the Committee, in its sole discretion), for the [ applicable period ] (“Base Price”), divided by (b) the Base Price (in each case, with such adjustments as are appropriate, in the judgment of the Committee in its sole discretion, to equitably calculate Total Stockholder Return in light of any stock splits, reverse stock splits, stock dividends, and other extraordinary transactions or other changes in the capital structure of the company, as applicable). 

Determination of Final Award Number

Net Operating Loss Adjustments . If the Company incurs a Net Operating Loss for any year in the Performance Period, the Target Award Number will be reduced by one-third for each such year, effective upon certification by the Committee of a Net Operating Loss for such year. The Target Award Number after giving effect to each such Net Operating Loss adjustment is referred to herein as the “NOL Adjusted Target Award Number.” If the Company does not incur a Net Operating Loss in any year in the Performance Period, your NOL Adjusted Target Award Number will be the same as your Target Award Number.

RORCE Adjustment . The NOL Adjusted Target Award Number will be adjusted upward or downward depending on the Company’s Average Return on Realized Common Equity performance over the Performance Period as follows:

1.
Absolute RORCE . If the Company Average Return on Realized Common Equity is equal to or greater than [ applicable % ], your Final Award Number will be determined by multiplying the NOL Adjusted Target Award Number by [ applicable % ]. If the Company Average Return on Realized Common Equity is less than [ applicable % ], your Final Award Number will be [ applicable % or other applicable number ].

2.
Relative RORCE . If the Company Average Return on Realized Common Equity is less than [ applicable % ] but equal to or greater than [ applicable % ], the Final Award Number will be determined by the Company Return on Realized Common Equity Ranking in accordance with the chart below to calculate your Final Award Number of Performance Shares. The Final Award Number of Performance Shares will be determined by multiplying (i) the Final Award Number Percentage (rounded to the nearest whole percent) by (ii) your NOL Adjusted Target Award Number. Each Final Award Number Percentage in the chart below will be based on the Company Return on Realized Common Equity Ranking in each quartile among the Financial Performance Group Companies and apply to the lowest ranking percentile in each quartile that is equal to or greater than the Company Return on Realized Common Equity Ranking percentile shown.

Company Return on Realized Common Equity Ranking
Final Award Number Percentage
Final Award Number of
  Performance Shares
[ applicable ranking ]
[ applicable % ]
[ applicable % ] x NOL Adjusted Target Award Number
[ applicable ranking ]
[ applicable % ]
[ applicable % ] x NOL Adjusted Target Award Number
[ applicable ranking ]
[ applicable % ]
[ applicable % ] x NOL Adjusted Target Award Number
---
[ applicable % ]
[ applicable % ] x NOL Adjusted Target Award Number

If the Company Return on Realized Common Equity Ranking is [ applicable ranking range ], the Final Award Number Percentage shall be interpolated on a straight-line basis between [ applicable percentage range ] and

7



the Final Award Number of Performance Shares shall be interpolated on a corresponding straight-line basis between [ applicable percentage range ] of the NOL Adjusted Target Award Number, but in no event will the Final Award Number Percentage exceed [ applicable percentage ] unless the Company Total Stockholder Return Ranking is [ applicable percentage range ].

If the Company Return on Realized Common Equity Ranking is [ applicable ranking range ], the Final Award Number Percentage shall be interpolated on a straight-line basis between [ applicable percentage range ] and the Final Award Number of Performance Shares shall be interpolated on a corresponding straight-line basis between [ applicable percentage range ] of the NOL Adjusted Target Award Number.

If the Company does not have the lowest Average Return on Realized Common Equity among the Financial Performance Group Companies and the Company Return on Realized Common Equity Ranking is [ applicable ranking range ], the Final Award Number Percentage shall be interpolated on a straight-line basis between [ applicable percentage range ] and the Final Award Number of Performance Shares shall be interpolated on a straight-line basis between [ applicable percentage range ] of the NOL Adjusted Target Award Number.

In no event shall the Final Award Number Percentage be greater than [ applicable percentage ] nor shall the Final Award Number of Performance Shares be greater than [ applicable percentage ] of the NOL Adjusted Target Award Number. If the Company Total Stockholder Return Ranking is below the [ applicable percentage range], in no event shall the Final Award Number Percentage be greater than [ applicable percentage] nor shall the Final Award Number of Performance Shares be greater than [ applicable percentage ] of the NOL Adjusted Target Award Number.

As provided in paragraph 4, you will be entitled to receive Performance Shares with respect to dividend equivalents on the Final Award Number (or the Target Award Number, as applicable and as may be adjusted under paragraphs 3(a), [and] 3(b)[, 3(c) and 3(d)]) to determine the total number of Performance Shares that will be distributed to you upon settlement.

Committee Determination

The Committee shall determine the Final Award Number of Performance Shares after the end of the Performance Period and not later than [ applicable date ] and the date the Committee makes such determination is referred to in this Award as the “Determination Date.” The Committee shall make all determinations in calculating the Final Award Number of Performance Shares and the Committee’s determination shall be binding.




8



WELLS FARGO & COMPANY
LONG-TERM INCENTIVE COMPENSATION PLAN
PERFORMANCE SHARE AWARD AGREEMENT

Exhibit B to Performance Share Award Agreement

Cause

“Cause” means (1) the continued failure by you to substantially perform your duties; (2) your conviction of a crime involving dishonesty or breach of trust, conviction of a felony, or commission of any act that makes you ineligible for coverage under the Company’s fidelity bond or otherwise makes you ineligible for continued employment; or (3) your violation of the Company’s policies, including but not limited to Wells Fargo’s Code of Ethics and Business Conduct (or the Code applicable to your line of business), Anti-Bribery and Corruption Policy, Information Security Policies, and Risk Management Accountability Policy. For the avoidance of doubt, an event or conduct constituting Cause could take place before or after your termination of employment.

[ Change in Control

“Change in Control” means a change in the ownership or effective control of the Company or the Affiliate that employs you, or in the ownership of a substantial portion of the assets of the Company or the Affiliate that employs you within the meaning of Treas. Reg. section 1.409A-3(i)(5) as determined by the Company.]

Disability

You will be considered to have a “Disability” if you are (1) receiving income replacement benefits for a period of not less than three months under the Company’s or an Affiliate’s long-term disability plan as a result of any medically determinable physical or mental impairment that can be expected to result in death or can be expected to last for a continuous period of not less than 12 months; or (2) determined by the Social Security Administration to be eligible for social security disability benefits.

Separation from Service

A “Separation from Service” occurs upon your death, retirement or other termination of employment or other event that qualifies as a “separation from service” under Internal Revenue Code Section 409A and the applicable regulations thereunder as in effect from time to time. The Company shall determine in each case when a Separation from Service has occurred, which determination shall be made in a manner consistent with Treasury Regulation Section 1.409A-1(h). The Company shall determine that a Separation from Service has occurred as of a certain date when the facts and circumstances indicate that the Company (or an Affiliate, if applicable) and you reasonably anticipate that, after that date, you will render no further services, or your level of bona fide services (either as an employee or independent contractor) will permanently decrease to a level that is 20% or less than the average level of your bona fide services (either as an employee or independent contractor) previously in effect for you over the immediately preceding 36-month period (or your entire period of service, if you have been providing services for less than 36 months).

The following presumptions shall also apply to all such determinations:

(1)
Transfers . A Separation from Service has not occurred upon your transfer of employment from the Company to an Affiliate or vice versa, or from an Affiliate to another Affiliate.

(2)
Medical leave of absence . Where you have a medical leave of absence due to any medically determinable physical or mental impairment that can be expected to result in death or can be expected to last for a continuous period of not less than six months, and you have not returned to employment with the Company or an Affiliate, a Separation from Service has occurred on the earlier of: (A) the first day on which you would not be considered “disabled” under any disability policy of the Company or Affiliate under which you are then receiving a benefit; or (B) the first day on which your medical leave of absence period exceeds 29 months.

9




(3)
Military leave of absence . Where you have a military leave of absence, and you have not returned to employment with the Company or an Affiliate, a Separation from Service has occurred on the day next following the last day on which you are entitled to reemployment rights under USERRA.

(4)
Salary continuation leave . A Separation from Service has occurred on the first day of your salary continuation leave taken under the Company’s Salary Continuation Pay Plan.

(5)
Other leaves of absence . In the event that you are on a bona fide leave of absence, not otherwise described in this definition, from which you have not returned to employment with the Company or an Affiliate, your Separation from Service has occurred on the first day on which your leave of absence period exceeds six months or, if earlier, upon your termination of employment (provided that such termination of employment constitutes a Separation from Service in accordance with the last sentence of the first paragraph of this definition).

(6)
Asset purchase transaction . If, in connection with the sale or other disposition of substantial assets (such as a division or substantially all assets of a trade or business) of the Company or an Affiliate to an unrelated buyer, you become an employee of the buyer or an affiliate of the buyer upon the closing of or in connection with such transaction, a Separation from Service has not occurred if the Company and the buyer have specified that such transaction will not, with respect to any individual affected by such transaction who becomes an employee of the buyer or an affiliate, be considered a “separation from service” under Treasury Regulation Section 1.409A-1(h), and such specification meets the requirements of Treasury Regulation Section 1.409A-1(h)(4).

Specified Employee

A “Specified Employee” means an individual who at any time during the applicable identification period is:

(1)
one of the top 50 most highly compensated officers in the Controlled Group with a title of Senior Vice President or above (where the “Controlled Group” includes the Company and its controlled group members); or
(2)
a member of the Wells Fargo Operating Committee or the Wells Fargo Management Committee Review Group; or
(3)
“a key employee” under Internal Revenue Code Section 416(i)(1)(A)(i), (ii) or (iii) (applied in accordance with the regulations thereunder and disregarding Internal Revenue Code Section 416(i)(5)).

For purposes of applying Internal Revenue Code Section 409A, the “identification period” is the 12-month period ending each December 31. Any person described in (1), (2), or (3) above during an identification period shall be treated as a Specified Employee for the entire 12-month period beginning on the following April 1.

Notwithstanding the above, in the event of a corporate transaction to which the Company or an Affiliate is a party, the Company may, in its discretion, establish a method for determining Specified Employees pursuant to Treasury Regulation Section 1.409A-1(i)(6).






10



[Wells Fargo Agreement Regarding Trade Secrets,
Confidential Information, Non-Solicitation and Assignment of Inventions


I. Introduction
In consideration for the Performance Share Award granted to me by Wells Fargo & Company on [ insert date ], on the terms and conditions contained in the Performance Share Award Agreement (“Performance Share Award Agreement”), I acknowledge that the nature of my employment with and performance of services for Wells Fargo & Company and its affiliates (the “Company”) permits me to have access to certain of its trade secrets and confidential and proprietary information and that such information is, and shall always remain, the sole property of the Company. Any unauthorized disclosure or use of this information would be wrongful and would cause the Company irreparable harm. I also acknowledge that if in the course of my employment I develop Inventions (as defined herein), I agree that the property rights of such inventions belong to the Company and agree to assist, as may be necessary, with the assignment of these Inventions to the Company. Therefore, I agree as follows:

II.  Confidential Information
During the course of my employment I will acquire knowledge of the Company’s Confidential Information. The Company’s Confidential Information includes the following:

Trade Secrets : “Trade Secrets” shall be defined under the Uniform Trade Secrets Act (the “UTSA”), as may be amended from time to time. If the UTSA is not recognized by a state or jurisdiction that is interpreting this agreement, “Trade Secrets” is defined as information, including a formula, pattern, compilation, program, device, method, technique, or process, that: (1) derives independent economic value, actual or potential, from not being generally known to and not being readily ascertainable by proper means by, other persons who can obtain economic value from its disclosure or use; and (2) is the subject of efforts that are reasonable under the circumstances to maintain its secrecy.

Proprietary Information :
The names, address, and contact information of the Company’s customers and prospective customers, as well as any other personal or financial information relating to any customer or prospect, including, without limitation, account numbers, balances, portfolios, maturity and/or expiration or renewal dates, loans, policies, investment activities, purchasing practices, insurance, annuity policies and objectives;

Any information concerning the Company’s operations, including without limitation, information related to its methods, services, pricing, costs, margins and mark ups, finances, practices, strategies, business plans, agreements, decision-making, systems, technology, policies, procedures, marketing, sales, techniques, agent information, and processes; and

Any other proprietary and/or confidential information relating to the Company’s customers, products, services, sales, technologies, or business affairs.

Company Records : The records, documents, files and archives of the Company and include, but are not limited to, original, duplicated, computerized, memorized, handwritten or any other form of information, whether contained in materials provided to me by the Company, or by any institution acquired by the Company, or compiled by me in any form or manner including information in documents or electronic devices, such as software, flowcharts, graphs, spreadsheets, resource manuals, videotapes, calendars, day timers, planners, rolodexes, or telephone directories maintained in personal computers, laptop computers, personal digital assistants or any other device.

Personnel Records : Personal information about Company employees contained in the Company’s records and to which access is restricted and granted only for purposes of performing and evaluating job duties.

Confidential Information : “Confidential Information” includes (comprises) Trade Secrets, Proprietary Information, Company Records and Personnel Records.

I understand that my obligation to maintain the confidentiality of all Confidential Information continues at all times

11



during and after my employment. Confidential Information does not become any less confidential or proprietary to the Company because I may commit some of it to memory or because I may otherwise maintain this information outside of the Company’s offices.

I agree that any Confidential Information of the Company is to be used by me solely and exclusively for the purpose of conducting business on behalf of the Company. I am expected to keep such Confidential Information confidential and not to divulge, use or disclose this information except for that purpose. If I resign or am terminated from my employment for any reason, I agree to immediately return to the Company all Company Records and Confidential Information, including information maintained by me in my office, outside of the office, in personal electronic devices, and in any format or storage system.

Notwithstanding the foregoing, I understand that nothing contained in this Agreement prohibits or restricts me (or my attorney) from initiating communications directly with, or responding to any inquiry from, or providing testimony before, the Securities and Exchange Commission, the Financial Industry Regulatory Authority, the National Labor Relations Board, the Equal Employment Opportunity Commission, or any self-regulatory organization or governmental authority charged with the enforcement of any laws.

III. Non-Solicitation of Company’s Employees and Customers
I agree that for the period beginning on my termination date with the Company through the greater of (i) the period beginning on my termination date through the Determination Date as defined in the Performance Share Award Agreement or (ii) the one-year period following my termination date (“the Non-Solicitation Period”), I will not do any of the following, either directly or indirectly or through associates, agents, or employees:

a.
solicit, recruit or promote the solicitation or recruitment of any employee or consultant of the Company for the purpose of encouraging that employee or consultant to leave the Company’s employ or sever an agreement for services; or

b.
to the fullest extent enforceable under the applicable state law, solicit, participate in or promote the solicitation of any of the Company's clients, customers, or prospective customers with whom I had Material Contact and/or regarding whom I received Confidential Information, for the purpose of providing products or services (“Competitive Products/Services”). “Material Contact” means interaction between me and the customer, client or prospective customer within one (1) year prior to my Separation of Service (as defined in the Performance Award Agreement) which takes place to manage, service or further the business relationship.

This limitation is not intended to limit the Company’s right to prevent misappropriation of its Confidential Information beyond the Non-Solicitation Period.

IV. Assignment of Inventions

I agree to disclose to the Company promptly in writing complete information regarding all Inventions that I make, conceive or first reduce to practice (alone or in conjunction with others) during my employment with the Company. For the purposes of this Assignment, the term “Invention” means any invention, discovery, design, formula, modification, improvement, new idea, business method, process, algorithm, software program, know how or trade secret, or other work or concept, whether recorded in a written document, electronically or not recorded at all and whether or not copyrightable or patentable.

The categories of Inventions that are subject to this assignment are: (1) all Inventions that relate at the time of conception or reduction to practice of the Invention to the Company’s business, or actual or demonstrably anticipated research or development of the Company whether or not I made, conceived or first reduced the Inventions to practice during normal working hours; and (2) all Inventions involving the use of any time, material, information, or facility of the Company.

I acknowledge and agree that all Inventions and all worldwide intellectual property rights therein are owned by the Company. All intellectual property rights in the Inventions shall vest in the Company on the date such Inventions are created, conceived, reduced to practice, actually or constructively, or reduced to a tangible medium of expression,

12



whichever occurs first. Without limiting the foregoing, I agree that if any Inventions are copyrightable and fall within the definition of a “work made for hire” as defined in 17 U.S.C. §101 and §201(b), such Inventions will be considered “works made for hire” and all copyrights and copyright registrations related to such copyrightable Inventions will be the sole and exclusive property of the Company. If, and to the extent that, all intellectual property rights in any Inventions do not vest in the Company, I hereby irrevocably grant and assign, and agree to assign, to the Company without reservation, all of my worldwide ownership rights, title and interest in and to all Inventions and all present and future intellectual property rights in such Inventions, and irrevocably waive all moral rights in, and other intellectual property rights to, all Inventions.

By entering into this Assignment, I understand that I am not conveying any rights in Inventions I may have made, conceived or first reduced to practice before my employment with the Company (“Prior Inventions”). If I claim ownership in any Prior Inventions, I have identified and provided a non-confidential description of each such Prior Invention in the space provided below (and on additional pages as necessary):
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

I further agree, without charge and at the Company’s expense, to give the Company all assistance it reasonably requires to evidence, establish, maintain, perfect, protect, and use the rights to the Inventions I have assigned to it. In particular, but without limitation, I agree to sign all documents, supply all information, and provide all written or oral testimony that the Company may deem necessary or desirable to: (i) transfer or record the transfer of my entire right, title, and interest in the assigned Inventions; (ii) enable the Company to obtain patent protection for such Inventions anywhere in the world; and (iii) protect and enforce Company’s rights in the Inventions and the intellectual property rights therein. Notwithstanding the foregoing, I hereby irrevocably appoint Wells Fargo as attorney in fact (coupled with an interest) to execute any such documents.

V. Defend Trade Secrets Act Notice
I acknowledge and agree that nothing in this Agreement is intended to discourage or restrict me from reporting any theft of Trade Secrets pursuant to the Defend Trade Secrets Act of 2016 (the “DTSA”) or other applicable state or federal law.  The DTSA prohibits retaliation against an employee because of whistleblower activity in connection with the disclosure of Trade Secrets, so long as any such disclosure is made either (A) in confidence to an attorney or a federal, state, or local government official and solely to report or investigate a suspected violation of the law, or (B) under seal in a complaint or other document filed in a lawsuit or other proceeding. Nothing in this Agreement shall limit, curtail or diminish the Company’s statutory rights under the DTSA, any applicable state law regarding trade secrets or common law.

VI. Employment At Will
I understand that my employment with the Company is “at will” which means; (1) the Company and I both have the right to terminate my employment at any time, with or without advance notice and with or without cause and, (2) the Company has the right to change policies and terms and conditions of my employment at any time. I also understand that nothing in this Agreement changes, alters or modifies my “at will” status or my obligation to comply with all policies, procedures and rules of the Company, as they may be adopted or amended from time to time. My employment at will status may not be changed except in writing, signed by me and an officer of the Company at the level of executive vice president or higher, authorized by the senior Human Resource Manager for my business group.

VII. Injunctive Relief & Damages
Recognizing the irreparable nature of the injury that could be done by my violation of this Agreement and that money damages alone would be inadequate compensation to the Company, it is agreed that any violation of this Agreement by me should be the proper subject for immediate injunctive relief, specific performance and other equitable relief which shall be in addition to and not in lieu of any other remedies and damages to the Company may recover.

VIII. Partial Invalidity
If any provision of this Agreement is held to be invalid or unenforceable by a court of competent jurisdiction, the

13



remaining provisions of this Agreement shall remain in full force and effect and the invalid or unenforceable provision shall be modified only to the extent necessary to render that provision valid and enforceable to the fullest extent permitted by law. If the invalid or unenforceable provision cannot be modified, that provision shall be severed from the Agreement and all other provisions shall remain valid and enforceable.

IX. Choice of Law/Integration/Survival
This Agreement and any dispute, controversy or claim which arises under or relates in any way to it shall be governed by the law of the state where the incident(s) giving rise to the dispute or claim arose. This Agreement supersedes any prior written or verbal agreements pertaining to the subject matter herein, and is intended to be a final expression of our Agreement with respect only to the terms contained herein. There may be no modification of this Agreement except in writing signed by me and an executive officer of the Company. This Agreement shall survive my employment by the Company, inure to the benefit of successors and assigns of the Company, and is binding upon my heirs and legal representatives.

Acknowledgement

I acknowledge that I have read, understand, and received a copy of this Agreement, and will abide by its terms.


]
[Name of Executive]                    Date

End of Form of Performance Share Award Agreement
For Grants on or after February 26, 2019



14



Form of Restricted Share Rights Award Agreement for Grants on or after February 26, 2019
Brackets identify provisions that may vary depending on the particular grant, grant recipient
and/or other relevant factor.

WELLS FARGO & COMPANY
LONG-TERM INCENTIVE COMPENSATION PLAN
RESTRICTED SHARE RIGHTS AWARD AGREEMENT


Grant Date: [applicable date]
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1.
Award. To encourage your continued employment with the Company or any Affiliate and to motivate you to help the Company increase stockholder value over the long term, Wells Fargo & Company (the “Company”) has awarded you the number of Restricted Share Rights as set forth on the acknowledgement screen for your grant on this website (the “Award”). Each Restricted Share Right entitles you to receive one share of Wells Fargo & Company common stock ("Common Stock") contingent upon vesting and subject to the other terms and conditions set forth in the Company’s Long‑Term Incentive Compensation Plan, as may be amended from time to time (the “Plan”) and this Award Agreement.

2.
Vesting. Except as otherwise provided in this Award Agreement, and subject to the Company’s right to recoup or forfeit all or any portion of this Award and other conditions as provided in this Award Agreement[, including but not limited to the performance conditions in [applicable paragraphs] below], the Restricted Share Rights will vest and be settled according to the following schedule:
[ Vesting Schedule ]
Shares of Common Stock in settlement of the Restricted Share Rights will be issued to you or, in case of your death, your Beneficiary determined in accordance with the Plan. Although you may receive dividend equivalents as provided below, you will have no rights as a stockholder of the Company with respect to your Restricted Share Rights until settlement. Upon vesting, each Restricted Share Right will be settled and distributed as one share of Common Stock except as otherwise provided in the Plan or this Award Agreement.
3.
Termination.
(a)
If you cease to be an Employee due to your death, any then unvested Restricted Share Right awarded hereby (including any Restricted Share Right granted with respect to dividend equivalents as provided below) will immediately vest upon your date of death and will be settled and distributed to your Beneficiary in shares of Common Stock between January 2 and March 1 of the year following the year in which you die. Notwithstanding the foregoing, if by the last date set forth herein your Beneficiary has not presented evidence deemed satisfactory by the Company to allow transfer of the shares of Common Stock to the Beneficiary under applicable laws, the Company may treat all unvested Restricted Share Rights as forfeited, in which case the Company shall have no obligation to issue shares of Common Stock or benefits in lieu of such shares to your Beneficiary and shall have no liability therefor.
(b)
If you incur an involuntary [Separation from Service][termination of employment] as a result of [one of] the [following:]
[(1)]
application of the Company’s Extended Absence Policy to you in connection with a Disability,
(2)
[your displacement and receipt of an immediate lump sum severance benefit, placement on a Salary Continuation Leave of Absence or placement on another leave of absence which will result in your receipt of a severance benefit in connection with that leave, or ]
(3)
[the Company or an Affiliate entering into a corporate transaction with another company (the “buyer”) (including a transaction where the buyer acquires all or any portion of the assets, stock or operations of the Company or Affiliate) and pursuant to the terms of the transaction your continuing in employment with the buyer after completion of the corporate transaction,]

15



any then unvested Restricted Share Right awarded hereby (including any Restricted Share Right granted with respect to dividend equivalents as provided below) will immediately vest and will be settled and distributed to you in shares of Common Stock within 90 days from your [Separation from Service][termination of employment or, if earlier, by March 1 of the year following the year in which the Restricted Share Rights vest][, subject to the performance conditions in [applicable paragraphs] below.
[The definitions of the terms [“Separation from Service” (which is determined by the Company in accordance with Section 409A (as defined in paragraph 11 below)),] and “Disability” are set forth on Exhibit A to this Award Agreement, which definitions are incorporated by reference herein.][For purposes of this Award, you will be considered to have a “Disability” if you are (1) receiving income replacement benefits for a period of not less than three months under the Company’s or an Affiliate’s long-term disability plan as a result of any medically determinable physical or mental impairment that can be expected to result in death or can be expected to last for a continuous period of not less than 12 months; or (2) determined by the Social Security Administration to be eligible for social security disability benefits.]
(c)
[If you have a Separation from Service that is not addressed in paragraph 3(b) above for a reason other than Cause and you satisfy the definition of Retirement under the Plan on your Separation from Service date or you satisfy the definition of Retirement following your Separation from Service date at the end of an approved leave of absence not to exceed six months, any then unvested Restricted Share Right awarded hereby (including any Restricted Share Right granted with respect to dividend equivalents as provided below) will continue to vest and be settled upon the scheduled vesting date as set forth in paragraph 2 above[, subject to the conditions and restrictions in [applicable paragraphs] below]; provided, however, if you die following Retirement, subject to the limitations set forth in paragraph 3(a), any then unvested Restricted Share Right will vest immediately upon your date of death and will be settled and distributed to your Beneficiary in shares of Common Stock between January 2 and March 1 of the year following the year in which you die. The definition of the term “Cause” is set forth on Exhibit A to this Award Agreement, which definition is incorporated by reference herein.]

(d)
[If the Affiliate that employs you incurs a Change in Control and you continue employment with the buyer immediately after the Change in Control, any then unvested Restricted Share Right awarded hereby (including any Restricted Share Right granted with respect to dividend equivalents as provided below) will immediately vest and will be settled and distributed to you in shares of Common Stock within 90 days from the date the Change in Control occurred [or, if earlier, by March 1 of the year immediately following the year in which the Change in Control occurred][, subject to the conditions and restrictions in [applicable paragraphs] below]. Exhibit A to this Award Agreement sets forth the definition of the term “Change in Control,” which definition is incorporated in this Award Agreement by reference.]
(e)
If you [incur a Separation from Service][terminate employment] other than for a reason described in [applicable paragraphs] above, any then unvested Restricted Share Right awarded hereby (including any Restricted Share Right granted with respect to dividend equivalents as provided below) will immediately terminate without notice to you and will be forfeited.

4.
Dividend Equivalents. During the period beginning on the Grant Date and ending on the date the applicable Restricted Share Rights vest and are distributed, or are forfeited, whichever occurs first, if the Company pays a dividend on the Common Stock, you will automatically receive, as of the payment date for such dividend, dividend equivalents in the form of additional Restricted Share Rights based on the amount or number of shares that would have been paid on the Restricted Share Rights had they been issued and outstanding shares of Common Stock as of the record date and, if a cash dividend, the closing price of the Common Stock on the New York Stock Exchange as of the dividend payment date. You will also automatically receive dividend equivalents with respect to such additional Restricted Share Rights, to be granted in the same manner. Restricted Share Rights granted with respect to dividend equivalents will be subject to the same vesting schedule and other terms and conditions as the underlying Restricted Share Rights, including the Company’s right of recoupment or forfeiture, and will be distributed in shares of Common Stock when, and if, the underlying Restricted Share Rights are settled and distributed.


16



5.
Tax Withholding. Regardless of any action the Company or an Affiliate which is your employer (the “Employer”) takes with respect to any or all income tax, payroll tax, payment on account or other tax-related items related to your participation in the Plan and legally applicable to you or deemed by the Company or the Employer to be an appropriate charge to you even if technically due by the Company or the Employer (“Tax-Related Items”), you acknowledge that the ultimate liability for all Tax-Related Items is and remains your responsibility and may exceed the amount actually withheld by the Company or the Employer. You further acknowledge that the Company and/or the Employer: (a) make no representations or undertakings regarding the treatment of any Tax-Related Items in connection with any aspect of the Award, including the grant, vesting or settlement of the Restricted Share Rights, the issuance of shares of Common Stock upon settlement of the Restricted Share Rights, the subsequent sale of shares of Common Stock acquired pursuant to such issuance and the receipt of any dividends and/or any dividend equivalents; and (b) do not commit to and are under no obligation to structure the terms of the grant or any aspect of the Award to reduce or eliminate your liability for such Tax-Related Items or to achieve any particular tax result. Further, if you are subject to tax on the Award in more than one jurisdiction at the time of any relevant taxable event, you acknowledge that the Company and/or the Employer (or former employer, as applicable) may be required to withhold or account for Tax-Related Items in more than one jurisdiction.

Prior to any relevant taxable or tax withholding event, as applicable, you shall pay or make adequate arrangements satisfactory to the Company or the Employer to satisfy all Tax-Related Items. In this regard, you authorize the Company and/or the Employer, or their respective agents, at their discretion and pursuant to such procedures as the Company may specify from time to time, to satisfy the obligations with regard to all Tax-Related Items by one or a combination of the following: (1) withholding from any wages or other cash compensation paid to you by the Company and/or the Employer; (2) withholding from proceeds of the sale of shares of Common Stock acquired upon vesting and settlement of the Restricted Share Rights either through a voluntary sale or through a mandatory sale arranged by the Company (on your behalf pursuant to this authorization); or (3) withholding in shares of Common Stock to be issued upon vesting and settlement of the Restricted Share Rights. Notwithstanding the foregoing, if you are subject to the short-swing profit rules of Section 16(b) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the Company will withhold in shares of Common Stock upon the relevant tax withholding event[, except with respect to any Tax-Related Items required to be withheld prior to the vesting dates set forth in paragraph 2 which may be withheld from your wages or other cash compensation], unless such withholding method is prevented by applicable law or has materially adverse accounting or tax consequences, in which case the Tax-Related Items withholding obligation may be satisfied by one or a combination of methods (1) and (2) above.
Depending on the withholding method, the Company may withhold or account for Tax-Related Items by considering applicable minimum statutory withholding amounts or other applicable withholding rates, including maximum applicable rates, in which case you will receive a refund of any over-withheld amount in cash and will have no entitlement to the Common Stock equivalent. Anything to the contrary in this paragraph 5 notwithstanding, the Company or the Employer’s right to withhold any amounts payable pursuant to this Award to cover Tax-Related Items for any portion of the Award that is considered deferred compensation subject to Section 409A shall be limited to the minimum amount permitted to avoid a prohibited acceleration under Section 409A. If the obligation for Tax-Related Items is satisfied by withholding in shares of Common Stock, for tax purposes, you will be deemed to have been issued the full number of shares of Common Stock subject to the vested Restricted Share Rights, notwithstanding that a number of the shares of Common Stock are held back solely for the purpose of paying the Tax-Related Items due as a result of any aspect of your participation in the Plan.
Finally, you shall pay to the Company or the Employer any amount of Tax-Related Items that the Company or the Employer may be required to withhold or account for as a result of your participation in the Plan that cannot be satisfied by the means previously described. The Company may refuse to issue or deliver the shares or the proceeds of the sale of shares of Common Stock, if you fail to comply with your obligations in connection with the Tax-Related Items.
6.
Nontransferable. Unless the Committee provides otherwise, (i) no rights under this Award will be assignable or transferable, and neither you nor your Beneficiary will have any power to anticipate, alienate, dispose of, pledge or encumber any rights under this Award, and (ii) the rights and the benefits of this Award may be exercised and received during your lifetime only by you or your legal representative.

17



7.
Other Restrictions; Amendment. The issuance of Common Stock hereunder is subject to compliance by the Company and you with all legal requirements applicable thereto, including compliance with the requirements of 12 C.F.R. Part 359, orders issued under 12 U.S.C. § 1818(b) (together with any agreements related thereto, “orders”) and tax withholding obligations, and with all applicable regulations of any stock exchange on which the Common Stock may be listed at the time of issuance. For the avoidance of doubt, regulatory approval under Part 359 or any orders to which the Company is a party may be required for the issuance of Common Stock hereunder in certain circumstances, and the Company cannot provide any assurance that it will be able to request such approval in accordance with the requirements of Part 359 or the applicable order or that any requested approval will be received. Subject to paragraph[s] 11 [and 12] below, the Committee may, in its sole discretion and without your consent, reduce, delay vesting, modify, revoke, cancel, impose additional conditions and restrictions on or recover all or a portion of this Award if the Committee deems it necessary or advisable to comply with applicable laws, rules and regulations. This Award is subject to any applicable recoupment or “clawback” policies of the Company, as in effect from time to time, and any applicable recoupment or clawback requirements imposed under laws, rules and regulations.

8.
Performance Conditions. The Award is fully conditioned on and subject to performance adjustments, which include the right of the Committee to cause you to forfeit all or any unpaid portion of an Award, if the Committee determines in its sole discretion that:
You engage in misconduct which has or might reasonably be expected to have reputational or other harm to the Company or any conduct that constitutes Cause;
You engage in misconduct or commit a material error that causes or might reasonably be expected to cause significant financial or reputational harm to the Company or your business group;
The Award was based on materially inaccurate performance metrics, whether or not you were responsible for the inaccuracy;
You improperly or with gross negligence, including in a supervisory capacity, fail to identify, escalate, monitor, or manage, in a timely manner and as reasonably expected, risks material to the Company or your business group; or
The Company or your business group suffers a material downturn in its financial performance or suffers a material failure of risk management.
[For purposes of this Award, “Cause” means (1) the continued failure by you to substantially perform your duties; (2) your conviction of a crime involving dishonesty or breach of trust, conviction of a felony, or commission of any act that makes you ineligible for coverage under Wells Fargo's fidelity bond or otherwise makes you ineligible for continued employment; or (3) your violation of the Company’s policies, including but not limited to Wells Fargo’s Code of Ethics and Business Conduct (or the Code applicable to your line of business), Anti-Bribery and Corruption Policy, Information Security Policies, or Risk Management Accountability Policy. For the avoidance of doubt, an event or conduct constituting Cause could take place before or after your termination of employment.] The Committee may consider any factors it determines necessary or appropriate for purposes of making a determination whether a performance adjustment is appropriate and the amount of the adjustment based on the particular facts and circumstances. All determinations by the Committee will be final and binding.
9.
Restrictive Covenants. In consideration of the terms of this Award and your access to Confidential Information, you agree to the restrictive covenants and associated remedies as set forth below, which exist independently of and in addition to any obligation to which you are subject under the terms of the Wells Fargo Agreement Regarding Trade Secrets, Confidential Information, Non-Solicitation, And Assignment Of Inventions (the “TSA”):

(a)
Trade Secrets and Confidential Information. During the course of your employment, you will acquire knowledge of the Company’s and/or any Affiliate’s (collectively “WFC”) Trade Secrets and other proprietary information relating to its business, business methods, personnel, and customers (collectively, “Confidential Information”). “Trade Secrets” means WFC’s confidential information, which has an economic value in being secret and which WFC has taken steps to keep secret and you understand and agree that Trade Secrets include, but are not limited to, confidentially maintained client and customer lists and information, and confidentially maintained prospective client and customer lists and information. You agree that Confidential Information of WFC is to be used solely and exclusively for the purpose of conducting business on behalf of WFC. You agree to keep such Confidential Information confidential and will not divulge, use or disclose this information

18



except for that purpose. In addition, you agree that, both during and after your employment, you will not remove, share, disseminate or otherwise use WFC’s Trade Secrets to directly or indirectly solicit, participate in or promote the solicitation of any of WFC’s clients, customers, or prospective customers for the purpose of providing products or services that are in competition with WFC’s products or services. Notwithstanding the foregoing, nothing contained in this Award Agreement prohibits or restricts you (or your attorney) from initiating communications directly with, or responding to any inquiry from, or providing testimony before, the Securities and Exchange Commission, the Financial Industry Regulatory Authority, the National Labor Relations Board, the Equal Employment Opportunity Commission, or any self-regulatory organization or governmental authority charged with the enforcement of any laws.

(b)
Assignment of Inventions. You acknowledge and agree that all inventions and all worldwide intellectual property rights that you make, conceive or first reduce to practice (alone or in conjunction with others) during your employment with WFC are owned by WFC that (1) relate at the time of conception or reduction to practice of the invention to WFC’s business, or actual or demonstrably anticipated research or development of WFC whether or not you made, conceived or first reduced the inventions to practice during normal working hours; and (2) involve the use of any time, material, information, or facility of WFC.

(c)
Non-solicitation. If you are currently subject to a TSA, you shall continue to be bound by the terms of the TSA. If you are not currently subject to a TSA, you agree to the following:
For a period of one year immediately following termination of your employment for any reason, you will not do any of the following, either directly or indirectly or through associates, agents, or employees:
i.
solicit, recruit  or promote the solicitation or recruitment of any employee or consultant of WFC for the purpose of encouraging that employee or consultant to leave WFC’s employ or sever an agreement for services; or  
ii.
to the fullest extent enforceable under the applicable state law, solicit, participate in or promote the solicitation of any of WFC’s clients, customers, or prospective customers with whom you had Material Contact and/or regarding whom you received Confidential Information, for the purpose of providing products or services that are in competition with WFC’s products or services. "Material Contact" means interaction between you and the customer, client or prospective customer within one (1) year prior to your last day as a team member which takes place to manage, service or further the business relationship.
The one-year limitation is not intended to limit WFC’s right to prevent misappropriation of its Confidential Information beyond the one-year period.
(d)
Violation of TSA or Restrictive Covenants. If you breach any of the terms of a TSA and/or the restrictive covenants above, all unvested Restricted Share Rights shall be immediately and irrevocably forfeited. For any Restricted Share Rights that vested within one (1) year prior to the termination of your employment with WFC or at any time after your termination, you shall be required to repay or otherwise reimburse WFC an amount having a value equal to the aggregate fair market value (determined as of the date of vesting) of such vested shares. This paragraph does not constitute the Company’s exclusive remedy for violation of your restrictive covenant obligations, and WFC may seek any additional legal or equitable remedy, including injunctive relief, for any such violation.
10.
No Employment Agreement. Neither the award to you of the Restricted Share Rights nor the delivery to you of this Award Agreement or any other document relating to the Restricted Share Rights will confer on you the right to continued employment with the Company or any Affiliate. You understand that your employment with the Company or any Affiliate is “at will” and nothing in this document changes, alters or modifies your “at will” status or your obligation to comply with all policies, procedures and rules of the Company, as they may be adopted or amended from time to time.
11.
Section 409A . This Award is intended to [comply with the requirements of][be exempt from] Section 409A of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended, and the applicable Treasury Regulations or other binding guidance thereunder (“Section 409A”). Accordingly, all provisions included in this Award Agreement, or incorporated by reference, will be interpreted and administered in accordance with that intent. [Therefore, all Restricted Share Rights will be settled and distributed no later than March 1 of the year following the year when such Restricted

19



Share Rights vest.] If any provision of the Plan or this Award Agreement would otherwise conflict with or frustrate this intent, that provision will be interpreted and deemed amended or limited so as to avoid the conflict; provided, however, that the Company makes no representation that the Award is exempt from or complies with Section 409A and makes no undertaking to preclude Section 409A from applying to the Award. The Company will have no liability to you or to any other party if the Award or payment of the Award that is intended to be [compliant with][exempt from] Section 409A is not so [compliant][exempt] or for any action taken by the Committee with respect thereto.
12.
[Six-month Delay . Notwithstanding any provision of the Plan or this Award Agreement to the contrary, if, upon your Separation from Service for any reason, the Company determines that you are a “Specified Employee” for purposes of Section 409A and in accordance with the definition set forth on Exhibit A to this Award Agreement, which definition is incorporated by reference herein, your Restricted Share Rights, if subject to settlement upon your Separation from Service and if required pursuant to Section 409A, will not settle before the date that is the first business day following the six-month anniversary of such Separation from Service, or, if earlier, upon your death.]
13.
Stock Ownership Provision. In accordance with the terms of the Company’s stock ownership policy, as may be amended from time to time: (a) if you are an Executive Officer of the Company or a member of its Operating Committee, as a condition to receiving this Award, you agree to hold, while employed by the Company or any Affiliate and for a period of one year after your Retirement, a number of shares of Common Stock equal to at least 50% of the after-tax shares of Common Stock (assuming a 50% tax rate) acquired upon vesting and settlement of Company stock-based awards or pursuant to the exercise of Company stock options (if applicable), subject to a maximum holding requirement of shares with a value equal to ten (10) times your cash salary; and (b) if you are not an Executive Officer or member of the Operating Committee, you are expected to hold that number of shares while employed by the Company or any Affiliate.
14.
Severability and Judicial Modification. If any provision of this Award Agreement is held to be invalid or unenforceable under pertinent state law or otherwise or Wells Fargo elects not to enforce such restriction, including but not limited to paragraph 9(c)ii, the remaining provisions shall remain in full force and effect and the invalid or unenforceable provision shall be modified only to the extent necessary to render that provision valid and enforceable to the fullest extent permitted by law.  If the invalid or unenforceable provision cannot be, or is not, modified, that provision shall be severed from this Award Agreement and all other provisions shall remain valid and enforceable.
15.
Additional Provisions. This Award Agreement is subject to the provisions of the Plan. Capitalized terms not defined in this Award Agreement are used as defined in the Plan. If the Plan and this Award Agreement are inconsistent, the provisions of the Plan will govern. Interpretations of the Plan and this Award Agreement by the Committee are binding on you and the Company.
16.
Applicable Law. This Award Agreement and the award of Restricted Share Rights evidenced hereby will be governed by, and construed in accordance with the laws of the state of Delaware (without regard to its choice-of-law provisions), except to the extent Federal law would apply.
17.
Imposition of Other Requirements. The Company reserves the right to impose other requirements on your participation in the Plan, on the Award and on any shares of Common Stock acquired under the Plan, to the extent the Company determines it is necessary or advisable in order to comply with applicable law or facilitate the administration of the Plan and provided the imposition of the term or condition will not result in adverse accounting expense to the Company, and to require you to sign any additional agreements or undertakings that may be necessary to accomplish the foregoing.
18.
Electronic Delivery and Acceptance. The Company is electronically delivering documents related to current or future participation in the Plan and is requesting your consent to participate in the Plan by electronic means. You hereby consent to receive such documents by electronic delivery and agree to participate in the Plan through the current plan administrator’s on-line system, or any other on-line system or electronic means that the Company may decide, in its sole discretion, to use in the future.
19.
Entire Agreement. The Plan is incorporated herein by reference. The Plan and this Award Agreement [(including Exhibit A attached hereto)] constitute the entire agreement of the parties with respect to the Award and supersede

20



in their entirety all prior proposals, undertakings and agreements, written or oral, and all other communications between you and the Company with respect to the Award.
[Insert requirement to acknowledge and accept grant terms]
[ Exhibit A]
[Certain Definitions]
[Separation from Service

A Participant’s “Separation from Service” occurs upon his or her death, retirement or other termination of employment or other event that qualifies as a “separation from service” under Internal Revenue Code Section 409A and the applicable regulations thereunder as in effect from time to time. The Company shall determine in each case when a Participant’s Separation from Service has occurred, which determination shall be made in a manner consistent with Treasury Regulation Section 1.409A-1(h). The Company shall determine that a Separation from Service has occurred as of a certain date when the facts and circumstances indicate that the Company (or an Affiliate, if applicable) and the Participant reasonably anticipate that, after that date, the Participant will render no further services, or the Participant’s level of bona fide services (either as an employee or independent contractor) will permanently decrease to a level that is 20% or less than the average level of the Participant’s bona fide services (either as an employee or independent contractor) previously in effect for such Participant over the immediately preceding 36-month period (or the Participant’s entire period of service, if the Participant has been providing services for less than 36 months).

The following presumptions shall also apply to all such determinations:

(1)
Transfers . A Separation from Service has not occurred upon the Participant’s transfer of employment from the Company to an Affiliate or vice versa, or from an Affiliate to another Affiliate.

(2)
Medical leave of absence . Where the Participant has a medical leave of absence due to any medically determinable physical or mental impairment that can be expected to result in death or can be expected to last for a continuous period of not less than six months, and he or she has not returned to employment with the Company or an Affiliate, a Separation from Service has occurred on the earlier of: (A) the first day on which the Participant would not be considered “disabled” under any disability policy of the Company or Affiliate under which the Participant is then receiving a benefit; or (B) the first day on which the Participant’s medical leave of absence period exceeds 29 months.

(3)
Military leave of absence . Where the Participant has a military leave of absence, and he or she has not returned to employment with the Company or an Affiliate, a Separation from Service has occurred on the day next following the last day on which the Participant is entitled to reemployment rights under USERRA.

(4)
Salary continuation leave . A Separation from Service has occurred on the first day of the Participant’s salary continuation leave taken under the Company’s Salary Continuation Pay Plan.

(5)
Other leaves of absence . In the event that the Participant is on a bona fide leave of absence, not otherwise described in this definition, from which he or she has not returned to employment with the Company or an Affiliate, the Participant’s Separation from Service has occurred on the first day on which the Participant’s leave of absence period exceeds six months or, if earlier, upon the Participant’s termination of employment (provided that such termination of employment constitutes a Separation from Service in accordance with the last sentence of the first paragraph of this definition).

(6)
Asset purchase transaction . If, in connection with the sale or other disposition of substantial assets (such as a division or substantially all assets of a trade or business) of the Company or an Affiliate to an unrelated buyer, the Participant becomes an employee of the buyer or an affiliate of the buyer upon the closing of or in connection with such transaction, a Separation from Service has not occurred if the Company and the buyer have specified that such transaction will not, with respect to any individual affected by such transaction who becomes an employee of the buyer or an affiliate, be considered a “separation from service” under Treasury

21



Regulation Section 1.409A-1(h), and such specification meets the requirements of Treasury Regulation Section 1.409A-1(h)(4).]


[Specified Employee

A “Specified Employee” means an individual who at any time during the applicable identification period is:

(1)
one of the top 50 most highly compensated officers in the Controlled Group with a title of Senior Vice President or above (where the “Controlled Group” includes the Company and its controlled group members); or
(2)
a member of the Wells Fargo Operating Committee or the Wells Fargo Management Committee Review Group; or
(3)
“a key employee” under Internal Revenue Code Section 416(i)(1)(A)(i), (ii) or (iii) (applied in accordance with the regulations thereunder and disregarding Internal Revenue Code Section 416(i)(5)).

For purposes of applying Internal Revenue Code Section 409A, the “identification period” is the 12-month period ending each December 31. Any person described in (1), (2), or (3) above during an identification period shall be treated as a Specified Employee for the entire 12-month period beginning on the following April 1.

Notwithstanding the above, in the event of a corporate transaction to which the Company or an Affiliate is a party, the Company may, in its discretion, establish a method for determining Specified Employees pursuant to Treasury Regulation Section 1.409A-1(i)(6).]

[Disability
You will be considered to have a “Disability” if you are (1) receiving income replacement benefits for a period of not less than three months under the Company’s or an Affiliate’s long-term disability plan as a result of any medically determinable physical or mental impairment that can be expected to result in death or can be expected to last for a continuous period of not less than 12 months; or (2) determined by the Social Security Administration to be eligible for social security disability benefits.]

[Cause
“Cause” means (1) the continued failure by you to substantially perform your duties; (2) your conviction of a crime involving dishonesty or breach of trust, conviction of a felony, or commission of any act that makes you ineligible for coverage under Wells Fargo's fidelity bond or otherwise makes you ineligible for continued employment; or (3) your violation of the Company’s policies, including but not limited to Wells Fargo’s Code of Ethics and Business Conduct (or the Code applicable to your line of business), Anti-Bribery and Corruption Policy, Information Security Policies, and Risk Management Accountability Policy. For the avoidance of doubt, an event or conduct constituting Cause could take place before or after your termination of employment.]

[Change in Control
“Change in Control” means a change in the ownership or effective control of the Company or the Affiliate that employs you, or in the ownership of a substantial portion of the assets of the Company or the Affiliate that employs you within the meaning of Treas. Reg. section 1.409A-3(i)(5) as determined by the Company.]



End of Form of Restricted Share Rights Award Agreement
For Grants on or after February 26, 2019



22
Exhibit 10(c)

Amendment to Wells Fargo & Company Deferred Compensation Plan

The Wells Fargo & Company Deferred Compensation Plan (the “DCP”) is amended as follows:

1.
Section 2(N) of the DCP is amended in its entirety effective December 31, 2018 to read in full as follows:

(N) Key Employee . If the Participant is determined to be a “Key Employee” for purposes of Code section 409A, no lump sum or installment payment shall be paid to the Participant prior to the date that is six months after the date the Participant’s Separation from Service occurred. For purposes of this Plan, a Participant’s status as a Key Employee shall be determined in accordance with the Wells Fargo & Company Key/Specified Employee Policy as adopted and amended from time to time by the Human Resources Committee of the Company’s Board of Directors.     

2.
Except as herein expressly amended, all the terms and provisions of the DCP shall continue in full force and effect.




Exhibit 10(i)  
 
Amendment to Wells Fargo & Company Supplemental 401(k) Plan

The Wells Fargo & Company Supplemental 401(k) Plan (the “Supplemental 401(k) Plan”) is amended as follows:

1.
Section 16(d)(2) of the Supplemental 401(k) Plan is amended in its entirety effective December 31, 2018 to read in full as follows:

(N) Key Employee . If the Participant is determined to be a “Key Employee” for purposes of Code section 409A, no lump sum or installment payment shall be paid to the Participant prior to the date that is six months after the date the Participant’s Separation from Service occurred. For purposes of this Plan, a Participant’s status as a Key Employee shall be determined in accordance with the Wells Fargo & Company Key/Specified Employee Policy as adopted and amended from time to time by the Human Resources Committee of the Company’s Board of Directors.     

2.
Except as herein expressly amended, all the terms and provisions of the Supplemental 401(k) Plan shall continue in full force and effect.




Exhibit 10(j)

Amendments to Wells Fargo & Company Supplemental Cash Balance Plan

Sec. 4 of the Wells Fargo & Company Supplemental Cash Balance Plan (the “Supplemental Plan”) is amended in its entirety effective February 1, 2019 to read in full as follows:
    
Sec. 14 Death Benefits . The following benefits are payable under this Plan following the death of a participant:
(a)
If the participant dies prior to the first day of the month as of which the participant’s vested Plan benefit is to be paid or commence under Section 13, the participant’s vested Plan benefit determined as of the January 1 following the date of the participant’s death shall be paid to the participant’s Beneficiary in a lump sum cash distribution as soon as administratively feasible after such January 1, but no later than the December 31 following such January 1.
(b)
If a participant who is to receive a lump sum distribution under Section 13 dies on or after the first day of the month as of which the participant’s lump sum is to be paid, but before the lump sum is actually paid, the lump sum distribution shall be paid as soon as administratively feasible to the participant’s estate.
(c)
If the participant dies on or after the first day of the month as of which payment of the participant’s vested Plan benefit commences, or is to commence, in the form of a monthly annuity pursuant to Section 13(b) or (c), the participant’s joint annuitant or Beneficiary shall receive such benefit, if any, that may be provided for that person by the form of annuity the participant elected. In the event such a participant dies before actually beginning to receive monthly annuity payments, this subsection shall be applied as if the participant had begun receiving such payments immediately prior to his or her death.
(d)
Notwithstanding subsection (c), if the Actuarial Equivalent present value of any annuity payable to a joint annuitant or Beneficiary immediately following the participant’s death is less than the limit in effect under Code section 402(g) for the year in which the participant’s death occurs, the entire death benefit payable to such person shall instead be paid in a lump sum cash distribution as soon as administratively feasible after the January 1 following the participant’s death, but no later than the December 31 following such January 1.
(e)
In the event of any delay in any payment or payments due under the preceding subsections of this section, there shall be no adjustment for interest or earnings during the period of the delay.
(f)
For purposes of this Plan, a “Beneficiary” is one or more individuals, trusts, estates or charitable organizations designated by a participant to receive any benefit payable under the Plan in the event of the participant’s death. A participant who has designated a Beneficiary may, without the consent of such Beneficiary, alter or revoke such designation. To be effective, any such designation, alteration, or revocation shall be in such form as the Plan Administrator may prescribe, and shall be filed with the Plan Administrator or its agent prior to the participant’s death.

If at the time of a participant’s death the Plan Administrator or its designated agent is not in possession of a fully effective designation of his Beneficiary, or if the designated Beneficiary does not survive the participant, the participant’s Beneficiary shall be the person or persons surviving in the first of the following classes in which there is a survivor, share and share alike:
(1)
The participant’s Spouse or Domestic Partner.





(2)
The participant’s biological and adopted children, except that if any of his or her children predecease the participant but leave descendants surviving the participant, such descendants shall take by right of representation the share their parent would have taken if living.
(3)
The participant’s parents.
(4)
The participant’s brothers and sisters.
(5)
The participant’s estate.
Notwithstanding the foregoing, if a participant has not commenced distribution from the Pension Plan prior to his or her death and did not designate a beneficiary under this Plan but has an effective beneficiary designation on file for the Pension Plan, the beneficiary designation on file for the Pension Plan shall apply to this Plan.

Except as herein expressly amended, all the terms and provisions of the Supplemental Plan shall continue in full force and effect.





        


Exhibit 10(s)

Amendment to Wachovia Corporation Savings Restoration Plan

RESOLVED that the Wachovia Corporation Savings Restoration Plan (the “SRP”) is amended as follows:

1.
The last sentence in Section 6.10 of the SRP is amended effective December 31, 2018 to read in full as follows:

“Whether the Participant is a “key employee” shall be determined in accordance with the Wells Fargo & Company Key/Specified Employee Policy as adopted and amended from time to time by the Human Resources Committee of the Company’s Board of Directors.”

2.
Except as herein expressly amended, all the terms and provisions of the SRP shall continue in full force and effect.



Exhibit 10(v)

WELLS FARGO & COMPANY
KEY/SPECIFIED EMPLOYEE POLICY

Certain individuals providing services to Wells Fargo & Company (“Wells Fargo”) and its controlled group members (the “Controlled Group”) will be considered “Key/Specified Employees” for purposes of section 409A of the Internal Revenue Code (“Section 409A”). The members of the Controlled Group are determined in accordance with Section 409A.

This Key/Specified Employee Policy (the “Policy”) (a) governs which individuals are Key/Specified Employees, (b) applies to all plans, awards, agreements or arrangements sponsored by a member of the Controlled Group that are subject to Section 409A (the “409A Plans”), and (c) supersedes any contrary provisions in any 409A Plan. The six-month delay on payments to Key/Specified Employees upon separation from service applies to amounts subject to Section 409A under the 409A Plans.

The Key/Specified Employees for the Controlled Group are determined each Identification Period in a manner consistent with Treas. Reg. § 1.409A-1(i)(5) and (8) and based on the following criteria:

Key Employees:
An employee shall be considered a Key/Specified Employee during an Effective Period if at any time during the applicable Identification Period, the employee is:

one of the top 50 most highly compensated officers in the Controlled Group with a title of Senior Vice President or above; or
a member of the Wells Fargo Operating Committee or the Wells Fargo Management Committee Review Group; or
a “key employee” under Internal Revenue Code Section 416(i)(1)(A)(i), (ii) or (iii) (applied in accordance with the regulations thereunder and disregarding Internal Revenue Code section 416(i)(5)).

Identification Period: A 12-month period ending each December 31.

Effective Period: With respect to an Identification Period, the 12-month period commencing on the immediately following April 1.

The Wells Fargo & Company Human Resources Committee (the “Committee”) has adopted this Key Employee Policy, effective December 31, 2018. This Policy is effective for Identification Periods ending on or after December 31, 2018 unless amended by the Committee.






ADOPTION AGREEMENT
with respect to the
SOUTHTRUST CORPORATION
ADDITIONAL RETIREMENT BENEFIT PLAN


Pursuant to the provisions of Section 5 of the SouthTrust Corporation Additional Retirement Benefit Plan, as amended (“the Plan”), SouthTrust Bank of Alabama, National Association, hereby adopts the Plan, effective as of January 1, 1989.

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, SouthTrust Bank of Alabama, National Association, has caused this instrument to be executed and its seal to be hereunto affixed and attested by its duly authorized officer on this 18th day of January, 1990.

SOUTHTRUST BANK OF ALABAMA,
NATIONAL ASSOCIATION



By: /s/ Julian W. Banton            

Its: President                    


ATTEST:



/s/ Doris B. Kilgore    
Its Cashier

[CORPORATE SEAL]


    






STATE OF ALABAMA    

JEFFERSON COUNTY        



ADDENDUM TO
SOUTHTRUST CORPORATION
ADDITIONAL RETIREMENT BENEFIT PLAN (PENSION)


SOUTHTRUST CORPORATION, a Corporation organized and existing under the laws of the State of Delaware (hereinafter called the “Employer”), hereby publishes on this the 20th day of April, 1994 this Addendum to the SouthTrust Corporation Additional Retirement Benefit Plan, as follows:

WITNESSETH :

WHEREAS, Employer, effective on January 1, 1987, established an Additional Retirement Benefit Plan and Trust; and

WHEREAS, the Internal Revenue Service has recently taken the position in a private letter ruling that all employers which participate in nonqualified deferred compensation plans are grantors under the plan and accompanying trust; and
    
WHEREAS, it is the desire of SouthTrust Corporation that the Plan and Trust conform to the Internal Revenue Service position.

NOW, THEREFORE, in consideration of the premises hereinabove set forth, Employer hereby clarifies the Plan, by addendum, as follows:

FIRST. Section 9.3 of said Plan shall be amended to read as follows:

9.3     Unsecured Promise . SouthTrust, each Employing Company and each Participant acknowledges that this Agreement shall create only an unsecured promise by SouthTrust and each Employing Company to Participants to pay the benefits provided herein. Until the occurrence of a distribution event, at which point Participant shall be entitled to receive all amounts as provided hereunder, all such amounts shall remain solely the property of SouthTrust and each Employing Company with respect to the assets contributed on behalf of its employees) subject only to the claims of the general creditors of the Employer and each Employing Company.

SECOND: This Addendum shall be effective as of the date first entered above.

THIRD: In all other respects, said Plan is hereby ratified, confirmed and approved.

    






The Employer has caused this Addendum to be executed by its duly authorized officer and duly attested, and its corporate seal to be hereunto affixed on the day and year first above written.


SOUTHTRUST CORPORATION
                    

By: /s/ Wallace D. Malone, Jr.            
Wallace D. Malone,
Chairman and Chief Executive Officer

(EMPLOYER)

ATTEST


/s/ Aubrey D. Barnard    
Aubrey D. Barnard,
Secretary

[CORPORATE SEAL]







AMENDMENT 2008-1 TO THE
AMENDED AND RESTATED
SOUTHTRUST CORPORATION
ADDITIONAL RETIREMENT BENEFIT PLAN (PENSION)


THIS AMENDMENT, dated as of December 29, 2008, hereby amends the Amended and Restated SouthTrust Corporation Additional Retirement Benefit Plan (Pension) (the “Plan”).

RECITALS

WHEREAS, SouthTrust Corporation (“SouthTrust”) previously adopted the Plan for the benefit of a select group of highly compensated or management employees of SouthTrust and other employing companies affiliated with SouthTrust (collectively referred to as “Participants”), effective as of July 15, 1992 and amended effective as of April 20, 1994.

WHEREAS, Wachovia Corporation (“Wachovia”) and SouthTrust merged, effective November 1, 2004, and Wachovia currently sponsors the Plan for the benefit of the Participants
    
WHEREAS, Wachovia desires to amend the Plan to bring it into compliance with Section 409A of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the “Code”), by modifying the distribution provisions and adding a special distribution election for amounts subject to Section 409A of the Code.

1. A new Section 7A is hereby added after Section 7 to read as follows:

“7A.     PAYMENT OF NON-GRANDFATHERED BENEFITS .

7A.1    Notwithstanding anything in the Plan to the contrary, prior to December 31, 2008, a Participant who will not have begun receiving distributions of his Non-Grandfathered Benefits (as defined below) calculated pursuant to Section 6 of this Plan (the “Non-Grandfathered Retirement Benefit”) prior to January 1, 2009 and who is entitled to a Non-Grandfathered Retirement Benefit, may make an election with respect to the form of payment by filing an election form in the form prescribed by the Committee (the “Distribution Election”). The Participant may choose from a form of annuity available under the Retirement Plan or a lump sum. If a Participant selects an annuity, the Participant will be permitted to choose his annuity option at the time payment of his Non-Grandfathered Retirement Benefit commences. If a Participant chooses a lump sum, his Non-Grandfathered Retirement Benefit will be the actuarially equivalent lump sum of the Non-Grandfathered Retirement Benefit. For purposes of this Plan, “Non-Grandfathered Benefits” shall mean a Participant’s benefits hereunder that were not earned and vested for purposes of Section 409A of the Code on or before December 31, 2004.

7A.2    If a Participant does not elect an annuity on his Distribution Election, then the Participant’s Non-Grandfathered Retirement Benefit shall be paid in a lump sum.    

7A.3    If a Participant is not currently employed by SouthTrust (i) at the time he makes his Distribution Election, or (ii) as of December 31, 2008 in the event the Participant does not make a Distribution Election, then the Participant’s Non-Grandfathered Retirement Benefit will be distributed or commenced distribution, as applicable, on the first day of the month coincident with or next following the Participant’s 65th birthday.

7A.4    Notwithstanding anything to the contrary herein, a Participant shall not be permitted in Plan Year 2008 to (a) change payment elections in a manner that will defer





distribution of amounts that the Participant otherwise would have received in 2008 or (b) accelerate payments that would otherwise be made at a later date into 2008

7A.5    Notwithstanding anything to the contrary herein, if a Participant’s Beneficiary (including an eligible spouse) becomes eligible at any time to receive a death benefit which is payable prior to the commencement of the Participant’s retirement benefit under the Retirement Plan, the Participant’s Beneficiary shall be entitled to a death benefit under this Plan equal to (A) the amount of the death benefit which the Beneficiary is entitled to receive under the Retirement Plan, reduced by (B) the amount of the death benefit which the Beneficiary is entitled to receive under the terms, provision and limitations of the Retirement Plan. If a Participant, at the date of his death, is receiving payment of the Non-Grandfathered Retirement Benefit provided hereunder in a form which contemplates that a payment or payments will be made after his death, such Participant’s Beneficiary shall be entitled to receive payment of the Non-Grandfathered Retirement Benefit if such Participant would be entitled to receive those death benefits under the Retirement Plan. The death benefit payable to a Participant’s Beneficiary as described above in this Section 7A.5, shall be paid to the Participant’s Beneficiary in the actuarially equivalent lump sum of the death benefit within 60 days following Participant’s death.

7A.6    Distribution of the Non-Grandfathered Retirement Benefit pursuant to the Participant’s Distribution Election and this Section 7A shall supersede and replace any and all prior agreements with respect to distribution of the Non-Grandfathered Retirement Benefit entered into by the Participant and SouthTrust.”    

2. A new Section 9.10 is hereby added to read as follows:

“9.10     Compliance with Section 409A of the Code . The Plan is intended to comply with the requirements of Section 409A of the Code, and shall in all respects be administered in accordance with Section 409A of the Code. Notwithstanding anything in the Plan to the contrary, distributions of Non-Grandfathered Benefits may only be made under the Plan upon an event and in a manner permitted by Section 409A of the Code, including the requirement that Specified Employees, may not receive distributions of Non-Grandfathered Benefits prior to the end of the six-month period following a Separation from Service. If a payment of Non-Grandfathered Benefits is not made by the designated payment date under the Plan, the payment shall be made by December 31 of the calendar year in which the designated date occurs. To the extent that any provision of the Plan would cause a conflict with the requirements of Section 409A of the Code, or would cause the administration of the Plan to fail to satisfy the requirements of Section 409A of the Code, such provision shall be deemed null and void to the extent permitted by applicable law. Other than the special Distribution Election made before December 31, 2008 pursuant to Section 7A above, in no event may a Participant designate the year of a distribution of his Non-Grandfathered Benefits.”

3. This Amendment shall be effective as of the date first written above.

4. Nothing in this Amendment shall, or is intended to, constitute a “material modification” so as to subject amounts that were earned and vested as of December 31, 2004 to the provisions of Section 409A of the Code.

5. In all respects not modified herein, the Plan is hereby ratified, confirmed and approved.


[Signature Page Follows]





IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties set forth below have caused this instrument to be executed on the date first written above.



WACHOVIA CORPORATION
                    


By: /s/ Chuck Loring                
Chuck Loring
    
Title: Senior Vice President            

                            

PARTICIPANT



/s/ Elizabeth A. Duke                
Elizabeth Duke

    



Exhibit 13



                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        
 
 
 
 
Financial Review
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Overview
 
 
5

 
Available-for-Sale and Held-to-Maturity Debt Securities
 
 
 
Earnings Performance
 
 
6

 
Loans and Allowance for Credit Losses
 
 
 
Balance Sheet Analysis
 
 
7

 
Premises, Equipment, Lease Commitments and Other Assets
 
 
 
Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements
 
 
8

 
Equity Securities
 
 
 
Risk Management
 
 
9

 
Securitizations and Variable Interest Entities
 
 
 
Capital Management
 
 
10

 
Mortgage Banking Activities
 
 
 
Regulatory Matters
 
 
11

 
Intangible Assets
 
 
 
Critical Accounting Policies
 
 
12

 
Deposits
 
 
 
Current Accounting Developments
 
 
13

 
Short-Term Borrowings
 
 
 
Forward-Looking Statements
 
 
14

 
Long-Term Debt
 
 
 
Risk Factors
 
 
15

 
Guarantees, Pledged Assets and Collateral, and Other Commitments
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
16

 
Legal Actions
 
 
 
 
Controls and Procedures
 
 
17

 
Derivatives
 
 
 
Disclosure Controls and Procedures
 
 
18

 
Fair Values of Assets and Liabilities
 
 
 
Internal Control Over Financial Reporting
 
 
19

 
Preferred Stock
 
 
 
Management’s Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting
 
 
20

 
Common Stock and Stock Plans
 
 
 
Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm
 
 
21

 
Revenue from Contracts with Customers
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
22

 
Employee Benefits and Other Expenses
 
 
 
 
Financial Statements
 
 
23

 
Income Taxes
 
 
 
Consolidated Statement of Income
 
 
24

 
Earnings and Dividends Per Common Share
 
 
 
Consolidated Statement of Comprehensive Income
 
 
25

 
Other Comprehensive Income
 
 
 
Consolidated Balance Sheet
 
 
26

 
Operating Segments
 
 
 
Consolidated Statement of Changes in Equity
 
 
27

 
Parent-Only Financial Statements
 
 
 
Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows
 
 
28

 
Regulatory and Agency Capital Requirements
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Notes to Financial Statements
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1

 
Summary of Significant Accounting Policies
 
 
 
 
Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm
 
2

 
Business Combinations
 
 
 
 
Quarterly Financial Data
 
3

 
Cash, Loan and Dividend Restrictions
 
 
 
 
Glossary of Acronyms
 
4

 
Trading Activities
 
 
 
 
 
 

 
Wells Fargo & Company
41


Overview (continued)

This Annual Report, including the Financial Review and the Financial Statements and related Notes, contains forward-looking statements, which may include forecasts of our financial results and condition, expectations for our operations and business, and our assumptions for those forecasts and expectations. Do not unduly rely on forward-looking statements. Actual results may differ materially from our forward-looking statements due to several factors. Factors that could cause our actual results to differ materially from our forward-looking statements are described in this Report, including in the “Forward-Looking Statements” and “Risk Factors” sections, and in the “Regulation and Supervision” section of our Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2018 ( 2018 Form 10-K).
 
When we refer to “Wells Fargo,” “the Company,” “we,” “our,” or “us” in this Report, we mean Wells Fargo & Company and Subsidiaries (consolidated). When we refer to the “Parent,” we mean Wells Fargo & Company. See the Glossary of Acronyms for terms used throughout this Report.  
Financial Review 1  
Overview
Wells Fargo & Company is a diversified, community-based financial services company with $1.90 trillion in assets. Founded in 1852 and headquartered in San Francisco, we provide banking, investment and mortgage products and services, as well as consumer and commercial finance, through 7,800 locations, more than 13,000 ATMs, digital (online, mobile and social), and contact centers (phone, email and correspondence), and we have offices in 37 countries and territories to support customers who conduct business in the global economy. With approximately 259,000 active, full-time equivalent team members, we serve one in three households in the United States and ranked No. 26 on Fortune’s  2018 rankings of America’s largest corporations. We ranked fourth in assets and third in the market value of our common stock among all U.S. banks at December 31, 2018
We use our Vision, Values & Goals to guide us toward growth and success. Our vision is to satisfy our customers’ financial needs and help them succeed financially. We aspire to create deep and enduring relationships with our customers by providing them with an exceptional experience and by understanding their needs and delivering the most relevant products, services, advice, and guidance.
We have five primary values, which are based on our vision and guide the actions we take. First, we place customers at the center of everything we do. We want to exceed customer expectations and build relationships that last a lifetime. Second, we value and support our people as a competitive advantage and strive to attract, develop, motivate, and retain the best team members. Third, we strive for the highest ethical standards of integrity, transparency, and principled performance. Fourth, we value and promote diversity and inclusion in all aspects of business and at all levels. Fifth, we look to each of our team members to be a leader in establishing, sharing, and communicating our vision for our customers, communities, team members, and shareholders. In addition to our five primary values, one of our key day-to-day priorities is to make risk management a competitive advantage by working hard to ensure that appropriate controls are in place to reduce risks to our customers, maintain and increase our competitive market position, and protect Wells Fargo’s long-term safety, soundness, and reputation.
____________________________________________
1  
Financial information for periods prior to 2018 has been revised to reflect presentation changes made in connection with our adoption in first quarter 2018 of Accounting Standards Update (ASU) 2016-01 Financial Instruments – Overall (Subtopic 825-10): Recognition and Measurement of Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities . See Note 1 (Summary of Significant Accounting Policies) to Financial Statements in this Report for more information.
 
In keeping with our primary values and risk management priorities, we have six long-term goals for the Company, which entail becoming the financial services leader in the following areas:
Customer service and advice – provide exceptional service and guidance to our customers to help them succeed financially.
Team member engagement – be a company where people feel included, valued, and supported; everyone is respected; and we work as a team.
Innovation – create lasting value for our customers and increased efficiency for our operations through innovative thinking, industry-leading technology, and a willingness to test and learn.
Risk management – set the global standard in
managing all forms of risk.
Corporate citizenship – make a positive contribution to communities through philanthropy, advancing diversity and inclusion, creating economic opportunity, and promoting environmental sustainability.
Shareholder value – deliver long-term value for shareholders.

Federal Reserve Board Consent Order Regarding Governance Oversight and Compliance and Operational Risk Management
On February 2, 2018, the Company entered into a consent order with the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System (FRB). As required by the consent order, the Board submitted to the FRB a plan to further enhance the Board’s governance and oversight of the Company, and the Company submitted to the FRB a plan to further improve the Company’s compliance and operational risk management program. The consent order requires the Company, following the FRB’s acceptance and approval of the plans and the Company’s adoption and implementation of the plans, to complete third-party reviews of the enhancements and improvements provided for in the plans. Until these third-party reviews are complete and the plans are approved and implemented to the satisfaction of the FRB, the Company’s total consolidated assets will be limited to the level as of December 31, 2017. Compliance with this asset cap will be measured on a two-quarter daily average basis to allow for management of temporary fluctuations. The Company continues to have constructive dialogue with the FRB on an ongoing basis to clarify expectations, receive feedback, and assess progress under the consent order. In order to have enough time to incorporate this feedback into the Company’s plans in a

42
Wells Fargo & Company
 


thoughtful manner, adopt and implement the final plans as accepted by the FRB, and complete the required third-party reviews, the Company is planning to operate under the asset cap through the end of 2019. As of the end of fourth quarter 2018, our total consolidated assets, as calculated pursuant to the requirements of the consent order, were below our level of total assets as of December 31, 2017. Additionally, after removal of the asset cap, a second third-party review must also be conducted to assess the efficacy and sustainability of the enhancements and improvements.

Consent Orders with the Consumer Financial Protection Bureau and Office of the Comptroller of the Currency Regarding Compliance Risk Management Program, Automobile Collateral Protection Insurance Policies, and Mortgage Interest Rate Lock Extensions
On April 20, 2018, the Company entered into consent orders with the Consumer Financial Protection Bureau (CFPB) and the Office of the Comptroller of the Currency (OCC) to pay an aggregate of $1 billion in civil money penalties to resolve matters regarding the Company’s compliance risk management program and past practices involving certain automobile collateral protection insurance policies and certain mortgage interest rate lock extensions. As required by the consent orders, the Company submitted to the CFPB and OCC an enterprise-wide compliance risk management plan and a plan to enhance the Company’s internal audit program with respect to federal consumer financial law and the terms of the consent orders. In addition, as required by the consent orders, the Company submitted for non-objection plans to remediate customers affected by the automobile collateral protection insurance and mortgage interest rate lock matters, as well as a plan for the management of remediation activities conducted by the Company.

Retail Sales Practices Matters
As we have previously reported, in September 2016 we announced settlements with the CFPB, the OCC, and the Office of the Los Angeles City Attorney, and entered into consent orders with the CFPB and the OCC, in connection with allegations that some of our retail customers received products and services they did not request. As a result, it remains our top priority to rebuild trust through a comprehensive action plan that includes making things right for our customers, team members, and other stakeholders, and building a better Company for the future.
Our priority of rebuilding trust has included numerous actions focused on identifying potential financial harm and customer remediation. The Board and management are conducting company-wide reviews of sales practices issues. These reviews are ongoing. In August 2017, a third-party consulting firm completed an expanded data-driven review of retail banking accounts opened from January 2009 to September 2016 to identify financial harm stemming from potentially unauthorized accounts. We have completed financial remediation for the customers identified through the expanded account analysis. Additionally, customer outreach under the $142 million class action lawsuit settlement concerning improper retail sales practices ( Jabbari v. Wells Fargo Bank, N.A. ), into which the Company entered to provide further remediation to customers, concluded in June 2018 and the period for customers to submit claims closed on July 7, 2018. The settlement administrator will pay claims following the
 
calculation of compensatory damages and favorable resolution of pending appeals in the case.
For additional information regarding sales practices matters, including related legal matters, see the “Risk Factors” section and Note 16 (Legal Actions) to Financial Statements in this Report.

Additional Efforts to Rebuild Trust
Our priority of rebuilding trust has also included an effort to identify other areas or instances where customers may have experienced financial harm. We are working with our regulatory agencies in this effort, and we have accrued for the reasonably estimable remediation costs related to these matters, which amounts may change based on additional facts and information, as well as ongoing reviews and communications with our regulators. As part of this effort, we are focused on the following key areas:
Automobile Lending Business The Company is reviewing practices concerning the origination, servicing, and/or collection of consumer automobile loans, including matters related to certain insurance products, and is providing remediation to the extent it identifies affected customers. For example:
In July 2017, the Company announced it would remediate customers who may have been financially harmed due to issues related to automobile collateral protection insurance (CPI) policies purchased through a third-party vendor on their behalf (based on an understanding that the borrowers did not have physical damage insurance coverage on their automobiles as required during the term of their automobile loans). The practice of placing CPI had been previously discontinued by the Company. The Company is in the process of providing remediation to affected customers and/or letters to affected customers through which they may claim or otherwise receive remediation compensation for policies placed between October 15, 2005, and September 30, 2016.
The Company has identified certain issues related to the unused portion of guaranteed automobile protection waiver or insurance agreements between the customer and dealer and, by assignment, the lender, which will result in remediation to customers in certain states. The Company is in the process of providing remediation to affected customers.
Mortgage Interest Rate Lock Extensions In October 2017, the Company announced plans to reach out to all home lending customers who paid fees for mortgage rate lock extensions requested from September 16, 2013, through February 28, 2017, and to provide refunds, with interest, to customers who believe they should not have paid those fees. The plan to issue refunds follows an internal review that determined a rate lock extension policy implemented in September 2013 was, at times, not consistently applied, resulting in some borrowers being charged fees in cases where the Company was primarily responsible for the delays that made the extensions necessary. Effective March 1, 2017, the Company changed how it manages the mortgage rate lock extension process by establishing a centralized review team that reviews all rate lock extension requests for consistent application of the policy. Although the Company believes a substantial number of the rate lock extension fees during the period in question were appropriately charged under its policy, due to

 
Wells Fargo & Company
43


Overview (continued)

our customer-oriented remediation approach, we have issued refunds and interest to substantially all of our customers who paid rate lock extension fees during the period in question. We have substantially completed the remediation process.
Add-on Products The Company is reviewing practices related to certain consumer “add-on” products, including identity theft and debt protection products that were subject to an OCC consent order entered into in June 2015, as well as home and automobile warranty products, and memberships in discount programs. The products were sold to customers through a number of distribution channels and, in some cases, were acquired by the Company in connection with the purchase of loans. Sales of certain of these products have been discontinued over the past few years primarily due to decisions made by the Company in the normal course of business, and by mid-2017, the Company had ceased selling any of these products to consumers. We are in the process of providing remediation where we identify affected customers, and are also providing refunds to customers who purchased certain products. The review of the Company’s historical practices with respect to these products is ongoing, focusing on, among other topics, sales practices, adequacy of disclosures, customer servicing, and volume and type of customer complaints.
Consumer Deposit Account Freezing/Closing The Company is reviewing procedures regarding the freezing (and, in many cases, closing) of consumer deposit accounts after the Company detected suspected fraudulent activity (by third-parties or account holders) that affected those accounts. This review is ongoing.
Review of Certain Activities Within Wealth and Investment Management A review of certain activities within Wealth and Investment Management (WIM) being conducted by the Board, in response to inquiries from federal government agencies, is assessing whether there have been inappropriate referrals or recommendations, including with respect to rollovers for 401(k) plan participants, certain alternative investments, or referrals of brokerage customers to the Company’s investment and fiduciary services business. The Board’s review is substantially completed and has not, to date, uncovered evidence of systemic or widespread issues in these businesses. Federal government agencies continue to review this matter.
Fiduciary and Custody Account Fee Calculations The Company is reviewing fee calculations within certain fiduciary and custody accounts in its investment and fiduciary services business, which is part of the wealth management business in WIM. The Company has determined that there have been instances of incorrect fees being applied to certain assets and accounts, resulting in both overcharges and undercharges to customers. These issues include the incorrect set-up and maintenance in the system of record of the values associated with certain assets. Systems, operations, and account-level reviews are underway to determine the extent of any assets and accounts affected, and root cause analyses are being performed with the assistance of third parties. These reviews are ongoing and, as a result of its reviews to date, the Company has suspended the charging of fees on some assets and accounts, has notified the affected customers, and is continuing its analysis of those assets and accounts. The review of
 
customer accounts is ongoing to determine the extent of any additional necessary remediation, including with respect to additional accounts not yet reviewed, which may lead to additional accruals and fee suspensions.
Foreign Exchange Business The Company has completed an assessment, with the assistance of a third party, of its policies, practices, and procedures in its foreign exchange (FX) business. The FX business continues to revise and implement new policies, practices, and procedures, including those related to pricing. The Company has begun providing remediation to customers that may have received pricing inconsistent with commitments made to those customers, and rebates to customers where historic pricing, while consistent with contracts entered into with those customers, does not conform to the Company’s recently implemented standards and pricing. The Company’s review of affected customers is ongoing.
Mortgage Loan Modifications An internal review of the Company’s use of a mortgage loan modification underwriting tool identified a calculation error regarding foreclosure attorneys’ fees affecting certain accounts that were in the foreclosure process between April 13, 2010, and October 2, 2015, when the error was corrected. A subsequent expanded review identified related errors regarding the maximum allowable foreclosure attorneys’ fees permitted for certain accounts that were in the foreclosure process between March 15, 2010, and April 30, 2018, when new controls were implemented. Similar to the initial calculation error, these errors caused an overstatement of the attorneys’ fees that were included for purposes of determining whether a customer qualified for a mortgage loan modification or repayment plan pursuant to the requirements of government-sponsored enterprises (such as Fannie Mae and Freddie Mac), the Federal Housing Administration (FHA), and the U.S. Department of Treasury’s Home Affordable Modification Program (HAMP). Customers were not actually charged the incorrect attorneys’ fees. As previously disclosed, the Company has identified customers who, as a result of these errors, were incorrectly denied a loan modification or were not offered a loan modification or repayment plan in cases where they otherwise would have qualified, as well as instances where a foreclosure was completed after the loan modification was denied or the customer was deemed ineligible to be offered a loan modification or repayment plan. The number of previously disclosed customers affected by these errors may change as a result of ongoing validation, but is not expected to have changed materially upon completion of this validation. The Company has contacted substantially all of the identified customers affected by these errors and has provided remediation as well as the option to pursue no-cost mediation with an independent mediator. The Company’s review of its mortgage loan modification practices is ongoing, and we are providing remediation to the extent we identify additional affected customers as a result of this review.

To the extent issues are identified, we will continue to assess any customer harm and provide remediation as appropriate. This effort to identify other instances in which customers may have experienced harm is ongoing, and it is possible that we may identify other areas of potential concern.

44
Wells Fargo & Company
 


For more information, including related legal and regulatory risk, see the “Risk Factors” section and Note 16 (Legal Actions) to Financial Statements in this Report.

Financial Performance
In 2018 , we generated $22.4 billion of net income and diluted earnings per common share (EPS) of $4.28 , compared with $22.2 billion of net income and EPS of $4.10 for 2017 . We grew average commercial and industrial, and average real estate 1-4 family first mortgage loans compared with 2017 , maintained strong capital and liquidity levels, and rewarded our shareholders by increasing our dividend and continuing to repurchase shares of our common stock. Our achievements during 2018 continued to demonstrate the benefit of our diversified business model and our ability to generate consistent financial performance. We remain focused on meeting the financial needs of our customers. Noteworthy financial performance items for 2018 (compared with 2017 ) included: 
revenue of $86.4 billion , down from $88.4 billion , which included net interest income of $50.0 billion , up $438 million , or 1% ;
average loans of $945.2 billion , down 1%;
average deposits of $1.3 trillion , down $28.8 billion , or 2%;
return on assets (ROA) of 1.19% and return on equity (ROE) of 11.53%, up from 1.15% and 11.35%, respectively, a year ago;
our credit results improved with a net charge-off rate of 0.29%, compared with 0.31% a year ago;
nonaccrual loans of $6.5 billion , down $1.2 billion , or 15% , from a year ago; and
$25.8 billion in capital returned to our shareholders through increased common stock dividends and additional net share repurchases, up 78% from a year ago.

Table 1 presents a six-year summary of selected financial data and Table 2 presents selected ratios and per common share data.

Balance Sheet and Liquidity
Our balance sheet remained strong during 2018 with strong credit quality and solid levels of liquidity and capital. Our total assets were $1.90 trillion at December 31, 2018 . Cash and other short-term investments decreased $42.5 billion from December 31, 2017, reflecting lower deposit balances. Debt securities grew $11.3 billion , or 2% , from December 31, 2017. Our loan portfolio declined $3.7 billion from December 31, 2017. Growth in commercial and industrial loans and real estate 1-4 family first mortgage loans was more than offset by declines in commercial real estate mortgage, real estate 1-4 family junior lien mortgage and automobile loans.
Deposits at December 31, 2018, were down $49.8 billion , or 4% , from 2017. The decline was driven by a decrease in commercial deposits from financial institutions, which includes actions the Company took in the first half of 2018 in response to the asset cap, and a decline in consumer and small business banking deposits. Our average deposit cost increased 21 basis points from a year ago driven by an increase in Wholesale Banking and Wealth and Investment Management deposit rates.
 
 
Credit Quality
Credit quality remained solid in 2018, driven by continued strong performance in the commercial and consumer real estate portfolios. Performance in several of our commercial and consumer loan portfolios remained near historically low loss levels and reflected our long-term risk focus. Net charge-offs were $2.7 billion, or 0.29% of average loans, in 2018, compared with $2.9 billion, or 0.31%, in 2017.
Net losses in our commercial portfolio were $429 million, or 9 basis points of average commercial loans, in 2018, compared with $446 million, or 9 basis points, in 2017, driven by decreased losses in our commercial and industrial loan portfolio. Net consumer losses decreased to 52 basis points of average consumer loans in 2018, compared with 55 basis points in 2017. Losses in our consumer real estate portfolios declined $93 million in 2018 to a net recovery position. The consumer loss levels reflected decreased losses in our automobile and other revolving and installment loan portfolios, lower losses in our residential real estate portfolios due to the benefit of the improving housing market, and our continued focus on originating high quality loans.
The allowance for credit losses of $10.7 billion at December 31, 2018, declined $1.3 billion from the prior year. Our provision for credit losses in 2018 was $1.7 billion, compared with $2.5 billion in 2017, reflecting a release of $1.0 billion in the allowance for credit losses, compared with a release of $400 million in 2017. The release in 2018 and 2017 was due to strong underlying credit performance.
Nonperforming assets (NPAs) at the end of 2018 were $6.9 billion, down 16% from the end of 2017. Nonaccrual loans declined $1.2 billion from the prior year end while foreclosed assets were down $191 million from 2017.

Capital
Our financial performance in 2018 allowed us to maintain a solid capital position with total equity of $197.1 billion at December 31, 2018, compared with $208.1 billion at December 31, 2017. We returned $25.8 billion to shareholders in 2018 ($14.5 billion in 2017) through common stock dividends and net share repurchases , and our net payout ratio (which is the ratio of (i) common stock dividends and share repurchases less issuances and stock compensation-related items, divided by (ii) net income applicable to common stock) was 125%. During 2018 we increased our quarterly common stock dividend from $0.39 to $0.43 per share. Our common shares outstanding declined by 310.4 million shares, or 6%, as we continued to reduce our common share count through the repurchase of 375.5 million common shares during the year. We expect our share count to continue to decline in 2019 as a result of anticipated net share repurchases.
We believe an important measure of our capital strength is the Common Equity Tier 1 ratio on a fully phased-in basis, which was 11.74 % as of December 31, 2018, down from 11.98% a year ago, but still well above our internal target of 10%. Likewise, our other regulatory capital ratios remained strong. See the “Capital Management” section in this Report for more information regarding our capital, including the calculation of our regulatory capital amounts.

 
Wells Fargo & Company
45


Overview (continued)

Table 1: Six-Year Summary of Selected Financial Data
(in millions, except per share amounts)
2018

 
2017

 
2016

 
2015

 
2014

 
2013

 
%
Change
2018/
2017

 
Five-year
compound
growth
rate 

Income statement
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net interest income
$
49,995

 
49,557

 
47,754

 
45,301

 
43,527

 
42,800

 
1
 %
 
3

Noninterest income
36,413

 
38,832

 
40,513

 
40,756

 
40,820

 
40,980

 
(6
)
 
(2
)
Revenue
86,408

 
88,389


88,267


86,057


84,347


83,780

 
(2
)
 
1

Provision for credit losses
1,744

 
2,528

 
3,770

 
2,442

 
1,395

 
2,309

 
(31
)
 
(5
)
Noninterest expense
56,126

 
58,484

 
52,377

 
49,974

 
49,037

 
48,842

 
(4
)
 
3

Net income before noncontrolling interests
22,876

 
22,460

 
22,045

 
23,276

 
23,608

 
22,224

 
2

 
1

Less: Net income from noncontrolling interests
483

 
277

 
107

 
382

 
551

 
346

 
74

 
7

Wells Fargo net income
22,393

 
22,183


21,938


22,894


23,057


21,878

 
1

 

Earnings per common share
4.31

 
4.14

 
4.03

 
4.18

 
4.17

 
3.95

 
4

 
2

Diluted earnings per common share
4.28

 
4.10

 
3.99

 
4.12

 
4.10

 
3.89

 
4

 
2

Dividends declared per common share
1.640

 
1.540

 
1.515

 
1.475

 
1.350

 
1.150

 
6

 
7

Balance sheet  (at year end)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Debt securities
$
484,689

 
473,366

 
459,038

 
394,744

 
350,661

 
298,241

 
2
 %
 
10

Loans
953,110

 
956,770

 
967,604

 
916,559

 
862,551

 
822,286

 

 
3

Allowance for loan losses
9,775

 
11,004

 
11,419

 
11,545

 
12,319

 
14,502

 
(11
)
 
(8
)
Goodwill
26,418

 
26,587

 
26,693

 
25,529

 
25,705

 
25,637

 
(1
)
 
1

Equity securities
55,148

 
62,497

 
49,110

 
40,266

 
44,005

 
32,227

 
(12
)
 
11

Assets
1,895,883

 
1,951,757

 
1,930,115

 
1,787,632

 
1,687,155

 
1,523,502

 
(3
)
 
4

Deposits
1,286,170

 
1,335,991

 
1,306,079

 
1,223,312

 
1,168,310

 
1,079,177

 
(4
)
 
4

Long-term debt
229,044

 
225,020

 
255,077

 
199,536

 
183,943

 
152,998

 
2

 
8

Wells Fargo stockholders’ equity
196,166

 
206,936

 
199,581

 
192,998

 
184,394

 
170,142

 
(5
)
 
3

Noncontrolling interests
900

 
1,143

 
916

 
893

 
868

 
866

 
(21
)
 
1

Total equity
197,066

 
208,079

 
200,497

 
193,891

 
185,262

 
171,008

 
(5
)
 
3




46
Wells Fargo & Company
 


Table 2: Ratios and Per Common Share Data
 
Year ended December 31, 
 
 
2018

 
2017

 
2016

Profitability ratios
 
 
 
 
 
Wells Fargo net income to average assets (ROA)
1.19
%
 
1.15

 
1.16

Wells Fargo net income applicable to common stock to average Wells Fargo common stockholders’ equity (ROE)
11.53

 
11.35

 
11.49

Return on average tangible common equity (ROTCE) (1)
13.73

 
13.55

 
13.85

Efficiency ratio (2)
65.0

 
66.2

 
59.3

Capital ratios (3)
 
 
 
 
 
At year end:
 
 
 
 
 
Wells Fargo common stockholders’ equity to assets
9.20

 
9.38

 
9.14

Total equity to assets
10.39

 
10.66

 
10.39

Risk-based capital (4):
 
 
 
 
 
Common Equity Tier 1
11.74

 
12.28

 
11.13

Tier 1 capital
13.46

 
14.14

 
12.82

Total capital
16.60

 
17.46

 
16.04

Tier 1 leverage
9.07

 
9.35

 
8.95

Average balances:
 
 
 
 
 
Average Wells Fargo common stockholders’ equity to average assets
9.50

 
9.37

 
9.40

Average total equity to average assets
10.77

 
10.64

 
10.64

Per common share data
 
 
 
 
 
Dividend payout (5)
38.3

 
37.6

 
38.0

Book value (6)
$
38.06

 
37.44

 
35.18

(1)
Tangible common equity is a non-GAAP financial measure and represents total equity less preferred equity, noncontrolling interests, and goodwill and certain identifiable intangible assets (including goodwill and intangible assets associated with certain of our nonmarketable equity securities, but excluding mortgage servicing rights), net of applicable deferred taxes. The methodology of determining tangible common equity may differ among companies. Management believes that return on average tangible common equity, which utilizes tangible common equity, is a useful financial measure because it enables investors and others to assess the Company’s use of equity. For additional information, including a corresponding reconciliation to GAAP financial measures, see the “Capital Management – Tangible Common Equity” section in this Report.
(2)
The efficiency ratio is noninterest expense divided by total revenue (net interest income and noninterest income).
(3)
See the “Capital Management” section and Note 28 (Regulatory and Agency Capital Requirements) to Financial Statements in this Report for additional information.
(4)
The risk-based capital ratios were calculated under the lower of Standardized or Advanced Approach determined pursuant to Basel III. Beginning January 1, 2018, the requirements for calculating common equity tier 1 and tier 1 capital, along with risk-weighted assets, became fully phased-in; Accordingly, the information presented reflects fully phased-in common equity tier 1 capital, tier 1 capital and risk-weighted assets but reflects total capital still in accordance with Transition Requirements. See the “Capital Management” section and Note 28 (Regulatory and Agency Capital Requirements) to Financial Statements in this Report for additional information.
(5)
Dividend payout ratio is dividends declared per common share as a percentage of diluted earnings per common share.
(6)
Book value per common share is common stockholders’ equity divided by common shares outstanding.



 
Wells Fargo & Company
47


Earnings Performance (continued)

Earnings Performance
Wells Fargo net income for 2018 was $22.4 billion ( $4.28 diluted earnings per common share), compared with $22.2 billion ( $4.10  diluted per share) for 2017 and $21.9 billion ( $3.99  diluted per share) for 2016 . Our financial performance in 2018 benefited from a $438 million increase in net interest income, a $784 million decrease in our provision for credit losses, and a $2.4 billion decrease in noninterest expense, partially offset by a $2.4 billion decrease in noninterest income, and a $745 million increase in income tax expense.
 
Revenue, the sum of net interest income and noninterest income, was $86.4 billion in 2018 , compared with $88.4 billion in 2017 and $88.3 billion in 2016 . The decrease in revenue for 2018 compared with 2017 was predominantly due to a decrease in noninterest income, reflecting decreases in mortgage banking income, insurance income, service charges on deposit accounts, and net gains (losses) from debt and equity securities, partially offset by an increase in all other noninterest income. Our diversified sources of revenue generated by our businesses continued to be balanced between net interest income and noninterest income. In 2018 , net interest income of $50.0 billion represented 58% of revenue, compared with $49.6 billion ( 56% ) in 2017 and $47.8 billion ( 54% ) in 2016 . Table 3 presents the components of revenue and noninterest expense as a percentage of revenue for year-over-year results.
See later in this section for discussions of net interest income, noninterest income and noninterest expense.


48
Wells Fargo & Company
 


Table 3: Net Interest Income, Noninterest Income and Noninterest Expense as a Percentage of Revenue
 
Year ended December 31, 
 
(in millions)
2018

 
% of revenue 

 
2017

 
% of revenue 

 
2016

 
% of revenue 

Interest income (on a taxable-equivalent basis)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Debt securities
$
14,947

 
17
 %
 
$
14,084

 
15
 %
 
$
12,328

 
14
 %
Mortgage loans held for sale (MLHFS)
777

 
1

 
786

 
1

 
784

 
1

Loans held for sale (LHFS)
140

 

 
50

 
3

 
38

 

Loans
44,086

 
51

 
41,551

 
47

 
39,630

 
45

Equity securities
999

 
1

 
821

 
1

 
669

 
1

Other interest income
4,359

 
5

 
2,941

 
3

 
1,457

 
2

Total interest income (on a taxable-equivalent basis)
65,308

 
76

 
60,233

 
68

 
54,906

 
62

Interest expense (on a taxable-equivalent basis)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Deposits
5,622

 
7

 
3,013

 
3

 
1,395

 
2

Short-term borrowings
1,719

 
2

 
761

 
1

 
333

 

Long-term debt
6,703

 
8

 
5,157

 
6

 
3,830

 
5

Other interest expense
610

 
1

 
424

 

 
354

 

Total interest expense (on a taxable-equivalent basis)
14,654

 
17

 
9,355

 
11

 
5,912

 
7

Net interest income (on a taxable-equivalent basis)
50,654

 
59

 
50,878

 
57

 
48,994

 
55

Taxable-equivalent adjustment
(659
)
 
(1
)
 
(1,321
)
 
(1
)
 
(1,240
)
 
(1
)
Net interest income  (A) 
49,995

 
58

 
49,557

 
56

 
47,754

 
54

Noninterest income
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Service charges on deposit accounts
4,716

 
5

 
5,111

 
6

 
5,372

 
6

Trust and investment fees (1)
14,509

 
17

 
14,495

 
16

 
14,243

 
16

Card fees
3,907

 
5

 
3,960

 
4

 
3,936

 
5

Other fees (1)
3,384

 
4

 
3,557

 
4

 
3,727

 
4

Mortgage banking (1)
3,017

 
3

 
4,350

 
5

 
6,096

 
7

Insurance
429

 

 
1,049

 
1

 
1,268

 
2

Net gains from trading activities
602

 
1

 
542

 
1

 
610

 
1

Net gains on debt securities
108

 

 
479

 
1

 
942

 
1

Net gains from equity securities
1,515

 
2

 
1,779

 
2

 
1,103

 
1

Lease income
1,753

 
2

 
1,907

 
2

 
1,927

 
2

Other (1)
2,473

 
3

 
1,603

 
2

 
1,289

 
1

Total noninterest income (B)
36,413

 
42

 
38,832

 
44

 
40,513

 
46

Noninterest expense
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Salaries
17,834

 
21

 
17,363

 
20

 
16,552

 
19

Commission and incentive compensation
10,264

 
12

 
10,442

 
12

 
10,247

 
12

Employee benefits
4,926

 
6

 
5,566

 
6

 
5,094

 
6

Equipment
2,444

 
3

 
2,237

 
3

 
2,154

 
2

Net occupancy
2,888

 
3

 
2,849

 
3

 
2,855

 
3

Core deposit and other intangibles
1,058

 
1

 
1,152

 
1

 
1,192

 
1

FDIC and other deposit assessments
1,110

 
1

 
1,287

 
1

 
1,168

 
1

Operating losses
3,124

 
4

 
5,492

 
6

 
1,608

 
2

Outside professional services
3,306

 
4

 
3,813

 
4

 
3,138

 
4

Other (2)
9,172

 
11

 
8,283

 
9

 
8,369

 
9

Total noninterest expense
56,126

 
65

 
58,484

 
66

 
52,377

 
59

Revenue (A) + (B)
$
86,408

 
 
 
$
88,389

 
 
 
$
88,267

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(1)
See Table 7 – Noninterest Income in this Report for additional detail.
(2)
See Table 8 – Noninterest Expense in this Report for additional detail.


 
Wells Fargo & Company
49


Earnings Performance (continued)

Net Interest Income
Net interest income is the interest earned on debt securities, loans (including yield-related loan fees) and other interest-earning assets minus the interest paid on deposits, short-term borrowings and long-term debt. Net interest margin is the average yield on earning assets minus the average interest rate paid for deposits and our other sources of funding. Net interest income and the net interest margin are presented on a taxable-equivalent basis in Table 5 to consistently reflect income from taxable and tax-exempt loans and debt and equity securities based on a 21% and 35% federal statutory tax rate for the periods ending December 31, 2018 and 2017 , respectively.
Net interest income and the net interest margin in any one period can be significantly affected by a variety of factors including the mix and overall size of our earning assets portfolio and the cost of funding those assets. In addition, some variable sources of interest income, such as resolutions from purchased credit-impaired (PCI) loans, loan fees, periodic dividends, and collection of interest on nonaccrual loans, can vary from period to period.
Net interest income on a taxable-equivalent basis was $50.7 billion  in 2018 , compared with $50.9 billion in 2017 , and $49.0 billion in 2016 . The decrease in net interest income in 2018 , compared with 2017 , was driven by:
lower loan swap income due to unwinding the receive-fixed loan swap portfolio;
lower tax-equivalent net interest income from updated tax-equivalent factors reflecting new tax law;
a smaller balance sheet and unfavorable mix;
higher premium amortization; and
unfavorable hedge ineffectiveness accounting results;
partially offset by:
the net repricing benefit of higher interest rates; and
higher variable income.

The increase in net interest income for 2017 , compared with 2016 , was driven by growth in earning assets and the benefit of higher interest rates, partially offset by growth and repricing of long-term debt. Deposit interest expense also increased in 2017, largely due to an increase in wholesale and Wealth and Investment Management (WIM) deposit pricing resulting from higher interest rates.
Net interest margin on a taxable-equivalent basis
was 2.91% in 2018 , compared with 2.87% in 2017 and 2.86% in 2016 . The increase in net interest margin in 2018 , compared with 2017 , was driven by:
the net repricing benefit of higher interest rates;
runoff of lower yielding assets and other favorable mix; and
higher variable income;
partially offset by:
lower loan swap income due to unwinding the receive-fixed loan swap portfolio;
lower tax-equivalent net interest income from updated tax-equivalent factors reflecting new tax law;
higher premium amortization; and
unfavorable hedge ineffectiveness accounting results.

 
The slight increase in net interest margin in 2017 , compared with 2016 , was due to the repricing benefits of earning assets from higher interest rates exceeding the repricing costs of deposits and market based funding sources.
Table 4 presents the components of earning assets and funding sources as a percentage of earning assets to provide a more meaningful analysis of year-over-year changes that influenced net interest income.
Average earning assets decreased $38.1 billion in 2018 compared with 2017 . The decrease was driven by:
average loans decreased $10.9 billion in 2018 ;
average interest-earning deposits decreased $45.5 billion in 2018 ;
partially offset by:
average federal funds sold and securities purchased under resale agreements increased $3.9 billion in 2018 ;
average debt securities increased $13.8 billion in 2018 ; and
average equity securities increased $2.0 billion in 2018 .

Deposits are an important low-cost source of funding and affect both net interest income and the net interest margin. Deposits include noninterest-bearing deposits, interest-bearing checking, market rate and other savings, savings certificates, other time deposits, and deposits in foreign offices. Average deposits decreased to $1.28 trillion in 2018 , compared with $1.30 trillion in 2017 , and represented 135% of average loans in 2018, compared with 136% in 2017. Average deposits were 73% of average earning assets in both 2018 and 2017 .
Table 5 presents the individual components of net interest income and the net interest margin. The effect on interest income and costs of earning asset and funding mix changes described above, combined with rate changes during 2018 , are analyzed in Table 6 .

50
Wells Fargo & Company
 


Table 4: Average Earning Assets and Funding Sources as a Percentage of Average Earning Assets
 
Year ended December 31,
 
 
2018
 
 
2017
 
(in millions)
Average
balance

 
% of earning assets

 
Average
balance

 
% of earning
assets

Earning assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest-earning deposits with banks
$
156,366

 
9
%
 
$
201,864

 
12
%
Federal funds sold, securities purchased under resale agreements
78,547

 
5

 
74,697

 
4

Debt securities:
 
 


 
 
 


Trading debt securities
83,526

 
5

 
74,475

 
4

Available-for-sale debt securities:
 
 


 
 
 


Securities of U.S. Treasury and federal agencies
6,618

 

 
15,966

 
1

Securities of U.S. states and political subdivisions
47,884

 
3

 
52,658

 
3

Mortgage-backed securities:
 
 


 
 
 


Federal agencies
156,052

 
9

 
145,310

 
8

Residential and commercial
7,769

 

 
11,839

 
1

Total mortgage-backed securities
163,821

 
9

 
157,149

 
9

Other debt securities
46,875

 
3

 
48,714

 
3

Total available-for-sale debt securities
265,198

 
15

 
274,487

 
16

Held-to-maturity debt securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities of U.S. Treasury and federal agencies
44,735

 
3

 
44,705

 
3

Securities of U.S. states and political subdivisions
6,253

 

 
6,268

 

Federal agency mortgage-backed securities
94,216

 
5

 
78,330

 
4

Other debt securities
361

 

 
2,194

 

Held-to-maturity debt securities
145,565

 
8

 
131,497

 
7

Total debt securities
494,289

 
28

 
480,459

 
27

Mortgage loans held for sale (1)
18,394

 
1

 
20,780

 
1

Loans held for sale (1)
2,526

 

 
1,487

 

Commercial loans:
 
 


 
 
 


Commercial and industrial – U.S.
275,656

 
16

 
272,034

 
16

Commercial and industrial – Non-U.S.
60,718

 
4

 
57,198

 
3

Real estate mortgage
122,947

 
7

 
129,990

 
7

Real estate construction
23,609

 
1

 
24,813

 
1

Lease financing
19,392

 
1

 
19,128

 
1

Total commercial loans
502,322

 
29

 
503,163

 
28

Consumer loans:
 
 


 
 
 


Real estate 1-4 family first mortgage
284,178

 
16

 
277,751

 
16

Real estate 1-4 family junior lien mortgage
36,687

 
2

 
42,780

 
3

Credit card
36,780

 
2

 
35,600

 
2

Automobile
48,115

 
3

 
57,900

 
3

Other revolving credit and installment
37,115

 
2

 
38,935

 
2

Total consumer loans
442,875

 
25

 
452,966

 
26

Total loans (1)
945,197

 
54

 
956,129

 
54

Equity securities
38,092

 
2

 
36,105

 
2

Other
5,071

 
1

 
5,069

 

Total earning assets
$
1,738,482

 
100
%
 
$
1,776,590

 
100
%
Funding sources
 
 


 
 
 


Deposits:
 
 


 
 
 


Interest-bearing checking
$
63,243

 
4
%
 
$
49,474

 
3
%
Market rate and other savings
684,882

 
39

 
682,053

 
39

Savings certificates
20,653

 
1

 
22,190

 
1

Other time deposits
84,822

 
5

 
61,625

 
3

Deposits in foreign offices
63,945

 
4

 
123,816

 
7

Total interest-bearing deposits
917,545

 
53

 
939,158

 
53

Short-term borrowings
104,267

 
6

 
98,922

 
6

Long-term debt
224,268

 
13

 
246,195

 
14

Other liabilities
27,648

 
1

 
21,872

 
1

Total interest-bearing liabilities
1,273,728

 
73

 
1,306,147

 
74

Portion of noninterest-bearing funding sources
464,754

 
27

 
470,443

 
26

Total funding sources
$
1,738,482

 
100
%
 
$
1,776,590

 
100
%
Noninterest-earning assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Cash and due from banks
$
18,777

 
 
 
18,622

 
 
Goodwill
26,453

 
 
 
26,629

 
 
Other
105,180

 
 
 
111,164

 
 
Total noninterest-earning assets
$
150,410

 
 
 
156,415

 
 
Noninterest-bearing funding sources
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Deposits
$
358,312

 
 
 
365,464

 
 
Other liabilities
53,496

 
 
 
55,740

 
 
Total equity
203,356

 
 
 
205,654

 
 
Noninterest-bearing funding sources used to fund earning assets
(464,754
)
 
 
 
(470,443
)
 
 
Net noninterest-bearing funding sources
$
150,410

 
 
 
156,415

 
 
Total assets
$
1,888,892

 
 
 
1,933,005

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(1)
Nonaccrual loans are included in their respective loan categories.

 
Wells Fargo & Company
51


Earnings Performance (continued)

Table 5: Average Balances, Yields and Rates Paid (Taxable-Equivalent Basis) (1)(2)
 
 
 
 
 
2018

 
 
 
 
 
2017

(in millions) 
Average 
balance 

 
Yields/ 
rates 

 
Interest 
income/ 
expense 

 
Average 
balance 

 
Yields/ 
rates 

 
Interest 
income/ 
expense 

Earning assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest-earning deposits with banks (3)
$
156,366

 
1.82
%
 
$
2,854

 
201,864

 
1.07
%
 
$
2,162

Federal funds sold and securities purchased under resale agreements (3)
78,547

 
1.82

 
1,431

 
74,697

 
0.98

 
735

Debt securities (4):
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Trading debt securities
83,526

 
3.42

 
2,856

 
74,475

 
3.16

 
2,356

Available-for-sale debt securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities of U.S. Treasury and federal agencies
6,618

 
1.70

 
112

 
15,966

 
1.49

 
239

Securities of U.S. states and political subdivisions
47,884

 
3.77

 
1,806

 
52,658

 
3.95

 
2,082

Mortgage-backed securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Federal agencies
156,052

 
2.79

 
4,348

 
145,310

 
2.60

 
3,782

Residential and commercial
7,769

 
4.62

 
358

 
11,839

 
5.33

 
631

Total mortgage-backed securities
163,821

 
2.87

 
4,706

 
157,149

 
2.81

 
4,413

Other debt securities
46,875

 
4.22

 
1,980

 
48,714

 
3.68

 
1,794

Total available-for-sale debt securities
265,198

 
3.24

 
8,604

 
274,487

 
3.11

 
8,528

Held-to-maturity debt securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities of U.S. Treasury and federal agencies
44,735

 
2.19

 
980

 
44,705

 
2.19

 
979

Securities of U.S. states and political subdivisions
6,253

 
4.34

 
271

 
6,268

 
5.32

 
334

Federal agency and other mortgage-backed securities
94,216

 
2.36

 
2,221

 
78,330

 
2.34

 
1,832

Other debt securities
361

 
4.00

 
15

 
2,194

 
2.50

 
55

Held-to-maturity debt securities
145,565

 
2.40

 
3,487

 
131,497

 
2.43

 
3,200

Total debt securities
494,289

 
3.02

 
14,947

 
480,459

 
2.93

 
14,084

Mortgage loans held for sale (5)
18,394

 
4.22

 
777

 
20,780

 
3.78

 
786

Loans held for sale (5)
2,526

 
5.56

 
140

 
1,487

 
3.40

 
50

Commercial:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial – U.S.
275,656

 
4.16

 
11,465

 
272,034

 
3.75

 
10,196

Commercial and industrial – Non-U.S.
60,718

 
3.53

 
2,143

 
57,198

 
2.86

 
1,639

Real estate mortgage
122,947

 
4.29

 
5,279

 
129,990

 
3.74

 
4,859

Real estate construction
23,609

 
4.94

 
1,167

 
24,813

 
4.10

 
1,017

Lease financing
19,392

 
4.74

 
919

 
19,128

 
3.74

 
715

Total commercial loans
502,322

 
4.18

 
20,973

 
503,163

 
3.66

 
18,426

Consumer:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Real estate 1-4 family first mortgage
284,178

 
4.04

 
11,481

 
277,751

 
4.03

 
11,206

Real estate 1-4 family junior lien mortgage
36,687

 
5.38

 
1,975

 
42,780

 
4.82

 
2,062

Credit card
36,780

 
12.72

 
4,678

 
35,600

 
12.23

 
4,355

Automobile
48,115

 
5.18

 
2,491

 
57,900

 
5.34

 
3,094

Other revolving credit and installment
37,115

 
6.70

 
2,488

 
38,935

 
6.18

 
2,408

Total consumer loans
442,875

 
5.22

 
23,113

 
452,966

 
5.11

 
23,125

Total loans (5)
945,197

 
4.66

 
44,086

 
956,129

 
4.35

 
41,551

Equity securities
38,092

 
2.62

 
999

 
36,105

 
2.27

 
821

Other
5,071

 
1.46

 
74

 
5,069

 
0.85

 
44

Total earning assets
$
1,738,482

 
3.76
%
 
$
65,308

 
1,776,590

 
3.40
%
 
$
60,233

Funding sources
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Deposits:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest-bearing checking
$
63,243

 
0.96
%
 
$
606

 
49,474

 
0.49
%
 
$
242

Market rate and other savings
684,882

 
0.31

 
2,157

 
682,053

 
0.14

 
983

Savings certificates
20,653

 
0.57

 
118

 
22,190

 
0.30

 
67

Other time deposits
84,822

 
2.25

 
1,906

 
61,625

 
1.43

 
880

Deposits in foreign offices
63,945

 
1.30

 
835

 
123,816

 
0.68

 
841

Total interest-bearing deposits
917,545

 
0.61

 
5,622

 
939,158

 
0.32

 
3,013

Short-term borrowings
104,267

 
1.65

 
1,719

 
98,922

 
0.77

 
761

Long-term debt
224,268

 
2.99

 
6,703

 
246,195

 
2.09

 
5,157

Other liabilities
27,648

 
2.21

 
610

 
21,872

 
1.94

 
424

Total interest-bearing liabilities
1,273,728

 
1.15

 
14,654

 
1,306,147

 
0.72

 
9,355

Portion of noninterest-bearing funding sources
464,754

 

 

 
470,443

 

 

Total funding sources
$
1,738,482

 
0.85

 
14,654

 
1,776,590

 
0.53

 
9,355

Net interest margin and net interest income on a taxable-equivalent basis   (6)
 
 
2.91
%
 
$
50,654

 
 
 
2.87
%
 
$
50,878

Noninterest-earning assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Cash and due from banks
$
18,777

 
 
 
 
 
18,622

 
 
 
 
Goodwill
26,453

 
 
 
 
 
26,629

 
 
 
 
Other
105,180

 
 
 
 
 
111,164

 
 
 
 
Total noninterest-earning assets
$
150,410

 
 
 
 
 
156,415

 
 
 
 
Noninterest-bearing funding sources
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Deposits
$
358,312

 
 
 
 
 
365,464

 
 
 
 
Other liabilities
53,496

 
 
 
 
 
55,740

 
 
 
 
Total equity
203,356

 
 
 
 
 
205,654

 
 
 
 
Noninterest-bearing funding sources used to fund earning assets
(464,754
)
 
 
 
 
 
(470,443
)
 
 
 
 
Net noninterest-bearing funding sources
$
150,410

 
 
 
 
 
156,415

 
 
 
 
Total assets
$
1,888,892

 
 
 
 
 
1,933,005

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(1)
Our average prime rate was 4.91% for the year ended December 31, 2018 , 4.10% for the year ended December 31, 2017 , 3.51% for the year ended December 31, 2016 , and 3.26% for the year ended December 31, 2015 , and 3.25% for the year ended December 31, 2014 . The average three-month London Interbank Offered Rate (LIBOR) was 2.31% , 1.26% , 0.74% , 0.32% , and 0.23% for the same years, respectively.
(2)
Yield/rates and amounts include the effects of hedge and risk management activities associated with the respective asset and liability categories.
(3)
Financial information for the prior periods has been revised to reflect the impact of our adoption of Accounting Standards Update (ASU) 2016-18 Statement of Cash Flows (Topic 230): Restricted Cash in which we changed the presentation of our cash and cash equivalents to include both cash and due from banks as well as interest-earning deposits with banks, which are inclusive of any restricted cash.


52
Wells Fargo & Company
 



 
 
 
 
2016

 
 
 
 
 
2015

 
 
 
 
 
2014

Average 
balance 

 
Yields/ 
rates 

 
Interest 
income/ 
expense 

 
Average 
balance 

 
Yields/ 
rates 

 
Interest 
income/ 
expense 

 
Average 
balance 

 
Yields/ 
rates 

 
Interest 
income/ 
expense 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$
225,955

 
0.51
%
 
$
1,161

 
222,773

 
0.27
%
 
$
605

 
209,686

 
0.26
%
 
$
554

61,763

 
0.48

 
296

 
44,059

 
0.30

 
133

 
31,596

 
0.38

 
119

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
70,195

 
2.97

 
2,082

 
51,551

 
3.16

 
1,627

 
43,108

 
3.23

 
1,392

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
29,418

 
1.56

 
457

 
32,093

 
1.58

 
505

 
10,400

 
1.64

 
171

52,959

 
4.20

 
2,225

 
47,404

 
4.23

 
2,007

 
43,138

 
4.29

 
1,852

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
110,637

 
2.50

 
2,764

 
100,218

 
2.73

 
2,733

 
114,076

 
2.84

 
3,235

18,725

 
5.49

 
1,029

 
22,490

 
5.73

 
1,289

 
26,475

 
6.03

 
1,597

129,362

 
2.93

 
3,793

 
122,708

 
3.28

 
4,022

 
140,551

 
3.44

 
4,832

52,731

 
3.36

 
1,771

 
48,515

 
3.32

 
1,609

 
45,759

 
3.57

 
1,635

264,470

 
3.12

 
8,246

 
250,720

 
3.25

 
8,143

 
239,848

 
3.54

 
8,490

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
44,675

 
2.19

 
979

 
44,173

 
2.19

 
968

 
17,239

 
2.23

 
385

2,893

 
5.32

 
154

 
2,087

 
5.40

 
113

 
246

 
4.93

 
12

39,330

 
2.00

 
786

 
21,967

 
2.23

 
489

 
5,921

 
2.55

 
151

4,043

 
2.01

 
81

 
5,821

 
1.73

 
101

 
5,913

 
1.85

 
109

90,941

 
2.20

 
2,000

 
74,048

 
2.26

 
1,671

 
29,319

 
2.24

 
657

425,606

 
2.90

 
12,328

 
376,319

 
3.04

 
11,441

 
312,275

 
3.37

 
10,539

22,412

 
3.50

 
784

 
21,603

 
3.63

 
785

 
19,018

 
4.03

 
767

1,361

 
2.76

 
38

 
1,651

 
2.59

 
43

 
5,585

 
2.02

 
113

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
268,182

 
3.45

 
9,243

 
237,844

 
3.29

 
7,836

 
204,819

 
3.35

 
6,869

51,601

 
2.36

 
1,219

 
46,028

 
1.90

 
877

 
42,661

 
2.03

 
867

127,232

 
3.44

 
4,371

 
116,893

 
3.41

 
3,984

 
112,710

 
3.64

 
4,100

23,197

 
3.55

 
824

 
20,979

 
3.57

 
749

 
17,676

 
4.21

 
744

17,950

 
5.10

 
916

 
12,301

 
4.70

 
577

 
12,257

 
5.63

 
690

488,162

 
3.39

 
16,573

 
434,045

 
3.23

 
14,023

 
390,123

 
3.40

 
13,270

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
276,712

 
4.01

 
11,096

 
268,560

 
4.10

 
11,002

 
261,620

 
4.19

 
10,961

49,735

 
4.39

 
2,183

 
56,242

 
4.25

 
2,391

 
62,510

 
4.30

 
2,686

34,178

 
11.62

 
3,970

 
31,307

 
11.70

 
3,664

 
27,491

 
11.98

 
3,294

61,566

 
5.62

 
3,458

 
57,766

 
5.84

 
3,374

 
53,854

 
6.27

 
3,377

39,607

 
5.93

 
2,350

 
37,512

 
5.89

 
2,209

 
38,834

 
5.48

 
2,127

461,798

 
4.99

 
23,057

 
451,387

 
5.02

 
22,640

 
444,309

 
5.05

 
22,445

949,960

 
4.17

 
39,630

 
885,432

 
4.14

 
36,663

 
834,432

 
4.28

 
35,715

27,417

 
2.44

 
669

 
23,921

 
2.94

 
703

 
21,125

 
3.08

 
650


 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

$
1,714,474

 
3.21
%
 
$
54,906

 
1,575,758

 
3.20
%
 
$
50,373

 
1,433,717

 
3.39
%
 
$
48,457

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$
42,379

 
0.14
%
 
$
60

 
38,640

 
0.05
%
 
$
20

 
39,729

 
0.07
%
 
$
26

663,557

 
0.07

 
449

 
625,549

 
0.06

 
367

 
585,854

 
0.07

 
403

25,912

 
0.35

 
91

 
31,887

 
0.63

 
201

 
38,111

 
0.85

 
323

55,846

 
0.91

 
508

 
51,790

 
0.45

 
232

 
51,434

 
0.40

 
207

103,206

 
0.28

 
287

 
107,138

 
0.13

 
143

 
95,889

 
0.14

 
137

890,900

 
0.16

 
1,395

 
855,004

 
0.11

 
963

 
811,017

 
0.14

 
1,096

115,187

 
0.29

 
333

 
87,465

 
0.07

 
64

 
60,111

 
0.10

 
62

239,471

 
1.60

 
3,830

 
185,078

 
1.40

 
2,592

 
167,420

 
1.49

 
2,488

16,702

 
2.12

 
354

 
16,545

 
2.15

 
357

 
14,401

 
2.65

 
382

1,262,260

 
0.47

 
5,912

 
1,144,092

 
0.35

 
3,976

 
1,052,949

 
0.38

 
4,028

452,214

 

 

 
431,666

 

 

 
380,768

 

 

$
1,714,474

 
0.35

 
5,912

 
1,575,758

 
0.25

 
3,976

 
1,433,717

 
0.28

 
4,028

 
 
2.86
%
 
$
48,994

 
 
 
2.95
%
 
$
46,397

 
 
 
3.11
%
 
$
44,429

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$
18,617

 
 
 
 
 
17,327

 
 
 
 
 
16,361

 
 
 
 
26,700

 
 
 
 
 
25,673

 
 
 
 
 
25,687

 
 
 
 
125,650

 
 
 
 
 
124,161

 
 
 
 
 
117,584

 
 
 
 
$
170,967

 
 
 
 
 
167,161

 
 
 
 
 
159,632

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$
359,666

 
 
 
 
 
339,069

 
 
 
 
 
303,127

 
 
 
 
62,825

 
 
 
 
 
68,174

 
 
 
 
 
56,985

 
 
 
 
200,690

 
 
 
 
 
191,584

 
 
 
 
 
180,288

 
 
 
 
(452,214
)
 
 
 
 
 
(431,666
)
 
 
 
 
 
(380,768
)
 
 
 
 
$
170,967

 
 
 
 
 
167,161

 
 
 
 
 
159,632

 
 
 
 
$
1,885,441

 
 
 
 
 
1,742,919

 
 
 
 
 
1,593,349

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(4)
Yields and rates are based on interest income/expense amounts for the period. The average balance amounts represent amortized cost for the periods presented.
(5)
Nonaccrual loans and related income are included in their respective loan categories.
(6)
Includes taxable-equivalent adjustments of $659 million , $1.3 billion , $1.2 billion , $1.1 billion and $902 million for the years ended December 31, 2018 , 2017 , 2016 , 2015 and 2014 , respectively, predominantly related to tax-exempt income on certain loans and securities. The federal statutory tax rate utilized was 21% for the period ended December 31, 2018 , and 35% for the periods ended December 31, 2017 , 2016 , 2015 and 2014 .

 
Wells Fargo & Company
53


Earnings Performance (continued)

Table 6 allocates the changes in net interest income on a taxable-equivalent basis to changes in either average balances or average rates for both interest-earning assets and interest-bearing liabilities. Because of the numerous simultaneous volume and rate changes during any period, it is not possible to precisely allocate such changes between volume and rate. For
 
this table, changes that are not solely due to either volume or rate are allocated to these categories on a pro-rata basis based on the absolute value of the change due to average volume and average rate.

Table 6: Analysis of Changes in Net Interest Income
 
Year ended December 31, 
 
 
2018 over 2017
 
 
2017 over 2016
 
(in millions)
Volume 

 
Rate 

 
Total 

 
Volume

 
Rate

 
Total

Increase (decrease) in interest income:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest-earning deposits with banks (1)
$
(569
)
 
1,261

 
692

 
(135
)
 
1,136

 
1,001

Federal funds sold and securities purchased under resale agreements (1)
40

 
656

 
696

 
73

 
366

 
439

Debt securities:
 
 
 
 

 
 
 
 
 

Trading debt securities
298

 
202

 
500

 
134

 
140

 
274

Available-for-sale debt securities:
 
 
 
 

 
 
 
 
 

Securities of U.S. Treasury and federal agencies
(157
)
 
30

 
(127
)
 
(198
)
 
(20
)
 
(218
)
Securities of U.S. states and political subdivisions
(184
)
 
(92
)
 
(276
)
 
(13
)
 
(130
)
 
(143
)
Mortgage-backed securities:
 
 
 
 

 
 
 
 
 

Federal agencies
285

 
281

 
566

 
902

 
116

 
1,018

Residential and commercial
(197
)
 
(76
)
 
(273
)
 
(369
)
 
(29
)
 
(398
)
Total mortgage-backed securities
88

 
205

 
293

 
533

 
87

 
620

     Other debt securities
(70
)
 
256

 
186

 
(140
)
 
163

 
23

Total available-for-sale debt securities
(323
)
 
399

 
76

 
182

 
100

 
282

Held-to-maturity debt securities:
 
 
 
 


 
 
 
 
 


Securities of U.S. Treasury and federal agencies
1

 

 
1

 

 

 

Securities of U.S. states and political subdivisions
(1
)
 
(62
)
 
(63
)
 
180

 

 
180

Federal agency mortgage-backed securities
373

 
16

 
389

 
893

 
153

 
1,046

Other debt securities
(62
)
 
22

 
(40
)
 
(43
)
 
17

 
(26
)
  Total held-to-maturity debt securities
311

 
(24
)
 
287

 
1,030

 
170

 
1,200

Mortgage loans held for sale
(95
)
 
86

 
(9
)
 
(59
)
 
61

 
2

Loans held for sale
47

 
43

 
90

 
3

 
9

 
12

Commercial loans:
 
 
 
 

 
 
 
 
 

Commercial and industrial – U.S.
138

 
1,131

 
1,269

 
135

 
818

 
953

Commercial and industrial – Non-U.S.
105

 
399

 
504

 
142

 
278

 
420

Real estate mortgage
(272
)
 
692

 
420

 
97

 
391

 
488

Real estate construction
(51
)
 
201

 
150

 
59

 
134

 
193

Lease financing
10

 
194

 
204

 
57

 
(258
)
 
(201
)
Total commercial loans
(70
)
 
2,617

 
2,547

 
490

 
1,363

 
1,853

Consumer loans:
 
 
 
 

 
 
 
 
 

Real estate 1-4 family first mortgage
248

 
27

 
275

 
48

 
62

 
110

Real estate 1-4 family junior lien mortgage
(312
)
 
225

 
(87
)
 
(323
)
 
202

 
(121
)
Credit card
146

 
177

 
323

 
170

 
215

 
385

Automobile
(512
)
 
(91
)
 
(603
)
 
(198
)
 
(166
)
 
(364
)
Other revolving credit and installment
(116
)
 
196

 
80

 
(40
)
 
98

 
58

Total consumer loans
(546
)
 
534

 
(12
)
 
(343
)
 
411

 
68

Total loans
(616
)
 
3,151

 
2,535

 
147

 
1,774

 
1,921

Equity securities
47

 
131

 
178

 
201

 
(49
)
 
152

Other

 
30

 
30

 
44

 

 
44

Total increase in interest income (1)
(860
)
 
5,935

 
5,075

 
1,620

 
3,707

 
5,327

Increase (decrease) in interest expense:
 
 
 
 

 
 
 
 
 

Deposits:
 
 
 
 

 
 
 
 
 

Interest-bearing checking
82

 
282

 
364

 
11

 
171

 
182

Market rate and other savings
4

 
1,170

 
1,174

 
14

 
520

 
534

Savings certificates
(5
)
 
56

 
51

 
(12
)
 
(12
)
 
(24
)
Other time deposits
407

 
619

 
1,026

 
57

 
315

 
372

Deposits in foreign offices
(534
)
 
528

 
(6
)
 
68

 
486

 
554

Total interest-bearing deposits
(46
)
 
2,655

 
2,609

 
138

 
1,480

 
1,618

Short-term borrowings
43

 
915

 
958

 
(53
)
 
481

 
428

Long-term debt
(495
)
 
2,041

 
1,546

 
111

 
1,216

 
1,327

Other liabilities
122

 
64

 
186

 
102

 
(32
)
 
70

         Total increase in interest expense
(376
)
 
5,675

 
5,299

 
298

 
3,145

 
3,443

Increase (decrease) in net interest income on a taxable-equivalent basis
$
(484
)
 
260

 
(224
)
 
1,322

 
562

 
1,884

(1)
Financial information has been revised to reflect the impact of our adoption in first quarter 2018 of ASU 2016-18 Statement of Cash Flows (Topic 230): Restricted Cash in which we changed the presentation of our cash and cash equivalents to include both cash and due from banks as well as interest-earning deposits with banks, which are inclusive of any restricted cash. See Note 1 (Summary of Significant Accounting Policies) to Financial Statements in this Report for more information.



54
Wells Fargo & Company
 


Noninterest Income

Table 7: Noninterest Income
 
Year ended December 31, 
 
(in millions)
2018

 
2017

 
2016

Service charges on deposit accounts
$
4,716

 
5,111

 
5,372

Trust and investment fees:
 
 

 
 
Brokerage advisory, commissions and other fees
9,436

 
9,358

 
9,216

Trust and investment management
3,316

 
3,372

 
3,336

Investment banking
1,757

 
1,765

 
1,691

Total trust and investment fees
14,509

 
14,495

 
14,243

Card fees
3,907

 
3,960

 
3,936

Other fees:
 
 
 
 
 
Lending related charges and fees (1)
1,526

 
1,568

 
1,562

Cash network fees
481

 
506

 
537

Commercial real estate
brokerage commissions
468

 
462

 
494

Wire transfer and other remittance fees
477

 
448

 
401

All other fees (2)
432

 
573

 
733

Total other fees
3,384

 
3,557

 
3,727

Mortgage banking:
 
 
 
 
 
Servicing income, net
1,373

 
1,427

 
1,765

Net gains on mortgage loan
origination/sales activities
1,644

 
2,923

 
4,331

Total mortgage banking
3,017

 
4,350

 
6,096

Insurance
429

 
1,049

 
1,268

Net gains from trading activities
602

 
542

 
610

Net gains on debt securities
108

 
479

 
942

Net gains from equity securities
1,515

 
1,779

 
1,103

Lease income
1,753

 
1,907

 
1,927

Life insurance investment income
651

 
594

 
587

All other
1,822

 
1,009

 
702

Total
$
36,413

 
38,832

 
40,513

(1)
Represents combined amount of previously reported “Charges and fees on loans” and “Letters of credit fees”.
(2)
All other fees have been revised to include merchant processing fees for the year ended 2016.
Noninterest income of $ 36.4 billion represented 42% of revenue for 2018 , compared with $38.8 billion , or 44% , for 2017 and $40.5 billion , or 46% , for 2016 . The decline in noninterest income in 2018 compared with 2017 was predominantly due to lower mortgage banking income, lower insurance income due to the sale of Wells Fargo Insurance Services in fourth quarter 2017, lower service charges on deposit accounts, lower gains on debt securities, and lower deferred compensation plan investment results (offset in employee benefits expense). These decreases were partially offset by higher gains from equity securities and higher all other income. The decline in noninterest income in 2017 compared with 2016 was predominantly driven by lower mortgage banking, impairments on low income housing credits and tax-advantaged renewable energy investments as a result of the Tax Act, and lower service charges on deposit accounts. These decreases in noninterest income were partially offset by growth in trust and investment fees, deferred compensation plan investment results (offset in employee benefits expense), and the net impact of our insurance services business divestiture in November 2017 and gains from the sale of Pick-a-Pay PCI loans. For more information on our performance obligations and the nature of services performed for certain of our revenues discussed below, see Note 21 (Revenue from Contracts with Customers) to Financial Statements in this Report.
Service charges on deposit accounts were $4.7 billion in 2018 , down from $5.1 billion in 2017 due to lower overdraft and monthly service fees driven by customer-friendly initiatives that help customers minimize monthly service charges and overdraft fees, and the impact of a higher earnings credit rate applied to
 
commercial accounts due to increased interest rates. Service charges on deposit accounts decreased $261 million in 2017 from 2016 due to lower consumer and business checking account service charges, lower overdraft fees driven by customer-friendly initiatives including the Overdraft Rewind launched in November 2017, and a higher earnings credit rate applied to commercial accounts due to increased interest rates.
Brokerage advisory, commissions and other fees increased to $ 9.44 billion in 2018 , from $9.36 billion in 2017 , which increased $142 million from 2016 . The increase in these fees in both 2018 and 2017 was due to higher asset-based fees, partially offset by lower transactional commission revenue. Retail brokerage client assets totaled $1.49 trillion at December 31, 2018 , compared with $1.65 trillion and $1.49 trillion at December 31, 2017 and 2016 , respectively. All retail brokerage services are provided by our WIM operating segment. For additional information on retail brokerage client assets, see the discussion and Tables 9d and 9e in the “Operating Segment Results – Wealth and Investment Management – Retail Brokerage Client Assets” section in this Report.
Trust and investment management fee income is largely from client assets under management (AUM), for which fees are based on a tiered scale relative to market value of the assets, and client assets under administration (AUA), for which fees are generally based on the extent of services to administer the assets.
Trust and investment management fees of $ 3.3 billion in 2018 declined slightly from 2017 as a decrease in corporate trust fees due to the sale of Wells Fargo Shareowner Services in first quarter 2018 was only partially offset by growth in management fees for investment advice on mutual funds. Trust and investment management fees of $ 3.4 billion in 2017 were relatively stable compared with 2016 . Our AUM totaled $638.3 billion at December 31, 2018 , compared with $690.3 billion and $652.2 billion at December 31, 2017 and 2016 , respectively, with substantially all of our AUM managed by our WIM operating segment. Additional information regarding our WIM operating segment AUM is provided in Table 9f and the related discussion in the “Operating Segment Results – Wealth and Investment Management – Trust and Investment Client Assets Under Management” section in this Report. Our AUA totaled $1.7 trillion at both December 31, 2018 and 2017 , compared with $1.6 trillion at December 31, 2016 .
Investment banking fees of $ 1.8 billion in 2018 were relatively stable compared with 2017 . Investment banking fees in 2017 increased $74 million compared with 2016 due to higher equity and debt originations, partially offset by lower advisory fees.
Card fees were $3.9 billion in 2018 , compared with $4.0 billion  in 2017 and $3.9 billion in 2016 . The decrease in 2018 reflected the impact of the new revenue recognition accounting standard, which reduced noninterest expense and lowered card fees in 2018 by an equal amount due to the netting of card payment network charges against related interchange and network revenues in card fees. This decrease in card fees in 2018 was partially offset by higher interchange fees. Card fees increased in 2017 , compared with 2016 , predominantly due to increased purchase activity.
Other fees were $3.4 billion in 2018 , compared with $3.6 billion in 2017 and $3.7 billion in 2016 . Other fees declined in both 2018 and 2017 predominantly due to lower all other fees. All other fees were $432 million in 2018 , compared with $573 million in 2017 and $733 million in 2016 . The decrease in 2018 compared with 2017 was driven by lost fees from discontinued products. The decrease in all other fees in 2017 compared with 2016 was driven by lower fees from discontinued

 
Wells Fargo & Company
55


Earnings Performance (continued)

products and the impact of the sale of our global fund services business in fourth quarter 2016.
Mortgage banking income, consisting of net servicing income and net gains on loan origination/sales activities, totaled $3.0 billion in 2018 , compared with $4.4 billion in 2017 and $6.1 billion in 2016 . As further discussed below, the decrease in mortgage banking income in both 2018 and 2017 was primarily driven by overall reductions in the size of the residential mortgage market as well as declines in production margins.    
In addition to servicing fees, net servicing income includes amortization of commercial mortgage servicing rights (MSRs), changes in the fair value of residential MSRs during the period, as well as changes in the value of derivatives (economic hedges) used to hedge the residential MSRs during the period. Net servicing income of $1.4 billion for 2018 included a $112 million net MSR valuation loss ( $960 million increase in the fair value of the MSRs and a $1.1 billion hedge loss). Net servicing income of $1.4 billion for 2017 included a $287 million net MSR valuation gain ( $126 million decrease in the fair value of the MSRs and a $413 million hedge gain), and net servicing income of $1.8 billion for 2016 included a $826 million net MSR valuation gain ( $565 million increase in the fair value of MSRs and a $261 million hedge gain). The decline in net MSR valuation results in 2018 , compared with 2017 , was predominantly due to negative MSR valuation adjustments in fourth quarter 2018 for servicing and foreclosure costs, discount rates and prepayment estimates recognized as a result of recent market observations related to an acceleration of prepayments, including for Department of Veterans Affairs (VA) loans. The decrease in net MSR valuation gains in 2017 , compared with 2016 , was largely due to lower hedge gains in 2017 and MSR valuation adjustments in first quarter 2016 that reflected a reduction in forecasted prepayments due to updated economic, customer data attributes and mortgage market rate inputs. Net servicing income in 2018 was also favorably impacted by lower unreimbursed servicing and foreclosure costs as we continued to reduce our inventory of aged FHA loans in foreclosure.
Our portfolio of loans serviced for others was $1.71 trillion at December 31, 2018 , $1.70 trillion at December 31, 2017 , and $1.68 trillion at December 31, 2016 . At December 31, 2018 , the ratio of combined residential and commercial MSRs to related loans serviced for others was 0.94% , compared with 0.88% at December 31, 2017 , and 0.85% at December 31, 2016 . See the “Risk Management – Asset/Liability Management – Mortgage Banking Interest Rate and Market Risk” section in this Report for additional information regarding our MSRs risks and hedging approach.
Net gains on mortgage loan origination/sales activities was $1.6 billion in 2018 , compared with $2.9 billion in 2017 and $4.3 billion in 2016 . The decrease in both 2018 and 2017 was driven by decreased origination volumes and margins.
Mortgage loan originations were $ 177 billion in 2018 , compared with $212 billion in 2017 and $249 billion in 2016 . The production margin on residential held-for-sale mortgage loan originations, which represents net gains on residential mortgage loan origination/sales activities divided by total residential held-for-sale mortgage loan originations, provides a measure of the profitability of our residential mortgage origination activity. Table 7a presents the information used in determining the production margin.
 
Table 7a: Selected Mortgage Production Data
 
 
Year ended December 31, 
 
 
 
2018

2017

2016

Net gains on mortgage loan origination/sales activities (in millions):
 
 
 
 
Residential
(A)
$
1,174

2,140

3,168

Commercial
 
265

358

400

Residential pipeline and unsold/repurchased loan management (1)
 
205

425

763

Total
 
$
1,644

2,923

4,331

Residential real estate originations (in billions):
 
 
 
 
Held-for-sale
(B)
$
132

160

186

Held-for-investment
 
45

52

63

Total
 
$
177

212

249

Production margin on residential held-for-sale mortgage originations
(A)/(B)
0.89
%
1.34

1.71

(1)
Predominantly includes the results of Government National Mortgage Association (GNMA) loss mitigation activities, interest rate management activities and changes in estimate to the liability for mortgage loan repurchase losses.
The production margin was 0.89% for 2018 , compared with 1.34% for 2017 and 1.71% for 2016 . The decline in the production margin in 2018 was due to lower margins in both retail and correspondent production channels and a shift to more correspondent origination volume, which has a lower production margin. The decrease in the production margin in 2017 was due to a shift in origination channel mix from retail to correspondent.
Mortgage applications were $230 billion in 2018 , compared with $278 billion in 2017 and $347 billion in 2016 . The 1-4 family first mortgage unclosed pipeline was $ 18 billion at December 31, 2018 , compared with $23 billion at December 31, 2017 , and $30 billion at December 31, 2016 . For additional information about our mortgage banking activities and results, see the “Risk Management – Asset/Liability Management – Mortgage Banking Interest Rate and Market Risk” section and Note 10 (Mortgage Banking Activities) and Note 18 (Fair Values of Assets and Liabilities) to Financial Statements in this Report.
Net gains on mortgage loan origination/sales activities include adjustments to the mortgage repurchase liability. Mortgage loans are repurchased from third parties based on standard representations and warranties, and early payment default clauses in mortgage sale contracts.

56
Wells Fargo & Company
 


Insurance income was $429 million in 2018 compared with $1.0 billion in 2017 and $1.3 billion in 2016 . The decrease in both 2018 and 2017 was driven by the sale of Wells Fargo Insurance Services in fourth quarter 2017. The decrease in 2017 was also driven by the divestiture of our crop insurance business in first quarter 2016.
Net gains from trading activities, which reflect unrealized changes in fair value of our trading positions and realized gains and losses, were $602 million in 2018 , compared with $542 million in 2017 and $610 million in 2016 . The increase in 2018 was due to growth in equity trading driven by market volatility, partially offset by lower foreign exchange trading income. The decrease in 2017 , compared with 2016 , was driven by lower customer accommodation trading activity. Net gains from trading activities do not include interest and dividend income and expense on trading securities. Those amounts are reported within interest income from trading assets and other interest expense from trading liabilities. For additional information about trading activities, see the “Risk Management – Asset/Liability Management – Market Risk – Trading Activities” section and Note 4 (Trading Activities) to Financial Statements in this Report.
Net gains on debt and equity securities totaled $1.6 billion for 2018 and $2.3 billion and $2.0 billion for 2017 and 2016 , respectively, after other-than-temporary impairment (OTTI) write-downs of $380 million , $606 million and $642 million , respectively, for the same periods. The decrease in 2018 was predominantly driven by lower deferred compensation gains (offset in employee benefits expense) and lower net gains on debt securities, partially offset by higher net gains from nonmarketable equity securities and $313 million of unrealized gains from the impact of the new accounting standard for financial instruments which requires any gain or loss associated with the fair value measurement of equity securities to be reflected in earnings. The decrease in OTTI in 2018 was predominantly driven by lower write-downs in municipal debt securities, commercial mortgage-backed securities and corporate debt securities. The decrease in net gains on debt and equity securities in 2017 , compared with 2016 , was driven by lower net gains on debt securities, partially offset by higher net gains from nonmarketable equity securities.
 
Lease income was $1.8 billion in 2018 , compared with $1.9 billion in 2017 , driven by lower rail and equipment lease income. Lease income in 2017 was stable compared with 2016 .
All other income was $1.8 billion in 2018 , compared with $1.0 billion in 2017 and $702 million in 2016 . All other income includes losses on low income housing tax credit investments, foreign currency adjustments, income from investments accounted for under the equity method, hedge accounting results related to hedges of foreign currency risk, and the results of certain economic hedges, any of which can cause decreases and net losses in other income. The increase in other income in 2018 , compared with 2017 , was predominantly driven by $2.0 billion higher pre-tax gains from the sales of purchased credit-impaired (PCI) Pick-a-Pay loans, a pre-tax gain from the sale of Wells Fargo Shareowner Services, and gains from the previously announced sale of 52 retail branches. The increase was partially offset by a gain from the sale of our insurance services business in 2017, a realized loss related to the previously announced sale of certain assets and liabilities of Reliable Financial Services, Inc. (a subsidiary of Wells Fargo’s automobile financing business), and a lower benefit from hedge ineffectiveness accounting. The increase in other income in 2017 compared with 2016 was driven by a $848 million pre-tax gain from the sale of our insurance services business in fourth quarter 2017 and a $309 million pre-tax gain from the sale of a PCI Pick-a-Pay loan portfolio in second quarter 2017, as well as the impact of our adoption in fourth quarter 2017 of Accounting Standards Update (ASU) 2017-12 – Derivatives and Hedging (Topic 815): Targeted Improvements to Accounting for Hedging Activities , partially offset by a gain from the sale of our crop insurance business in first quarter 2016 and a gain from the sale of our health benefit services business in second quarter 2016. All other income in 2017 also included $284 million of impairments on low income housing investments and $130 million of impairments on tax-advantaged renewable energy investments in each case due to the 2017 Tax Cuts & Jobs Act (Tax Act).



 
Wells Fargo & Company
57


Earnings Performance (continued)

Noninterest Expense

Table 8: Noninterest Expense
 
Year ended December 31, 
 
(in millions)
2018

 
2017

 
2016

Salaries
$
17,834

 
17,363

 
16,552

Commission and incentive compensation
10,264

 
10,442

 
10,247

Employee benefits
4,926

 
5,566

 
5,094

Equipment
2,444

 
2,237

 
2,154

Net occupancy
2,888

 
2,849

 
2,855

Core deposit and other intangibles
1,058

 
1,152

 
1,192

FDIC and other deposit assessments
1,110

 
1,287

 
1,168

Outside professional services
3,306

 
3,813

 
3,138

Operating losses
3,124

 
5,492

 
1,608

Contract services (1)
2,192

 
1,638

 
1,497

Operating leases
1,334

 
1,351

 
1,329

Advertising and promotion
857

 
614

 
595

Outside data processing
660

 
891

 
888

Travel and entertainment
618

 
687

 
704

Postage, stationery and supplies
515

 
544

 
622

Telecommunications
361

 
364

 
383

Foreclosed assets
188

 
251

 
202

Insurance
101

 
100

 
179

All other (1)
2,346

 
1,843

 
1,970

Total
$
56,126

 
58,484

 
52,377

(1)
The periods prior to 2018 have been revised to conform with the current period presentation whereby temporary help is included in contract services rather than in all other noninterest expense.

Noninterest expense was $56.1 billion in 2018 , down 4% from $58.5 billion in 2017 , which was up 12% from $52.4 billion in 2016 . The decrease in 2018 , compared with 2017 , was driven by lower operating losses, personnel expenses, outside data processing, and FDIC expense, partially offset by higher advertising and promotion, equipment, and other expense. The increase in 2017 , compared with 2016 , was predominantly driven by higher operating losses, personnel expenses, and outside professional and contract services, partially offset by lower insurance and postage, stationery and supplies.
Personnel expenses, which include salaries, commissions, incentive compensation and employee benefits, were down $347 million , or 1% in 2018 , compared with 2017 , due to lower deferred compensation costs (offset in net gains from equity securities), and lower commission and incentive compensation, partially offset by salary and minimum pay increases, and higher company health plan and retirement plan expenses. Personnel expenses were up $1.5 billion , or 5% in 2017 , compared with 2016 , due to annual salary increases, higher deferred compensation costs (offset in net gains from equity securities), and higher employee benefits.
Equipment expense was up 9% in 2018 , compared with 2017 , due to increased computer purchases and equipment expense related to the Company’s migration to Windows 10, higher software license and maintenance expense, as well as higher depreciation expense. Equipment expense was up 4% in 2017 , compared with 2016 , primarily due to higher depreciation expense.
FDIC and other deposit assessments were down 14% in 2018 , compared with 2017 , due to the completion of the FDIC temporary surcharge which ended September 30, 2018. FDIC and other deposit assessments were up 10% in 2017 , compared
 
with 2016 , due to an increase in deposit assessments as a result of the FDIC temporary surcharge which became effective on July 1, 2016. See the “Regulation and Supervision” section in our 2018 Form 10-K for additional information.
Operating losses were down $2.4 billion in 2018 , compared with 2017 , due to lower litigation accruals, partially offset by higher remediation accruals for previously disclosed matters. Operating losses were up $3.9 billion in 2017 , compared with 2016 , predominantly due to higher litigation accruals for a variety of matters, including mortgage-related regulatory investigations, sales practices, and other consumer-related matters. Litigation accruals in 2017 included $3.7 billion that were non tax-deductible.
Outside professional and contract services expense was up 1% in 2018 , compared with 2017 , driven by higher project and technology spending on regulatory and compliance related initiatives. Outside professional and contract services expense was up 18% in 2017 , compared with 2016 , driven by higher project and technology spending on regulatory and compliance related initiatives, as well as higher legal expense related to sales practice matters.
Outside data processing expense was down 26% in 2018 , compared with 2017 , reflecting lower data processing expense related to the GE Capital business acquisitions and the impact of the new revenue recognition accounting standard, which reduced noninterest expense and lowered card fees by an equal amount due to the netting of card payment network charges against related interchange and network revenues in card fees. Outside data processing expense was relatively stable in 2017 , compared with 2016 .
Advertising and promotion expense was up 40% in 2018 , compared with 2017 , due to higher advertising expense, including expense for the “Re-Established” advertising campaign launched in second quarter 2018. Advertising and promotion expense was up 3% in 2017 , compared with 2016 , due to higher advertising expense, including higher media and production expense, partially offset by lower sales promotion expense.
Foreclosed assets expense was down 25% in 2018 , compared with 2017 , predominantly due to lower operating expenses. Foreclosed assets expense was up 24% in 2017 , compared with 2016 , due to lower gains on sales of foreclosed properties, partially offset by lower operating expenses.
Insurance expense was relatively stable in 2018 , compared with 2017 , and was down 44% in 2017 , compared with 2016 , predominantly driven by the sale of our crop insurance business in first quarter 2016.
All other noninterest expense was up 27% in 2018 , compared with 2017 , predominantly due to higher charitable donations expense, higher insurance premium payments, a pension plan settlement expense, and lower gains on the sale of corporate properties. All other noninterest expense was down 6% in 2017 , compared with 2016 , due to lower insurance premium payments and higher gains on the sale of a corporate property, partially offset by higher charitable donations expense. All other noninterest expense in 2018 included a $305 million contribution to the Wells Fargo Foundation, compared with a $199 million contribution in 2017 and a $107 million contribution in 2016.
Our full year 2018 efficiency ratio was 65.0% , compared with 66.2% in 2017 and 59.3% in 2016 .


58
Wells Fargo & Company
 


Income Tax Expense
The 2018 annual effective income tax rate was 20.2% , compared with 18.1% in 2017 and 31.5% in 2016. The 2018 effective income tax rate reflected the reduction to the U.S. federal income tax rate from 35% to 21% resulting from the 2017 Tax Act. It also included income tax expense related to non-deductible litigation accruals and the reconsideration of reserves for state income taxes following the U.S. Supreme Court opinion in South Dakota v. Wayfair, Inc . In addition, we recognized $164 million of income tax expense associated with the final re-measurement of our initial estimates for the impacts of the 2017 Tax Act, in accordance with ASC Topic 740, Income Taxes and SEC Accounting Bulletin 118. The 2017 effective income tax rate included an estimated impact of the Tax Act including a benefit of $3.89 billion resulting from the re-measurement of the Company’s estimated net deferred tax liability as of December 31, 2017, partially offset by $173 million of income tax expense for the estimated deemed repatriation of the Company’s previously undistributed foreign earnings. The 2017 effective income tax rate also included income tax expense of $1.3 billion related to the effect of discrete non tax-deductible items, predominantly consisting of litigation accruals. The effective income tax rate for 2016 included net reductions in reserves for uncertain tax positions resulting from settlements with tax authorities, partially offset by a net increase in tax benefits related to tax credit investments. See Note 23 (Income Taxes) to Financial Statements in this Report for additional information about our income taxes.

 
Operating Segment Results
We are organized for management reporting purposes into three operating segments: Community Banking; Wholesale Banking; and Wealth and Investment Management (WIM). These segments are defined by product type and customer segment and their results are based on our management accounting process, for which there is no comprehensive, authoritative financial accounting guidance equivalent to generally accepted accounting principles (GAAP). Effective first quarter 2018, we adopted a new funds transfer pricing methodology to allow for better comparability of performance across the Company. Under the new methodology, assets and liabilities now receive a funding charge or credit that considers interest rate risk, liquidity risk, and other product characteristics on a more granular level. This methodology change affects results across all three of our reportable operating segments and operating segment results for periods prior to 2018 have been revised to reflect this methodology change. Our previously reported consolidated financial results were not impacted by the methodology change; however, in connection with our adoption of ASU 2016-01 in first quarter 2018, certain reclassifications have occurred within noninterest income. Table 9 and the following discussion present our results by operating segment. For additional description of our operating segments, including additional financial information and the underlying management accounting process, see Note 26 (Operating Segments) to Financial Statements in this Report.
Table 9: Operating Segment Results – Highlights
 
Year ended December 31,
 
(in millions, except average balances which are in billions)
Community Banking 

 
Wholesale Banking 

 
Wealth and Investment Management

 
Other (1) 

 
Consolidated Company 

2018
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Revenue
$
46,913

 
28,706

 
16,376

 
(5,587
)
 
86,408

Provision (reversal of provision) for credit losses
1,783

 
(58
)
 
(5
)
 
24

 
1,744

Net income (loss)
10,394

 
11,032

 
2,580

 
(1,613
)
 
22,393

Average loans
$
463.7

 
465.7

 
74.6

 
(58.8
)
 
945.2

Average deposits
757.2

 
423.7

 
165.0

 
(70.0
)
 
1,275.9

2017
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Revenue
$
47,018

 
30,000

 
17,072

 
(5,701
)
 
88,389

Provision (reversal of provision) for credit losses
2,555

 
(19
)
 
(5
)
 
(3
)
 
2,528

Net income (loss)
10,938

 
9,914

 
2,770

 
(1,439
)
 
22,183

Average loans
$
475.7

 
465.6

 
71.9

 
(57.1
)
 
956.1

Average deposits
729.6

 
464.2

 
189.0

 
(78.2
)
 
1,304.6

2016
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Revenue
$
46,513

 
31,047

 
16,278

 
(5,571
)
 
88,267

Provision (reversal of provision) for credit losses
2,691

 
1,073

 
(5
)
 
11

 
3,770

Net income (loss)
10,818

 
9,942

 
2,637

 
(1,459
)
 
21,938

Average loans
$
485.2

 
451.0

 
67.3

 
(53.5
)
 
950.0

Average deposits
703.6

 
436.2

 
189.7

 
(78.9
)
 
1,250.6

(1)
Includes the elimination of certain items that are included in more than one business segment, most of which represents products and services for WIM customers served through Community Banking distribution channels.

 
Wells Fargo & Company
59


Earnings Performance (continued)

Community Banking offers a complete line of diversified financial products and services for consumers and small businesses including checking and savings accounts, credit and debit cards, and automobile, student, mortgage, home equity and small business lending, as well as referrals to Wholesale Banking and WIM business partners. The Community Banking segment also includes the results of our Corporate Treasury activities net of allocations (including funds transfer pricing,
 
capital, liquidity and certain corporate expenses) in support of other segments and results of investments in our affiliated venture capital and private equity partnerships. We continue to wind down the personal insurance business and expect to substantially complete these activities in the first half of 2019. Table 9a provides additional financial information for Community Banking.
Table 9a: Community Banking
 
Year ended December 31,
 
(in millions, except average balances which are in billions)
2018

 
2017

 
% Change

 
2016

 
% Change

Net interest income
$
29,219

 
28,658

 
2
 %
 
$
27,333

 
5
 %
Noninterest income:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Service charges on deposit accounts
2,641

 
2,909

 
(9
)
 
3,111

 
(6
)
Trust and investment fees:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Brokerage advisory, commissions and other fees (1)
1,887

 
1,830

 
3

 
1,854

 
(1
)
Trust and investment management (1)
910

 
889

 
2

 
849

 
5

Investment banking (2)
(35
)
 
(59
)
 
41

 
(141
)
 
58

Total trust and investment fees
2,762

 
2,660

 
4

 
2,562

 
4

Card fees
3,543

 
3,613

 
(2
)
 
3,598

 

Other fees
1,359

 
1,497

 
(9
)
 
1,636

 
(8
)
Mortgage banking
2,659

 
3,895

 
(32
)
 
5,624

 
(31
)
Insurance
83

 
139

 
(40
)
 
112

 
24

Net gains (losses) from trading activities
28

 
(251
)
 
111

 
(148
)
 
(70
)
Net gains (losses) on debt securities
(3
)
 
709

 
NM

 
933

 
(24
)
Net gains from equity securities (3)
1,505

 
1,455

 
3

 
804

 
81

Other income of the segment
3,117

 
1,734

 
80

 
948

 
83

Total noninterest income
17,694

 
18,360

 
(4
)
 
19,180

 
(4
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total revenue
46,913

 
47,018

 

 
46,513

 
1

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Provision for credit losses
1,783

 
2,555

 
(30
)
 
2,691

 
(5
)
Noninterest expense:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Personnel expense
21,252

 
20,381

 
4

 
19,382

 
5

Equipment
2,356

 
2,157

 
9

 
2,040

 
6

Net occupancy
2,166

 
2,111

 
3

 
2,114

 

Core deposit and other intangibles
404

 
446

 
(9
)
 
505

 
(12
)
FDIC and other deposit assessments
624

 
715

 
(13
)
 
651

 
10

Outside professional services
1,560

 
1,875

 
(17
)
 
1,264

 
48

Operating losses
2,656

 
5,312

 
(50
)
 
1,454

 
265

Other expense of the segment
(527
)
 
(382
)
 
(38
)
 
245

 
NM

Total noninterest expense
30,491

 
32,615

 
(7
)
 
27,655

 
18

Income before income tax expense and noncontrolling interests
14,639

 
11,848

 
24

 
16,167

 
(27
)
Income tax expense
3,784

 
634

 
497

 
5,213

 
(88
)
Net income from noncontrolling interests (4)
461

 
276

 
67

 
136

 
103

Net income
$
10,394

 
10,938

 
(5
)
 
$
10,818

 
1

Average loans
$
463.7

 
475.7

 
(3
)
 
$
485.2

 
(2
)
Average deposits
757.2

 
729.6

 
4

 
703.6

 
4

NM - Not meaningful
(1)
Represents income on products and services for WIM customers served through Community Banking distribution channels and is eliminated in consolidation.
(2)
Includes syndication and underwriting fees paid to Wells Fargo Securities which are offset in our Wholesale Banking segment.
(3)
Largely represents gains resulting from venture capital investments.
(4)
Reflects results attributable to noncontrolling interests predominantly associated with the Company’s consolidated venture capital investments.

60
Wells Fargo & Company
 


Community Banking reported net income of $10.4 billion in 2018, down $544 million , or 5% , from $10.9 billion in 2017, which was up $120 million , or 1% , from 2016. Revenue was $46.9 billion in 2018, down $105 million from $47.0 billion in 2017, which was up $505 million , or 1% , compared with 2016. The decrease in revenue in 2018 was due to lower mortgage banking revenue driven by lower mortgage loan originations and a decrease in servicing income, lower gains on debt securities, lower service charges on deposit accounts, and lower other fees. These decreases were partially offset by higher other income, including gains from the sales of PCI mortgage loans and the sale of 52 branches, and higher net interest income. The increase in revenue in 2017 was due to higher net interest income, higher gains on equity securities, higher deferred compensation plan investment results (offset in employee benefits expense), and higher other income (including higher net hedge ineffectiveness income and a gain on the sale of PCI mortgage loans), partially offset by lower mortgage banking revenue, lower gains on debt securities, and lower service charges on deposit accounts.
Average deposits increased $27.6 billion in 2018, or 4% , from 2017, which increased $26.0 billion , or 4% , from 2016.
Noninterest expense of $30.5 billion decreased $2.1 billion in 2018, or 7% , from 2017, which increased $5.0 billion , or 18% , from 2016. The decrease in 2018 was predominantly driven by lower operating losses due to lower litigation accruals, partially offset by higher outside professional and contract services expense driven by project and technology spending on regulatory and compliance-related initiatives. The increase in 2017 was substantially due to higher operating losses driven by higher litigation accruals, higher personnel expense, and higher outside professional services, partially offset by lower foreclosed assets expense driven by improvement in the residential real estate portfolio, lower telephone and supplies expenses, and lower other expense.
 
The provision for credit losses in 2018 decreased $772 million from 2017 due to credit improvement in the consumer real estate and automobile portfolios. The provision for credit losses in 2017 decreased $136 million from 2016 due to credit improvement in the consumer real estate portfolio.
Income tax expense was $3.8 billion in 2018, up $ 3.2 billion from $ 634 million in 2017, which was down $ 4.6 billion from 2016. Income tax expense in 2018 included the adverse impact of non-deductible litigation accruals, the reconsideration of reserves for state income taxes following the U.S. Supreme Court opinion in South Dakota v. Wayfair, Inc ., and the expense associated with the final re-measurement of our initial estimates for the impacts of the 2017 Tax Act. Income tax expense in 2017 included the estimated net benefit from the impact of the 2017 Tax Act to the Company, partially offset by the impact of discrete non tax-deductible items, predominantly litigation accruals.


 

 
Wells Fargo & Company
61


Earnings Performance (continued)

Wholesale Banking provides financial solutions to businesses across the United States and globally with annual sales generally in excess of $5 million. Products and businesses include Commercial Banking, Commercial Real Estate, Corporate and
 
Investment Banking, Credit Investment Portfolio, Treasury Management, and Commercial Capital. Table 9b provides additional financial information for Wholesale Banking.
Table 9b: Wholesale Banking
 
Year ended December 31,
 
(in millions, except average balances which are in billions)
2018

 
2017

 
% Change

 
2016

 
% Change

Net interest income
$
18,690

 
18,810

 
(1
)%
 
$
18,699

 
1
 %
Noninterest income:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Service charges on deposit accounts
2,074

 
2,201

 
(6
)
 
2,260

 
(3
)
Trust and investment fees:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Brokerage advisory, commissions and other fees
317

 
304

 
4

 
368

 
(17
)
Trust and investment management
445

 
523

 
(15
)
 
473

 
11

Investment banking
1,783

 
1,827

 
(2
)
 
1,833

 

Total trust and investment fees
2,545

 
2,654

 
(4
)
 
2,674

 
(1
)
Card fees
362

 
345

 
5

 
336

 
3

Other fees
2,019

 
2,054

 
(2
)
 
2,085

 
(1
)
Mortgage banking
362

 
458

 
(21
)
 
475

 
(4
)
Insurance
312

 
872

 
(64
)
 
1,156

 
(25
)
Net gains from trading activities
516

 
701

 
(26
)
 
677

 
4

Net gains (losses) on debt securities
102

 
(232
)
 
144

 
8

 
NM

Net gains from equity securities
293

 
116

 
153

 
199

 
(42
)
Other income of the segment
1,431

 
2,021

 
(29
)
 
2,478

 
(18
)
Total noninterest income
10,016

 
11,190

 
(10
)
 
12,348

 
(9
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total revenue
28,706

 
30,000

 
(4
)
 
31,047

 
(3
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Provision (reversal of provision) for credit losses
(58
)
 
(19
)
 
NM

 
1,073

 
NM

Noninterest expense:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Personnel expense
5,567

 
6,603

 
(16
)
 
6,456

 
2

Equipment
48

 
55

 
(13
)
 
68

 
(19
)
Net occupancy
403

 
425

 
(5
)
 
423

 

Core deposit and other intangibles
378

 
414

 
(9
)
 
385

 
8

FDIC and other deposit assessments
419

 
481

 
(13
)
 
428

 
12

Outside professional services
958

 
1,134

 
(16
)
 
989

 
15

Operating losses
246

 
74

 
232

 
115

 
(36
)
Other expense of the segment
8,138

 
7,438

 
9

 
7,037

 
6

Total noninterest expense
16,157

 
16,624

 
(3
)
 
15,901

 
5

Income before income tax expense and noncontrolling interest
12,607

 
13,395

 
(6
)
 
14,073

 
(5
)
Income tax expense
1,555

 
3,496

 
(56
)
 
4,159

 
(16
)
Net income (loss) from noncontrolling interest
20

 
(15
)
 
233

 
(28
)
 
46

Net income
$
11,032

 
9,914

 
11

 
$
9,942

 

Average loans
$
465.7

 
465.6

 

 
$
451.0

 
3

Average deposits
423.7

 
464.2

 
(9
)
 
436.2

 
6

NM - Not meaningful

62
Wells Fargo & Company
 


Wholesale Banking reported net income of $11.0 billion in 2018, up $1.1 billion from 2017, which was down $28 million from 2016. The increase in 2018 was due to the reduced U.S. federal statutory income tax rate as well as lower noninterest expense, partially offset by lower revenue. The decrease in 2017 compared with 2016 was due to lower noninterest income and higher noninterest expense, partially offset by higher net interest income and lower loan loss provision. Revenue in 2018 of $28.7 billion decreased $1.3 billion , or 4% , from 2017, which decreased $1.0 billion , or 3% , from 2016. Net interest income of $18.7 billion in 2018 decreased $120 million , or 1% , from 2017, which increased $111 million , or 1% , from 2016. The decrease in net interest income in 2018 was due to lower income on trading assets, debt securities, and loans, partially offset by the impact of higher interest rates and the increased income on leveraged leases related to the basis adjustment in 2017 associated with the Tax Act. The increase in net interest income in 2017 was due to strong deposit growth and the impact of rising interest rates, partially offset by lower income on debt securities and trading assets as well as the 2017 leveraged lease adjustment.
Average loans of $465.7 billion in 2018 were relatively flat compared with 2017, which increased $14.6 billion , or 3% , from 2016. Loan growth in 2018 from commercial and industrial loans was substantially offset by declines in commercial real estate loans. Loan growth in 2017 was broad based across many Wholesale Banking businesses and included the impact of the GE Capital business acquisitions in 2016. Average deposits of $423.7 billion in 2018 decreased $40.5 billion , or 9% , which increased $28 billion , or 6% , from 2016. The decline in 2018 was driven by actions taken in the first half of 2018 in response to the asset cap included in the FRB consent order on February 2, 2018, and declines across many businesses as commercial customers allocated more cash to higher-rate alternatives.
Noninterest income of $10.0 billion in 2018 decreased $1.2 billion , or 10% , from 2017, which decreased $1.2 billion , or 9% , from 2016. The decrease in 2018 was driven by the impact of the 2017 sale of Wells Fargo Insurance Services USA (WFIS), as well as lower trading, operating lease income, service charges on deposits and mortgage banking fees, partially offset by losses taken in fourth quarter 2017 from adjustments to tax advantaged businesses due to the Tax Act as well as the gain on the sale of Wells Fargo Shareowner Services in 2018. The decrease in 2017, compared with 2016, was driven by the gains on the sale of our crop insurance and health benefit services businesses in 2016, impairments to low income housing and renewable energy investments as a result of the Tax Act, lower insurance income driven by the 2016 sale of our crop insurance business, and lower gains on debt and equity securities. These declines were partially offset by a gain on the sale of our insurance services business in 2017.

 
Noninterest expense of $16.2 billion in 2018 decreased $467 million , or 3% , compared with 2017, which increased $723 million , or 5% , compared with 2016. The decrease in 2018 was primarily due to lower personnel expense related to the sale of WFIS and lower variable compensation, lower project related spending, and lower FDIC expense, partially offset by higher operating losses and increased regulatory, risk, cyber and technology expenses. The increase in 2017 was predominantly due to increased project and technology spending on compliance and regulatory requirements. The provision for credit losses in 2018 decreased $39 million from 2017, from lower losses. The provision for credit losses in 2017 decreased from $1.1 billion in 2016, predominantly due to lower losses in the oil and gas portfolio.

Wealth and Investment Management provides a full range of personalized wealth management, investment and retirement products and services to clients across U.S. based businesses including Wells Fargo Advisors, The Private Bank, Abbot Downing, Wells Fargo Institutional Retirement and Trust, and Wells Fargo Asset Management. We deliver financial planning, private banking, credit, investment management and fiduciary services to high-net worth and ultra-high-net worth individuals and families. We also serve clients’ brokerage needs, supply retirement and trust services to institutional clients and provide investment management capabilities delivered to global institutional clients through separate accounts and the Wells Fargo Funds. Table 9c provides additional financial information for WIM.

 
Wells Fargo & Company
63


Earnings Performance (continued)

Table 9c: Wealth and Investment Management
 
Year ended December 31,
 
(in millions, except average balances which are in billions)
2018

 
2017

 
% Change

 
2016

 
% Change

Net interest income
$
4,441

 
4,641

 
(4
)%
 
$
4,249

 
9
 %
Noninterest income:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Service charges on deposit accounts
16

 
17

 
(6
)
 
19

 
(11
)
Trust and investment fees:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Brokerage advisory, commissions and other fees
9,161

 
9,072

 
1

 
8,870

 
2

Trust and investment management
2,893

 
2,877

 
1

 
2,891

 

Investment banking (1)
9

 
(2
)
 
550

 
(1
)
 
(100
)
Total trust and investment fees
12,063

 
11,947

 
1

 
11,760

 
2

Card fees
6

 
6

 

 
6

 

Other fees
17

 
18

 
(6
)
 
18

 

Mortgage banking
(11
)
 
(10
)
 
(10
)
 
(9
)
 
(11
)
Insurance
82

 
88

 
(7
)
 

 
NM

Net gains from trading activities
57

 
92

 
(38
)
 
81

 
14

Net gains on debt securities
9

 
2

 
350

 
1

 
100

Net gains (losses) from equity securities
(283
)
 
208

 
NM

 
100

 
108

Other income of the segment
(21
)
 
63

 
NM

 
53

 
19

Total noninterest income
11,935

 
12,431

 
(4
)
 
12,029

 
3

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total revenue
16,376

 
17,072

 
(4
)
 
16,278

 
5

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Reversal of provision for credit losses
(5
)
 
(5
)
 

 
(5
)
 

Noninterest expense:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Personnel expense
8,085

 
8,126

 
(1
)
 
7,704

 
5

Equipment
42

 
28

 
50

 
51

 
(45
)
Net occupancy
440

 
431

 
2

 
436

 
(1
)
Core deposit and other intangibles
276

 
292

 
(5
)
 
302

 
(3
)
FDIC and other deposit assessments
116

 
154

 
(25
)
 
152

 
1

Outside professional services
815

 
834

 
(2
)
 
916

 
(9
)
Operating losses
232

 
115

 
102

 
50

 
130

Other expense of the segment
2,932

 
2,643

 
11

 
2,440

 
8

Total noninterest expense
12,938

 
12,623

 
2

 
12,051

 
5

Income before income tax expense and noncontrolling interest
3,443

 
4,454

 
(23
)
 
4,232

 
5

Income tax expense
861

 
1,668

 
(48
)
 
1,596

 
5

Net income (loss) from noncontrolling interest
2

 
16

 
(88
)
 
(1
)
 
NM

Net income
$
2,580

 
2,770

 
(7
)
 
$
2,637

 
5

Average loans
$
74.6

 
71.9

 
4

 
$
67.3

 
7

Average deposits
165.0

 
189.0

 
(13
)
 
189.7

 

NM - Not meaningful
(1)
Includes syndication and underwriting fees paid to Wells Fargo Securities which are offset in our Wholesale Banking segment.
WIM reported net income of $2.6 billion in 2018, down $190 million , or 7% , from 2017, which was up $133 million , or 5% , from 2016. Revenue of $16.4 billion in 2018 decreased $696 million from 2017, which was up $794 million from 2016. The decrease in revenue in 2018 was due to lower noninterest income and net interest income. The increase in revenue in 2017 was due to growth in net interest income and asset-based fees. Net interest income decreased 4% in 2018 primarily due to lower deposit balances, partially offset by higher interest rates. Net interest income increased 9% in 2017 predominantly due to higher interest rates. Average loan balances of $74.6 billion in 2018 increased $2.7 billion from $71.9 billion in 2017, which was up 7% from 2016. Average deposits of $165.0 billion in 2018 decreased 13% from $189.0 billion in 2017, which was relatively flat compared with 2016. Noninterest income in 2018 decreased 4% from 2017 due to net losses from equity securities on lower deferred compensation plan investment results (offset in employee benefits expense), the impairment on the sale of our ownership stake in RockCreek, and lower transaction revenue, partially offset by higher asset-based fees.
 
Noninterest income in 2017 increased 3% from 2016 due to higher asset-based fees and gains on deferred compensation plan investments (offset in employee benefits expense), partially offset by lower transaction revenue. Noninterest expense of $12.9 billion in 2018 increased 2% from $12.6 billion in 2017 due to higher project and technology spending on compliance and regulatory requirements, higher broker commissions, higher operating losses and higher other personnel expense, partially offset by lower employee benefits from deferred compensation plan expense (offset in deferred compensation plan investments). Noninterest expense of $12.6 billion in 2017 increased 5% from $12.1 billion in 2016 due to higher project and technology spending on compliance and regulatory requirements, higher broker commissions, and higher employee benefits from deferred compensation plan expense (offset in deferred compensation plan investments). The provision for credit losses was flat in both 2018 and 2017.

64
Wells Fargo & Company
 


The following discussions provide additional information for client assets we oversee in our retail brokerage advisory and trust and investment management business lines.

Retail Brokerage Client Assets Brokerage advisory, commissions and other fees are received for providing full-service and discount brokerage services predominantly to retail brokerage clients. Offering advisory account relationships to our brokerage clients is an important component of our broader strategy of meeting their financial needs. Although a majority of our retail brokerage client assets are in accounts that earn brokerage commissions, the fees from those accounts generally
 
represent transactional commissions based on the number and size of transactions executed at the client’s direction. Fees earned from advisory accounts are asset-based, are priced at the beginning of the quarter, and depend on changes in the value of the client’s assets as well as the level of assets resulting from inflows and outflows. A majority of our brokerage advisory, commissions and other fee income is earned from advisory accounts. Table 9d shows advisory account client assets as a percentage of total retail brokerage client assets at December 31, 2018 , 2017 and 2016 .
Table 9d: Retail Brokerage Client Assets
 
Year ended December 31,
 
(in billions)
2018

 
2017

 
2016

Retail brokerage client assets
$
1,487.6

 
1,651.3

 
1,486.1

Advisory account client assets
501.1

 
542.8

 
463.8

Advisory account client assets as a percentage of total client assets
34
%
 
33

 
31

Retail Brokerage advisory accounts include assets that are financial advisor-directed and separately managed by third-party managers, as well as certain client-directed brokerage assets where we earn a fee for advisory and other services, but do not have investment discretion. These advisory accounts generate fees as a percentage of the market value of the assets as of the beginning of the quarter, which vary across the account types based on the distinct
 
services provided, and are affected by investment performance as well as asset inflows and outflows. For the years ended December 31, 2018 , 2017 and 2016 , the average fee rate by account type ranged from 80 to 120 basis points. Table 9e presents retail brokerage advisory account client assets activity by account type for the years ended December 31, 2018 , 2017 and 2016 .
Table 9e: Retail Brokerage Advisory Account Client Assets
 
Year ended
 
(in billions)
Balance, beginning of period

Inflows (1)

Outflows (2)

Market impact (3)

Balance, end of period

December 31, 2018
 
 
 
 
 
Client directed (4)
$
170.9

33.6

(41.0
)
(12.0
)
151.5

Financial advisor directed (5)
147.0

30.0

(32.9
)
(2.2
)
141.9

Separate accounts (6)
149.1

23.8

(29.1
)
(7.4
)
136.4

Mutual fund advisory (7)
75.8

12.8

(13.8
)
(3.5
)
71.3

Total advisory client assets
$
542.8

100.2

(116.8
)
(25.1
)
501.1

December 31, 2017
 
 
 
 
 
Client directed (4)
$
159.1

37.1

(39.2
)
13.9

170.9

Financial advisor directed (5)
115.7

30.6

(24.5
)
25.2

147.0

Separate accounts (6)
125.7

26.1

(23.5
)
20.8

149.1

Mutual fund advisory (7)
63.3

13.1

(11.1
)
10.5

75.8

Total advisory client assets
$
463.8

106.9

(98.3
)
70.4

542.8

December 31, 2016
 
 
 
 
 
Client directed (4)
$
154.7

36.0

(37.5
)
5.9

159.1

Financial advisor directed (5)
91.9

28.6

(18.7
)
13.9

115.7

Separate accounts (6)
110.4

26.0

(21.9
)
11.2

125.7

Mutual fund advisory (7)
62.9

8.7

(11.6
)
3.3

63.3

Total advisory client assets
$
419.9

99.3

(89.7
)
34.3

463.8

(1)
Inflows include new advisory account assets, contributions, dividends and interest.
(2)
Outflows include closed advisory account assets, withdrawals and client management fees.
(3)
Market impact reflects gains and losses on portfolio investments.
(4)
Investment advice and other services are provided to client, but decisions are made by the client and the fees earned are based on a percentage of the advisory account assets, not the number and size of transactions executed by the client.
(5)
Professionally managed portfolios with fees earned based on respective strategies and as a percentage of certain client assets.
(6)
Professional advisory portfolios managed by Wells Fargo Asset Management advisors or third-party asset managers. Fees are earned based on a percentage of certain client assets.
(7)
Program with portfolios constructed of load-waived, no-load and institutional share class mutual funds. Fees are earned based on a percentage of certain client assets.


 
Wells Fargo & Company
65


Earnings Performance (continued)

Trust and Investment Client Assets Under Management We earn trust and investment management fees from managing and administering assets, including mutual funds, institutional separate accounts, personal trust, employee benefit trust and agency assets through our asset management, wealth and retirement businesses. Our asset management business is conducted by Wells Fargo Asset Management (WFAM), which offers Wells Fargo proprietary mutual funds and manages institutional separate accounts. Our wealth business manages
assets for high net worth clients, and our retirement business
 
provides total retirement management, investments, and trust and custody solutions tailored to meet the needs of institutional clients. Substantially all of our trust and investment management fee income is earned from AUM where we have discretionary management authority over the investments and generate fees as a percentage of the market value of the AUM. Table 9f presents AUM activity for the years ended December 31, 2018 , 2017 and 2016 .
Table 9f: WIM Trust and Investment – Assets Under Management
 
Year ended
 
(in billions)
Balance, beginning of period

Inflows (1)

Outflows (2)

Market impact (3)

Balance, end of period

December 31, 2018
 
 
 
 
 
Assets managed by WFAM (4):
 
 
 
 
 
Money market funds (5)
$
108.2

4.2



112.4

Other assets managed
395.7

85.5

(120.2
)
(7.5
)
353.5

Assets managed by Wealth and Retirement (6)
186.2

36.3

(39.5
)
(12.3
)
170.7

Total assets under management
$
690.1

126.0

(159.7
)
(19.8
)
636.6

December 31, 2017
 
 
 
 
 
Assets managed by WFAM (4):
 
 
 
 
 
Money market funds (5)
$
102.6

5.6



108.2

Other assets managed
379.6

116.0

(130.9
)
31.0

395.7

Assets managed by Wealth and Retirement (6)
168.5

41.1

(39.4
)
16.0

186.2

Total assets under management
$
650.7

162.7

(170.3
)
47.0

690.1

December 31, 2016
 
 
 
 
 
Assets managed by WFAM (4):
 
 
 
 
 
Money market funds (5)
$
123.6


(21.0
)

102.6

Other assets managed
366.1

114.0

(125.0
)
24.5

379.6

Assets managed by Wealth and Retirement (6)
162.1

37.0

(35.9
)
5.3

168.5

Total assets under management
$
651.8

151.0

(181.9
)
29.8

650.7

(1)
Inflows include new managed account assets, contributions, dividends and interest.
(2)
Outflows include closed managed account assets, withdrawals and client management fees.
(3)
Market impact reflects gains and losses on portfolio investments.
(4)
Assets managed by WFAM consist of equity, alternative, balanced, fixed income, money market, and stable value, and include client assets that are managed or sub-advised on behalf of other Wells Fargo lines of business.
(5)
Money Market funds activity is presented on a net inflow or net outflow basis, because the gross flows are not meaningful nor used by management as an indicator of performance.
(6)
Includes $4.9 billion , $5.5 billion and $6.9 billion as of December 31, 2018 , 2017 and 2016 , respectively, of client assets invested in proprietary funds managed by WFAM.

66
Wells Fargo & Company
 


Balance Sheet Analysis

At December 31, 2018 , our assets totaled $1.9 trillion , down $55.9 billion from December 31, 2017 . Asset decline was predominantly due to interest-earning deposits with banks, which declined $42.8 billion .
The following discussion provides additional information about the major components of our balance sheet. Information
 
regarding our capital and changes in our asset mix is included in the “Earnings Performance – Net Interest Income” and “Capital Management” sections and Note 28 (Regulatory and Agency Capital Requirements) to Financial Statements in this Report.
Available-for-Sale and Held-to-Maturity Debt Securities

Table 10: Available-for-Sale and Held-to-Maturity Debt Securities
 
December 31, 2018
 
 
December 31, 2017
 
(in millions)
Amortized Cost 

 
Net 
unrealized 
gain (loss)

 
Fair 
value 

 
Amortized Cost 

 
Net 
unrealized 
gain (loss)

 
Fair 
value 

Available-for-sale
$
272,471

 
(2,559
)
 
269,912

 
275,096

 
1,311

 
276,407

Held-to-maturity
144,788

 
(2,673
)
 
142,115

 
139,335

 
(350
)
 
138,985

Total (1)
417,259

 
(5,232
)
 
412,027

 
414,431

 
961

 
415,392

(1)
Available-for-sale debt securities are carried on the balance sheet at fair value. Held-to-maturity debt securities are carried on the balance sheet at amortized cost.

Table 10 presents a summary of our available-for-sale and held-to-maturity debt securities, which decreased $1.0 billion in balance sheet carrying value from December 31, 2017 , largely due to higher net unrealized losses, partially offset by purchases outpacing paydowns and maturities.
The total net unrealized losses on available-for-sale debt securities were $2.6 billion at December 31, 2018 , down from net unrealized gains of $1.3 billion at December 31, 2017 , primarily due to higher interest rates and wider credit spreads.
The size and composition of our available-for-sale and held-to-maturity debt securities is largely dependent upon the Company’s liquidity and interest rate risk management objectives. Our business generates assets and liabilities, such as loans, deposits and long-term debt, which have different maturities, yields, re-pricing, prepayment characteristics and other provisions that expose us to interest rate and liquidity risk. 
The available-for-sale debt securities portfolio predominantly consists of liquid, high quality U.S. Treasury and federal agency debt, agency mortgage-backed securities (MBS), privately-issued residential and commercial MBS, securities issued by U.S. states and political subdivisions, corporate debt securities, and highly rated collateralized loan obligations. Due to its highly liquid nature, the available-for-sale debt securities portfolio can be used to meet funding needs that arise in the normal course of business or due to market stress. Changes in our interest rate risk profile may occur due to changes in overall economic or market conditions, which could influence loan origination demand, prepayment speeds, or deposit balances and mix. In response, the available-for-sale debt securities portfolio can be rebalanced to meet the Company’s interest rate risk management objectives. In addition to meeting liquidity and interest rate risk management objectives, the available-for-sale debt securities portfolio may provide yield enhancement over other short-term assets. See the “Risk Management Asset/Liability Management” section in this Report for more information on liquidity and interest rate risk.
 
The held-to-maturity debt securities portfolio consists of high quality U.S. Treasury debt, securities issued by U.S. states and political subdivisions, agency MBS, asset-backed securities (ABS) primarily collateralized by automobile loans and leases and cash, and collateralized loan obligations where our intent is to hold these securities to maturity and collect the contractual cash flows. The held-to-maturity debt securities portfolio may also provide yield enhancement over short-term assets.
We analyze debt securities for other-than-temporary impairment (OTTI) quarterly or more often if a potential loss-triggering event occurs. In 2018 , we recognized $28 million of OTTI write-downs on debt securities. For a discussion of our OTTI accounting policies and underlying considerations and analysis, see Note 1 (Summary of Significant Accounting Policies) and Note 5 (Available-for-Sale and Held-to-Maturity Debt Securities) to Financial Statements in this Report.
At December 31, 2018 , debt securities included $55.6 billion of municipal bonds, of which 93.4% were rated “A-” or better based predominantly on external and, in some cases, internal ratings. Additionally, some of the debt securities in our total municipal bond portfolio are guaranteed against loss by bond insurers. These guaranteed bonds are predominantly investment grade and were generally underwritten in accordance with our own investment standards prior to the determination to purchase, without relying on the bond insurer’s guarantee in making the investment decision. The credit quality of our municipal bond holdings are monitored as part of our ongoing impairment analysis.
The weighted-average expected maturity of debt securities available-for-sale was 6.2 years at December 31, 2018 . The expected remaining maturity is shorter than the remaining contractual maturity for the 59.4% of this portfolio that is MBS because borrowers generally have the right to prepay obligations before the underlying mortgages mature. The estimated effects of a 200 basis point increase or decrease in interest rates on the fair value and the expected remaining maturity of the MBS available-for-sale portfolio are shown in Table 11 .


 
Wells Fargo & Company
67


Balance Sheet Analysis (continued)


Table 11: Mortgage-Backed Securities Available for Sale
(in billions)
Fair 
value 

 
Net 
unrealized 
gain (loss) 

 
Expected 
remaining 
maturity 
(in years) 
At December 31, 2018
 
 
 
 
 
Actual
160.2

 
(2.6
)
 
5.8
Assuming a 200 basis point:
 
 
 
 
 
Increase in interest rates
143.3

 
(19.5
)
 
7.8
Decrease in interest rates
171.7

 
8.9

 
3.1
The weighted-average expected maturity of debt securities held-to-maturity was 5.6 years at December 31, 2018 . See Note 5 (Available-for-Sale and Held-to-Maturity Debt Securities) to Financial Statements in this Report for a summary of debt securities by security type.
 
Loan Portfolios
Table 12 provides a summary of total outstanding loans by portfolio segment. Total loans decreased $3.7 billion from December 31, 2017 , driven by a decline in consumer loans, partially offset by an increase in commercial loans. Commercial loan growth reflected growth in commercial and industrial loans, partially offset by a decline in commercial real estate loans reflecting continued credit discipline. The decrease in consumer loans reflected paydowns, sales of 1-4 family first mortgage PCI Pick-a-Pay loans, a continued decline in junior lien mortgage loans, the sale of Reliable Financial Services, Inc., and an expected decline in automobile loans as originations were more than offset by paydowns.
Table 12: Loan Portfolios
(in millions)
 
December 31, 2018

 
December 31, 2017

Commercial
 
$
513,405

 
503,388

Consumer
 
439,705

 
453,382

Total loans
 
953,110

 
956,770

Change from prior year
 
$
(3,660
)
 
(10,834
)

A discussion of average loan balances and a comparative detail of average loan balances is included in Table 5 under “Earnings Performance – Net Interest Income” earlier in this Report. Additional information on total loans outstanding by portfolio segment and class of financing receivable is included in the “Risk Management – Credit Risk Management” section in this Report. Period-end balances and other loan related
 
information are in Note 6 (Loans and Allowance for Credit Losses) to Financial Statements in this Report. 
Table 13 shows contractual loan maturities for loan categories normally not subject to regular periodic principal reduction and the contractual distribution of loans in those categories to changes in interest rates.

Table 13: Maturities for Selected Commercial Loan Categories
 
December 31, 2018
 
 
December 31, 2017
 
(in millions)
Within 
one 
year 

 
After 
one year 
through 
five years 

 
After 
five 
years 

 
Total 

 
Within 
one 
year 

 
After 
one year through
five years 

 
After 
five 
years 

 
Total 

Selected loan maturities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial
$
109,566

 
213,425

 
27,208

 
350,199

 
105,327

 
201,530

 
26,268

 
333,125

Real estate mortgage
16,413

 
63,648

 
40,953

 
121,014

 
20,069

 
64,384

 
42,146

 
126,599

Real estate construction
9,958

 
11,343

 
1,195

 
22,496

 
9,555

 
13,276

 
1,448

 
24,279

Total selected loans
$
135,937

 
288,416

 
69,356

 
493,709

 
134,951

 
279,190

 
69,862

 
484,003

Distribution of loans to changes in interest rates:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Loans at fixed interest rates
$
17,619

 
28,545

 
28,163

 
74,327

 
18,587

 
30,049

 
26,748

 
75,384

Loans at floating/variable interest rates
118,318

 
259,871

 
41,193

 
419,382

 
116,364

 
249,141

 
43,114

 
408,619

Total selected loans
$
135,937

 
288,416

 
69,356

 
493,709

 
134,951

 
279,190

 
69,862

 
484,003



68
Wells Fargo & Company
 


Deposits
Deposits were $1.3 trillion at December 31, 2018 , down $49.8 billion from December 31, 2017 , due to a decrease in commercial deposits from financial institutions and a decline in consumer and small business banking deposits. The decline in commercial deposits from financial institutions was due to actions taken in the first half of 2018 in response to the asset cap included in the consent order issued by the FRB on February 2, 2018, and declines across many businesses as
 
commercial customers allocated more cash to higher-rate alternative investments. The decline in consumer and small business banking deposits was due to higher balance customers moving a portion of those balances to other cash alternatives offering higher rates. Table 14 provides additional information regarding deposits. Information regarding the impact of deposits on net interest income and a comparison of average deposit balances is provided in “Earnings Performance – Net Interest Income” and Table 5 earlier in this Report.
Table 14: Deposits
($ in millions)
Dec 31,
2018

 
% of  
total 
deposits 

 
Dec 31,
2017

 
% of
total 
deposits 

 
% Change 

Noninterest-bearing
$
349,534

 
27
%
 
$
373,722

 
28
%
 
(6
)
Interest-bearing checking
56,797

 
4

 
51,928

 
4

 
9

Market rate and other savings
703,338

 
55

 
690,168

 
52

 
2

Savings certificates
22,648

 
2

 
20,415

 
2

 
11

Other time deposits
95,602

 
7

 
71,715

 
4

 
33

Deposits in foreign offices (1)
58,251

 
5

 
128,043

 
10

 
(55
)
Total deposits
$
1,286,170

 
100
%
 
$
1,335,991

 
100
%
 
(4
)
(1)
Includes Eurodollar sweep balances of $31.8 billion and $80.1 billion at December 31, 2018 and 2017 , respectively.
Equity
Total equity was $197.1 billion at December 31, 2018 , compared with $208.1 billion at December 31, 2017 . The decrease was driven by a $17.3 billion increase in treasury stock, a $4.2 billion decline in cumulative other comprehensive income predominantly due to fair value adjustments to available-for-sale
 
securities caused by an increase in long-term interest rates, and a $2.1 billion decline in preferred stock, partially offset by a $12.9 billion increase in retained earnings from earnings net of dividends paid. The increase in treasury stock was the result of the repurchase of 375.5 million shares of common stock in 2018, an increase of 91% from 2017.
Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements

In the ordinary course of business, we engage in financial transactions that are not recorded on the balance sheet, or may be recorded on the balance sheet in amounts that are different from the full contract or notional amount of the transaction. Our off-balance sheet arrangements include commitments to lend and purchase debt and equity securities, transactions with unconsolidated entities, guarantees, derivatives, and other commitments. These transactions are designed to (1) meet the financial needs of customers, (2) manage our credit, market or liquidity risks, and/or (3) diversify our funding sources.

Commitments to Lend and Purchase Debt and Equity Securities
We enter into commitments to lend funds to customers, which are usually at a stated interest rate, if funded, and for specific purposes and time periods. When we make commitments, we are exposed to credit risk. However, the maximum credit risk for these commitments will generally be lower than the contractual amount because a significant portion of these commitments is expected to expire without being used by the customer. For more information on lending commitments, see Note 6 (Loans and Allowance for Credit Losses) to Financial Statements in this Report. We also enter into commitments to purchase securities under resale agreements. For more information on commitments to purchase securities under resale agreements, see Note 15 (Guarantees, Pledged Assets and Collateral, and Other Commitments) to Financial Statements in this Report. We also may enter into commitments to purchase debt and equity securities to provide capital for customers’ funding, liquidity or
 
other future needs. For more information, see the “Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements – Contractual Cash Obligations” section in this report and Note 15 (Guarantees, Pledged Assets and Collateral, and Other Commitments) to Financial Statements in this Report.

Transactions with Unconsolidated Entities
In the normal course of business, we enter into various types of on- and off-balance sheet transactions with special purpose entities (SPEs), which are corporations, trusts, limited liability companies or partnerships that are established for a limited purpose. Generally, SPEs are formed in connection with securitization transactions and are considered variable interest entities (VIEs). For more information on securitizations, including sales proceeds and cash flows from securitizations, see Note 9 (Securitizations and Variable Interest Entities) to Financial Statements in this Report.

Guarantees and Certain Contingent Arrangements
Guarantees are contracts that contingently require us to make payments to a guaranteed party based on an event or a change in an underlying asset, liability, rate or index. Guarantees are generally in the form of standby letters of credit, securities lending and other indemnifications, written put options, recourse obligations and other types of arrangements. For more information on guarantees and certain contingent arrangements, see Note 15 (Guarantees, Pledged Assets and Collateral, and Other Commitments) to Financial Statements in this Report.

 
Wells Fargo & Company
69


Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements (continued)

Derivatives
We use derivatives to manage exposure to market risk, including interest rate risk, credit risk and foreign currency risk, and to assist customers with their risk management objectives. Derivatives are recorded on the balance sheet at fair value, and volume can be measured in terms of the notional amount, which is generally not exchanged, but is used only as the basis on which interest and other payments are determined. The notional amount is not recorded on the balance sheet and is not, when viewed in isolation, a meaningful measure of the risk profile of the instruments. For more information on derivatives, see Note 17 (Derivatives) to Financial Statements in this Report.

Other Commitments
We also have other off-balance sheet transactions, including obligations to make rental payments under noncancelable operating leases. Our operating lease obligations are discussed in Note 7 (Premises, Equipment, Lease Commitments and Other Assets) to Financial Statements in this Report.
 
Contractual Cash Obligations
In addition to the contractual commitments and arrangements previously described, which, depending on the nature of the obligation, may or may not require use of our resources, we enter into other contractual obligations that may require future cash payments in the ordinary course of business, including debt issuances for the funding of operations and leases for premises and equipment.
Table 15 summarizes these contractual obligations as of December 31, 2018 , excluding the projected cash payments for obligations for short-term borrowing arrangements and pension and postretirement benefit plans. More information on those obligations is in Note 13 (Short-Term Borrowings) and Note 22 (Employee Benefits and Other Expenses) to Financial Statements in this Report. 

Table 15: Contractual Cash Obligations     
 
 
 
December 31, 2018
 
(in millions)
Note(s) to 
Financial 
Statements 
 
Less than 
1 year 

 
1-3 
years 

 
3-5 
years 

 
More 
than 
5 years 

 
Indeterminate 
maturity 

 
Total 

Contractual payments by period:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Deposits (1)
12
 
$
88,435

 
32,310

 
6,188

 
3,712

 
1,155,525

 
1,286,170

Long-term debt (2)
14
 
46,547

 
73,239

 
36,892

 
72,366

 

 
229,044

Interest (3)

 
8,496

 
11,082

 
6,669

 
24,791

 

 
51,038

Operating leases
7
 
1,174

 
1,936

 
1,290

 
1,654

 

 
6,054

Unrecognized tax obligations
23
 
4

 

 

 

 
3,939

 
3,943

Commitments to purchase debt
and equity securities (4)
15
 
2,436

 
409

 

 

 

 
2,845

Purchase and other obligations (5)

 
777

 
811

 
258

 
331

 

 
2,177

Total contractual obligations
 
 
$
147,869

 
119,787

 
51,297

 
102,854

 
1,159,464

 
1,581,271

(1)
Includes interest-bearing and noninterest-bearing checking, and market rate and other savings accounts.
(2)
Balances are presented net of unamortized debt discounts and premiums and purchase accounting adjustments.
(3)
Represents the future interest obligations related to interest-bearing time deposits and long-term debt in the normal course of business including a net reduction of $2.3 billion related to hedges used to manage interest rate risk. These interest obligations assume no early debt redemption. We estimated variable interest rate payments using December 31, 2018 , rates, which we held constant until maturity. We have excluded interest related to structured notes where our payment obligation is contingent on the performance of certain benchmarks.
(4)
Includes unfunded commitments to purchase debt and equity securities, excluding trade date payables, of $335 million and $2.5 billion , respectively. We have presented predominantly all of our contractual obligations on equity securities above in the maturing in less than one year category as there are no specified contribution dates in the agreements. These obligations may be requested at any time by the investment manager.
(5)
Represents agreements related to unrecognized obligations to purchase goods or services.
We are subject to the income tax laws of the U.S., its states and municipalities, and those of the foreign jurisdictions in which we operate. We have various unrecognized tax obligations related to these operations that may require future cash tax payments to various taxing authorities. Because of their uncertain nature, the expected timing and amounts of these payments generally are not reasonably estimable or determinable. We attempt to estimate the amount payable in the next 12 months based on the status of our tax examinations and settlement discussions. See Note 23 (Income Taxes) to Financial Statements in this Report for more information.

 
Transactions with Related Parties
The Related Party Disclosures topic of the Accounting Standards Codification (ASC) 850 requires disclosure of material related party transactions, other than compensation arrangements, expense allowances and other similar items in the ordinary course of business. Based on ASC 850, we had no transactions required to be reported for the years ended December 31, 2018 , 2017 and  2016 . The Company has included within its disclosures information on its equity securities, relationships with variable interest entities, and employee benefit plan arrangements. See Note 8 (Equity Securities), Note 9 (Securitizations and Variable Interest Entities) and Note 22 (Employee Benefits and Other Expenses) to Financial Statements in this Report.


70
Wells Fargo & Company
 


Risk Management
Wells Fargo manages a variety of risks that can significantly affect our financial performance and our ability to meet the expectations of our customers, stockholders, regulators and other stakeholders. We operate under a Board approved risk management framework which outlines our company-wide approach to risk management and oversight and describes the structures and practices employed to manage current and emerging risks inherent to Wells Fargo. We believe that enhancements made during 2018 to our risk management framework transform and clarify our risk management approach by emphasizing the role of risk management when setting corporate strategy and by further rationalizing and integrating certain risk management organizational, governance and reporting practices.

Risk Management Framework
Our risk management framework defines how we manage risk in a comprehensive, integrated and consistent manner and lays out our vision for the risk management of the organization. It reinforces each team member’s personal accountability for risk management and is built on a foundation that begins with a deep understanding of the Company’s processes, risks and controls. Our risk management framework also supports members of senior management in achieving the Company’s strategic objectives and priorities, and it supports the Board as it carries out its risk oversight responsibilities.
The risk management framework consists of three lines of defense: (1) the front line which consists of Wells Fargo’s risk-generating activities, including all activities of its four primary business groups (Consumer Banking; Wholesale Banking; Wealth and Investment Management; and Payments, Virtual Solutions & Innovation) and certain activities of its enterprise functions (Human Resources, Enterprise Finance, Technology, Legal Department, Corporate Risk, Stakeholder Relations, and Wells Fargo Audit Services); (2) independent risk management, which consists of our Corporate Risk function and is led by our Chief Risk Officer (CRO) who reports to the Board’s Risk Committee; and (3) internal audit, which is Wells Fargo Audit Services and is led by our Chief Auditor who reports to the Board’s Audit & Examination Committee. In addition to the three lines of defense, our risk management framework includes enterprise control activities, which are certain specialized activities performed within centralized enterprise functions (such as Human Resources and the Legal Department) with a focus on controlling specific risks. Key elements of our risk management framework include:
A strong culture that emphasizes each team member’s ownership and understanding of risk. We want to cultivate an environment that expects and promotes robust communication and cooperation among the three lines of defense and supports identifying, escalating and addressing current and emerging risk issues.
 
A company-wide statement of risk appetite that guides business and risk leaders as they manage risk on a daily basis. The company-wide statement of risk appetite describes the nature and magnitude of risk that the Company is willing to assume in pursuit of its business and strategic objectives, consistent with capital, liquidity and other regulatory requirements.
A risk management governance structure , including escalation requirements and a committee structure that helps provide comprehensive oversight of the risks we face.
A company-wide risk inventory that promotes a standardized and systematic process to identify and quantify risks at the business group and enterprise level to guide strategic business decisions and capital planning efforts.
Policies, procedures, and controls which form an integrated risk management program that promotes active, prompt, and consistent identification, measurement, assessment, control, mitigation, reporting, and monitoring of current and emerging risk exposures across Wells Fargo and are integrated with clear enterprise risk roles and responsibilities for the three lines of defense.
Three lines of defense that are closely integrated, each with specific roles and responsibilities for risk management and a clear engagement model that promotes challenge and appropriate escalation of issues and information.

Board and Management-level Committee Structures
Wells Fargo’s Board committee and management-level governance committee structures are designed to ensure that key risks are identified and escalated and, if necessary, decided upon at the appropriate level of the Company. Accordingly, the structure is built upon defined escalation and reporting paths from the front line to independent risk management and management-level governance committees and, ultimately, to the Board as appropriate. Each management-level governance committee has defined escalation processes, authorities and responsibilities as outlined in its charter. Our Board committee and management-level governance committee structures, and the primary risk oversight responsibilities of each of those committees, is presented in Table 16 .



 
Wells Fargo & Company
71


Risk Management ( continued )

Table 16: Board and Management-level Governance Committee Structure
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Wells Fargo & Company
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Board Committees and Primary Risk Oversight Responsibility
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Audit & Examination Committee (1)
 
 
 
Finance Committee
 
 
 
Corporate Responsibility Committee
 
 
 
Risk
Committee (2)
 
 
 
Governance & Nominating Committee
 
 
 
Credit Committee
 
 
 
Human Resources Committee
 
 
 
 
 
Financial, regulatory and risk reporting and controls
 
Interest Rate Risk
Market Risk
 
Social and public responsibility matters
 
COMPANY-WIDE RISKS
- Compliance
(includes Conduct and Financial Crimes)
- Liquidity
- Model
- Operational (includes
Data Management, Information Security/Cyber and Technology)
- Reputation
- Strategic

 
Board-level governance matters

 
 
Credit Risk
 
 
 
Culture, ethics, human capital management and compensation
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Management-level Governance Committees (3)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Regulatory and Risk Reporting Oversight Committee
 
 
 
 
 
Capital Adequacy Process Committee
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Enterprise
Risk & Control
Committee (4)

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Corporate Allowance for Credit Losses Approval Governance Committee
 
 
 
 
 
Incentive Compensation Committee

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
SOX Disclosure Committee

 
 
 
 
 
Capital Management Committee
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 


 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Corporate Asset and Liability Committee
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Recovery and Resolution Committee
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Management Reporting Oversight Committee
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(1)
The Audit & Examination Committee additionally oversees the internal audit function, external auditor independence, activities, and performance, and the disclosure framework for financial, regulatory and risk reports prepared for the Board, management, and bank regulatory agencies, and assists the Board in its oversight of the Company’s compliance with legal and regulatory requirements.
(2)
The Risk Committee has a compliance subcommittee and a technology subcommittee to assist it in providing oversight of those risks as discussed herein.
(3) Pursuant to their charters, many of the management-level governance committees have formed one or more sub-committees to address specific risk matters.
(4) Certain committees report to the Enterprise Risk & Control Committee and have dual escalation and informational reporting paths to Board committees.
Board Oversight of Risk
The business and affairs of the Company are managed under the direction of the Board, whose responsibilities include overseeing management’s implementation of the Company’s risk management framework and ongoing oversight and governance of the Company’s risk management activities. The Board carries out its risk oversight responsibilities directly and through the work of its seven standing committees, which all report to the full Board. Each Board committee works closely with management to understand and oversee the Company’s key risk exposures.
The Risk Committee oversees company-wide risks. The Board’s other standing committees also have primary oversight responsibility for certain specific risk matters, as highlighted in Table 16 .
 
The Risk Committee additionally oversees the Company’s Corporate Risk function and plays an active role in approving and overseeing the Company’s risk management framework. The Risk Committee and the full Board review and approve the enterprise statement of risk appetite annually, and the Risk Committee also actively monitors the Company’s risk profile relative to the approved risk appetite.
The full Board receives reports at each of its regular meetings from the Board committee chairs about committee activities, including risk oversight matters, and the Risk Committee receives periodic reports from management regarding current or emerging risk matters.


72
Wells Fargo & Company
 


Management Oversight of Risk
The Company’s management-level governance committees are designed to enable understanding, consideration and decision-making of significant risk and control matters at the appropriate level of the Company and by the appropriate mix of executives. Each committee has a defined set of authorities and responsibilities as set forth in its charter, and each committee has defined escalation paths and risk reporting responsibilities, including to the Board or Board committees, as appropriate.
The Enterprise Risk & Control Committee is the
management-level governance committee that governs the management of financial risks, non-financial risks and enterprise and other risk programs. The Enterprise Risk & Control Committee is co-chaired by the Company’s CEO and CRO and has an escalation path to the Board’s Risk Committee. It considers and decides risk and control matters, addresses escalated issues, actively oversees risk mitigation, and provides regular updates to the Board’s Risk Committee regarding emerging risks and senior management’s assessment of the effectiveness of the Company’s risk management program. It may escalate certain risk and control matters to other Board committees as appropriate based on their primary risk oversight responsibilities.
Each business group and enterprise function has a Risk &
Control Committee that reports to the Enterprise Risk & Control Committee and has a mandate that mirrors the Enterprise Risk & Control Committee but is limited to the relevant business group or enterprise function. These committees focus on the risks that each group or function generates and is responsible for managing, and on the controls that are expected to be in place. Additionally, there are standalone specific risk type- or program-specific risk governance committees reporting to the Enterprise Risk & Control Committee to help provide complete and comprehensive governance for certain risk areas.
While the Enterprise Risk & Control Committee and the committees that report to it serve as the focal point for the management of company-wide risk matters, the management of certain specific risk types is supported by additional management-level governance committees, which all report to at least one of the Board’s standing committees.
The Corporate Risk function, which is the Company’s independent risk management organization, is headed by the Company’s CRO who, among other things, is responsible for setting the strategic direction and driving the execution of Wells Fargo’s risk management activities. The Corporate Risk function provides senior management and the Board with an independent perspective of the level of risk to which the Company is exposed.
Corporate Risk develops the Company’s enterprise statement of risk appetite in the context of our risk management framework described above. As part of Wells Fargo’s risk appetite, we maintain metrics along with associated objectives to measure and monitor the amount of risk that the Company is prepared to take. Actual results of these metrics are reported to the Enterprise Risk & Control Committee on a quarterly basis and to the Board’s Risk Committee. Our business groups also have business-specific risk appetite statements based on the enterprise statement of risk appetite. The metrics included in the business group statements are harmonized with the enterprise level metrics to ensure consistency where appropriate. Business lines also maintain metrics and qualitative statements that are unique to their line of business. This allows for monitoring of risk and definition of risk appetite deeper within the organization.
The Company’s senior management, including the CRO and Chief Auditor, work closely with the Board’s committees and
 
provide ongoing reports and updates on risk matters during and outside of regular committee meetings, as appropriate.

Operational Risk Management
Operational risk is the risk resulting from inadequate or failed internal controls, processes, people and systems, or from external events. Operational risk is inherent in all Wells Fargo activities.
The Board’s Risk Committee has primary oversight responsibility for all aspects of operational risk, including significant policies and programs regarding the Company’s business continuity, data management, information security, privacy, technology, and third-party risk management. As part of its oversight responsibilities, the Board’s Risk Committee approves the operational risk statement of risk appetite including inner and outer boundary thresholds, reviews and approves significant operational risk policies, and oversees the Company’s ongoing operational risk management program.
At the management level, the Operational Risk function, which is part of Corporate Risk, has primary oversight responsibility for operational risk. The Operational Risk function reports to the CRO and also provides periodic reporting related to operational risk to the Board’s Risk Committee. Within the Operational Risk function, Information Security Risk Management has oversight responsibility for information security risk, and Technology Risk Management Oversight has oversight responsibility for technology risk. Oversight of data management risk, an operational risk, is an enterprise control activity performed within the Data Management & Insight function, and oversight of human capital risk, an operational risk, is an enterprise control activity performed within the Human Resources function. In addition, the Risk & Control Committee for each business group and enterprise function reports operational risk matters to the Enterprise Risk & Control Committee.
Information security is a significant operational risk for financial institutions such as Wells Fargo, and includes the risk resulting from cyber attacks and other information security events relating to Wells Fargo technology, systems, networks, and data that would disrupt Wells Fargo’s businesses, result in the disclosure of confidential data which could damage Wells Fargo’s reputation, cause losses or increase costs. Wells Fargo’s Board is actively engaged in the oversight of the Company’s information security risk management and cyber defense programs. The Board’s Risk Committee has primary oversight responsibility for information security risk and approves the Company’s information security program, which includes the information security policy and the cyber defense program. The Risk Committee formed a Technology Subcommittee to assist it in providing oversight of technology, information security, and cyber risks as well as data management risk. The Technology Subcommittee reviews and recommends to the Risk Committee for approval any significant supporting information security (including cybersecurity) risk, technology risk, and data management risk programs and/or policies, including the Company’s data management strategy. The Technology Subcommittee reports to the Risk Committee and both provide updates to the full Board.
Wells Fargo and other financial institutions continue to be the target of various evolving and adaptive cyber attacks, including malware and denial-of-service, as part of an effort to disrupt the operations of financial institutions, potentially test their cybersecurity capabilities, commit fraud, or obtain confidential, proprietary or other information. Cyber attacks have also focused on targeting online applications and services,

 
Wells Fargo & Company
73


Risk Management ( continued )

such as online banking, as well as cloud-based services provided by third parties, and have targeted the infrastructure of the internet causing the widespread unavailability of websites and degrading website performance. Wells Fargo has not experienced any material losses relating to these or other types of cyber attacks. Cybersecurity risk is a priority for Wells Fargo, and we continue to develop and enhance our controls, processes and systems in order to protect our networks, computers, software and data from attack, damage or unauthorized access. Wells Fargo is also proactively involved in industry cybersecurity efforts and working with other parties, including our third-party service providers and governmental agencies, to continue to enhance defenses and improve resiliency to cybersecurity threats. See the “Risk Factors” section in this Report for additional information regarding the risks associated with a failure or breach of our operational or security systems or infrastructure, including as a result of cyber attacks.

Compliance Risk Management
Compliance risk is the risk resulting from the failure to comply with applicable laws, regulations, rules, and other regulatory requirements, and the failure to appropriately address and limit violations of law and any associated impact to customers. Compliance risk encompasses other standards of self-regulatory organizations applicable to the banking industry as well as nonconformance with applicable internal policies and procedures.
The Board’s Risk Committee has primary oversight responsibility for all aspects of compliance risk, including financial crimes risk. As part of its oversight responsibilities, the Board’s Risk Committee approves the compliance risk and financial crimes risk statement of risk appetites including inner and outer boundary thresholds, reviews and approves significant compliance risk and financial crimes risk policies and programs, and oversees the Company’s ongoing compliance risk management and financial crimes risk management programs. The Compliance Subcommittee of the Risk Committee assists the Risk Committee in providing oversight of the Company’s compliance program and compliance risk management. The Compliance Subcommittee reports to the Risk Committee and both provide updates to the full Board.
At the management level, Wells Fargo Compliance, which is part of Corporate Risk, monitors the implementation of the Company’s compliance program. Financial Crimes Risk Management, which is part of Wells Fargo Compliance, oversees and monitors financial crimes risk. Wells Fargo Compliance reports to the CRO and also provides periodic reporting related to compliance risk to the Board’s Risk Committee and Compliance Subcommittee. In addition, the Risk & Control Committee for each business group and enterprise function reports compliance risk matters to the Enterprise Risk & Control Committee. We continue to enhance our oversight of operational and compliance risk management, including as required by the FRB’s February 2, 2018, and the CFPB/OCC’s April 20, 2018, consent orders.

Conduct Risk Management
Conduct risk, a sub-category of compliance risk, is the risk resulting from inappropriate, unethical, or unlawful behavior on the part of team members or individuals acting on behalf of the Company, caused by deliberate actions or business practices.
The Board has enhanced its oversight of conduct risk to oversee the alignment of team member conduct to the Company’s risk appetite (which the Board approves annually) and culture as reflected in our Vision, Values & Goals and Code
 
of Ethics and Business Conduct. The Board’s Risk Committee has primary oversight responsibility for company-wide conduct risk and risk management components of the Company’s culture, while the responsibilities of the Board’s Human Resources Committee include oversight of the Company’s company-wide culture, Code of Ethics and Business Conduct, conflicts of interest program, human capital management (including talent management and succession planning), performance management program, and incentive compensation risk management program.
At the management level, the Conduct Management Office has primary oversight responsibility for key elements of conduct risk, including internal investigations, sales practices oversight, complaints oversight, and ethics oversight. The Conduct Management Office reports to the CRO and also provides periodic reporting related to conduct risk to the relevant Board committees. In addition, the Risk & Control Committee for each business group and enterprise function reports conduct risk matters to the Enterprise Risk & Control Committee.
The Company’s incentive compensation risk management program is overseen by the management-level Incentive Compensation Committee, which is chaired by the Head of Human Resources and provides periodic reporting related to incentive compensation risk to the Board’s Human Resources Committee. The Human Resources function, which reports to the CEO, also oversees the Company’s culture program, which promotes compliance with laws, consideration of risks when making decisions, and facilitates open dialogue and transparency among the lines of defense.

Strategic Risk Management
Strategic risk is the risk to earnings, capital, and/or liquidity
arising from adverse or poorly executed business decisions or ill-timed or inadequate responses to changes in the internal and
external operating environment.
The Board has primary oversight responsibility for strategic planning and oversees management’s development and implementation of and approves the Company’s strategic plan, and considers whether it is aligned with the Company’s risk appetite. Management develops, executes and recommends strategic corporate transactions and the Board evaluates management’s proposals, including their impact on the Company’s risk profile and financial position. The Board’s Risk Committee has primary oversight responsibility for the Company’s strategic risk and the adequacy of the Company’s
strategic risk management program, including associated risk
management practices, processes and controls. The Board’s
Risk Committee also reviews and approves significant strategic
risk governance documents, and receives periodic reporting from management regarding risks related to new products, and changes to products, as appropriate.
At the management level, the Strategic Risk function, which
is part of Corporate Risk, has primary oversight responsibility for strategic risk. The Strategic Risk function reports into the CRO and also provides periodic reporting related to strategic risk to the Board’s Risk Committee. In addition, the Risk & Control
Committee for each business group and enterprise function
reports strategic risk matters to the Enterprise Risk & Control
Committee.

Model Risk Management
Model risk is the risk arising from decisions based on incorrect or misused model outputs or reports.
The Board’s Risk Committee has primary oversight responsibility for model risk. As part of its oversight

74
Wells Fargo & Company
 


responsibilities, the Board’s Risk Committee oversees the Company’s model risk management policy, model validation activities, model performance, model issue remediation status, and adherence to model risk appetite metrics.
At the management level, the Corporate Model Risk function, which is part of Corporate Risk, has primary oversight responsibility for model risk and is responsible for ongoing governance, validation and monitoring of model risk across the Company. The Corporate Model Risk function reports to the CRO and also provides periodic reporting related to model risk to the Board’s Risk Committee. In addition, the Risk & Control Committee for each business group and enterprise function reports model risk matters to the Enterprise Risk & Control Committee.

Reputation Risk Management
Reputation risk is the risk arising from negative perceptions by
stakeholders, whether real or not, resulting in potential loss of
trust in the Company’s competence or integrity. Key external stakeholders include customers, potential and non-customers, shareholders, regulators, elected officials, advocacy groups, and the media.
The Board’s Risk Committee has primary oversight
responsibility for company-wide reputation risk, while each
Board committee has reputation risk oversight responsibilities
related to their primary oversight responsibilities. As part of its
oversight responsibilities, the Board’s Risk Committee receives reports from management that help it monitor how effectively the Company is managing reputation risk. As part of its oversight responsibilities for social and public responsibility matters, the Board’s Corporate Responsibility Committee also receives reports from management relating to the Company’s brand and stakeholder perception of the Company.
At the management level, the Reputation Risk Oversight
function, which is part of Corporate Risk, has primary oversight responsibility for reputation risk. The Reputation Risk Oversight
function reports into the CRO and also provides periodic reporting related to reputation risk to the Board’s Risk Committee. In addition, the Risk & Control Committee for each business group and enterprise function reports reputation risk
matters to the Enterprise Risk & Control Committee.
Credit Risk Management
We define credit risk as the risk of loss associated with a borrower or counterparty default (failure to meet obligations in accordance with agreed upon terms). Credit risk exists with many of our assets and exposures such as debt security holdings, certain derivatives, and loans.
The Board’s Credit Committee has primary oversight responsibility for credit risk. At the management level, the Corporate Credit function, which is part of Corporate Risk, has primary oversight responsibility for credit risk. The Corporate Credit function reports to the CRO and also provides periodic reporting related to credit risk to the Board’s Credit Committee. In addition, the Risk & Control Committee for each business group and enterprise function reports credit risk matters to the Enterprise Risk & Control Committee.
 
The following discussion focuses on our loan portfolios, which represent the largest component of assets on our balance sheet for which we have credit risk. Table 17 presents our total loans outstanding by portfolio segment and class of financing receivable.

Table 17: Total Loans Outstanding by Portfolio Segment and Class of Financing Receivable
(in millions)
Dec 31, 2018

 
Dec 31, 2017

Commercial:
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial
$
350,199

 
333,125

Real estate mortgage
121,014

 
126,599

Real estate construction
22,496

 
24,279

Lease financing
19,696

 
19,385

Total commercial
513,405

 
503,388

Consumer:
 
 
 
Real estate 1-4 family first mortgage
285,065

 
284,054

Real estate 1-4 family junior lien mortgage
34,398

 
39,713

Credit card
39,025

 
37,976

Automobile
45,069

 
53,371

Other revolving credit and installment
36,148

 
38,268

Total consumer
439,705

 
453,382

Total loans
$
953,110

 
956,770


We manage our credit risk by establishing what we believe are sound credit policies for underwriting new business, while monitoring and reviewing the performance of our existing loan portfolios. We employ various credit risk management and monitoring activities to mitigate risks associated with multiple risk factors affecting loans we hold, could acquire or originate including: 
Loan concentrations and related credit quality
Counterparty credit risk
Economic and market conditions
Legislative or regulatory mandates
Changes in interest rates
Merger and acquisition activities
Reputation risk

Our credit risk management oversight process is governed centrally, but provides for decentralized management and accountability by our lines of business. Our overall credit process includes comprehensive credit policies, disciplined credit underwriting, frequent and detailed risk measurement and modeling, extensive credit training programs, and a continual loan review and audit process.
A key to our credit risk management is adherence to a well-controlled underwriting process, which we believe is appropriate for the needs of our customers as well as investors who purchase the loans or securities collateralized by the loans.


 
Wells Fargo & Company
75

 
Risk Management – Credit Risk Management (continued)


Credit Quality Overview   Solid credit quality continued in 2018 , as our net charge-off rate remained low at 0.29% of average total loans. We continued to benefit from improvements in the performance of our commercial and consumer real estate portfolios. In particular:
Nonaccrual loans were $6.5 billion at December 31, 2018 , down from $7.6 billion at December 31, 2017 . Commercial nonaccrual loans declined to $2.2 billion at December 31, 2018 , compared with $2.6 billion at December 31, 2017 , and consumer nonaccrual loans declined to $4.3 billion at December 31, 2018 , compared with $5.0 billion at December 31, 2017 . The decline in nonaccrual loans reflected an improved housing market and credit improvement in commercial and industrial loans. Nonaccrual loans represented 0.68% of total loans at December 31, 2018 , compared with 0.80% at December 31, 2017 .
Net charge-offs as a percentage of average total loans decreased to 0.29% in 2018 , compared with 0.31% in 2017 . Net charge-offs as a percentage of our average commercial and consumer portfolios were 0.09% and 0.52% in 2018 , respectively, compared with 0.09% and 0.55% , respectively, in 2017 .
Loans that are not government insured/guaranteed and 90 days or more past due and still accruing were $94 million and $885 million in our commercial and consumer portfolios, respectively, at December 31, 2018 , compared with $49 million and $1.0 billion at December 31, 2017 .
Our provision for credit losses was $1.7 billion during 2018 , compared with $2.5 billion in 2017.
The allowance for credit losses declined to $10.7 billion , or 1.12% of total loans, at December 31, 2018 , compared with $12.0 billion , or 1.25% , at December 31, 2017 .

Additional information on our loan portfolios and our credit quality trends follows.

PURCHASED CREDIT-IMPAIRED (PCI) LOANS   Loans acquired with evidence of credit deterioration since their origination and where it is probable that we will not collect all contractually required principal and interest payments are PCI loans. Substantially all of our PCI loans were acquired in the Wachovia acquisition on December 31, 2008. PCI loans are recorded at fair value at the date of acquisition, and the historical allowance for credit losses related to these loans is not carried over. The carrying value of PCI loans at December 31, 2018 , totaled $5.0 billion , compared with $12.8 billion at December 31, 2017 , and $58.8 billion at December 31, 2008. The decrease from December 31, 2017 , was due to the sales of $6.2 billion of Pick-a-Pay PCI loans during 2018, as well as portfolio runoff. PCI loans are considered to be accruing due to the existence of the accretable yield amount, which represents the cash expected to be collected in excess of their carrying value, and not based on consideration given to contractual interest payments. The accretable yield at December 31, 2018 , was $3.0 billion .
A nonaccretable difference is established for PCI loans to absorb losses expected on the contractual amounts of those loans in excess of the fair value recorded at the date of acquisition. Amounts absorbed by the nonaccretable difference do not affect the income statement or the allowance for credit losses. At December 31, 2018 , $480 million in nonaccretable difference remained to absorb losses on PCI loans.
 
For additional information on PCI loans, see the “Risk Management – Credit Risk Management – Real Estate 1-4 Family First and Junior Lien Mortgage Loans – Pick-a-Pay Portfolio” section in this Report, Note 1 (Summary of Significant Accounting Policies ) and Note 6 (Loans and Allowance for Credit Losses) to Financial Statements in this Report.

Significant Loan Portfolio Reviews    Measuring and monitoring our credit risk is an ongoing process that tracks delinquencies, collateral values, Fair Isaac Corporation (FICO) scores, economic trends by geographic areas, loan-level risk grading for certain portfolios (typically commercial) and other indications of credit risk. Our credit risk monitoring process is designed to enable early identification of developing risk and to support our determination of an appropriate allowance for credit losses. The following discussion provides additional characteristics and analysis of our significant portfolios. See Note 6 (Loans and Allowance for Credit Losses) to Financial Statements in this Report for more analysis and credit metric information for each of the following portfolios.

COMMERCIAL AND INDUSTRIAL LOANS AND LEASE FINANCING   For purposes of portfolio risk management, we aggregate commercial and industrial loans and lease financing according to market segmentation and standard industry codes. We generally subject commercial and industrial loans and lease financing to individual risk assessment using our internal borrower and collateral quality ratings. Our ratings are aligned to regulatory definitions of pass and criticized categories with criticized divided among special mention, substandard, doubtful and loss categories.
The commercial and industrial loans and lease financing portfolio totaled $369.9 billion , or 39% of total loans, at December 31, 2018 . The net charge-off rate for this portfolio was 0.13% in 2018 , compared with 0.15% in 2017 . At December 31, 2018 , 0.43% of this portfolio was nonaccruing, compared with 0.56% at December 31, 2017 , reflecting a decrease of $399 million in nonaccrual loans, predominantly due to credit improvement in the oil and gas portfolio. Also, $15.8 billion of the commercial and industrial loan and lease financing portfolio was internally classified as criticized in accordance with regulatory guidance at December 31, 2018 , compared with $17.9 billion at December 31, 2017 . The decrease in criticized loans, which also includes the decrease in nonaccrual loans, was mostly due to improvement in the oil and gas portfolio.
Most of our commercial and industrial loans and lease financing portfolio is secured by short-term assets, such as accounts receivable, inventory and securities, as well as long-lived assets, such as equipment and other business assets. Generally, the collateral securing this portfolio represents a secondary source of repayment.
Table 18 provides a breakout of commercial and industrial loans and lease financing by industry, and includes $63.7 billion of foreign loans at December 31, 2018 . Foreign loans totaled $21.8 billion within the investors category, $19.1 billion within the financial institutions category and $1.2 billion within the oil and gas category.
The investors category includes loans to special purpose vehicles (SPVs) formed by sponsoring entities to invest in financial assets backed predominantly by commercial and residential real estate or corporate cash flow, and are repaid from the asset cash flows or the sale of assets by the SPV. We limit loan amounts to a percentage of the value of the underlying assets, as determined by us, based on analysis of underlying

76
Wells Fargo & Company
 


credit risk and other factors such as asset duration and ongoing performance.
We provide financial institutions with a variety of relationship focused products and services, including loans supporting short-term trade finance and working capital needs. The $19.1 billion of foreign loans in the financial institutions category were predominantly originated by our Corporate and Investment Banking business.
The oil and gas loan portfolio totaled $12.2 billion , or 1% of total outstanding loans at December 31, 2018 , compared with $12.5 billion , or 1% of total outstanding loans at December 31, 2017 . Oil and gas nonaccrual loans decreased to $416 million at December 31, 2018 , compared with $1.1 billion at December 31, 2017 , due to continued credit improvement in the portfolio.

Table 18: Commercial and Industrial Loans and Lease Financing by Industry (1)
 
December 31, 2018
 
(in millions)
Nonaccrual loans 

 
Total portfolio 

(2)
% of total loans 

Investors
$
24

 
73,880

 
8
%
Financial institutions
159

 
43,054

 
5

Cyclical retailers
81

 
27,875

 
3

Food and beverage
53

 
17,175

 
2

Healthcare
126

 
16,611

 
2

Technology
15

 
16,379

 
2

Industrial equipment
63

 
14,780

 
2

Real estate lessor
6

 
14,711

 
2

Oil and gas
416

 
12,221

 
1

Transportation
51

 
8,773

 
1

Business services
27

 
8,245

 
1

Public administration
7

 
7,659

 
1

Other
548

 
108,532

(3)
9

Total
$
1,576

 
369,895

 
39
%
(1)
Industry categories are based on the North American Industry Classification System and the amounts reported include foreign loans. See Note 6 (Loans and Allowance for Credit Losses) to Financial Statements in this Report for a breakout of commercial foreign loans.
(2)
Includes $4 million PCI loans, which are considered to be accruing due to the existence of the accretable yield and not based on consideration given to contractual interest payments.
(3)
No other single industry had total loans in excess of $6.0 billion .

Risk mitigation actions, including the restructuring of repayment terms, securing collateral or guarantees, and entering into extensions, are based on a re-underwriting of the loan and our assessment of the borrower’s ability to perform under the agreed-upon terms. Extension terms generally range from six to thirty-six months and may require that the borrower provide additional economic support in the form of partial repayment, or additional collateral or guarantees. In cases where the value of
 
collateral or financial condition of the borrower is insufficient to repay our loan, we may rely upon the support of an outside repayment guarantee in providing the extension.
Our ability to seek performance under a guarantee is directly related to the guarantor’s creditworthiness, capacity and willingness to perform, which is evaluated on an annual basis, or more frequently as warranted. Our evaluation is based on the most current financial information available and is focused on various key financial metrics, including net worth, leverage, and current and future liquidity. We consider the guarantor’s reputation, creditworthiness, and willingness to work with us based on our analysis as well as other lenders’ experience with the guarantor. Our assessment of the guarantor’s credit strength is reflected in our loan risk ratings for such loans. The loan risk rating and accruing status are important factors in our allowance methodology.
In considering the accrual status of the loan, we evaluate the collateral and future cash flows as well as the anticipated support of any repayment guarantor. In many cases, the strength of the guarantor provides sufficient assurance that full repayment of the loan is expected. When full and timely collection of the loan becomes uncertain, including the performance of the guarantor, we place the loan on nonaccrual status. As appropriate, we also charge the loan down in accordance with our charge-off policies, generally to the net realizable value of the collateral securing the loan, if any.
COMMERCIAL REAL ESTATE (CRE)  We generally subject CRE loans to individual risk assessment using our internal borrower and collateral quality ratings. Our ratings are aligned to regulatory definitions of pass and criticized categories with criticized segmented among special mention, substandard, doubtful and loss categories. The CRE portfolio, which included $7.7 billion of foreign CRE loans, totaled $143.5 billion , or 15% of total loans, at December 31, 2018 , and consisted of $121.0 billion of mortgage loans and $22.5 billion of construction loans.
Table 19 summarizes CRE loans by state and property type with the related nonaccrual totals. The portfolio is diversified both geographically and by property type. The largest geographic concentrations of CRE loans are in California, New York, Florida and Texas, which combined represented 50% of the total CRE portfolio. By property type, the largest concentrations are office buildings at 27% and apartments at 16% of the portfolio. CRE nonaccrual loans totaled 0.4% of the CRE outstanding balance at December 31, 2018 , compared with 0.4% at December 31, 2017 . At December 31, 2018 , we had $4.5 billion of criticized CRE mortgage loans, compared with $4.3 billion at December 31, 2017 , and $289 million of criticized CRE construction loans, compared with $298 million at December 31, 2017 .


 
Wells Fargo & Company
77


Risk Management – Credit Risk Management ( continued )

Table 19: CRE Loans by State and Property Type
 
December 31, 2018
 
 
Real estate mortgage 
 
 
Real estate construction 
 
 
Total 
 
 
% of
total
 loans 

(in millions)
Nonaccrual loans 

 
Total portfolio 

 
Nonaccrual loans 

 
Total portfolio 

 
Nonaccrual loans 

 
Total portfolio 

 
By state:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
California
$
143

 
34,396

 
7

 
4,559

 
150

 
38,955

 
4
%
New York
10

 
10,676

 

 
2,796

 
10

 
13,472

 
1

Florida
29

 
7,708

 
2

 
2,044

 
31

 
9,752

 
1

Texas
64

 
7,796

 
1

 
1,451

 
65

 
9,247

 
1

Arizona
33

 
4,246

 

 
366

 
33

 
4,612

 
*

North Carolina
31

 
3,679

 
6

 
849

 
37

 
4,528

 
*

Georgia
12

 
3,615

 

 
606

 
12

 
4,221

 
*

Washington
11

 
3,390

 
1

 
593

 
12

 
3,983

 
*

Virginia
12

 
2,864

 

 
941

 
12

 
3,805

 
*

Illinois
7

 
2,958

 

 
429

 
7

 
3,387

 
*

Other
228

 
39,686

 
15

 
7,862

 
243

 
47,548

(1)
5

Total
$
580

 
121,014

 
32

 
22,496

 
612

 
143,510

 
15
%
By property:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Office buildings
$
142

 
36,089

 
2

 
3,079

 
144

 
39,168

 
4
%
Apartments
12

 
16,107

 

 
7,484

 
12

 
23,591

 
2

Industrial/warehouse
95

 
15,366

 

 
1,295

 
95

 
16,661

 
2

Retail (excluding shopping center)
99

 
14,512

 
7

 
569

 
106

 
15,081

 
2

Shopping center
6

 
11,217

 

 
1,184

 
6

 
12,401

 
1

Hotel/motel
19

 
9,649

 

 
1,832

 
19

 
11,481

 
1

Mixed use properties (2)
81

 
5,943

 
2

 
524

 
83

 
6,467

 
1

Institutional
43

 
3,135

 

 
1,946

 
43

 
5,081

 
1

Agriculture
46

 
2,468

 

 
33

 
46

 
2,501

 
*

1-4 family structure

 
9

 
6

 
2,210

 
6

 
2,219

 
*

Other
37

 
6,519

 
15

 
2,340

 
52

 
8,859

 
1

Total
$
580

 
121,014

 
32

 
22,496

 
612

 
143,510

 
15
%
*    Less than 1%.
(1)
Includes 40 states; no state had loans in excess of $3.4 billion .
(2)
Mixed use properties are primarily owner occupied real estate, including data centers, flexible space leased to multiple tenants, light manufacturing and other specialized uses.
FOREIGN LOANS AND COUNTRY RISK EXPOSURE  We classify loans for financial statement and certain regulatory purposes as foreign primarily based on whether the borrower’s primary address is outside of the United States. At December 31, 2018 , foreign loans totaled $71.9 billion , representing approximately 8% of our total consolidated loans outstanding, compared with $70.4 billion , or approximately 7% of total consolidated loans outstanding, at December 31, 2017 . Foreign loans were approximately 4% of our consolidated total assets at both December 31, 2018 , and December 31, 2017 .
Our country risk monitoring process incorporates frequent dialogue with our financial institution customers, counterparties and regulatory agencies, enhanced by centralized monitoring of macroeconomic and capital markets conditions in the respective countries. We establish exposure limits for each country through a centralized oversight process based on customer needs, and in consideration of relevant economic, political, social, legal, and transfer risks. We monitor exposures closely and adjust our country limits in response to changing conditions.
We evaluate our individual country risk exposure based on our assessment of the borrower’s ability to repay, which gives consideration for allowable transfers of risk such as guarantees and collateral and may be different from the reporting based on the borrower’s primary address. Our largest single foreign country exposure based on our assessment of risk at December 31, 2018 , was the United Kingdom, which totaled
 
$27.2 billion , or approximately 1% of our total assets, and included $3.1 billion of sovereign claims. Our United Kingdom sovereign claims arise predominantly from deposits we have placed with the Bank of England pursuant to regulatory requirements in support of our London branch. The United Kingdom officially announced its intention to leave the European Union (Brexit) on March 29, 2017, starting the two-year negotiation process leading to its departure. We continue to implement plans for Brexit. Our primary goal is to continue to serve our existing clients in the United Kingdom and the European Union as well as to continue to meet the needs of our domestic clients as they do business in the United Kingdom and the European Union. We have an existing authorized bank in Ireland and an asset management entity in Luxembourg. We are also in the process of obtaining regulatory approvals to establish a broker dealer in France. We continue to explore options to leverage these entities in order to continue to serve clients in the European Union. In addition, the impact of Brexit on our supplier contracts, staffing and business operations in the European Union is subject to an ongoing review, and we are implementing mitigating actions where possible. For additional information on risks associated with Brexit, see the “Risk Factors” section in this Report.
Table 20 provides information regarding our top 20 exposures by country (excluding the U.S.) and our Eurozone exposure, based on our assessment of risk, which gives

78
Wells Fargo & Company
 


consideration to the country of any guarantors and/or underlying collateral.
Table 20: Select Country Exposures
 
December 31, 2018
 
 
Lending (1)
 
 
Securities (2)
 
 
Derivatives and other (3)
 
 
Total exposure
 
(in millions)
Sovereign

 
Non-sovereign

 
Sovereign

 
Non-sovereign

 
Sovereign

 
Non-sovereign

 
Sovereign

 
Non-
sovereign (4)

 
Total

Top 20 country exposures:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
United Kingdom
$
3,102

 
22,227

 

 
1,694

 
3

 
215

 
3,105

 
24,136

 
27,241

Canada
31

 
16,651

 
(27
)
 
190

 

 
135

 
4

 
16,976

 
16,980

Cayman Islands

 
7,208

 

 

 

 
182

 

 
7,390

 
7,390

Germany
3,840

 
1,871

 
(10
)
 
(7
)
 

 
340

 
3,830

 
2,204

 
6,034

Ireland
20

 
3,897

 

 
132

 

 
74

 
20

 
4,103

 
4,123

Bermuda

 
3,841

 

 
98

 

 
56

 

 
3,995

 
3,995

China

 
2,754

 
(1
)
 
(28
)
 
25

 
17

 
24

 
2,743

 
2,767

Guernsey

 
2,606

 

 

 

 
2

 

 
2,608

 
2,608

Netherlands

 
2,180

 
43

 
315

 

 
28

 
43

 
2,523

 
2,566

India

 
2,120

 

 
156

 

 

 

 
2,276

 
2,276

Luxembourg

 
1,502

 

 
617

 

 
30

 

 
2,149

 
2,149

Brazil

 
1,967

 

 

 
22

 

 
22

 
1,967

 
1,989

Chile
1

 
1,654

 

 
(3
)
 

 
5

 
1

 
1,656

 
1,657

Japan
271

 
1,082

 
3

 
55

 

 
11

 
274

 
1,148

 
1,422

Australia

 
1,288

 

 
94

 

 
10

 

 
1,392

 
1,392

France

 
1,220

 

 
81

 
8

 
3

 
8

 
1,304

 
1,312

South Korea

 
1,254

 
11

 
9

 

 
5

 
11

 
1,268

 
1,279

Switzerland

 
1,206

 

 
(22
)
 

 
17

 

 
1,201

 
1,201

Mexico

 
1,164

 

 
5

 

 
3

 

 
1,172

 
1,172

Virgin Islands (British)

 
1,018

 

 
64

 

 

 

 
1,082

 
1,082

Total top 20 country exposures
$
7,265

 
78,710

 
19

 
3,450

 
58

 
1,133

 
7,342

 
83,293

 
90,635

Eurozone exposure:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Eurozone countries included in Top 20 above (5)
$
3,860

 
10,670

 
33

 
1,138

 
8

 
475

 
3,901

 
12,283

 
16,184

Austria

 
680

 

 
116

 

 

 

 
796

 
796

Spain

 
428

 

 
17

 

 
35

 

 
480

 
480

Belgium

 
322

 

 
(67
)
 

 

 

 
255

 
255

Other Eurozone countries (6)
23

 
187

 

 
74

 

 

 
23

 
261

 
284

Total Eurozone exposure
$
3,883

 
12,287

 
33

 
1,278

 
8

 
510

 
3,924

 
14,075

 
17,999

(1)
Lending exposure includes funded loans and unfunded commitments, leveraged leases, and money market placements presented on a gross basis prior to the deduction of impairment allowance and collateral received under the terms of the credit agreements. For the countries listed above, there are $478 million in defeased leases secured significantly by U.S. Treasury and government agency securities.
(2)
Represents exposure on debt and equity securities of foreign issuers. Long and short positions are netted and net short positions are reflected as negative exposure.
(3)
Represents counterparty exposure on foreign exchange and derivative contracts, and securities resale and lending agreements. This exposure is presented net of counterparty netting adjustments and reduced by the amount of cash collateral. It includes credit default swaps (CDS) predominantly used for market making activities in the U.S. and London based trading businesses, which sometimes results in selling and purchasing protection on the identical reference entities. Generally, we do not use market instruments such as CDS to hedge the credit risk of our investment or loan positions, although we do use them to manage risk in our trading businesses. At December 31, 2018 , the gross notional amount of our CDS sold that reference assets in the Top 20 or Eurozone countries was $332 million , which was offset by the notional amount of CDS purchased of $484 million . We did not have any CDS purchased or sold that reference pools of assets that contain sovereign debt or where the reference asset was solely the sovereign debt of a foreign country.
(4)
For countries presented in the table, total non-sovereign exposure comprises $41.3 billion exposure to financial institutions and $43.8 billion to non-financial corporations at December 31, 2018 .
(5)
Consists of exposure to Germany, Ireland, Netherlands, Luxembourg and France included in Top 20.
(6)
Includes non-sovereign exposure to Italy, Portugal, and Greece in the amount of $141 million , $19 million and $14 million , respectively. We had no sovereign exposure in these countries at December 31, 2018 .

 
Wells Fargo & Company
79


Risk Management – Credit Risk Management ( continued )

REAL ESTATE 1-4 FAMILY FIRST AND JUNIOR LIEN MORTGAGE LOANS Our real estate 1-4 family first and junior lien mortgage loans, as presented in Table 21 , include loans we have made to customers and retained as part of our asset/liability management strategy, the Pick-a-Pay portfolio acquired
 
from Wachovia which is discussed later in this Report and other purchased loans, and loans included on our balance sheet as a result of consolidation of variable interest entities (VIEs).

Table 21: Real Estate 1-4 Family First and Junior Lien Mortgage Loans
 
December 31, 2018
 
 
December 31, 2017
 
(in millions)
Balance

% of portfolio

 
Balance

% of portfolio

Real estate 1-4 family first mortgage
$
285,065

89
%
 
$
284,054

88
%
Real estate 1-4 family junior lien mortgage
34,398

11

 
39,713

12

Total real estate 1-4 family mortgage loans
$
319,463

100
%
 
$
323,767

100
%

The real estate 1-4 family mortgage loan portfolio includes some loans with adjustable-rate features and some with an interest-only feature as part of the loan terms. Interest-only loans were approximately 4% of total loans at both December 31, 2018 and 2017 . We believe we have manageable adjustable-rate mortgage (ARM) reset risk across our owned mortgage loan portfolios. We do not offer option ARM products, nor do we offer variable-rate mortgage products with fixed payment amounts, commonly referred to within the financial services industry as negative amortizing mortgage loans. The option ARMs we do have are included in the Pick-a-Pay portfolio which was acquired from Wachovia. For more information, see the “Pick-a-Pay Portfolio” section in this Report.
We continue to modify real estate 1-4 family mortgage loans to assist homeowners and other borrowers experiencing financial difficulties. Loans are generally underwritten at the time of the modification in accordance with underwriting guidelines established for our loan modification programs. Under these programs, we may provide concessions such as interest rate reductions, forbearance of principal, and in some cases, principal forgiveness. These programs generally include trial payment periods of three to four months, and after successful completion and compliance with terms during this period, the loan is permanently modified. Loans included under these programs are accounted for as troubled debt restructurings (TDRs) at the start of a trial period or at the time of permanent modification, if no trial period is used. See the “Critical Accounting Policies – Allowance for Credit Losses” section in this Report for discussion on how we determine the allowance attributable to our modified residential real estate portfolios.
Part of our credit monitoring includes tracking delinquency, current FICO scores and loan/combined loan to collateral values (LTV/CLTV) on the entire real estate 1-4 family mortgage loan portfolio. These credit risk indicators, which exclude government insured/guaranteed loans, continued to improve in 2018 on the non-PCI mortgage portfolio. Loans 30 days or more delinquent at December 31, 2018 , totaled $4.0 billion , or 1% of total non-PCI mortgages, compared with $5.3 billion , or 2% , at December 31, 2017 . Loans with FICO scores lower than 640 totaled $9.7 billion , or 3% of total non-PCI mortgages at December 31, 2018 , compared with $11.7 billion , or 4% , at December 31, 2017 . Mortgages with a LTV/CLTV greater than 100% totaled $3.9 billion at December 31, 2018 , or 1% of total non-PCI mortgages, compared with $6.1 billion , or 2% , at December 31, 2017 . Information regarding credit quality indicators, including PCI credit quality indicators, can be found in Note 6 (Loans and Allowance for Credit Losses) to Financial Statements in this Report.
 
Real estate 1-4 family first and junior lien mortgage loans by state are presented in Table 22 . Our real estate 1-4 family non-PCI mortgage loans to borrowers in California represented 12% of total loans at December 31, 2018 , located predominantly within the larger metropolitan areas, with no single California metropolitan area consisting of more than 5% of total loans. We monitor changes in real estate values and underlying economic or market conditions for all geographic areas of our real estate 1-4 family first and junior lien mortgage portfolios as part of our credit risk management process. Our underwriting and periodic review of loans and lines secured by residential real estate collateral includes appraisals or estimates from automated valuation models (AVMs) to support property values. AVMs are computer-based tools used to estimate the market value of homes. AVMs are a lower-cost alternative to appraisals and support valuations of large numbers of properties in a short period of time using market comparables and price trends for local market areas. The primary risk associated with the use of AVMs is that the value of an individual property may vary significantly from the average for the market area. We have processes to periodically validate AVMs and specific risk management guidelines addressing the circumstances when AVMs may be used. AVMs are not allowed in real estate 1-4 family first and junior lien mortgage origination underwriting. Broker evaluations and enhanced desktop appraisal reports are allowed in junior lien originations and some first lien line of credit originations up to $250,000. An appraisal is required for all real estate 1-4 family first and junior lien mortgage commitments greater than $250,000. Additional information about AVMs and our policy for their use can be found in Note 6 (Loans and Allowance for Credit Losses) to Financial Statements in this Report.


80
Wells Fargo & Company
 


Table 22: Real Estate 1-4 Family First and Junior Lien Mortgage Loans by State
 
December 31, 2018
 
(in millions)
Real estate 1-4 family first mortgage 

 
Real estate 1-4 family junior lien mortgage 

 
Total real estate 1-4 family mortgage 

 
% of total loans 

Real estate 1-4 family loans (excluding PCI):
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
California
$
109,092

 
9,338

 
118,430

 
12
%
New York
28,954

 
1,714

 
30,668

 
3

New Jersey
13,811

 
3,152

 
16,963

 
2

Florida
12,350

 
3,140

 
15,490

 
2

Washington
9,677

 
759

 
10,436

 
1

Virginia
8,343

 
2,020

 
10,363

 
1

Texas
8,566

 
658

 
9,224

 
1

North Carolina
5,888

 
1,608

 
7,496

 
1

Pennsylvania
5,422

 
1,929

 
7,351

 
1

Other (1)
65,042

 
10,063

 
75,105

 
8

Government insured/guaranteed loans (2)
12,932

 

 
12,932

 
1

Real estate 1-4 family loans (excluding PCI)
280,077

 
34,381

 
314,458

 
33

Real estate 1-4 family PCI loans
4,988

 
17

 
5,005

 
1

Total
$
285,065

 
34,398

 
319,463

 
34
%
(1)
Consists of 41 states; no state had loans in excess of $6.8 billion .
(2)
Represents loans whose repayments are predominantly insured by the Federal Housing Administration (FHA) or guaranteed by the Department of Veterans Affairs (VA).
 
First Lien Mortgage Portfolio Our total real estate 1-4 family first lien mortgage portfolio increased $1.0 billion in 2018 , as growth in held for investment nonconforming mortgage loans was partially offset by payoffs and Pick-a-Pay PCI loan sales of $6.2 billion. In addition, $1.3 billion of nonconforming mortgage loan originations that would have otherwise been included in this portfolio, were designated as held for sale in 2018 in anticipation of the future issuance of residential mortgage-backed securities. We retained $42.0 billion in nonconforming originations, consisting of loans that exceed conventional conforming loan amount limits established by federal government-sponsored entities (GSEs) in 2018 .
The credit performance associated with our real estate 1-4 family first lien mortgage portfolio continued to improve in 2018 , as measured through net charge-offs and nonaccrual loans. Net charge-offs as a percentage of average real estate 1-4 family first lien mortgage loans improved to a net recovery of 0.03% in 2018 , compared with a net recovery of 0.02% in 2017 . Nonaccrual loans were $3.2 billion at December 31, 2018 , compared with $3.7 billion at December 31, 2017 . The decrease in nonaccrual loans from December 31, 2017, was driven by nonaccrual loan sales and an improving housing environment.
Table 23 shows certain delinquency and loss information for the first lien mortgage portfolio and lists the top five states by outstanding balance.
Table 23: First Lien Mortgage Portfolio Performance
 
Outstanding balance
 
 
% of loans 30 days or more past due
 
Loss (recovery) rate
 
 
December 31,
 
 
December 31,
 
Year ended December 31,
 
(in millions)
2018

2017

 
2018

2017
 
2018

2017

California
$
109,092

101,464

 
0.68
%
1.06
 
(0.06
)
(0.07
)
New York
28,954

26,624

 
1.12

1.65
 
0.04

0.03

New Jersey
13,811

13,212

 
1.91

2.74
 
0.03

0.16

Florida
12,350

13,083

 
2.58

3.95
 
(0.17
)
(0.16
)
Washington
9,677

8,845

 
0.57

0.85
 
(0.06
)
(0.08
)
Other
93,261

92,961

 
1.70

2.25
 
(0.02
)
0.02

Total
267,145

256,189

 
1.23

1.78
 
(0.03
)
(0.02
)
Government insured/guaranteed loans
12,932

15,143

 
 
 
 
 
 
PCI
4,988

12,722

 
 
 
 
 
 
Total first lien mortgages
$
285,065

284,054

 
 
 
 
 
 

 
Wells Fargo & Company
81


Risk Management – Credit Risk Management ( continued )

Pick-a-Pay Portfolio   The Pick-a-Pay portfolio was one of the consumer residential first lien mortgage portfolios we acquired from Wachovia and a majority of the portfolio was identified as PCI loans.
The Pick-a-Pay portfolio is included in the consumer real estate 1-4 family first mortgage class of loans throughout this Report. Table 24 provides balances by types of loans as of December 31, 2018 . As a result of our loan modification and loss mitigation efforts as well as borrower payoffs, Pick-a-Pay option payment loans have been reduced to $8.8 billion at December 31, 2018, from $99.9 billion at acquisition. Total
 
adjusted unpaid principal balance of Pick-a-Pay PCI loans was $6.6 billion at December 31, 2018 , compared with $61.0 billion at acquisition. Due to loan modification and loss mitigation efforts as well as borrower payoffs, the adjusted unpaid principal balance of option payment PCI loans has declined to 19% of the total Pick-a-Pay portfolio at December 31, 2018 , compared with 51% at acquisition. As favorable sale opportunities arise, we may sell portions of this portfolio. We expect to close on the sale of approximately $2.4 billion unpaid principal balance of Pick-a-Pay PCI loans in first quarter 2019.

Table 24: Pick-a-Pay Portfolio – Comparison to Acquisition Date
 
December 31, 2018
 
 
December 31, 2008
 
(in millions)
Adjusted unpaid principal balance (1) 

 
% of total 

 
Adjusted unpaid principal balance (1) 

 
% of total 

Option payment loans
$
8,813

 
50
%
 
$
99,937

 
86
%
Non-option payment adjustable-rate and fixed-rate loans
2,848

 
16

 
15,763

 
14

Full-term loan modifications
6,080

 
34

 

 

Total adjusted unpaid principal balance
$
17,741

 
100
%
 
$
115,700

 
100
%
Total carrying value
$
16,115

 
 
 
$
95,315

 
 
(1)
Adjusted unpaid principal balance includes write-downs taken on loans where severe delinquency (normally 180 days) or other indications of severe borrower financial stress exist that indicate there will be a loss of contractually due amounts upon final resolution of the loan.

Pick-a-Pay option payment loans may have fixed or adjustable rates with payment options that include a minimum payment, an interest-only payment or fully amortizing payment (both 15- and 30-year options).
Since December 31, 2008, we have completed over 138,000 proprietary and Home Affordability Modification Program (HAMP) Pick-a-Pay loan modifications, which have resulted in over $6.1 billion of principal forgiveness. We have also provided interest rate reductions and loan term extensions to enable sustainable homeownership for our Pick-a-Pay customers.
The predominant portion of our PCI loans is included in the Pick-a-Pay portfolio. Our cash flows expected to be collected have been favorably affected over time by lower expected defaults and losses as a result of observed and forecasted economic strengthening, particularly in housing prices, and our loan modification efforts. Since acquisition, we have reclassified $9.3 billion from the nonaccretable difference to the accretable yield. Fluctuations in the accretable yield are driven by changes in interest rate indices for variable rate PCI loans, prepayment assumptions, and expected principal and interest payments over the estimated life of the portfolio, which will be affected by the pace and degree of improvements in the U.S. economy and housing markets and projected lifetime performance resulting from loan modification activity. Changes in the projected timing of cash flow events, including loan liquidations, prepayments, modifications and short sales, can also affect the accretable yield and the estimated weighted-average life of the portfolio.
 
During 2018, we sold $6.2 billion of Pick-a-Pay PCI loans that resulted in a gain of $2.4 billion. The accretable yield balance related to our Pick-a-Pay PCI loan portfolio declined $5.9 billion during 2018, driven by realized accretion of $1.0 billion, $2.4 billion from the gain on the loan sales, a $2.1 billion reduction in expected interest cash flows resulting from the loan sales, and a $752 million reduction in cash flows resulting from higher prepayments, partially offset by a $372 million reclassification from nonaccretable difference. An increase in expected prepayments and passage of time lowered our estimated weighted-average life to approximately 5.5 years at December 31, 2018 , from 6.8 years at December 31, 2017 . The accretable yield percentage for Pick-a-Pay PCI loans for fourth quarter 2018 was 11.47%, up from 9.83% in fourth quarter 2017, due to an increase in the amount of accretable yield relative to the shortened weighted-average life. Based on loan sales in fourth quarter 2018, we expect the accretable yield percentage to increase to approximately 11.49% for first quarter 2019.
For further information on the judgment involved in estimating expected cash flows for PCI loans, see Note 1 (Summary of Significant Accounting Policies) to Financial Statements in this Report.


82
Wells Fargo & Company
 


Junior Lien Mortgage Portfolio The junior lien mortgage portfolio consists of residential mortgage lines and loans that are subordinate in rights to an existing lien on the same property. It is not unusual for these lines and loans to have draw periods, interest only payments, balloon payments, adjustable rates and similar features. Junior lien loan products are mostly amortizing payment loans with fixed interest rates and repayment periods between five to 30 years. 
We continuously monitor the credit performance of our junior lien mortgage portfolio for trends and factors that influence the frequency and severity of loss. We have observed that the severity of loss for junior lien mortgages is high and generally not affected by whether we or a third party own or service the related first lien mortgage, but the frequency of delinquency is typically lower when we own or service the first lien mortgage. In general, we have limited information available on the delinquency status of the third party owned or serviced first lien where we also hold a junior lien. To capture this inherent loss content, our allowance process for junior lien mortgages considers the relative difference in loss experience for junior lien mortgages behind first lien mortgage loans we own or service, compared with those behind first lien mortgage loans owned or serviced by third parties. In addition, our allowance process for junior lien mortgages that are current, but are in
 
their revolving period, considers the inherent loss where the borrower is delinquent on the corresponding first lien mortgage loans.
Table 25 shows certain delinquency and loss information for the junior lien mortgage portfolio and lists the top five states by outstanding balance. The decrease in outstanding balances since December 31, 2017 , predominantly reflects loan paydowns. As of December 31, 2018 , 6% of the outstanding balance of the junior lien mortgage portfolio was associated with loans that had a combined loan to value (CLTV) ratio in excess of 100%. Of those junior lien mortgages with a CLTV ratio in excess of 100%, 2.93% were 30 days or more past due. CLTV means the ratio of the total loan balance of first lien mortgages and junior lien mortgages (including unused line amounts for credit line products) to property collateral value. The unsecured portion (the outstanding amount that was in excess of the most recent property collateral value) of the outstanding balances of these loans totaled 2% of the junior lien mortgage portfolio at December 31, 2018 . For additional information on consumer loans by LTV/CLTV, see Table 6.12 in Note 6 (Loans and Allowance for Credit Losses) to Financial Statements in this Report.    

Table 25: Junior Lien Mortgage Portfolio Performance
 
Outstanding balance 
 
 
% of loans 30 days or more past due
 
Loss (recovery) rate
 
 
December 31,
 
 
December 31,
 
Year ended December 31,
 
(in millions)
2018

 
2017

 
2018

2017
 
2018

2017

California
$
9,338

 
10,599

 
1.67
%
2.09
 
(0.46
)
(0.40
)
New Jersey
3,152

 
3,606

 
2.57

2.86
 
0.25

0.64

Florida
3,140

 
3,688

 
2.73

3.05
 

0.10

Virginia
2,020

 
2,358

 
1.91

2.34
 
0.19

0.29

Pennsylvania
1,929

 
2,210

 
2.10

2.37
 
0.15

0.39

Other
14,802

 
17,225

 
2.12

2.33
 
(0.07
)
0.08

Total
34,381

 
39,686

 
2.08

2.38
 
(0.11
)
0.03

PCI
17

 
27

 
 
 
 
 
 
Total junior lien mortgages
$
34,398

 
39,713

 
 
 
 
 
 



 
Wells Fargo & Company
83


Risk Management – Credit Risk Management ( continued )

Our junior lien, as well as first lien, lines of credit portfolios generally have draw periods of 10, 15 or 20 years with variable interest rate and payment options during the draw period of (1) interest only or (2) 1.5% of outstanding principal balance plus accrued interest. During the draw period, the borrower has the option of converting all or a portion of the line from a variable interest rate to a fixed rate with terms including interest-only payments for a fixed period between three to seven years or a fully amortizing payment with a fixed period between five to 30 years. At the end of the draw period, a line of credit generally converts to an amortizing payment schedule with repayment terms of up to 30 years based on the balance at time of conversion. Certain lines and loans have been structured with a balloon payment, which requires full repayment of the outstanding balance at the end of the term period. The conversion of lines or loans to fully amortizing or balloon payoff may result in a significant payment increase, which can affect some borrowers’ ability to repay the outstanding balance.
On a monthly basis, we monitor the payment characteristics of borrowers in our first and junior lien lines of credit portfolios. In December 2018 , approximately 44% of these borrowers paid only the minimum amount due and approximately 50% paid more than the minimum amount due. The rest were either delinquent or paid less than the minimum amount due. For the borrowers with an interest only payment feature, approximately
 
30% paid only the minimum amount due and approximately 63% paid more than the minimum amount due.
The lines that enter their amortization period may experience higher delinquencies and higher loss rates than the ones in their draw or term period. We have considered this increased inherent risk in our allowance for credit loss estimate.
In anticipation of our borrowers reaching the end of their contractual commitment, we have created a program to inform, educate and help these borrowers transition from interest-only to fully-amortizing payments or full repayment. We monitor the performance of the borrowers moving through the program in an effort to refine our ongoing program strategy.
Table 26 reflects the outstanding balance of our portfolio of junior lien mortgages, including lines and loans, and first lien lines segregated into scheduled end of draw or end of term periods and products that are currently amortizing, or in balloon repayment status. It excludes real estate 1-4 family first lien line reverse mortgages, which total $109 million , because they are predominantly insured by the FHA, and it excludes PCI loans, which total $34 million , because their losses were generally reflected in our nonaccretable difference established at the date of acquisition.


Table 26: Junior Lien Mortgage Line and Loan and First Lien Mortgage Line Portfolios Payment Schedule






Scheduled end of draw/term
 




Outstanding balance 















2024 and




(in millions)
December 31, 2018


2019


2020

 
2021


2022


2023


thereafter (1)


Amortizing

Junior lien lines and loans
$
34,381

 
456

 
499

 
1,107

 
3,964

 
2,754

 
14,291

 
11,310

First lien lines
11,802

 
169

 
197

 
509

 
1,887

 
1,419

 
5,616

 
2,005

Total (2)(3)
$
46,183

 
625

 
696

 
1,616

 
5,851

 
4,173

 
19,907

 
13,315

% of portfolios
100
%
 
1

 
2

 
3

 
13


9


43

 
29

(1)
Substantially all lines and loans are scheduled to convert to amortizing loans by the end of 2028, with annual scheduled amounts through 2028 ranging from $2.4 billion to $5.8 billion and averaging $3.9 billion per year.
(2)
Junior and first lien lines are primarily interest-only during their draw period. The unfunded credit commitments for junior and first lien lines totaled $60.1 billion at December 31, 2018 .
(3)
Includes scheduled end-of-term balloon payments for lines and loans totaling $179 million , $223 million , $365 million , $172 million , $7 million and $30 million for 2019 , 2020 , 2021 , 2022 , 2023 , and 2024 and thereafter , respectively. Amortizing lines and loans include $56 million of end-of-term balloon payments, which are past due. At December 31, 2018 , $488 million , or 4% of outstanding lines of credit that are amortizing, are 30 days or more past due compared to $553 million or 2% for lines in their draw period.
CREDIT CARDS   Our credit card portfolio totaled $39.0 billion at December 31, 2018 , which represented 4% of our total outstanding loans. The net charge-off rate for our credit card portfolio was 3.51% for 2018 , compared with 3.49% for 2017 .
 
AUTOMOBILE   Our automobile portfolio, predominantly composed of indirect loans, totaled $45.1 billion at December 31, 2018 . The net charge-off rate for our automobile portfolio was 1.21% for 2018 , compared with 1.18% for 2017 .

 
OTHER REVOLVING CREDIT AND INSTALLMENT   Other revolving credit and installment loans totaled $36.1 billion at December 31, 2018 , and primarily included student and securities-based loans. Our private student loan portfolio totaled $11.2 billion at December 31, 2018 . The net charge-off rate for other revolving credit and installment loans was 1.53% for 2018 , compared with 1.52% for 2017 .


84
Wells Fargo & Company
 


NONPERFORMING ASSETS (NONACCRUAL LOANS AND FORECLOSED ASSETS)   Table 27 summarizes nonperforming assets (NPAs) for each of the last five years. We generally place loans on nonaccrual status when:
the full and timely collection of interest or principal becomes uncertain (generally based on an assessment of the borrower’s financial condition and the adequacy of collateral, if any), such as in bankruptcy or other circumstances;
they are 90 days (120 days with respect to real estate 1-4 family first and junior lien mortgages) past due for interest or principal, unless both well-secured and in the process of collection;
part of the principal balance has been charged off; or
for junior lien mortgages, we have evidence that the related first lien mortgage may be 120 days past due or in the
 
process of foreclosure regardless of the junior lien delinquency status.
Credit card loans are not placed on nonaccrual status, but are generally fully charged off when the loan reaches 180 days past due.
Note 1 (Summary of Significant Accounting Policies – Loans) to Financial Statements in this Report describes our accounting policy for nonaccrual and impaired loans.
Nonaccrual loans were $6.5 billion at December 31, 2018 , down $1.2 billion from a year ago, due to a $413 million decrease in commercial and industrial nonaccruals reflecting continued credit improvement in the portfolio, as well as a decrease of $690 million in consumer real estate nonaccruals.


Table 27: Nonperforming Assets (Nonaccrual Loans and Foreclosed Assets)
 
 
December 31,
 
(in millions)
 
2018

 
2017

 
2016

 
2015

 
2014

Nonaccrual loans:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial
 
$
1,486

 
1,899

 
3,199

 
1,363

 
537

Real estate mortgage
 
580

 
628

 
685

 
969

 
1,490

Real estate construction
 
32

 
37

 
43

 
66

 
187

Lease financing
 
90

 
76

 
115

 
26

 
24

Total commercial
 
2,188

 
2,640

 
4,042

 
2,424

 
2,238

Consumer:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Real estate 1-4 family first mortgage
 
3,183

 
3,732

 
4,516

 
6,829

 
8,056

Real estate 1-4 family junior lien mortgage
 
945

 
1,086

 
1,206

 
1,495

 
1,848

Automobile
 
130

 
130

 
106

 
121

 
137

Other revolving credit and installment
 
50

 
58

 
51

 
49

 
41

Total consumer
 
4,308

 
5,006

 
5,879

 
8,494

 
10,082

Total nonaccrual loans (1)(2)(3)(4)
 
$
6,496

 
7,646

 
9,921

 
10,918

 
12,320

As a percentage of total loans
 
0.68
%
 
0.80

 
1.03

 
1.19

 
1.43

Foreclosed assets:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Government insured/guaranteed (5)
 
$
88

 
120

 
197

 
446

 
982

Non-government insured/guaranteed
 
363

 
522

 
781

 
979

 
1,627

Total foreclosed assets
 
451

 
642

 
978

 
1,425

 
2,609

Total nonperforming assets
 
$
6,947

 
8,288

 
10,899

 
12,343

 
14,929

As a percentage of total loans
 
0.73
%
 
0.87

 
1.13

 
1.35

 
1.73

(1)
Financial information for periods prior to December 31, 2018, has been revised to exclude mortgage loans held for sale (MLHFS), loans held for sale (LHFS) and loans held at fair value of $390 million , $463 million , $464 million , and $528 million at December 31, 2017 , 2016 , 2015 , and 2014 , respectively.
(2)
Excludes PCI loans because they continue to earn interest income from accretable yield, independent of performance in accordance with their contractual terms.
(3)
Real estate 1-4 family mortgage loans predominantly insured by the FHA or guaranteed by the VA are not placed on nonaccrual status because they are insured or guaranteed.
(4)
See Note 6 (Loans and Allowance for Credit Losses) to Financial Statements in this Report for further information on impaired loans.
(5)
Consistent with regulatory reporting requirements, foreclosed real estate resulting from government insured/guaranteed loans are classified as nonperforming. However, both principal and interest related to these foreclosed real estate assets are collectible because the loans were predominantly insured by the FHA or guaranteed by the VA. Foreclosure of certain government guaranteed residential real estate mortgage loans that meet criteria specified by Accounting Standards Update (ASU) 2014-14, Classification of Certain Government-Guaranteed Mortgage Loans Upon Foreclosure , effective as of January 1, 2014, are excluded from this table and included in Accounts Receivable in Other Assets. For more information on the classification of certain government-guaranteed mortgage loans upon foreclosure, see Note 1 (Summary of Significant Accounting Policies) to Financial Statements in this Report.

 
Wells Fargo & Company
85


Risk Management – Credit Risk Management ( continued )

Table 28 provides a summary of nonperforming assets during 2018 .

Table 28: Nonperforming Assets by Quarter During 2018
 
 
December 31, 2018
 
 
September 30, 2018
 
 
June 30, 2018
 
 
March 31, 2018
 
 
 
 
 
% of 

 
 
 
% of 

 
 
 
% of 

 
 
 
% of 

 
 
 
 
total 

 
 
 
total 

 
 
 
total 

 
 
 
total 

(in millions)
 
Balance 

 
loans 

 
Balance 

 
loans 

 
Balance 

 
loans 

 
Balance 

 
loans 

Nonaccrual loans:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial
 
$
1,486

 
0.42
%
 
$
1,555

 
0.46
%
 
$
1,559

 
0.46
%
 
$
1,516

 
0.45
%
Real estate mortgage
 
580

 
0.48

 
603

 
0.50

 
765

 
0.62

 
755

 
0.60

Real estate construction
 
32

 
0.14

 
44

 
0.19

 
51

 
0.22

 
45

 
0.19

Lease financing
 
90

 
0.46

 
96

 
0.49

 
80

 
0.41

 
93

 
0.48

Total commercial
 
2,188

 
0.43

 
2,298

 
0.46

 
2,455

 
0.49

 
2,409

 
0.48

Consumer:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Real estate 1-4 family first mortgage
 
3,183

 
1.12

 
3,267

 
1.15

 
3,469

 
1.23

 
3,673

 
1.30

Real estate 1-4 family junior lien mortgage
 
945

 
2.75

 
983

 
2.78

 
1,029

 
2.82

 
1,087

 
2.87

Automobile
 
130

 
0.29

 
118

 
0.26

 
119

 
0.25

 
117

 
0.24

Other revolving credit and installment
 
50

 
0.14

 
48

 
0.13

 
54

 
0.14

 
53

 
0.14

Total consumer
 
4,308

 
0.98

 
4,416

 
1.00

 
4,671

 
1.06

 
4,930

 
1.11

Total nonaccrual loans (1)
 
6,496

 
0.68

 
6,714

 
0.71

 
7,126

 
0.75

 
7,339

 
0.77

Foreclosed assets:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Government insured/guaranteed
 
88

 
 
 
87

 
 
 
90

 
 
 
103

 
 
Non-government insured/guaranteed
 
363

 
 
 
435

 
 
 
409

 
 
 
468

 
 
Total foreclosed assets
 
451

 
 
 
522

 
 
 
499

 
 
 
571

 
 
Total nonperforming assets
 
$
6,947

 
0.73
%
 
$
7,236

 
0.77
%
 
$
7,625

 
0.81
%
 
$
7,910

 
0.83
%
Change in NPAs from prior quarter
 
$
(289
)
 
 
 
(389
)
 
 
 
(285
)
 
 
 
(378
)
 
 
(1)
Financial information for periods prior to December 31, 2018, has been revised to exclude MLHFS, LHFS and loans held at fair value of $339 million , $360 million , and $380 million , at September 30, June 30, and March 31, 2018 , respectively.


86
Wells Fargo & Company
 


Table 29 provides an analysis of the changes in nonaccrual loans.

Table 29: Analysis of Changes in Nonaccrual Loans         
 
Quarter ended 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Dec 31,

 
Sep 30,

 
Jun 30,

 
Mar 31,

 
Year ended Dec 31,
 
(in millions)
2018

 
2018

 
2018

 
2018

 
2018

 
2017

Commercial nonaccrual loans
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Balance, beginning of period
$
2,298

 
2,455

 
2,409

 
2,640

 
2,640

 
4,059

Inflows
662

 
774

 
726

 
605

 
2,767

 
2,893

Outflows:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Returned to accruing
(45
)
 
(122
)
 
(43
)
 
(113
)
 
(323
)
 
(417
)
Foreclosures
(12
)
 

 

 

 
(12
)
 
(20
)
Charge-offs
(193
)
 
(191
)
 
(133
)
 
(119
)
 
(636
)
 
(630
)
Payments, sales and other
(522
)
 
(618
)
 
(504
)
 
(604
)
 
(2,248
)
 
(3,245
)
Total outflows
(772
)
 
(931
)
 
(680
)
 
(836
)
 
(3,219
)
 
(4,312
)
Balance, end of period
2,188

 
2,298

 
2,455

 
2,409

 
2,188

 
2,640

Consumer nonaccrual loans
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Balance, beginning of period
4,416

 
4,671

 
4,930

 
5,006

 
5,006

 
5,879

Inflows
569

 
572

 
578

 
714

 
2,433

 
3,093

Outflows:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Returned to accruing
(269
)
 
(319
)
 
(342
)
 
(374
)
 
(1,304
)
 
(1,583
)
Foreclosures
(35
)
 
(41
)
 
(40
)
 
(50
)
 
(166
)
 
(218
)
Charge-offs
(57
)
 
(65
)
 
(84
)
 
(86
)
 
(292
)
 
(468
)
Payments, sales and other
(316
)
 
(402
)
 
(371
)
 
(280
)
 
(1,369
)
 
(1,697
)
Total outflows
(677
)
 
(827
)
 
(837
)
 
(790
)
 
(3,131
)
 
(3,966
)
Balance, end of period
4,308

 
4,416

 
4,671

 
4,930

 
4,308

 
5,006

Total nonaccrual loans (1)
$
6,496

 
6,714

 
7,126

 
7,339

 
6,496

 
7,646

(1)
Financial information for periods prior to December 31, 2018, has been revised to exclude MLHFS, LHFS and loans held at fair value of $339 million , $360 million , and $380 million , at September 30, June 30, and March 31, 2018 , respectively, and $390 million at December 31, 2017 .

Typically, changes to nonaccrual loans period-over-period represent inflows for loans that are placed on nonaccrual status in accordance with our policy, offset by reductions for loans that are paid down, charged off, sold, foreclosed, or are no longer classified as nonaccrual as a result of continued performance and an improvement in the borrower’s financial condition and loan repayment capabilities. Also, reductions can come from borrower repayments even if the loan remains on nonaccrual.
While nonaccrual loans are not free of loss content, we believe exposure to loss is significantly mitigated by the following factors at December 31, 2018 :
Over 96% of total commercial nonaccrual loans and 99% of total consumer nonaccrual loans are secured. Of the consumer nonaccrual loans, 96% are secured by real estate and 87% have a combined LTV (CLTV) ratio of 80% or less.
losses of $358 million and $1.5 billion have already been recognized on 20% of commercial nonaccrual loans and 45% of consumer nonaccrual loans, respectively. Generally, when a consumer real estate loan is 120 days past due (except when required earlier by guidance issued by bank regulatory agencies), we transfer it to nonaccrual status. When the loan reaches 180 days past due, or is active or discharged in bankruptcy, it is our policy to write these loans down to net realizable value (fair value of collateral less estimated costs to sell). Thereafter, we re-evaluate each loan regularly and record additional write-downs if needed.
82% of commercial nonaccrual loans were current on interest, but were on nonaccrual status because the full or timely collection of interest or principal had become uncertain.
 
72% of commercial nonaccrual loans were current on both principal and interest, but will remain on nonaccrual status until the full and timely collection of principal and interest becomes certain.
the remaining risk of loss of all nonaccrual loans has been considered and we believe is adequately covered by the allowance for loan losses.
of $1.9 billion of consumer loans in bankruptcy or discharged in bankruptcy, and classified as nonaccrual, $1.3 billion were current.
 
We continue to work with our customers experiencing financial difficulty to determine if they can qualify for a loan modification so that they can stay in their homes. Under our proprietary modification programs, customers may be required to provide updated documentation, and some programs require completion of payment during trial periods to demonstrate sustained performance before the loan can be removed from nonaccrual status.
If interest due on all nonaccrual loans (including loans that were, but are no longer on nonaccrual at year end) had been accrued under the original terms, approximately $446 million of interest would have been recorded as income on these loans, compared with $426 million actually recorded as interest income in 2018 , versus $500 million and $395 million , respectively, in 2017 .

 
Wells Fargo & Company
87


Risk Management – Credit Risk Management ( continued )

Table 30 provides a summary of foreclosed assets and an analysis of changes in foreclosed assets.
Table 30: Foreclosed Assets     
 
Quarter ended
 
 
 
 
 
 
Dec 31,

 
Sep 30,

 
Jun 30,

 
Mar 31,

 
Year ended Dec 31,
 
(in millions)
2018

 
2018

 
2018

 
2018

 
2018

 
2017

Summary by loan segment
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Government insured/guaranteed
$
88

 
87

 
90

 
103

 
88

 
120

PCI loans:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial
24

 
31

 
42

 
59

 
24

 
57

Consumer
72

 
63

 
61

 
58

 
72

 
62

Total PCI loans
96

 
94

 
103

 
117

 
96

 
119

All other loans:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial
103

 
170

 
134

 
162

 
103

 
207

Consumer
164

 
171

 
172

 
189

 
164

 
196

Total all other loans
267

 
341

 
306

 
351

 
267

 
403

Total foreclosed assets
$
451

 
522

 
499

 
571

 
451

 
642

Analysis of changes in foreclosed assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Balance, beginning of period
$
522

 
499

 
571

 
642

 
642

 
978

Net change in government insured/guaranteed (2)
1

 
(3
)
 
(13
)
 
(17
)
 
(32
)
 
(77
)
Additions to foreclosed assets (3)
193

 
209

 
191

 
185

 
778

 
899

Reductions:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Sales
(274
)
 
(181
)
 
(257
)
 
(245
)
 
(957
)
 
(1,125
)
Write-downs and gains (losses) on sales
9

 
(2
)
 
7

 
6

 
20

 
(33
)
Total reductions
(265
)
 
(183
)
 
(250
)
 
(239
)
 
(937
)
 
(1,158
)
Balance, end of period
$
451

 
522

 
499

 
571

 
451

 
642

(1)
Foreclosed government insured/guaranteed loans are temporarily transferred to and held by us as servicer, until reimbursement is received from FHA or VA. The net change in government insured/guaranteed foreclosed assets is generally made up of inflows from mortgages held for investment and MLHFS, and outflows when we are reimbursed by FHA/VA.
(2)
Includes loans moved into foreclosure from nonaccrual status, PCI loans transitioned directly to foreclosed assets and repossessed automobiles.

Foreclosed assets at December 31, 2018 , included $ 317 million of foreclosed residential real estate, of which 28% is predominantly FHA insured or VA guaranteed and expected to have minimal or no loss content. The remaining foreclosed assets balance of $134 million has been written down to estimated net realizable value. Of the $451 million in foreclosed assets at December 31, 2018 , 65% have been in the foreclosed assets portfolio one year or less.



88
Wells Fargo & Company
 


TROUBLED DEBT RESTRUCTURINGS (TDRs)

Table 31: Troubled Debt Restructurings (TDRs)
 
December 31,
 
(in millions)
2018

 
2017

 
2016

 
2015

 
2014

Commercial:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial
$
1,623

 
2,096

 
2,584

 
1,123

 
724

Real estate mortgage
704

 
901

 
1,119

 
1,456

 
1,880

Real estate construction
39

 
44

 
91

 
125

 
314

Lease financing
56

 
35

 
6

 
1

 
2

Total commercial TDRs
2,422

 
3,076

 
3,800

 
2,705

 
2,920

Consumer:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Real estate 1-4 family first mortgage
10,629

 
12,080

 
14,134

 
16,812

 
18,226

Real estate 1-4 family junior lien mortgage
1,639

 
1,849

 
2,074

 
2,306

 
2,437

Credit Card
449

 
356

 
300

 
299

 
338

Automobile
89

 
87

 
85

 
105

 
127

Other revolving credit and installment
154

 
126

 
101

 
73

 
49

Trial modifications
149

 
194

 
299

 
402

 
452

Total consumer TDRs
13,109

 
14,692

 
16,993

 
19,997

 
21,629

Total TDRs
$
15,531

 
17,768

 
20,793

 
22,702

 
24,549

TDRs on nonaccrual status
$
4,058

 
4,801

 
6,193

 
6,506

 
7,104

TDRs on accrual status:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Government insured/guaranteed
1,299

 
1,359

 
1,526

 
1,771

 
2,078

Non-government insured/guaranteed
10,174

 
11,608

 
13,074

 
14,425

 
15,367

Total TDRs
$
15,531

 
17,768

 
20,793

 
22,702

 
24,549

Table 32: TDRs Balance by Quarter During 2018
 
Dec 31,

 
Sep 30,

 
Jun 30,

 
Mar 31,

(in millions)
2018

 
2018

 
2018

 
2018

Commercial:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial
$
1,623

 
1,837

 
1,792

 
1,703

Real estate mortgage
704

 
782

 
904

 
939

Real estate construction
39

 
49

 
40

 
45

Lease financing
56

 
65

 
50

 
53

Total commercial TDRs
2,422

 
2,733

 
2,786

 
2,740

Consumer:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Real estate 1-4 family first mortgage
10,629

 
10,967

 
11,387

 
11,782

Real estate 1-4 family junior lien mortgage
1,639

 
1,689

 
1,735

 
1,794

Credit Card
449

 
431

 
410

 
386

Automobile
89

 
91

 
81

 
83

Other revolving credit and installment
154

 
146

 
141

 
137

Trial modifications
149

 
163

 
200

 
198

Total consumer TDRs
13,109

 
13,487

 
13,954

 
14,380

Total TDRs
$
15,531

 
16,220

 
16,740

 
17,120

TDRs on nonaccrual status
$
4,058

 
4,298

 
4,454

 
4,428

TDRs on accrual status:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Government insured/guaranteed
1,299

 
1,308

 
1,368

 
1,375

Non-government insured/guaranteed
10,174

 
10,614

 
10,918

 
11,317

Total TDRs
$
15,531

 
16,220

 
16,740

 
17,120


Table 31 and Table 32 provide information regarding the recorded investment of loans modified in TDRs. The allowance for loan losses for TDRs was $1.2 billion and $1.6 billion at December 31,  2018  and 2017 , respectively. See Note 6 (Loans and Allowance for Credit Losses) to Financial Statements in this Report for additional information regarding TDRs. In those situations where principal is forgiven, the entire amount of such
 
forgiveness is immediately charged off to the extent not done so prior to the modification. When we delay the timing on the repayment of a portion of principal (principal forbearance), we charge off the amount of forbearance if that amount is not considered fully collectible.
Our nonaccrual policies are generally the same for all loan types when a restructuring is involved. We typically

 
Wells Fargo & Company
89


Risk Management – Credit Risk Management ( continued )

re-underwrite loans at the time of restructuring to determine whether there is sufficient evidence of sustained repayment capacity based on the borrower’s documented income, debt to income ratios, and other factors. Loans lacking sufficient evidence of sustained repayment capacity at the time of modification are charged down to the fair value of the collateral, if applicable. For an accruing loan that has been modified, if the borrower has demonstrated performance under the previous terms and the underwriting process shows the capacity to continue to perform under the restructured terms, the loan will generally remain in accruing status. Otherwise, the loan will be placed in nonaccrual status and may be returned to accruing status when the borrower demonstrates a sustained period of performance, generally six consecutive months of payments, or
 
equivalent, inclusive of consecutive payments made prior to modification. Loans will also be placed on nonaccrual, and a corresponding charge-off is recorded to the loan balance, when we believe that principal and interest contractually due under the modified agreement will not be collectible.
Table 33 provides an analysis of the changes in TDRs. Loans modified more than once are reported as TDR inflows only in the period they are first modified. Other than resolutions such as foreclosures, sales and transfers to held for sale, we may remove loans held for investment from TDR classification, but only if they have been refinanced or restructured at market terms and qualify as a new loan.  
 

Table 33: Analysis of Changes in TDRs
 
 
 
 
 
Quarter ended 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Dec 31,

 
Sep 30,

 
Jun 30,

 
Mar 31,

 
Year ended Dec 31, 
 
(in millions)
2018

 
2018

 
2018

 
2018

 
2018

 
2017

Commercial TDRs
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Balance, beginning of period
$
2,733

 
2,786

 
2,740

 
3,076

 
3,076

 
3,800

Inflows (1)(2)
374

 
588

 
481

 
321

 
1,764

 
2,117

Outflows
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Charge-offs
(88
)
 
(92
)
 
(41
)
 
(63
)
 
(284
)
 
(306
)
Foreclosure
(2
)
 
(13
)
 

 

 
(15
)
 
(15
)
Payments, sales and other (2)(3)
(595
)
 
(536
)
 
(394
)
 
(594
)
 
(2,119
)
 
(2,520
)
Balance, end of period
2,422

 
2,733

 
2,786

 
2,740

 
2,422

 
3,076

Consumer TDRs
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Balance, beginning of period
13,487

 
13,954

 
14,380

 
14,692

 
14,692

 
16,993

Inflows (1)
379

 
414

 
467

 
487

 
1,747

 
1,817

Outflows
 
 

 

 

 
 
 

Charge-offs
(57
)
 
(56
)
 
(56
)
 
(54
)
 
(223
)
 
(205
)
Foreclosure
(90
)
 
(116
)
 
(133
)
 
(131
)
 
(470
)
 
(619
)
Payments, sales and other (3)
(595
)
 
(672
)
 
(706
)
 
(618
)
 
(2,591
)
 
(3,189
)
Net change in trial modifications (4)
(15
)
 
(37
)
 
2

 
4

 
(46
)
 
(105
)
Balance, end of period
13,109

 
13,487

 
13,954

 
14,380

 
13,109

 
14,692

Total TDRs
$
15,531

 
16,220

 
16,740

 
17,120

 
15,531

 
17,768

(1)
Inflows include loans that modify, even if they resolve within the period, as well as gross advances on term loans that modified in a prior period and net advances on revolving commercial TDRs that modified in a prior period.
(2)
Information for the quarter ended June 30, 2018, has been revised to offset payments and advances (i.e., inflows) on revolving commercial TDRs, for consistent presentation of this activity for all periods.
(3)
Other outflows include normal amortization/accretion of loan basis adjustments and loans transferred to held-for-sale. It also includes $59 million and $ 5 million of loans refinanced or restructured at market terms and qualifying as new loans and removed from TDR classification for the quarters ended December 31 and March 31, 2018, respectively, while no loans were removed from TDR classification for the quarters ended September 30 and June 30, 2018. During 2017 , $6 million of loans refinanced or structured as new loans and were removed from TDR classification.
(4)
Net change in trial modifications includes: inflows of new TDRs entering the trial payment period, net of outflows for modifications that either (i) successfully perform and enter into a permanent modification, or (ii) did not successfully perform according to the terms of the trial period plan and are subsequently charged-off, foreclosed upon or otherwise resolved.


90
Wells Fargo & Company
 


LOANS 90 DAYS OR MORE PAST DUE AND STILL ACCRUING  Loans 90 days or more past due as to interest or principal are still accruing if they are (1) well-secured and in the process of collection or (2) real estate 1-4 family mortgage loans or consumer loans exempt under regulatory rules from being classified as nonaccrual until later delinquency, usually 120 days past due. PCI loans are not included in past due and still accruing loans even when they are 90 days or more contractually past due. These PCI loans are considered to be accruing because they continue to earn interest from accretable yield, independent of performance in accordance with their contractual terms.
Excluding insured/guaranteed loans, loans 90 days or more past due and still accruing at December 31, 2018 , were down $ 78 million , or 7% , from December 31, 2017 , due to payoffs, modifications and other loss mitigation activities and credit stabilization.
 
Loans 90 days or more past due and still accruing whose repayments are predominantly insured by the FHA or guaranteed by the VA for mortgages were $7.7 billion at December 31, 2018 , down from $10.5 billion at December 31, 2017 , due to an improvement in delinquencies, loan modification activity, as well as runoff. All remaining student loans guaranteed by agencies on behalf of the U.S. Department of Education under the FFELP were sold as of March 31, 2017.
Table 34 reflects non-PCI loans 90 days or more past due and still accruing by class for loans not government insured/guaranteed. For additional information on delinquencies by loan class, see Note 6 (Loans and Allowance for Credit Losses) to Financial Statements in this Report.

Table 34: Loans 90 Days or More Past Due and Still Accruing (1)
 
 
 
December 31, 
 
(in millions)
 
2018

 
2017

 
2016

 
2015

 
2014

Total (excluding PCI)(2):
 
$
8,704

 
11,532

 
11,437

 
13,866

 
17,183

 
Less: FHA insured/VA guaranteed (3)
 
7,725

 
10,475

 
10,467

 
12,863

 
16,204

 
Less: Student loans guaranteed under the FFELP (4)
 

 

 
3

 
26

 
63

 
Total, not government insured/guaranteed
 
$
979

 
1,057

 
967

 
977

 
916

By segment and class, not government insured/guaranteed:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial
 
$
43

 
26

 
28

 
97

 
31

 
Real estate mortgage
 
51

 
23

 
36

 
13

 
16

 
Real estate construction
 

 

 

 
4

 

 
Total commercial
 
94

 
49

 
64

 
114

 
47

 
Consumer:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Real estate 1-4 family first mortgage
 
124

 
213

 
170

 
220

 
256

 
Real estate 1-4 family junior lien mortgage
 
32

 
60

 
56

 
65

 
83

 
Credit card
 
513

 
492

 
452

 
397

 
364

 
Automobile
 
114

 
143

 
112

 
79

 
73

 
Other revolving credit and installment
 
102

 
100

 
113

 
102

 
93

 
Total consumer
 
885

 
1,008

 
903

 
863

 
869

 
Total, not government insured/guaranteed
 
$
979

 
1,057

 
967

 
977

 
916

(1)
Financial information for periods prior to December 31, 2018, has been revised to exclude MLHFS, LHFS and loans held at fair value, which reduced “Total, not government insured/guaranteed” by $6 million , $5 million , $4 million and $4 million at December 31, 2017 , 2016 , 2015 and 2014 , respectively.
(2)
PCI loans totaled $370 million , $1.4 billion , $2.0 billion , $2.9 billion and $3.7 billion at December 31, 2018 , 2017 , 2016 , 2015 and 2014 , respectively.
(3)
Represents loans whose repayments are predominantly insured by the FHA or guaranteed by the VA.
(4)
Represents loans whose repayments are largely guaranteed by agencies on behalf of the U.S. Department of Education under the FFELP. All remaining student loans guaranteed under the FFELP were sold as of March 31, 2017.





 
Wells Fargo & Company
91


Risk Management – Credit Risk Management ( continued )

NET CHARGE-OFFS

Table 35: Net Charge-offs
 
 
 
Year ended 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Quarter ended 
 
 
 
 
December 31, 
 
 
December 31, 
 
 
September 30, 
 
 
June 30, 
 
 
March 31, 
 
 
 
 
Net loan

 
% of 

 
Net loan 

 
% of 

 
Net loan 

 
% of 

 
Net loan 

 
% of 

 
Net loan 

 
% of 

 
 
 
charge-

 
avg. 

 
charge-

 
avg. 

 
charge-

 
avg. 

 
charge- 

 
avg. 

 
charge-

 
avg. 

($ in millions)
 
offs 

 
loans 

 
offs 

 
loans  (1) 

 
offs 

 
loans  (1) 

 
offs 

 
loans  (1) 

 
offs 

 
loans  (1) 

2018
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial
 
$
423

 
0.13
 %
 
$
132

 
0.15
 %
 
$
148

 
0.18
 %
 
$
58

 
0.07
 %
 
$
85

 
0.10
 %
 
Real estate mortgage
 
(28
)
 
(0.02
)
 
(12
)
 
(0.04
)
 
(1
)
 

 

 

 
(15
)
 
(0.05
)
 
Real estate construction
 
(13
)
 
(0.05
)
 
(1
)
 
(0.01
)
 
(2
)
 
(0.04
)
 
(6
)
 
(0.09
)
 
(4
)
 
(0.07
)
 
Lease financing
 
47

 
0.24

 
13

 
0.26

 
7

 
0.14

 
15

 
0.32

 
12

 
0.25

Total commercial
 
429

 
0.09

 
132

 
0.10

 
152

 
0.12

 
67

 
0.05

 
78

 
0.06

Consumer:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Real estate 1-4 family first mortgage
 
(88
)
 
(0.03
)
 
(22
)
 
(0.03
)
 
(25
)
 
(0.04
)
 
(23
)
 
(0.03
)
 
(18
)
 
(0.03
)
 
Real estate 1-4 family junior lien mortgage
 
(40
)
 
(0.11
)
 
(10
)
 
(0.11
)
 
(9
)
 
(0.10
)
 
(13
)
 
(0.13
)
 
(8
)
 
(0.09
)
 
Credit card
 
1,292

 
3.51

 
338

 
3.54

 
299

 
3.22

 
323

 
3.61

 
332

 
3.69

 
Automobile
 
584

 
1.21

 
133

 
1.16

 
130

 
1.10

 
113

 
0.93

 
208

 
1.64

 
Other revolving credit and installment
 
567

 
1.53

 
150

 
1.64

 
133

 
1.44

 
135

 
1.44

 
149

 
1.60

Total consumer
 
2,315

 
0.52

 
589

 
0.53

 
528

 
0.47

 
535

 
0.49

 
663

 
0.60

 
Total
 
$
2,744

 
0.29
 %
 
$
721

 
0.30
 %
 
$
680

 
0.29
 %
 
$
602

 
0.26
 %
 
$
741

 
0.32
 %
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2017
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial
 
$
492

 
0.15
 %
 
$
118

 
0.14
 %
 
$
125

 
0.15
 %
 
$
78

 
0.10
 %
 
$
171

 
0.21
 %
 
Real estate mortgage
 
(44
)
 
(0.03
)
 
(10
)
 
(0.03
)
 
(3
)
 
(0.01
)
 
(6
)
 
(0.02
)
 
(25
)
 
(0.08
)
 
Real estate construction
 
(30
)
 
(0.12
)
 
(3
)
 
(0.05
)
 
(15
)
 
(0.24
)
 
(4
)
 
(0.05
)
 
(8
)
 
(0.15
)
 
Lease financing
 
28

 
0.15

 
10

 
0.20

 
6

 
0.12

 
7

 
0.15

 
5

 
0.11

Total commercial
 
446

 
0.09

 
115

 
0.09

 
113

 
0.09

 
75

 
0.06

 
143

 
0.11

Consumer:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Real estate 1-4 family first mortgage
 
(48
)
 
(0.02
)
 
(23
)
 
(0.03
)
 
(16
)
 
(0.02
)
 
(16
)
 
(0.02
)
 
7

 
0.01

 
Real estate 1-4 family junior lien mortgage
 
13

 
0.03

 
(7
)
 
(0.06
)
 
1

 

 
(4
)
 
(0.03
)
 
23

 
0.21

 
Credit card
 
1,242

 
3.49

 
336

 
3.66

 
277

 
3.08

 
320

 
3.67

 
309

 
3.54

 
Automobile
 
683

 
1.18

 
188

 
1.38

 
202

 
1.41

 
126

 
0.86

 
167

 
1.10

 
Other revolving credit and installment
 
592

 
1.52

 
142

 
1.46

 
140

 
1.44

 
154

 
1.58

 
156

 
1.60

Total consumer
 
2,482

 
0.55

 
636

 
0.56

 
604

 
0.53

 
580

 
0.51

 
662

 
0.59

 
Total
 
$
2,928

 
0.31
 %
 
$
751

 
0.31
 %
 
$
717

 
0.30
 %
 
$
655

 
0.27
 %
 
$
805

 
0.34
 %
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(1)
Quarterly net charge-offs (recoveries) as a percentage of average respective loans are annualized.

Table 35 presents net charge-offs for the four quarters and full year of 2018 and 2017 . Net charge-offs in 2018 were $2.7 billion ( 0.29% of average total loans outstanding), compared with $2.9 billion ( 0.31% ) in 2017 .
The decrease in commercial and industrial net charge-offs in 2018 reflected continued improvement in our oil and gas portfolio. Our commercial real estate portfolios were in a net recovery position every quarter in 2018 and 2017. Total net charge-offs decreased from the prior year across all consumer portfolios, except for the credit card portfolio, which had a slight increase.

ALLOWANCE FOR CREDIT LOSSES   The allowance for credit losses, which consists of the allowance for loan losses and the allowance for unfunded credit commitments, is management’s estimate of credit losses inherent in the loan portfolio and unfunded credit commitments at the balance sheet date, excluding loans carried at fair value. The detail of the changes in the allowance for credit losses by portfolio segment (including charge-offs and recoveries by loan class) is in Note 6 (Loans and Allowance for Credit Losses) to Financial Statements in this Report.
We apply a disciplined process and methodology to establish our allowance for credit losses each quarter. This
 
process takes into consideration many factors, including historical and forecasted loss trends, loan-level credit quality ratings and loan grade-specific characteristics. The process involves subjective and complex judgments. In addition, we review a variety of credit metrics and trends. These credit metrics and trends, however, do not solely determine the amount of the allowance as we use several analytical tools. Our estimation approach for the commercial portfolio reflects the estimated probability of default in accordance with the borrower’s financial strength, and the severity of loss in the event of default, considering the quality of any underlying collateral. Probability of default and severity at the time of default are statistically derived through historical observations of defaults and losses after default within each credit risk rating. Our estimation approach for the consumer portfolio uses forecasted losses that represent our best estimate of inherent loss based on historical experience, quantitative and other mathematical techniques. For additional information on our allowance for credit losses, see the “Critical Accounting Policies – Allowance for Credit Losses” section and Note 1 (Summary of Significant Accounting Policies) and Note 6 (Loans and Allowance for Credit Losses) to Financial Statements in this Report.

92
Wells Fargo & Company
 


Table 36 presents the allocation of the allowance for credit losses by loan segment and class for the last five years.

Table 36: Allocation of the Allowance for Credit Losses (ACL)
 
Dec 31, 2018
 
 
Dec 31, 2017
 
 
Dec 31, 2016
 
 
Dec 31, 2015
 
 
Dec 31, 2014
 
 
Loans
 
 
Loans 
 
 
Loans
 
 
Loans
 
 
Loans
 
 
 
 
as %

 
 
 
as %

 
 
 
as %

 
 
 
as %

 
 
 
as %

 
 
of total
 
 
 
of total
 
 
 
of total
 
 
 
of total
 
 
 
of total
 
(in millions)
ACL

 
loans

 
ACL

 
loans

 
ACL

 
loans

 
ACL

 
loans

 
ACL

 
loans

Commercial:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial
$
3,628

 
37
%
 
$
3,752

 
35
%
 
$
4,560

 
34
%
 
$
4,231

 
33
%
 
$
3,506

 
32
%
Real estate mortgage
1,282

 
13

 
1,374

 
13

 
1,320

 
14

 
1,264

 
13

 
1,576

 
13

Real estate construction
1,200

 
2

 
1,238

 
3

 
1,294

 
2

 
1,210

 
3

 
1,097

 
2

Lease financing
307

 
2

 
268

 
2

 
220

 
2

 
167

 
1

 
198

 
1

Total commercial
6,417

 
54

 
6,632

 
53

 
7,394

 
52

 
6,872

 
50

 
6,377

 
48

Consumer:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Real estate 1-4 family first mortgage
750

 
30

 
1,085

 
30

 
1,270

 
29

 
1,895

 
30

 
2,878

 
31

Real estate 1-4 family junior lien mortgage
431

 
3

 
608

 
4

 
815

 
5

 
1,223

 
6

 
1,566

 
7

Credit card
2,064

 
4

 
1,944

 
4

 
1,605

 
4

 
1,412

 
4

 
1,271

 
4

Automobile
475

 
5

 
1,039

 
5

 
817

 
6

 
529

 
6

 
516

 
6

Other revolving credit and installment
570

 
4

 
652

 
4

 
639

 
4

 
581

 
4

 
561

 
4

Total consumer
4,290

 
46

 
5,328

 
47

 
5,146

 
48

 
5,640

 
50

 
6,792

 
52

Total
$
10,707

 
100
%
 
$
11,960

 
100
%
 
$
12,540

 
100
%
 
$
12,512

 
100
%
 
$
13,169

 
100
%
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Dec 31, 2018
 
 
Dec 31, 2017
 
 
Dec 31, 2016
 
 
Dec 31, 2015
 
 
Dec 31, 2014
 
Components:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Allowance for loan losses
$
9,775
 
 
11,004
 
 
11,419
 
 
11,545
 
 
12,319
 
Allowance for unfunded credit commitments
932
 
 
956
 
 
1,121
 
 
967
 
 
850
 
Allowance for credit losses
$
10,707
 

11,960
 
 
12,540
 
 
12,512
 
 
13,169
 
Allowance for loan losses as a percentage of total loans
 
1.03
%
 
 
1.15

 
 
1.18

 
 
1.26

 
 
1.43

Allowance for loan losses as a percentage of total net charge-offs
 
356

 
 
376

 
 
324

 
 
399

 
 
418

Allowance for credit losses as a percentage of total loans
 
1.12

 
 
1.25

 
 
1.30

 
 
1.37

 
 
1.53

Allowance for credit losses as a percentage of total nonaccrual loans (1)
 
165

 
 
156

 
 
126

 
 
115

 
 
107

(1)
Financial information for periods prior to December 31, 2018, has been revised to exclude MLHFS, LHFS and loans held at fair value from nonaccrual loans.
In addition to the allowance for credit losses, there was $480 million at December 31, 2018 , and $474 million at December 31, 2017 , of nonaccretable difference to absorb losses for PCI loans, which totaled $5.0 billion at December 31, 2018 . The allowance for credit losses is lower than otherwise would have been required without PCI loan accounting. As a result of PCI loans, certain ratios of the Company may not be directly comparable with credit-related metrics for other financial institutions. Additionally, loans purchased at fair value, including loans from the GE Capital business acquisitions in 2016, generally reflect a lifetime credit loss adjustment and therefore do not initially require additions to the allowance as is typically associated with loan growth. For additional information on PCI loans, see the “Risk Management – Credit Risk Management – Purchased Credit-Impaired Loans” section, Note 1 (Summary of Significant Accounting Policies) and Note 6 (Loans and Allowance for Credit Losses) to Financial Statements in this Report. 
The ratio of the allowance for credit losses to total nonaccrual loans may fluctuate significantly from period to period due to such factors as the mix of loan types in the
 
portfolio, borrower credit strength and the value and marketability of collateral.
The allowance for credit losses decreased $1.3 billion , or 10% , in 2018 , due to continued improvement in the credit quality of our residential real estate portfolios and a decrease in allowance for our automobile portfolio reflecting an improvement in our outlook for hurricane-related losses in Puerto Rico, partially offset by an increase in allowance for the credit card portfolio. Total provision for credit losses was $1.7 billion in 2018 , $2.5 billion in 2017 , and $3.8 billion in 2016 . The provision for credit losses was $1.0 billion less than net charge-offs in 2018 , reflecting the same changes mentioned above for the allowance for credit losses, compared with $400 million less than net charge-offs in 2017. The 2016 provision was $250 million more than net charge-offs.
We believe the allowance for credit losses of $10.7 billion at December 31, 2018 , was appropriate to cover credit losses inherent in the loan portfolio, including unfunded credit commitments, at that date. The entire allowance is available to absorb credit losses inherent in the total loan portfolio. The allowance for credit losses is subject to change and reflects

 
Wells Fargo & Company
93


Risk Management – Credit Risk Management ( continued )

existing factors as of the date of determination, including economic or market conditions and ongoing internal and external examination processes. Due to the sensitivity of the allowance for credit losses to changes in the economic and business environment, it is possible that we will incur incremental credit losses not anticipated as of the balance sheet date. Future allowance levels will be based on a variety of factors, including loan growth, portfolio performance and general economic conditions. Our process for determining the allowance for credit losses is discussed in the “Critical Accounting Policies – Allowance for Credit Losses” section and Note 1 (Summary of Significant Accounting Policies) to Financial Statements in this Report.

LIABILITY FOR MORTGAGE LOAN REPURCHASE LOSSES 
We sell residential mortgage loans to various parties, including (1) government-sponsored entities (GSEs) Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation (FHLMC) and Federal National Mortgage Association (FNMA) who include the mortgage loans in GSE-guaranteed mortgage securitizations, (2) SPEs that issue private label MBS, and (3) other financial institutions that purchase mortgage loans for investment or private label securitization. In addition, we pool FHA-insured and VA-guaranteed mortgage loans that are then used to back securities guaranteed by the Government National Mortgage Association (GNMA). We may be required to repurchase these mortgage loans, indemnify the securitization trust, investor or insurer, or reimburse the securitization trust, investor or insurer for credit losses incurred on loans (collectively, repurchase) in the event of a breach of contractual representations or warranties that is not remedied within a period (usually 90 days or less) after we receive notice of the breach.
In connection with our sales and securitization of residential mortgage loans to various parties, we have established a mortgage repurchase liability, initially at fair value, related to various representations and warranties that reflect management’s estimate of losses for loans for which we could have a repurchase obligation, whether or not we currently service those loans, based on a combination of factors. Our mortgage repurchase liability estimation process also incorporates a forecast of repurchase demands associated with mortgage insurance rescission activity.
The overall level of unresolved repurchase demands and mortgage insurance rescissions outstanding at December 31, 2018 , was $49 million , representing 230 loans, down from $108 million , or 482 loans, a year ago both in number of outstanding loans and in total dollar balances. The decrease was predominantly due to private investor demands resolved in third quarter 2018.
Customary with industry practice, we have the right of recourse against correspondent lenders from whom we have purchased loans with respect to representations and warranties. Historical recovery rates as well as projected lender performance are incorporated in the establishment of our mortgage repurchase liability.
We do not typically receive repurchase requests from GNMA, FHA and the Department of Housing and Urban Development (HUD) or VA. As an originator of an FHA-insured or VA-guaranteed loan, we are responsible for obtaining the insurance with the FHA or the guarantee with the VA. To the extent we are not able to obtain the insurance or the guarantee we must request permission to repurchase the loan from the GNMA pool. Such repurchases from GNMA pools typically represent a self-initiated process upon discovery of the uninsurable loan (usually within 180 days from funding of the
 
loan). Alternatively, in lieu of repurchasing loans from GNMA pools, we may be asked by FHA/HUD or the VA to indemnify them (as applicable) for defects found in the Post Endorsement Technical Review process or audits performed by FHA/HUD or the VA. The Post Endorsement Technical Review is a process whereby HUD performs underwriting audits of closed/insured FHA loans for potential deficiencies. Our liability for mortgage loan repurchase losses incorporates probable losses associated with such indemnification.

RISKS RELATING TO SERVICING ACTIVITIES   In addition to servicing loans in our portfolio, we act as servicer and/or master servicer of residential mortgage loans included in GSE-guaranteed mortgage securitizations, GNMA-guaranteed mortgage securitizations of FHA-insured/VA-guaranteed mortgages and private label mortgage securitizations, as well as for unsecuritized loans owned by institutional investors. The following discussion summarizes the primary duties and requirements of servicing and related industry developments.
The loans we service were originated by us or by other mortgage loan originators. As servicer, our primary duties are typically to (1) collect payments due from borrowers, (2) advance certain delinquent payments of principal and interest on the mortgage loans, (3) maintain and administer any hazard, title or primary mortgage insurance policies relating to the mortgage loans, (4) maintain any required escrow accounts for payment of taxes and insurance and administer escrow payments, (5) foreclose on defaulted mortgage loans or, to the extent consistent with the related servicing agreement, consider alternatives to foreclosure, such as loan modifications or short sales, and (6) for loans sold into private label securitizations, manage the foreclosed property through liquidation. As master servicer, our primary duties are typically to (1) supervise, monitor and oversee the servicing of the mortgage loans by the servicer, (2) consult with each servicer and use reasonable efforts to cause the servicer to observe its servicing obligations, (3) prepare monthly distribution statements to security holders and, if required by the securitization documents, certain periodic reports required to be filed with the SEC, (4) if required by the securitization documents, calculate distributions and loss allocations on the mortgage-backed securities, (5) prepare tax and information returns of the securitization trust, and (6) advance amounts required by non-affiliated servicers who fail to perform their advancing obligations.
Each agreement under which we act as servicer or master servicer generally specifies a standard of responsibility for actions we take in such capacity and provides protection against expenses and liabilities we incur when acting in compliance with the specified standard. For example, private label securitization agreements under which we act as servicer or master servicer typically provide that the servicer and the master servicer are entitled to indemnification by the securitization trust for taking action or refraining from taking action in good faith or for errors in judgment. However, we are not indemnified, but rather are required to indemnify the securitization trustee, against any failure by us, as servicer or master servicer, to perform our servicing obligations or against any of our acts or omissions that involve willful misfeasance, bad faith or gross negligence in the performance of, or reckless disregard of, our duties. In addition, if we commit a material breach of our obligations as servicer or master servicer, we may be subject to termination if the breach is not cured within a specified period following notice, which can generally be given by the securitization trustee or a specified percentage of security holders. Whole loan sale contracts under which we act as servicer generally include similar provisions

94
Wells Fargo & Company
 


with respect to our actions as servicer. The standards governing servicing in GSE-guaranteed securitizations, and the possible remedies for violations of such standards, vary, and those standards and remedies are determined by servicing guides maintained by the GSEs, contracts between the GSEs and individual servicers and topical guides published by the GSEs from time to time. Such remedies could include indemnification or repurchase of an affected mortgage loan. In addition, in connection with our servicing activities, we could become subject to consent orders and settlement agreements with federal and state regulators for alleged servicing issues and practices. In general, these can require us to provide customers with loan modification relief, refinancing relief, and foreclosure prevention and assistance, as well as can impose certain monetary penalties on us.

Asset/Liability Management
Asset/liability management involves evaluating, monitoring and managing interest rate risk, market risk, liquidity and funding. Primary oversight of interest rate risk and market risk resides with the Finance Committee of our Board of Directors (Board), which oversees the administration and effectiveness of financial risk management policies and processes used to assess and manage these risks. Primary oversight of liquidity and funding resides with the Risk Committee of the Board. At the management level we utilize a Corporate Asset/Liability Management Committee (Corporate ALCO), which consists of senior financial, risk, and business executives, to oversee these risks and report on them periodically to the Board’s Finance Committee and Risk Committee as appropriate. As discussed in more detail for market risk activities below, we employ separate management level oversight specific to market risk.
 
INTEREST RATE RISK Interest rate risk, which potentially can have a significant earnings impact, is an integral part of being a financial intermediary. We are subject to interest rate risk because:
assets and liabilities may mature or reprice at different times (for example, if assets reprice faster than liabilities and interest rates are generally rising, earnings will initially increase);
assets and liabilities may reprice at the same time but by different amounts (for example, when the general level of interest rates is rising, we may increase rates paid on checking and savings deposit accounts by an amount that is less than the general rise in market interest rates);
short-term and long-term market interest rates may change by different amounts (for example, the shape of the yield curve may affect new loan yields and funding costs differently);
the remaining maturity of various assets or liabilities may shorten or lengthen as interest rates change (for example, if long-term mortgage interest rates increase sharply, MBS held in the debt securities portfolio may pay down slower than anticipated, which could impact portfolio income); or

 
interest rates may also have a direct or indirect effect on loan demand, collateral values, credit losses, mortgage origination volume, the fair value of MSRs and other financial instruments, the value of the pension liability and other items affecting earnings.
 
We assess interest rate risk by comparing outcomes under various net interest income simulations using many interest rate scenarios that differ in the direction of interest rate changes, the degree of change over time, the speed of change and the projected shape of the yield curve. These simulations require assumptions regarding drivers of earnings and balance sheet composition such as loan originations, prepayment speeds on loans and debt securities, deposit flows and mix, as well as pricing strategies.
Currently, our profile is such that we project net interest income will benefit modestly from higher interest rates as our assets would reprice faster and to a greater degree than our liabilities, while in the case of lower interest rates, our assets would reprice downward and to a greater degree than our liabilities.
Our most recent simulations estimate net interest income sensitivity over the next two years under a range of both lower and higher interest rates. Measured impacts from standardized ramps (gradual changes) and shocks (instantaneous changes) are summarized in Table 37 , indicating net interest income sensitivity relative to the Company’s base net interest income plan. Ramp scenarios assume interest rates move gradually in parallel across the yield curve relative to the base scenario in year one, and the full amount of the ramp is held as a constant differential to the base scenario in year two. The following describes the simulation assumptions for the scenarios presented in Table 37 :
Simulations are dynamic and reflect anticipated growth across assets and liabilities.
Other macroeconomic variables that could be correlated with the changes in interest rates are held constant.
Mortgage prepayment and origination assumptions vary across scenarios and reflect only the impact of the higher or lower interest rates.
Our base scenario deposit forecast incorporates mix changes consistent with the base interest rate trajectory. Deposit mix is modeled to be the same as in the base scenario across the alternative scenarios. In higher interest rate scenarios, customer activity that shifts balances into higher-yielding products could reduce expected net interest income.
We hold the size of the projected debt and equity securities portfolios constant across scenarios.


 
Wells Fargo & Company
95


Risk Management – Asset/Liability Management ( continued )

Table 37: Net Interest Income Sensitivity Over Next Two-Year Horizon Relative to Base Expectation
 
 
 
Lower Rates
 
Higher Rates
($ in billions)
Base
 
100 bps
Ramp
Parallel
 Decrease
 
100 bps Instantaneous
Parallel
Increase
 
200 bps
Ramp
Parallel
Increase
First Year of Forecasting Horizon
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net Interest Income Sensitivity to Base Scenario
 
$
(0.9) - (0.4)
 
0.9 - 1.4
 
0.9 - 1.4
Key Rates at Horizon End
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Fed Funds Target
3.00
%
2.00
 
4.00
 
5.00
10-year CMT (1)
3.72
 
2.72
 
4.72
 
5.72
Second Year of Forecasting Horizon
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net Interest Income Sensitivity to Base Scenario
 
$
(1.7) - (1.2)
 
1.4 - 1.9
 
2.3 - 2.8
Key Rates at Horizon End
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Fed Funds Target
3.00
%
2.00
 
4.00
 
5.00
10-year CMT (1)
4.01
 
3.01
 
5.01
 
6.01
(1)
U.S. Constant Maturity Treasury Rate
The sensitivity results above do not capture interest rate sensitive noninterest income and expense impacts. Our interest rate sensitive noninterest income and expense is predominantly driven by mortgage activity, and may move in the opposite direction of our net interest income. Typically, in response to higher interest rates, mortgage activity, primarily refinancing activity, generally declines. And in response to lower interest rates, mortgage activity generally increases. Mortgage results are also impacted by the valuation of MSRs and related hedge positions. See the “Risk Management – Asset/Liability Management – Mortgage Banking Interest Rate and Market Risk” section in this Report for more information.
Interest rate sensitive noninterest income also results from changes in earnings credit for noninterest-bearing deposits that reduce treasury management deposit service fees. Furthermore, for the trading portfolio, interest rate changes may result in net interest income compression (generally as interest rates rise) or expansion (generally as interest rates fall) that does not reflect the offsetting effects of certain economic hedges. Instead, as a result of GAAP requirements, the effects of such economic hedges are recorded in noninterest income.
We use the debt securities portfolio and exchange-traded and over-the-counter (OTC) interest rate derivatives to hedge our interest rate exposures. See the “Balance Sheet Analysis – Available-for-Sale and Held-to-Maturity Debt Securities” section in this Report for more information on the use of the available-for-sale and held-to-maturity securities portfolios. The notional or contractual amount, credit risk amount and fair value of the derivatives used to hedge our interest rate risk exposures as of December 31, 2018 , and December 31, 2017 , are presented in Note 17 (Derivatives) to Financial Statements in this Report. We use derivatives for asset/liability management in two main ways:
to convert the cash flows from selected asset and/or liability instruments/portfolios including investments, commercial loans and long-term debt, from fixed-rate payments to floating-rate payments, or vice versa; and
to economically hedge our mortgage origination pipeline, funded mortgage loans and MSRs using interest rate swaps, swaptions, futures, forwards and options.

 
MORTGAGE BANKING INTEREST RATE AND MARKET RISK  We originate, fund and service mortgage loans, which subjects us to various risks, including credit, liquidity and interest rate risks. Based on market conditions and other factors, we reduce credit and liquidity risks by selling or securitizing a majority of the long-term fixed-rate mortgage and ARM loans we originate. On the other hand, we may hold originated ARMs and fixed-rate mortgage loans in our loan portfolio as an investment for our deposits. We determine whether the loans will be held for investment or held for sale at the time of commitment. We may subsequently change our intent to hold loans for investment and sell some or all of our ARMs or fixed-rate mortgages as part of our corporate asset/liability management. We may also acquire and add to our securities available for sale a portion of the securities issued at the time we securitize MLHFS.
Interest rate and market risk can be substantial in the mortgage business. Changes in interest rates may potentially reduce total origination and servicing fees, the value of our residential MSRs measured at fair value, the value of MLHFS and the associated income and loss reflected in mortgage banking noninterest income, the income and expense associated with instruments (economic hedges) used to hedge changes in the fair value of MSRs and MLHFS, and the value of derivative loan commitments (interest rate “locks”) extended to mortgage applicants.
Interest rates affect the amount and timing of origination and servicing fees because consumer demand for new mortgages and the level of refinancing activity are sensitive to changes in mortgage interest rates. Typically, a decline in mortgage interest rates will lead to an increase in mortgage originations and fees and may also lead to an increase in servicing fee income, depending on the level of new loans added to the servicing portfolio and prepayments. Given the time it takes for consumer behavior to fully react to interest rate changes, as well as the time required for processing a new application, providing the commitment, and securitizing and selling the loan, interest rate changes will affect origination and servicing fees with a lag. The amount and timing of the impact on origination and servicing fees will depend on the magnitude, speed and duration of the change in interest rates.
We measure originations of MLHFS at fair value where an active secondary market and readily available market prices exist to reliably support fair value pricing models used for these loans. Loan origination fees on these loans are recorded when earned, and related direct loan origination costs are recognized when incurred. We also measure at fair value certain of our other interests held related to residential loan sales and securitizations. We believe fair value measurement for MLHFS and other interests held, which we hedge with free-standing derivatives (economic hedges) along with our MSRs measured at fair value, reduces certain timing differences and better matches changes in the value of these assets with changes in the value of derivatives used as economic hedges for these assets. During 2016, 2017, and 2018, in response to continued secondary market illiquidity, as well as our desire to retain high quality loans on our balance sheet, we continued to originate certain prime non-agency loans to be substantially held for investment. We did however designate a small portion of our non-agency originations in 2018 to MLHFS in support of future issuances of private label residential mortgage backed securities (RMBS). We issued $441 million of RMBS in fourth quarter 2018.
We initially measure all of our MSRs at fair value and carry substantially all of them at fair value depending on our strategy for managing interest rate risk. Under this method, the MSRs are recorded at fair value at the time we sell or securitize the

96
Wells Fargo & Company
 


related mortgage loans. The carrying value of MSRs carried at fair value reflects changes in fair value at the end of each quarter and changes are included in net servicing income, a component of mortgage banking noninterest income. If the fair value of the MSRs increases, income is recognized; if the fair value of the MSRs decreases, a loss is recognized. We use a dynamic and sophisticated model to estimate the fair value of our MSRs and periodically benchmark our estimates to independent appraisals. The valuation of MSRs can be highly subjective and involve complex judgments by management about matters that are inherently unpredictable. See “Critical Accounting Policies – Valuation of Residential Mortgage Servicing Rights” section in this Report for additional information. Changes in interest rates influence a variety of significant assumptions included in the periodic valuation of MSRs, including prepayment speeds, expected returns and potential risks on the servicing asset portfolio, the value of escrow balances and other servicing valuation elements.
An increase in interest rates generally reduces the propensity for refinancing, extends the expected duration of the servicing portfolio and, therefore, increases the estimated fair value of the MSRs. However, an increase in interest rates can also reduce mortgage loan demand and, therefore, reduce origination income. A decline in interest rates generally increases the propensity for refinancing, reduces the expected duration of the servicing portfolio and therefore reduces the estimated fair value of MSRs. This reduction in fair value causes a charge to income for MSRs carried at fair value, net of any gains on free-standing derivatives (economic hedges) used to hedge MSRs. We may choose not to fully hedge the entire potential decline in the value of our MSRs resulting from a decline in interest rates because the potential increase in origination/servicing fees in that scenario provides a partial “natural business hedge.”
The price risk associated with our MSRs is economically hedged with a combination of highly liquid interest rate forward instruments including mortgage forward contracts, interest rate swaps and interest rate options. All of the instruments included in the hedge are marked to fair value daily. Because the hedging instruments are traded in predominantly highly liquid markets, their prices are readily observable and are fully reflected in each quarter’s mark to market. Quarterly MSR hedging results include a combination of directional gain or loss due to market changes as well as any carry income generated. If the economic hedge is effective, its overall directional hedge gain or loss will offset the change in the valuation of the underlying MSR asset. Gains or losses associated with these economic hedges are included in mortgage banking noninterest income. Consistent with our longstanding approach to hedging interest rate risk in the mortgage business, the size of the hedge and the particular combination of forward hedging instruments at any point in time is designed to reduce the volatility of the mortgage business’s earnings over various time frames within a range of mortgage interest rates. Because market factors, the composition of the mortgage servicing portfolio and the relationship between the origination and servicing sides of our mortgage business change continually, the types of instruments used in our hedging are reviewed daily and rebalanced based on our evaluation of current market factors and the interest rate risk inherent in our MSRs portfolio. Throughout 2018 , our economic hedging strategy generally used forward mortgage purchase contracts that were effective at offsetting the impact of interest rates on the value of the MSR asset.
Mortgage forward contracts are designed to pass the full economics of the underlying reference mortgage securities to the
 
holder of the contract, including both the directional gain and loss from the forward delivery of the reference securities and the corresponding carry income. Carry income represents the contract’s price accretion from the forward delivery price to the spot price including both the yield earned on the reference securities and the market implied cost of financing during the period. The actual amount of carry income earned on the hedge each quarter will depend on the amount of the underlying asset that is hedged and the particular instruments included in the hedge. The level of carry income is driven by the slope of the yield curve and other market driven supply and demand factors affecting the specific reference securities. A steep yield curve generally produces higher carry income while a flat or inverted yield curve can result in lower or potentially negative carry income. The level of carry income is also affected by the type of instrument used. In general, mortgage forward contracts tend to produce higher carry income than interest rate swap contracts. Carry income is recognized over the life of the mortgage forward as a component of the contract’s mark to market gain or loss.
Hedging the various sources of interest rate risk in mortgage banking is a complex process that requires sophisticated modeling and constant monitoring. While we attempt to balance these various aspects of the mortgage business, there are several potential risks to earnings:
Valuation changes for MSRs associated with interest rate changes are recorded in earnings immediately within the accounting period in which those interest rate changes occur, whereas the impact of those same changes in interest rates on origination and servicing fees occur with a lag and over time. Thus, the mortgage business could be protected from adverse changes in interest rates over a period of time on a cumulative basis but still display large variations in income from one accounting period to the next.
The degree to which our net gains on loan originations offsets valuation changes for MSRs is imperfect, varies at different points in the interest rate cycle, and depends not just on the direction of interest rates but on the pattern of quarterly interest rate changes.
Origination volumes, the valuation of MSRs and hedging results and associated costs are also affected by many factors. Such factors include the mix of new business between ARMs and fixed-rate mortgages, the relationship between short-term and long-term interest rates, the degree of volatility in interest rates, the relationship between mortgage interest rates and other interest rate markets, and other interest rate factors. Additional factors that can impact the valuation of the MSRs include changes in servicing and foreclosure costs due to changes in investor or regulatory guidelines, as well as individual state foreclosure legislation, and changes in discount rates due to market participants requiring a higher return due to updated market expectations on costs and risks associated with investing in MSRs. Many of these factors are hard to predict and we may not be able to directly or perfectly hedge their effect.
While our hedging activities are designed to balance our mortgage banking interest rate risks, the financial instruments we use may not perfectly correlate with the values and income being hedged. For example, the change in the value of ARM production held for sale from changes in mortgage interest rates may or may not be fully offset by index-based financial instruments used as economic hedges for such ARMs. Additionally, hedge-carry income on our economic hedges for the MSRs may not continue at recent levels if the spread between short-term and long-term

 
Wells Fargo & Company
97


Risk Management – Asset/Liability Management ( continued )

interest rates decreases, the overall level of hedges changes as interest rates change, or there are other changes in the market for mortgage forwards that affect the implied carry.

The total carrying value of our residential and commercial MSRs was $16.1 billion and $15.0 billion at December 31, 2018 and 2017 , respectively. The weighted-average note rate on our portfolio of loans serviced for others was 4.32% and 4.23% at December 31, 2018 and 2017 , respectively. The carrying value of our total MSRs represented 0.94% and 0.88% of mortgage loans serviced for others at December 31, 2018 and 2017 , respectively.
As part of our mortgage banking activities, we enter into commitments to fund residential mortgage loans at specified times in the future. A mortgage loan commitment can be either a floating rate commitment, where the interest rate is not yet determined, or it can be an interest rate lock that binds us to lend funds to a potential borrower at a specified interest rate and within a specified period of time, generally up to 60 days after inception of the rate lock. These loan commitments are derivative loan commitments if the loans that will result from the exercise of the commitments will be held for sale. These derivative loan commitments are recognized at fair value on the balance sheet with changes in their fair values recorded as part of mortgage banking noninterest income. The fair value of these commitments include, at inception and during the life of the loan commitment, the expected net future cash flows related to the associated servicing of the loan as part of the fair value measurement of derivative loan commitments. Changes subsequent to inception are based on changes in fair value of the underlying loan resulting from the exercise of the commitment and changes in the probability that the loan will not fund within the terms of the commitment, referred to as a fall-out factor. The value of the underlying loan commitment is affected by changes in interest rates and the passage of time.
Outstanding derivative loan commitments (interest rate “locks”) expose us to the risk that the price of the mortgage loans underlying the commitments might decline due to increases in mortgage interest rates from inception of the rate lock to the funding of the loan. To minimize this risk, we employ mortgage forwards and options and Eurodollar futures and options contracts as economic hedges against the potential decreases in the values of the loans. We expect that these derivative financial instruments will experience changes in fair value that will either fully or partially offset the changes in fair value of the derivative loan commitments. However, changes in investor demand, such as concerns about credit risk, can also cause changes in the spread relationships between underlying loan value and the derivative financial instruments that cannot be hedged.

MARKET RISK Market risk is the risk of possible economic loss from adverse changes in market risk factors such as interest rates, credit spreads, foreign exchange rates, equity and commodity prices, and the risk of possible loss due to counterparty risk. This includes implied volatility risk, basis risk, and market liquidity risk. Market risk also includes counterparty credit risk, price risk in the trading book, mortgage servicing rights and the associated hedge effectiveness risk associated with the mortgage book, and impairment on private equity investments.
 
The Board’s Finance Committee has primary oversight responsibility for market risk and oversees the Company’s market risk exposure and market risk management strategies. In addition, the Board’s Risk Committee has certain oversight responsibilities with respect to market risk, including adjusting the Company’s market risk appetite with input from the Finance Committee. The Finance Committee also reports key market risk matters to the Risk Committee.
At the management level, the Market and Counterparty Risk Management function, which is part of Corporate Risk, has primary oversight responsibility for market risk. The Market and Counterparty Risk Management function reports into the CRO and also provides periodic reporting related to market risk to the Board’s Finance Committee. In addition, the Risk & Control Committee for each business group and enterprise function reports market risk matters to the Enterprise Risk & Control Committee.

MARKET RISK – TRADING ACTIVITIES  We engage in trading activities to accommodate the investment and risk management activities of our customers and to execute economic hedging to manage certain balance sheet risks. These trading activities predominantly occur within our Wholesale Banking businesses and to a lesser extent other divisions of the Company. Debt securities held for trading, equity securities held for trading, trading loans and trading derivatives are financial instruments used in our trading activities, and all are carried at fair value. Income earned on the financial instruments used in our trading activities include net interest income, changes in fair value and realized gains and losses. Net interest income earned from our trading activities is reflected in the interest income and interest expense components of our income statement. Changes in fair value of the financial instruments used in our trading activities are reflected in net gains on trading activities, a component of noninterest income in our income statement. For more information on the financial instruments used in our trading activities and the income from these trading activities, see Note 4 (Trading Activities) to Financial Statements in this Report.
Value-at-risk (VaR) is a statistical measure used to estimate the potential loss from adverse moves in the financial markets. The Company uses VaR metrics complemented with sensitivity analysis and stress testing in measuring and monitoring market risk. These market risk measures are monitored at both the business unit level and at aggregated levels on a daily basis. Our corporate market risk management function aggregates and monitors all exposures to ensure risk measures are within our established risk appetite. Changes to the market risk profile are analyzed and reported on a daily basis. The Company monitors various market risk exposure measures from a variety of perspectives, including line of business, product, risk type, and legal entity.
Trading VaR is the measure used to provide insight into the market risk exhibited by the Company’s trading positions. The
Company calculates Trading VaR for risk management purposes to establish line of business and Company-wide risk limits. Trading VaR is calculated based on all trading positions on our balance sheet.

98
Wells Fargo & Company
 


Table 38 shows the Company’s Trading General VaR by risk category. As presented in Table 38 , average Company Trading General VaR was $16 million for the quarter ended December 31, 2018, compared with $12 million for the quarter ended September 30, 2018, and $13 million for the quarter ended
 
December 31, 2017. The increase in average Company Trading General VaR for the quarter ended December 31, 2018, was mainly driven by changes in portfolio composition.
Table 38: Trading 1-Day 99% General VaR by Risk Category
 
Quarter ended
 
 
December 31, 2018
 
 
September 30, 2018
 
 
December 31, 2017
 
(in millions)
Period 
end 

 
Average 

 
Low 

 
High 

 
Period
end 

 
Average 

 
Low 

 
High 

 
Period
end 

 
Average 

 
Low 

 
High 

Company Trading General VaR Risk Categories
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Credit
$
18

 
16

 
13

 
24

 
13

 
17

 
11

 
55

 
12

 
16

 
11

 
28

Interest rate
28

 
20

 
14

 
28

 
18

 
18

 
6

 
52

 
13

 
10

 
6

 
17

Equity
5

 
5

 
2

 
7

 
5

 
5

 
4

 
7

 
10

 
11

 
10

 
14

Commodity
2

 
2

 
1

 
4

 
2

 
1

 
1

 
2

 
1

 
1

 
1

 
2

Foreign exchange
1

 
1

 
0

 
2

 
0

 
1

 
0

 
1

 
0

 
0

 
0

 
1

Diversification benefit (1)
(33
)
 
(28
)
 


 

 
(25
)
 
(30
)
 


 


 
(24
)
 
(25
)
 
 
 
 
Company Trading General VaR
$
21

 
16

 
 
 
 
 
13

 
12

 


 


 
12

 
13

 
 
 
 
(1)
The period-end VaR was less than the sum of the VaR components described above, which is due to portfolio diversification. The diversification effect arises because the risks are not perfectly correlated causing a portfolio of positions to usually be less risky than the sum of the risks of the positions alone. The diversification benefit is not meaningful for low and high metrics since they may occur on different days.

Sensitivity Analysis Given the inherent limitations of the VaR models, the Company uses other measures, including sensitivity analysis, to measure and monitor risk. Sensitivity analysis is the measure of exposure to a single risk factor, such as a 0.01% increase in interest rates or a 1% increase in equity prices. We conduct and monitor sensitivity on interest rates, credit spreads, volatility, equity, commodity, and foreign exchange exposure. Sensitivity analysis complements VaR as it provides an indication of risk relative to each factor irrespective of historical market moves.

Stress Testing While VaR captures the risk of loss due to adverse changes in markets using recent historical market data, stress testing is designed to capture the Company’s exposure to extreme but low probability market movements. Stress scenarios estimate the risk of losses based on management’s assumptions of abnormal but severe market movements such as severe credit spread widening or a large decline in equity prices. These scenarios assume that the market moves happen instantaneously and no repositioning or hedging activity takes place to mitigate losses as events unfold (a conservative approach since experience demonstrates otherwise).
An inventory of scenarios is maintained representing both historical and hypothetical stress events that affect a broad range of market risk factors with varying degrees of correlation and differing time horizons. Hypothetical scenarios assess the impact of large movements in financial variables on portfolio values. Typical examples include a 1% (100 basis point) increase across the yield curve or a 10% decline in equity market indexes. Historical scenarios utilize an event-driven approach: the stress scenarios are based on plausible but rare events, and the analysis addresses how these events might affect the risk factors relevant to a portfolio.
The Company’s stress testing framework is also used in calculating results in support of the Federal Reserve Board’s Comprehensive Capital Analysis and Review (CCAR) and internal stress tests. Stress scenarios are regularly reviewed and updated to address potential market events or concerns. For
 
more detail on the CCAR process, see the “Capital Management” section in this Report.

MARKET RISK – EQUITY SECURITIES We are directly and indirectly affected by changes in the equity markets. We make and manage direct investments in start-up businesses, emerging growth companies, management buy-outs, acquisitions and corporate recapitalizations. We also invest in non-affiliated funds that make similar private equity investments. These private equity investments are made within capital allocations approved by management and the Board. The Board’s policy is to review business developments, key risks and historical returns for the private equity investment portfolio at least annually. Management reviews these investments at least quarterly and assesses them for possible OTTI. For nonmarketable equity securities, the analysis is based on facts and circumstances of each individual investment and the expectations for that investment’s cash flows and capital needs, the viability of its business model and our exit strategy. Investments in nonmarketable equity securities include private equity investments accounted for under the equity method, fair value through net income, and the measurement alternative.
In conjunction with the March 2008 initial public offering (IPO) of Visa, Inc. (Visa), we received approximately 20.7 million shares of Visa Class B common stock, the class which was apportioned to member banks of Visa at the time of the IPO. To manage our exposure to Visa and realize the value of the appreciated Visa shares, we incrementally sold these shares through a series of sales, thereby eliminating this position as of September 30, 2015. As part of these sales, we agreed to compensate the buyer for any additional contributions to a litigation settlement fund for the litigation matters associated with the Class B shares we sold. Our exposure to this retained litigation risk has been updated quarterly and is reflected on our balance sheet. For additional information about the associated litigation matters, see the “Interchange Litigation” section in Note 16 (Legal Actions) to Financial Statements in this Report.

 
Wells Fargo & Company
99


Risk Management – Asset/Liability Management ( continued )

As part of our business to support our customers, we trade public equities, listed/OTC equity derivatives and convertible bonds. We have parameters that govern these activities. We also have marketable equity securities that include investments relating to our venture capital activities. We manage these marketable equity securities within capital risk limits approved by management and the Board and monitored by Corporate ALCO and the Market Risk Committee. The fair value changes in these marketable equity securities are recognized in net income. For more information, see Note 8 (Equity Securities) to Financial Statements in this Report.
Changes in equity market prices may also indirectly affect our net income by (1) the value of third-party assets under management and, hence, fee income, (2) borrowers whose ability to repay principal and/or interest may be affected by the stock market, or (3) brokerage activity, related commission income and other business activities. Each business line monitors and manages these indirect risks.
LIQUIDITY AND FUNDING  The objective of effective liquidity management is to ensure that we can meet customer loan requests, customer deposit maturities/withdrawals and other cash commitments efficiently under both normal operating conditions and under periods of Wells Fargo-specific and/or market stress. To achieve this objective, the Board of Directors establishes liquidity guidelines that require sufficient asset-based liquidity to cover potential funding requirements and to avoid over-dependence on volatile, less reliable funding markets. These guidelines are monitored on a monthly basis by the Corporate ALCO and on a quarterly basis by the Board of Directors. These guidelines are established and monitored for both the consolidated company and for the Parent on a stand-alone basis to ensure that the Parent is a source of strength for its regulated, deposit-taking banking subsidiaries.

Liquidity Standards In September 2014, the FRB, OCC and FDIC issued a final rule that implements a quantitative liquidity requirement consistent with the liquidity coverage ratio (LCR) established by the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision (BCBS). The rule requires banking institutions, such as Wells Fargo, to hold high-quality liquid assets (HQLA), such as central bank reserves and government and corporate debt that can be converted easily and quickly into cash, in an amount equal to or greater than its projected net cash outflows during a 30-day stress period. The rule is applicable to the Company on a consolidated basis and to our insured depository institutions with total assets greater than $10 billion. In addition, the FRB finalized rules imposing enhanced liquidity management standards on large bank holding companies (BHC) such as Wells Fargo, and has finalized a rule that requires large bank holding companies to publicly disclose on a quarterly basis certain quantitative and qualitative information regarding their LCR calculations.
 
The FRB, OCC and FDIC have proposed a rule that would implement a stable funding requirement, the net stable funding ratio (NSFR), which would require large banking organizations, such as Wells Fargo, to maintain a sufficient amount of stable funding in relation to their assets, derivative exposures and commitments over a one-year horizon period.

Liquidity Coverage Ratio As of December 31, 2018 , the consolidated Company and Wells Fargo Bank, N.A. were above the minimum LCR requirement of 100%, which is calculated as HQLA divided by projected net cash outflows, as each is defined under the LCR rule. Table 39 presents the Company’s quarterly average values for the daily-calculated LCR and its components calculated pursuant to the LCR rule requirements.

Table 39: Liquidity Coverage Ratio
(in millions, except ratio)
Average for Quarter ended December 31, 2018
 
HQLA (1)(2)
$
366,578

Projected net cash outflows
303,158

LCR
 
121
%
(1) Excludes excess HQLA at Wells Fargo Bank, N.A.
(2) Net of applicable haircuts required under the LCR rule.

Liquidity Sources We maintain liquidity in the form of cash, cash equivalents and unencumbered high-quality, liquid debt securities. These assets make up our primary sources of liquidity which are presented in Table 40 . Our primary sources of liquidity are substantially the same in composition as HQLA under the LCR rule; however, our primary sources of liquidity will generally exceed HQLA calculated under the LCR rule due to the applicable haircuts to HQLA and the exclusion of excess HQLA at our subsidiary insured depository institutions required under the LCR rule.
Our cash is predominantly on deposit with the Federal Reserve. Debt securities included as part of our primary sources of liquidity are comprised of U.S. Treasury and federal agency debt, and mortgage-backed securities issued by federal agencies within our debt securities portfolio. We believe these debt securities provide quick sources of liquidity through sales or by pledging to obtain financing, regardless of market conditions. Some of these debt securities are within the held-to-maturity portion of our debt securities portfolio and as such are not intended for sale but may be pledged to obtain financing. Some of the legal entities within our consolidated group of companies are subject to various regulatory, tax, legal and other restrictions that can limit the transferability of their funds. We believe we maintain adequate liquidity for these entities in consideration of such funds transfer restrictions.


100
Wells Fargo & Company
 


Table 40: Primary Sources of Liquidity
 
December 31, 2018
 
 
December 31, 2017
 
(in millions)
Total

 
Encumbered

 
Unencumbered

 
Total 

 
Encumbered 

 
Unencumbered 

Interest-earning deposits with banks
$
149,736

 

 
149,736

 
192,580

 

 
192,580

Debt securities of U.S. Treasury and federal agencies
57,688

 
1,504

 
56,184

 
51,125

 
964

 
50,161

Mortgage-backed securities of federal agencies (1)
244,211

 
35,656

 
208,555

 
246,894

 
46,062

 
200,832

Total
$
451,635

 
37,160

 
414,475

 
490,599

 
47,026

 
443,573

(1)
Included in encumbered securities at December 31, 2018 , were securities with a fair value of $261 million which were purchased in December 2018, but settled in January 2019.

In addition to our primary sources of liquidity shown in Table 40 , liquidity is also available through the sale or financing of other debt securities including trading and/or available-for-sale debt securities, as well as through the sale, securitization or financing of loans, to the extent such debt securities and loans are not encumbered. In addition, other debt securities in our held-to-maturity portfolio, to the extent not encumbered, may be pledged to obtain financing.
Deposits have historically provided a sizable source of relatively low-cost funds. Deposits were 135% of total loans at December 31, 2018 , and 140% at December 31, 2017 .
 
Additional funding is provided by long-term debt and short-term borrowings. We access domestic and international capital markets for long-term funding (generally greater than one year) through issuances of registered debt securities, private placements and asset-backed secured funding.
Table 41 shows selected information for short-term borrowings, which generally mature in less than 30 days.


Table 41: Short-Term Borrowings
 
Quarter ended
 
(in millions)
Dec 31,
2018

 
Sep 30,
2018

 
Jun 30,
2018

 
Mar 31,
2018

 
Dec 31,
2017

Balance, period end
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Federal funds purchased and securities sold under agreements to repurchase
$
92,430

 
92,418

 
89,307

 
80,916

 
88,684

Other short-term borrowings
13,357

 
13,033

 
15,189

 
16,291

 
14,572

Total
$
105,787

 
105,451

 
104,496

 
97,207

 
103,256

Average daily balance for period
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Federal funds purchased and securities sold under agreements to repurchase
$
93,483

 
92,141

 
89,138

 
86,535

 
88,197

Other short-term borrowings
12,479

 
13,331

 
14,657

 
15,244

 
13,945

Total
$
105,962

 
105,472

 
103,795

 
101,779

 
102,142

Maximum month-end balance for period
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Federal funds purchased and securities sold under agreements to repurchase (1)
$
93,918

 
92,531

 
92,103

 
88,121

 
91,604

Other short-term borrowings (2)
13,357

 
14,270

 
15,272

 
16,924

 
14,948

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(1)
Highest month-end balance in each of the last five quarters was in November, July, May and January 2018, and November 2017.
(2)
Highest month-end balance in each of the last five quarters was in December, July, May and January 2018, and November 2017.

Parent In February 2017, the Parent filed a registration statement with the SEC for the issuance of senior and subordinated notes, preferred stock and other securities. The Parent’s ability to issue debt and other securities under this registration statement is limited by the debt issuance authority granted by the Board. As of December 31, 2018 , the Parent was authorized by the Board to issue up to $180 billion in outstanding long-term debt. The Parent’s long-term debt issuance authority granted by the Board includes debt issued to affiliates and others. At December 31, 2018 , the Parent had available $38.1 billion in long-term debt issuance authority. In 2018 , the Parent issued $2.0 billion of senior notes, of which $1.5 billion were registered with the SEC. In addition, the Parent issued $5.5 billion of registered senior notes in January 2019 and issued CAD $1.0 billion of senior notes in February 2019 that were registered in the U.S. and distributed on a private placement basis in Canada. The Parent’s short-term debt issuance authority granted by the Board was limited to debt issued to affiliates, and was revoked by the Board at management’s request in January 2018.
The Parent’s proceeds from securities issued were used for general corporate purposes, and, unless otherwise specified in
 
the applicable prospectus or prospectus supplement, we expect the proceeds from securities issued in the future will be used for the same purposes. Depending on market conditions, we may purchase our outstanding debt securities from time to time in privately negotiated or open market transactions, by tender offer, or otherwise.

Wells Fargo Bank, N.A. As of December 31, 2018 , Wells Fargo Bank, N.A. was authorized by its board of directors to issue $100 billion  in outstanding short-term debt and $175 billion in outstanding long-term debt and had available $99.1 billion in short-term debt issuance authority and $96.4 billion in long-term debt issuance authority. In April 2018, Wells Fargo Bank, N.A. established a new $100 billion bank note program under which, subject to any other debt outstanding under the limits described above, it may issue $50 billion in outstanding short-term senior notes and $50 billion in outstanding long-term senior or subordinated notes. At December 31, 2018 , Wells Fargo Bank, N.A. had remaining issuance capacity under the new bank note program of $50.0 billion in short-term senior notes and $39.8 billion in long-term senior or subordinated notes. In 2018 , Wells Fargo

 
Wells Fargo & Company
101


Risk Management – Asset/Liability Management ( continued )

Bank, N.A. issued $17.8 billion of unregistered senior notes, including $1.0 billion of senior redeemable floating rate notes issued in September 2018 with an interest rate indexed to the new Secured Overnight Financing Rate (SOFR) published by the Federal Reserve Bank of New York, and $6.0 billion of which were issued under a prior bank note program. SOFR is an alternative to the London Interbank Offered Rate (LIBOR) and is a broad measure of the cost of borrowing cash overnight collateralized by U.S. Treasury securities. Due to the uncertainty surrounding the future of LIBOR, it is expected that a transition away from the widespread use of LIBOR to alternative benchmark rates will occur by the end of 2021. Accordingly, the FASB recently issued a pronouncement that includes SOFR, among others, as a permitted benchmark interest rate for the application of hedge accounting. We have a significant amount of assets and liabilities referenced to LIBOR such as commercial loans, adjustable rate mortgage loans, derivatives, securities, and long-term debt. We have established a LIBOR Transition Office to develop and direct a coordinated strategy to transition numerous products and exposures away from LIBOR. The LIBOR Transition Office has initiated a comprehensive, company-wide process to address certain challenges and risks associated with the transition away from the widespread use of LIBOR and has directed an evaluation of the provisions in our contracts that could apply in connection with any discontinuation of, or change to, LIBOR, as well as the operational issues that could arise. In addition, regulators and trade associations periodically issue guidance, consultations and recommendations relating to LIBOR-transition matters, which will inform our overall planning. See the “Risk Factors” section in this Report for additional information regarding the potential impact of a benchmark rate, such as LIBOR, or other referenced financial metric being significantly changed, replaced or discontinued.
 
In addition, during 2018 , Wells Fargo Bank, N.A. executed advances of $29.2 billion with the Federal Home Loan Bank of Des Moines, and as of December 31, 2018 , Wells Fargo Bank, N.A. had outstanding advances of $49.6 billion across the Federal Home Loan Bank System. In addition, Wells Fargo Bank, N.A. executed $3.0 billion in Federal Home Loan Bank advances in February 2019.

Credit Ratings Investors in the long-term capital markets, as well as other market participants, generally will consider, among other factors, a company’s debt rating in making investment decisions. Rating agencies base their ratings on many quantitative and qualitative factors, including capital adequacy, liquidity, asset quality, business mix, the level and quality of earnings, and rating agency assumptions regarding the probability and extent of federal financial assistance or support for certain large financial institutions. Adverse changes in these factors could result in a reduction of our credit rating; however, our debt securities do not contain credit rating covenants.
There were no actions undertaken by the rating agencies with regard to our credit ratings during fourth quarter 2018. Both the Parent and Wells Fargo Bank, N.A. remain among the highest-rated financial firms in the U.S.
See the “Risk Factors” section in this Report for additional information regarding our credit ratings and the potential impact a credit rating downgrade would have on our liquidity and operations, as well as Note 17 (Derivatives) to Financial Statements in this Report for information regarding additional collateral and funding obligations required for certain derivative instruments in the event our credit ratings were to fall below investment grade.
The credit ratings of the Parent and Wells Fargo Bank, N.A. as of December 31, 2018 , are presented in Table 42 .

Table 42: Credit Ratings as of December 31, 2018
 
 
 
Wells Fargo & Company 
 
Wells Fargo Bank, N.A. 
 
Senior debt 
 
Short-term 
borrowings 
 
Long-term 
deposits 
 
Short-term 
borrowings 
Moody’s
A2
 
P-1
 
Aa1
 
P-1
S&P Global Ratings
A-
 
A-2
 
A+
 
A-1
Fitch Ratings, Inc.
A+
 
F1
 
AA
 
F1+
DBRS
AA(low)
 
R-1(middle)
 
AA
 
R-1(high)
FEDERAL HOME LOAN BANK MEMBERSHIP The Federal Home Loan Banks (the FHLBs) are a group of cooperatives that lending institutions use to finance housing and economic development in local communities. We are a member of the FHLBs based in Dallas, Des Moines and San Francisco. Each member of the FHLBs is required to maintain a minimum investment in capital stock of the applicable FHLB. The board of directors of each FHLB can increase the minimum investment
 
requirements in the event it has concluded that additional capital is required to allow it to meet its own regulatory capital requirements. Any increase in the minimum investment requirements outside of specified ranges requires the approval of the Federal Housing Finance Agency. Because the extent of any obligation to increase our investment in any of the FHLBs depends entirely upon the occurrence of a future event, potential future payments to the FHLBs are not determinable.
Capital Management

We have an active program for managing capital through a comprehensive process for assessing the Company’s overall capital adequacy. Our objective is to maintain capital at an amount commensurate with our risk profile and risk tolerance objectives, and to meet both regulatory and market expectations. We primarily fund our working capital needs through the retention of earnings net of both dividends and share
 
repurchases, as well as through the issuance of preferred stock and long and short-term debt. Retained earnings increased $12.9 billion from December 31, 2017, predominantly from Wells Fargo net income of $22.4 billion , less common and preferred stock dividends of $9.5 billion . During 2018 , we issued 65.1 million shares of common stock. During 2018 , we repurchased 375.5 million shares of common stock in open

102
Wells Fargo & Company
 


market transactions, including through forward repurchase transactions, and from employee benefit plans, at a cost of $20.6 billion . The amount of our repurchases are subject to various factors as discussed in the “Securities Repurchases” section below. For additional information about our forward repurchase agreements, see Note 1 (Summary of Significant Accounting Policies) to Financial Statements in this Report.
On September 17, 2018, we redeemed all of our 8.00% Non-Cumulative Perpetual Class A Preferred Stock, Series J, at a redemption price equal to $1,000 per share.

Regulatory Capital Guidelines
The Company and each of our insured depository institutions are subject to various regulatory capital adequacy requirements administered by the FRB and the OCC. Risk-based capital (RBC) guidelines establish a risk-adjusted ratio relating capital to different categories of assets and off-balance sheet exposures as discussed below.

RISK-BASED CAPITAL AND RISK-WEIGHTED ASSETS The Company is subject to final and interim final rules issued by federal banking regulators to implement Basel III capital requirements for U.S. banking organizations. These rules are based on international guidelines for determining regulatory capital issued by the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision (BCBS). The federal banking regulators’ capital rules, among other things, require on a fully phased-in basis:
a minimum Common Equity Tier 1 (CET1) ratio of 9.0%, comprised of a 4.5% minimum requirement plus a capital conservation buffer of 2.5% and for us, as a global systemically important bank (G-SIB), a capital surcharge to be calculated annually, which is 2.0% based on our year-end 2017 data;
a minimum tier 1 capital ratio of 10.5%, comprised of a 6.0% minimum requirement plus the capital conservation buffer of 2.5% and the G-SIB capital surcharge of 2.0%;
a minimum total capital ratio of 12.5%, comprised of a 8.0% minimum requirement plus the capital conservation buffer of 2.5% and the G-SIB capital surcharge of 2.0%;
a potential countercyclical buffer of up to 2.5% to be added to the minimum capital ratios, which is currently not in effect but could be imposed by regulators at their discretion if it is determined that a period of excessive credit growth is contributing to an increase in systemic risk;
a minimum tier 1 leverage ratio of 4.0%; and
a minimum supplementary leverage ratio (SLR) of 5.0% (comprised of a 3.0% minimum requirement plus a supplementary leverage buffer of 2.0%) for large and internationally active bank holding companies (BHCs).

We were required to comply with the final Basel III capital rules beginning January 2014, with certain provisions subject to phase-in periods. Beginning January 1, 2018, the requirements for calculating CET1 and tier 1 capital, along with RWAs, became fully phased-in. However, the requirements for calculating tier 2 and total capital are still in accordance with Transition Requirements. The entire Basel III capital rules are scheduled to be fully phased in by the end of 2021. The Basel III capital rules contain two frameworks for calculating capital requirements, a Standardized Approach, which replaced Basel I, and an Advanced Approach applicable to certain institutions, including Wells Fargo. Accordingly, in the assessment of our capital adequacy, we must report the lower of our CET1, tier 1 and total capital ratios calculated
 
under the Standardized Approach and under the Advanced Approach.
On April 10, 2018, the FRB issued a proposed rule that would add a stress capital buffer and a stress leverage buffer to the minimum capital and tier 1 leverage ratio requirements. The buffers would be calculated based on the decrease in a financial institution’s risk-based capital and tier 1 leverage ratios under the supervisory severely adverse scenario in CCAR, plus four quarters of planned common stock dividends. The stress capital buffer would replace the 2.5% capital conservation buffer under the Standardized Approach, whereas the stress leverage buffer would be added to the current 4% minimum tier 1 leverage ratio.
Because the Company has been designated as a G-SIB, we are also subject to the FRB’s rule implementing the additional capital surcharge of between 1.0-4.5% on G-SIBs. Under the rule, we must annually calculate our surcharge under two methods and use the higher of the two surcharges. The first method (method one) considers our size, interconnectedness, cross-jurisdictional activity, substitutability, and complexity, consistent with the methodology developed by the BCBS and the Financial Stability Board (FSB). The second (method two) uses similar inputs, but replaces substitutability with use of short-term wholesale funding and will generally result in higher surcharges than the BCBS methodology. The G-SIB surcharge became fully effective on January 1, 2019. Based on year-end 2017 data, our 2019 G-SIB surcharge under method two is 2.0% of the Company’s RWAs, which is the higher of method one and method two. Because the G-SIB surcharge is calculated annually based on data that can differ over time, the amount of the surcharge is subject to change in future years. Under the Standardized Approach (fully phased-in), our CET1 ratio of 11.74% exceeded the minimum of 9.0% by 274 basis points at December 31, 2018 .
The tables that follow provide information about our risk- based capital and related ratios as calculated under Basel III capital guidelines. For banking industry regulatory reporting purposes, we continue to report our tier 2 and total capital in accordance with Transition Requirements but are managing our capital based on a fully phased-in calculation. For information about our capital requirements calculated in accordance with Transition Requirements, see Note 28 (Regulatory and Agency Capital Requirements) to Financial Statements in this Report.

 
Wells Fargo & Company
103


Capital Management (continued)

Table 43 summarizes our CET1, tier 1 capital, total capital, risk-weighted assets and capital ratios on a fully phased-in basis at December 31, 2018 and December 31, 2017 . As of December 31, 2018 , our CET1, tier 1, and total capital ratios were lower using RWAs calculated under the Standardized Approach.
 



Table 43: Capital Components and Ratios (Fully Phased-In) (1)
 
 
December 31, 2018
 
 
 
December 31, 2017
 
 
(in millions, except ratios)
 
Advanced Approach

 
Standardized Approach

 
 
Advanced Approach

 
Standardized Approach

 
Common Equity Tier 1
(A)
$
146,363

 
146,363

 
 
154,022

 
154,022

 
Tier 1 Capital
(B)
167,866

 
167,866

 
 
177,466

 
177,466

 
Total Capital
(C)
198,103

 
206,346

 
 
208,395

 
218,159

 
Risk-Weighted Assets
(D)
1,177,350

 
1,247,210

 
 
1,225,939

 
1,285,563

 
Common Equity Tier 1 Capital Ratio
(A)/(D)
12.43
%
 
11.74

*
 
12.56

 
11.98

*
Tier 1 Capital Ratio
(B)/(D)
14.26

 
13.46

*
 
14.48

 
13.80

*
Total Capital Ratio
(C)/(D)
16.83

 
16.54

*
 
17.00

 
16.97

*
*
Denotes the lowest capital ratio as determined under the Advanced and Standardized Approaches.
(1)
Beginning January 1, 2018, the requirements for calculating CET1 and tier 1 capital, along with RWAs, became fully phased-in. However, the requirements for calculating tier 2 and total capital are still in accordance with Transition Requirements. Accordingly, fully phased-in total capital amounts and ratios are considered non-GAAP financial measures that are used by management, bank regulatory agencies, investors and analysts to assess and monitor the Company’s capital position. See Table 44 for information regarding the calculation and components of CET1, tier 1 capital, total capital and RWAs, as well as the corresponding reconciliation of our fully phased-in regulatory capital amounts to GAAP financial measures.

104
Wells Fargo & Company
 


Table 44 provides information regarding the calculation and composition of our risk-based capital under the Advanced and Standardized Approaches at December 31, 2018 and December 31, 2017 .
 


Table 44: Risk-Based Capital Calculation and Components
 
 
December 31, 2018
 
 
December 31, 2017
 
(in millions)
 
Advanced Approach

 
Standardized Approach

 
Advanced Approach

 
Standardized Approach

Total equity
 
$
197,066

 
197,066

 
208,079

 
208,079

Adjustments:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Preferred stock
 
(23,214
)
 
(23,214
)
 
(25,358
)
 
(25,358
)
Additional paid-in capital on ESOP preferred stock
 
(95
)
 
(95
)
 
(122
)
 
(122
)
Unearned ESOP shares
 
1,502

 
1,502

 
1,678

 
1,678

Noncontrolling interests
 
(900
)
 
(900
)
 
(1,143
)
 
(1,143
)
Total common stockholders’ equity
 
174,359

 
174,359

 
183,134

 
183,134

Adjustments:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Goodwill
 
(26,418
)
 
(26,418
)
 
(26,587
)
 
(26,587
)
Certain identifiable intangible assets (other than MSRs)
 
(559
)
 
(559
)
 
(1,624
)
 
(1,624
)
Other assets (1)
 
(2,187
)
 
(2,187
)
 
(2,155
)
 
(2,155
)
Applicable deferred taxes (2)
 
785

 
785

 
962

 
962

Investment in certain subsidiaries and other
 
383

 
383

 
292

 
292

Common Equity Tier 1 (Fully Phased-In)
 
146,363

 
146,363

 
154,022

 
154,022

Effect of Transition Requirements (3)
 

 

 
743

 
743

Common Equity Tier 1 (Transition Requirements)
 
$
146,363

 
146,363

 
154,765

 
154,765

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Common Equity Tier 1 (Fully Phased-In)
 
$
146,363

 
146,363

 
154,022

 
154,022

Preferred stock
 
23,214

 
23,214

 
25,358

 
25,358

Additional paid-in capital on ESOP preferred stock
 
95

 
95

 
122

 
122

Unearned ESOP shares
 
(1,502
)
 
(1,502
)
 
(1,678
)
 
(1,678
)
Other
 
(304
)
 
(304
)
 
(358
)
 
(358
)
Total Tier 1 capital (Fully Phased-In)
(A)
167,866

 
167,866

 
177,466

 
177,466

Effect of Transition Requirements (3)
 

 

 
743

 
743

Total Tier 1 capital (Transition Requirements)
 
$
167,866

 
167,866

 
178,209

 
178,209

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total Tier 1 capital (Fully Phased-In)
 
$
167,866

 
167,866

 
177,466

 
177,466

Long-term debt and other instruments qualifying as Tier 2
 
27,946

 
27,946

 
28,994

 
28,994

Qualifying allowance for credit losses (4)
 
2,463

 
10,706

 
2,196

 
11,960

Other
 
(172
)
 
(172
)
 
(261
)
 
(261
)
Total Tier 2 capital (Fully Phased-In)
(B)
30,237

 
38,480

 
30,929

 
40,693

Effect of Transition Requirements
 
695

 
695

 
1,195

 
1,195

Total Tier 2 capital (Transition Requirements)
 
$
30,932

 
39,175

 
32,124

 
41,888

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total qualifying capital (Fully Phased-In)
(A)+(B)
$
198,103

 
206,346

 
208,395

 
218,159

Total Effect of Transition Requirements
 
695

 
695

 
1,938

 
1,938

Total qualifying capital (Transition Requirements)
 
$
198,798

 
207,041

 
210,333

 
220,097

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Risk-Weighted Assets (RWAs) (5)(6):
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Credit risk
 
$
803,273

 
1,201,246

 
890,171

 
1,249,395

Market risk
 
45,964

 
45,964

 
36,168

 
36,168

Operational risk
 
328,113

 
N/A

 
299,600

 
N/A

Total RWAs (Fully Phased-In) (3)
 
$
1,177,350

 
1,247,210

 
1,225,939

 
1,285,563

(1)
Represents goodwill and other intangibles on nonmarketable equity securities, which are included in other assets.
(2)
Applicable deferred taxes relate to goodwill and other intangible assets. They were determined by applying the combined federal statutory rate and composite state income tax rates to the difference between book and tax basis of the respective goodwill and intangible assets at period end.
(3)
Beginning January 1, 2018, the requirements for calculating CET1 and tier 1 capital, along with RWAs, became fully phased-in, so the effect of the transition requirements was $0 at December 31, 2018.
(4)
Under the Advanced Approach the allowance for credit losses that exceeds expected credit losses is eligible for inclusion in Tier 2 Capital, to the extent the excess allowance does not exceed 0.6% of Advanced credit RWAs, and under the Standardized Approach, the allowance for credit losses is includable in Tier 2 Capital up to 1.25% of Standardized credit RWAs, with any excess allowance for credit losses being deducted from total RWAs.
(5)
RWAs calculated under the Advanced Approach utilize a risk-sensitive methodology, which relies upon the use of internal credit models based upon our experience with internal rating grades. Advanced Approach also includes an operational risk component, which reflects the risk of operating loss resulting from inadequate or failed internal processes or systems.
(6)
Under the regulatory guidelines for risk-based capital, on-balance sheet assets and credit equivalent amounts of derivatives and off-balance sheet items are assigned to one of several broad risk categories according to the obligor, or, if relevant, the guarantor or the nature of any collateral. The aggregate dollar amount in each risk category is then multiplied by the risk weight associated with that category. The resulting weighted values from each of the risk categories are aggregated for determining total RWAs.

 
Wells Fargo & Company
105


Capital Management (continued)

Table 45 presents the changes in Common Equity Tier 1 under the Advanced Approach for the year ended December 31, 2018 .
 


Table 45: Analysis of Changes in Common Equity Tier 1
(in millions)
 
 
Common Equity Tier 1 (Fully Phased-In) at December 31, 2017
 
$
154,022

Net income applicable to common stock
 
20,689

Common stock dividends
 
(7,889
)
Common stock issued, repurchased, and stock compensation-related items
 
(17,881
)
Goodwill
 
170

Certain identifiable intangible assets (other than MSRs)
 
1,065

Other assets (1)
 
(32
)
Applicable deferred taxes (2)
 
(177
)
Investment in certain subsidiaries and other
 
(3,604
)
Change in Common Equity Tier 1
 
(7,659
)
Common Equity Tier 1 (Fully Phased-In) at December 31, 2018
 
$
146,363

(1)
Represents goodwill and other intangibles on nonmarketable equity securities, which are included in other assets.
(2)
Applicable deferred taxes relate to goodwill and other intangible assets. They were determined by applying the combined federal statutory rate and composite state income tax rates to the difference between book and tax basis of the respective goodwill and intangible assets at period end.

Table 46 presents net changes in the components of RWAs under the Advanced and Standardized Approaches for the year ended December 31, 2018 .
 


Table 46: Analysis of Changes in RWAs
(in millions)
Advanced Approach

Standardized Approach

RWAs (Fully Phased-In) at December 31, 2017
$
1,225,939

1,285,563

Net change in credit risk RWAs
(86,898
)
(48,149
)
Net change in market risk RWAs
9,796

9,796

Net change in operational risk RWAs
28,513

N/A

Total change in RWAs
(48,589
)
(38,353
)
RWAs (Fully Phased-In) at December 31, 2018
$
1,177,350

1,247,210




106
Wells Fargo & Company
 


TANGIBLE COMMON EQUITY We also evaluate our business based on certain ratios that utilize tangible common equity. Tangible common equity is a non-GAAP financial measure and represents total equity less preferred equity, noncontrolling interests, and goodwill and certain identifiable intangible assets (including goodwill and intangible assets associated with certain of our nonmarketable equity securities, but excluding mortgage servicing rights), net of applicable deferred taxes. These tangible common equity ratios are as follows:
Tangible book value per common share, which represents tangible common equity divided by common shares outstanding.
 
Return on average tangible common equity (ROTCE), which represents our annualized earnings contribution as a percentage of tangible common equity.

The methodology of determining tangible common equity may differ among companies. Management believes that tangible book value per common share and return on average tangible common equity, which utilize tangible common equity, are useful financial measures because they enable investors and others to assess the Company’s use of equity.
Table 47 provides a reconciliation of these non-GAAP financial measures to GAAP financial measures.

Table 47: Tangible Common Equity
 
 
 
Balance at period end
 
 
Average balance for the year ended
 
(in millions, except ratios)
 
 
Dec 31,
2018

Dec 31,
2017

Dec 31,
2016

 
Dec 31,
2018

 
Dec 31,
2017

Dec 31,
2016

Total equity
 
 
$
197,066

208,079

200,497

 
203,356

 
205,654

200,690

Adjustments:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Preferred stock
 
 
(23,214
)
(25,358
)
(24,551
)
 
(24,956
)
 
(25,592
)
(24,363
)
Additional paid-in capital on ESOP preferred stock
 
 
(95
)
(122
)
(126
)
 
(125
)
 
(139
)
(161
)
Unearned ESOP shares
 
 
1,502

1,678

1,565

 
2,159

 
2,143

2,011

Noncontrolling interests
 
 
(900
)
(1,143
)
(916
)
 
(929
)
 
(948
)
(936
)
Total common stockholders’ equity
(A)
 
174,359

183,134

176,469

 
179,505

 
181,118

177,241

Adjustments:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Goodwill
 
 
(26,418
)
(26,587
)
(26,693
)
 
(26,453
)
 
(26,629
)
(26,700
)
Certain identifiable intangible assets (other than MSRs)
 
 
(559
)
(1,624
)
(2,723
)
 
(1,088
)
 
(2,176
)
(3,254
)
Other assets (1)
 
 
(2,187
)
(2,155
)
(2,088
)
 
(2,197
)
 
(2,184
)
(2,117
)
Applicable deferred taxes (2)
 
 
785

962

1,772

 
866

 
1,570

1,897

Tangible common equity
(B)
 
$
145,980

153,730

146,737

 
150,633

 
151,699

147,067

Common shares outstanding
(C)
 
4,581.3

4,891.6

5,016.1

 
N/A

 
N/A

N/A

Net income applicable to common stock
(D)
 
N/A

N/A

N/A

 
$
20,689

 
20,554

20,373

Book value per common share
(A)/(C)
 
$
38.06

37.44

35.18

 
N/A

 
N/A

N/A

Tangible book value per common share
(B)/(C)
 
31.86

31.43

29.25

 
N/A

 
N/A

N/A

Return on average common stockholders’ equity (ROE)
(D)/(A)
 
N/A

N/A

N/A

 
11.53

%
11.35

11.49

Return on average tangible common equity (ROTCE)
(D)/(B)
 
N/A

N/A

N/A

 
13.73

 
13.55

13.85

(1)
Represents goodwill and other intangibles on nonmarketable equity securities, which are included in other assets.
(2)
Applicable deferred taxes relate to goodwill and other intangible assets. They were determined by applying the combined federal statutory rate and composite state income tax rates to the difference between book and tax basis of the respective goodwill and intangible assets at period end.



 
Wells Fargo & Company
107


Capital Management (continued)

SUPPLEMENTARY LEVERAGE RATIO In April 2014, federal banking regulators finalized a rule that enhances the SLR requirements for BHCs, like Wells Fargo, and their insured depository institutions. The SLR consists of Tier 1 capital divided by the Company’s total leverage exposure. Total leverage exposure consists of the total average on-balance sheet assets, plus off-balance sheet exposures, such as undrawn commitments and derivative exposures, less amounts permitted to be deducted from Tier 1 capital. The rule, which became effective on January 1, 2018, requires a covered BHC to maintain a SLR of at least 5.0% (comprised of the 3.0% minimum requirement plus a supplementary leverage buffer of 2.0%) to avoid restrictions on capital distributions and discretionary bonus payments. The rule also requires that all of our insured depository institutions maintain a SLR of 6.0% under applicable regulatory capital adequacy guidelines. In April 2018, the FRB and OCC proposed rules (the “Proposed SLR Rules”) that would replace the 2% supplementary leverage buffer with a buffer equal to one-half of the firm’s G-SIB capital surcharge. The Proposed SLR Rules would similarly tailor the current 6% SLR requirement for our insured depository institutions. At December 31, 2018 , our SLR for the Company was 7.7% calculated under the Advanced Approach capital framework. Based on our review, our current leverage levels would exceed the applicable requirements for each of our insured depository institutions as well. See Table 48 for information regarding the calculation and components of the SLR.
Table 48: Supplementary Leverage Ratio
(in millions, except ratio)
Quarter ended December 31, 2018

Tier 1 capital
$
167,866

Total average assets
1,879,047

Less: deductions from Tier 1 capital (1)
28,748

Total adjusted average assets
1,850,299

Adjustments:
 
Derivative exposures (2)
68,753

Repo-style transactions (3)
5,350

Other off-balance sheet exposures (4)
250,162

Total adjustments
324,265

Total leverage exposure
$
2,174,564

Supplementary leverage ratio
7.7
%
(1)
Amounts permitted to be deducted from Tier 1 capital primarily include goodwill and other intangible assets, net of associated deferred tax liabilities.
(2)
Represents adjustments for off balance sheet derivative exposures, and derivative collateral netting as defined for supplementary leverage ratio determination purposes.
(3)
Adjustments for repo-style transactions represent counterparty credit risk for all repo-style transactions where Wells Fargo & Company is the principal (i.e., principal counterparty facing the client).
(4)
Adjustments for other off-balance sheet exposures represent the notional amounts of all off-balance sheet exposures (excluding off balance sheet exposures associated with derivative and repo-style transactions) less the adjustments for conversion to credit equivalent amounts under the regulatory capital rule.
OTHER REGULATORY CAPITAL MATTERS In December 2016, the FRB finalized rules to address the amount of equity and unsecured long-term debt a U.S. G-SIB must hold to improve its resolvability and resiliency, often referred to as Total Loss Absorbing Capacity (TLAC). Under the rules, which became effective on January 1, 2019, U.S. G-SIBs are required to have a minimum TLAC amount (consisting of CET1 capital and additional tier 1 capital issued directly by the top-tier or covered BHC plus eligible external long-term debt) equal to the greater of (i) 18% of RWAs and (ii) 7.5% of total leverage exposure (the
 
denominator of the SLR calculation). Additionally, U.S. G-SIBs are required to maintain (i) a TLAC buffer equal to 2.5% of RWAs plus the firm’s applicable G-SIB capital surcharge calculated under method one plus any applicable countercyclical buffer to be added to the 18% minimum and (ii) an external TLAC leverage buffer equal to 2.0% of total leverage exposure to be added to the 7.5% minimum, in order to avoid restrictions on capital distributions and discretionary bonus payments. The rules also require U.S. G-SIBs to have a minimum amount of eligible unsecured long-term debt equal to the greater of (i) 6.0% of RWAs plus the firm’s applicable G-SIB capital surcharge calculated under method two and (ii) 4.5% of the total leverage exposure. In addition, the rules impose certain restrictions on the operations and liabilities of the top-tier or covered BHC in order to further facilitate an orderly resolution, including prohibitions on the issuance of short-term debt to external investors and on entering into derivatives and certain other types of financial contracts with external counterparties. While the rules permit permanent grandfathering of a significant portion of otherwise ineligible long-term debt that was issued prior to December 31, 2016, long-term debt issued after that date must be fully compliant with the eligibility requirements of the rules in order to count toward the minimum TLAC amount. As a result of the rules, we will need to issue additional long-term debt to remain compliant with the requirements. Under the Proposed SLR Rules, the 2% external TLAC leverage buffer would be replaced with a buffer equal to one-half of the firm’s G-SIB capital surcharge. Additionally, the Proposed SLR Rules would modify the leverage component for calculating the minimum amount of eligible unsecured long-term debt from 4.5% of total leverage exposure to 2.5% of total leverage exposure plus one-half of the firm’s G-SIB capital surcharge. As of December 31, 2018 , our eligible external TLAC as a percentage of total risk-weighted assets was 23.35% compared with a required minimum of 22.0%. Similar to the risk-based capital requirements, we determine minimum required TLAC based on the greater of RWAs determined under the Standardized and Advanced approaches.
In addition, as discussed in the “Risk Management – Asset/ Liability Management – Liquidity and Funding – Liquidity Standards” section in this Report, federal banking regulators have issued a final rule regarding the U.S. implementation of the Basel III LCR and a proposed rule regarding the NSFR.

Capital Planning and Stress Testing
Our planned long-term capital structure is designed to meet regulatory and market expectations. We believe that our long-term targeted capital structure enables us to invest in and grow our business, satisfy our customers’ financial needs in varying environments, access markets, and maintain flexibility to return capital to our shareholders. Our long-term targeted capital structure also considers capital levels sufficient to exceed capital requirements including the G-SIB surcharge. Accordingly, based on the final Basel III capital rules under the lower of the Standardized or Advanced Approaches CET1 capital ratios, we currently target a long-term CET1 capital ratio at or in excess of 10%, which includes a 2% G-SIB surcharge. Our capital targets are subject to change based on various factors, including changes to the regulatory capital framework and expectations for large banks promulgated by bank regulatory agencies, planned capital actions, changes in our risk profile and other factors. As discussed above in “Regulatory Capital Guidelines”, the FRB has proposed including a stress capital buffer (SCB) to replace the current capital conservation buffer as part of the capital requirements for large U.S. banks. The proposal is not final, but

108
Wells Fargo & Company
 


it is expected that the adoption of CECL accounting would be included in the SCB calculation. We expect that implementation of the SCB may increase the level and volatility of minimum capital requirements, which may cause our current 10% CET1 long-term target ratio to increase.
Under the FRB’s capital plan rule, large BHCs are required to submit capital plans annually for review to determine if the FRB has any objections before making any capital distributions. The rule requires updates to capital plans in the event of material changes in a BHC’s risk profile, including as a result of any significant acquisitions. The FRB assesses the overall financial condition, risk profile, and capital adequacy of BHCs while considering both quantitative and qualitative factors when evaluating capital plans.
Our 2018 capital plan, which was submitted on April 4, 2018, as part of CCAR, included a comprehensive capital outlook supported by an assessment of expected sources and uses of capital over a given planning horizon under a range of expected and stress scenarios. As part of the 2018 CCAR, the FRB also generated a supervisory stress test, which assumed a sharp decline in the economy and significant decline in asset pricing using the information provided by the Company to estimate performance. The FRB reviewed the supervisory stress results both as required under the Dodd-Frank Act using a common set of capital actions for all large BHCs and by taking into account the Company’s proposed capital actions. The FRB published its supervisory stress test results as required under the Dodd-Frank Act on June 21, 2018. On June 28, 2018, the FRB notified us that it did not object to our capital plan included in the 2018 CCAR.
Federal banking regulators require stress tests to evaluate whether an institution has sufficient capital to continue to operate during periods of adverse economic and financial conditions. These stress testing requirements set forth the timing and type of stress test activities large BHCs and banks must undertake as well as rules governing stress testing controls, oversight and disclosure requirements. The rules also limit a large BHC’s ability to make capital distributions to the extent its actual capital issuances were less than amounts indicated in its capital plan. As required under the FRB’s stress testing rule, we must submit a mid-cycle stress test based on second quarter data and scenarios developed by the Company. We submitted the results of the mid-cycle stress test to the FRB and disclosed a summary of the results in October 2018. In October 2018, the FRB proposed a rule that would, among other things, eliminate the mid-cycle stress test requirement for banks beginning in 2020.

 
Securities Repurchases
From time to time the Board authorizes the Company to repurchase shares of our common stock. Although we announce when the Board authorizes share repurchases, we typically do not give any public notice before we repurchase our shares. Future stock repurchases may be private or open-market repurchases, including block transactions, accelerated or delayed block transactions, forward repurchase transactions, and similar transactions. Additionally, we may enter into plans to purchase stock that satisfy the conditions of Rule 10b5-1 of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934. Various factors determine the amount of our share repurchases, including our capital requirements, the number of shares we expect to issue for employee benefit plans and acquisitions, market conditions (including the trading price of our stock), and regulatory and legal considerations, including the FRB’s response to our capital plan and to changes in our risk profile. Due to the various factors impacting the amount of our share repurchases and the fact that we tend to be in the market regularly to satisfy repurchase considerations under our capital plan, our repurchases occur at various price levels. We may suspend repurchase activity at any time.
In January 2018, the Board authorized the repurchase of 350 million shares of our common stock. In October 2018, the Board authorized the repurchase of an additional 350 million shares of our common stock. At December 31, 2018 , we had remaining authority to repurchase approximately 395 million shares, subject to regulatory and legal conditions. For more information about share repurchases during fourth quarter 2018 , see Part II, Item 5 in our 2018 Form 10-K.
Historically, our policy has been to repurchase shares under the “safe harbor” conditions of Rule 10b-18 of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 including a limitation on the daily volume of repurchases. Rule 10b-18 imposes an additional daily volume limitation on share repurchases during a pending merger or acquisition in which shares of our stock will constitute some or all of the consideration. Our management may determine that during a pending stock merger or acquisition when the safe harbor would otherwise be available, it is in our best interest to repurchase shares in excess of this additional daily volume limitation. In such cases, we intend to repurchase shares in compliance with the other conditions of the safe harbor, including the standing daily volume limitation that applies whether or not there is a pending stock merger or acquisition.
In connection with our participation in the Capital Purchase Program (CPP), a part of the Troubled Asset Relief Program (TARP), we issued to the U.S. Treasury Department warrants to purchase 110,261,688 shares of our common stock with an original exercise price of $34.01 per share. The warrants expired on October 29, 2018, and the holders of 110,646 unexercised warrants as of the expiration date are no longer entitled to receive any shares of our common stock.


 
Wells Fargo & Company
109


Regulatory Matters (continued)

Regulatory Matters
Since the enactment of the Dodd-Frank Act in 2010, the U.S. financial services industry has been subject to a significant increase in regulation and regulatory oversight initiatives. This increased regulation and oversight has substantially changed how most U.S. financial services companies conduct business and has increased their regulatory compliance costs. The following highlights the more significant regulations and regulatory oversight initiatives that have affected or may affect our business. For additional information about the regulatory matters discussed below and other regulations and regulatory oversight matters, see Part I, Item 1 “Regulation and Supervision” of our 2018 Form 10-K, and the “Capital Management,” “Forward-Looking Statements” and “Risk Factors” sections and Note 28 (Regulatory and Agency Capital Requirements) to Financial Statements in this Report.

Dodd-Frank Act
The Dodd-Frank Act is the most significant financial reform legislation since the 1930s and is driving much of the current U.S. regulatory reform efforts. The Dodd-Frank Act and many of its provisions became effective in July 2010 and July 2011. The following provides additional information on the Dodd-Frank Act, including the current status of certain of its rulemaking initiatives.
Enhanced supervision and regulation of systemically important firms . The Dodd-Frank Act grants broad authority to federal banking regulators to establish enhanced supervisory and regulatory requirements for systemically important firms. The FRB has finalized a number of regulations implementing enhanced prudential requirements for large bank holding companies (BHCs) like Wells Fargo regarding risk-based capital and leverage, risk and liquidity management, and imposing debt-to-equity limits on any BHC that regulators determine poses a grave threat to the financial stability of the United States. The FRB and OCC have also finalized rules implementing stress testing requirements for large BHCs and national banks. The FRB has also finalized enhanced prudential standards that implement single counterparty credit limits, and has proposed a rule to establish remediation requirements for large BHCs experiencing financial distress. Similarly, the FRB has proposed additional requirements regarding effective risk management practices at large BHCs, including its expectations for boards of directors and senior management. In addition to the authorization of enhanced supervisory and regulatory requirements for systemically important firms, the Dodd-Frank Act also established the Financial Stability Oversight Council and the Office of Financial Research, which may recommend new systemic risk management requirements and require new reporting of systemic risks. The OCC, under separate authority, has also finalized guidelines establishing heightened governance and risk management standards for large national banks such as Wells Fargo Bank, N.A. The OCC guidelines require covered banks to establish and adhere to a written risk governance framework in order to manage and control their risk-taking activities. The guidelines also formalize roles and responsibilities for risk management practices within covered banks and create certain risk oversight responsibilities for their boards of directors.
Regulation of consumer financial products. The Dodd-Frank Act established the Consumer Financial Protection
 
Bureau (CFPB) to ensure consumers receive clear and accurate disclosures regarding financial products and to protect them from hidden fees and unfair, deceptive or abusive practices. With respect to residential mortgage lending, the CFPB issued a number of final rules implementing new origination, notification, disclosure and other requirements, as well as additional limitations on the fees and charges that may be increased from the estimates provided by lenders. The CFPB finalized amendments to the rule implementing the Home Mortgage Disclosure Act, resulting in a significant expansion of the data points lenders are required to collect and report to the CFPB. The CFPB also expanded the transactions covered by the rule and increased the reporting frequency from annual to quarterly for large volume lenders, such as Wells Fargo, beginning January 1, 2020. With respect to other financial products, the CFPB finalized rules, most of which become effective on April 1, 2019, to make prepaid cards subject to similar consumer protections as those provided by more traditional debit and credit cards such as fraud protection and expanded access to account information. In addition to these rulemaking activities, the CFPB is continuing its on-going supervisory examination activities of the financial services industry with respect to a number of consumer businesses and products, including mortgage lending and servicing, fair lending requirements, student lending activities, and automobile finance.
Volcker Rule. The Volcker Rule, with limited exceptions, prohibits banking entities from engaging in proprietary trading or owning any interest in or sponsoring or having certain relationships with a hedge fund, a private equity fund or certain structured transactions that are deemed covered funds. Federal banking regulators, the SEC and the Commodity Futures Trading Commission (CFTC) (collectively, the Volcker supervisory regulators) jointly released a final rule to implement the Volcker Rule’s restrictions, and the FRB has proposed further rules to streamline and modify compliance with the Volcker Rule’s requirements. As a banking entity with more than $50 billion in consolidated assets, we are also subject to enhanced compliance program requirements.
Regulation of swaps and other derivatives activities . The Dodd-Frank Act established a comprehensive framework for regulating over-the-counter derivatives and authorized the CFTC and the SEC to regulate swaps and security-based swaps, respectively. The CFTC has adopted rules applicable to our provisionally registered swap dealer, Wells Fargo Bank, N.A., that require, among other things, extensive regulatory and public reporting of swaps, central clearing and trading of swaps on exchanges or other multilateral platforms, and compliance with comprehensive internal and external business conduct standards. The SEC is expected to implement parallel rules applicable to security-based swaps. In addition, federal regulators have adopted final rules establishing initial and variation margin requirements for swaps and security-based swaps not centrally cleared, rules placing restrictions on a party’s right to exercise default rights under derivatives and other qualified financial contracts against applicable banking organizations, and record-keeping requirements for qualified financial contracts. All of these new rules, as well as others being considered by regulators in other jurisdictions, may

110
Wells Fargo & Company
 


negatively impact customer demand for over-the-counter derivatives, impact our ability to offer customers new derivatives or amendments to existing derivatives, and may increase our costs for engaging in swaps, security-based swaps, and other derivatives activities.
Regulation of interchange transaction fees (the Durbin Amendment). On October 1, 2011, the FRB rule enacted to implement the Durbin Amendment to the Dodd-Frank Act that limits debit card interchange transaction fees to those reasonable and proportional to the cost of the transaction became effective. The rule generally established that the maximum allowable interchange fee that an issuer may receive or charge for an electronic debit transaction is the sum of 21 cents per transaction and 5 basis points multiplied by the value of the transaction. On July 31, 2013, the U.S. District Court for the District of Columbia ruled that the approach used by the FRB in setting the maximum allowable interchange transaction fee impermissibly included costs that were specifically excluded from consideration under the Durbin Amendment. In August 2013, the FRB filed a notice of appeal of the decision to the United States Court of Appeals for the District of Columbia. In March 2014, the Court of Appeals reversed the District Court’s decision, but did direct the FRB to provide further explanation regarding its treatment of the costs of monitoring transactions, which the FRB published in August 2015. The plaintiffs did not file a petition for rehearing with the Court of Appeals but filed a petition for writ of certiorari with the U.S. Supreme Court. In January 2015, the U.S. Supreme Court denied the petition for writ of certiorari.

Regulatory Capital Guidelines and Capital Plans
During 2013, federal banking regulators issued final rules that substantially amended the risk-based capital rules for banking organizations. The rules implement the Basel III regulatory capital reforms in the U.S., comply with changes required by the Dodd-Frank Act, and replace the existing Basel I-based capital requirements. We were required to begin complying with the rules on January 1, 2014, subject to phase-in periods that are scheduled to be fully phased in by January 1, 2022. In 2014, federal banking regulators also finalized rules to impose a supplementary leverage ratio on large BHCs like Wells Fargo and our insured depository institutions and to implement the Basel III liquidity coverage ratio. For more information on the final capital, leverage and liquidity rules, and additional capital requirements applicable to us, see the “Capital Management” section in this Report.

“Living Will” Requirements and Related Matters
Rules adopted by the FRB and the FDIC under the Dodd-Frank Act require large financial institutions, including Wells Fargo, to prepare and periodically revise resolution plans, so-called “living-wills”, that would facilitate their resolution in the event of material distress or failure. Under the rules, resolution plans are required to provide strategies for resolution under the Bankruptcy Code and other applicable insolvency regimes that can be accomplished in a reasonable period of time and in a manner that mitigates the risk that failure would have serious adverse effects on the financial stability of the United States. On December 19, 2017, the FRB and FDIC announced that Wells Fargo’s 2017 resolution plan submission did not have any deficiencies; however, they identified a specific shortcoming that would need to be addressed in the Company’s next submission. Our national bank subsidiary, Wells Fargo Bank, N.A. (the
 
“Bank”), is also required to prepare a resolution plan and submitted its 2018 resolution plan to the FDIC on June 29, 2018. If the FRB or FDIC determines that our resolution plan has deficiencies, they may impose more stringent capital, leverage or liquidity requirements on us or restrict our growth, activities or operations until we adequately remedy the deficiencies. If the FRB or FDIC ultimately determines that we have been unable to remedy any deficiencies, they could require us to divest certain assets or operations.
We must also prepare and submit to the FRB a recovery plan that identifies a range of options that we may consider during times of idiosyncratic or systemic economic stress to remedy any financial weaknesses and restore market confidence without extraordinary government support. Recovery options include the possible sale, transfer or disposal of assets, securities, loan portfolios or businesses. The Bank must also prepare and submit to the OCC a recovery plan that sets forth the bank’s plan to remain a going concern when the bank is experiencing considerable financial or operational stress, but has not yet deteriorated to the point where liquidation or resolution is imminent. If either the FRB or the OCC determine that our recovery plan is deficient, they may impose fines, restrictions on our business or ultimately require us to divest assets.
If Wells Fargo were to fail, it may be resolved in a bankruptcy proceeding or, if certain conditions are met, under the resolution regime created by the Dodd-Frank Act known as the “orderly liquidation authority.” The orderly liquidation authority allows for the appointment of the FDIC as receiver for a systemically important financial institution that is in default or in danger of default if, among other things, the resolution of the institution under the U.S. Bankruptcy Code would have serious adverse effects on financial stability in the United States. If the FDIC is appointed as receiver for Wells Fargo & Company (the “Parent”), then the orderly liquidation authority, rather than the U.S. Bankruptcy Code, would determine the powers of the receiver and the rights and obligations of our security holders. The FDIC’s orderly liquidation authority requires that security holders of a company in receivership bear all losses before U.S. taxpayers are exposed to any losses, and allows the FDIC to disregard the strict priority of creditor claims under the U.S. Bankruptcy Code in certain circumstances.
Whether under the U.S. Bankruptcy Code or by the FDIC under the orderly liquidation authority, Wells Fargo could be resolved using a “multiple point of entry” strategy, in which the Parent and one or more of its subsidiaries would each undergo separate resolution proceedings, or a “single point of entry” strategy, in which the Parent would likely be the only material legal entity to enter resolution proceedings. The FDIC has announced that a single point of entry strategy may be a desirable strategy under its implementation of the orderly liquidation authority, but not all aspects of how the FDIC might exercise this authority are known and additional rulemaking is possible.
The strategy described in our most recent resolution plan submission is a multiple point of entry strategy; however, we have made a decision to move to a single point of entry strategy for our next resolution plan submission. We are not obligated to maintain either a single point of entry or multiple point of entry strategy, and the strategies reflected in our resolution plan submissions are not binding in the event of an actual resolution of Wells Fargo, whether conducted under the U.S. Bankruptcy Code or by the FDIC under the orderly liquidation authority.
To facilitate the orderly resolution of systemically important financial institutions in case of material distress or failure,

 
Wells Fargo & Company
111


Regulatory Matters (continued)

federal banking regulations require that institutions, such as Wells Fargo, maintain a minimum amount of equity and unsecured debt to absorb losses and recapitalize operating subsidiaries. Federal banking regulators have also required measures to facilitate the continued operation of operating subsidiaries notwithstanding the failure of their parent companies, such as limitations on parent guarantees, and have issued guidance encouraging institutions to take legally binding measures to provide capital and liquidity resources to certain subsidiaries in order to facilitate an orderly resolution. In response to the regulators’ guidance and to facilitate the orderly resolution of the Company using either a single point of entry or multiple point of entry resolution strategy, on June 28, 2017, the Parent entered into a support agreement (the “Support Agreement”) with WFC Holdings, LLC, an intermediate holding company and subsidiary of the Parent (the “IHC”), and the Bank, Wells Fargo Securities, LLC (“WFS”), and Wells Fargo Clearing Services, LLC (“WFCS”), each an indirect subsidiary of the Parent. Pursuant to the Support Agreement, the Parent transferred a significant amount of its assets, including the majority of its cash, deposits, liquid securities and intercompany loans (but excluding its equity interests in its subsidiaries and certain other assets), to the IHC and will continue to transfer those types of assets to the IHC from time to time. In the event of our material financial distress or failure, the IHC will be obligated to use the transferred assets to provide capital and/or liquidity to the Bank pursuant to the Support Agreement and to WFS and WFCS through repurchase facilities entered into in connection with the Support Agreement. Under the Support Agreement, the IHC will also provide funding and liquidity to the Parent through subordinated notes and a committed line of credit, which, together with the issuance of dividends, is expected to provide the Parent, during business as usual operating conditions, with the same access to cash necessary to service its debts, pay dividends, repurchase its shares, and perform its other obligations as it would have had if it had not entered into these arrangements and transferred any assets. If certain liquidity and/or capital metrics fall below defined triggers, the subordinated notes would be forgiven and the committed line of credit would terminate, which could materially and adversely impact the Parent’s liquidity and its ability to satisfy its debts and other obligations, and could result in the commencement of bankruptcy proceedings by the Parent at an earlier time than might have otherwise occurred if the Support Agreement were not implemented. The Parent’s and the IHC’s respective obligations under the Support Agreement are secured pursuant to a related security agreement.

Other Regulatory Related Matters
Broker-dealer standards of conduct . In April 2018, the SEC proposed a rule that would require broker-dealers to act in the best interest of a retail customer when making a recommendation of any securities transaction or investment strategy involving securities. This rule may impact the manner in which business is conducted with customers seeking investment advice and may affect certain investment product offerings.
OCC revocation of relief . On November 18, 2016, the OCC revoked provisions of certain consent orders that provided Wells Fargo Bank, N.A. relief from specific requirements and limitations regarding rules, policies, and procedures for corporate activities; OCC approval of changes in directors and senior executive officers; and golden parachute payments. As a result, Wells Fargo Bank, N.A. is no longer eligible for expedited treatment for certain applications; is
 
now required to provide prior written notice to the OCC of a change in directors and senior executive officers; and is now subject to certain regulatory limitations on golden parachute payments.
Community Reinvestment Act (CRA) rating . In March 2017, we announced that the OCC had downgraded our most recent CRA rating, which covers the years 2009 – 2012, to “Needs to Improve” due to previously issued regulatory consent orders. A “Needs to Improve” rating imposes regulatory restrictions and limitations on certain of the Company’s nonbank activities, including its ability to engage in certain nonbank mergers and acquisitions or undertake new financial in nature activities, and CRA performance is taken into account by regulators in reviewing applications to establish bank branches and for approving proposed bank mergers and acquisitions. The rating also results in the loss of expedited processing of applications to undertake certain activities, and requires the Company to receive prior regulatory approval for certain activities, including to issue or prepay certain subordinated debt obligations, open or relocate bank branches, or make certain public welfare investments. In addition, a “Needs to Improve” rating could have an impact on the Company’s relationships with certain states, counties, municipalities or other public agencies to the extent applicable law, regulation or policy limits, restricts or influences whether such entity may do business with a company that has a below “Satisfactory” rating.
FRB consent order regarding governance oversight and compliance and operational risk management. On February 2, 2018, the Company entered into a consent order with the FRB. As required by the consent order, the Board submitted to the FRB a plan to further enhance the Board’s governance and oversight of the Company, and the Company submitted to the FRB a plan to further improve the Company’s compliance and operational risk management program. The consent order requires the Company, following the FRB’s acceptance and approval of the plans and the Company’s adoption and implementation of the plans, to complete third-party reviews of the enhancements and improvements provided for in the plans. Until these third-party reviews are complete and the plans are approved and implemented to the satisfaction of the FRB, the Company’s total consolidated assets will be limited to the level as of December 31, 2017. Compliance with this asset cap will be measured on a two-quarter daily average basis to allow for management of temporary fluctuations. The Company continues to have constructive dialogue with the FRB on an ongoing basis to clarify expectations, receive feedback, and assess progress under the consent order. In order to have enough time to incorporate this feedback into the Company’s plans in a thoughtful manner, adopt and implement the final plans as accepted by the FRB, and complete the required third-party reviews, the Company is planning to operate under the asset cap through the end of 2019. Additionally, after removal of the asset cap, a second third-party review must also be conducted to assess the efficacy and sustainability of the enhancements and improvements.
Consent orders with the CFPB and OCC regarding compliance risk management program, automobile collateral protection insurance policies, and mortgage interest rate lock extensions . On April 20, 2018, the Company entered into consent orders with the CFPB and OCC to pay an aggregate of $1 billion in civil money

112
Wells Fargo & Company
 


penalties to resolve matters regarding the Company’s compliance risk management program and past practices involving certain automobile collateral protection insurance policies and certain mortgage interest rate lock extensions. As required by the consent orders, the Company submitted to the CFPB and OCC an enterprise-wide compliance risk management plan and a plan to enhance the Company’s internal audit program with respect to federal consumer
 
financial law and the terms of the consent orders. In addition, as required by the consent orders, the Company submitted for non-objection plans to remediate customers affected by the automobile collateral protection insurance and mortgage interest rate lock matters, as well as a plan for the management of remediation activities conducted by the Company.
Critical Accounting Policies 
Our significant accounting policies (see Note 1 (Summary of Significant Accounting Policies) to Financial Statements in this Report) are fundamental to understanding our results of operations and financial condition because they require that we use estimates and assumptions that may affect the value of our assets or liabilities and financial results. Five of these policies are critical because they require management to make difficult, subjective and complex judgments about matters that are inherently uncertain and because it is likely that materially different amounts would be reported under different conditions or using different assumptions. These policies govern:
the allowance for credit losses;
the valuation of residential MSRs;
the fair value of financial instruments;
income taxes; and
liability for contingent litigation losses.

Management and the Board’s Audit and Examination Committee have reviewed and approved these critical accounting policies.

Allowance for Credit Losses
We maintain an allowance for credit losses, which consists of the allowance for loan losses and the allowance for unfunded credit commitments, which is management’s estimate of credit losses inherent in the loan portfolio, including unfunded credit commitments, at the balance sheet date, excluding loans carried at fair value. For a description of our related accounting policies, see Note 1 (Summary of Significant Accounting Policies) to Financial Statements in this Report.
Changes in the allowance for credit losses and, therefore, in the related provision for credit losses can materially affect net income. In applying the judgment and review required to determine the allowance for credit losses, management considers changes in economic conditions, customer behavior, and collateral value, among other influences. From time to time, economic factors or business decisions, such as the addition or liquidation of a loan product or business unit, may affect the loan portfolio, causing management to provide for or release amounts from the allowance for credit losses. While our methodology attributes portions of the allowance to specific portfolio segments (commercial and consumer), the entire allowance for credit losses is available to absorb credit losses inherent in the total loan portfolio and unfunded credit commitments.
Judgment is specifically applied in:
Credit risk ratings applied to individual commercial loans and unfunded credit commitments. We estimate the probability of default in accordance with the borrower’s financial strength using a borrower quality rating and the severity of loss in the event of default using a collateral quality rating. Collectively, these ratings are referred to as credit risk ratings and are assigned to our commercial loans.
 
Probability of default and severity at the time of default are statistically derived through historical observations of defaults and losses after default within each credit risk rating. Commercial loan risk ratings are evaluated based on each situation by experienced senior credit officers and are subject to periodic review by an internal team of credit specialists.
Economic assumptions applied to pools of consumer loans (statistically modeled). Losses are estimated using economic variables to represent our best estimate of inherent loss. Our forecasted losses are modeled using a range of economic scenarios.
Selection of a credit loss estimation model that fits the credit risk characteristics of its portfolio . We use both internally developed and vendor supplied models in this process. We often use expected loss, transition rate, flow rate, competing hazard, vintage maturation, and time series or statistical trend models, most with economic correlations. Management must use judgment in establishing additional input metrics for the modeling processes, considering further stratification into reference data time series, sub-product, origination channel, vintage, loss type, geographic location and other predictive characteristics. The models used to determine the allowance for credit losses are validated in accordance with Company policies by an internal model validation group.
Assessment of limitations to credit loss estimation models. We apply our judgment to adjust our modeled estimates to reflect other risks that may be identified from current conditions and developments in selected portfolios.
Identification and measurement of impaired loans, including loans modified in a TDR. Our experienced senior credit officers may consider a loan impaired based on their evaluation of current information and events, including loans modified in a TDR. The measurement of impairment is typically based on an analysis of the present value of expected future cash flows. The development of these expectations requires significant management judgment and review.
An amount for imprecision or uncertainty which reflects management’s overall estimate of the effect of quantitative and qualitative factors on inherent credit losses. This amount represents management’s judgment of risks inherent in the processes and assumptions used in establishing the allowance for credit losses. This imprecision considers economic environmental factors, modeling assumptions and performance, process risk, and other subjective factors, including industry trends and emerging risk assessments.


 
Wells Fargo & Company
113


Critical Accounting Policies (continued)

SENSITIVITY TO CHANGES Table 49 demonstrates the impact of the sensitivity of our estimates on our allowance for credit losses.

Table 49: Allowance Sensitivity Summary
 
 
 
 
December 31, 2018
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Estimated
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
increase/(decrease)
 
(in billions)
 
 
 
 
in allowance
 
Assumption:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Favorable (1)
 
 
 
 
 
 
$
(3.2
)
 
Adverse (2)
 
 
 
 
 
 
6.9

(1)
Represents a one risk rating upgrade throughout our commercial portfolio segment and a more optimistic economic outlook for modeled losses on our consumer portfolio segment.
(2)
Represents a one risk rating downgrade throughout our commercial portfolio segment, a more pessimistic economic outlook for modeled losses on our consumer portfolio segment, and incremental deterioration for PCI loans.

The sensitivity analyses provided in the previous table are hypothetical scenarios and are not considered probable. They do not represent management’s view of inherent losses in the portfolio as of the balance sheet date. Because significant judgment is used, it is possible that others performing similar analyses could reach different conclusions. See the “Risk Management Credit Risk Management Allowance for Credit Losses” section and Note 6 (Loans and Allowance for Credit Losses) to Financial Statements in this Report for further discussion of our allowance for credit losses.
 
Valuation of Residential Mortgage Servicing Rights (MSRs)
MSRs are assets that represent the rights to service mortgage loans for others. We recognize MSRs when we purchase servicing rights from third parties, or retain servicing rights in connection with the sale or securitization of loans we originate (asset transfers). We also have MSRs acquired in the past under co-issuer agreements that provide for us to service loans that were originated and securitized by third-party correspondents.
We carry our MSRs related to residential mortgage loans at fair value. Periodic changes in our residential MSRs and the economic hedges used to hedge our residential MSRs are reflected in earnings .
We use a model to estimate the fair value of our residential MSRs. The model is validated by an internal model validation group operating in accordance with Company policies . The model calculates the present value of estimated future net servicing income and incorporates inputs and assumptions that market participants use in estimating fair value. Certain significant inputs and assumptions generally are not observable in the market and require judgment to determine. If observable market indications do become available, these are factored into the estimates as appropriate:
The mortgage loan prepayment speed used to estimate future net servicing income. The prepayment speed is the annual rate at which borrowers are forecasted to repay their mortgage loan principal; this rate also includes estimated borrower defaults. We use models to estimate prepayment speeds and borrower defaults which are influenced by changes in mortgage interest rates and borrower behavior.
The discount rate used to present value estimated future net servicing income. The discount rate is the required rate of return investors in the market would expect for an asset with similar risk. To determine the discount rate, we consider the risk premium for uncertainties from servicing
 
operations (e.g., possible changes in future servicing costs, ancillary income and earnings on escrow accounts).
The expected cost to service loans used to estimate future net servicing income. The cost to service loans includes estimates for unreimbursed expenses, such as delinquency and foreclosure costs, which considers the number of defaulted loans as well as changes in servicing processes associated with default and foreclosure management.

Both prepayment speed and discount rate assumptions can, and generally will, change quarterly as market conditions and mortgage interest rates change. For example, an increase in either the prepayment speed or discount rate assumption results in a decrease in the fair value of the MSRs, while a decrease in either assumption would result in an increase in the fair value of the MSRs. In recent years, there have been significant market-driven fluctuations in loan prepayment speeds and the discount rate. These fluctuations can be rapid and may be significant in the future. Additionally, while our current valuation reflects our best estimate of servicing costs, future regulatory or investor changes in servicing standards, as well as changes in individual state foreclosure legislation or additional market participant information regarding servicing cost assumptions, may have an impact on our servicing cost assumption and our MSR valuation in future periods.
For a description of our valuation and sensitivity of MSRs, see Note 1 (Summary of Significant Accounting Policies), Note 9 (Securitizations and Variable Interest Entities), Note 10 (Mortgage Banking Activities) and Note 18 (Fair Values of Assets and Liabilities) to Financial Statements in this Report.

Fair Value of Financial Instruments
Fair value represents the price that would be received to sell the financial asset or paid to transfer the financial liability in an orderly transaction between market participants at the measurement date.
We use fair value measurements to record fair value adjustments to certain financial instruments and to determine fair value disclosures. For example, assets and liabilities held for trading purposes, marketable equity securities not held for trading purposes, debt securities available for sale, derivatives and substantially all of our residential MLHFS are carried at fair value each period. Other financial instruments, such as certain MLHFS, nonmarketable equity securities and substantially all of our loans held for investment, are not carried at fair value each period but may require nonrecurring fair value adjustments due to application of lower-of-cost-or-market accounting, measurement alternative accounting or write-downs of individual assets. We also disclose our estimate of fair value for financial instruments not recorded at fair value, such as loans held for investment or issuances of long-term debt.
The accounting provisions for fair value measurements include a three-level hierarchy for disclosure of assets and liabilities recorded at fair value. The classification of assets and liabilities within the hierarchy is based on whether the inputs to the valuation methodology used for measurement are observable or unobservable. Observable inputs reflect market-derived or market-based information obtained from independent sources, while unobservable inputs reflect our estimates about market data. For additional information on fair value levels, see Note 18 (Fair Values of Assets and Liabilities) to Financial Statements in this Report.
When developing fair value measurements, we maximize the use of observable inputs and minimize the use of unobservable inputs. When available, we use quoted prices in

114
Wells Fargo & Company
 


active markets to measure fair value. If quoted prices in active markets are not available, fair value measurement is based upon models that use primarily market-based or independently sourced market parameters, including interest rate yield curves, prepayment speeds, option volatilities and currency rates. However, when observable market data is limited or not available, fair value estimates are typically determined using internally-developed models based on unobservable inputs. In these instances, management judgment is necessary as we are required to make judgments about significant assumptions market participants would use to estimate fair value. Determination of these assumptions includes consideration of market conditions and liquidity levels. Changes in the market conditions, such as reduced liquidity in the capital markets or changes in secondary market activities, may reduce the availability and reliability of quoted prices or observable data used to determine fair value. In such cases, it may be appropriate to adjust available quoted prices or observable market data. When significant adjustments are required to price quotes or other observable market data, it may be appropriate to utilize an estimate of fair value based primarily on unobservable inputs. Internal models used to determine fair value are validated in accordance with company policies by an internal model validation group. Additionally, we use third-party pricing services to obtain fair values, which are used to either record the price of an instrument or to corroborate internally developed prices. Third-party price validation procedures are performed over the reasonableness of the fair value measurements. For additional information on our use of pricing services, see Note 1 (Summary of Significant Accounting Policies) and Note 18 (Fair Value of Assets and Liabilities) to Financial Statements in this Report.
Significant judgment is also required to determine whether certain assets measured at fair value are classified as Level 2 or Level 3 of the fair value hierarchy as described in Note 18 (Fair Value of Assets and Liabilities) to Financial Statements in this Report. When making this judgment, we consider available information, including observable market data, indications of market liquidity and orderliness, and our understanding of the valuation techniques and significant inputs used. The classification of Level 2 or Level 3 is based upon the specific facts and circumstances of each instrument or instrument category and judgments are made regarding the significance of the Level 3 inputs to the instruments’ fair value measurement in its entirety. If Level 3 inputs are considered significant, the instrument is classified as Level 3.
Table 50 presents the summary of the fair value of financial instruments recorded at fair value on a recurring basis, and the amounts of Level 3 assets and liabilities (before derivative netting adjustments). The fair value of the remaining assets and liabilities were measured using valuation methodologies involving market-based or market-derived information (collectively Level 1 and 2 measurements).
 
Table 50: Fair Value Level 3 Summary
 
December 31, 2018
 
 
December 31, 2017
 
($ in billions)
Total balance 

 
Level 3 (1) 

 
Total balance 

 
Level 3 (1) 

Assets carried
at fair value
$
408.4

 
25.3

 
416.6

 
24.9

As a percentage
of total assets
22
%

1

 
21

 
1

Liabilities carried
at fair value
$
28.2

 
1.6

 
27.3

 
2.0

As a percentage of
total liabilities
2
%

*

 
2

 
*

*    Less than 1%.
(1)
Before derivative netting adjustments.

See Note 18 (Fair Values of Assets and Liabilities) to Financial Statements in this Report for a complete discussion on our fair value of financial instruments, our related measurement techniques and the impact to our financial statements.
 
Income Taxes
We file consolidated and separate company U.S. federal income tax returns, foreign tax returns and various combined and separate company state tax returns. We evaluate two components of income tax expense: current and deferred income tax expense. Current income tax expense represents our estimated taxes to be paid or refunded for the current period and includes income tax expense related to our uncertain tax positions. Deferred income tax expense results from changes in deferred tax assets and liabilities between periods. We determine deferred income taxes using the balance sheet method. Under this method, the net deferred tax asset or liability is based on the tax effects of the differences between the book and tax bases of assets and liabilities, and recognizes enacted changes in tax rates and laws in the period in which they occur. Deferred tax assets are recognized subject to management’s judgment that realization is “more likely than not.” Uncertain tax positions that meet the more likely than not recognition threshold are measured to determine the amount of benefit to recognize. An uncertain tax position is measured at the largest amount of benefit that management believes has a greater than 50% likelihood of realization upon settlement. Tax benefits not meeting our realization criteria represent unrecognized tax benefits. We account for interest and penalties as a component of income tax expense. In 2018, we finalized the recognition of the U.S. tax expense associated with a deemed repatriation of undistributed earnings of certain non-U.S. subsidiaries as required under the 2017 Tax Act. We do not intend to distribute these earnings in a taxable manner, and therefore intend to limit distributions of foreign earnings previously taxed in the U.S., that would qualify for the 100% dividends received deduction, and that would not result in any significant state or foreign taxes. All other undistributed foreign earnings will continue to be permanently reinvested outside the U.S.
The income tax laws of the jurisdictions in which we operate are complex and subject to different interpretations by the taxpayer and the relevant government taxing authorities. In establishing a provision for income tax expense, we must make judgments and interpretations about the application of these inherently complex tax laws. We must also make estimates about when in the future certain items will affect taxable income in the various tax jurisdictions, both domestic and foreign. Our interpretations may be subjected to review during examination by taxing authorities and disputes may arise over the respective tax positions. We attempt to resolve these disputes during the

 
Wells Fargo & Company
115


Critical Accounting Policies (continued)

tax examination and audit process and ultimately through the court systems when applicable.
We monitor relevant tax authorities and revise our estimate of accrued income taxes due to changes in income tax laws and their interpretation by the courts and regulatory authorities on a quarterly basis. Revisions of our estimate of accrued income taxes also may result from our own income tax planning and from the resolution of income tax controversies. Such revisions in our estimates may be material to our operating results for any given quarter.
See Note 23 (Income Taxes) to Financial Statements in this Report for a further description of our provision for income taxes and related income tax assets and liabilities.

Liability for Contingent Litigation Losses
The Company is involved in a number of judicial, regulatory, arbitration and other proceedings concerning matters arising from the conduct of its business activities, and many of those proceedings expose the Company to potential financial loss. We establish accruals for these legal actions when potential losses associated with the actions become probable and the costs can be reasonably estimated. For such accruals, we record the amount we consider to be the best estimate within a range of potential losses that are both probable and estimable; however, if we cannot determine a best estimate, then we record the low end of the range of those potential losses. The actual costs of resolving legal actions may be substantially higher or lower than the amounts accrued for those actions.
 
We apply judgment when establishing an accrual for potential losses associated with legal actions and in establishing the range of reasonably possible losses in excess of the accrual. Our judgment in establishing accruals and the range of reasonably possible losses in excess of the Company’s accrual for probable and estimable losses is influenced by our understanding of information currently available related to the legal evaluation and potential outcome of actions, including input and advice on these matters from our internal counsel, external counsel and senior management. These matters may be in various stages of investigation, discovery or proceedings. They may also involve a wide variety of claims across our businesses, legal entities and jurisdictions. The eventual outcome may be a scenario that was not considered or was considered remote in anticipated occurrence. Accordingly, our estimate of potential losses will change over time and the actual losses may vary significantly.
The outcomes of legal actions are unpredictable and subject to significant uncertainties, and it is inherently difficult to determine whether any loss is probable or even possible. It is also inherently difficult to estimate the amount of any loss and there may be matters for which a loss is probable or reasonably possible but not currently estimable. Accordingly, actual losses may be in excess of the established accrual or the range of reasonably possible loss.
See Note 16 (Legal Actions) to Financial Statements in this Report for further information.

116
Wells Fargo & Company
 


Current Accounting Developments

Table 51 provides the significant accounting updates applicable to us that have been issued by the FASB but are not yet effective.
 
 

Table 51: Current Accounting Developments – Issued Standards
Standard
 
Description
 
Effective date and financial statement impact
Accounting Standard Update (ASU or Update) 2018-16 - Derivatives and Hedging (Topic 815): Inclusion of the Secured Overnight Financing Rate (SOFR) Overnight Index Swap (OIS) Rate as a Benchmark Interest Rate for Hedge Accounting Purposes
 
The Update expands the list of U.S. benchmark interest rates permitted in the application of hedge accounting. The Update adds the OIS rate based on SOFR as a U.S. benchmark interest rate to facilitate the LIBOR to SOFR transition and provide sufficient lead time for entities to prepare for changes to interest rate risk hedging strategies for both risk management and hedge accounting purposes.
 
We adopted the guidance in first quarter 2019. The adoption did not impact existing hedges, but may impact new hedge relationships if we designate the SOFR OIS rate as the designated hedged benchmark interest rate for the Company’s fixed-rate financial instruments and forecasted issuances or purchases of fixed-rate financial instruments.
ASU 2018-12 – Financial Services – Insurance (Topic 944): Targeted Improvements to the Accounting for Long-Duration Contracts
 
The Update requires all features in long-duration insurance contracts that meet the definition of a market risk benefit to be measured at fair value through earnings with changes in fair value attributable to our own credit risk recognized in other comprehensive income. Currently, two measurement models exist for these features, fair value and insurance accrual. The Update requires the use of a standardized discount rate and routine updates for insurance assumptions used in valuing the liability for future policy benefits for traditional long-duration contracts. The Update also simplifies the amortization of deferred acquisition costs.
 
The guidance becomes effective on January 1, 2021. Certain of our variable annuity reinsurance products meet the definition of market risk benefits and will be measured at fair value as of the earliest period presented. The cumulative effect of changes attributable to the market risk benefit of the liability’s instrument-specific credit risk (i.e., the Company’s own credit risk) will be recognized in the beginning balance of accumulated other comprehensive income. The cumulative effect of the difference between fair value and carrying value, excluding the effect of our own credit, will be recognized in the opening balance of retained earnings. Changes to the liability for future policy benefits for traditional long-duration contracts and deferred acquisition costs will be applied to all outstanding contracts on the basis of their existing carrying amounts at the beginning of the earliest period presented. The impact of the Update on our consolidated financial statements is still being evaluated.
ASU 2017-08 – Receivables – Nonrefundable Fees and Other Costs (Subtopic 310-20): Premium Amortization on Purchased Callable Debt Securities
 
The Update changes the accounting for certain purchased callable debt securities held at a premium to shorten the amortization period for the premium to the earliest call date rather than to the maturity date. Accounting for purchased callable debt securities held at a discount does not change. The discount would continue to amortize to the maturity date.
 
We adopted the guidance in first quarter 2019 and recorded a cumulative-effect adjustment as of January 1, 2019, that reduced retained earnings by $592 million and increased other comprehensive income by $481 million. The guidance impacted our investments in purchased callable debt securities held at a premium classified as available-for-sale (AFS) and held-to-maturity (HTM), which primarily consist of obligations of U.S. states and political subdivisions. In future periods, interest income recognized prior to the call date will be reduced because the premium will be amortized over a shorter time period.


 
Wells Fargo & Company
117


Current Accounting Developments (continued)


Standard
 
Description
 
Effective date and financial statement impact
ASU 2016-13 – Financial Instruments – Credit Losses (Topic 326):  Measurement of Credit Losses on Financial Instruments
 
The Update changes the accounting for credit losses measurement on loans and debt securities. For loans and held-to-maturity debt securities, the Update requires a current expected credit loss (CECL) measurement to estimate the allowance for credit losses (ACL) for the remaining estimated life of the financial asset (including off-balance sheet credit exposures) using historical experience, current conditions, and reasonable and supportable forecasts. The Update eliminates the existing guidance for PCI loans, but requires an allowance for purchased financial assets with more than insignificant deterioration since origination. In addition, the Update modifies the other-than-temporary impairment model for available-for-sale debt securities to require an allowance for credit impairment instead of a direct write-down, which allows for reversal of credit impairments in future periods based on improvements in credit.
 
We expect to adopt the guidance in first quarter 2020. Our implementation process includes loss forecasting model development, evaluation of technical accounting topics, updates to our allowance documentation, reporting processes and related internal controls, and overall operational readiness for our adoption of the Update, which will continue throughout 2019, including parallel runs for CECL alongside our current allowance process.
We are in the process of developing, validating, and implementing models used to estimate credit losses under CECL. We have substantially completed a significant majority of our loss forecasting models, and we expect to complete the validation process for our loan models during 2019.
Our current planned approach for estimating expected life-time credit losses for loans and debt securities includes the following key components:
An initial forecast period of one year for all portfolio segments and classes of financing receivables and off-balance-sheet credit exposures. This period reflects management’s expectation of losses based on forward-looking economic scenarios over that time.
A historical loss forecast period covering the remaining contractual life, adjusted for prepayments, by portfolio segment and class of financing receivables based on the change in key historic economic variables during representative historical expansionary and recessionary periods.
A reversion period of up to 2 years connecting the initial loss forecast to the historical loss forecast based on economic conditions at the measurement date.
We will utilize discounted cash flow (DCF) methods to measure credit impairment for loans modified in a TDR, unless they are collateral dependent and measured at the fair value of collateral. The DCF methods would obtain estimated life-time credit losses using the conceptual components described above.
For available-for-sale debt securities and certain beneficial interests classified as held-to-maturity, we plan to utilize the DCF methods to measure the ACL, which will incorporate expected credit losses using the conceptual components described above.

We expect an overall increase in the ACL for loans, with an expected increase for longer duration consumer portfolios and an expected decrease for commercial loans given short contractual maturities with conditional renewal options. The expected impact on our ACL does not include the impact of the FASB’s recently proposed change to consider recoveries of previously charged off loans or subsequent increases in fair value of collateral for collateral dependent loans in the ACL measurement. If finalized, the proposed changes would reduce the expected change in our ACL. We continue to evaluate the results of our modeled loss estimates and will continue to make refinements to our approach, including evaluating an amount for imprecision or uncertainty, based on management’s judgment of the risk inherent in the processes and assumptions used in estimating the ACL.
We will recognize an ACL for held-to-maturity and available-for-sale debt securities. The ACL on available-for-sale debt securities will be subject to a limitation based on the fair value of the security. Based on the credit quality of our existing debt securities portfolio, we do not expect the ACL for held-to-maturity and available-for-sale debt securities to be significant.
The amount of the change in our ACL will be impacted by our portfolio composition and credit quality at the adoption date as well as economic conditions and forecasts at that time. At adoption, we expect to have a cumulative-effect adjustment to retained earnings for our change in the ACL, which will impact our capital. Federal banking regulatory agencies have agreed to limit the initial capital impact of the Update by allowing a phased adoption over three years, on a straight-line basis. An increase in our ACL will result in a reduction to our regulatory capital amounts and ratios; however, at this point in implementation, we are not able to provide a more precise estimate of the impact.

118
Wells Fargo & Company
 


Standard
 
Description
 
Effective date and financial statement impact
ASU 2016-02 – Leases (Topic 842) and subsequent related Updates
 
The Update requires lessees to recognize operating leases on the balance sheet with lease liabilities and related right-of-use assets based on the present value of future lease payments. Lessor accounting activities are largely unchanged from existing lease accounting. The Update also eliminates leveraged lease accounting but allows existing leveraged leases to continue their current accounting until maturity, termination or modification.
 
We adopted the guidance in first quarter 2019 and have elected not to provide a comparative presentation for 2018 and 2017 financial statements. At adoption, we recognized a cumulative effect adjustment of approximately $100 million that increased retained earnings related to deferred gains on our prior sale-leaseback transactions. Our operating lease right-of-use assets and liabilities, for approximately 7,000 leases, were $5 billion and $5.6 billion, respectively. There were no material changes to the timing of expense recognition on these operating leases or in the recognition and measurement of our lessor accounting. While the increase to our consolidated total assets related to operating lease right-of-use assets increases our risk-weighted assets and decreases our capital ratios, we do not expect these changes to be material.
In addition to the list above, the following Updates are applicable to us but are not expected to have a material impact on our consolidated financial statements:
ASU 2018-17 – Consolidation (Topic 810): Targeted Improvements to Related Party Guidance for Variable Interest Entities
ASU 2018-15 – Intangibles – Goodwill and Other – Internal-Use Software (Subtopic 350-40): Customer’s Accounting for Implementation Costs Incurred in a Cloud Computing Arrangement That Is a Service Contract (a consensus of the FASB Emerging Issues Task Force)
 
ASU 2018-13 – Fair Value Measurement (Topic 820): Disclosure Framework Changes to the Disclosure Requirements for Fair Value Measurement
ASU 2018-09 – Codification Improvements
ASU 2018-03 – Technical Corrections and Improvements to Financial Instruments – Overall (Subtopic 825-10): Financial Instruments Overall
ASU 2017-04 – Intangibles – Goodwill and Other (Topic 350): Simplifying the Test for Goodwill Impairment

Forward-Looking Statements  
This document contains “forward-looking statements” within the meaning of the Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995. In addition, we may make forward-looking statements in our other documents filed or furnished with the SEC, and our management may make forward-looking statements orally to analysts, investors, representatives of the media and others. Forward-looking statements can be identified by words such as “anticipates,” “intends,” “plans,” “seeks,” “believes,” “estimates,” “expects,” “target,” “projects,” “outlook,” “forecast,” “will,” “may,” “could,” “should,” “can” and similar references to future periods. In particular, forward-looking statements include, but are not limited to, statements we make about: (i) the future operating or financial performance of the Company, including our outlook for future growth; (ii) our noninterest expense and efficiency ratio; (iii) future credit quality and performance, including our expectations regarding future loan losses and allowance levels; (iv) the appropriateness of the allowance for credit losses; (v) our expectations regarding net interest income and net interest margin; (vi) loan growth or the reduction or mitigation of risk in our loan portfolios; (vii) future capital or liquidity levels or targets and our estimated Common Equity Tier 1 ratio under Basel III capital standards; (viii) the performance of our mortgage business and any related exposures; (ix) the expected outcome and impact of legal, regulatory and legislative developments, as well as our expectations regarding compliance therewith; (x) future common stock dividends, common share repurchases and other uses of capital; (xi) our targeted range for return on assets, return on equity, and return on tangible common equity; (xii) the outcome of contingencies, such as legal proceedings; and (xiii) the Company’s plans, objectives and strategies.
Forward-looking statements are not based on historical facts but instead represent our current expectations and assumptions regarding our business, the economy and other future conditions. Because forward-looking statements relate to the future, they are subject to inherent uncertainties, risks and
 
changes in circumstances that are difficult to predict. Our actual results may differ materially from those contemplated by the forward-looking statements. We caution you, therefore, against relying on any of these forward-looking statements. They are neither statements of historical fact nor guarantees or assurances of future performance. While there is no assurance that any list of risks and uncertainties or risk factors is complete, important factors that could cause actual results to differ materially from those in the forward-looking statements include the following, without limitation:
current and future economic and market conditions, including the effects of declines in housing prices, high unemployment rates, U.S. fiscal debt, budget and tax matters, geopolitical matters, and any slowdown in global economic growth; 
our capital and liquidity requirements (including under regulatory capital standards, such as the Basel III capital standards) and our ability to generate capital internally or raise capital on favorable terms;
financial services reform and other current, pending or future legislation or regulation that could have a negative effect on our revenue and businesses, including the Dodd-Frank Act and other legislation and regulation relating to bank products and services;
developments in our mortgage banking business, including the extent of the success of our mortgage loan modification efforts, the amount of mortgage loan repurchase demands that we receive, any negative effects relating to our mortgage servicing, loan modification or foreclosure practices, and the effects of regulatory or judicial requirements or guidance impacting our mortgage banking business and any changes in industry standards;
our ability to realize any efficiency ratio or expense target as part of our expense management initiatives, including as a result of business and economic cyclicality, seasonality, changes in our business composition and operating

 
Wells Fargo & Company
119


Forward-Looking Statements (continued)

environment, growth in our businesses and/or acquisitions, and unexpected expenses relating to, among other things, litigation and regulatory matters;
the effect of the current interest rate environment or changes in interest rates on our net interest income, net interest margin and our mortgage originations, mortgage servicing rights and mortgage loans held for sale;
significant turbulence or a disruption in the capital or financial markets, which could result in, among other things, reduced investor demand for mortgage loans, a reduction in the availability of funding or increased funding costs, and declines in asset values and/or recognition of other-than-temporary impairment on securities held in our debt securities and equity securities portfolios;
the effect of a fall in stock market prices on our investment banking business and our fee income from our brokerage, asset and wealth management businesses;
negative effects from the retail banking sales practices matter and from other instances where customers may have experienced financial harm, including on our legal, operational and compliance costs, our ability to engage in certain business activities or offer certain products or services, our ability to keep and attract customers, our ability to attract and retain qualified team members, and our reputation;
resolution of regulatory matters, litigation, or other legal actions, which may result in, among other things, additional costs, fines, penalties, restrictions on our business activities, reputational harm, or other adverse consequences;
a failure in or breach of our operational or security systems or infrastructure, or those of our third-party vendors or other service providers, including as a result of cyber attacks;
the effect of changes in the level of checking or savings account deposits on our funding costs and net interest margin;
fiscal and monetary policies of the Federal Reserve Board; and
the other risk factors and uncertainties described under “Risk Factors” in this Report.
 
 
In addition to the above factors, we also caution that the amount and timing of any future common stock dividends or repurchases will depend on the earnings, cash requirements and financial condition of the Company, market conditions, capital requirements (including under Basel capital standards), common stock issuance requirements, applicable law and regulations (including federal securities laws and federal banking regulations), and other factors deemed relevant by the Company’s Board of Directors, and may be subject to regulatory approval or conditions.
For more information about factors that could cause actual results to differ materially from our expectations, refer to our reports filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission, including the discussion under “Risk Factors” in this Report, as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission and available on its website at www.sec.gov. 
Any forward-looking statement made by us speaks only as of the date on which it is made. Factors or events that could cause our actual results to differ may emerge from time to time, and it is not possible for us to predict all of them. We undertake no obligation to publicly update any forward-looking statement, whether as a result of new information, future developments or otherwise, except as may be required by law.

Forward-looking Non-GAAP Financial Measures . From time to time management may discuss forward-looking non-GAAP financial measures, such as forward-looking estimates or targets for return on average tangible common equity. We are unable to provide a reconciliation of forward-looking non-GAAP financial measures to their most directly comparable GAAP financial measures because we are unable to provide, without unreasonable effort, a meaningful or accurate calculation or estimation of amounts that would be necessary for the reconciliation due to the complexity and inherent difficulty in forecasting and quantifying future amounts or when they may occur. Such unavailable information could be significant to future results.

Risk Factors
An investment in the Company involves risk, including the possibility that the value of the investment could fall substantially and that dividends or other distributions on the investment could be reduced or eliminated. We discuss below risk factors that could adversely affect our financial results and condition, and the value of, and return on, an investment in the Company.
 
RISKS RELATED TO THE ECONOMY, FINANCIAL MARKETS, INTEREST RATES AND LIQUIDITY
 
As one of the largest lenders in the U.S. and a provider of financial products and services to consumers and businesses across the U.S. and internationally, our financial results have been, and will continue to be, materially affected by general economic conditions, and a deterioration in economic conditions or in the financial markets may materially adversely affect our lending and other businesses and our financial results and condition.  We generate revenue from the interest and fees we charge on the loans and other products and services we
 
sell, and a substantial amount of our revenue and earnings comes from the net interest income and fee income that we earn from our consumer and commercial lending and banking businesses, including our mortgage banking business. These businesses have been, and will continue to be, materially affected by the state of the U.S. economy, particularly unemployment levels and home prices. Although the U.S. economy has continued to gradually improve from the depressed levels of 2008 and early 2009, economic growth has at times been slow and uneven. In addition, the negative effects and continued uncertainty stemming from U.S. fiscal and political matters, including concerns about deficit levels, taxes and U.S. debt ratings, have impacted and may continue to impact the global economic recovery. Moreover, geopolitical matters, including international political unrest or disturbances, Britain’s vote to withdraw from the European Union, as well as continued concerns over commodity prices, restrictions on international trade, and global economic difficulties, may impact the stability of financial markets and the global economy. In particular, Britain’s vote to withdraw from the European Union, including the terms of its exit, could increase economic barriers between

120
Wells Fargo & Company
 


Britain and the European Union, limit our ability to conduct business in the European Union, impose additional costs on us, subject us to different laws, regulations and/or regulatory authorities, or adversely impact our business, financial results and operating model. For example, certain operations of our broker-dealer in London may be impacted by the terms and conditions of Britain’s withdrawal. Although we are transitioning certain of these operations to other European countries, there is no guarantee that we will be able to operate or conduct business in the European Union in the same manner following Britain’s withdrawal. A prolonged period of slow growth in the global economy, particularly in the U.S., or any deterioration in general economic conditions and/or the financial markets resulting from the above matters or any other events or factors that may disrupt or dampen the global economic recovery could materially adversely affect our financial results and condition. 
A weakening in business or economic conditions, including higher unemployment levels or declines in home prices, can also adversely affect our borrowers’ ability to repay their loans, which can negatively impact our credit performance. If unemployment levels worsen or if home prices fall we would expect to incur elevated charge-offs and provision expense from increases in our allowance for credit losses. These conditions may adversely affect not only consumer loan performance but also commercial and CRE loans, especially for those business borrowers that rely on the health of industries that may experience deteriorating economic conditions. The ability of these and other borrowers to repay their loans may deteriorate, causing us, as one of the largest commercial and CRE lenders in the U.S., to incur significantly higher credit losses. In addition, weak or deteriorating economic conditions make it more challenging for us to increase our consumer and commercial loan portfolios by making loans to creditworthy borrowers at attractive yields. Furthermore, weak economic conditions, as well as competition and/or increases in interest rates, could soften demand for our loans resulting in our retaining a much higher amount of lower yielding liquid assets on our balance sheet. If economic conditions do not continue to improve or if the economy worsens and unemployment rises, which also would likely result in a decrease in consumer and business confidence and spending, the demand for our credit products, including our mortgages, may fall, reducing our interest and noninterest income and our earnings.
A deterioration in business and economic conditions, which may erode consumer and investor confidence levels, and/or increased volatility of financial markets, also could adversely affect financial results for our fee-based businesses, including our investment advisory, mutual fund, securities brokerage, wealth management, and investment banking businesses. In 2018 , approximately 25% of our revenue was fee income, which included trust and investment fees, card fees and other fees. We earn fee income from managing assets for others and providing brokerage and other investment advisory and wealth management services. Because investment management fees are often based on the value of assets under management, a fall in the market prices of those assets could reduce our fee income. Changes in stock market prices could affect the trading activity of investors, reducing commissions and other fees we earn from our brokerage business. In addition, adverse market conditions may negatively affect the performance of products we have provided to customers, which may expose us to legal actions or additional costs. The U.S. stock market experienced all-time highs in 2018, but also experienced significant volatility and there is no guarantee that high price levels will continue or that price levels will stabilize. Poor economic conditions and volatile
 
or unstable financial markets also can negatively affect our debt and equity underwriting and advisory businesses, as well as our trading activities and venture capital businesses. Any deterioration in global financial markets and economies, including as a result of any international political unrest or disturbances, may adversely affect the revenues and earnings of our international operations, particularly our global financial institution and correspondent banking services.
For more information, refer to the “Risk Management – Asset/Liability Management” and “– Credit Risk Management” sections in this Report.
 
Changes in interest rates and financial market values could reduce our net interest income and earnings, as well as our other comprehensive income, including as a result of recognizing losses on the debt and equity securities that we hold in our portfolio or trade for our customers.   Our net interest income is the interest we earn on loans, debt securities and other assets we hold less
the interest we pay on our deposits, long-term and short-term debt, and other liabilities. Net interest income is a measure of both our net interest margin – the difference between the yield we earn on our assets and the interest rate we pay for deposits and our other sources of funding – and the amount of earning assets we hold. Changes in either our net interest margin or the amount or mix of earning assets we hold could affect our net interest income and our earnings. Changes in interest rates can affect our net interest margin. Although the yield we earn on our assets and our funding costs tend to move in the same direction in response to changes in interest rates, one can rise or fall faster than the other, causing our net interest margin to expand or contract. If our funding costs rise faster than the yield we earn on our assets or if the yield we earn on our assets falls faster than our funding costs, our net interest margin could contract.
The amount and type of earning assets we hold can affect our yield and net interest margin. We hold earning assets in the form of loans and debt and equity securities, among other assets. As noted above, if the economy worsens we may see lower demand for loans by creditworthy customers, reducing our net interest income and yield. In addition, our net interest income and net interest margin can be negatively affected by a prolonged low interest rate environment as it may result in us holding lower yielding loans and securities on our balance sheet, particularly if we are unable to replace the maturing higher yielding assets with similar higher yielding assets. Increases in interest rates, however, may negatively affect loan demand and could result in higher credit losses as borrowers may have more difficulty making higher interest payments. As described below, changes in interest rates also affect our mortgage business, including the value of our MSRs.
Changes in the slope of the “yield curve” – or the spread between short-term and long-term interest rates – could also reduce our net interest margin. Normally, the yield curve is upward sloping, meaning short-term rates are lower than long-term rates. When the yield curve flattens, or even inverts, our net interest margin could decrease if the cost of our short-term funding increases relative to the yield we can earn on our long-term assets.
The interest we earn on our loans may be tied to U.S.-denominated interest rates such as the federal funds rate while the interest we pay on our debt may be based on international rates such as LIBOR. If the federal funds rate were to fall without a corresponding decrease in LIBOR, we might earn less on our loans without any offsetting decrease in our funding costs. This could lower our net interest margin and our net interest income.

 
Wells Fargo & Company
121


Risk Factors (continued)

In addition, our floating rate funding, certain hedging transactions, and certain of the products that we offer, such as floating rate loans and derivatives in connection with customer accommodation activities, reference a benchmark rate, such as LIBOR, or other financial metric in order to determine the applicable interest rate or payment amount. In the event any such benchmark rate or other referenced financial metric is significantly changed, replaced or discontinued, or ceases to be recognized as an acceptable market benchmark rate or financial metric (for example, if LIBOR is discontinued after 2021 as contemplated by the U.K. Financial Conduct Authority), there may be uncertainty or differences in the calculation of the applicable interest rate or payment amount depending on the terms of the governing instrument and there may be significant work required to transition to using any new benchmark rate or other financial metric. This could result in different financial performance for previously booked transactions, require different hedging strategies, require renegotiation of previously booked transactions, or affect our capital and liquidity planning and management. In addition, the transition to using any new benchmark rate or other financial metric may impact our existing transaction data, products, systems, models, operations and pricing processes, and could result in significant operational, systems, or other practical challenges, increased compliance, legal and operational costs, losses on financial instruments we hold, or other adverse consequences. Furthermore, the transition from a widely-used benchmark rate like LIBOR to any new benchmark rate could have a significant impact on the overall interest rate environment and could result in customers challenging the determination of their interest payments or entering into fewer transactions or postponing their financing needs, which could reduce our revenue and adversely affect our business. Moreover, to the extent borrowers with loans referenced to LIBOR, such as adjustable rate mortgage loans, experience higher interest payments as a result of the transition to a new benchmark rate, our customers’ ability to repay their loans may be adversely affected, which can negatively impact our credit performance.
We assess our interest rate risk by estimating the effect on our earnings under various scenarios that differ based on assumptions about the direction, magnitude and speed of interest rate changes and the slope of the yield curve. We hedge some of that interest rate risk with interest rate derivatives. We also rely on the “natural hedge” that our mortgage loan originations and servicing rights can provide.
We generally do not hedge all of our interest rate risk. There is always the risk that changes in interest rates, credit spreads or option volatility could reduce our net interest income and earnings, as well as our other comprehensive income, in material amounts, especially if actual conditions turn out to be materially different than what we assumed. For example, if interest rates rise or fall faster than we assumed or the slope of the yield curve changes, we may incur significant losses on debt securities we hold as investments. To reduce our interest rate risk, we may rebalance our portfolios of debt securities, equity securities and loans, refinance our debt and take other strategic actions. We may incur losses when we take such actions.
We hold debt and equity securities, including U.S. Treasury and federal agency securities and federal agency MBS, securities of U.S. states and political subdivisions, residential and commercial MBS, corporate debt securities, other asset-backed securities and marketable equity securities, including securities relating to our venture capital activities. Because of changing economic and market conditions, as well as credit ratings, affecting issuers and the performance of any collateral
 
underlying the securities, we may be required to recognize OTTI in future periods on the securities we hold. In particular, economic difficulties in the oil and gas industry resulting from volatile or prolonged low energy prices may further impact our energy sector investments and require us to recognize OTTI in these investments in future periods. Furthermore, the value of the debt securities we hold can fluctuate due to changes in interest rates, issuer creditworthiness, and other factors. Our net income also is exposed to changes in interest rates, credit spreads, foreign exchange rates, and equity and commodity prices in connection with our trading activities, which are conducted primarily to accommodate the investment and risk management activities of our customers, as well as when we execute economic hedging to manage certain balance sheet risks. Trading debt securities and equity securities held for trading are carried at fair value with realized and unrealized gains and losses recorded in noninterest income. As part of our business to support our customers, we trade public debt and equity securities that are subject to market fluctuations with gains and losses recognized in net income. In addition, although high market volatility can increase our exposure to trading-related losses, periods of low volatility may have an adverse effect on our businesses as a result of reduced customer activity levels. Although we have processes in place to measure and monitor the risks associated with our trading activities, including stress testing and hedging strategies, there can be no assurance that our processes and strategies will be effective in avoiding losses that could have a material adverse effect on our financial results.
The value of our marketable and nonmarketable equity securities can fluctuate from quarter to quarter. Marketable equity securities are carried at fair value with unrealized gains and losses reflected in earnings. Nonmarketable equity securities are carried under the cost method, equity method, or measurement alternative, while others are carried at fair value with unrealized gains and losses reflected in earnings. Earnings from our equity securities portfolio may be volatile and hard to predict, and may have a significant effect on our earnings from period to period. When, and if, we recognize gains may depend on a number of factors, including general economic and market conditions, the prospects of the companies in which we invest, when a company goes public, the size of our position relative to the public float, and whether we are subject to any resale restrictions.
Nonmarketable equity securities include our private equity and venture capital investments that could result in significant OTTI losses for those investments carried under the measurement alternative or equity method. If we determine there is OTTI for an investment, we write-down the carrying value of the investment, resulting in a charge to earnings, which could be significant.
For more information, refer to the “Risk Management – Asset/Liability Management – Interest Rate Risk”, “– Mortgage Banking Interest Rate and Market Risk”, “– Market Risk – Trading Activities”, and “– Market Risk – Equity Securities” and the “Balance Sheet Analysis – Available-for-Sale and Held-to-Maturity Debt Securities” sections in this Report and Note 4 (Trading Activities), Note 5 (Available-for-Sale and Held-to-Maturity Debt Securities) and Note 8 (Equity Securities) to Financial Statements in this Report.
 
Effective liquidity management, which ensures that we can meet customer loan requests, customer deposit maturities/withdrawals and other cash commitments, including principal and interest payments on our debt, efficiently under both normal operating conditions and

122
Wells Fargo & Company
 


other unpredictable circumstances of industry or financial market stress, is essential for the operation of our business, and our financial results and condition could be materially adversely affected if we do not effectively manage our liquidity.   Our liquidity is essential for the operation of our business. We primarily rely on bank deposits to be a low cost and stable source of funding for the loans we make and the operation of our business. Customer deposits, which include noninterest-bearing deposits, interest-bearing checking, savings certificates, certain market rate and other savings, and certain foreign deposits, have historically provided us with a sizable source of relatively stable and low-cost funds. In addition to customer deposits, our sources of liquidity include certain debt and equity securities, our ability to sell or securitize loans in secondary markets and to pledge loans to access secured borrowing facilities through the FHLB and the FRB, and our ability to raise funds in domestic and international money through capital markets.
Our liquidity and our ability to fund and run our business could be materially adversely affected by a variety of conditions and factors, including financial and credit market disruption and volatility or a lack of market or customer confidence in financial markets in general similar to what occurred during the financial crisis in 2008 and early 2009, which may result in a loss of customer deposits or outflows of cash or collateral and/or our inability to access capital markets on favorable terms. Market disruption and volatility could impact our credit spreads, which are the amount in excess of the interest rate of U.S. Treasury securities, or other benchmark securities, of the same maturity that we need to pay to our funding providers. Increases in interest rates and our credit spreads could significantly increase our funding costs. Other conditions and factors that could materially adversely affect our liquidity and funding include a lack of market or customer confidence in the Company or negative news about the Company or the financial services industry generally which also may result in a loss of deposits and/or negatively affect our ability to access the capital markets; our inability to sell or securitize loans or other assets; and, as described below, reductions in one or more of our credit ratings. Many of the above conditions and factors may be caused by events over which we have little or no control. While market conditions have improved since the financial crisis, there can be no assurance that significant disruption and volatility in the financial markets will not occur in the future. For example, concerns over geopolitical issues, commodity and currency prices, as well as global economic conditions, may cause financial market volatility.
In addition, concerns regarding U.S. government debt levels and any associated downgrade of U.S. government debt ratings may cause uncertainty and volatility as well. A downgrade of the sovereign debt ratings of the U.S. government or the debt ratings of related institutions, agencies or instrumentalities, as well as other fiscal or political events could, in addition to causing economic and financial market disruptions, materially adversely affect the market value of the U.S. government securities that we hold, the availability of those securities as collateral for borrowing, and our ability to access capital markets on favorable terms, as well as have other material adverse effects on the operation of our business and our financial results and condition.
As noted above, we rely heavily on bank deposits for our funding and liquidity. We compete with banks and other financial services companies for deposits. If our competitors raise the rates they pay on deposits our funding costs may increase, either because we raise our rates to avoid losing
 
deposits or because we lose deposits and must rely on more expensive sources of funding. Higher funding costs reduce our net interest margin and net interest income. Checking and savings account balances and other forms of customer deposits may decrease when customers perceive alternative investments, such as the stock market, as providing a better risk/return tradeoff. When customers move money out of bank deposits and into other investments, we may lose a relatively low-cost source of funds, increasing our funding costs and negatively affecting our liquidity.
If we are unable to continue to fund our assets through customer bank deposits or access capital markets on favorable terms or if we suffer an increase in our borrowing costs or otherwise fail to manage our liquidity effectively (including on an intraday basis), our liquidity, net interest margin, financial results and condition may be materially adversely affected. As we did during the financial crisis, we may also need, or be required by our regulators, to raise additional capital through the issuance of common stock, which could dilute the ownership of existing stockholders, or reduce or even eliminate our common stock dividend to preserve capital or in order to raise additional capital.  
For more information, refer to the “Risk Management – Asset/Liability Management” section in this Report.
 
Adverse changes in our credit ratings could have a material adverse effect on our liquidity, cash flows, financial results and condition.   Our borrowing costs and ability to obtain funding are influenced by our credit ratings. Reductions in one or more of our credit ratings could adversely affect our ability to borrow funds and raise the costs of our borrowings substantially and could cause creditors and business counterparties to raise collateral requirements or take other actions that could adversely affect our ability to raise funding. Credit ratings and credit ratings agencies’ outlooks are based on the ratings agencies’ analysis of many quantitative and qualitative factors, such as our capital adequacy, liquidity, asset quality, business mix, the level and quality of our earnings, rating agency assumptions regarding the probability and extent of federal financial assistance or support, and other rating agency specific criteria. In addition to credit ratings, our borrowing costs are affected by various other external factors, including market volatility and concerns or perceptions about the financial services industry generally. There can be no assurance that we will maintain our credit ratings and outlooks and that credit ratings downgrades in the future would not materially affect our ability to borrow funds and borrowing costs.
Downgrades in our credit ratings also may trigger additional collateral or funding obligations which could negatively affect our liquidity, including as a result of credit-related contingent features in certain of our derivative contracts. Although a one or two notch downgrade in our current credit ratings would not be expected to trigger a material increase in our collateral or funding obligations, a more severe credit rating downgrade of our long-term and short-term credit ratings could increase our collateral or funding obligations and the effect on our liquidity could be material.
For information on our credit ratings, see the “Risk Management – Asset/Liability Management – Liquidity and Funding – Credit Ratings” section and for information regarding additional collateral and funding obligations required of certain derivative instruments in the event our credit ratings were to fall below investment grade, see Note 17 (Derivatives) to Financial Statements in this Report.

 
Wells Fargo & Company
123


Risk Factors (continued)

We rely on dividends from our subsidiaries for liquidity, and federal and state law, as well as certain contractual arrangements, can limit those dividends.  Wells Fargo & Company, the parent holding company (the “Parent”), is a separate and distinct legal entity from its subsidiaries. It receives substantially all of its funding and liquidity from dividends and other distributions from its subsidiaries. We generally use these dividends and distributions, among other things, to pay dividends on our common and preferred stock and interest and principal on our debt. Federal and state laws limit the amount of dividends and distributions that our bank and some of our nonbank subsidiaries, including our broker-dealer subsidiaries, may pay to the Parent. In addition, under a Support Agreement (the “Support Agreement”) dated June 28, 2017 among the Parent, WFC Holdings, LLC, an intermediate holding company and subsidiary of the Parent (the “IHC”), and Wells Fargo Bank, N.A., Wells Fargo Securities, LLC, and Wells Fargo Clearing Services, LLC, each an indirect subsidiary of the Parent, the IHC may be restricted from making dividend payments to the Parent if certain liquidity and/or capital metrics fall below defined triggers. Also, our right to participate in a distribution of assets upon a subsidiary’s liquidation or reorganization is subject to the prior claims of the subsidiary’s creditors.
For more information, refer to the “Regulation and Supervision – Dividend Restrictions” and “– Holding Company Structure” sections in our 2018 Form 10-K and to Note 3 (Cash, Loan and Dividend Restrictions) and Note 28 (Regulatory and Agency Capital Requirements) to Financial Statements in this Report.
 
RISKS RELATED TO FINANCIAL REGULATORY REFORM AND OTHER LEGISLATION AND REGULATIONS

Enacted legislation and regulation, including the Dodd-Frank Act, as well as future legislation and/or regulation, could require us to change certain of our business practices, reduce our revenue and earnings, impose additional costs on us or otherwise adversely affect our business operations and/or competitive position.   Our parent company, our subsidiary banks and many of our nonbank subsidiaries such as those related to our brokerage and mutual fund businesses, are subject to significant and extensive regulation under state and federal laws in the U.S., as well as the applicable laws of the various jurisdictions outside of the U.S. where we conduct business. These regulations protect depositors, federal deposit insurance funds, consumers, investors, team members, and the banking and financial system as a whole, not necessarily our security holders. Economic, market and political conditions during the past few years have led to a significant amount of legislation and regulation in the U.S. and abroad affecting the financial services industry, as well as heightened expectations and scrutiny of financial services companies from banking regulators. These laws and regulations may affect the manner in which we do business and the products and services that we provide, affect or restrict our ability to compete in our current businesses or our ability to enter into or acquire new businesses, reduce or limit our revenue in businesses or impose additional fees, assessments or taxes on us, intensify the regulatory supervision of us and the financial services industry, and adversely affect our business operations or have other negative consequences. Our businesses and revenues in non-U.S. jurisdictions are also subject to risks from political, economic and social developments in those jurisdictions,
 
including sanctions or business restrictions, asset freezes or confiscation, unfavorable political or diplomatic developments, or financial or social instability. In addition, greater government oversight and scrutiny of financial services companies has increased our operational and compliance costs as we must continue to devote substantial resources to enhancing our procedures and controls and meeting heightened regulatory standards and expectations. Any failure to meet regulatory requirements, standards or expectations, either in the U.S. or in foreign jurisdictions, could result in fees, penalties, restrictions on our ability to engage in certain business activities, or other adverse consequences.
On July 21, 2010, the Dodd-Frank Act, the most significant financial reform legislation since the 1930s, became law. The Dodd-Frank Act, among other things, imposes significant requirements and restrictions impacting the financial services industry. The Dodd-Frank Act, including current and future rules implementing its provisions and the interpretation of those rules, could result in a loss of revenue, require us to change certain of our business practices, limit our ability to pursue certain business opportunities, increase our capital requirements and impose additional assessments and costs on us and otherwise adversely affect our business operations and have other negative consequences.
Our consumer businesses, including our mortgage, automobile, credit card and other consumer lending and non-lending businesses, are subject to numerous and, in many cases, highly complex consumer protection laws and regulations, as well as enhanced regulatory scrutiny and more and expanded regulatory examinations and/or investigations. In particular, we may be negatively affected by the activities of the Consumer Financial Protection Bureau (CFPB), which has broad rulemaking powers and supervisory authority over consumer financial products and services. The CFPB’s activities may increase our compliance costs and require changes in our business practices as a result of regulations and requirements which could limit or negatively affect the products and services that we offer our customers. For example, the CFPB has issued a number of rules impacting residential mortgage lending practices and prepaid cards. If we fail to meet enhanced regulatory requirements and expectations with respect to our consumer businesses, we may be subject to increased costs, fines, penalties, restrictions on our business activities including the products and services we can provide, and/or harm to our reputation.
The Dodd-Frank Act’s proposed prohibitions or limitations on proprietary trading and private fund investment activities, known as the “Volcker Rule,” also may reduce our revenue. Final rules to implement the requirements of the Volcker Rule were issued in December 2013. The FRB has proposed further rules to streamline and modify compliance with the Volcker Rule’s requirements. Wells Fargo is also subject to enhanced compliance program requirements.
In addition, the Dodd-Frank Act established a comprehensive framework for regulating over-the-counter derivatives and authorized the CFTC and SEC to regulate swaps and security-based swaps, respectively. The CFTC has adopted rules applicable to our provisionally registered swap dealer, Wells Fargo Bank, N.A., that require, among other things, extensive regulatory and public reporting of swaps, central clearing and trading of swaps on exchanges or other multilateral platforms, and compliance with comprehensive internal and external business conduct standards. The SEC is expected to implement parallel rules applicable to security-based swaps. In addition, federal regulators have adopted final rules establishing

124
Wells Fargo & Company
 


initial and variation margin requirements for swaps and security-based swaps not centrally cleared, rules placing restrictions on a party’s right to exercise default rights under derivatives and other qualified financial contracts against applicable banking organizations, and record-keeping requirements for qualified financial contracts. All of these new rules, as well as others being considered by regulators in other jurisdictions, may negatively impact customer demand for over-the-counter derivatives, impact our ability to offer customers new derivatives or amendments to existing derivatives, and may increase our costs for engaging in swaps, security-based swaps, and other derivatives activities.
We are also subject to various rules and regulations related to the prevention of financial crimes and combating terrorism, including the U.S. Patriot Act of 2001. These rules and regulations require us to, among other things, implement policies and procedures related to anti-money laundering, anti-bribery and corruption, fraud, compliance, suspicious activities, currency transaction reporting and due diligence on customers. Although we have policies and procedures designed to comply with these rules and regulations, to the extent they are not fully effective or do not meet heightened regulatory standards or expectations, we may be subject to fines, penalties, restrictions on certain activities, reputational harm, or other adverse consequences.
Our businesses are also subject to laws and regulations enacted by U.S. and non-U.S. regulators and governmental authorities relating to the privacy of the information of customers, team members and others. These laws and regulations, among other things, increase our compliance obligations; have a significant impact on our businesses’ collection, processing, sharing, use, and retention of personal data and reporting of data breaches; and provide for significantly increased penalties for non-compliance.
In April 2018, the SEC proposed a rule that would require broker-dealers to act in the best interest of a retail customer when making a recommendation of any securities transaction or investment strategy involving securities. This rule may impact the manner in which business is conducted with customers seeking investment advice and may affect certain investment product offerings.
On November 18, 2016, the OCC revoked provisions of certain consent orders that provided Wells Fargo Bank, N.A. relief from specific requirements and limitations regarding rules, policies, and procedures for corporate activities; OCC approval of changes in directors and senior executive officers; and golden parachute payments. As a result, Wells Fargo Bank, N.A. is no longer eligible for expedited treatment for certain applications; is now required to provide prior written notice to the OCC of a change in directors and senior executive officers; and is now subject to certain regulatory limitations on golden parachute payments.
In March 2017, we announced that the OCC had downgraded our most recent Community Reinvestment Act (CRA) rating, which covers the years 2009-2012, to “Needs to Improve” due to previously issued regulatory consent orders. A “Needs to Improve” rating imposes regulatory restrictions and limitations on certain of the Company’s nonbank activities, including its ability to engage in certain nonbank mergers and acquisitions or undertake new financial in nature activities, and CRA performance is taken into account by regulators in reviewing applications to establish bank branches and for approving proposed bank mergers and acquisitions. The rating also results in the loss of expedited processing of applications to undertake certain activities, and requires the Company to receive
 
prior regulatory approval for certain activities, including to issue or prepay certain subordinated debt obligations, open or relocate bank branches, or make certain public welfare investments. In addition, a “Needs to Improve” rating could have an impact on the Company’s relationships with certain states, counties, municipalities or other public agencies to the extent applicable law, regulation or policy limits, restricts or influences whether such entity may do business with a company that has a below “Satisfactory” rating.
On February 2, 2018, the Company entered into a consent order with the FRB. As required by the consent order, the Board submitted to the FRB a plan to further enhance the Board’s governance and oversight of the Company, and the Company submitted to the FRB a plan to further improve the Company’s compliance and operational risk management program. The consent order requires the Company, following the FRB’s acceptance and approval of the plans and the Company’s adoption and implementation of the plans, to complete third-party reviews of the enhancements and improvements provided for in the plans. Until these third-party reviews are complete and the plans are approved and implemented to the satisfaction of the FRB, the Company’s total consolidated assets will be limited to the level as of December 31, 2017, which could adversely affect our results of operations or financial condition. Compliance with this asset cap will be measured on a two-quarter daily average basis to allow for management of temporary fluctuations. Additionally, after removal of the asset cap, a second third-party review must also be conducted to assess the efficacy and sustainability of the enhancements and improvements.
On April 20, 2018, the Company entered into consent orders with the CFPB and OCC to pay an aggregate of $1 billion in civil money penalties to resolve matters regarding the Company’s compliance risk management program and past practices involving certain automobile collateral protection insurance policies and certain mortgage interest rate lock extensions. As required by the consent orders, the Company submitted to the CFPB and OCC an enterprise-wide compliance risk management plan and a plan to enhance the Company’s internal audit program with respect to federal consumer financial law and the terms of the consent orders. In addition, as required by the consent orders, the Company submitted for non-objection plans to remediate customers affected by the automobile collateral protection insurance and mortgage interest rate lock matters, as well as a plan for the management of remediation activities conducted by the Company.
The Company may be subject to further actions, including the imposition of consent orders or similar regulatory agreements or civil money penalties, by other federal regulators regarding similar issues, including the Company’s risk management policies and procedures. Compliance with the FRB consent order, the CFPB and OCC consent orders, and any other consent orders or regulatory actions, as well as the implementation of their requirements, may increase the Company’s costs and require the Company to undergo significant changes to its business, products and services .
Other future regulatory initiatives that could significantly affect our business include proposals to reform the housing finance market in the United States. These proposals, among other things, consider winding down the GSEs and reducing or eliminating over time the role of the GSEs in guaranteeing mortgages and providing funding for mortgage loans, as well as the implementation of reforms relating to borrowers, lenders, and investors in the mortgage market, including reducing the maximum size of a loan that the GSEs can guarantee, phasing in a minimum down payment requirement for borrowers,

 
Wells Fargo & Company
125


Risk Factors (continued)

improving underwriting standards, and increasing accountability and transparency in the securitization process. Congress also may consider the adoption of legislation to reform the mortgage financing market in an effort to assist borrowers experiencing difficulty in making mortgage payments or refinancing their mortgages. The extent and timing of any regulatory reform or the adoption of any legislation regarding the GSEs and/or the home mortgage market, as well as any effect on the Company’s business and financial results, are uncertain.
Any other future legislation and/or regulation, if adopted, also could significantly change our regulatory environment and increase our cost of doing business, limit the activities we may pursue or affect the competitive balance among banks, savings associations, credit unions, and other financial services companies, and have a material adverse effect on our financial results and condition.
For more information, refer to the “Regulatory Matters” section in this Report and the “Regulation and Supervision” section in our 2018 Form 10-K.

We could be subject to more stringent capital, leverage or liquidity requirements or restrictions on our growth, activities or operations if regulators determine that our resolution or recovery plan is deficient. Pursuant to rules adopted by the FRB and the FDIC, Wells Fargo has prepared and filed a resolution plan, a so-called “living will,” that is designed to facilitate our resolution in the event of material distress or failure. There can be no assurance that the FRB or FDIC will respond favorably to the Company’s resolution plans. If the FRB or FDIC determines that our resolution plan has deficiencies, they may impose more stringent capital, leverage or liquidity requirements on us or restrict our growth, activities or operations until we adequately remedy the deficiencies. If the FRB or FDIC ultimately determines that we have been unable to remedy any deficiencies, they could require us to divest certain assets or operations.
We must also prepare and submit to the FRB a recovery plan that identifies a range of options that we may consider during times of idiosyncratic or systemic economic stress to remedy any financial weaknesses and restore market confidence without extraordinary government support. Recovery options include the possible sale, transfer or disposal of assets, securities, loan portfolios or businesses. Our insured national bank subsidiary, Wells Fargo Bank, N.A. (the “Bank”), must also prepare and submit to the OCC a recovery plan that sets forth the Bank’s plan to remain a going concern when the Bank is experiencing considerable financial or operational stress, but has not yet deteriorated to the point where liquidation or resolution is imminent. If the FRB or the OCC determines that our recovery plan is deficient, they may impose fines, restrictions on our business or ultimately require us to divest assets.

Our security holders may suffer losses in a resolution of Wells Fargo, whether in a bankruptcy proceeding or under the orderly liquidation authority of the FDIC, even if creditors of our subsidiaries are paid in full. If Wells Fargo were to fail, it may be resolved in a bankruptcy proceeding or, if certain conditions are met, under the resolution regime created by the Dodd-Frank Act known as the “orderly liquidation authority.” The orderly liquidation authority allows for the appointment of the FDIC as receiver for a systemically important financial institution that is in default or in danger of default if, among other things, the resolution of the institution under the U.S. Bankruptcy Code would have serious adverse
 
effects on financial stability in the United States. If the FDIC is appointed as receiver for Wells Fargo & Company (the “Parent”), then the orderly liquidation authority, rather than the U.S. Bankruptcy Code, would determine the powers of the receiver and the rights and obligations of our security holders. The FDIC’s orderly liquidation authority requires that security holders of a company in receivership bear all losses before U.S. taxpayers are exposed to any losses, and allows the FDIC to disregard the strict priority of creditor claims under the U.S. Bankruptcy Code in certain circumstances.
Whether under the U.S. Bankruptcy Code or by the FDIC under the orderly liquidation authority, Wells Fargo could be resolved using a “multiple point of entry” strategy, in which the Parent and one or more of its subsidiaries would each undergo separate resolution proceedings, or a “single point of entry” strategy, in which the Parent would likely be the only material legal entity to enter resolution proceedings. The FDIC has announced that a single point of entry strategy may be a desirable strategy under its implementation of the orderly liquidation authority, but not all aspects of how the FDIC might exercise this authority are known and additional rulemaking is possible.
The strategy described in our most recent resolution plan submission is a multiple point of entry strategy; however, we have made a decision to move to a single point of entry strategy for our next resolution plan submission. We are not obligated to maintain either a single point of entry or multiple point of entry strategy, and the strategies reflected in our resolution plan submissions are not binding in the event of an actual resolution of Wells Fargo, whether conducted under the U.S. Bankruptcy Code or by the FDIC under the orderly liquidation authority.
To facilitate the orderly resolution of systemically important financial institutions in case of material distress or failure, federal banking regulations require that institutions, such as Wells Fargo, maintain a minimum amount of equity and unsecured debt to absorb losses and recapitalize operating subsidiaries. Federal banking regulators have also required measures to facilitate the continued operation of operating subsidiaries notwithstanding the failure of their parent companies, such as limitations on parent guarantees, and have issued guidance encouraging institutions to take legally binding measures to provide capital and liquidity resources to certain subsidiaries in order to facilitate an orderly resolution. In response to the regulators’ guidance and to facilitate the orderly resolution of the Company using either a single point of entry or multiple point of entry resolution strategy, on June 28, 2017, the Parent entered into the Support Agreement with WFC Holdings, LLC, an intermediate holding company and subsidiary of the Parent (the “IHC”), and the Bank, Wells Fargo Securities, LLC (“WFS”), and Wells Fargo Clearing Services, LLC (“WFCS”), each an indirect subsidiary of the Parent. Pursuant to the Support Agreement, the Parent transferred a significant amount of its assets, including the majority of its cash, deposits, liquid securities and intercompany loans (but excluding its equity interests in its subsidiaries and certain other assets), to the IHC and will continue to transfer those types of assets to the IHC from time to time. In the event of our material financial distress or failure, the IHC will be obligated to use the transferred assets to provide capital and/or liquidity to the Bank pursuant to the Support Agreement and to WFS and WFCS through repurchase facilities entered into in connection with the Support Agreement. Under the Support Agreement, the IHC will also provide funding and liquidity to the Parent through subordinated notes and a committed line of credit, which, together with the issuance of dividends, is expected to provide the Parent, during business as

126
Wells Fargo & Company
 


usual operating conditions, with the same access to cash necessary to service its debts, pay dividends, repurchase its shares, and perform its other obligations as it would have had if it had not entered into these arrangements and transferred any assets. If certain liquidity and/or capital metrics fall below defined triggers, the subordinated notes would be forgiven and the committed line of credit would terminate, which could materially and adversely impact the Parent’s liquidity and its ability to satisfy its debts and other obligations, and could result in the commencement of bankruptcy proceedings by the Parent at an earlier time than might have otherwise occurred if the Support Agreement were not implemented. The Parent’s and the IHC’s respective obligations under the Support Agreement are secured pursuant to a related security agreement.
Any resolution of the Company will likely impose losses on shareholders, unsecured debt holders and other creditors of the Parent, while the Parent’s subsidiaries may continue to operate. Creditors of some or all of our subsidiaries may receive significant or full recoveries on their claims, while the Parent’s security holders could face significant or complete losses. This outcome may arise whether the Company is resolved under the U.S. Bankruptcy Code or by the FDIC under the orderly liquidation authority, and whether the resolution is conducted using a multiple point of entry or a single point of entry strategy. Furthermore, in a multiple point of entry or single point of entry strategy, losses at some or all of our subsidiaries could be transferred to the Parent and borne by the Parent’s security holders. Moreover, if either resolution strategy proved to be unsuccessful, our security holders could face greater losses than if the strategy had not been implemented.
 
Bank regulations, including Basel capital and liquidity standards and FRB guidelines and rules, may require higher capital and liquidity levels, limiting our ability to pay common stock dividends, repurchase our common stock, invest in our business, or provide loans or other products and services to our customers .  The Company and each of our insured depository institutions are subject to various regulatory capital adequacy requirements administered by federal banking regulators. In particular, the Company is subject to final and interim final rules issued by federal banking regulators to implement Basel III capital requirements for U.S. banking organizations. These rules are based on international guidelines for determining regulatory capital issued by the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision (BCBS). The federal banking regulators’ capital rules, among other things, require on a fully phased-in basis: 
a minimum Common Equity Tier 1 (CET1) ratio of 9.0%, comprised of a 4.5% minimum requirement plus a capital conservation buffer of 2.5% and for us, as a global systemically important bank (G-SIB), a capital surcharge to be calculated annually, which is 2.0% based on our year-end 2017 data;
a minimum tier 1 capital ratio of 10.5%, comprised of a 6.0% minimum requirement plus the capital conservation buffer of 2.5% and the G-SIB capital surcharge of 2.0%;
a minimum total capital ratio of 12.5%, comprised of a 8.0% minimum requirement plus the capital conservation buffer of 2.5% and the G-SIB capital surcharge of 2.0%;
a potential countercyclical buffer of up to 2.5% to be added to the minimum capital ratios, which is currently not in effect but could be imposed by regulators at their discretion if it is determined that a period of excessive credit growth is contributing to an increase in systemic risk;
a minimum tier 1 leverage ratio of 4.0%; and
 
a minimum supplementary leverage ratio (SLR) of 5.0% (comprised of a 3.0% minimum requirement plus a supplementary leverage buffer of 2.0%) for large and internationally active bank holding companies (BHCs).

We were required to comply with the final Basel III capital rules beginning January 2014, with certain provisions subject to phase-in periods. Beginning January 1, 2018, the requirements for calculating CET1 and tier 1 capital, along with RWAs, became fully phased-in. However, the requirements for calculating tier 2 and total capital are still in accordance with Transition Requirements. The entire Basel III capital rules are scheduled to be fully phased in by the end of 2021.
On April 10, 2018, the FRB issued a proposed rule that would add a stress capital buffer and a stress leverage buffer to the minimum capital and tier 1 leverage ratio requirements. The buffers would be calculated based on the decrease in a financial institution’s risk-based capital and tier 1 leverage ratios under the supervisory severely adverse scenario in CCAR, plus four quarters of planned common stock dividends. The stress capital buffer would replace the 2.5% capital conservation buffer under the Standardized Approach, whereas the stress leverage buffer would be added to the current 4% minimum tier 1 leverage ratio.
Because the Company has been designated as a G-SIB, we are also subject to the FRB’s rule implementing the additional capital surcharge of between 1.0-4.5% on G-SIBs. Under the rule, we must annually calculate our surcharge under two prescribed methods and use the higher of the two surcharges. The G-SIB surcharge became fully effective on January 1, 2019. Based on year-end 2017 data, our 2019 G-SIB surcharge is 2.0% of the Company’s RWAs. However, because the G-SIB surcharge is calculated annually based on data that can differ over time, the amount of the surcharge is subject to change in future years.
In April 2014, federal banking regulators finalized a rule that enhances the SLR requirements for BHCs, like Wells Fargo, and their insured depository institutions. The SLR consists of tier 1 capital under Basel III divided by the Company’s total leverage exposure. Total leverage exposure consists of the total average on-balance sheet assets, plus off-balance sheet exposures, such as undrawn commitments and derivative exposures, less amounts permitted to be deducted from tier 1 capital. The rule, which became effective on January 1, 2018, requires a covered BHC to maintain a SLR of at least 5.0% (comprised of the 3.0% minimum requirement plus a supplementary leverage buffer of 2.0%) to avoid restrictions on capital distributions and discretionary bonus payments. The rule also requires that all of our insured depository institutions maintain a SLR of 6.0% under applicable regulatory capital adequacy guidelines. In April 2018, the FRB and OCC proposed rules (the “Proposed SLR Rules”) that would replace the 2% supplementary leverage buffer with a buffer equal to one-half of the firm’s G-SIB capital surcharge. The Proposed SLR Rules would similarly tailor the current 6% SLR requirement for our insured depository institutions .
In December 2016, the FRB finalized rules to address the amount of equity and unsecured long-term debt a U.S. G-SIB must hold to improve its resolvability and resiliency, often referred to as Total Loss Absorbing Capacity (TLAC). Under the rules, which became effective on January 1, 2019, U.S. G-SIBs are required to have a minimum TLAC amount (consisting of CET1 capital and additional tier 1 capital issued directly by the top-tier or covered BHC plus eligible external long-term debt) equal to the greater of (i) 18% of RWAs and (ii) 7.5% of total leverage exposure (the denominator of the SLR calculation). Additionally, U.S. G-SIBs are required to maintain (i) a TLAC

 
Wells Fargo & Company
127


Risk Factors (continued)

buffer equal to 2.5% of RWAs plus the firm’s applicable G-SIB capital surcharge calculated under method one of the G-SIB calculation plus any applicable countercyclical buffer to be added to the 18% minimum and (ii) an external TLAC leverage buffer equal to 2.0% of total leverage exposure to be added to the 7.5% minimum, in order to avoid restrictions on capital distributions and discretionary bonus payments. The rules also require U.S. G-SIBs to have a minimum amount of eligible unsecured long-term debt equal to the greater of (i) 6.0% of RWAs plus the firm’s applicable G-SIB capital surcharge calculated under method two of the G-SIB calculation and (ii) 4.5% of the total leverage exposure. In addition, the rules impose certain restrictions on the operations and liabilities of the top-tier or covered BHC in order to further facilitate an orderly resolution, including prohibitions on the issuance of short-term debt to external investors and on entering into derivatives and certain other types of financial contracts with external counterparties. While the rules permit permanent grandfathering of a significant portion of otherwise ineligible long-term debt that was issued prior to December 31, 2016, long-term debt issued after that date must be fully compliant with the eligibility requirements of the rules in order to count toward the minimum TLAC amount. As a result of the rules, we will need to issue additional long-term debt to remain compliant with the requirements. Under the Proposed SLR Rules, the 2% external TLAC leverage buffer would be replaced with a buffer equal to one-half of the firm’s G-SIB capital surcharge. Additionally, the Proposed SLR Rules would modify the leverage component for calculating the minimum amount of eligible unsecured long-term debt from 4.5% of total leverage exposure to 2.5% of total leverage exposure plus one-half of the firm’s G-SIB capital surcharge.
In September 2014, federal banking regulators issued a final rule that implements a quantitative liquidity requirement consistent with the liquidity coverage ratio (LCR) established by the BCBS. The rule requires banking institutions, such as Wells Fargo, to hold high-quality liquid assets, such as central bank reserves and government and corporate debt that can be converted easily and quickly into cash, in an amount equal to or greater than its projected net cash outflows during a 30-day stress period. The FRB also finalized rules imposing enhanced liquidity management standards on large BHCs such as Wells Fargo, and has finalized a rule that requires large bank holding companies to publicly disclose on a quarterly basis certain quantitative and qualitative information regarding their LCR calculations.
As part of its obligation to impose enhanced capital and risk-management standards on large financial firms pursuant to the Dodd-Frank Act, the FRB issued a final capital plan rule that requires large BHCs, including the Company, to submit annual capital plans for review and to obtain regulatory approval before making capital distributions. There can be no assurance that the FRB would respond favorably to the Company’s future capital plans. The FRB has also finalized a number of regulations implementing enhanced prudential requirements for large BHCs like Wells Fargo regarding risk-based capital and leverage, risk and liquidity management, and imposing debt-to-equity limits on any BHC that regulators determine poses a grave threat to the financial stability of the United States. The FRB and OCC have also finalized rules implementing stress testing requirements for large BHCs and national banks. The FRB has also finalized enhanced prudential standards that implement single counterparty credit limits, and has proposed a rule to establish remediation requirements for large BHCs experiencing financial distress. The OCC, under separate authority, has also established
 
heightened governance and risk management standards for large national banks, such as Wells Fargo Bank, N.A.
The Basel standards and federal regulatory capital and liquidity requirements may limit or otherwise restrict how we utilize our capital, including common stock dividends and stock repurchases, and may require us to increase our capital and/or liquidity. Any requirement that we increase our regulatory capital, regulatory capital ratios or liquidity, including as a result of business growth, acquisitions or a change in our risk profile, could require us to liquidate assets or otherwise change our business, product offerings and/or investment plans, which may negatively affect our financial results. Although not currently anticipated, proposed capital requirements and/or our regulators may require us to raise additional capital in the future. Issuing additional common stock may dilute the ownership of existing stockholders. In addition, federal banking regulations may increase our compliance costs as well as limit our ability to invest in our business or provide loans or other products and services to our customers.
For more information, refer to the “Capital Management” and “Regulatory Matters” sections in this Report and the “Regulation and Supervision” section of our 2018 Form 10-K.
 
FRB policies, including policies on interest rates, can significantly affect business and economic conditions and our financial results and condition.  The FRB regulates the supply of money in the United States. Its policies determine in large part our cost of funds for lending and investing and the return we earn on those loans and investments, both of which affect our net interest income and net interest margin. The FRB’s interest rate policies also can materially affect the value of financial instruments we hold, such as debt securities and MSRs. In addition, its policies can affect our borrowers, potentially increasing the risk that they may fail to repay their loans. Changes in FRB policies are beyond our control and can be hard to predict. The FRB has stated that in determining the timing and size of any adjustments to the target range for the federal funds rate, the FRB will assess realized and expected economic conditions relative to its objectives of maximum employment and 2% inflation. As noted above, a declining or low interest rate environment and a flattening yield curve which may result from the FRB’s actions could negatively affect our net interest income and net interest margin as it may result in us holding lower yielding loans and debt securities on our balance sheet.
 
CREDIT RISK
 
As one of the largest lenders in the U.S., increased credit risk, including as a result of a deterioration in economic conditions or changes in market conditions, could require us to increase our provision for credit losses and allowance for credit losses and could have a material adverse effect on our results of operations and financial condition.   When we loan money or commit to loan money we incur credit risk, or the risk of losses if our borrowers do not repay their loans. As one of the largest lenders in the U.S., the credit performance of our loan portfolios significantly affects our financial results and condition. As noted above, if the current economic environment were to deteriorate, more of our customers may have difficulty in repaying their loans or other obligations which could result in a higher level of credit losses and provision for credit losses. We reserve for credit losses by establishing an allowance through a charge to earnings. The amount of this allowance is based on our assessment of credit

128
Wells Fargo & Company
 


losses inherent in our loan portfolio (including unfunded credit commitments). The process for determining the amount of the allowance is critical to our financial results and condition. It requires difficult, subjective and complex judgments about the future, including forecasts of economic or market conditions that might impair the ability of our borrowers to repay their loans. We might increase the allowance because of changing economic conditions, including falling home prices and higher unemployment, significant loan growth, changes in consumer behavior or other market conditions that adversely affect borrowers, or other factors. Additionally, the regulatory environment or external factors, such as natural disasters, also can influence recognition of credit losses in our loan portfolios and impact our allowance for credit losses.
Our provision for credit losses was $1.0 billion less than net charge-offs in 2018, which had a positive effect on our earnings. Future allowance levels may increase or decrease based on a variety of factors, including loan growth, portfolio performance and general economic conditions. While we believe that our allowance for credit losses was appropriate at December 31, 2018 , there is no assurance that it will be sufficient to cover future credit losses, especially if housing and employment conditions worsen. In the event of significant deterioration in economic conditions or if we experience significant loan growth, we may be required to build reserves in future periods, which would reduce our earnings.
For more information, refer to the “Risk Management – Credit Risk Management” and “Critical Accounting Policies – Allowance for Credit Losses” sections in this Report.

We may have more credit risk and higher credit losses to the extent our loans are concentrated by loan type, industry segment, borrower type, or location of the borrower or collateral.   Our credit risk and credit losses can increase if our loans are concentrated to borrowers engaged in the same or similar activities or to borrowers who individually or as a group may be uniquely or disproportionately affected by economic or market conditions. Similarly, challenging economic or market conditions, or trade policies, affecting a particular industry or geography may also impact related or dependent industries or the ability of borrowers living in such affected areas or working in such industries to meet their financial obligations. We experienced the effect of concentration risk in 2009 and 2010 when we incurred greater than expected losses in our residential real estate loan portfolio due to a housing slowdown and greater than expected deterioration in residential real estate values in many markets, including the Central Valley California market and several Southern California metropolitan statistical areas. As California is our largest banking state in terms of loans and deposits, deterioration in real estate values and underlying economic conditions in those markets or elsewhere in California could result in materially higher credit losses. In addition, deterioration in macro-economic conditions generally across the country could result in materially higher credit losses, including for our residential real estate loan portfolio, which includes nonconforming mortgage loans we retain on our balance sheet. We may experience higher delinquencies and higher loss rates as our consumer real estate secured lines of credit reach their contractual end of draw period and begin to amortize or our consumer Pick-a-Pay loans reach their recast trigger.
We are currently one of the largest CRE lenders in the U.S. A deterioration in economic conditions that negatively affects the business performance of our CRE borrowers, including increases in interest rates, declines in commercial property values, and/or changes in consumer behavior or other market
 
conditions, could result in materially higher credit losses and have a material adverse effect on our financial results and condition. 
Challenges and/or changes in foreign economic conditions may increase our foreign credit risk. Our foreign loan exposure represented approximately 8% of our total consolidated outstanding loans and 4% of our total assets at December 31, 2018 . Economic difficulties in foreign jurisdictions could also indirectly have a material adverse effect on our credit performance and results of operations and financial condition to the extent they negatively affect the U.S. economy and/or our borrowers who have foreign operations.
In order to reduce credit risk and obtain additional funding, from time to time we may securitize or sell similar types or categories of loans that we originate, such as mortgage loans and automobile loans. The agreements under which we do this generally contain various representations and warranties regarding the origination and characteristics of the loans. We may be required to repurchase the loans, reimburse investors and others, or incur other losses, including regulatory fines and penalties, as a result of any breaches in these contractual representations and warranties. For more information about our repurchase obligations with respect to mortgage loans, refer to the “Risk Factors – Risks Related to Our Mortgage Business” section in this Report.
For more information regarding credit risk, refer to the “Risk Management – Credit Risk Management” section and Note 6 (Loans and Allowance for Credit Losses) to Financial Statements in this Report.
 
We may incur losses on loans, securities and other acquired assets of Wachovia that are materially greater than reflected in our fair value adjustments.   We accounted for the Wachovia merger under the purchase method of accounting, recording the acquired assets and liabilities of Wachovia at fair value. All PCI loans acquired in the merger were recorded at fair value based on the present value of their expected cash flows. We estimated cash flows using internal credit, interest rate and prepayment risk models using assumptions about matters that are inherently uncertain. We may not realize the estimated cash flows or fair value of these loans. In addition, although the difference between the pre-merger carrying value of the credit-impaired loans and their expected cash flows – the “nonaccretable difference” – is available to absorb future charge-offs, we may be required to increase our allowance for credit losses and related provision expense because of subsequent additional credit deterioration in these loans.
For more information, refer to the “Risk Management – Credit Risk Management” section in this Report.

OPERATIONAL AND LEGAL RISK
 
A failure in or breach of our operational or security systems, controls or infrastructure, or those of our third-party vendors and other service providers, could disrupt our businesses, damage our reputation, increase our costs and cause losses.   As a large financial institution that serves customers through numerous physical locations, ATMs, the internet, mobile banking and other distribution channels across the U.S. and internationally, we depend on our ability to process, record and monitor a large number of customer transactions on a continuous basis. As our customer base and locations have expanded throughout the U.S. and internationally, as we have increasingly used the internet

 
Wells Fargo & Company
129


Risk Factors (continued)

and mobile banking to provide products and services to our customers, and as customer, public, legislative and regulatory expectations regarding operational and information security have increased, our operational systems, controls and infrastructure must continue to be safeguarded and monitored for potential failures, disruptions and breakdowns. Our business, financial, accounting, data processing systems or other operating systems and facilities may stop operating properly, become insufficient based on our evolving business needs, or become disabled or damaged as a result of a number of factors including events that are wholly or partially beyond our control. For example, there could be sudden increases in customer transaction volume; electrical or telecommunications outages; degradation or loss of internet, website or mobile banking availability; climate change related impacts and natural disasters such as earthquakes, tornados, and hurricanes; disease pandemics; events arising from local or larger scale political or social matters, including terrorist acts; and, as described below, cyber attacks or other information security breaches. Furthermore, enhancements and upgrades to our infrastructure or operating systems may be time-consuming, entail significant costs, and create risks associated with implementing new systems and integrating them with existing ones. Due to the complexity and interconnectedness of our systems, the process of enhancing our infrastructure and operating systems, including their security measures and controls, can itself create a risk of system disruptions and security issues. Although we have business continuity plans and other safeguards in place, our business operations may be adversely affected by significant and widespread disruption to our physical infrastructure or operating systems that support our businesses and customers. For example, on February 7, 2019, we experienced system issues caused by an automatic power shutdown at one of our main data center facilities, which was triggered by a smoke alarm that resulted from a steam condition created by routine maintenance activities in the building. Although applications and related workloads were systematically re-routed to back-up data centers throughout the day, certain of our services experienced disruptions that delayed service to our customers. For instance, our online and mobile banking systems and certain ATM functions experienced disruptions for several hours, and certain critical mortgage origination systems experienced disruptions for several days.
As a result of financial institutions and technology systems becoming more interconnected and complex, any operational incident at a third party may increase the risk of loss or material impact to us or the financial industry as a whole. Furthermore, third parties on which we rely, including those that facilitate our business activities or to which we outsource operations, such as exchanges, clearing houses, financial intermediaries or vendors that provide services or security solutions for our operations, could also be sources of operational risk to us, including from information breaches or loss, breakdowns, disruptions or failures of their own systems or infrastructure, or any deficiencies in the performance of their responsibilities. We are also exposed to the risk that a disruption or other operational incident at a common service provider to those third parties could impede their ability to provide services or perform their responsibilities for us. In addition, we must meet regulatory requirements and expectations regarding our use of third-party service providers, and any failure by our third-party service providers to meet their obligations to us or to comply with applicable laws, rules, regulations, or Wells Fargo policies could result in fines, penalties, restrictions on our business, or other negative consequences.
 
Disruptions or failures in the physical infrastructure, controls or operating systems that support our businesses and customers, failures of the third parties on which we rely to adequately or appropriately provide their services or perform their responsibilities, or our failure to effectively manage or oversee our third-party relationships, could result in business disruptions, loss of revenue or customers, legal or regulatory proceedings, compliance and other costs, violations of applicable privacy and other laws, reputational damage, or other adverse consequences, any of which could materially adversely affect our results of operations or financial condition.

A cyber attack or other information security breach of our technologies, computer systems or networks, or those of our third-party vendors and other service providers, could disrupt our businesses, result in the disclosure or misuse of confidential or proprietary information, damage our reputation, increase our costs and cause losses.   Information security risks for large financial institutions such as Wells Fargo have generally increased in recent years in part because of the proliferation of new technologies, the use of the internet, mobile devices, and cloud technologies to conduct financial transactions, and the increased sophistication and activities of organized crime, hackers, terrorists, activists, and other external parties, including foreign state-sponsored parties. Those parties also may attempt to misrepresent personal or financial information to obtain loans or other financial products from us or attempt to fraudulently induce employees, customers, or other users of our systems to disclose confidential information in order to gain access to our data or that of our customers. As noted above, our operations rely on the secure processing, transmission and storage of confidential information in our computer systems and networks. Our banking, brokerage, investment advisory, and capital markets businesses rely on our digital technologies, computer and email systems, software, hardware, and networks to conduct their operations. In addition, to access our products and services, our customers may use personal smartphones, tablets, and other mobile devices that are beyond our control systems. Although we believe we have robust information security procedures and controls, our technologies, systems, networks, and our customers’ devices may become the target of cyber attacks or other information security breaches that could result in the unauthorized release, gathering, monitoring, misuse, loss or destruction of Wells Fargo’s or our customers’ confidential, proprietary and other information, or otherwise disrupt Wells Fargo’s or its customers’ or other third parties’ business operations. For example, various retailers have reported they were victims of cyber attacks in which large amounts of their customers’ data, including debit and credit card information, was obtained. In these situations, we generally incur costs to replace compromised cards and address fraudulent transaction activity affecting our customers. We are also exposed to the risk that a team member or other person acting on behalf of the Company fails to comply with applicable policies and procedures and inappropriately circumvents controls for personal gain or other improper purposes.
Due to the increasing interconnectedness and complexity of financial institutions and technology systems, an information security incident at a third party may increase the risk of loss or material impact to us or the financial industry as a whole. In addition, third parties on which we rely, including those that facilitate our business activities or to which we outsource operations, such as internet, mobile technology and cloud service providers, could be sources of information security risk

130
Wells Fargo & Company
 


to us. If those third parties fail to adequately or appropriately safeguard their technologies, systems, and networks, we may suffer material harm, including business disruptions, losses or remediation costs, reputational damage, legal or regulatory proceedings, or other adverse consequences.
To date we have not experienced any material losses relating to cyber attacks or other information security breaches, but there can be no assurance that we will not suffer such losses in the future. Our risk and exposure to these matters remains heightened because of, among other things, the evolving nature of these threats, the prominent size and scale of Wells Fargo and its role in the financial services industry, our plans to continue to implement our digital and mobile banking channel strategies and develop additional remote connectivity solutions to serve our customers when and how they want to be served, our expanded geographic footprint and international presence, the outsourcing of some of our business operations, and the current global economic and political environment. For example, Wells Fargo and other financial institutions continue to be the target of various evolving and adaptive cyber attacks, including malware and denial-of-service, as part of an effort to disrupt the operations of financial institutions, potentially test their cybersecurity capabilities, commit fraud, or obtain confidential, proprietary or other information. Cyber attacks have also focused on targeting online applications and services, such as online banking, as well as cloud-based services provided by third parties, and have targeted the infrastructure of the internet, causing the widespread unavailability of websites and degrading website performance. As a result, information security and the continued development and enhancement of our controls, processes and systems designed to protect our networks, computers, software and data from attack, damage or unauthorized access remain a priority for Wells Fargo. We are also proactively involved in industry cybersecurity efforts and working with other parties, including our third-party service providers and governmental agencies, to continue to enhance defenses and improve resiliency to cybersecurity and other information security threats. As these threats continue to evolve, we may be required to expend significant additional resources to continue to modify or enhance our protective measures or to investigate and remediate any information security vulnerabilities or incidents. Because the investigation of any information security breach is inherently unpredictable and would require time to complete, we may not be able to immediately address the consequences of a breach, which may further increase any associated costs and consequences. Moreover, to the extent our insurance covers aspects of information security risk, such insurance may not be sufficient to cover all losses associated with an information security breach.
Cyber attacks or other information security breaches affecting us or third parties on which we rely, including those that facilitate our business activities or to which we outsource operations, or security breaches of the networks, systems or devices that our customers use to access our products and services, could result in business disruptions, loss of revenue or customers, legal or regulatory proceedings, compliance and other costs, violations of applicable privacy and other laws, reputational damage, or other adverse consequences, any of which could materially adversely affect our results of operations or financial condition.

Our framework for managing risks may not be fully effective in mitigating risk and loss to us.   Our risk management framework seeks to mitigate risk and loss to us. We have established processes and procedures intended to identify,
 
measure, monitor, report and analyze the types of risk to which we are subject, including liquidity risk, credit risk, market risk, interest rate risk, operational risk, legal and compliance risk, and reputational risk, among others. However, as with any risk management framework, there are inherent limitations to our risk management strategies as there may exist, or develop in the future, risks that we have not appropriately anticipated, identified or managed. Our risk management framework is also dependent on ensuring that effective operational controls and a sound culture exist throughout the Company. The inability to develop effective operational controls or to foster the appropriate culture in each of our lines of business, including the inability to align performance management and compensation to achieve the desired culture, could adversely impact the effectiveness of our risk management framework . Similarly, if we are unable to effectively manage our business or operations, we may be exposed to increased risks or unexpected losses. We are also exposed to risks if we do not accurately or completely execute a process or transaction, whether due to human error or otherwise. In certain instances, we rely on models to measure, monitor and predict risks, such as market and interest rate risks, as well as to help inform business decisions; however, there is no assurance that these models will appropriately or sufficiently capture all relevant risks or accurately predict future events or exposures. In addition, we rely on data to aggregate and assess our various risk exposures and business activities, and any issues with the quality or effectiveness of our data, including our aggregation, management, and validation procedures, could result in ineffective risk management practices, business decisions or customer service, inefficient use of resources, or inaccurate regulatory or other risk reporting. We also use artificial intelligence to help further inform our business decisions and risk management practices, but there is no assurance that artificial intelligence will appropriately or sufficiently replicate certain outcomes or accurately predict future events or exposures. The recent financial and credit crisis and resulting regulatory reform highlighted both the importance and some of the limitations of managing unanticipated risks, and our regulators remain focused on ensuring that financial institutions build and maintain robust risk management policies and practices. If our risk management framework proves ineffective, we could suffer unexpected losses which could materially adversely affect our results of operations or financial condition.

Risks related to sales practices and other instances where customers may have experienced financial harm. Various government entities and offices have undertaken formal or informal inquiries, investigations or examinations arising out of certain sales practices of the Company that were the subject of settlements with the CFPB, the Office of the Comptroller of the Currency, and the Office of the Los Angeles City Attorney announced by the Company on September 8, 2016. In addition to imposing monetary penalties and other sanctions, regulatory authorities may require admissions of wrongdoing and compliance with other conditions in connection with such matters, which can lead to restrictions on our ability to engage in certain business activities or offer certain products or services, limitations on our ability to access capital markets, limitations on capital distributions, the loss of customers, and/or other direct and indirect adverse consequences. A number of lawsuits have also been filed by non-governmental parties seeking damages or other remedies related to these sales practices. The ultimate resolution of any of these pending legal proceedings or government investigations, depending on the sanctions and

 
Wells Fargo & Company
131


Risk Factors (continued)

remedy sought and granted, could materially adversely affect our results of operations and financial condition. We may also incur additional costs and expenses in order to address and defend these pending legal proceedings and government investigations, and we may have increased compliance and other costs related to these matters. Furthermore, negative publicity or public opinion resulting from these matters may increase the risk of reputational harm to our business, which can impact our ability to keep and attract customers, affect our ability to attract and retain qualified team members, result in the loss of revenue, or have other material adverse effects on our results of operations and financial condition. In addition, the ultimate results and conclusions of our company-wide review of sales practices issues are still pending and could lead to an increase in the identified number of potentially impacted customers, additional legal or regulatory proceedings, compliance and other costs, reputational damage, the identification of issues in our practices or methodologies that were used to identify, prevent or remediate sales practices related matters, the loss of additional team members, or further changes in policies and procedures that may impact our business.
Furthermore, our priority of rebuilding trust has included an ongoing effort to identify other areas or instances where customers may have experienced financial harm. For example, we have identified certain issues related to historical practices concerning the origination, servicing, and/or collection of consumer automobile loans, including matters related to certain insurance products. The identification of such other areas or instances where customers may have experienced financial harm could lead to, and in some cases has already resulted in, additional remediation costs, loss of revenue or customers, legal or regulatory proceedings, compliance and other costs, reputational damage, or other adverse consequences.
For more information, refer to the “Overview – Retail Sales Practices Matters” and “– Additional Efforts to Rebuild Trust” sections and Note 16 (Legal Actions) to Financial Statements in this Report.
 
We may incur fines, penalties and other negative consequences from regulatory violations, possibly even inadvertent or unintentional violations, or from any failure to meet regulatory standards or expectations.  We maintain systems and procedures designed to ensure that we comply with applicable laws and regulations. However, we are subject to heightened compliance and regulatory oversight and expectations, particularly due to the evolving and increasing regulatory landscape we operate in. We are also subject to consent orders with regulators that subject us to various conditions and restrictions. In addition, a single event or issue may give rise to numerous and overlapping investigations and proceedings, either by multiple federal and state agencies in the U.S. or by multiple regulators and other governmental entities in different jurisdictions. Also, the laws and regulations in jurisdictions in which we operate may be different or even conflict with each other, such as differences between U.S. federal and state law or differences between U.S. and foreign laws as to the products and services we may offer or other business activities we may engage in, which can lead to compliance difficulties or issues. Furthermore, many legal and regulatory regimes require us to report transactions and other information to regulators and other governmental authorities, self-regulatory organizations, exchanges, clearing houses and customers. We are also required to withhold funds and make various tax-related payments, relating to our own tax obligations and those of our customers. We may be subject to fines, penalties, restrictions on
 
our business, or other negative consequences if we do not timely, completely, or accurately provide regulatory reports, customer notices or disclosures, or make tax-related withholdings or payments, on behalf of ourselves or our customers. Moreover, some legal/regulatory frameworks provide for the imposition of fines or penalties for noncompliance even though the noncompliance was inadvertent or unintentional and even though there was in place at the time systems and procedures designed to ensure compliance. For example, we are subject to regulations issued by the Office of Foreign Assets Control (OFAC) that prohibit financial institutions from participating in the transfer of property belonging to the governments of certain foreign countries and designated nationals of those countries. OFAC may impose penalties or restrictions on certain activities for inadvertent or unintentional violations even if reasonable processes are in place to prevent the violations. Any violation of these or other applicable laws or regulatory requirements, even if inadvertent or unintentional, or any failure to meet regulatory standards or expectations, including any failure to satisfy the conditions of any consent orders, could result in fees, penalties, restrictions on our ability to engage in certain business activities, reputational harm, loss of customers or other negative consequences.

Negative publicity, including as a result of our actual or alleged conduct or public opinion of the financial services industry generally, could damage our reputation and business.   Reputation risk, or the risk to our business, earnings and capital from negative public opinion, is inherent in our business and has increased substantially because of the financial crisis, our size and profile in the financial services industry, and sales practices related matters and other instances where customers may have experienced financial harm. Negative public opinion about the financial services industry generally or Wells Fargo specifically could adversely affect our ability to keep and attract customers. Negative public opinion could result from our actual or alleged conduct in any number of activities, including sales practices; mortgage, automobile or other consumer lending practices; loan origination or servicing activities; mortgage foreclosure actions; management of client accounts or investments; lending, investing or other business relationships; identification and management of potential conflicts of interest from transactions, obligations and interests with and among our customers; corporate governance; regulatory compliance; risk management; incentive compensation practices; and disclosure, sharing or inadequate protection or improper use of customer information, and from actions taken by government regulators and community or other organizations in response to that conduct. Although we have policies and procedures in place intended to detect and prevent conduct by team members and third-party service providers that could potentially harm customers or our reputation, there is no assurance that such policies and procedures will be fully effective in preventing such conduct. Furthermore, our actual or perceived failure to address or prevent any such conduct or otherwise to effectively manage our business or operations could result in significant reputational harm. In addition, because we conduct most of our businesses under the “Wells Fargo” brand, negative public opinion about one business also could affect our other businesses. Moreover, actions by the financial services industry generally or by certain members or individuals in the industry also can adversely affect our reputation. The proliferation of social media websites utilized by Wells Fargo and other third parties, as well as the personal use of social media by our team members and others,

132
Wells Fargo & Company
 


including personal blogs and social network profiles, also may increase the risk that negative, inappropriate or unauthorized information may be posted or released publicly that could harm our reputation or have other negative consequences, including as a result of our team members interacting with our customers in an unauthorized manner in various social media outlets.
Wells Fargo and other financial institutions have been targeted from time to time by protests and demonstrations, which have included disrupting the operation of our retail banking locations and have resulted in negative public commentary about financial institutions, including the fees charged for various products and services. Wells Fargo and other financial institutions have also been subject to negative publicity as a result of providing financial services to or making investments in industries or organizations subject to stakeholder concerns. There can be no assurance that continued protests or negative publicity for the Company specifically or large financial institutions generally will not harm our reputation and adversely affect our business and financial results.
 
Risks related to legal actions.   Wells Fargo and some of its subsidiaries are involved in judicial, regulatory, arbitration, and other proceedings or investigations concerning matters arising from the conduct of our business activities. Although we believe we have a meritorious defense in all significant legal actions pending against us, there can be no assurance as to the ultimate outcome. We establish accruals for legal actions when potential losses associated with the actions become probable and the costs can be reasonably estimated. We may still incur costs for a legal action even if we have not established an accrual. In addition, the actual cost of resolving a legal action may be substantially higher than any amounts accrued for that action. The ultimate resolution of a pending legal proceeding or investigation, depending on the remedy sought and granted, could materially adversely affect our results of operations and financial condition.
As noted above, we are subject to heightened regulatory oversight and scrutiny, which may lead to regulatory investigations, proceedings or enforcement actions. In addition to imposing monetary penalties and other sanctions, regulatory authorities may require criminal pleas or other admissions of wrongdoing and compliance with other conditions in connection with settling such matters, which can lead to reputational harm, loss of customers, restrictions on the ability to access capital markets, limitations on capital distributions, the inability to engage in certain business activities or offer certain products or services, and/or other direct and indirect adverse effects.
For more information, refer to Note 16 (Legal Actions) to Financial Statements in this Report.

RISKS RELATED TO OUR MORTGAGE BUSINESS

Our mortgage banking revenue can be volatile from quarter to quarter, including from the impact of changes in interest rates on our origination activity and on the value of our MSRs, MLHFS and associated economic hedges, and we rely on the GSEs to purchase our conforming loans to reduce our credit risk and provide liquidity to fund new mortgage loans.   We are one of the largest mortgage originators and residential mortgage servicers in the U.S., and we earn revenue from fees we receive for originating mortgage loans and for servicing mortgage loans. As a result of our mortgage servicing business, we have a sizable portfolio of MSRs. An MSR is the right to service a mortgage loan – collect principal, interest and escrow amounts – for a fee. We acquire MSRs when we retain the servicing rights after we
 
sell or securitize the loans we have originated or when we purchase the servicing rights to mortgage loans originated by other lenders. We initially measure and carry all our residential MSRs using the fair value measurement method. Fair value is the present value of estimated future net servicing income, calculated based on a number of variables, including assumptions about the likelihood of prepayment by borrowers. Changes in interest rates can affect prepayment assumptions and thus fair value. When interest rates fall, borrowers are usually more likely to prepay their mortgage loans by refinancing them at a lower rate. As the likelihood of prepayment increases, the fair value of our MSRs can decrease. Each quarter we evaluate the fair value of our MSRs, and any decrease in fair value reduces earnings in the period in which the decrease occurs. We also measure at fair value MLHFS for which an active secondary market and readily available market prices exist. In addition, we measure at fair value certain other interests we hold related to residential loan sales and securitizations. Similar to other interest-bearing securities, the value of these MLHFS and other interests may be negatively affected by changes in interest rates. For example, if market interest rates increase relative to the yield on these MLHFS and other interests, their fair value may fall.
When rates rise, the demand for mortgage loans usually tends to fall, reducing the revenue we receive from loan originations. Under the same conditions, revenue from our MSRs can increase through increases in fair value. When rates fall, mortgage originations usually tend to increase and the value of our MSRs usually tends to decline, also with some offsetting revenue effect. Even though they can act as a “natural hedge,” the hedge is not perfect, either in amount or timing. For example, the negative effect on revenue from a decrease in the fair value of residential MSRs is generally immediate, but any offsetting revenue benefit from more originations and the MSRs relating to the new loans would generally accrue over time. It is also possible that, because of economic conditions and/or a weak or deteriorating housing market, even if interest rates were to fall or remain low, mortgage originations may also fall or any increase in mortgage originations may not be enough to offset the decrease in the MSRs value caused by the lower rates.
We typically use derivatives and other instruments to hedge our mortgage banking interest rate risk. We may not hedge all of our risk, and we may not be successful in hedging any of the risk. Hedging is a complex process, requiring sophisticated models and constant monitoring, and is not a perfect science. We may use hedging instruments tied to U.S. Treasury rates, LIBOR or Eurodollars that may not perfectly correlate with the value or income being hedged. We could incur significant losses from our hedging activities. There may be periods where we elect not to use derivatives and other instruments to hedge mortgage banking interest rate risk.
We rely on GSEs to purchase mortgage loans that meet their conforming loan requirements and on the Federal Housing Authority (FHA) to insure loans that meet their policy requirements. These loans are then securitized into either GSE or GNMA securities that are sold to investors. In order to meet customer needs, we also originate loans that do not conform to either GSE or FHA standards, which are referred to as “nonconforming” loans. We generally retain these nonconforming loans on our balance sheet. When we retain a loan on our balance sheet not only do we forgo fee revenue and keep the credit risk of the loan but we also do not receive any sale proceeds that could be used to generate new loans. If we were unable or unwilling to continue retaining nonconforming loans on our balance sheet, whether due to regulatory, business

 
Wells Fargo & Company
133


Risk Factors (continued)

or other reasons, our ability to originate new nonconforming loans may be reduced, thereby reducing the interest income we earn from originating these loans. Similarly, if the GSEs or the FHA were to limit or reduce their purchases or insuring of loans, our ability to fund, and thus originate new mortgage loans, could also be reduced. We cannot assure that the GSEs or the FHA will not materially limit their purchases or insuring of conforming loans or change their criteria for what constitutes a conforming loan (e.g., maximum loan amount or borrower eligibility). Each of the GSEs is currently in conservatorship, with its primary regulator, the Federal Housing Finance Agency acting as conservator. We cannot predict if, when or how the conservatorship will end, or any associated changes to the GSEs business structure and operations that could result. As noted above, there are various proposals to reform the housing finance market in the U.S., including the role of the GSEs in the housing finance market. The impact of any such regulatory reform regarding the housing finance market and the GSEs, including whether the GSEs will continue to exist in their current form, as well as any effect on the Company’s business and financial results, are uncertain.
For more information, refer to the “Risk Management – Asset/Liability Management – Mortgage Banking Interest Rate and Market Risk” and “Critical Accounting Policies” sections in this Report.

We may be required to repurchase mortgage loans or reimburse investors and others as a result of breaches in contractual representations and warranties, and we may incur other losses as a result of real or alleged violations of statutes or regulations applicable to the origination of our residential mortgage loans.   The origination of residential mortgage loans is governed by a variety of federal and state laws and regulations, including the Truth in Lending Act of 1968 and various anti-fraud and consumer protection statutes, which are complex and frequently changing. We often sell residential mortgage loans that we originate to various parties, including GSEs, SPEs that issue private label MBS, and other financial institutions that purchase mortgage loans for investment or private label securitization. We may also pool FHA-insured and VA-guaranteed mortgage loans which back securities guaranteed by GNMA. The agreements under which we sell mortgage loans and the insurance or guaranty agreements with the FHA and VA contain various representations and warranties regarding the origination and characteristics of the mortgage loans. We may be required to repurchase mortgage loans, indemnify the securitization trust, investor or insurer, or reimburse the securitization trust, investor or insurer for credit losses incurred on loans in the event of a breach of contractual representations or warranties that is not remedied within a period (usually 90 days or less) after we receive notice of the breach. We establish a mortgage repurchase liability related to the various representations and warranties that reflect management’s estimate of losses for loans which we have a repurchase obligation. Because the level of mortgage loan repurchase losses depends upon economic factors, investor demand strategies and other external conditions that may change over the life of the underlying loans, the level of the liability for mortgage loan repurchase losses is difficult to estimate, requires considerable management judgment, and is subject to change. If economic conditions or the housing market worsen or future investor repurchase demand and our success at appealing repurchase requests differ from past experience, we could have increased repurchase
 
obligations and increased loss severity on repurchases, requiring significant additions to the repurchase liability.
Additionally, for residential mortgage loans that we originate, borrowers may allege that the origination of the loans did not comply with applicable laws or regulations in one or more respects and assert such violation as an affirmative defense to payment or to the exercise by us of our remedies, including foreclosure proceedings, or in an action seeking statutory and other damages in connection with such violation. If we are not successful in demonstrating that the loans in dispute were originated in accordance with applicable statutes and regulations, we could become subject to monetary damages and other civil penalties, including the loss of certain contractual payments or the inability to exercise certain remedies under the loans.
For more information, refer to the “Risk Management – Credit Risk Management – Liability for Mortgage Loan Repurchase Losses” section in this Report. 

We may be terminated as a servicer or master servicer, be required to repurchase a mortgage loan or reimburse investors for credit losses on a mortgage loan, or incur costs, liabilities, fines and other sanctions if we fail to satisfy our servicing obligations, including our obligations with respect to mortgage loan foreclosure actions.   We act as servicer and/or master servicer for mortgage loans included in securitizations and for unsecuritized mortgage loans owned by investors. As a servicer or master servicer for those loans we have certain contractual obligations to the securitization trusts, investors or other third parties, including, in our capacity as a servicer, foreclosing on defaulted mortgage loans or, to the extent consistent with the applicable securitization or other investor agreement, considering alternatives to foreclosure such as loan modifications or short sales and, in our capacity as a master servicer, overseeing the servicing of mortgage loans by the servicer. In addition, we may have certain servicing obligations for properties that fall within a flood zone. If we commit a material breach of our obligations as servicer or master servicer, we may be subject to termination if the breach is not cured within a specified period of time following notice, which can generally be given by the securitization trustee or a specified percentage of security holders, causing us to lose servicing income. In addition, we may be required to indemnify the securitization trustee against losses from any failure by us, as a servicer or master servicer, to perform our servicing obligations or any act or omission on our part that involves willful misfeasance, bad faith or gross negligence. Furthermore, if any of the companies that insure the mortgage loans in our servicing portfolio experience financial difficulties or credit downgrades, we may incur additional costs to obtain replacement insurance coverage with another provider, possibly at a higher cost than the coverage we would replace. In some cases, if we do not satisfy our servicing obligations, we may be contractually obligated to repurchase a mortgage loan or reimburse the investor for credit losses, which could significantly reduce our net servicing income.
We may incur costs, liabilities to borrowers, title insurers and/or securitization investors, legal proceedings, or other adverse consequences if we fail to meet our obligations with respect to mortgage foreclosure actions or we experience delays in the foreclosure process. The fair value of our MSRs may be negatively affected to the extent our servicing costs increase because of higher foreclosure or other servicing related costs. We may be subject to fines and other sanctions imposed by federal

134
Wells Fargo & Company
 


or state regulators as a result of actual or perceived deficiencies in our mortgage servicing practices, including with respect to our foreclosure practices or our servicing of flood zone properties. Any of these actions may harm our reputation, negatively affect our residential mortgage origination or servicing business, or result in material fines, penalties, equitable remedies, or other enforcement actions.
For more information, refer to the “Risk Management – Credit Risk Management – Liability for Mortgage Loan Repurchase Losses” and “– Risks Relating to Servicing Activities,” and “Critical Accounting Policies – Valuation of Residential Mortgage Servicing Rights” sections and Note 15 (Guarantees, Pledged Assets and Collateral, and Other Commitments) and Note 16 (Legal Actions) to Financial Statements in this Report.

RISKS RELATED TO OUR INDUSTRY’S COMPETITIVE OPERATING ENVIRONMENT
 
We face significant and increasing competition in the rapidly evolving financial services industry.   We compete with other financial institutions in a highly competitive industry that is undergoing significant changes as a result of financial regulatory reform, technological advances, increased public scrutiny stemming from the financial crisis, and current economic conditions. Our success depends on our ability to develop and maintain deep and enduring relationships with our customers based on the quality of our customer service, the wide variety of products and services that we can offer our customers and the ability of those products and services to satisfy our customers’ needs, the pricing of our products and services, the extensive distribution channels available for our customers, our innovation, and our reputation. Continued or increased competition in any one or all of these areas may negatively affect our customer relationships, market share and results of operations and/or cause us to increase our capital investment in our businesses in order to remain competitive. In addition, our ability to reposition or reprice our products and services from time to time may be limited and could be influenced significantly by the current economic, regulatory and political environment for large financial institutions as well as by the actions of our competitors. Furthermore, any changes in the types of products and services that we offer our customers and/or the pricing for those products and services could result in a loss of customer relationships and market share and could materially adversely affect our results of operations.
Continued technological advances and the growth of     e-commerce have made it possible for non-depository institutions to offer products and services that traditionally were banking products, and for financial institutions and other companies to provide electronic and internet-based financial solutions, including electronic securities trading, lending and payment solutions. In addition, technological advances, including digital currencies, may diminish the importance of depository institutions and other financial intermediaries in the transfer of funds between parties. We may not respond effectively to these and other competitive threats from existing and new competitors and may be forced to sell products at lower prices, increase our investment in our business to modify or adapt our existing products and services, and/or develop new products and services to respond to our customers’ needs. To the extent we are not successful in developing and introducing new products and services or responding or adapting to the competitive landscape or to changes in customer preferences, we
 
may lose customer relationships and our revenue growth and results of operations may be materially adversely affected.

Our ability to attract and retain qualified team members is critical to the success of our business and failure to do so could adversely affect our business performance, competitive position and future prospects.   The success of Wells Fargo is heavily dependent on the talents and efforts of our team members, including our senior leaders, and in many areas of our business, including commercial banking, brokerage, investment advisory, capital markets, risk management and technology, the competition for highly qualified personnel is intense. We also seek to retain a pipeline of team members to provide continuity of succession for our senior leadership positions. In order to attract and retain highly qualified team members, we must provide competitive compensation and effectively manage team member performance and development. As a large financial institution and additionally to the extent we remain subject to consent orders we may be subject to limitations on compensation by our regulators that may adversely affect our ability to attract and retain these qualified team members, especially if some of our competitors may not be subject to these same compensation limitations. If we are unable to continue to attract and retain qualified team members, including successors for senior leadership positions, our business performance, competitive position and future prospects may be adversely affected.
 
RISKS RELATED TO OUR FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
 
Changes in accounting policies or accounting standards, and changes in how accounting standards are interpreted or applied, could materially affect how we report our financial results and condition.  Our accounting policies are fundamental to determining and understanding our financial results and condition. As described below, some of these policies require use of estimates and assumptions that may affect the value of our assets or liabilities and financial results. Any changes in our accounting policies could materially affect our financial statements.
From time to time the FASB and the SEC change the financial accounting and reporting standards that govern the preparation of our external financial statements. For example, Accounting Standards Update 2016-13 - Financial Instruments-Credit Losses (Topic 326), which becomes effective in first quarter 2020, will replace the current “incurred loss” model for the allowance for credit losses with an “expected loss” model referred to as the Current Expected Credit Loss model, or CECL. CECL could materially affect how we determine our allowance and report our financial results and condition.
In addition, accounting standard setters and those who interpret the accounting standards (such as the FASB, SEC, banking regulators and our outside auditors) may change or even reverse their previous interpretations or positions on how these standards should be applied. Changes in financial accounting and reporting standards and changes in current interpretations may be beyond our control, can be hard to predict and could materially affect how we report our financial results and condition. We may be required to apply a new or revised standard retroactively or apply an existing standard differently, also retroactively, in each case potentially resulting in our restating prior period financial statements in material amounts.
For more information, refer to the “Current Accounting Developments” section in this Report.

 
Wells Fargo & Company
135


Risk Factors (continued)

Our financial statements are based in part on assumptions and estimates which, if wrong, could cause unexpected losses in the future, and our financial statements depend on our internal controls over financial reporting.  Pursuant to U.S. GAAP, we are required to use certain assumptions and estimates in preparing our financial statements, including in determining credit loss reserves, reserves for mortgage repurchases, reserves related to litigation and the fair value of certain assets and liabilities, among other items. Several of our accounting policies are critical because they require management to make difficult, subjective and complex judgments about matters that are inherently uncertain and because it is likely that materially different amounts would be reported under different conditions or using different assumptions. For a description of these policies, refer to the “Critical Accounting Policies” section in this Report. If assumptions or estimates underlying our financial statements are incorrect, we may experience material losses.
Certain of our financial instruments, including derivative assets and liabilities, debt securities, certain loans, MSRs, private equity investments, structured notes and certain repurchase and resale agreements, among other items, require a determination of their fair value in order to prepare our financial statements. Where quoted market prices are not available, we may make fair value determinations based on internally developed models or other means which ultimately rely to some degree on management judgment, and there is no assurance that our models will capture or appropriately reflect all relevant inputs required to accurately determine fair value. Some of these and other assets and liabilities may have no direct observable price levels, making their valuation particularly subjective, being based on significant estimation and judgment. In addition, sudden illiquidity in markets or declines in prices of certain loans and securities may make it more difficult to value certain balance sheet items, which may lead to the possibility that such valuations will be subject to further change or adjustment and could lead to declines in our earnings.
The Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 (Sarbanes-Oxley) requires our management to evaluate the Company’s disclosure controls and procedures and its internal control over financial reporting and requires our auditors to issue a report on our internal control over financial reporting. We are required to disclose, in our annual report on Form 10-K, the existence of any “material weaknesses” in our internal controls. We cannot assure that we will not identify one or more material weaknesses as of the end of any given quarter or year, nor can we predict the effect on our stock price of disclosure of a material weakness. In addition, our customers may rely on the effectiveness of our internal controls as a service provider, and any deficiency in those controls could affect our customers and damage our reputation or business.  Sarbanes-Oxley also limits the types of non-audit services our outside auditors may provide to us in order to preserve their independence from us. If our auditors were found not to be “independent” of us under SEC rules, we could be required to engage new auditors and re-file financial statements and audit reports with the SEC. We could be out of compliance with SEC rules until new financial statements and audit reports were filed, limiting our ability to raise capital and resulting in other adverse consequences.

RISKS RELATED TO STRATEGIC DECISIONS  
If we are unable to develop and execute effective business plans or strategies, our competitive standing and results of operations could suffer. We are subject to rapid changes in technology, regulation, and product innovation,
 
and face intense competition for customers, sources of revenue, capital, services, qualified team members, and other essential business resources. In order to meet these challenges, we may undertake business plans or strategies related to, among other things, our organizational structure and risk management framework, our expenses and efficiency, the types of products and services we offer, the geographies in which we operate, the manner in which we serve our clients and customers, the third parties with which we do business, and the methods and distribution channels by which we offer our products and services. Accomplishing these business plans or strategies may be complex, time intensive, and require significant financial, technological, management and other resources, and there is no guarantee that any business plans or strategies will ultimately be successful. To the extent we are unable to develop or execute effective business plans or strategies, our competitive position, reputation, prospects for growth, and results of operations may be adversely affected.
In addition, we regularly explore opportunities to expand our products, services, and assets through strategic acquisitions of companies or businesses in the financial services industry. We generally must receive federal regulatory approvals before we can acquire a bank, bank holding company, or certain other financial services businesses. We cannot be certain when or if, or on what terms and conditions, any required regulatory approvals will be granted. We might be required to sell banks, branches and/or business units or assets or issue additional equity as a condition to receiving regulatory approval for an acquisition. When we do announce an acquisition, our stock price may fall depending on the size of the acquisition, the type of business to be acquired, the purchase price, and the potential dilution to existing stockholders or our earnings per share if we issue common stock in connection with the acquisition. Furthermore, difficulty in integrating an acquired company or business may cause us not to realize expected revenue increases, cost savings, increases in geographic or product presence, and other projected benefits from the acquisition. The integration could result in higher than expected deposit attrition, loss of key team members, an increase in our compliance costs or risk profile, disruption of our business or the acquired business, or otherwise harm our ability to retain customers and team members or achieve the anticipated benefits of the acquisition. Time and resources spent on integration may also impair our ability to grow our existing businesses. Many of the foregoing risks may be increased if the acquired company or business operates internationally or in a geographic location where we do not already have significant business operations and/or team members.
 
*   *   *
 
Any factor described in this Report or in any of our other SEC filings could by itself, or together with other factors, adversely affect our financial results and condition. Refer to our quarterly reports on Form 10-Q filed with the SEC in 2019 for material changes to the above discussion of risk factors. There are factors not discussed above or elsewhere in this Report that could adversely affect our financial results and condition.

136
Wells Fargo & Company
 


Controls and Procedures
Disclosure Controls and Procedures
The Company’s management evaluated the effectiveness, as of December 31, 2018 , of the Company’s disclosure controls and procedures. The Company’s chief executive officer and chief financial officer participated in the evaluation. Based on this evaluation, the Company’s chief executive officer and chief financial officer concluded that the Company’s disclosure controls and procedures were effective as of December 31, 2018 .
 
Internal Control Over Financial Reporting
Internal control over financial reporting is defined in Rule 13a-15(f) promulgated under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 as a process designed by, or under the supervision of, the Company’s principal executive and principal financial officers and effected by the Company’s Board, management and other personnel, to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles (GAAP) and includes those policies and procedures that:
pertain to the maintenance of records that in reasonable detail accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of assets of the Company;
provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with GAAP, and that receipts and expenditures of the Company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the Company; and
provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use or disposition of the Company’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.
Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate. No change occurred during any quarter in 2018 that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, the Company’s internal control over financial reporting. Management’s report on internal control over financial reporting is set forth below and should be read with these limitations in mind.
 
Management’s Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting
The Company’s management is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting for the Company. Management assessed the effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2018 , using the criteria set forth by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO) in Internal Control Integrated Framework (2013) . Based on this assessment, management concluded that as of December 31, 2018 , the Company’s internal control over financial reporting was effective.
KPMG LLP, the independent registered public accounting firm that audited the Company’s financial statements included in this Annual Report, issued an audit report on the Company’s internal control over financial reporting. KPMG’s audit report appears on the following page.


 
Wells Fargo & Company
137




Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm
 
The Stockholders and Board of Directors
Wells Fargo & Company:
 
Opinion on Internal Control Over Financial Reporting

We have audited Wells Fargo & Company and Subsidiaries’ (the Company) internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2018 , based on criteria established in Internal Control Integrated Framework (2013) issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission. In our opinion, the Company maintained, in all material respects, effective internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2018 , based on criteria established in Internal Control Integrated Framework (2013) issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission.

We also have audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States) (PCAOB), the consolidated balance sheets of the Company as of December 31, 2018 and 2017 , the related consolidated statements of income, comprehensive income, changes in equity, and cash flows for each of the years in the three-year period ended December 31, 2018 , and the related notes (collectively, the consolidated financial statements), and our report dated February 27, 2019 expressed an unqualified opinion on those consolidated financial statements.

Basis for Opinion
 
The Company’s management is responsible for maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting and for its assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting, included in the accompanying Management’s Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on the Company’s internal control over financial reporting based on our audit. We are a public accounting firm registered with the PCAOB and are required to be independent with respect to the Company in accordance with the U.S. federal securities laws and the applicable rules and regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission and the PCAOB.

We conducted our audit in accordance with the standards of the PCAOB. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether effective internal control over financial reporting was maintained in all material respects. Our audit of internal control over financial reporting included obtaining an understanding of internal control over financial reporting, assessing the risk that a material weakness exists, and testing and evaluating the design and operating effectiveness of internal control based on the assessed risk. Our audit also included performing such other procedures as we considered necessary in the circumstances. We believe that our audit provides a reasonable basis for our opinion.

Definition and Limitations of Internal Control Over Financial Reporting
 
A company’s internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. A company’s internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (1) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the company; (2) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the company; and (3) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of the company’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.
 
Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.

 

 

 
/s/ KPMG LLP                         
 
San Francisco, California
February 27, 2019

138
Wells Fargo & Company
 


Financial Statements

Wells Fargo & Company and Subsidiaries
Consolidated Statement of Income
 
Year ended December 31, 
 
(in millions, except per share amounts)
2018

 
2017

 
2016

Interest income
 
 
 
 
 
Debt securities (1)
$
14,406

 
12,946

 
11,244

Mortgage loans held for sale
777

 
786

 
784

Loans held for sale (1)
140

 
50

 
38

Loans
43,974

 
41,388

 
39,505

Equity securities (1)
992

 
799

 
635

Other interest income (1)
4,358

 
2,940

 
1,457

Total interest income
64,647

 
58,909

 
53,663

Interest expense
 
 
 
 
 
Deposits
5,622

 
3,013

 
1,395

Short-term borrowings
1,717

 
758

 
330

Long-term debt
6,703

 
5,157

 
3,830

Other interest expense
610

 
424

 
354

Total interest expense
14,652

 
9,352

 
5,909

Net interest income
49,995

 
49,557

 
47,754

Provision for credit losses
1,744

 
2,528

 
3,770

Net interest income after provision for credit losses
48,251

 
47,029

 
43,984

Noninterest income
 
 
 
 
 
Service charges on deposit accounts
4,716

 
5,111

 
5,372

Trust and investment fees
14,509

 
14,495

 
14,243

Card fees
3,907

 
3,960

 
3,936

Other fees
3,384

 
3,557

 
3,727

Mortgage banking
3,017

 
4,350

 
6,096

Insurance
429

 
1,049

 
1,268

Net gains from trading activities (1)
602

 
542

 
610

Net gains on debt securities (2)
108

 
479

 
942

Net gains from equity securities (1)(3)
1,515

 
1,779

 
1,103

Lease income
1,753

 
1,907

 
1,927

Other
2,473

 
1,603

 
1,289

Total noninterest income
36,413

 
38,832

 
40,513

Noninterest expense
 
 
 
 
 
Salaries
17,834

 
17,363

 
16,552

Commission and incentive compensation
10,264

 
10,442

 
10,247

Employee benefits
4,926

 
5,566

 
5,094

Equipment
2,444

 
2,237

 
2,154

Net occupancy
2,888

 
2,849

 
2,855

Core deposit and other intangibles
1,058

 
1,152

 
1,192

FDIC and other deposit assessments
1,110

 
1,287

 
1,168

Other
15,602

 
17,588

 
13,115

Total noninterest expense
56,126

 
58,484

 
52,377

Income before income tax expense
28,538

 
27,377

 
32,120

Income tax expense
5,662

 
4,917

 
10,075

Net income before noncontrolling interests
22,876

 
22,460

 
22,045

Less: Net income from noncontrolling interests
483

 
277

 
107

Wells Fargo net income
$
22,393

 
22,183

 
21,938

Less: Preferred stock dividends and other
1,704

 
1,629

 
1,565

Wells Fargo net income applicable to common stock
$
20,689

 
20,554

 
20,373

Per share information
 
 
 
 
 
Earnings per common share
$
4.31

 
4.14

 
4.03

Diluted earnings per common share
4.28

 
4.10

 
3.99

Average common shares outstanding
4,799.7

 
4,964.6

 
5,052.8

Diluted average common shares outstanding
4,838.4

 
5,017.3

 
5,108.3

(1)
Financial information for the prior periods has been revised to reflect presentation changes made in connection with our adoption in first quarter 2018 of Accounting Standards Update (ASU) 2016-01 – Financial Instruments – Overall (Subtopic 825-10): Recognition and Measurement of Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities. See Note 1 (Summary of Significant Accounting Policies) for more information.
(2)
Total other-than-temporary impairment (OTTI) losses were $17 million , $205 million and $207 million for the years ended December 31, 2018 , 2017 and 2016 , respectively. Of total OTTI, losses of $28 million , $262 million and $189 million were recognized in earnings, and losses (reversal of losses) of $(11) million , $(57) million and $18 million were recognized as non-credit-related OTTI in other comprehensive income for the years ended December 31, 2018 , 2017 and 2016 , respectively. 
(3)
Includes OTTI losses of $352 million , $344 million and $453 million for the years ended December 31, 2018 , 2017 and 2016 , respectively.
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these statements.

 
Wells Fargo & Company
139




Wells Fargo & Company and Subsidiaries
Consolidated Statement of Comprehensive Income
 
Year ended December 31,
 
(in millions)
2018

 
2017

 
2016

Wells Fargo net income
$
22,393

 
22,183

 
21,938

Other comprehensive income (loss), before tax:
 
 
 
 
 
Debt securities (1):
 
 
 
 
 
Net unrealized gains (losses) arising during the period
(4,493
)
 
2,719

 
(3,458
)
Reclassification of net (gains) losses to net income
248

 
(737
)
 
(1,240
)
Derivatives and hedging activities:
 
 
 
 
 
Net unrealized gains (losses) arising during the period
(532
)
 
(540
)
 
177

Reclassification of net (gains) losses on cash flow hedges to net income
294

 
(543
)
 
(1,029
)
Defined benefit plans adjustments:
 
 
 
 
 
Net actuarial and prior service gains (losses) arising during the period
(434
)
 
49

 
(52
)
Amortization of net actuarial loss, settlements and other to net income
253

 
153

 
158

Foreign currency translation adjustments:
 
 
 
 
 
Net unrealized gains (losses) arising during the period
(156
)
 
96

 
(3
)
Other comprehensive income (loss), before tax
(4,820
)
 
1,197

 
(5,447
)
Income tax benefit (expense) related to other comprehensive income
1,144

 
(434
)
 
1,996

Other comprehensive income (loss), net of tax
(3,676
)
 
763

 
(3,451
)
Less: Other comprehensive loss from noncontrolling interests
(2
)
 
(62
)
 
(17
)
Wells Fargo other comprehensive income (loss), net of tax
(3,674
)
 
825

 
(3,434
)
Wells Fargo comprehensive income
18,719

 
23,008


18,504

Comprehensive income from noncontrolling interests
481

 
215

 
90

Total comprehensive income
$
19,200

 
23,223


18,594

(1)
The year ended December 31, 2017, and December 31, 2016, includes net unrealized gains (losses) arising during the period from equity securities of $81 million and $259 million and reclassification of net (gains) losses to net income related to equity securities of $(456) million and $(300) million , respectively. In connection with our adoption in first quarter 2018 of ASU 2016-01, the year ended December 31, 2018, reflects net unrealized gains (losses) arising during the period and reclassification of net (gains) losses to net income from only debt securities.
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these statements.




140
Wells Fargo & Company
 




Wells Fargo & Company and Subsidiaries
Consolidated Balance Sheet
 
Dec 31,

 
Dec 31,

(in millions, except shares)
2018

 
2017

Assets
 
 
 
Cash and due from banks
$
23,551

 
23,367

Interest-earning deposits with banks (1)
149,736

 
192,580

Total cash, cash equivalents, and restricted cash (1)
173,287

 
215,947

Federal funds sold and securities purchased under resale agreements (1)
80,207

 
80,025

Debt securities:
 
 
 
Trading, at fair value (2)
69,989

 
57,624

Available-for-sale, at fair value (2)
269,912

 
276,407

Held-to-maturity, at cost (fair value $142,115 and $138,985)
144,788

 
139,335

Mortgage loans held for sale (includes $11,771 and $16,116 carried at fair value) (3)
15,126

 
20,070

Loans held for sale (includes $1,469 and $1,023 carried at fair value) (2)(3)
2,041

 
1,131

Loans (includes $244 and $376 carried at fair value) (3)
953,110

 
956,770

Allowance for loan losses
(9,775
)
 
(11,004
)
Net loans
943,335

 
945,766

Mortgage servicing rights:
 
 
 
Measured at fair value
14,649

 
13,625

Amortized
1,443

 
1,424

Premises and equipment, net
8,920

 
8,847

Goodwill
26,418

 
26,587

Derivative assets
10,770

 
12,228

Equity securities (includes $29,556 and $39,227 carried at fair value) (2)(3)
55,148

 
62,497

Other assets (2)
79,850

 
90,244

Total assets (4)
$
1,895,883


1,951,757

Liabilities
 
 
 
Noninterest-bearing deposits
$
349,534

 
373,722

Interest-bearing deposits
936,636

 
962,269

Total deposits
1,286,170

 
1,335,991

Short-term borrowings
105,787

 
103,256

Derivative liabilities
8,499

 
8,796

Accrued expenses and other liabilities
69,317

 
70,615

Long-term debt
229,044

 
225,020

Total liabilities (5)
1,698,817

 
1,743,678

Equity
 
 
 
Wells Fargo stockholders’ equity:
 
 
 
Preferred stock
23,214

 
25,358

Common stock – $1-2/3 par value, authorized 9,000,000,000 shares; issued 5,481,811,474 shares 
9,136

 
9,136

Additional paid-in capital
60,685

 
60,893

Retained earnings
158,163

 
145,263

Cumulative other comprehensive income (loss)
(6,336
)
 
(2,144
)
Treasury stock – 900,557,866   shares and 590,194,846 shares 
(47,194
)
 
(29,892
)
Unearned ESOP shares
(1,502
)
 
(1,678
)
Total Wells Fargo stockholders’ equity
196,166

 
206,936

Noncontrolling interests
900

 
1,143

Total equity
197,066

 
208,079

Total liabilities and equity
$
1,895,883

 
1,951,757

(1)
Financial information has been revised to reflect the impact of our adoption in first quarter 2018 of ASU 2016-18 Statement of Cash Flows (Topic 230): Restricted Cash in which we changed the presentation of our cash and cash equivalents to include both cash and due from banks as well as interest-earning deposits with banks, which are inclusive of any restricted cash. See Note 1 (Summary of Significant Accounting Policies) for more information.
(2)
Financial information for the prior period has been revised to reflect presentation changes in connection with our adoption in first quarter 2018 of ASU 2016-01 Financial Instruments Overall (Subtopic 825-10): Recognition and Measurement of Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities . See Note 1 (Summary of Significant Accounting Policies) for more information.
(3)
Parenthetical amounts represent assets and liabilities that we are required to carry at fair value or have elected the fair value option.
(4)
Our consolidated assets at December 31, 2018 and 2017 , include the following assets of certain variable interest entities (VIEs) that can only be used to settle the liabilities of those VIEs: Cash and due from banks, $139 million and $116 million ; Interest-bearing deposits with banks, $8 million and $371 million ; Debt securities, $45 million and $0 million ; Net loans, $13.6 billion and $12.5 billion ; Derivative assets, $0 million and $0 million ; Equity securities, $85 million and $306 million ; Other assets, $221 million and $342 million ; and Total assets, $14.1 billion and $13.6 billion , respectively.
(5)
Our consolidated liabilities at December 31, 2018 and 2017 , include the following VIE liabilities for which the VIE creditors do not have recourse to Wells Fargo: Derivative liabilities, $0 million and $ 5 million ; Accrued expenses and other liabilities, $191 million and $132 million ; Long-term debt, $816 million and $1.5 billion ; and Total liabilities, $1.0 billion and $1.6 billion , respectively.
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these statements.

 
Wells Fargo & Company
141




Wells Fargo & Company and Subsidiaries
Consolidated Statement of Changes in Equity
 
 
 
 
 

Preferred stock 
 
 

Common stock 
 
(in millions, except shares)
Shares 

 
Amount 

 
Shares 

 
Amount 

Balance December 31, 2015
11,259,917

 
$
22,214

 
5,092,128,810

 
$
9,136

Cumulative effect from change in consolidation accounting (1)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Balance January 1, 2016
11,259,917

 
22,214

 
5,092,128,810

 
9,136

Net income
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Other comprehensive income (loss), net of tax
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Noncontrolling interests
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Common stock issued
 
 
 
 
63,441,805

 


Common stock repurchased (2)
 
 
 
 
(159,647,152
)
 
 
Preferred stock issued to ESOP
1,150,000

 
1,150

 
 
 
 
Preferred stock released by ESOP
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Preferred stock converted to common shares
(963,205
)
 
(963
)
 
20,185,863

 


Common stock warrants repurchased/exercised
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
Preferred stock issued
86,000

 
2,150

 
  
 
 
Common stock dividends
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Preferred stock dividends
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Tax benefit from stock incentive compensation
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Stock incentive compensation expense
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net change in deferred compensation and related plans
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net change
272,795

 
2,337

 
(76,019,484
)
 

Balance December 31, 2016
11,532,712

 
$
24,551

 
5,016,109,326

 
$
9,136

Cumulative effect from change in hedge accounting (3)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Balance January 1, 2017
11,532,712

 
24,551

 
5,016,109,326

 
9,136

Net income
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Other comprehensive income (loss), net of tax
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Noncontrolling interests
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Common stock issued
 
 
 
 
57,257,564

 


Common stock repurchased (2)
 
 
 
 
(196,519,707
)
 
 
Preferred stock issued to ESOP
950,000

 
950

 
 
 
 
Preferred stock released by ESOP
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Preferred stock converted to common shares
(833,077
)
 
(833
)
 
14,769,445

 


Common stock warrants repurchased/exercised
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Preferred stock issued
27,600

 
690

 
 
 
 
Common stock dividends
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Preferred stock dividends
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Tax benefit from stock incentive compensation (4)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Stock incentive compensation expense
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net change in deferred compensation and related plans
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net change
144,523

 
807

 
(124,492,698
)
 

Balance December 31, 2017
11,677,235

 
$
25,358

 
4,891,616,628

 
$
9,136

(1)
Effective January 1, 2016, we adopted changes in consolidation accounting pursuant to Accounting Standards Update (ASU) 2015-02: Amendments to the Consolidation Analysis . Accordingly, we recorded a $121 million net increase to beginning noncontrolling interests as a cumulative-effect adjustment.
(2)
For the year ended December 31, 2016, includes $750 million related to a private forward repurchase transaction that settled in first quarter 2017 for 14.7 million shares of common stock. See Note 1 (Summary of Significant Accounting Policies) for additional information.
(3)
Effective January 1, 2017, we adopted changes in hedge accounting pursuant to ASU 2017-12 Derivatives and Hedging (Topic 815): Targeted Improvements to Accounting for Hedging Activities .
(4)
Effective January 1, 2017, we adopted Accounting Standards Update 2016-09 ( Improvements to Employee Share-Based Payment Accounting ). Accordingly, tax benefit from stock incentive compensation is reported in income tax expense in the consolidated statement of income.
 The accompanying notes are an integral part of these statements.
 
(continued on following pages)

142
Wells Fargo & Company
 




 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Wells Fargo stockholders’ equity 
 
 
Additional
paid-in
capital 

 
Retained earnings 

 
Cumulative
other
comprehensive income (loss)

 
Treasury
stock 

 
Unearned
ESOP
shares 

 
Total
Wells Fargo stockholders’ equity 

 
Noncontrolling interests 

 
Total
equity 

60,714

 
120,866

 
297

 
(18,867
)
 
(1,362
)
 
192,998

 
893

 
193,891

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
121

 
121

60,714

 
120,866

 
297

 
(18,867
)
 
(1,362
)
 
192,998

 
1,014

 
194,012

 
 
21,938

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
21,938

 
107

 
22,045

 
 
 
 
(3,434
)
 
 
 
 
 
(3,434
)
 
(17
)
 
(3,451
)
2

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2

 
(188
)
 
(186
)
(203
)
 
(451
)
 
 
 
3,040

 
 
 
2,386

 
 
 
2,386

(250
)
 
 
 
 
 
(7,866
)
 
 
 
(8,116
)
 
 
 
(8,116
)
99

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(1,249
)
 

 
 
 

(83
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1,046

 
963

 
 
 
963

(11
)
 
 
 
 
 
974

 
 
 

 
 
 

(17
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(17
)
 
 
 
(17
)
(49
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2,101

 
 
 
2,101

51

 
(7,712
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(7,661
)
 
 
 
(7,661
)
 
 
(1,566
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(1,566
)
 
 
 
(1,566
)
277

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
277

 
 
 
277

779

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
779

 
 
 
779

(1,075
)
 
 
 
 
 
6

 
 
 
(1,069
)
 
 
 
(1,069
)
(480
)
 
12,209

 
(3,434
)
 
(3,846
)
 
(203
)
 
6,583

 
(98
)
 
6,485

60,234

 
133,075

 
(3,137
)
 
(22,713
)
 
(1,565
)
 
199,581

 
916

 
200,497

 
 
(381
)
 
168

 
 
 
 
 
(213
)
 
 
 
(213
)
60,234

 
132,694

 
(2,969
)
 
(22,713
)
 
(1,565
)
 
199,368

 
916

 
200,284

 
 
22,183

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
22,183

 
277

 
22,460

 
 
 
 
825

 
 
 
 
 
825

 
(62
)
 
763


 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

 
12

 
12

(133
)
 
(277
)
 
 
 
2,758

 
 
 
2,348

 
 
 
2,348

750

 
 
 
 
 
(10,658
)
 
 
 
(9,908
)
 
 
 
(9,908
)
31

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(981
)
 

 
 
 

(35
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
868

 
833

 
 
 
833

97

 
 
 
 
 
736

 
 
 

 
 
 

(133
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(133
)
 
 
 
(133
)
(13
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
677

 
 
 
677

50

 
(7,708
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(7,658
)
 
 
 
(7,658
)
 
 
(1,629
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(1,629
)
 
 
 
(1,629
)

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

 
 
 

875

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
875

 
 
 
875

(830
)
 
 
 
 
 
(15
)
 
 
 
(845
)
 
 
 
(845
)
659

 
12,569

 
825

 
(7,179
)
 
(113
)
 
7,568

 
227

 
7,795

60,893

 
145,263

 
(2,144
)
 
(29,892
)
 
(1,678
)
 
206,936

 
1,143

 
208,079


 
Wells Fargo & Company
143




(continued from previous pages)
Wells Fargo & Company and Subsidiaries
Consolidated Statement of Changes in Equity
 
 
 
 
 

Preferred stock 
 
 

Common stock 
 
(in millions, except shares)
Shares 

 
Amount 

 
Shares 

 
Amount 

Balance December 31, 2017
11,677,235

 
$
25,358

 
4,891,616,628

 
$
9,136

Cumulative effect from change in accounting policies (1)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Balance January 1, 2018
11,677,235

 
25,358

 
4,891,616,628

 
9,136

Adoption of accounting standard related to certain tax effects stranded in accumulated other comprehensive income (loss)(2)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net income
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Other comprehensive income (loss), net of tax
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Noncontrolling interests
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Common stock issued
 
 
 
 
41,082,047

 
 
Common stock repurchased
 
 
 
 
(375,477,998
)
 
 
Preferred stock redeemed (3)
(2,150,375
)
 
(1,995
)
 
 
 
 
Preferred stock issued to ESOP
1,100,000

 
1,100

 
 
 
 
Preferred stock released by ESOP
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Preferred stock converted to common shares
(1,249,644
)
 
(1,249
)
 
24,032,931

 
 
Common stock warrants repurchased/exercised
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Preferred stock issued

 

 
 
 
 
Common stock dividends
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Preferred stock dividends
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Stock incentive compensation expense
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net change in deferred compensation and related plans
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net change
(2,300,019
)
 
(2,144
)
 
(310,363,020
)
 

Balance December 31, 2018
9,377,216

 
$
23,214

 
4,581,253,608

 
$
9,136

(1)
Effective January 1, 2018, we adopted ASU 2016-04 – Liabilities – Extinguishments of Liabilities (Subtopic 405-20): Recognition of Breakage for Certain Prepaid Stored-Value Products, ASU 2016-01 – Financial Instruments – Overall (Subtopic 825-10): Recognition and Measurement of Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities , and ASU 2014-09 – Revenue from Contracts With Customers (Topic 606) and subsequent related Updates. See Note 1 (Summary of Significant Accounting Policies) in this Report for more information.
(2)
Represents the reclassification from other comprehensive income to retained earnings as a result of our adoption of ASU 2018-02 – Reclassification of Certain Tax Effects from Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income, in the third quarter of 2018. For additional information, see Note 1.
(3)
Represents the impact of the redemption of preferred stock, series J, in third quarter 2018.
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these statements.

144
Wells Fargo & Company
 





 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Wells Fargo stockholders’ equity 
 
 
Additional
 paid-in
capital 

 
Retained earnings 

 
Cumulative
other
comprehensive
income (loss)

 
Treasury
stock 

 
Unearned
ESOP
shares 

 
Total
Wells Fargo stockholders’ equity 

 
Noncontrolling interests 

 
Total
equity 

60,893

 
145,263

 
(2,144
)
 
(29,892
)
 
(1,678
)
 
206,936

 
1,143

 
208,079

 
 
94

 
(118
)
 
 
 
 
 
(24
)
 
 
 
(24
)
60,893

 
145,357

 
(2,262
)
 
(29,892
)
 
(1,678
)
 
206,912

 
1,143

 
208,055

 
 
400

 
(400
)
 
 
 
 
 

 
 
 

 
 
22,393

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
22,393

 
483

 
22,876

 
 
 
 
(3,674
)
 
 
 
 
 
(3,674
)
 
(2
)
 
(3,676
)
7

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
7

 
(724
)
 
(717
)
(76
)
 
(321
)
 
 
 
2,073

 
 
 
1,676

 
 
 
1,676


 
 
 
 
 
(20,633
)
 
 
 
(20,633
)
 
 
 
(20,633
)
 
 
(155
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(2,150
)
 
 
 
(2,150
)
43

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(1,143
)
 

 
 
 

(70
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1,319

 
1,249

 
 
 
1,249

6

 
 
 
 
 
1,243

 
 
 

 
 
 

(325
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(325
)
 
 
 
(325
)

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

 
 
 

66

 
(7,955
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(7,889
)
 
 
 
(7,889
)
 
 
(1,556
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(1,556
)
 
 
 
(1,556
)
1,041

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1,041

 
 
 
1,041

(900
)
 
 
 
 
 
15

 
 
 
(885
)
 
 
 
(885
)
(208
)
 
12,806


(4,074
)

(17,302
)

176


(10,746
)

(243
)

(10,989
)
60,685

 
158,163


(6,336
)

(47,194
)

(1,502
)

196,166


900


197,066


 
Wells Fargo & Company
145




Wells Fargo & Company and Subsidiaries
Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows
 
Year ended December 31, 
 
(in millions)
2018

 
2017

 
2016

Cash flows from operating activities:
 
 
 
 
 
Net income before noncontrolling interests
$
22,876

 
22,460

 
22,045

Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided by operating activities:
 
 
 
 
 
Provision for credit losses
1,744

 
2,528

 
3,770

Changes in fair value of MSRs, MLHFS and LHFS carried at fair value
453

 
886

 
139

Depreciation, amortization and accretion
5,593

 
5,406

 
4,970

Other net gains (1)
(7,630
)
 
(1,518
)
 
(6,337
)
Stock-based compensation
2,255

 
2,046

 
1,945

Originations and purchases of mortgage loans held for sale (1)
(152,832
)
 
(181,269
)
 
(205,300
)
Proceeds from sales of and paydowns on mortgages loans held for sale (1)
119,097

 
134,984

 
127,479

Net change in:
 
 
 
 
 
Debt and equity securities, held for trading (1)
35,054

 
33,505

 
63,309

Loans held for sale (1)
(960
)
 
327

 
(451
)
Deferred income taxes
1,970

 
666

 
1,793

Derivative assets and liabilities
1,513

 
(5,025
)
 
2,089

Other assets (1)
7,805

 
(1,214
)
 
(14,232
)
Other accrued expenses and liabilities
(865
)
 
4,837

 
(211
)
Net cash provided by operating activities
36,073

 
18,619

 
1,008

Cash flows from investing activities:
 
 
 
 
 
Net change in:
 
 
 
 
 
Federal funds sold and securities purchased under resale agreements (2)
(1,184
)
 
(21,497
)
 
(15,747
)
Available-for-sale debt securities:
 
 
 
 
 
Proceeds from sales (1)
7,320

 
42,067

 
30,958

Prepayments and maturities (1)
36,725

 
45,688

 
40,998

Purchases (1)
(60,067
)
 
(103,656
)
 
(120,978
)
Held-to-maturity securities:
 
 
 
 
 
Paydowns and maturities
10,934

 
10,673

 
7,957

Purchases

 

 
(23,593
)
Equity securities, not held for trading:
 
 
 
 
 
Proceeds from sales and capital returns (1)
6,242

 
5,451

 
3,711

Purchases (1)
(6,433
)
 
(3,735
)
 
(5,383
)
Loans:
 
 
 
 
 
Loans originated by banking subsidiaries, net of principal collected
(18,619
)
 
317

 
(39,002
)
Proceeds from sales (including participations) of loans held for investment
16,294

 
10,439

 
10,061

Purchases (including participations) of loans
(2,088
)
 
(3,702
)
 
(6,221
)
Principal collected on nonbank entities’ loans
6,791

 
7,448

 
6,844

Loans originated by nonbank entities
(6,482
)
 
(6,814
)
 
(7,743
)
Net cash paid for acquisitions
(10
)
 
(320
)
 
(30,584
)
Proceeds from sales of foreclosed assets and short sales
3,592

 
5,198

 
7,311

Other, net (2)
(769
)
 
(709
)
 
(508
)
Net cash used by investing activities
(7,754
)
 
(13,152
)

(141,919
)
Cash flows from financing activities:
 
 
 
 
 
Net change in:
 
 
 
 
 
Deposits
(48,034
)
 
29,912

 
82,767

Short-term borrowings
2,531

 
14,020

 
(1,198
)
Long-term debt:
 
 
 
 
 
Proceeds from issuance
47,595

 
43,575

 
90,111

Repayment
(40,565
)
 
(80,802
)
 
(34,462
)
Preferred stock:
 
 
 
 
 
Proceeds from issuance

 
677

 
2,101

Redeemed
(2,150
)
 

 

Cash dividends paid
(1,622
)
 
(1,629
)
 
(1,566
)
Common stock:
 
 
 
 
 
Proceeds from issuance
632

 
1,211

 
1,415

Stock tendered for payment of withholding taxes
(331
)
 
(393
)
 
(494
)
Repurchased
(20,633
)
 
(9,908
)
 
(8,116
)
Cash dividends paid
(7,692
)
 
(7,480
)
 
(7,472
)
Net change in noncontrolling interests
(462
)
 
30

 
(188
)
Other, net
(248
)
 
(133
)
 
(107
)
Net cash provided (used) by financing activities
(70,979
)
 
(10,920
)

122,791

Net change in cash, cash equivalents, and restricted cash (2)
(42,660
)
 
(5,453
)

(18,120
)
Cash, cash equivalents, and restricted cash at beginning of year (2)
215,947

 
221,400


239,520

Cash, cash equivalents, and restricted cash at end of year (2)
$
173,287

 
215,947

 
221,400

Supplemental cash flow disclosures:
 
 
 
 
 
Cash paid for interest
$
14,366

 
9,103

 
5,573

Cash paid for income taxes
1,977

 
6,592

 
8,446

(1)
Financial information for the prior periods has been revised to reflect presentation changes made in connection with our adoption in first quarter 2018 of ASU 2016-01 – Financial Instruments – Overall (Subtopic 825-10): Recognition and Measurement of Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities . See Note 1 (Summary of Significant Accounting Policies) for more information.
(2)
Financial information has been revised to reflect the impact of our adoption in first quarter 2018 of ASU 2016-18 – Statement of Cash Flows (Topic 230): Restricted Cash in which we changed the presentation of our cash and cash equivalents to include both cash and due from banks as well as interest-earning deposits with banks, which are inclusive of any restricted cash. See Note 1 (Summary of Significant Accounting Policies) for more information.
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these statements. See Note 1 (Summary of Significant Accounting Policies) for noncash activities.

146
Wells Fargo & Company
 


Notes to Financial Statements

See the Glossary of Acronyms at the end of this Report for terms used throughout the Financial Statements and related Notes.
Note 1: Summary of Significant Accounting Policies
Wells Fargo & Company is a diversified financial services company. We provide banking, trust and investments, mortgage banking, investment banking, retail banking, brokerage, and consumer and commercial finance through banking locations, the internet and other distribution channels to consumers, businesses and institutions in all 50 states, the District of Columbia, and in foreign countries. When we refer to “Wells Fargo,” “the Company,” “we,” “our” or “us,” we mean Wells Fargo & Company and Subsidiaries (consolidated). Wells Fargo & Company (the Parent) is a financial holding company and a bank holding company. We also hold a majority interest in a real estate investment trust, which has publicly traded preferred stock outstanding.
Our accounting and reporting policies conform with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles (GAAP) and practices in the financial services industry. To prepare the financial statements in conformity with GAAP, management must make estimates based on assumptions about future economic and market conditions (for example, unemployment, market liquidity, real estate prices, etc.) that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities at the date of the financial statements, income and expenses during the reporting period and the related disclosures. Although our estimates contemplate current conditions and how we expect them to change in the future, it is reasonably possible that actual conditions could be worse than anticipated in those estimates, which could materially affect our results of operations and financial condition. Management has made significant estimates in several areas, including:
allowance for credit losses (Note 6 (Loans and Allowance for Credit Losses));
valuations of residential mortgage servicing rights (MSRs) (Note 9 (Securitizations and Variable Interest Entities) and Note 10 (Mortgage Banking Activities)) and financial instruments (Note 18 (Fair Values of Assets and Liabilities));
liabilities for contingent litigation losses (Note 16 (Legal Actions)); and
income taxes (Note 23 (Income Taxes)).

Actual results could differ from those estimates.
 
Accounting Standards Adopted in 2018
In 2018 , we adopted the following new accounting guidance:
Accounting Standards Update (ASU or Update) 2018-14 – Compensation – Retirement Benefits – Defined Benefit Plans—General (Subtopic 715-20): Disclosure Framework Changes to the Disclosure Requirements for Defined Benefit Plans
ASU 2018-02 – Income Statement-Reporting Comprehensive Income (Topic 220): Reclassification of Certain Tax Effects from Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income
ASU 2017-09 – Compensation – Stock Compensation (Topic 718): Scope of Modification Accounting;
ASU 2017-07 – Improving the Presentation of Net Periodic Pension Cost and Net Periodic Postretirement Benefit Cost;
ASU 2017-05 – Other Income – Gains and Losses from the Derecognition of Nonfinancial Assets (Subtopic 610-20): Clarifying the Scope of Asset Derecognition Guidance and Accounting for Partial Sales of Nonfinancial Assets;
ASU 2017-01 – Business Combinations (Topic 805):
 
Clarifying the Definition of a Business;
ASU 2016-18 Statement of Cash Flows (Topic 230): Restricted Cash;
ASU 2016-16 – Income Taxes (Topic 740): Intra-Entity Transfers of Assets Other Than Inventory;
ASU 2016-15 – Statement of Cash Flows (Topic 230): Classification of Certain Cash Receipts and Cash Payments;
ASU 2016-04 – Liabilities – Extinguishments of Liabilities (Subtopic 405-20): Recognition of Breakage for Certain Prepaid Stored-Value Products;
ASU 2016-01 – Financial Instruments – Overall (Subtopic 825-10): Recognition and Measurement of Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities; and
ASU 2014-09 – Revenue from Contracts With Customers (Topic 606) and subsequent related Updates.

ASU 2018-14 changes the disclosure requirements for our defined benefit pension and postretirement plans. We are eliminating two disclosures that are no longer considered beneficial: (1) information related to amounts in accumulated other comprehensive income to be recognized in the next year as benefit cost and (2) the effect of one-percentage point change on assumed health care cost trend rates. We have added two disclosures: (1) the weighted-average interest crediting rates for plans with promised interest crediting rates, and (2) explanations for significant gain and losses related to changes in the benefit obligation. We early adopted this change in fourth quarter 2018.

ASU 2018-02 allows a reclassification to update amounts in accumulated other comprehensive income to an appropriate tax rate under the Tax Cuts & Jobs Act. In 2018, we reclassified $400 million resulting in a reduction of accumulated other comprehensive income and an increase to retained earnings. For additional information, see Note 25 (Other Comprehensive Income). We have finalized our provisional tax estimates based on the completion of our U.S. tax filings in fourth quarter 2018.

ASU 2017-09 clarifies when to account for a change to the terms or conditions of a share-based payment award as a modification. Under the ASU, modification accounting is required only if the fair value, the vesting conditions, or the classification of the award (as equity or liability) changes as a result of the change in terms or conditions. The Update is applied to awards modified on or after the adoption date and accordingly, did not have a material impact on our consolidated financial statements.

ASU 2017-07 requires that the service cost component of net benefit cost be reported in the same line item as other compensation costs arising from services rendered by employees during the period, and the other pension cost components (interest cost, expected return on plan assets and amortization of actuarial gains and losses) be presented in the income statement separate from the service cost component. The income statement line item used to present the other pension cost components must be disclosed. We adopted this change in first quarter 2018. The Update did not have a material impact on our consolidated financial statements.


 
Wells Fargo & Company
147


Note 1: Summary of Significant Accounting Policies (continued)

ASU 2017-05 provides guidance for recognizing gains and losses from the transfer of nonfinancial assets in contracts with non-customers. The ASU applies to nonfinancial assets, including real estate (e.g., buildings, land, windmills, solar farms), ships and intellectual property. We adopted this change in first quarter 2018. The Update did not have a material impact on our consolidated financial statements.

ASU 2017-01 requires that when substantially all of the fair value of gross assets acquired is concentrated in a single asset (or a group of similar assets), the assets acquired would not represent a business. We adopted this change in first quarter 2018. The Update is applied prospectively and did not have a material impact on our consolidated financial statements.

ASU 2016-18 requires that restricted cash and cash equivalents are included with the total cash and cash equivalents in the consolidated statement of cash flows. In addition, the nature of any restrictions will be disclosed in the footnotes to the financial statements. We adopted this change in first quarter 2018. Our retrospective adoption includes changes to our presentation of cash and cash equivalents in our consolidated statement of cash flows to include both cash and due from banks as well as interest-earning deposits with banks. In addition, we had corresponding changes on our consolidated balance sheets.

ASU 2016-16 requires us to recognize the income tax effects of intercompany sales and transfers of assets other than inventory in the period in which the transfer occurs. We adopted this change in first quarter 2018. The Update did not have a material impact on our consolidated financial statements.

ASU 2016-15 addresses eight specific cash flow issues with the objective of reducing the existing diversity in practice for reporting in the statement of cash flows. We adopted this change in first quarter 2018. The Update did not have a material impact on our consolidated financial statements.

ASU 2016-04 modifies the accounting for certain prepaid card products to require the recognition of breakage. Breakage represents the estimated amount that will not be redeemed by the cardholder for goods or services. We adopted this change in first quarter 2018. Upon adoption, we recorded a cumulative-effect adjustment that increased retained earnings, given estimated breakage, by $20 million .

 
ASU 2016-01 changes the accounting for certain equity securities to record at fair value with unrealized gains or losses reflected in earnings, as well as improve the disclosures of equity securities and the fair value of financial instruments. The Update also requires that for purposes of disclosing the fair value of financial instruments recorded at amortized cost, including loans and long-term debt, the valuation methodology is based on an exit price notion.
We adopted the Update in first quarter 2018 and recorded a cumulative-effect adjustment as of January 1, 2018, that increased retained earnings by $106 million as a result of a transition adjustment to reclassify $118 million in net unrealized gains from other comprehensive income to retained earnings, partially offset by a transition adjustment to decrease retained earnings by $12 million primarily to adjust the carrying value of our auction rate securities from cost to fair value. No transition adjustment was recorded for investments changed to the measurement alternative (described below), which was applied prospectively.
As a result of adopting this ASU, our investments in marketable equity securities, including those previously classified as available-for-sale, are accounted for at fair value with unrealized gains or losses reflected in earnings. Additionally, our share of unrealized gains or losses related to marketable equity securities held by our equity method investees are reflected in earnings. Prior to adoption, such unrealized gains and losses were reflected in other comprehensive income. Our investments in nonmarketable equity securities previously accounted for under the cost method of accounting, except for Federal Reserve Bank stock, are now accounted for either at fair value with unrealized gains and losses reflected in earnings or using the measurement alternative. The measurement alternative is similar to the cost method of accounting, except the carrying value is adjusted through earnings for impairment, if any, and changes in observable and orderly transactions in the same or similar investment. We account for substantially all of our private equity investments, previously using the cost method of accounting, now under the measurement alternative. Our auction rate securities portfolio is now accounted for at fair value with unrealized gains or losses reflected in earnings.
In connection with our adoption of this Update, we have modified our balance sheet and income statement presentation to report marketable and nonmarketable equity securities and their results separately from debt securities by now reporting all equity securities in a new line labeled “Equity securities” in both the balance sheet and income statement. Additionally we now report loans held for trading purposes in loans held for sale and have reclassified net gains and losses on marketable equity securities used as economic hedges of deferred compensation obligations from “Net gains for trading activities” to “Net gains from equity securities”. All prior periods have been revised to conform to these changes in reporting.

148
Wells Fargo & Company
 


Table 1.1 provides a summary of our reporting changes implemented in connection with our adoption of ASU 2016-01 in first quarter 2018.
Table 1.1: Summary of Reporting Changes
Financial instrument or transaction type
As previously reported
Revised reporting
Balance Sheet
 
 
   Marketable equity securities
Trading assets and available for sale investment securities
Equity securities (new caption)
   Nonmarketable equity securities
Other assets
Equity securities (new caption)
   Loans held for trading
Trading assets
Loans held for sale
   Debt securities held for trading
Trading assets
Debt securities (formerly “Investment securities”)
 
 
 
Income Statement
 
 
   Interest income:
 
 
      Marketable equity securities
Trading assets and investment securities
Equity securities (new caption)
      Nonmarketable equity securities
Other
Equity securities (new caption)
      Loans held for trading
Trading assets
Loans held for sale
      Debt securities held for trading
Trading assets
Debt securities (formerly “Investment securities”)
   Noninterest income:
 
 
      Deferred compensation gains (1)
Net gains from trading activities
Net gains from equity securities
(1)
Reclassification of net gains and losses on marketable equity securities economically hedging our deferred compensation obligations.
Table 1.2 summarizes financial assets and liabilities by form and measurement accounting model.
Table 1.2: Accounting Model for Financial Assets and Liabilities
Balance sheet caption
Measurement model(s)
Financial statement Note reference
Cash and due from banks
Cost
N/A
Interest-earning deposits with banks
Cost
N/A
Federal funds sold and securities purchased under resale agreements
Amortized cost
N/A
Debt securities:
 
 
Trading
FV-NI (1)
Note 4: Trading Activities
Note 18: Fair Values of Assets and Liabilities
Available-for-sale
FV-OCI (2)
Note 5: Available-for-Sale and Held-to-Maturity Debt Securities
Note 18: Fair Values of Assets and Liabilities
Held-to-maturity
Amortized cost
Note 5: Available-for-Sale and Held-to-Maturity Debt Securities
Mortgage loans held for sale
FV-NI (1)
LOCOM (3)
Note 18: Fair Values of Assets and Liabilities
Loans held for sale
FV-NI (1)
LOCOM (3)
Note 18: Fair Values of Assets and Liabilities
Loans
Amortized cost
FV-NI (1)
Note 6: Loans and Allowance for Credit Losses
Note 18: Fair Values of Assets and Liabilities
Derivative assets and liabilities
FV-NI (1)
FV-OCI (2)
Note 4: Trading Activities
Note 17: Derivatives
Note 18: Fair Values of Assets and Liabilities
Equity securities:
 
 
Marketable
FV-NI (1)
Note 4: Trading Activities
Note 8: Equity Securities
Note 18: Fair Values of Assets and Liabilities
Nonmarketable
FV-NI (1)
Cost method
Equity method
MA (4)
Note 4: Trading Activities
Note 8: Equity Securities
Note 18: Fair Values of Assets and Liabilities
Other assets
Amortized cost (5)
Note 7: Premises, Equipment, Lease Commitments and Other Assets
Deposits
Amortized cost
N/A
Short-term borrowings
Amortized cost
N/A
Long-term debt
Amortized cost
N/A
(1)
FV-NI represents the fair value through net income accounting model.
(2)
FV-OCI represents the fair value through other comprehensive income accounting model.
(3)
LOCOM represents the lower of cost or fair value accounting model.
(4)
MA represents the measurement alternative accounting model.
(5)
Other assets are generally carried at amortized cost, except for bank-owned life insurance which is carried at cash surrender value.

 
Wells Fargo & Company
149


Note 1: Summary of Significant Accounting Policies (continued)

ASU 2014-09 modifies the guidance used to recognize revenue from contracts with customers for transfers of goods or services and transfers of non-financial assets, unless those contracts are within the scope of other guidance. We adopted the Update in first quarter 2018, and upon a modified retrospective adoption, we recorded a cumulative-effect adjustment as of January 1, 2018, that decreased retained earnings by $32 million , due to changes in the timing of revenue for corporate trust services that are provided over the life of the associated trust. In addition, we changed the presentation of some costs such that underwriting expenses of our broker-dealer business that were previously netted against revenue are now included in noninterest expense, and card payment network charges that were previously included in noninterest expense are now netted against card fee revenue.

Consolidation
Our consolidated financial statements include the accounts of the Parent and our subsidiaries in which we have a controlling interest.
We are also a variable interest holder in certain entities in which equity investors do not have the characteristics of a controlling financial interest or where the entity does not have enough equity at risk to finance its activities without additional subordinated financial support from other parties (referred to as variable interest entities (VIEs)). Our variable interest arises from contractual, ownership or other monetary interests in the entity, which change with fluctuations in the fair value of the entity’s net assets. We consolidate a VIE if we are the primary beneficiary. We are the primary beneficiary if we have a controlling financial interest, which includes both the power to direct the activities that most significantly impact the VIE and a variable interest that potentially could be significant to the VIE. To determine whether or not a variable interest we hold could potentially be significant to the VIE, we consider both qualitative and quantitative factors regarding the nature, size and form of our involvement with the VIE. We assess whether or not we are the primary beneficiary of a VIE on an ongoing basis.
Significant intercompany accounts and transactions are eliminated in consolidation. When we have significant influence over operating and financing decisions for a company but do not own a majority of the voting equity interests, we account for the investment using the equity method of accounting, which requires us to recognize our proportionate share of the company’s earnings. If we do not have significant influence, we account for the equity security under the fair value method, cost method or measurement alternative.

Cash, Cash Equivalents and Restricted Cash
Cash, cash equivalents and restricted cash include cash on hand, cash items in transit, and amounts due from or held with other depository institutions. See Note 3 (Cash, Loan and Dividend Restrictions) for the nature of our restrictions on cash and cash equivalents.
 
Trading Activities
We engage in trading activities to accommodate the investment and risk management activities of our customers. These activities predominantly occur in our Wholesale Banking businesses and to a lesser extent other divisions of the Company. The assets and liabilities classified as trading include debt securities, loans, equity securities, derivatives and short sales, which are reported within the balance sheet line item based on the form of the instrument. In addition, debt securities that are
 
held for investment purposes that we have elected to account for under the fair value method, are classified as trading.
Our trading assets and liabilities are carried on the balance sheet at fair value with changes in fair value recognized in net gains from trading activities and interest income and interest expense recognized in net interest income.
Customer accommodation trading activities include our actions as an intermediary to buy and sell financial instruments and market-making activities. We also take positions to manage our exposure to customer accommodation activities. We hold financial instruments for trading in long positions (assets), as well as short positions where we sold financial instruments we have not yet purchased (liabilities), to facilitate our trading activities. As an intermediary we interact with market buyers and sellers to facilitate the purchase and sale of financial instruments to meet the anticipated or current needs of our customers. For example, we may purchase or sell a derivative to a customer who wants to manage interest rate risk exposure. We typically enter into an offsetting derivative or security position to manage our exposure to the customer transaction. We earn income based on the transaction price difference between the customer transaction and the offsetting position, which is reflected in the fair value changes of the positions recorded in the net gains from trading activities.
Our market-making activities include taking long and short trading positions to facilitate customer order flow. These activities are typically executed on a short-term basis. As a market-maker we earn income due to: (1) difference between the price paid or received for the purchase and sale of the security (bid-ask spread), (2) the net interest income of the positions, and (3) the changes in fair value of the trading positions held on our balance sheet. Additionally, we may enter into separate derivative or security positions to manage our exposure related to our long and short trading positions taken in our market-making activities. Income earned on these market-making activities are reflected in the fair value changes of these positions recorded in net gains from trading activities.
 
Debt Securities
Our investments in debt securities that are not held for trading purposes are classified as either debt securities available-for-sale (AFS) or held-to-maturity (HTM).

AVAILABLE-FOR-SALE DEBT SECURITIES
Debt securities for which the Company does not have the postitive intent and ability to hold to maturity are classified as AFS. These AFS debt securities are reported at fair value with unrealized gains and losses, net of applicable income taxes, reported in cumulative OCI.
We conduct other-than-temporary impairment (OTTI) analysis on a quarterly basis or more often if a potential loss-triggering event occurs. The initial indicator of OTTI is a decline in fair value below the amortized cost of the debt security.
An AFS debt security that has a decline in the fair value below the security’s amortized cost records OTTI if we (1) have the intent to sell the security, (2) it is more likely than not that we will be required to sell the security before recovery of its amortized cost basis, or (3) we do not expect to recover the entire amortized cost basis of the security.
Estimating recovery of the amortized cost basis of an AFS debt security is based upon an assessment of the cash flows expected to be collected. If the present value of cash flows expected to be collected, discounted at the security’s effective yield, is less than amortized cost, OTTI is considered to have occurred. In performing an assessment of the cash flows

150
Wells Fargo & Company
 


expected to be collected, we consider all relevant information including:
the length of time and the extent to which the fair value has been less than the amortized cost basis;
the historical and implied volatility of the fair value of the security;
the cause of the price decline, such as the general level of interest rates or adverse conditions specifically related to the security, an industry or a geographic area;
the issuer’s financial condition, near-term prospects and ability to service the debt;
the payment structure of the debt security and the likelihood of the issuer being able to make payments that increase in the future;
for asset-backed securities, the credit performance of the underlying collateral, including delinquency rates, level of non-performing assets, cumulative losses to date, collateral value and the remaining credit enhancement compared with expected credit losses;
any change in rating agencies’ credit ratings at evaluation date from acquisition date and any likely imminent action;
independent analyst reports and forecasts, sector credit ratings and other independent market data; and
recoveries or additional declines in fair value subsequent to the balance sheet date.
 
If we intend to sell the security, or if it is more likely than not we will be required to sell the security before recovery of amortized cost basis, an OTTI write-down is recognized in earnings equal to the entire difference between the amortized cost basis and fair value of the security. For debt security that is considered other-than-temporarily impaired that we do not intend to sell or it is more likely than not that we will not be required to sell before recovery, the OTTI write-down is separated into an amount representing the credit loss, which is recognized in earnings, and the amount related to all other factors, which is recognized in OCI. The measurement of the credit loss component is equal to the difference between the debt security’s amortized cost basis and the present value of its expected future cash flows discounted at the security’s effective yield. The remaining difference between the security’s fair value and the present value of expected future cash flows is due to all other factors. We believe that we will fully collect the carrying value of securities on which we have recorded a non-credit-related impairment in OCI.
Following the recognition of OTTI, the security’s new amortized cost basis is the previous basis minus the OTTI amount recognized in earnings.
We recognize realized gains and losses on the sale of AFS debt securities in net gains (losses) on debt securities using the specific identification method.
Unamortized premiums and discounts are recognized in interest income over the contractual life of the security using the interest method. As principal repayments are received on securities (i.e., primarily mortgage-backed securities (MBS)) a proportionate amount of the related premium or discount is recognized in income so that the effective interest rate on the remaining portion of the security continues unchanged.

HELD-TO-MATURITY DEBT SECURITIES Debt securities for which the Company has the positive intent and ability to hold to maturity are classified as held-to-maturity (HTM). These HTM debt securities are reported at historical cost adjusted for amortization of premiums and accretion of discounts. We recognize OTTI when there is a decline in fair value and we do
 
not expect to recover the entire amortized cost basis of the debt security. The amortized cost is written-down to fair value with the credit loss component recorded to earnings and the remaining component recognized in OCI. The OTTI assessment related to intent to sell, required to sell, whether we expect recovery of the amortized cost basis and determination of any credit loss component recognized in earnings for HTM debt securities is the same as described for AFS debt securities. AFS debt securities transferred to the HTM classification are recorded at fair value and the unrealized gains or losses resulting from the transfer of these securities continue to be reported in cumulative OCI. The unamortized OCI balance is amortized into earnings over the remaining life of the security using the effective interest method. The HTM amortized cost basis used in the OTTI analysis includes the unamortized OCI balances related to previous security transfers .
 
Securities Purchased and Sold Agreements
Securities purchased under resale agreements and securities sold under repurchase agreements are accounted for as collateralized financing transactions and are recorded at the acquisition or sale price plus accrued interest. We monitor the fair value of securities purchased and sold and obtain collateral from or return it to counterparties when appropriate. These financing transactions do not create material credit risk given the collateral provided and the related monitoring process.

Mortgage Loans and Loans Held for Sale
Mortgage loans held for sale (MLHFS) include commercial and residential mortgages originated for sale and securitization in the secondary market, which is our principal market, or for sale as whole loans. We have elected the fair value option for substantially all residential MLHFS (see Note 18 (Fair Values of Assets and Liabilities)). The remaining residential MLHFS are held at the lower of cost or fair value (LOCOM) and are valued on an aggregate portfolio basis. Commercial MLHFS are held at LOCOM and are valued on an individual loan basis.
Loans held for sale (LHFS) includes commercial loans originated for sale in the secondary market and loans used in market-making activities in our trading business. The loans held for trading purposes are carried at fair value, with the remainder of LHFS recorded at LOCOM.
Gains and losses on MLHFS are recorded in mortgage banking noninterest income. Gains and losses on LHFS used in trading activities are recognized in net gains from trading activities, with gains and losses on LHFS not used in trading activities recognized in other noninterest income. Direct loan origination costs and fees for MLHFS and LHFS under the fair value option are recognized in income at origination. For MLHFS and LHFS recorded at LOCOM, loan costs and fees are deferred at origination and are recognized in income at time of sale. Interest income on MLHFS and LHFS is calculated based upon the note rate of the loan and is recorded in interest income.
Our lines of business are authorized to originate held-for-investment loans that meet or exceed established loan product profitability criteria, including minimum positive net interest margin spreads in excess of funding costs. When a determination is made at the time of commitment to originate loans as held for investment, it is our intent to hold these loans to maturity or for the “foreseeable future,” subject to periodic review under our management evaluation processes, including corporate asset/liability management. In determining the “foreseeable future” for loans, management considers (1) the current economic environment and market conditions, (2) our business strategy and current business plans, (3) the nature and

 
Wells Fargo & Company
151


Note 1: Summary of Significant Accounting Policies (continued)

type of the loan receivable, including its expected life, and (4) our current financial condition and liquidity demands. If subsequent changes, including changes in interest rates, significantly impact the ongoing profitability of certain loan products, we may subsequently change our intent to hold these loans, and we would take actions to sell such loans. Upon such management determination, we immediately transfer these loans to the MLHFS or LHFS portfolio at LOCOM.

Loans
Loans are reported at their outstanding principal balances net of any unearned income, cumulative charge-offs, unamortized deferred fees and costs on originated loans and unamortized premiums or discounts on purchased loans. PCI loans are reported net of any remaining purchase accounting adjustments. See the “Purchased Credit-Impaired Loans” section in this Note for our accounting policy for PCI loans.
Unearned income, deferred fees and costs, and discounts and premiums are amortized to interest income over the contractual life of the loan using the interest method. Loan commitment fees are generally deferred and amortized into noninterest income on a straight-line basis over the commitment period.
We have certain private label and co-brand credit card loans through a program agreement that involves our active participation in the operating activity of the program with a third party. We share in the economic results of the loans subject to this agreement. We consider the program to be a collaborative arrangement and therefore report our share of revenue and losses on a net basis in interest income for loans, other noninterest income and provision for credit losses as applicable. Our net share of revenue from this activity represented less than 1% of our total revenues for 2018 .
Loans also include direct financing leases that are recorded at the aggregate of minimum lease payments receivable plus the estimated residual value of the leased property, less unearned income. Leveraged leases, which are a form of direct financing leases, are recorded net of related non-recourse debt. Leasing income is recognized as a constant percentage of outstanding lease financing balances over the lease terms in interest income.

NONACCRUAL AND PAST DUE LOANS We generally place loans on nonaccrual status when:
the full and timely collection of interest or principal becomes uncertain (generally based on an assessment of the borrower’s financial condition and the adequacy of collateral, if any), such as in bankruptcy or other circumstances;
they are 90 days ( 120 days with respect to real estate 1-4 family first and junior lien mortgages) past due for interest or principal, unless both well-secured and in the process of collection;
part of the principal balance has been charged off, except for credit card loans, which are generally not placed on nonaccrual status, but are generally fully charged off when the loan reaches 180 days past due; or
for junior lien mortgages, we have evidence that the related first lien mortgage may be 120 days past due or in the process of foreclosure regardless of the junior lien delinquency status.
 
PCI loans are written down at acquisition to fair value using an estimate of cash flows deemed to be collectible and an accretable yield is established. Accordingly, such loans are not classified as nonaccrual because they continue to earn interest
 
from accretable yield, independent of performance in accordance of their contractual terms, and we expect to fully collect the new carrying values of such loans (that is, the new cost basis arising out of purchase accounting).
When we place a loan on nonaccrual status, we reverse the accrued unpaid interest receivable against interest income and suspend amortization of any net deferred fees. If the ultimate collectability of the recorded loan balance is in doubt on a nonaccrual loan, the cost recovery method is used and cash collected is applied to first reduce the carrying value of the loan. Otherwise, interest income may be recognized to the extent cash is received. Generally, we return a loan to accrual status when all delinquent interest and principal become current under the terms of the loan agreement and collectability of remaining principal and interest is no longer doubtful.
We typically re-underwrite modified loans at the time of a restructuring to determine if there is sufficient evidence of sustained repayment capacity based on the borrower’s financial strength, including documented income, debt to income ratios and other factors. If the borrower has demonstrated performance under the previous terms and the underwriting process shows the capacity to continue to perform under the restructured terms, the loan will generally remain in accruing status. When a loan classified as a troubled debt restructuring (TDR) performs in accordance with its modified terms, the loan either continues to accrue interest (for performing loans) or will return to accrual status after the borrower demonstrates a sustained period of performance (generally six consecutive months of payments, or equivalent, inclusive of consecutive payments made prior to the modification). Loans will be placed on nonaccrual status and a corresponding charge-off is recorded if we believe it is probable that principal and interest contractually due under the modified terms of the agreement will not be collectible.
Our loans are considered past due when contractually required principal or interest payments have not been made on the due dates.
 
LOAN CHARGE-OFF POLICIES For commercial loans, we generally fully charge off or charge down to net realizable value (fair value of collateral, less estimated costs to sell) for loans secured by collateral when:
management judges the loan to be uncollectible;
repayment is deemed to be protracted beyond reasonable time frames;
the loan has been classified as a loss by either our internal loan review process or our banking regulatory agencies;
the customer has filed bankruptcy and the loss becomes evident owing to a lack of assets; or
the loan is 180 days past due unless both well-secured and in the process of collection.
 
For consumer loans, we fully charge off or charge down to net realizable value when deemed uncollectible due to bankruptcy or other factors, or no later than reaching a defined number of days past due, as follows:
1-4 family first and junior lien mortgages – We generally charge down to net realizable value when the loan is 180 days past due.
Automobile loans – We generally fully charge off when the loan is 120 days past due.
Credit card loans – We generally fully charge off when the loan is 180 days past due.
Unsecured loans (closed end) – We generally fully charge off when the loan is 120 days past due.

152
Wells Fargo & Company
 


Unsecured loans (open end) – We generally fully charge off when the loan is 180 days past due.
Other secured loans – We generally fully or partially charge down to net realizable value when the loan is 120 days past due.
 
IMPAIRED LOANS We consider a loan to be impaired when, based on current information and events, we determine that we will not be able to collect all amounts due according to the loan contract, including scheduled interest payments. This evaluation is generally based on delinquency information, an assessment of the borrower’s financial condition and the adequacy of collateral, if any. Our impaired loans predominantly include loans on nonaccrual status in the commercial portfolio segment and loans modified in a TDR, whether on accrual or nonaccrual status.
When we identify a loan as impaired, we generally measure the impairment, if any, based on the difference between the recorded investment in the loan (net of previous charge-offs, deferred loan fees or costs and unamortized premium or discount) and the present value of expected future cash flows, discounted at the loan’s effective interest rate. When the value of an impaired loan is calculated by discounting expected cash flows, interest income is recognized using the loan’s effective interest rate over the remaining life of the loan. When collateral is the sole source of repayment for the impaired loan, rather than the borrower’s income or other sources of repayment, we charge down to net realizable value.
 
TROUBLED DEBT RESTRUCTURINGS In situations where, for economic or legal reasons related to a borrower’s financial difficulties, we grant a concession for other than an insignificant period of time to the borrower that we would not otherwise consider, the related loan is classified as a TDR. These modified terms may include rate reductions, principal forgiveness, term extensions, payment forbearance and other actions intended to minimize our economic loss and to avoid foreclosure or repossession of the collateral, if applicable. For modifications where we forgive principal, the entire amount of such principal forgiveness is immediately charged off. Loans classified as TDRs, including loans in trial payment periods (trial modifications), are considered impaired loans. Other than resolutions such as foreclosures, sales and transfers to held-for-sale, we may remove loans held for investment from TDR classification, but only if they have been refinanced or restructured at market terms and qualify as a new loan.

PURCHASED CREDIT-IMPAIRED LOANS Loans acquired with evidence of credit deterioration since their origination and where it is probable that we will not collect all contractually required principal and interest payments are PCI loans. PCI loans are recorded at fair value at the date of acquisition, and the historical allowance for credit losses related to these loans is not carried over. Fair value at date of acquisition is generally determined using a discounted cash flow method and any excess cash flow expected to be collected over the carrying value (estimated fair value at acquisition date) is referred to as the accretable yield and is recognized in interest income using an effective yield method over the remaining life of the loan, or pool of loans if aggregated based on common risk characteristics. The difference between contractually required payments and the cash flows expected to be collected at acquisition, considering the impact of prepayments, is referred to as the nonaccretable difference. Based on quarterly evaluations of remaining cash flows expected to be collected, expected decreases may result in recording a provision for loss and expected increases may result
 
in a prospective yield adjustment after first reversing any allowance for losses related to the loan, or pool of loans.
Resolutions of loans may include sales of loans to third parties, receipt of payments in settlement with the borrower, or foreclosure of the collateral. For individual PCI loans, gains or losses on sales to third parties are included in other noninterest income, and gains or losses as a result of a settlement with the borrower are included in interest income. Our policy is to remove an individual loan from a pool based on comparing the amount received from its resolution with its contractual amount. Any difference between these amounts is absorbed by the nonaccretable difference for the entire pool, which assumes that the amount received from resolution approximates pool performance expectations. Any material change in remaining effective yield caused by this removal method is addressed by our quarterly cash flow evaluation process for each
pool. We may also sell groups of loans from a pool and include any gains or losses on sales to third parties in other noninterest income. Any difference between the amount received from the buyer and the contractual amount due from the customer is absorbed by the nonaccretable difference for the entire pool. We maintain the effective yield for the remaining loans in the pool consistent with the yield immediately prior to the sale.
Modified PCI loans are not removed from a pool even if those loans would otherwise be deemed TDRs. Modified PCI loans that are accounted for individually are considered TDRs and removed from PCI accounting if there has been a concession granted in excess of the original nonaccretable difference. We include these TDRs in our impaired loans.
 
FORECLOSED ASSETS   Foreclosed assets obtained through our lending activities primarily include real estate. Generally, loans have been written down to their net realizable value prior to foreclosure. Any further reduction to their net realizable value is recorded with a charge to the allowance for credit losses at foreclosure. We allow up to 90 days after foreclosure to finalize determination of net realizable value. Thereafter, changes in net realizable value are recorded to noninterest expense. The net realizable value of these assets is reviewed and updated periodically depending on the type of property. Certain government-guaranteed mortgage loans upon foreclosure are included in accounts receivable, not foreclosed assets. These receivables were loans predominantly insured by the FHA or guaranteed by the VA and are measured based on the balance expected to be recovered from the FHA or VA.
 
ALLOWANCE FOR CREDIT LOSSES (ACL) The allowance for credit losses is management’s estimate of credit losses inherent in the loan portfolio, including unfunded credit commitments, at the balance sheet date. We have an established process to determine the appropriateness of the allowance for credit losses that assesses the losses inherent in our portfolio and related unfunded credit commitments. We develop and document our allowance methodology at the portfolio segment level commercial loan portfolio and consumer loan portfolio. While we attribute portions of the allowance to our respective commercial and consumer portfolio segments, the entire allowance is available to absorb credit losses inherent in the total loan portfolio and unfunded credit commitments.
Our process involves procedures to appropriately consider the unique risk characteristics of our commercial and consumer loan portfolio segments. For each portfolio segment, losses are estimated collectively for groups of loans with similar characteristics, individually or pooled for impaired loans or, for

 
Wells Fargo & Company
153


Note 1: Summary of Significant Accounting Policies (continued)

PCI loans, based on the changes in cash flows expected to be collected.
Our allowance levels are influenced by loan volumes, loan grade migration or delinquency status, historic loss experience and other conditions influencing loss expectations, such as economic conditions. 

COMMERCIAL PORTFOLIO SEGMENT ACL METHODOLOGY Generally, commercial loans are assessed for estimated losses by grading each loan using various risk factors as identified through periodic reviews. Our estimation approach for the commercial portfolio reflects the estimated probability of default in accordance with the borrower’s financial strength and the severity of loss in the event of default, considering the quality of any underlying collateral. Probability of default and severity at the time of default are statistically derived through historical observations of default and losses after default within each credit risk rating. These estimates are adjusted as appropriate based on additional analysis of long-term average loss experience compared to previously forecasted losses, external loss data or other risks identified from current economic conditions and credit quality trends. The estimated probability of default and severity at the time of default are applied to loan equivalent exposures to estimate losses for unfunded credit commitments.
The allowance also includes an amount for the estimated impairment on nonaccrual commercial loans and commercial loans modified in a TDR, whether on accrual or nonaccrual status.
 
CONSUMER PORTFOLIO SEGMENT ACL METHODOLOGY For consumer loans that are not identified as a TDR, we generally determine the allowance on a collective basis utilizing forecasted losses to represent our best estimate of inherent loss. We pool loans, generally by product types with similar risk characteristics, such as residential real estate mortgages and credit cards. As appropriate and to achieve greater accuracy, we may further stratify selected portfolios by sub-product, origination channel, vintage, loss type, geographic location and other predictive characteristics. Models designed for each pool are utilized to develop the loss estimates. We use assumptions for these pools in our forecast models, such as historic delinquency and default, loss severity, home price trends, unemployment trends, and other key economic variables that may influence the frequency and severity of losses in the pool.
In determining the appropriate allowance attributable to our residential mortgage portfolio, we take into consideration portfolios determined to be at elevated risk, such as junior lien mortgages behind delinquent first lien mortgages and junior lien lines of credit subject to near term significant payment increases. We incorporate the default rates and severity of loss for these higher risk portfolios, including the impact of our established loan modification programs. Accordingly, the loss content associated with the effects of loan modifications and higher risk portfolios has been captured in our ACL methodology.
We separately estimate impairment for consumer loans that have been modified in a TDR (including trial modifications), whether on accrual or nonaccrual status.
 
OTHER ACL MATTERS   The allowance for credit losses for both portfolio segments includes an amount for imprecision or uncertainty that may change from period to period. This amount represents management’s judgment of risks inherent in the processes and assumptions used in establishing the allowance. This imprecision considers economic environmental factors,
 
modeling assumptions and performance, process risk, and other subjective factors, including industry trends and emerging risk assessments.

Securitizations and Beneficial Interests
In certain asset securitization transactions that meet the applicable criteria to be accounted for as a sale, assets are sold to an entity referred to as a Special Purpose Entity (SPE), which then issues beneficial interests in the form of senior and subordinated interests collateralized by the assets. In some cases, we may retain beneficial interests issued by the entity. Additionally, from time to time, we may also re-securitize certain assets in a new securitization transaction.
The assets and liabilities transferred to an SPE are excluded from our consolidated balance sheet if the transfer qualifies as a sale and we are not required to consolidate the SPE.
For transfers of financial assets recorded as sales, we recognize and initially measure at fair value all assets obtained (including beneficial interests) and liabilities incurred. We record a gain or loss in noninterest income for the difference between the carrying amount and the fair value of the assets sold. Fair values are based on quoted market prices, quoted market prices for similar assets, or if market prices are not available, then the fair value is estimated using discounted cash flow analyses with assumptions for credit losses, prepayments and discount rates that are corroborated by and verified against market observable data, where possible. Interests retained from and liabilities incurred in securitizations with off-balance sheet entities i nclude debt and equity securities , loans, MSRs, derivative assets and liabilities, other assets, other liabilities, such as liabilities for mortgage repurchase losses or long-term debt and are accounted for as described within this Note.
 
Mortgage Servicing Rights (MSRs)
We recognize the rights to service mortgage loans for others, or MSRs, as assets whether we purchase the MSRs or the MSRs result from a sale or securitization of loans we originate (asset transfers). We initially record all of our MSRs at fair value. Subsequently, residential loan MSRs are carried at fair value. All of our MSRs related to our commercial mortgage loans are subsequently measured at LOCOM. The valuation and sensitivity of MSRs is discussed further in Note 9 (Securitizations and Variable Interest Entities), Note 10 (Mortgage Banking Activities) and Note 18 (Fair Values of Assets and Liabilities).
For MSRs carried at fair value, changes in fair value are reported in mortgage banking noninterest income in the period in which the change occurs. MSRs subsequently measured at LOCOM are amortized in proportion to, and over the period of, estimated net servicing income. The amortization of MSRs is reported in mortgage banking noninterest income, analyzed monthly and adjusted to reflect changes in prepayment speeds, as well as other factors.
MSRs accounted for at LOCOM are periodically evaluated for impairment based on the fair value of those assets. For purposes of impairment evaluation and measurement, we stratify MSRs based on the predominant risk characteristics of the underlying loans, including investor and product type. If, by individual stratum, the carrying amount of these MSRs exceeds fair value, a valuation allowance is established. The valuation allowance is adjusted as the fair value changes.
 
Premises and Equipment
Premises and equipment are carried at cost less accumulated depreciation and amortization. Capital leases, where we are the

154
Wells Fargo & Company
 


lessee, are included in premises and equipment at the capitalized amount less accumulated amortization.
We primarily use the straight-line method of depreciation and amortization. Estimated useful lives range up to 40 years for buildings, up to 10 years for furniture and equipment, and the shorter of the estimated useful life (up to 8 years ) or the lease term for leasehold improvements. We amortize capitalized leased assets on a straight-line basis over the lives of the respective leases.
 
Goodwill and Identifiable Intangible Assets
Goodwill is recorded in business combinations under the purchase method of accounting when the purchase price is higher than the fair value of net assets, including identifiable intangible assets.
We assess goodwill for impairment at a reporting unit level on an annual basis or more frequently in certain circumstances. We have determined that our reporting units are one level below the operating segments and distinguish these reporting units based on how the segments and reporting units are managed, taking into consideration the economic characteristics, nature of the products, and customers of the segments and reporting units. At the time we acquire a business, we allocate goodwill to applicable reporting units based on their relative fair value, and if we have a significant business reorganization, we may reallocate the goodwill. If we sell a business, a portion of goodwill is included with the carrying amount of the divested business.
We have the option of performing a qualitative assessment of goodwill. We may also elect to bypass the qualitative test and proceed directly to a quantitative test. If we perform a qualitative assessment of goodwill to test for impairment and conclude it is more likely than not that a reporting unit’s fair value is greater than its carrying amount, quantitative tests are not required. However, if we determine it is more likely than not that a reporting unit’s fair value is less than its carrying amount, then we complete a quantitative assessment to determine if there is goodwill impairment. We apply various quantitative valuation methodologies, including discounted cash flow and earnings multiple approaches, to determine the estimated fair value, which is compared to the carrying value of each reporting unit. If the fair value is less than the carrying amount, an additional test is required to measure the amount of impairment. We recognize impairment losses as a charge to other noninterest expense (unless related to discontinued operations) and an adjustment to the carrying value of the goodwill asset. Subsequent reversals of goodwill impairment are prohibited.
We amortize core deposit and other customer relationship intangibles on an accelerated basis over useful lives not exceeding 10 years. We review such intangibles for impairment whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate that their carrying amounts may not be recoverable. Impairment is indicated if the sum of undiscounted estimated future net cash flows is less than the carrying value of the asset. Impairment is permanently recognized by writing down the asset to the extent that the carrying value exceeds the estimated fair value.

Derivatives and Hedging Activities
DERIVATIVES We recognize all derivatives on the balance sheet at fair value. On the date we enter into a derivative contract, we designate the derivative as (1) qualifying for hedge accounting in a hedge of the fair value of a recognized asset or liability or an unrecognized firm commitment, including hedges of foreign currency exposure (“fair value hedge”), (2) qualifying for hedge accounting in a hedge of a forecasted transaction or of
 
the variability of cash flows to be received or paid related to a recognized asset or liability (“cash flow hedge”), or (3) held for customer accommodation trading or asset/liability risk management or other purposes, including economic hedges not qualifying for hedge accounting. For derivatives not designated as a fair value or cash flow hedge, we report changes in the fair values in current period noninterest income. For additional information on derivative assets and liabilities used in our trading business, see Note 4 (Trading Activities).

DOCUMENTATION AND EFFECTIVENESS ASSESSMENT FOR ACCOUNTING HEDGES For fair value and cash flow hedges qualifying for hedge accounting, we formally document at inception the relationship between hedging instruments and hedged items, our risk management objective, strategy and our evaluation of effectiveness for our hedge transactions. This process includes linking all derivatives designated as fair value or cash flow hedges to specific assets and liabilities on the balance sheet or to specific forecasted transactions. We assess hedge effectiveness using regression analysis, both at inception of the hedging relationship and on an ongoing basis. For fair value hedges, the regression analysis involves regressing the periodic change in fair value of the hedging instrument against the periodic changes in fair value of the asset or liability being hedged due to changes in the hedged risk(s). For cash flow hedges, the regression analysis involves regressing the periodic changes in fair value of the hedging instrument against the periodic changes in fair value of the hypothetical derivative. The hypothetical derivative has terms that identically match and offset the cash flows of the forecasted transaction being hedged due to changes in the hedged risk(s). The initial assessment for fair value and cash flow hedges includes an evaluation of the quantitative measures of the regression results used to validate the conclusion of high effectiveness. Periodically, as required, we also formally assess whether the derivative we designated in each hedging relationship is expected to be and has been highly effective in offsetting changes in fair values or cash flows of the hedged item using the regression analysis method.

FAIR VALUE HEDGES For a fair value hedge, we record changes in the fair value of the derivative in current period income, except for certain derivatives in which a portion is recorded to OCI. We record basis adjustments to the amortized cost of the hedged asset or liability due to the changes in fair value related to the hedged risk with the offset recorded in current period net income. We present derivative gains or losses in the same income statement category as the hedged asset or liability, as follows:
For fair value hedges of interest rate risk, amounts are reflected in net interest income;
For hedges of foreign currency risk, amounts representing the fair value changes less the accrual for periodic cash flow settlements are reflected in noninterest income. The periodic cash flow settlements are reflected in net interest income;
For hedges of both interest rate risk and foreign currency risk, amounts representing the fair value change less the accrual for periodic cash flow settlements is attributed to both net interest income and noninterest income. The periodic cash flow settlements are reflected in net interest income.

The entire derivative gain or loss is included in the assessment of hedge effectiveness for all fair value hedge relationships, except for hedges of foreign-currency

 
Wells Fargo & Company
155


Note 1: Summary of Significant Accounting Policies (continued)

denominated available-for-sale debt securities and long-term debt liabilities, as follows:
When hedged with cross-currency swaps, the change in fair value of the derivative attributable to cross-currency basis spread changes component is excluded from the assessment of hedge effectiveness. The initial fair value of the excluded component is amortized to net interest income. For these hedges, the difference between changes in fair value of the excluded component and the amount recorded in earnings is recorded in OCI;
When hedged with foreign currency forward derivatives, the change in fair value of the derivative attributable to the time value component related to the changes in the difference between the spot and forward price is excluded from the assessment of hedge effectiveness. For these hedges, the changes in fair value of the excluded component are recorded in net interest income.

CASH FLOW HEDGES For a cash flow hedge, we record changes in the fair value of the derivative in OCI. We subsequently reclassify gains and losses from these changes in fair value from OCI to net income in the same period(s) that the hedged transaction affects net income and in the same income statement category as the hedged item, thus to net interest income. The entire gain or loss on these derivatives is included in the assessment of hedge effectiveness.

DISCONTINUING HEDGE ACCOUNTING We discontinue hedge accounting prospectively when (1) a derivative is no longer highly effective in offsetting changes in the fair value or cash flows of a hedged item, (2) a derivative expires or is sold, terminated or exercised, (3) we elect to discontinue the designation of a derivative as a hedge, or (4) in a cash flow hedge, a derivative is de-designated because it is no longer probable that a forecasted transaction will occur.
When we discontinue fair value hedge accounting, we no longer adjust the previously hedged asset or liability for changes in fair value, and remaining cumulative adjustments to the hedged item and accumulated amounts reported in OCI are accounted for in the same manner as other components of the carrying amount of the asset or liability. If the hedged item is derecognized, the accumulated amounts reported in OCI are immediately reclassified to net income . If the derivative continues to be held after fair value hedge accounting ceases, we carry the derivative on the balance sheet at its fair value with changes in fair value included in noninterest income.
When we discontinue cash flow hedge accounting and it is probable that the forecasted transaction will occur, the accumulated amount reported in OCI at the de-designation date continues to be reported in OCI until the forecasted transaction affects net income at which point the related OCI amount is reclassified to net income. If cash flow hedge accounting is discontinued and it is probable the forecasted transaction will no longer occur, the accumulated gains and losses reported in OCI at the de-designation date is immediately reclassified to net income. If the derivative continues to be held after cash flow hedge accounting ceases, we carry the derivative on the balance sheet at its fair value with changes in fair value included in noninterest income.

EMBEDDED DERIVATIVES We may purchase or originate financial instruments that contain an embedded derivative. At inception of the financial instrument, we assess (1) if the economic characteristics of the embedded derivative are not clearly and closely related to the economic characteristics of the
 
financial instrument (host contract), (2) if the financial instrument that embodies both the embedded derivative and the host contract is not measured at fair value with changes in fair value reported in net income, and (3) if a separate instrument with the same terms as the embedded instrument would meet the definition of a derivative. If the embedded derivative meets all of these conditions, we separate it from the host contract by recording the bifurcated derivative at fair value and the remaining host contract at the difference between the basis of the hybrid instrument and the fair value of the bifurcated derivative. The bifurcated derivative is carried at fair value with changes recorded in current period noninterest income.

COUNTERPARTY CREDIT RISK AND NETTING By using derivatives, we are exposed to counterparty credit risk, which is the risk that counterparties to the derivative contracts do not perform as expected. If a counterparty fails to perform, our counterparty credit risk is equal to the amount reported as a derivative asset on our balance sheet. The amounts reported as a derivative asset are derivative contracts in a gain position, and to the extent subject to legally enforceable master netting arrangements, net of derivatives in a loss position with the same counterparty and cash collateral received. We minimize counterparty credit risk through credit approvals, limits, monitoring procedures, executing master netting arrangements and obtaining collateral, where appropriate. Counterparty credit risk related to derivatives is considered in determining fair value and our assessment of hedge effectiveness. To the extent derivatives subject to master netting arrangements meet the applicable requirements, including determining the legal enforceability of the arrangement, it is our policy to present derivative balances and related cash collateral amounts net on the balance sheet. In the second quarter of 2017, we adopted Settlement to Market treatment for the cash collateralizing our interest rate derivative contracts with certain centrally cleared counterparties. As a result of this adoption, derivative balances with these counterparties are considered settled by the collateral.
For additional information on our derivatives and hedging activities, see Note 17 (Derivatives).

Equity Securities
Marketable equity securities have readily determinable fair values and include, but are not limited to securities used in our trading activities. Marketable equity securities are recorded at fair value with unrealized gains and losses, due to changes in fair value, reflected in earnings. Unrealized gains and losses are recognized in net gains from trading activities for equity securities related to our trading activities and net gains from equity securities for the remaining securities. Realized gains and losses are recognized in net gains from trading activities for equity securities related to our trading activities and net gains from equity securities for the remaining securities. Interest and dividend income from marketable equity securities is recognized in interest income.
N onmarketable equity securities do not have readily determinable fair values , and do not include investments for which we hold a controlling interest in the investee. These securities are accounted for under one of the following accounting methods:
Fair Value: This method is an election. The securities are recorded at fair value with unrealized gains or losses reflected in earnings;
Equity Method: We use this method when we have the ability to exert significant influence over the investee . These

156
Wells Fargo & Company
 


securities are carried at cost and adjusted for our share of the investee’s earnings or losses , less any impairments;
Cost Method: This method is required for specific securities, such as Federal Reserve Bank stock and Federal Home Loan Bank stock . These investments are held at their cost minus impairment. If impaired, the carrying value is written down to the fair value of the security;
Measurement Alternative: This method is followed by all remaining nonmarketable equity securities . These securities are carried at cost less impairment, and adjusted up or down to fair value upon the occurrence of orderly observable transactions of the same or similar security of the same issuer.

Our review for impairment for equity method, cost method and measurement alternative securities typically includes an analysis of the facts and circumstances of each security, the intent or requirement to sell the security, the expectations of cash flows, capital needs and the viability of its business model. For equity method and cost method investments, we reduce the asset’s carrying value when we consider declines in value to be other than temporary. For securities accounted for under the measurement alternative, we reduce the asset value when the fair value is less than carrying value, without the consideration of recovery. We recognize all estimated impairment losses as an unrealized loss recorded in net gains on equity securities.
Realized gains and losses on the sale of nonmarketable equity securities are recognized in net gains on equity securities.

Operating Lease Assets
Operating lease rental income for leased assets is recognized in other income on a straight-line basis over the lease term. Related depreciation expense is recorded on a straight-line basis over the estimated useful life, considering the estimated residual value of the leased asset. The useful life may be adjusted to the term of the lease depending on our plans for the asset after the lease term. On a periodic basis, leased assets are reviewed for impairment. Impairment loss is recognized if the carrying amount of leased assets exceeds fair value and is not recoverable. The carrying amount of leased assets is not recoverable if it exceeds the sum of the undiscounted cash flows expected to result from the lease payments and the estimated residual value upon the eventual disposition of the equipment.

Pension Accounting
We account for our defined benefit pension plans using an actuarial model. Two principal assumptions in determining net periodic pension cost are the discount rate and the expected long-term rate of return on plan assets.
A discount rate is used to estimate the present value of our future pension benefit obligations. We use a consistent methodology to determine the discount rate using a yield curve with maturity dates that closely match the estimated timing of the expected benefit payments for our plans. The yield curve is derived from a broad-based universe of high quality corporate bonds as of the measurement date.
Our determination of the reasonableness of our expected long-term rate of return on plan assets is highly quantitative by nature. We evaluate the current asset allocations and expected returns under two sets of conditions: (1) projected returns using several forward-looking capital market assumptions, and (2) historical returns for the main asset classes dating back to 1970 or the earliest period for which historical data was readily available for the asset classes included. Using long-term historical data allows us to capture multiple economic
 
environments, which we believe is relevant when using historical returns. We place greater emphasis on the forward-looking return and risk assumptions than on historical results. We use the resulting projections to derive a base line expected rate of return and risk level for the Cash Balance Plan’s prescribed asset mix. We evaluate the portfolio based on: (1) the established target asset allocations over short term ( one -year) and longer term ( ten -year) investment horizons, and (2) the range of potential outcomes over these horizons within specific standard deviations. We perform the above analyses to assess the reasonableness of our expected long-term rate of return on plan assets. We consider the expected rate of return to be a long-term average view of expected returns.
At year end, we re-measure our defined benefit plan liabilities and related plan assets and recognize any resulting actuarial gain or loss in other comprehensive income. We generally amortize net actuarial gain or loss in excess of a 5% corridor from accumulated OCI into net periodic pension cost over the estimated average remaining participation period, which at December 31, 2018 , is 19 years . See Note 22 (Employee Benefits and Other Expenses) for additional information on our pension accounting.

Income Taxes
We file consolidated and separate company U.S. federal income tax returns, foreign tax returns and various combined and separate company state tax returns.
We evaluate two components of income tax expense: current and deferred income tax expense. Current income tax expense represents our estimated taxes to be paid or refunded for the current period and includes income tax expense related to our uncertain tax positions. Deferred income tax expense results from changes in deferred tax assets and liabilities between periods. We determine deferred income taxes using the balance sheet method. Under this method, the net deferred tax asset or liability is based on the tax effects of the differences between the book and tax bases of assets and liabilities, and recognizes enacted changes in tax rates and laws in the period in which they occur. Deferred tax assets are recognized subject to management’s judgment that realization is “more likely than not.” Uncertain tax positions that meet the more likely than not recognition threshold are measured to determine the amount of benefit to recognize. An uncertain tax position is measured at the largest amount of benefit that management believes has a greater than 50% likelihood of realization upon settlement. Tax benefits not meeting our realization criteria represent unrecognized tax benefits. We account for interest and penalties as a component of income tax expense. In 2018, we finalized the recognition of the U.S. tax expense associated with a deemed repatriation of undistributed earnings of certain non-U.S. subsidiaries as required under the 2017 Tax Act. We do not intend to distribute these earnings in a taxable manner, and therefore intend to limit distributions to foreign earnings previously taxed in the U.S., that would qualify for the 100% dividends received deduction, and that would not result in any significant state or foreign taxes. All other undistributed foreign earnings will continue to be permanently reinvested outside the U.S.
See Note 23 (Income Taxes) to Financial Statements in this Report for a further description of our provision for income taxes and related income tax assets and liabilities.

Stock-Based Compensation
We have stock-based employee compensation plans as more fully discussed in Note 20 (Common Stock and Stock Plans). Our

 
Wells Fargo & Company
157


Note 1: Summary of Significant Accounting Policies (continued)

Long-Term Incentive Compensation Plan provides for awards of incentive and nonqualified stock options, stock appreciation rights, restricted shares, restricted share rights (RSRs), performance share awards (PSAs) and stock awards without restrictions. For most awards, we measure the cost of employee services received in exchange for an award of equity instruments, such as stock options, RSRs or PSAs, based on the fair value of the award on the grant date. The cost is normally recognized in our income statement over the vesting period of the award; awards with graded vesting are expensed on a straight-line method. Awards that continue to vest after retirement are expensed over the shorter of the period of time between the grant date and the final vesting period or between the grant date and when a team member becomes retirement eligible; awards to team members who are retirement eligible at the grant date are subject to immediate expensing upon grant.
Beginning in 2013, certain RSRs and all PSAs granted include discretionary conditions that can result in forfeiture and are subject to variable accounting. For these awards, the associated compensation expense fluctuates with changes in our stock price. For PSAs, compensation expense also fluctuates based on the estimated outcome of meeting the performance conditions. 
 
Earnings Per Common Share
We compute earnings per common share by dividing net income (after deducting dividends on preferred stock) by the average number of common shares outstanding during the year. We compute diluted earnings per common share by dividing net income (after deducting dividends on preferred stock) by the average number of common shares outstanding during the year plus the effect of common stock equivalents (for example, stock options, restricted share rights, convertible debentures and warrants) that are dilutive.

Fair Value of Financial Instruments
We use fair value measurements in our fair value disclosures and to record certain assets and liabilities at fair value on a recurring basis, such as instruments used in our trading activities, or on a nonrecurring basis, such as measuring impairment on assets carried at amortized cost. We base our fair values on the price that would be received to sell an asset or paid to transfer a liability in an orderly transaction between market participants at the measurement date. These fair value measurements are based on the exit price notion and are determined by maximizing the use of observable inputs. However, for certain instruments, we must utilize unobservable inputs in determining fair value due to the lack of observable inputs in the market, which requires greater judgment in the measurement of fair value.
In instances where there is limited or no observable market data for the asset or liability, fair value measurements are based on internal models, third-party vendor pricing, broker pricing or a combination of these sources. The valuation models utilize external market information and vendor or broker pricing where available, and consider the economic and competitive environment, the characteristics of the asset or liability, recent prices for products we offer or issue, and other relevant internal and external factors. As with any valuation technique used to estimate fair value, changes in underlying assumptions used, including discount rates and estimates of future cash flows, could significantly affect the results of current or future values. Accordingly, these fair value estimates may not be realized in an actual sale or immediate settlement of the asset or liability.
Our fair value measurements are adjusted, where necessary, to incorporate the lack of market liquidity. Fair value
 
measurements based on vendor or broker prices may reflect exit prices that inherently consider the lack of market liquidity. When the impact of illiquid markets has not already been incorporated in the fair value measurement, we adjust the vendor or broker price using internal models based on discounted cash flows. For certain residential MLHFS and certain securities where the significant inputs have become unobservable due to illiquid markets and vendor or broker pricing is not used, our discounted cash flow model uses a discount rate that reflects what we believe a market participant would require in light of the illiquid market.
Where markets are inactive and transactions are not orderly, transaction or quoted prices for assets or liabilities in inactive markets may require adjustment due to the uncertainty of whether the underlying transactions are orderly. For items that use price quotes in inactive markets, we analyze the degree of market inactivity and distressed transactions to determine the appropriate adjustment to the price quotes.
We continually assess the level and volume of market activity in our debt and equity security classes in determining adjustments, if any, to price quotes. Given market conditions can change over time, our determination of which securities markets are considered active or inactive can change. If we determine a market to be inactive, the degree to which price quotes require adjustment, can also change. See Note 18 (Fair Values of Assets and Liabilities) for discussion of the fair value hierarchy and valuation methodologies applied to financial instruments to determine fair value.
 
Private Share Repurchases
During 2018 and 2017 , we repurchased approximately 94 million shares and approximately 89 million shares of our common stock, respectively, under private forward repurchase contracts and a written repurchase plan pursuant to Rule 10b5-1 of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 that we executed in fourth quarter 2018. We enter into these stock repurchase transactions to complement our open-market common stock repurchase strategies, to allow us to manage our share repurchases in a manner consistent with our capital plans, currently submitted under the Comprehensive Capital Analysis and Review (CCAR), and to provide an economic benefit to the Company.
Our payments to the counterparties for the private forward repurchase contracts are recorded in permanent equity in the quarter paid and are not subject to re-measurement. The classification of the up-front payments as permanent equity assures that we have appropriate repurchase timing consistent with our capital plans, which contemplated a fixed dollar amount available per quarter for share repurchases pursuant to Federal Reserve Board (FRB) supervisory guidance. In return, the counterparty agrees to deliver a variable number of shares based on a per share discount to the volume-weighted average stock price over the contract period. There are no scenarios where the contracts would not either physically settle in shares or allow us to choose the settlement method. Our total number of outstanding shares of common stock is not reduced until settlement of the private forward repurchase contract. We had no unsettled private forward repurchase contracts at December 31, 2018 , or December 31, 2017 .
Under the Rule 10b5-1 repurchase plan, payments and receipt of repurchased shares settle on the same day and the shares repurchased reduce the total number of outstanding shares of common stock upon the settlement of each trade under the plan.


158
Wells Fargo & Company
 


SUPPLEMENTAL CASH FLOW INFORMATION Noncash activities are presented in Table 1.3 , including information on transfers affecting MLHFS and debt securities.

Table 1.3: Supplemental Cash Flow Information
 
Year ended December 31, 
 
(in millions)
2018

 
2017

 
2016

Trading debt securities retained from securitizations of MLHFS
$
37,265

 
52,435

 
72,399

Transfers from loans to MLHFS
5,366

 
5,500

 
6,894

Transfers from available-for-sale debt securities to held-to-maturity debt securities
16,479

 
50,405

 
4,161

Deconsolidation of reverse mortgages previously sold:
 
 
 
 
 
Loans

 

 
3,807

Long-term debt

 

 
3,769


SUBSEQUENT EVENTS We have evaluated the effects of events that have occurred subsequent to December 31, 2018 , and there have been no material events that would require recognition in our 2018 consolidated financial statements or disclosure in the Notes to the consolidated financial statements. On February 7, 2019, we experienced system issues caused by an automatic power shutdown at one of our main data center facilities. This power shutdown was triggered by a smoke alarm that resulted from a steam condition created by routine maintenance activities in the building. Although applications and related workloads were systematically re-routed to back-up data centers throughout the day, certain of our services
 
experienced disruptions that delayed service to our customers. As an example, our online and mobile banking systems and certain ATM functions experienced disruptions for several hours, and certain critical mortgage origination systems experienced disruptions for several days. We are currently assessing these system issues and expect that the Company will incur costs associated with system enhancements that may be necessary to improve the speed of re-routing applications and related workloads to back-up data centers, help ensure that applications are fully operational to the extent an incident occurs, and reduce the likelihood of similar issues occurring in the future.
Note 2:   Business Combinations
We regularly explore opportunities to acquire financial services companies and businesses. Generally, we do not make a public announcement about an acquisition opportunity until a definitive agreement has been signed. For information on additional contingent consideration related to acquisitions,
 
which is considered to be a guarantee, see Note 15 (Guarantees, Pledged Assets and Collateral, and Other Commitments).
Business combinations completed in 2017 and 2016 are presented in Table 2.1. There were no new acquisitions during 2018. As of December 31, 2018 , we had no pending acquisitions.

Table 2.1: Business Combinations Activity
Name of acquisition
 
Location
 
Type of business
 
Date
 
Total assets
(in millions)

2017:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Golden Capital Management, LLC
 
Charlotte, NC
 
Asset Management
 
July 1
 
$
83

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2016:
GE Railcar Services
 
Chicago, IL
 
Railcar and locomotive leasing
 
January 1
 
$
4,339

GE Capital’s Commercial Distribution Finance and Vendor Finance Businesses
 
North America, Asia, Australia / New Zealand and EMEA
 
Specialty Lending
 
March 1, July 1, August 1 & October 1
 
32,531

Analytic Investors, LLC
 
Los Angeles, CA
 
Asset Management
 
October 1
 
106

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$
36,976

During 2018, we completed the sale of Wells Fargo Shareowner Services in February, the sale of the automobile lending business of Reliable Financial Services, Inc. and Reliable Finance Holding Company in August, and the sale of 52  branches in Indiana, Ohio, Michigan and part of Wisconsin in November. Included with the branches sale were approximately $2.0 billion of deposits.




 
Wells Fargo & Company
159


Note 3:   Cash, Loan and Dividend Restrictions
Cash and cash equivalents may be restricted as to usage or withdrawal. Federal Reserve Board (FRB) regulations require that each of our subsidiary banks maintain reserve balances on deposit with the Federal Reserve Banks. Table 3.1 provides a summary of restrictions on cash equivalents in addition to the FRB reserve cash balance requirements.

Table 3.1: Nature of Restrictions on Cash Equivalents
(in millions)
Dec 31,
2018

 
Dec 31,
2017

Average required reserve balance for FRB (1)
$
12,428

 
12,306

Reserve balance for non-U.S. central banks
517

 
617

Segregated for benefit of brokerage customers under federal and other brokerage regulations
1,135

 
666

Related to consolidated variable interest entities (VIEs) that can only be used to settle liabilities of VIEs
147

 
487

(1)
FRB required reserve balance represents average for the years ended December 31, 2018 , and December 31, 2017 .

Federal law restricts the amount and the terms of both credit and non-credit transactions between a bank and its nonbank affiliates. These covered transactions may not exceed 10% of the bank’s capital and surplus (which for this purpose represents Tier 1 and Tier 2 capital, as calculated under the risk-based capital (RBC) guidelines, plus the balance of the allowance for credit losses excluded from Tier 2 capital) with any single nonbank affiliate and 20% of the bank’s capital and surplus with all its nonbank affiliates. Transactions that are extensions of credit may require collateral to be held to provide added security to the bank. For further discussion of RBC, see Note 28 (Regulatory and Agency Capital Requirements) in this Report.
Dividends paid by our subsidiary banks are subject to various federal and state regulatory limitations. Dividends that may be paid by a national bank without the express approval of the Office of the Comptroller of the Currency (OCC) are limited to that bank’s retained net profits for the preceding two calendar years plus retained net profits up to the date of any dividend declaration in the current calendar year. Retained net profits, as defined by the OCC, consist of net income less dividends declared during the period. 
 
We also have a state-chartered subsidiary bank that is subject to state regulations that limit dividends. Under these provisions and regulatory limitations, our national and state-chartered subsidiary banks could have declared additional dividends of $15.2 billion at December 31, 2018 , without obtaining prior regulatory approval. We have elected to retain higher capital at our national and state-chartered subsidiary banks in order to meet internal capital policy minimums and regulatory requirements. Our nonbank subsidiaries are also limited by certain federal and state statutory provisions and regulations covering the amount of dividends that may be paid in any given year. In addition, under a Support Agreement dated June 28, 2017, among Wells Fargo & Company, the parent holding company (the “Parent”), WFC Holdings, LLC, an intermediate holding company and subsidiary of the Parent (the “IHC”), and Wells Fargo Bank, N.A., Wells Fargo Securities, LLC, and Wells Fargo Clearing Services, LLC, each an indirect subsidiary of the Parent, the IHC may be restricted from making dividend payments to the Parent if certain liquidity and/or capital metrics fall below defined triggers. Based on retained earnings at December 31, 2018 , our nonbank subsidiaries could have declared additional dividends of $24.4 billion at December 31, 2018 , without obtaining prior approval.
The FRB’s Capital Plan Rule (codified at 12 CFR 225.8 of Regulation Y) establishes capital planning and prior notice and approval requirements for capital distributions including dividends by certain large bank holding companies. The FRB has also published guidance regarding its supervisory expectations for capital planning, including capital policies regarding the process relating to common stock dividend and repurchase decisions in the FRB’s SR Letter 15-18. The effect of this guidance is to require the approval of the FRB (or specifically under the Capital Plan Rule, a notice of non-objection) for the Company to repurchase or redeem common or perpetual preferred stock as well as to raise the per share quarterly dividend from its current level of $0.45  per share as declared by the Company’s Board of Directors on January 22, 2019 , payable on March 1, 2019 .



160
Wells Fargo & Company
 




Note 4:    Trading Activities

Table 4.1 presents a summary of our trading assets and liabilities measured at fair value through earnings.
 

Table 4.1: Trading Activities and Liabilities
(in millions)
Dec 31,
2018

 
Dec 31,
2017

Trading assets:
 
 
 
Debt securities
$
69,989

 
57,624

Equity securities
19,449

 
30,004

Loans held for sale
1,469

 
1,023

Gross trading derivative assets
29,216

 
31,340

Netting (1)
(19,807
)
 
(19,629
)
Total trading derivative assets
9,409

 
11,711

Total trading assets
100,316

 
100,362

Trading liabilities:
 
 
 
Short sale
19,720

 
18,472

Gross trading derivative liabilities
28,717

 
31,386

Netting (1)
(21,178
)
 
(23,062
)
Total trading derivative liabilities
7,539

 
8,324

Total trading liabilities
$
27,259

 
26,796

(1)
Represents balance sheet netting for trading derivative asset and liability balances, and trading portfolio level counterparty valuation adjustments.
Table 4.2 provides a summary of the net interest income earned from trading securities, and net gains and losses due to
 
the realized and unrealized gains and losses from trading activities.
Table 4.2: Net Interest Income and Net Gains (Losses) on Trading Activities
 
Year ended December 31,
 
(in millions)
2018

 
2017

 
2016

Interest income (1):
 
 
 
 
 
Debt securities
$
2,831

 
2,313

 
2,047

Equity securities
587

 
515

 
383

Loans held for sale
62

 
38

 
29

Total interest income
3,480

 
2,866

 
2,459

Less: Interest expense (2)
587

 
416

 
353

Net interest income
2,893

 
2,450

 
2,106

Net gains (losses) from trading activities:
 
 
 
 
 
Debt securities
(824
)
 
125

 
(444
)
Equity securities
(4,240
)
 
3,394

 
1,213

Loans held for sale
(1
)
 
45

 
55

Derivatives (3)
5,667

 
(3,022
)
 
(214
)
Total net gains from trading activities (4)
602

 
542

 
610

Total trading-related net interest and noninterest income
$
3,495

 
2,992

 
2,716

(1)
Represents interest and dividend income earned on trading securities.
(2)
Represents interest and dividend expense incurred on trading securities we have sold but have not yet purchased.
(3)
Excludes economic hedging of mortgage banking and asset/liability management activities, for which hedge results (realized and unrealized) are reported with the respective hedged activities.
(4)
Represents realized gains (losses) from our trading activities and unrealized gains (losses) due to changes in fair value of our trading positions, attributable to the type of asset or liability.


 
Wells Fargo & Company
161


Note 5:   Available-for-Sale and Held-to Maturity Debt Securities (continued)

Note 5: Available-for-Sale and Held-to-Maturity Debt Securities
Table 5.1 provides the amortized cost and fair value by major categories of available-for-sale debt securities, which are carried at fair value, and held-to-maturity debt securities, which are carried at amortized cost. The net unrealized gains (losses) for
 
available-for-sale debt securities are reported on an after-tax basis as a component of cumulative OCI. Information on debt securities held for trading is included in Note 4 (Trading Activities) to Financial Statements in this Report.

Table 5.1: Amortized Cost and Fair Value
(in millions)
 Amortized Cost

 
Gross unrealized gains 

 
Gross unrealized losses

 
Fair value

December 31, 2018
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Available-for-sale debt securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities of U.S. Treasury and federal agencies
$
13,451

 
3

 
(106
)
 
13,348

Securities of U.S. states and political subdivisions (1)
48,994

 
716

 
(446
)
 
49,264

Mortgage-backed securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Federal agencies
155,974

 
369

 
(3,140
)
 
153,203

Residential
2,638

 
142

 
(5
)
 
2,775

Commercial
4,207

 
40

 
(22
)
 
4,225

Total mortgage-backed securities
162,819

 
551

 
(3,167
)
 
160,203

Corporate debt securities
6,230

 
131

 
(90
)
 
6,271

Collateralized loan and other debt obligations (2) 
35,581

 
158

 
(396
)
 
35,343

Other (3)
5,396

 
100

 
(13
)
 
5,483

Total available-for-sale debt securities
272,471

 
1,659

 
(4,218
)
 
269,912

Held-to-maturity debt securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities of U.S. Treasury and federal agencies
44,751

 
4

 
(415
)
 
44,340

Securities of U.S. states and political subdivisions
6,286

 
30

 
(116
)
 
6,200

Federal agency and other mortgage-backed securities (4)
93,685

 
112

 
(2,288
)
 
91,509

Collateralized loan obligations
66

 

 

 
66

Other (3)

 

 

 

Total held-to-maturity debt securities
144,788

 
146

 
(2,819
)
 
142,115

Total (5)
$
417,259

 
1,805

 
(7,037
)
 
412,027

December 31, 2017
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Available-for-sale debt securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities of U.S. Treasury and federal agencies
$
6,425

 
2

 
(108
)
 
6,319

Securities of U.S. states and political subdivisions (1)
50,733

 
1,032

 
(439
)
 
51,326

Mortgage-backed securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Federal agencies
160,561

 
930

 
(1,272
)
 
160,219

Residential
4,356

 
254

 
(2
)
 
4,608

Commercial
4,487

 
80

 
(2
)
 
4,565

Total mortgage-backed securities
169,404


1,264

 
(1,276
)
 
169,392

Corporate debt securities
7,343

 
363

 
(40
)
 
7,666

Collateralized loan and other debt obligations (2)
35,675

 
384

 
(3
)
 
36,056

Other (3)
5,516

 
137

 
(5
)
 
5,648

Total available-for-sale debt securities
275,096

 
3,182

 
(1,871
)
 
276,407

Held-to-maturity debt securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities of U.S. Treasury and federal agencies
44,720

 
189

 
(103
)
 
44,806

Securities of U.S. states and political subdivisions
6,313

 
84

 
(43
)
 
6,354

Federal agency and other mortgage-backed securities (4)
87,527

 
201

 
(682
)
 
87,046

Collateralized loan obligations
661

 
4

 

 
665

Other (3) 
114

 

 

 
114

Total held-to-maturity debt securities
139,335

 
478

 
(828
)
 
138,985

Total (5)
$
414,431

 
3,660

 
(2,699
)
 
415,392

(1)
Available-for-sale debt securities include investments in tax-exempt preferred debt securities issued by investment funds or trusts that predominantly invest in tax-exempt municipal securities. The cost basis and fair value of these types of securities was $6.3 billion each at December 31, 2018 , and $5.2 billion each at December 31, 2017 .
(2)
Available-for-sale debt securities include collateralized debt obligations (CDOs) with a cost basis and fair value of $662 million and $800 million , respectively, at December 31, 2018 , and $887 million and $1.0 billion , respectively, at December 31, 2017 .
(3)
The “Other” category of available-for-sale debt securities largely includes asset-backed securities collateralized by student loans. Included in the “Other” category of held-to-maturity debt securities are asset-backed securities collateralized by automobile leases or loans and cash with a cost basis and fair value of $0 million each at December 31, 2018, and $114 million each at December 31, 2017 .
(4)
Predominantly consists of federal agency mortgage-backed securities at both December 31, 2018 , and December 31, 2017 .
(5)
At December 31, 2018 and 2017 , we held no securities of any single issuer (excluding the U.S. Treasury and federal agencies and government-sponsored entities (GSEs)) with a book value that exceeded 10% of stockholder’s equity.

162
Wells Fargo & Company
 


Gross Unrealized Losses and Fair Value
Table 5.2 shows the gross unrealized losses and fair value of available-for-sale and held-to-maturity debt securities by length of time those individual securities in each category have been in a continuous loss position. Debt securities on which we have
 
taken credit-related OTTI write-downs are categorized as being “less than 12 months” or “12 months or more” in a continuous loss position based on the point in time that the fair value declined to below the cost basis and not the period of time since the credit-related OTTI write-down.

Table 5.2: Gross Unrealized Losses and Fair Value
 
Less than 12 months 
 
 
12 months or more 
 
 
Total 
 
(in millions)
Gross unrealized losses 

 
Fair value 

 
Gross unrealized losses 

 
Fair value 

 
Gross unrealized losses 

 
Fair value 

December 31, 2018
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Available-for-sale debt securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities of U.S. Treasury and federal agencies
$
(1
)
 
498

 
(105
)
 
6,204

 
(106
)
 
6,702

Securities of U.S. states and political subdivisions
(73
)
 
9,746

 
(373
)
 
9,017

 
(446
)
 
18,763

Mortgage-backed securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 


 


Federal agencies
(42
)
 
10,979

 
(3,098
)
 
112,252

 
(3,140
)
 
123,231

Residential
(3
)
 
398

 
(2
)
 
69

 
(5
)
 
467

Commercial
(20
)
 
1,972

 
(2
)
 
79

 
(22
)
 
2,051

Total mortgage-backed securities
(65
)
 
13,349

 
(3,102
)
 
112,400

 
(3,167
)
 
125,749

Corporate debt securities
(64
)
 
1,965

 
(26
)
 
298

 
(90
)
 
2,263

Collateralized loan and other debt obligations
(388
)
 
28,306

 
(8
)
 
553

 
(396
)
 
28,859

Other
(7
)
 
819

 
(6
)
 
159

 
(13
)
 
978

Total available-for-sale debt securities
(598
)
 
54,683

 
(3,620
)
 
128,631

 
(4,218
)
 
183,314

Held-to-maturity debt securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities of U.S. Treasury and federal agencies
(3
)
 
895

 
(412
)
 
41,083

 
(415
)
 
41,978

Securities of U.S. states and political subdivisions
(4
)
 
598

 
(112
)
 
3,992

 
(116
)
 
4,590

     Federal agency and other mortgage-backed
        securities
(5
)
 
4,635

 
(2,283
)
 
77,741

 
(2,288
)
 
82,376

Collateralized loan obligations

 

 

 

 

 

Total held-to-maturity debt securities
(12
)
 
6,128

 
(2,807
)
 
122,816

 
(2,819
)
 
128,944

Total
$
(610
)
 
60,811

 
(6,427
)
 
251,447

 
(7,037
)
 
312,258

December 31, 2017
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Available-for-sale debt securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities of U.S. Treasury and federal agencies
$
(27
)
 
4,065

 
(81
)
 
2,209

 
(108
)
 
6,274

Securities of U.S. states and political subdivisions
(17
)
 
6,179

 
(422
)
 
11,766

 
(439
)
 
17,945

Mortgage-backed securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Federal agencies
(243
)
 
52,559

 
(1,029
)
 
44,691

 
(1,272
)
 
97,250

Residential
(1
)
 
47

 
(1
)
 
58

 
(2
)
 
105

Commercial
(1
)
 
101

 
(1
)
 
133

 
(2
)
 
234

Total mortgage-backed securities
(245
)
 
52,707

 
(1,031
)
 
44,882

 
(1,276
)
 
97,589

Corporate debt securities
(4
)
 
239

 
(36
)
 
503

 
(40
)
 
742

Collateralized loan and other debt obligations
(1
)
 
373

 
(2
)
 
146

 
(3
)
 
519

Other
(1
)
 
37

 
(4
)
 
483

 
(5
)
 
520

Total available-for-sale debt securities
(295
)
 
63,600

 
(1,576
)
 
59,989

 
(1,871
)
 
123,589

Held-to-maturity debt securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities of U.S. Treasury and federal agencies
(69
)
 
11,255

 
(34
)
 
1,490

 
(103
)
 
12,745

Securities of U.S. states and political subdivisions
(5
)
 
500

 
(38
)
 
1,683

 
(43
)
 
2,183

Federal agency and other mortgage-backed securities
(198
)
 
29,713

 
(484
)
 
28,244

 
(682
)
 
57,957

Collateralized loan obligations

 

 

 

 

 

Total held-to-maturity debt securities
(272
)
 
41,468

 
(556
)
 
31,417

 
(828
)
 
72,885

Total
$
(567
)
 
105,068

 
(2,132
)
 
91,406

 
(2,699
)
 
196,474














 













 
Wells Fargo & Company
163


Note 5:   Available-for-Sale and Held-to Maturity Debt Securities (continued)

We have assessed each debt security with gross unrealized losses included in the previous table for credit impairment. As part of that assessment we evaluated and concluded that we do not intend to sell any of the debt securities and that it is more likely than not that we will not be required to sell prior to recovery of the amortized cost basis. We evaluate, where necessary, whether credit impairment exists by comparing the present value of the expected cash flows to the debt securities’ amortized cost basis.
For descriptions of the factors we consider when analyzing debt securities for impairment, see Note 1 (Summary of Significant Accounting Policies) and below.

SECURITIES OF U.S. TREASURY AND FEDERAL AGENCIES AND FEDERAL AGENCY MORTGAGE-BACKED SECURITIES (MBS) The unrealized losses associated with U.S. Treasury and federal agency securities and federal agency MBS are generally driven by changes in interest rates and not due to credit losses given the explicit or implicit guarantees provided by the U.S. government.

SECURITIES OF U.S. STATES AND POLITICAL SUBDIVISIONS The unrealized losses associated with securities of U.S. states and political subdivisions are usually driven by changes in the relationship between municipal and term funding credit curves rather than by changes to the credit quality of the underlying securities. Substantially all of these investments with unrealized losses are investment grade. The securities were generally underwritten in accordance with our own investment standards prior to the decision to purchase. Some of these securities are guaranteed by a bond insurer, but we did not rely on this guarantee when making our investment decision. These investments will continue to be monitored as part of our ongoing impairment analysis but are expected to perform, even if the rating agencies reduce the credit rating of the bond insurers. As a result, we expect to recover the entire amortized cost basis of these securities.

RESIDENTIAL AND COMMERCIAL MBS   The unrealized losses associated with private residential MBS and commercial MBS are generally driven by changes in projected collateral losses, credit spreads and interest rates. We assess for credit impairment by estimating the present value of expected cash flows. The key assumptions for determining expected cash flows include default rates, loss severities and/or prepayment rates. We estimate security losses by forecasting the underlying mortgage loans in each transaction. We use forecasted loan performance to project cash flows to the various tranches in the structure. We also consider cash flow forecasts and, as applicable, independent industry analyst reports and forecasts, sector credit ratings, and other independent market data. Based upon our assessment of the expected credit losses and the credit enhancement level of the securities, we expect to recover the entire amortized cost basis of these securities.
 
CORPORATE DEBT SECURITIES  The unrealized losses associated with corporate debt securities are predominantly related to unsecured debt obligations issued by various corporations. We evaluate the financial performance of each issuer on a quarterly basis to determine if the issuer can make all contractual principal and interest payments. Based upon this assessment, we expect to recover the entire amortized cost basis of these securities.

COLLATERALIZED LOAN AND OTHER DEBT OBLIGATIONS  The unrealized losses associated with collateralized loan and other debt obligations relate to securities predominantly backed by commercial collateral. The unrealized losses are typically driven by changes in projected collateral losses, credit spreads and interest rates. We assess for credit impairment by estimating the present value of expected cash flows. The key assumptions for determining expected cash flows include default rates, loss severities and prepayment rates. We also consider cash flow forecasts and, as applicable, independent industry analyst reports and forecasts, sector credit ratings, and other independent market data. Based upon our assessment of the expected credit losses and the credit enhancement level of the securities, we expect to recover the entire amortized cost basis of these securities.

OTHER DEBT SECURITIES  The unrealized losses associated with other debt securities predominantly relate to other asset-backed securities. The losses are usually driven by changes in projected collateral losses, credit spreads and interest rates. We assess for credit impairment by estimating the present value of expected cash flows. The key assumptions for determining expected cash flows include default rates, loss severities and prepayment rates. Based upon our assessment of the expected credit losses and the credit enhancement level of the securities, we expect to recover the entire amortized cost basis of these securities.

OTHER DEBT SECURITIES MATTERS   The fair values of our debt securities could decline in the future if the underlying performance of the collateral for the residential and commercial MBS or other securities deteriorate, and our credit enhancement levels do not provide sufficient protection to our contractual principal and interest. As a result, there is a risk that significant OTTI may occur in the future.

164
Wells Fargo & Company
 


Table 5.3 shows the gross unrealized losses and fair value of the available-for-sale and held-to-maturity debt securities by those rated investment grade and those rated less than investment grade, according to their lowest credit rating by Standard & Poor’s Rating Services (S&P) or Moody’s Investors Service (Moody’s). Credit ratings express opinions about the credit quality of a debt security. Debt securities rated investment grade, that is those rated BBB- or higher by S&P or Baa3 or higher by Moody’s, are generally considered by the rating agencies and market participants to be low credit risk. Conversely, debt securities rated below investment grade, labeled as “speculative grade” by the rating agencies, are considered to be distinctively higher credit risk than investment
 
grade debt securities. We have also included debt securities not rated by S&P or Moody’s in the table below based on our internal credit grade of the debt securities (used for credit risk management purposes) equivalent to the credit rating assigned by major credit agencies. The unrealized losses and fair value of unrated debt securities categorized as investment grade based on internal credit grades were $20 million and $5.2 billion , respectively, at December 31, 2018 , and $32 million and $6.9 billion , respectively, at December 31, 2017 . If an internal credit grade was not assigned, we categorized the debt security as non-investment grade.

Table 5.3: Gross Unrealized Losses and Fair Value by Investment Grade
 
Investment grade
 
 
Non-investment grade
 
(in millions)
Gross unrealized losses 

 
Fair value 

 
Gross unrealized losses 

 
Fair value 

December 31, 2018
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Available-for-sale debt securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities of U.S. Treasury and federal agencies
$
(106
)
 
6,702

 

 

Securities of U.S. states and political subdivisions
(425
)
 
18,447

 
(21
)
 
316

Mortgage-backed securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Federal agencies
(3,140
)
 
123,231

 

 

Residential
(2
)
 
295

 
(3
)
 
172

Commercial
(20
)
 
1,999

 
(2
)
 
52

Total mortgage-backed securities
(3,162
)
 
125,525

 
(5
)
 
224

Corporate debt securities
(17
)
 
791

 
(73
)
 
1,472

Collateralized loan and other debt obligations
(396
)
 
28,859

 

 

Other
(7
)
 
726

 
(6
)
 
252

Total available-for-sale debt securities
(4,113
)
 
181,050

 
(105
)
 
2,264

Held-to-maturity debt securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities of U.S. Treasury and federal agencies
(415
)
 
41,978

 

 

Securities of U.S. states and political subdivisions
(116
)
 
4,590

 

 

Federal agency and other mortgage-backed securities
(2,278
)
 
81,977

 
(10
)
 
399

Collateralized loan obligations

 

 

 

Total held-to-maturity debt securities
(2,809
)
 
128,545

 
(10
)
 
399

Total
$
(6,922
)
 
309,595

 
(115
)
 
2,663

December 31, 2017
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Available-for-sale debt securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities of U.S. Treasury and federal agencies
$
(108
)
 
6,274

 

 

Securities of U.S. states and political subdivisions
(412
)
 
17,763

 
(27
)
 
182

Mortgage-backed securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Federal agencies
(1,272
)
 
97,250

 

 

Residential
(1
)
 
42

 
(1
)
 
63

Commercial
(1
)
 
183

 
(1
)
 
51

Total mortgage-backed securities
(1,274
)
 
97,475

 
(2
)
 
114

Corporate debt securities
(13
)
 
304

 
(27
)
 
438

Collateralized loan and other debt obligations
(3
)
 
519

 

 

Other
(2
)
 
469

 
(3
)
 
51

Total available-for-sale debt securities
(1,812
)
 
122,804

 
(59
)
 
785

Held-to-maturity debt securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities of U.S. Treasury and federal agencies
(103
)
 
12,745

 

 

Securities of U.S. states and political subdivisions
(43
)
 
2,183

 

 

Federal agency and other mortgage-backed securities
(680
)
 
57,789

 
(2
)
 
168

Collateralized loan obligations

 

 

 

Total held-to-maturity debt securities
(826
)
 
72,717

 
(2
)
 
168

Total
$
(2,638
)
 
195,521

 
(61
)
 
953


 
Wells Fargo & Company
165


Note 5:   Available-for-Sale and Held-to Maturity Debt Securities (continued)

Contractual Maturities
Table 5.4 shows the remaining contractual maturities and contractual weighted-average yields (taxable-equivalent basis) of available-for-sale debt securities. The remaining contractual
 
principal maturities for MBS do not consider prepayments. Remaining expected maturities will differ from contractual maturities because borrowers may have the right to prepay obligations before the underlying mortgages mature.

Table 5.4: Contractual Maturities
 
 
 
Remaining contractual maturity 
 
 
Total 

 
 
 
Within one year 
 
 
After one year through five years 
 
 
After five years through ten years 
 
 
After ten years 
 
(in millions)
amount 

 
Yield 

 
Amount 

 
Yield 

 
Amount 

 
Yield 

 
Amount 

 
Yield 

 
Amount 

 
Yield 

December 31, 2018
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Available-for-sale debt securities (1):
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Fair value:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities of U.S. Treasury and federal agencies
$
13,348

 
1.87
%
 
$
1,087

 
1.52
%
 
$
12,213

 
1.90
%
 
$
48

 
1.89
%
 
$

 
%
Securities of U.S. states and political subdivisions
49,264

 
4.78

 
3,568

 
2.92

 
6,644

 
3.42

 
4,635

 
3.44

 
34,417

 
5.42

Mortgage-backed securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Federal agencies
153,203

 
3.42

 

 

 
169

 
3.52

 
1,909

 
2.56

 
151,125

 
3.43

Residential
2,775

 
4.01

 

 

 
14

 
5.85

 
6

 
3.04

 
2,755

 
4.00

Commercial
4,225

 
3.64

 

 

 

 

 
342

 
3.60

 
3,883

 
3.65

Total mortgage-backed securities
160,203

 
3.44

 

 

 
183

 
3.70

 
2,257

 
2.72

 
157,763

 
3.45

Corporate debt securities
6,271

 
5.11

 
390

 
6.27

 
2,525

 
5.25

 
2,743

 
4.68

 
613

 
5.67

Collateralized loan and other debt obligations
35,343

 
3.89

 

 

 
28

 
4.18

 
8,866

 
3.91

 
26,449

 
3.89

Other
5,483

 
3.17

 
15

 
6.02

 
818

 
3.84

 
1,446

 
2.17

 
3,204

 
3.44

Total available-for-sale debt securities at fair value
$
269,912

 
3.70
%
 
$
5,060

 
2.89
%
 
$
22,411

 
2.82
%
 
$
19,995

 
3.64
%
 
$
222,446

 
3.81
%
December 31, 2017
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Available-for-sale debt securities (1):
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Fair value:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities of U.S. Treasury and federal agencies
$
6,319

 
1.59
%
 
$
81

 
1.37
%
 
$
6,189

 
1.59
%
 
$
49

 
1.89
%
 
$

 
%
Securities of U.S. states and political subdivisions
51,326

 
5.88

 
2,380

 
3.47

 
9,484

 
3.42

 
2,276

 
4.63

 
37,186

 
6.75

Mortgage-backed securities:

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Federal agencies
160,219

 
3.27

 
15

 
2.03

 
210

 
3.08

 
5,534

 
2.82

 
154,460

 
3.28

Residential
4,608

 
3.52

 

 

 
24

 
5.67

 
11

 
2.46

 
4,573

 
3.51

Commercial
4,565

 
3.45

 

 

 

 

 
166

 
2.69

 
4,399

 
3.48

Total mortgage-backed securities
169,392

 
3.28

 
15

 
2.03

 
234

 
3.35

 
5,711

 
2.82

 
163,432

 
3.30

Corporate debt securities
7,666

 
5.12

 
443

 
5.54

 
2,738

 
5.56

 
3,549

 
4.70

 
936

 
5.26

Collateralized loan and other debt obligations
36,056

 
2.98

 

 

 
50

 
1.68

 
15,008

 
2.96

 
20,998

 
3.00

Other
5,648

 
2.46

 
71

 
3.56

 
463

 
2.72

 
1,466

 
2.13

 
3,648

 
2.53

Total available-for-sale debt securities at fair value
$
276,407

 
3.72
%
 
$
2,990

 
3.70
%
 
$
19,158

 
3.11
%
 
$
28,059

 
3.24
%
 
$
226,200

 
3.83
%
(1)
Weighted-average yields displayed by maturity bucket are weighted based on fair value and predominantly represent contractual coupon rates without effect for any related hedging derivatives.

166
Wells Fargo & Company
 


Table 5.5 shows the amortized cost and weighted-average yields of held-to-maturity debt securities by contractual maturity.

Table 5.5: Amortized Cost by Contractual Maturity
 
 
 
Remaining contractual maturity 
 
 
Total 

 
 
 
Within one year 
 
 
After one year through five years 
 
 
After five years through ten years 
 
 
After ten years 
 
(in millions)
amount

 
Yield 

 
Amount 

 
Yield 

 
Amount 

 
Yield 

 
Amount 

 
Yield 

 
Amount 

 
Yield 

December 31, 2018
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Held-to-maturity debt securities (1):
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Amortized cost:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities of U.S. Treasury and federal agencies
$
44,751

 
2.12
%
 
$

 
%
 
$
32,356

 
2.04
%
 
$
12,395

 
2.32
%
 
$

 
%
Securities of U.S. states and political subdivisions
6,286

 
4.93

 

 

 
72

 
6.04

 
1,188

 
4.91

 
5,026

 
4.92

Federal agency and other mortgage-backed securities
93,685

 
3.10

 

 

 
26

 
3.52

 

 

 
93,659

 
3.10

Collateralized loan obligations
66

 
3.62

 

 

 

 

 
66

 
3.62

 

 

Other

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total held-to-maturity debt securities at amortized cost
$
144,788

 
2.87
%
 
$

 
%
 
$
32,454

 
2.05
%
 
$
13,649

 
2.55
%
 
$
98,685

 
3.19
%
December 31, 2017
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Held-to-maturity debt securities (1):
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Amortized cost:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities of U.S. Treasury and federal agencies
$
44,720

 
2.12
%
 
$

 
%
 
$
32,330

 
2.04
%
 
$
12,390

 
2.32
%
 
$

 
%
Securities of U.S. states and political subdivisions
6,313

 
6.02

 

 

 
50

 
7.18

 
695

 
6.31

 
5,568

 
5.98

Federal agency and other mortgage-backed securities
87,527

 
3.11

 

 

 
15

 
2.81

 
11

 
2.49

 
87,501

 
3.11

Collateralized loan obligations
661

 
2.86

 

 

 

 

 
661

 
2.86

 

 

Other
114

 
1.83

 

 

 
114

 
1.83

 

 

 

 

Total held-to-maturity debt securities at amortized cost
$
139,335

 
2.92
%
 
$

 
%
 
$
32,509

 
2.05
%
 
$
13,757

 
2.55
%
 
$
93,069

 
3.28
%
(1)
Weighted-average yields displayed by maturity bucket are weighted based on amortized cost and predominantly represent contractual coupon rates.

Table 5.6 shows the fair value of held-to-maturity debt securities by contractual maturity.

Table 5.6: Fair Value by Contractual Maturity
 
 
Remaining contractual maturity 
 
 
Total 

 
Within one year 

 
After one year through five years 

 
After five years through ten years 

 
After ten years 

(in millions)
amount

 
Amount

 
Amount

 
Amount

 
Amount

December 31, 2018
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Held-to-maturity debt securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Fair value:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities of U.S. Treasury and federal agencies
$
44,340

 

 
32,073

 
12,267

 

Securities of U.S. states and political subdivisions
6,200

 

 
70

 
1,191

 
4,939

Federal agency and other mortgage-backed securities
91,509

 

 
26

 

 
91,483

Collateralized loan obligations
66

 

 

 
66

 

Other

 

 

 

 

Total held-to-maturity debt securities at fair value
$
142,115

 

 
32,169

 
13,524

 
96,422

December 31, 2017
 
 
 
 

 

 

Held-to-maturity debt securities:
 
 
 
 

 

 

Fair value:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities of U.S. Treasury and federal agencies
$
44,806

 

 
32,388

 
12,418

 

Securities of U.S. states and political subdivisions
6,354

 

 
49

 
701

 
5,604

Federal agency and other mortgage-backed securities
87,046

 

 
15

 
11

 
87,020

Collateralized loan obligations
665

 

 

 
665

 

Other
114

 

 
114

 

 

Total held-to-maturity debt securities at fair value
$
138,985

 

 
32,566

 
13,795

 
92,624


 
Wells Fargo & Company
167


Note 5:   Available-for-Sale and Held-to Maturity Debt Securities (continued)

Realized Gains and Losses
Table 5.7 shows the gross realized gains and losses on sales and OTTI write-downs related to available-for-sale debt securities.

Table 5.7: Realized Gains and Losses
 
Year ended December 31,
 
(in millions)
2018

 
2017

 
2016

Gross realized gains
$
155

 
948

 
1,234

Gross realized losses
(19
)
 
(207
)
 
(103
)
OTTI write-downs
(28
)
 
(262
)
 
(189
)
Net realized gains from available-for-sale debt securities
$
108

 
479

 
942


Other-Than-Temporary Impaired Debt Securities
Table 5.8 shows the detail of total OTTI write-downs included in earnings for available-for-sale debt securities. There were no
 
OTTI write-downs on held-to-maturity debt securities during the years ended December 31, 2018 , 2017 or 2016 .

Table 5.8: Detail of OTTI Write-downs
 
Year ended December 31,
 
(in millions)
2018

 
2017

 
2016

Debt securities OTTI write-downs included in earnings:
 
 
 
 
 
Securities of U.S. states and political subdivisions
$
2

 
150

 
63

Mortgage-backed securities:
 
 
 
 
 
Residential
4

 
11

 
34

Commercial
18

 
80

 
14

Corporate debt securities

 
21

 
72

Other debt securities
4

 

 
6

Total debt securities OTTI write-downs included in earnings
$
28

 
262

 
189


Table 5.9 shows the detail of OTTI write-downs on available-for-sale debt securities included in earnings and the related changes in OCI for the same securities.
Table 5.9: OTTI Write-downs Included in Earnings and the Related Changes in OCI
 
Year ended December 31,
 
(in millions)
2018

 
2017

 
2016

OTTI on debt securities
 
 
 
 
 
Recorded as part of gross realized losses:
 
 
 
 
 
Credit-related OTTI
$
27

 
119

 
143

Intent-to-sell OTTI
1

 
143

 
46

Total recorded as part of gross realized losses
28

 
262

 
189

Changes to OCI for losses (reversal of losses) in non-credit-related OTTI (1):
 
 
 
 
 
Securities of U.S. states and political subdivisions
(2
)
 
(5
)
 
8

Residential mortgage-backed securities
2

 
(1
)
 
(3
)
Commercial mortgage-backed securities
(11
)
 
(51
)
 
24

Corporate debt securities

 
1

 
(13
)
Other debt securities

 
(1
)
 
2

Total changes to OCI for non-credit-related OTTI
(11
)
 
(57
)
 
18

Total OTTI losses (reversal of losses) recorded on debt securities
$
17

 
205

 
207

(1)
Represents amounts recorded to OCI for impairment of debt securities, due to factors other than credit, that have also had credit-related OTTI write-downs during the period. Increases represent initial or subsequent non-credit-related OTTI on debt securities. Decreases represent partial to full reversal of impairment due to recoveries in the fair value of debt securities due to non-credit factors.


168
Wells Fargo & Company
 


Table 5.10 presents a rollforward of the OTTI credit loss that has been recognized in earnings as a write-down of available-for-sale debt securities we still own (referred to as “credit-impaired” debt securities) and do not intend to sell. Recognized credit loss represents the difference between the present value of expected
 
future cash flows discounted using the security’s current effective interest rate and the amortized cost basis of the security prior to considering credit loss.
Table 5.10: Rollforward of OTTI Credit Loss
 
Year ended December 31,
 
(in millions)
2018

 
2017

 
2016

Credit loss recognized, beginning of year
$
742

 
1,043

 
1,092

Additions:
 
 
 
 
 
For securities with initial credit impairments
1

 
9

 
85

For securities with previous credit impairments
26

 
110

 
58

Total additions
27

 
119

 
143

Reductions:
 
 
 
 
 
For securities sold, matured, or intended/required to be sold
(204
)
 
(414
)
 
(184
)
For recoveries of previous credit impairments (1)
(3
)
 
(6
)
 
(8
)
Total reductions
(207
)
 
(420
)
 
(192
)
Credit loss recognized, end of year
$
562

 
742

 
1,043

(1)
Recoveries of previous credit impairments result from increases in expected cash flows subsequent to credit loss recognition. Such recoveries are reflected prospectively as interest yield adjustments using the effective interest method.



 
Wells Fargo & Company
169


Note 6: Loans and Allowance for Credit Losses (continued)

Note 6:   Loans and Allowance for Credit Losses
Table 6.1 presents total loans outstanding by portfolio segment and class of financing receivable. Outstanding balances include a total net reduction of $1.3 billion and $3.9 billion at December 31, 2018 and 2017 , respectively, for unearned income,
 
net deferred loan fees, and unamortized discounts and premiums, which among other things, reflect the
impact of various loan sales.


Table 6.1: Loans Outstanding
 
December 31,
 
(in millions)
2018

 
2017

 
2016

 
2015

 
2014

Commercial:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial
$
350,199

 
333,125

 
330,840

 
299,892

 
271,795

Real estate mortgage
121,014

 
126,599

 
132,491

 
122,160

 
111,996

Real estate construction
22,496

 
24,279

 
23,916

 
22,164

 
18,728

Lease financing
19,696

 
19,385

 
19,289

 
12,367

 
12,307

Total commercial
513,405

 
503,388

 
506,536

 
456,583

 
414,826

Consumer:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Real estate 1-4 family first mortgage
285,065

 
284,054

 
275,579

 
273,869

 
265,386

Real estate 1-4 family junior lien mortgage
34,398

 
39,713

 
46,237

 
53,004

 
59,717

Credit card
39,025

 
37,976

 
36,700

 
34,039

 
31,119

Automobile
45,069

 
53,371

 
62,286

 
59,966

 
55,740

Other revolving credit and installment
36,148

 
38,268

 
40,266

 
39,098

 
35,763

Total consumer
439,705

 
453,382

 
461,068

 
459,976

 
447,725

Total loans
$
953,110

 
956,770

 
967,604

 
916,559

 
862,551


Our foreign loans are reported by respective class of financing receivable in the table above. Substantially all of our foreign loan portfolio is commercial loans. Loans are classified as foreign primarily based on whether the borrower’s primary
 
address is outside of the United States. Table 6.2 presents total commercial foreign loans outstanding by class of financing receivable.

Table 6.2: Commercial Foreign Loans Outstanding
 
December 31,
 
(in millions)
2018

 
2017

 
2016

 
2015

 
2014

Commercial foreign loans:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial
$
62,564

 
60,106

 
55,396

 
49,049

 
44,707

Real estate mortgage
6,731

 
8,033

 
8,541

 
8,350

 
4,776

Real estate construction
1,011

 
655

 
375

 
444

 
218

Lease financing
1,159

 
1,126

 
972

 
274

 
336

Total commercial foreign loans
$
71,465

 
69,920

 
65,284

 
58,117

 
50,037



170
Wells Fargo & Company
 


Loan Concentrations
Loan concentrations may exist when there are amounts loaned to borrowers engaged in similar activities or similar types of loans extended to a diverse group of borrowers that would cause them to be similarly impacted by economic or other conditions. At December 31, 2018 and 2017 , we did not have concentrations representing 10% or more of our total loan portfolio in domestic commercial and industrial loans and lease financing by industry or CRE loans (real estate mortgage and real estate construction) by state or property type. Real estate 1-4 family non-PCI mortgage loans to borrowers in the state of California represented 12% of total loans at both December 31, 2018 and 2017 , and PCI loans were under 1% in both years. These California loans are generally diversified among the larger metropolitan areas in California, with no single area consisting of more than 5% of total loans. We continuously monitor changes in real estate values and underlying economic or market conditions for all geographic areas of our real estate 1-4 family mortgage portfolio as part of our credit risk management process.
Some of our real estate 1-4 family first and junior lien mortgage loans include an interest-only feature as part of the loan terms. These interest-only loans were approximately 4% of total loans at both December 31, 2018 and 2017. Substantially all of these interest-only loans at origination were considered to be prime or near prime. We do not offer option adjustable-rate mortgage (ARM) products, nor do we offer variable-rate mortgage products with fixed payment amounts, commonly referred to within the financial services industry as negative amortizing mortgage loans. We acquired an option payment loan portfolio (Pick-a-Pay) from Wachovia at December 31, 2008. A majority of the portfolio was identified as PCI loans. Since the acquisition, we have reduced our exposure to the option payment portion of the portfolio through our modification efforts and loss mitigation actions. At December 31, 2018 , approximately 1% of total loans remained with the payment option feature compared with 10% at December 31, 2008.
Our first and junior lien lines of credit products generally have draw periods of 10 , 15 or 20 years , with variable interest rate and payment options during the draw period of (1) interest only or (2) 1.5% of total outstanding balance plus accrued
 
interest. During the draw period, the borrower has the option of converting all or a portion of the line from a variable interest rate to a fixed rate with terms including interest-only payments for a fixed period between three to seven years or a fully amortizing payment with a fixed period between five to 30 years . At the end of the draw period, a line of credit generally converts to an amortizing payment schedule with repayment terms of up to 30 years based on the balance at time of conversion. At December 31, 2018 , our lines of credit portfolio had an outstanding balance of $43.6 billion , of which $11.1 billion , or 25% , is in its amortization period, another $1.3 billion , or 3% , of our total outstanding balance, will reach their end of draw period during 2019 through 2020 , $11.3 billion , or 26% , during 2021 through 2023 , and $19.9 billion , or 46% , will convert in subsequent years. This portfolio had unfunded credit commitments of $60.1 billion at December 31, 2018 . The lines that enter their amortization period may experience higher delinquencies and higher loss rates than the lines in their draw period. At December 31, 2018 , $488 million , or 4% , of outstanding lines of credit that are in their amortization period were 30 or more days past due, compared with $553 million , or 2% , for lines in their draw period. We have considered this increased inherent risk in our allowance for credit loss estimate. In anticipation of our borrowers reaching the end of their contractual commitment, we have created a program to inform, educate and help these borrowers transition from interest-only to fully-amortizing payments or full repayment. We monitor the performance of the borrowers moving through the program in an effort to refine our ongoing program strategy.

Loan Purchases, Sales, and Transfers
Table 6.3 summarizes the proceeds paid or received for purchases and sales of loans and transfers from loans held for investment to mortgages/loans held for sale at lower of cost or fair value. This loan activity primarily includes loans purchased and sales of whole loan or participating interests, whereby we receive or transfer a portion of a loan after origination. The table excludes PCI loans and loans recorded at fair value, including loans originated for sale because their loan activity normally does not impact the allowance for credit losses.
Table 6.3: Loan Purchases, Sales, and Transfers
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Year ended December 31,
 
  
2018
 
 
2017
 
(in millions)
Commercial

 
Consumer (1)

 
Total

 
Commercial

 
Consumer (1)

 
Total

Purchases
$
2,065

 
16

 
2,081

 
3,675

 
2

 
3,677

Sales
(1,905
)
 
(261
)
 
(2,166
)
 
(2,066
)
 
(425
)
 
(2,491
)
Transfers to MLHFS/LHFS
(617
)
 
(1,995
)
 
(2,612
)
 
(736
)
 
(2
)
 
(738
)
(1)
Excludes activity in government insured/guaranteed real estate 1-4 family first mortgage loans. As servicer, we are able to buy delinquent insured/guaranteed loans out of the Government National Mortgage Association (GNMA) pools, and manage and/or resell them in accordance with applicable requirements. These loans are predominantly insured by the Federal Housing Administration (FHA) or guaranteed by the Department of Veterans Affairs (VA). Accordingly, these loans have limited impact on the allowance for loan losses.


 
Wells Fargo & Company
171


Note 6: Loans and Allowance for Credit Losses (continued)

Commitments to Lend
A commitment to lend is a legally binding agreement to lend funds to a customer, usually at a stated interest rate, if funded, and for specific purposes and time periods. We generally require a fee to extend such commitments. Certain commitments are subject to loan agreements with covenants regarding the financial performance of the customer or borrowing base formulas on an ongoing basis that must be met before we are required to fund the commitment. We may reduce or cancel consumer commitments, including home equity lines and credit card lines, in accordance with the contracts and applicable law.
We may, as a representative for other lenders, advance funds or provide for the issuance of letters of credit under syndicated loan or letter of credit agreements. Any advances are generally repaid in less than a week and would normally require default of both the customer and another lender to expose us to loss. These temporary advance arrangements totaled approximately $91 billion at December 31, 2018 , and $85 billion at December 31, 2017 .
We issue commercial letters of credit to assist customers in purchasing goods or services, typically for international trade. At December 31, 2018 and 2017 , we had $919 million and $982 million , respectively, of outstanding issued commercial letters of credit. We also originate multipurpose lending commitments under which borrowers have the option to draw on the facility for different purposes in one of several forms, including a standby letter of credit. See Note 15 (Guarantees, Pledged Assets and Collateral, and Other Commitments) for additional information on standby letters of credit.
When we make commitments, we are exposed to credit risk. The maximum credit risk for these commitments will generally be lower than the contractual amount because a significant portion of these commitments are expected to expire without being used by the customer. In addition, we manage the potential risk in commitments to lend by limiting the total amount of commitments, both by individual customer and in total, by monitoring the size and maturity structure of these commitments and by applying the same credit standards for these commitments as for all of our credit activities.
 
For loans and commitments to lend, we generally require collateral or a guarantee. We may require various types of collateral, including commercial and consumer real estate, automobiles, other short-term liquid assets such as accounts receivable or inventory and long-lived assets, such as equipment and other business assets. Collateral requirements for each loan or commitment may vary based on the loan product and our assessment of a customer’s credit risk according to the specific credit underwriting, including credit terms and structure.
The contractual amount of our unfunded credit commitments, including unissued standby and commercial letters of credit, is summarized by portfolio segment and class of financing receivable in Table 6.4 . The table excludes the issued standby and commercial letters of credit and temporary advance arrangements described above.
Table 6.4: Unfunded Credit Commitments
(in millions)
Dec 31,
2018

 
Dec 31,
2017

Commercial:
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial
$
330,492

 
326,626

Real estate mortgage
6,984

 
7,485

Real estate construction
16,400

 
16,621

Total commercial
353,876

 
350,732

Consumer:
 
 
 
Real estate 1-4 family first mortgage
29,736

 
29,876

Real estate 1-4 family
junior lien mortgage
37,719

 
38,897

Credit card
109,840

 
108,465

Other revolving credit and installment
27,530

 
27,541

Total consumer
204,825

 
204,779

Total unfunded
credit commitments
$
558,701

 
555,511




172
Wells Fargo & Company
 


Allowance for Credit Losses
Table 6.5 presents the allowance for credit losses, which consists of the allowance for loan losses and the allowance for unfunded credit commitments.

Table 6.5: Allowance for Credit Losses
 
Year ended December 31, 
 
(in millions)
2018

 
2017

 
2016

 
2015

 
2014

Balance, beginning of year
$
11,960

 
12,540

 
12,512

 
13,169

 
14,971

Provision for credit losses
1,744

 
2,528

 
3,770

 
2,442

 
1,395

Interest income on certain impaired loans (1)
(166
)
 
(186
)
 
(205
)
 
(198
)
 
(211
)
Loan charge-offs:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial
(727
)
 
(789
)
 
(1,419
)
 
(734
)
 
(627
)
Real estate mortgage
(42
)
 
(38
)
 
(27
)
 
(59
)
 
(66
)
Real estate construction

 

 
(1
)
 
(4
)
 
(9
)
Lease financing
(70
)
 
(45
)
 
(41
)
 
(14
)
 
(15
)
Total commercial
(839
)
 
(872
)
 
(1,488
)
 
(811
)
 
(717
)
Consumer:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Real estate 1-4 family first mortgage
(179
)
 
(240
)
 
(452
)
 
(507
)
 
(721
)
Real estate 1-4 family junior lien mortgage
(179
)
 
(279
)
 
(495
)
 
(635
)
 
(864
)
Credit card
(1,599
)
 
(1,481
)
 
(1,259
)
 
(1,116
)
 
(1,025
)
Automobile
(947
)
 
(1,002
)
 
(845
)
 
(742
)
 
(729
)
Other revolving credit and installment
(685
)
 
(713
)
 
(708
)
 
(643
)
 
(668
)
Total consumer
(3,589
)
 
(3,715
)
 
(3,759
)
 
(3,643
)
 
(4,007
)
Total loan charge-offs
(4,428
)
 
(4,587
)
 
(5,247
)
 
(4,454
)
 
(4,724
)
Loan recoveries:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial
304

 
297

 
263

 
252

 
369

Real estate mortgage
70

 
82

 
116

 
127

 
160

Real estate construction
13

 
30

 
38

 
37

 
136

Lease financing
23

 
17

 
11

 
8

 
8

Total commercial
410

 
426

 
428

 
424

 
673

Consumer:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Real estate 1-4 family first mortgage
267

 
288

 
373

 
245

 
212

Real estate 1-4 family junior lien mortgage
219

 
266

 
266

 
259

 
238

Credit card
307

 
239

 
207

 
175

 
161

Automobile
363

 
319

 
325

 
325

 
349

Other revolving credit and installment
118

 
121

 
128

 
134

 
146

Total consumer
1,274

 
1,233

 
1,299

 
1,138

 
1,106

Total loan recoveries
1,684

 
1,659

 
1,727

 
1,562

 
1,779

Net loan charge-offs
(2,744
)
 
(2,928
)
 
(3,520
)
 
(2,892
)
 
(2,945
)
Other
(87
)
 
6

 
(17
)
 
(9
)
 
(41
)
Balance, end of year
$
10,707

 
11,960

 
12,540

 
12,512

 
13,169

Components:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Allowance for loan losses
$
9,775

 
11,004

 
11,419

 
11,545

 
12,319

Allowance for unfunded credit commitments
932

 
956

 
1,121

 
967

 
850

Allowance for credit losses
$
10,707

 
11,960

 
12,540

 
12,512

 
13,169

Net loan charge-offs as a percentage of average total loans
0.29
%
 
0.31

 
0.37

 
0.33

 
0.35

Allowance for loan losses as a percentage of total loans
1.03

 
1.15

 
1.18

 
1.26

 
1.43

Allowance for credit losses as a percentage of total loans
1.12

 
1.25

 
1.30

 
1.37

 
1.53

(1)
Certain impaired loans with an allowance calculated by discounting expected cash flows using the loan’s effective interest rate over the remaining life of the loan recognize changes in allowance attributable to the passage of time as interest income.


 
Wells Fargo & Company
173


Note 6: Loans and Allowance for Credit Losses (continued)

Table 6.6 summarizes the activity in the allowance for credit losses by our commercial and consumer portfolio segments. 

Table 6.6: Allowance Activity by Portfolio Segment
 
Year ended December 31, 
 
 
2018
 
 
2017
 
(in millions)
Commercial

 
Consumer 

 
Total 

 
Commercial 

 
Consumer 

 
Total 

Balance, beginning of year
$
6,632

 
5,328

 
11,960

 
7,394

 
5,146

 
12,540

Provision (reversal of provision) for credit losses
281

 
1,463

 
1,744

 
(261
)
 
2,789

 
2,528

Interest income on certain impaired loans
(47
)
 
(119
)
 
(166
)
 
(59
)
 
(127
)
 
(186
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Loan charge-offs
(839
)
 
(3,589
)
 
(4,428
)
 
(872
)
 
(3,715
)
 
(4,587
)
Loan recoveries
410

 
1,274

 
1,684

 
426

 
1,233

 
1,659

Net loan charge-offs
(429
)
 
(2,315
)
 
(2,744
)
 
(446
)
 
(2,482
)
 
(2,928
)
Other
(20
)
 
(67
)
 
(87
)
 
4

 
2

 
6

Balance, end of year
$
6,417

 
4,290

 
10,707

 
6,632

 
5,328

 
11,960


Table 6.7 disaggregates our allowance for credit losses and recorded investment in loans by impairment methodology.
 
Table 6.7: Allowance by Impairment Methodology
 
Allowance for credit losses 
 
 
Recorded investment in loans 
 
(in millions)
Commercial

 
Consumer 

 
Total 

 
Commercial 

 
Consumer 

 
Total 

December 31, 2018
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Collectively evaluated (1)
$
5,903

 
3,361

 
9,264

 
510,180

 
421,574

 
931,754

Individually evaluated (2)
514

 
929

 
1,443

 
3,221

 
13,126

 
16,347

PCI (3)

 

 

 
4

 
5,005

 
5,009

Total
$
6,417

 
4,290

 
10,707

 
513,405

 
439,705

 
953,110

December 31, 2017
 
Collectively evaluated (1)
$
5,927

 
4,143

 
10,070

 
499,342

 
425,919

 
925,261

Individually evaluated (2)
705

 
1,185

 
1,890

 
3,960

 
14,714

 
18,674

PCI (3)

 

 

 
86

 
12,749

 
12,835

Total
$
6,632

 
5,328

 
11,960

 
503,388

 
453,382

 
956,770

(1)
Represents loans collectively evaluated for impairment in accordance with Accounting Standards Codification (ASC) 450-20, Loss Contingencies (formerly FAS 5), and pursuant to amendments by ASU 2010-20 regarding allowance for non-impaired loans.
(2)
Represents loans individually evaluated for impairment in accordance with ASC 310-10, Receivables  (formerly FAS 114), and pursuant to amendments by ASU 2010-20 regarding allowance for impaired loans.
(3)
Represents the allowance and related loan carrying value determined in accordance with ASC 310-30 , Receivables – Loans and Debt Securities Acquired with Deteriorated Credit Quality (formerly SOP 3-3) and pursuant to amendments by ASU 2010-20 regarding allowance for PCI loans.

Credit Quality
We monitor credit quality by evaluating various attributes and utilize such information in our evaluation of the appropriateness of the allowance for credit losses. The following sections provide the credit quality indicators we most closely monitor. The credit quality indicators are generally based on information as of our financial statement date, with the exception of updated Fair Isaac Corporation (FICO) scores and updated loan-to-value (LTV)/combined LTV (CLTV). We obtain FICO scores at loan origination and the scores are generally updated at least quarterly, except in limited circumstances, including compliance with the Fair Credit Reporting Act (FCRA). Generally, the LTV and CLTV indicators are updated in the second month of each quarter, with updates no older than September 30, 2018 . See the “Purchased Credit-Impaired Loans” section in this Note for credit quality information on our PCI portfolio.

 
COMMERCIAL CREDIT QUALITY INDICATORS In addition to monitoring commercial loan concentration risk, we manage a consistent process for assessing commercial loan credit quality. Generally, commercial loans are subject to individual risk assessment using our internal borrower and collateral quality ratings. Our ratings are aligned to Pass and Criticized categories. The Criticized category includes Special Mention, Substandard, and Doubtful categories which are defined by bank regulatory agencies.
Table 6.8 provides a breakdown of outstanding commercial loans by risk category. Of the $14.8 billion in criticized commercial and industrial loans and $4.8 billion in criticized commercial real estate (CRE) loans at December 31, 2018 , $1.5 billion and $612 million , respectively, have been placed on nonaccrual status and written down to net realizable collateral value.

174
Wells Fargo & Company
 


Table 6.8: Commercial Loans by Risk Category
(in millions)
Commercial and industrial 

 
Real estate mortgage 

 
Real estate construction 

 
Lease financing 

 
Total 

December 31, 2018
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
By risk category:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Pass
$
335,412

 
116,514

 
22,207

 
18,671

 
492,804

Criticized
14,783

 
4,500

 
289

 
1,025

 
20,597

Total commercial loans (excluding PCI)
350,195

 
121,014

 
22,496

 
19,696

 
513,401

Total commercial PCI loans (carrying value)
4

 

 

 

 
4

Total commercial loans
$
350,199

 
121,014

 
22,496

 
19,696

 
513,405

December 31, 2017
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
By risk category:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Pass
$
316,431

 
122,312

 
23,981

 
18,162

 
480,886

Criticized
16,608

 
4,287

 
298

 
1,223

 
22,416

Total commercial loans (excluding PCI)
333,039

 
126,599

 
24,279

 
19,385

 
503,302

Total commercial PCI loans (carrying value)
86

 

 

 

 
86

Total commercial loans
$
333,125

 
126,599

 
24,279

 
19,385

 
503,388


Table 6.9 provides past due information for commercial loans, which we monitor as part of our credit risk management practices.

Table 6.9: Commercial Loans by Delinquency Status
(in millions)
Commercial and industrial 

 
Real estate mortgage 

 
Real estate construction 

 
Lease financing 

 
Total 

December 31, 2018
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
By delinquency status:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Current-29 days past due (DPD) and still accruing
$
348,158

 
120,176

 
22,411

 
19,443

 
510,188

30-89 DPD and still accruing
508

 
207

 
53

 
163

 
931

90+ DPD and still accruing
43

 
51

 

 

 
94

Nonaccrual loans
1,486

 
580

 
32

 
90

 
2,188

Total commercial loans (excluding PCI)
350,195

 
121,014

 
22,496

 
19,696

 
513,401

Total commercial PCI loans (carrying value)
4

 

 

 

 
4

Total commercial loans
$
350,199

 
121,014

 
22,496

 
19,696

 
513,405

December 31, 2017
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
By delinquency status:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Current-29 DPD and still accruing
$
330,319

 
125,642

 
24,107

 
19,148

 
499,216

30-89 DPD and still accruing
795

 
306

 
135

 
161

 
1,397

90+ DPD and still accruing
26

 
23

 

 

 
49

Nonaccrual loans
1,899

 
628

 
37

 
76

 
2,640

Total commercial loans (excluding PCI)
333,039

 
126,599

 
24,279

 
19,385

 
503,302

Total commercial PCI loans (carrying value)
86

 

 

 

 
86

Total commercial loans
$
333,125

 
126,599

 
24,279

 
19,385

 
503,388


 
Wells Fargo & Company
175


Note 6: Loans and Allowance for Credit Losses (continued)

CONSUMER CREDIT QUALITY INDICATORS We have various classes of consumer loans that present unique risks. Loan delinquency, FICO credit scores and LTV for loan types are common credit quality indicators that we monitor and utilize in our evaluation of the appropriateness of the allowance for credit losses for the consumer portfolio segment.
 
Many of our loss estimation techniques used for the allowance for credit losses rely on delinquency-based models; therefore, delinquency is an important indicator of credit quality and the establishment of our allowance for credit losses. Table 6.10 provides the outstanding balances of our consumer portfolio by delinquency status.
 
Table 6.10: Consumer Loans by Delinquency Status
(in millions)
Real estate 1-4 family first mortgage 

 
Real estate 1-4 family junior lien mortgage 

 
Credit card 

 
Automobile 

 
Other revolving credit and installment

 
Total 

December 31, 2018
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
By delinquency status:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Current-29 DPD
$
263,881

 
33,644

 
38,008

 
43,604

 
35,794

 
414,931

30-59 DPD
1,411

 
247

 
292

 
1,040

 
140

 
3,130

60-89 DPD
549

 
126

 
212

 
314

 
87

 
1,288

90-119 DPD
257

 
74

 
192

 
109

 
80

 
712

120-179 DPD
225

 
77

 
320

 
2

 
27

 
651

180+ DPD
822

 
213

 
1

 

 
20

 
1,056

Government insured/guaranteed loans (1)
12,688

 

 

 

 

 
12,688

Loans held at fair value
244

 

 

 

 

 
244

Total consumer loans (excluding PCI)
280,077

 
34,381

 
39,025

 
45,069

 
36,148

 
434,700

Total consumer PCI loans (carrying value)
4,988

 
17

 

 

 

 
5,005

Total consumer loans
$
285,065

 
34,398

 
39,025

 
45,069

 
36,148

 
439,705

December 31, 2017
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
By delinquency status:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Current-29 DPD
$
251,786

 
38,746

 
36,996

 
51,445

 
37,885

 
416,858

30-59 DPD
1,893

 
336

 
287

 
1,385

 
155

 
4,056

60-89 DPD
742

 
163

 
201

 
392

 
93

 
1,591

90-119 DPD
369

 
103

 
192

 
146

 
80

 
890

120-179 DPD
308

 
95

 
298

 
3

 
30

 
734

180+ DPD
1,091

 
243

 
2

 

 
25

 
1,361

Government insured/guaranteed loans (1)
14,767

 

 

 

 

 
14,767

Loans held at fair value
376

 

 

 

 

 
376

Total consumer loans (excluding PCI)
271,332

 
39,686

 
37,976

 
53,371

 
38,268

 
440,633

Total consumer PCI loans (carrying value)
12,722

 
27

 

 

 

 
12,749

Total consumer loans
$
284,054

 
39,713

 
37,976

 
53,371

 
38,268

 
453,382

(1)
Represents loans whose repayments are predominantly insured by the FHA or guaranteed by the VA. Loans insured/guaranteed by the FHA/VA and 90+ DPD totaled $7.7 billion at December 31, 2018 , compared with $10.5 billion at December 31, 2017 .

Of the $2.4 billion of consumer loans not government insured/guaranteed that are 90 days or more past due at December 31, 2018 , $885 million was accruing, compared with $3.0 billion past due and $1.0 billion accruing at December 31, 2017 .
Real estate 1-4 family first mortgage loans 180 days or more past due totaled $822 million , or 0.3% of total first mortgages (excluding PCI), at December 31, 2018 , compared with $1.1 billion , or 0.4% , at December 31, 2017 .
 
Table 6.11 provides a breakdown of our consumer portfolio by FICO. Most of the scored consumer portfolio has an updated FICO of 680 and above, reflecting a strong current borrower credit profile. FICO is not available for certain loan types, or may not be required if we deem it unnecessary due to strong collateral and other borrower attributes. Substantially all loans not requiring a FICO score are securities-based loans originated through retail brokerage, and totaled $8.9 billion at December 31, 2018 , and $8.5 billion at December 31, 2017 .

176
Wells Fargo & Company
 


Table 6.11: Consumer Loans by FICO
(in millions)
Real estate 1-4 family first mortgage 

 
Real estate
1-4 family junior lien mortgage

 
Credit card 

 
Automobile 

 
Other revolving credit and installment

 
Total 

December 31, 2018
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
By FICO:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
< 600
$
4,273

 
1,454

 
3,292

 
7,071

 
697

 
16,787

600-639
2,974

 
994

 
2,777

 
4,431

 
725

 
11,901

640-679
5,810

 
1,898

 
6,464

 
6,225

 
1,822

 
22,219

680-719
13,568

 
3,908

 
9,445

 
7,354

 
3,384

 
37,659

720-759
27,258

 
5,323

 
7,949

 
6,853

 
4,395

 
51,778

760-799
57,193

 
6,315

 
5,227

 
5,947

 
5,322

 
80,004

800+
151,465

 
13,190

 
3,794

 
7,099

 
8,411

 
183,959

No FICO available
4,604

 
1,299

 
77

 
89

 
2,507

 
8,576

FICO not required

 

 

 

 
8,885

 
8,885

Government insured/guaranteed loans (1)
12,932

 

 

 

 

 
12,932

Total consumer loans (excluding PCI)
280,077

 
34,381

 
39,025

 
45,069

 
36,148

 
434,700

Total consumer PCI loans (carrying value)
4,988

 
17

 

 

 

 
5,005

Total consumer loans
$
285,065

 
34,398

 
39,025

 
45,069

 
36,148

 
439,705

December 31, 2017
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
By FICO:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
< 600
$
5,145

 
1,768

 
3,525

 
8,858

 
863

 
20,159

600-639
3,487

 
1,253

 
3,101

 
5,615

 
904

 
14,360

640-679
6,789

 
2,387

 
5,690

 
7,696

 
1,959

 
24,521

680-719
14,977

 
4,797

 
7,628

 
8,825

 
3,582

 
39,809

720-759
27,926

 
6,246

 
8,097

 
7,806

 
5,089

 
55,164

760-799
55,590

 
7,323

 
6,372

 
6,468

 
6,257

 
82,010

800+
136,729

 
15,144

 
2,994

 
7,845

 
8,455

 
171,167

No FICO available
5,546

 
768

 
569

 
258

 
2,648

 
9,789

FICO not required

 

 

 

 
8,511

 
8,511

Government insured/guaranteed loans (1)
15,143

 

 

 

 

 
15,143

Total consumer loans (excluding PCI)
271,332

 
39,686

 
37,976

 
53,371

 
38,268

 
440,633

Total consumer PCI loans (carrying value)
12,722

 
27

 

 

 

 
12,749

Total consumer loans
$
284,054

 
39,713

 
37,976

 
53,371

 
38,268

 
453,382

(1)
Represents loans whose repayments are predominantly insured by the FHA or guaranteed by the VA.
 
LTV refers to the ratio comparing the loan’s unpaid principal balance to the property’s collateral value. CLTV refers to the combination of first mortgage and junior lien mortgage (including unused line amounts for credit line products) ratios. LTVs and CLTVs are updated quarterly using a cascade approach which first uses values provided by automated valuation models (AVMs) for the property. If an AVM is not available, then the value is estimated using the original appraised value adjusted by the change in Home Price Index (HPI) for the property location. If an HPI is not available, the original appraised value is used. The HPI value is normally the only method considered for high value properties, generally with an original value of $1 million or more, as the AVM values have proven less accurate for these properties.
 
Table 6.12 shows the most updated LTV and CLTV distribution of the real estate 1-4 family first and junior lien mortgage loan portfolios. We consider the trends in residential real estate markets as we monitor credit risk and establish our allowance for credit losses. In the event of a default, any loss should be limited to the portion of the loan amount in excess of the net realizable value of the underlying real estate collateral value. Certain loans do not have an LTV or CLTV due to industry data availability and portfolios acquired from or serviced by other institutions.

 
Wells Fargo & Company
177


Note 6: Loans and Allowance for Credit Losses (continued)

Table 6.12: Consumer Loans by LTV/CLTV
 
December 31, 2018
 
 
December 31, 2017
 
(in millions)
Real estate 1-4 family first mortgage by LTV 

 
Real estate 1-4 family junior lien mortgage by CLTV 

 
Total 

 
Real estate 1-4 family first mortgage by LTV 

 
Real estate 1-4 family junior lien mortgage by CLTV 

 
Total 

By LTV/CLTV:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
0-60%
$
147,666

 
15,753

 
163,419

 
133,902

 
16,301

 
150,203

60.01-80%
104,477

 
11,183

 
115,660

 
104,639

 
12,918

 
117,557

80.01-100%
12,372

 
4,874

 
17,246

 
13,924

 
6,580

 
20,504

100.01-120% (1)
1,211

 
1,596

 
2,807

 
1,868

 
2,427

 
4,295

> 120% (1)
484

 
578

 
1,062

 
783

 
1,008

 
1,791

No LTV/CLTV available
935

 
397

 
1,332

 
1,073

 
452

 
1,525

Government insured/guaranteed loans (2)
12,932

 

 
12,932

 
15,143

 

 
15,143

Total consumer loans (excluding PCI)
280,077

 
34,381

 
314,458

 
271,332

 
39,686

 
311,018

Total consumer PCI loans (carrying value)
4,988

 
17

 
5,005

 
12,722

 
27

 
12,749

Total consumer loans
$
285,065

 
34,398

 
319,463

 
284,054

 
39,713

 
323,767

(1)
Reflects total loan balances with LTV/CLTV amounts in excess of 100%. In the event of default, the loss content would generally be limited to only the amount in excess of 100% LTV/CLTV.
(2)
Represents loans whose repayments are predominantly insured by the FHA or guaranteed by the VA.

NONACCRUAL LOANS Table 6.13 provides loans on nonaccrual status. PCI loans are excluded from this table because they continue to earn interest from accretable yield, independent of performance in accordance with their contractual terms.

Table 6.13: Nonaccrual Loans
 
Dec 31,

 
Dec 31,

(in millions)
2018

 
2017

Commercial:
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial
$
1,486

 
1,899

Real estate mortgage
580

 
628

Real estate construction
32

 
37

Lease financing
90

 
76

Total commercial
2,188

 
2,640

Consumer:
 
 
 
Real estate 1-4 family first mortgage (1)
3,183

 
3,732

Real estate 1-4 family junior lien mortgage
945

 
1,086

Automobile
130

 
130

Other revolving credit and installment
50

 
58

Total consumer
4,308

 
5,006

Total nonaccrual loans
(excluding PCI)
$
6,496

 
7,646

(1)
Prior period has been revised to exclude $390 million of MLHFS, LHFS and loans held at fair value.
 
LOANS IN PROCESS OF FORECLOSURE Our recorded investment in consumer mortgage loans collateralized by residential real estate property that are in process of foreclosure was $4.6 billion and $6.3 billion at December 31, 2018 and 2017 , respectively, which included $3.2 billion and $4.0 billion , respectively, of loans that are government insured/guaranteed. Under the Consumer Financial Protection Bureau guidelines, we do not commence the foreclosure process on consumer real estate loans until after the loan is 120 days delinquent. Foreclosure procedures and timelines vary depending on whether the property address resides in a judicial or non-judicial state. Judicial states require the foreclosure to be processed through the state’s courts while non-judicial states are processed without court intervention. Foreclosure timelines vary according to state law.



178
Wells Fargo & Company
 


LOANS 90 DAYS OR MORE PAST DUE AND STILL ACCRUING    Certain loans 90 days or more past due as to interest or principal are still accruing, because they are (1) well-secured and in the process of collection or (2) real estate 1‑4 family mortgage loans or consumer loans exempt under regulatory rules from being classified as nonaccrual until later delinquency, usually 120 days past due. PCI loans of $370 million at December 31, 2018 , and $1.4 billion at December 31, 2017 , are not included in these past due and still accruing loans even when they are 90 days or more contractually past due. These PCI loans are considered to be accruing because they continue to earn interest from accretable yield, independent of performance in accordance with their contractual terms.
Table 6.14 shows non-PCI loans 90 days or more past due and still accruing by class for loans not government insured/guaranteed.
 
Table 6.14: Loans 90 Days or More Past Due and Still Accruing (1)
 
Dec 31,

 
Dec 31,

(in millions)
2018

 
2017

Total (excluding PCI):
$
8,704

 
11,532

Less: FHA insured/VA guaranteed (2)
7,725

 
10,475

Total, not government insured/guaranteed
$
979

 
1,057

By segment and class, not government insured/guaranteed:
 
 
 
Commercial:
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial
$
43

 
26

Real estate mortgage
51

 
23

Total commercial
94

 
49

Consumer:
 
 
 
Real estate 1-4 family first mortgage
124

 
213

Real estate 1-4 family junior lien mortgage
32

 
60

Credit card
513

 
492

Automobile
114

 
143

Other revolving credit and installment
102

 
100

Total consumer
885

 
1,008

Total, not government insured/guaranteed
$
979

 
1,057

(1)
Financial information for the prior period December 31, 2017 has been revised to exclude MLHFS, LHFS and loans held at fair value, which reduced “Total, not government insured/guaranteed” by $6 million .
(2)
Represents loans whose repayments are predominantly insured by the FHA or guaranteed by the VA.



 
Wells Fargo & Company
179


Note 6: Loans and Allowance for Credit Losses (continued)

IMPAIRED LOANS   Table 6.15 summarizes key information for impaired loans. Our impaired loans predominantly include loans on nonaccrual status in the commercial portfolio segment and loans modified in a TDR, whether on accrual or nonaccrual status. These impaired loans generally have estimated losses which are included in the allowance for credit losses. We have impaired loans with no allowance for credit losses when loss content has been previously recognized through charge-offs and we do not anticipate additional charge-offs or losses, or certain
 
loans are currently performing in accordance with their terms and for which no loss has been estimated. Impaired loans exclude PCI loans. Table 6.15 includes trial modifications that totaled $149 million at December 31, 2018 , and $194 million at December 31, 2017 .
For additional information on our impaired loans and allowance for credit losses, see Note 1 (Summary of Significant Accounting Policies).

Table 6.15: Impaired Loans Summary
 
 
 
Recorded investment 
 
 
 
(in millions)
Unpaid principal balance (1) 

 
Impaired loans 

 
Impaired loans with related allowance for credit losses 

 
Related allowance for credit losses 

December 31, 2018
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial
$
3,057

 
2,030

 
1,730

 
319

Real estate mortgage
1,228

 
1,032

 
1,009

 
154

Real estate construction
74

 
47

 
46

 
9

Lease financing
146

 
112

 
112

 
32

Total commercial
4,505

 
3,221

 
2,897

 
514

Consumer:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Real estate 1-4 family first mortgage
12,309

 
10,738

 
4,420

 
525

Real estate 1-4 family junior lien mortgage
1,886

 
1,694

 
1,133

 
183

Credit card
449

 
449

 
449

 
172

Automobile
153

 
89

 
43

 
8

Other revolving credit and installment
162

 
156

 
136

 
41

Total consumer (2)
14,959

 
13,126

 
6,181

 
929

Total impaired loans (excluding PCI)
$
19,464

 
16,347

 
9,078

 
1,443

December 31, 2017
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial
$
3,577

 
2,568

 
2,310

 
462

Real estate mortgage
1,502

 
1,239

 
1,207

 
211

Real estate construction
95

 
54

 
45

 
9

Lease financing
132

 
99

 
89

 
23

Total commercial
5,306

 
3,960

 
3,651

 
705

Consumer:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Real estate 1-4 family first mortgage
14,020

 
12,225

 
6,060

 
770

Real estate 1-4 family junior lien mortgage
2,135

 
1,918

 
1,421

 
245

Credit card
356

 
356

 
356

 
136

Automobile
157

 
87

 
34

 
5

Other revolving credit and installment
136

 
128

 
117

 
29

Total consumer (2)
16,804

 
14,714

 
7,988

 
1,185

Total impaired loans (excluding PCI)
$
22,110

 
18,674

 
11,639

 
1,890

(1)
Excludes the unpaid principal balance for loans that have been fully charged off or otherwise have zero recorded investment.
(2)
Includes the recorded investment of $1.3 billion and $1.4 billion at December 31, 2018 and 2017 , respectively, of government insured/guaranteed loans that are predominantly insured by the FHA or guaranteed by the VA and generally do not have an allowance. Impaired loans may also have limited, if any, allowance when the recorded investment of the loan approximates estimated net realizable value as a result of charge-offs prior to a TDR modification.


180
Wells Fargo & Company
 


Commitments to lend additional funds on loans whose terms have been modified in a TDR amounted to $513 million and $579 million at December 31, 2018 and 2017 , respectively.
Table 6.16 provides the average recorded investment in impaired loans and the amount of interest income recognized on impaired loans by portfolio segment and class.
 
Table 6.16: Average Recorded Investment in Impaired Loans
 
Year ended December 31, 
 
 
2018
 
 
2017
 
 
2016
 
(in millions)
Average recorded investment 

 
Recognized interest income 

 
Average recorded investment 

 
Recognized interest income 

 
Average recorded investment 

 
Recognized interest income 

Commercial:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial
$
2,287

 
173

 
3,241

 
118

 
3,408

 
101

Real estate mortgage
1,193

 
89

 
1,328

 
91

 
1,636

 
128

Real estate construction
60

 
7

 
66

 
14

 
115

 
11

Lease financing
125

 
1

 
105

 
1

 
88

 

Total commercial
3,665

 
270

 
4,740

 
224

 
5,247

 
240

Consumer:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  Real estate 1-4 family first mortgage
11,522

 
664

 
13,326

 
730

 
15,857

 
828

Real estate 1-4 family junior lien mortgage
1,804

 
116

 
2,041

 
121

 
2,294

 
132

Credit card
407

 
50

 
323

 
36

 
295

 
34

Automobile
86

 
11

 
86

 
11

 
93

 
11

Other revolving credit and installment
142

 
10

 
117

 
8

 
89

 
6

Total consumer
13,961

 
851

 
15,893

 
906

 
18,628

 
1,011

Total impaired loans (excluding PCI)
$
17,626

 
1,121

 
20,633

 
1,130

 
23,875

 
1,251

Interest income:
 
 
 
 
 
Cash basis of accounting
$
338

 
299

 
353

Other (1)
783

 
831

 
898

Total interest income
$
1,121

 
1,130

 
1,251

(1)
Includes interest recognized on accruing TDRs, interest recognized related to certain impaired loans which have an allowance calculated using discounting, and amortization of purchase accounting adjustments related to certain impaired loans.

TROUBLED DEBT RESTRUCTURINGS (TDRs)    When, for economic or legal reasons related to a borrower’s financial difficulties, we grant a concession for other than an insignificant period of time to a borrower that we would not otherwise consider, the related loan is classified as a TDR, the balance of which totaled $15.5 billion and $17.8 billion at December 31, 2018 and 2017 , respectively. We do not consider loan resolutions such as foreclosure or short sale to be a TDR.
We may require some consumer borrowers experiencing financial difficulty to make trial payments generally for a period of three to four months, according to the terms of a planned permanent modification, to determine if they can perform according to those terms. These arrangements represent trial modifications, which we classify and account for as TDRs. While loans are in trial payment programs, their original terms are not considered modified and they continue to advance through delinquency status and accrue interest according to their original terms.
 
Table 6.17 summarizes our TDR modifications for the periods presented by primary modification type and includes the financial effects of these modifications. For those loans that modify more than once, the table reflects each modification that occurred during the period. Loans that both modify and pay off within the period, as well as changes in recorded investment during the period for loans modified in prior periods, are not included in the table.

 
Wells Fargo & Company
181


Note 6: Loans and Allowance for Credit Losses (continued)

Table 6.17: TDR Modifications
 
Primary modification type (1) 
 
 
Financial effects of modifications
 
(in millions)
Principal (2) 

 
Interest rate reduction 

 
Other
 concessions (3)

 
Total 

 
Charge- offs (4) 

 
Weighted average interest rate reduction 

 
Recorded investment related to interest rate reduction (5)

Year ended December 31, 2018
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial
$
13

 
29

 
2,310

 
2,352

 
58

 
1.18
%
 
$
29

Real estate mortgage

 
44

 
375

 
419

 

 
0.88

 
44

Real estate construction

 

 
25

 
25

 

 

 

Lease financing

 

 
63

 
63

 

 

 

Total commercial
13

 
73

 
2,773

 
2,859

 
58

 
1.00

 
73

Consumer:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Real estate 1-4 family first mortgage
209

 
26

 
1,042

 
1,277

 
4

 
2.25

 
119

Real estate 1-4 family junior lien mortgage
7

 
41

 
113

 
161

 
5

 
2.14

 
45

Credit card

 
336

 

 
336

 

 
12.54

 
336

Automobile
13

 
16

 
55

 
84

 
30

 
6.21

 
16

Other revolving credit and installment

 
49

 
12

 
61

 

 
7.95

 
49

Trial modifications (6)

 

 
8

 
8

 

 

 

Total consumer
229


468


1,230


1,927


39

 
8.96

 
565

Total
$
242


541


4,003


4,786


97

 
8.06
%
 
$
638

Year ended December 31, 2017
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial
$
24

 
45

 
2,912

 
2,981

 
173

 
0.64
%
 
$
45

Real estate mortgage
5

 
59

 
507

 
571

 
20

 
1.28

 
59

Real estate construction

 
1

 
26

 
27

 

 
0.69

 
1

Lease financing

 

 
37

 
37

 

 

 

Total commercial
29

 
105

 
3,482

 
3,616

 
193

 
1.00

 
105

Consumer:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Real estate 1-4 family first mortgage
231

 
140

 
1,035

 
1,406

 
15

 
2.57

 
257

Real estate 1-4 family junior lien mortgage
25

 
82

 
81

 
188

 
14

 
3.26

 
93

Credit card

 
257

 

 
257

 

 
11.98

 
257

Automobile
2

 
15

 
67

 
84

 
39

 
5.89

 
15

Other revolving credit and installment

 
47

 
8

 
55

 
1

 
7.47

 
47

Trial modifications (6)

 

 
(28
)
 
(28
)
 

 

 

Total consumer
258

 
541

 
1,163

 
1,962

 
69

 
6.70

 
669

Total
$
287

 
646

 
4,645

 
5,578

 
262

 
5.92
%
 
$
774

Year ended December 31, 2016
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial:
 
 
 
 
 
 

 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial
$
42

 
130

 
3,154

 
3,326

 
360

 
1.91
%
 
$
130

Real estate mortgage
2

 
105

 
560

 
667

 
1

 
1.15

 
105

Real estate construction

 
27

 
72

 
99

 

 
1.02

 
27

Lease financing

 

 
8

 
8

 

 

 

Total commercial
44

 
262

 
3,794

 
4,100

 
361

 
1.51

 
262

Consumer:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Real estate 1-4 family first mortgage
338

 
288

 
1,411

 
2,037

 
49

 
2.69

 
507

Real estate 1-4 family junior lien mortgage
23

 
109

 
106

 
238

 
37

 
3.07

 
130

Credit card

 
180

 

 
180

 

 
12.09

 
180

Automobile
2

 
16

 
57

 
75

 
36

 
6.07

 
16

Other revolving credit and installment
1

 
33

 
10

 
44

 
2

 
6.83

 
33

Trial modifications (6)

 

 
44

 
44

 

 

 

Total consumer
364

 
626

 
1,628

 
2,618

 
124

 
4.92

 
866

Total
$
408

 
888

 
5,422

 
6,718

 
485

 
4.13
%
 
$
1,128

(1)
Amounts represent the recorded investment in loans after recognizing the effects of the TDR, if any. TDRs may have multiple types of concessions, but are presented only once in the first modification type based on the order presented in the table above. The reported amounts include loans remodified of $1.9 billion , $2.1 billion and $1.6 billion , for the years ended December 31, 2018 , 2017 , and 2016 , respectively.
(2)
Principal modifications include principal forgiveness at the time of the modification, contingent principal forgiveness granted over the life of the loan based on borrower performance, and principal that has been legally separated and deferred to the end of the loan, with a zero percent contractual interest rate.
(3)
Other concessions include loans discharged in bankruptcy, loan renewals, term extensions and other interest and noninterest adjustments, but exclude modifications that also forgive principal and/or reduce the contractual interest rate.
(4)
Charge-offs include write-downs of the investment in the loan in the period it is contractually modified. The amount of charge-off will differ from the modification terms if the loan has been charged down prior to the modification based on our policies. In addition, there may be cases where we have a charge-off/down with no legal principal modification. Modifications resulted in legally forgiving principal (actual, contingent or deferred) of $28 million , $32 million and $67 million for the years ended December 31, 2018 , 2017 , and 2016 , respectively.
(5)
Reflects the effect of reduced interest rates on loans with an interest rate concession as one of their concession types, which includes loans reported as a principal primary modification type that also have an interest rate concession.
(6)
Trial modifications are granted a delay in payments due under the original terms during the trial payment period. However, these loans continue to advance through delinquency status and accrue interest according to their original terms. Any subsequent permanent modification generally includes interest rate related concessions; however, the exact concession type and resulting financial effect are usually not known until the loan is permanently modified. Trial modifications for the period are presented net of previously reported trial modifications that became permanent in the current period.


182
Wells Fargo & Company
 


Table 6.18 summarizes permanent modification TDRs that have defaulted in the current period within 12 months of their permanent modification date. We are reporting these defaulted TDRs based on a payment default definition of 90 days past due for the commercial portfolio segment and 60 days past due for the consumer portfolio segment.
 



Table 6.18: Defaulted TDRs
 
Recorded investment of defaults 
 
 
Year ended December 31, 
 
(in millions)
2018

 
2017

 
2016

Commercial:
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial
$
198

 
173

 
124

Real estate mortgage
76

 
61

 
66

Real estate construction
36

 
4

 
3

Lease financing

 
1

 

Total commercial
310

 
239

 
193

Consumer:
 
 
 
 
 
Real estate 1-4 family first mortgage
60

 
114

 
138

Real estate 1-4 family junior lien mortgage
14

 
19

 
20

Credit card
79

 
74

 
56

Automobile
14

 
15

 
13

Other revolving credit and installment
6

 
5

 
4

Total consumer
173

 
227

 
231

Total
$
483

 
466

 
424

Purchased Credit-Impaired Loans
Substantially all of our PCI loans were acquired from Wachovia on December 31, 2008, at which time we acquired commercial and consumer loans with a carrying value of $18.7 billion and $40.1 billion , respectively. The unpaid principal balance on December 31, 2008, was $98.2 billion for the total of commercial and consumer PCI loans. Table 6.19 presents PCI loans net of any remaining purchase accounting adjustments. Real estate 1-4 family first mortgage PCI loans are predominantly Pick-a-Pay loans.

Table 6.19: PCI Loans
 
 
Dec 31,

 
Dec 31,

(in millions)
 
2018

 
2017

Total commercial
 
$
4

 
86

Consumer:
 
 
 
 
Real estate 1-4 family first mortgage
 
4,988

 
12,722

Real estate 1-4 family junior lien mortgage
 
17

 
27

Total consumer
 
5,005

 
12,749

Total PCI loans (carrying value)
 
$
5,009

 
12,835

Total PCI loans (unpaid principal balance)
 
$
7,348

 
18,975


 
Wells Fargo & Company
183


Note 6: Loans and Allowance for Credit Losses (continued)

ACCRETABLE YIELD   The excess of cash flows expected to be
collected over the carrying value of PCI loans is referred to as the accretable yield and is recognized in interest income using an effective yield method over the remaining life of the loan, or pools of loans. The accretable yield is affected by:
changes in interest rate indices for variable rate PCI loans – expected future cash flows are based on the variable rates in effect at the time of the regular evaluations of cash flows expected to be collected;
changes in prepayment assumptions – prepayments affect the estimated life of PCI loans which may change the amount of interest income, and possibly principal, expected to be collected; and
 
changes in the expected principal and interest payments over the estimated weighted-average life – updates to expected cash flows are driven by the credit outlook and actions taken with borrowers. Changes in expected future cash flows from loan modifications are included in the regular evaluations of cash flows expected to be collected.
 
The change in the accretable yield related to PCI loans since the merger with Wachovia is presented in Table 6.20 . Changes during 2018 also reflect $2.4 billion in gains on the sale of $6.2 billion Pick-a-Pay PCI loans.
 
Table 6.20: Change in Accretable Yield
(in millions)
2018

 
2017

 
2016

 
2009-2015

Total, beginning of period
$
8,887

 
11,216

 
16,301

 
10,447

Addition of accretable yield due to acquisitions

 
2

 
27

 
132

Accretion into interest income (1)
(1,094
)
 
(1,406
)
 
(1,365
)
 
(14,212
)
Accretion into noninterest income due to sales (2)
(2,374
)
 
(334
)
 
(9
)
 
(458
)
Reclassification from nonaccretable difference for loans with improving credit-related cash flows
403

 
642

 
1,221

 
9,734

Changes in expected cash flows that do not affect nonaccretable difference (3)
(2,789
)
 
(1,233
)
 
(4,959
)
 
10,658

Total, end of period
$
3,033

 
8,887

 
11,216

 
16,301

(1)
Includes accretable yield released as a result of settlements with borrowers, which is included in interest income.
(2)
Includes accretable yield released as a result of sales to third parties, which is included in noninterest income.
(3)
Represents changes in cash flows expected to be collected due to the impact of modifications, changes in prepayment assumptions, changes in interest rates on variable rate PCI loans and sales to third parties.

COMMERCIAL PCI CREDIT QUALITY INDICATORS Table 6.21 provides a breakdown of commercial PCI loans by risk category.

Table 6.21: Commercial PCI Loans by Risk Category
(in millions)
Dec. 31, 2018

 
Dec. 31, 2017

By risk category:
 
 
 
Pass
$
1

 
8

Criticized
3

 
78

Total commercial PCI loans
$
4

 
86



184
Wells Fargo & Company
 


Table 6.22 provides past due information for commercial PCI loans.

Table 6.22: Commercial PCI Loans by Delinquency Status
(in millions)
Dec. 31, 2018

 
Dec. 31, 2017

By delinquency status:
 
 
 
Current-29 DPD and still accruing
$
3

 
86

30-89 DPD and still accruing
1

 

Total commercial PCI loans
$
4

 
86


CONSUMER PCI CREDIT QUALITY INDICATORS   Our consumer PCI loans were aggregated into several pools of loans at acquisition. Below, we have provided credit quality indicators based on the unpaid principal balance (adjusted for write-
 
downs) of the individual loans included in the pool, but we have not allocated the remaining purchase accounting adjustments, which were established at a pool level. Table 6.23 provides the delinquency status of consumer PCI loans.
 
Table 6.23: Consumer PCI Loans by Delinquency Status
 
December 31, 2018
 
 
December 31, 2017
 
(in millions)
Real estate 1-4 family first mortgage 

 
Real estate 1-4 family junior lien mortgage 

 
Total 

 
Real estate 1-4 family first mortgage 

 
Real estate 1-4 family junior lien mortgage 

 
Total 

By delinquency status:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Current-29 DPD and still accruing
$
5,545

 
117

 
5,662

 
13,127

 
138

 
13,265

30-59 DPD and still accruing
495

 
8

 
503

 
1,317

 
8

 
1,325

60-89 DPD and still accruing
229

 
3

 
232

 
622

 
3

 
625

90-119 DPD and still accruing
99

 
2

 
101

 
293

 
2

 
295

120-179 DPD and still accruing
54

 
1

 
55

 
219

 
2

 
221

180+ DPD and still accruing
353

 
3

 
356

 
1,310

 
4

 
1,314

Total consumer PCI loans (adjusted unpaid principal balance)
$
6,775

 
134

 
6,909

 
16,888

 
157

 
17,045

Total consumer PCI loans (carrying value)
$
4,988

 
17

 
5,005

 
12,722

 
27

 
12,749


 
Wells Fargo & Company
185


Note 6: Loans and Allowance for Credit Losses (continued)

Table 6.24 provides FICO scores for consumer PCI loans.  

Table 6.24: Consumer PCI Loans by FICO
 
December 31, 2018
 
 
December 31, 2017
 
(in millions)
Real estate 1-4 family first mortgage 

 
Real estate 1-4 family junior lien mortgage 

 
Total 

 
Real estate 1-4 family first mortgage 

 
Real estate 1-4 family junior lien mortgage 

 
Total 

By FICO:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
< 600
$
1,418

 
27

 
1,445

 
4,014

 
37

 
4,051

600-639
713

 
18

 
731

 
2,086

 
20

 
2,106

640-679
898

 
20

 
918

 
2,393

 
24

 
2,417

680-719
970

 
24

 
994

 
2,242

 
29

 
2,271

720-759
843

 
20

 
863

 
1,779

 
23

 
1,802

760-799
523

 
11

 
534

 
933

 
12

 
945

800+
381

 
6

 
387

 
468

 
6

 
474

No FICO available
1,029

 
8

 
1,037

 
2,973

 
6

 
2,979

Total consumer PCI loans (adjusted unpaid principal balance)
$
6,775

 
134

 
6,909

 
16,888

 
157

 
17,045

Total consumer PCI loans (carrying value)
$
4,988

 
17

 
5,005

 
12,722

 
27

 
12,749

Table 6.25 shows the distribution of consumer PCI loans by LTV for real estate 1-4 family first mortgages and by CLTV for real estate 1-4 family junior lien mortgages.

Table 6.25: Consumer PCI Loans by LTV/CLTV
 
December 31, 2018
 
 
December 31, 2017
 
(in millions)
Real estate 1-4 family first mortgage by LTV

 
Real estate 1-4 family junior lien mortgage by CLTV

 
Total 

 
Real estate 1-4 family first mortgage by LTV

 
Real estate 1-4 family junior lien mortgage by CLTV

 
Total

By LTV/CLTV:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
0-60%
$
3,970

 
44

 
4,014

 
8,010

 
45

 
8,055

60.01-80%
2,161

 
53

 
2,214

 
6,510

 
63

 
6,573

80.01-100%
542

 
28

 
570

 
1,975

 
35

 
2,010

100.01-120% (1)
82

 
8

 
90

 
319

 
10

 
329

> 120% (1)
19

 
1

 
20

 
73

 
3

 
76

No LTV/CLTV available
1

 

 
1

 
1

 
1

 
2

Total consumer PCI loans (adjusted unpaid principal balance)
$
6,775

 
134

 
6,909

 
16,888

 
157

 
17,045

Total consumer PCI loans (carrying value)
$
4,988

 
17

 
5,005

 
12,722

 
27

 
12,749

(1)
Reflects total loan balances with LTV/CLTV amounts in excess of 100%. In the event of default, the loss content would generally be limited to only the amount in excess of 100% LTV/CLTV.



186
Wells Fargo & Company
 


Note 7:   Premises, Equipment, Lease Commitments and Other Assets
Table 7.1: Premises and Equipment
(in millions)
Dec 31, 2018

 
Dec 31, 2017

Land
$
1,757

 
1,799

Buildings
8,974

 
8,865

Furniture and equipment
6,896

 
7,089

Leasehold improvements
2,387

 
2,291

Premises and equipment leased under capital leases
75

 
103

Total premises and equipment
20,089

 
20,147

Less: Accumulated depreciation and amortization
11,169

 
11,300

Net book value, premises and equipment
$
8,920

 
8,847


Depreciation and amortization expense for premises and equipment was $1.3 billion , $1.2 billion and $1.2 billion in 2018 , 2017 and 2016 , respectively.
Dispositions of premises and equipment resulted in net gains of $32 million , $128 million and $44 million in 2018 , 2017 and 2016 , respectively, included in other noninterest expense.
We have obligations under a number of noncancelable operating leases for premises and equipment. The leases predominantly expire over the next fifteen years, with the longest expiring in 2105 , and many provide for periodic adjustment of rentals based on changes in various economic indicators. Some leases also include a renewal option. Table 7.2 provides the future minimum payments of noncancelable operating leases, net of sublease income, with terms greater than one year as of December 31, 2018 .
Table 7.2: Minimum Lease Payments of Operating Leases
(in millions)
 
Year ended December 31,
 
2019
$
1,174

2020
1,056

2021
880

2022
713

2023
577

Thereafter
1,654

Total
$
6,054

Total minimum lease payments for operating leases above are net of $427 million of noncancelable sublease income. Operating lease rental expense (predominantly for premises) was $1.3 billion for the years 2018 2017 and 2016 , net of sublease income of $73 million , $76 million and $86 million for the same years, respectively.
 
Table 7.3 presents the components of other assets.
Table 7.3: Other Assets
(in millions)
Dec 31, 2018

 
Dec 31, 2017

Corporate/bank-owned life insurance
$
19,751

 
19,549

Accounts receivable (1)
34,281

 
39,127

Interest receivable
6,084

 
5,688

Core deposit intangibles

 
769

Customer relationship and other amortized intangibles
545

 
841

Foreclosed assets:
 
 
 
Residential real estate:
 
 
 
Government insured/guaranteed (1)
88

 
120

Non-government insured/guaranteed
229

 
252

Non-residential real estate
134

 
270

Operating lease assets
9,036

 
9,666

Due from customers on acceptances
258

 
177

Other
9,444

 
13,785

Total other assets
$
79,850

 
90,244

(1)
Certain government-guaranteed residential real estate mortgage loans upon foreclosure are included in Accounts receivable. Both principal and interest related to these foreclosed real estate assets are collectible because the loans were predominantly insured by the FHA or guaranteed by the VA. For more information on the classification of certain government-guaranteed mortgage loans upon foreclosure, see Note 1 (Summary of Significant Accounting Policies).


 
Wells Fargo & Company
187


Note 8:    Equity Securities
Table 8.1 provides a summary of our equity securities by business purpose and accounting method, including equity securities with readily determinable fair values (marketable) and those without readily determinable fair values (nonmarketable).
Table 8.1: Equity Securities
(in millions)
Dec 31,
2018

 
Dec 31,
2017

Held for trading at fair value:
 
 
 
Marketable equity securities
$
19,449

 
30,004

Not held for trading:
 
 
 
Fair value:
 
 
 
Marketable equity securities (1)
4,513

 
4,356

Nonmarketable equity securities (2)
5,594

 
4,867

Total equity securities at fair value
10,107

 
9,223

Equity method:
 
 
 
LIHTC (3)
10,999

 
10,269

Private equity
3,832

 
3,839

Tax-advantaged renewable energy
3,073

 
1,950

New market tax credit and other
311

 
294

Total equity method
18,215

 
16,352

Other:
 
 
 
Federal Reserve Bank stock and other at cost (4)
5,643

 
5,828

Private equity (5)
1,734

 
1,090

Total equity securities not held for trading
35,699

 
32,493

Total equity securities (6)
$
55,148

 
62,497

(1)
Includes $3.2 billion and $3.7 billion at December 31, 2018 and 2017 , respectively, related to securities held as economic hedges of our deferred compensation plan obligations.
(2)
Includes $5.5 billion and $4.9 billion at December 31, 2018 and 2017 , respectively, related to investments for which we elected the fair value option. See Note 18 (Fair Value of Assets and Liabilities) for additional information.
(3)
Represents low-income housing tax credit investments.
(4)
Includes $5.6 billion and $5.4 billion at December 31, 2018 and 2017 , respectively, related to investments in Federal Reserve Bank and Federal Home Loan Bank stock.
(5)
Represents nonmarketable equity securities for which we have elected to account for the security under the measurement alternative.
(6)
At December 31, 2018 and 2017 , we held no securities of any single issuer with a book value that exceeded 10% of stockholder’s equity.
Equity Securities Held for Trading
Equity securities held for trading purposes are marketable equity securities traded on organized exchanges. These securities are held as part of our customer accommodation trading activities. For more information on these activities, see Note 4 (Trading Activities).

 
Equity Securities Not Held for Trading
We also hold equity securities unrelated to trading activities. These securities include private equity and tax credit investments, securities held as economic hedges or to meet regulatory requirements (for example, Federal Reserve Bank and Federal Home Loan Bank stock). Equity securities not held for trading purposes are accounted for at either fair value, equity method, cost or the measurement alternative.

FAIR VALUE Marketable equity securities held for purposes other than trading primarily consist of exchange-traded equity funds held to economically hedge obligations related to our deferred compensation plans and to a lesser extent other holdings of publicly traded equity securities held for investment purposes. We have elected to account for nonmarketable equity securities under the fair value method, and substantially all of these securities are economically hedged with equity derivatives.

EQUITY METHOD Our equity method investments consist of tax credit and private equity investments, the majority of which are our low-income housing tax credit (LIHTC) investments.
We invest in affordable housing projects that qualify for the LIHTC, which are designed to promote private development of low-income housing. These investments generate a return mostly through realization of federal tax credit and other tax benefits. We recognized pre-tax losses of $1.2 billion for both 2018 and 2017 , related to our LIHTC investments. These losses were recognized in other noninterest income. We also recognized total tax benefits of $1.5 billion for both 2018 and 2017 , which included tax credits recorded to income taxes of $1.2 billion and $1.1 billion for the same periods, respectively. We are periodically required to provide additional financial support during the investment period. Our liability for unfunded commitments was $3.9 billion and $3.6 billion at December 31, 2018 and 2017 , respectively. Substantially all of this liability is expected to be paid over the next three years . This liability is included in long-term debt.

OTHER The remaining portion of our nonmarketable equity securities portfolio consists of securities accounted for using the cost or measurement alternative method.

188
Wells Fargo & Company
 


Realized Gains and Losses
Table 8.2 provides a summary of the net gains and losses for equity securities. Gains and losses for securities held for trading are reported in net gains from trading activities.
 

Table 8.2: Net Gains (Losses) from Equity Securities
 
Year ended December 31, 
 
(in millions)
2018

 
2017

 
2016

Net gains (losses) from equity securities carried at fair value:
 
 
 
 
 
Marketable equity securities
$
(389
)
 
967

 
525

Nonmarketable equity securities
709

 
1,557

 
(21
)
Total equity securities carried at fair value
320

 
2,524

 
504

Net gains (losses) from nonmarketable equity securities not carried at fair value:
 
 
 
 
 
Impairment write-downs
(352
)
 
(339
)
 
(448
)
Net unrealized gains related to measurement alternative observable transactions
418

 

 

Net realized gains on sale
1,504

 
980

 
849

All other
33

 
97

 
73

Total nonmarketable equity securities not carried at fair value
1,603

 
738

 
474

Net gains (losses) from economic hedge derivatives (1)
(408
)
 
(1,483
)
 
125

Total net gains from equity securities
$
1,515

 
1,779

 
1,103

(1)
Includes net gains (losses) on derivatives not designated as hedging instruments.
Measurement Alternative
Table 8.3 provides additional information about the impairment write-downs and observable price adjustments related to
 
nonmarketable equity securities accounted for under the measurement alternative. Gains and losses related to these adjustments are also included in Table 8.2 .
Table 8.3: Measurement Alternative
 
Year ended December 31, 

(in millions)
2018

Net gains (losses) recognized in earnings during the period:
 
Gross unrealized gains due to observable price changes
$
443

Gross unrealized losses due to observable price changes
(25
)
Impairment write-downs
(33
)
Realized net gains from sale
274

Total net gains recognized during the period
$
659

The cumulative gross unrealized gains and (losses) due to observable price changes as of December 31, 2018 , were $415 million and $(25) million , respectively. Cumulative impairment losses as of December 31, 2018 , were $33 million . These cumulative amounts represent carrying value adjustments to equity securities accounted for under the measurement alternative that were recognized on the balance sheet as of December 31, 2018 .


 
Wells Fargo & Company
189


Note 9: Securitizations and Variable Interest Entities (continued)

Note 9:   Securitizations and Variable Interest Entities 

Involvement with Special Purpose Entities (SPEs)
In the normal course of business, we enter into various types of on- and off-balance sheet transactions with SPEs, which are corporations, trusts, limited liability companies or partnerships that are established for a limited purpose. Generally, SPEs are formed in connection with securitization transactions. In a securitization transaction, assets are transferred to an SPE, which then issues to investors various forms of interests in those assets and may also enter into derivative transactions. In a securitization transaction where we transferred assets from our balance sheet, we typically receive cash and/or other interests in an SPE as proceeds for the assets we transfer. Also, in certain transactions, we may retain the right to service the transferred receivables and to repurchase those receivables from the SPE if the outstanding balance of the receivables falls to a level where the cost exceeds the benefits of servicing such receivables. In addition, we may purchase the right to service loans in an SPE that were transferred to the SPE by a third party.
In connection with our securitization activities, we have various forms of ongoing involvement with SPEs, which may include:
underwriting securities issued by SPEs and subsequently making markets in those securities;
providing liquidity facilities to support short-term obligations of SPEs issued to third-party investors;
providing credit enhancement on securities issued by SPEs or market value guarantees of assets held by SPEs through the use of letters of credit, financial guarantees, credit default swaps and total return swaps;
entering into other derivative contracts with SPEs;
holding senior or subordinated interests in SPEs;
acting as servicer or investment manager for SPEs; and
providing administrative or trustee services to SPEs.

 
SPEs formed in connection with securitization transactions are generally considered variable interest entities (VIEs). SPEs formed for other corporate purposes may be VIEs as well. A VIE is an entity that has either a total equity investment that is insufficient to finance its activities without additional subordinated financial support or whose equity investors lack the ability to control the entity’s activities or lack the ability to receive expected benefits or absorb obligations in a manner that’s consistent with their investment in the entity. A VIE is consolidated by its primary beneficiary, the party that has both the power to direct the activities that most significantly impact the VIE and a variable interest that could potentially be significant to the VIE. A variable interest is a contractual, ownership or other interest whose value changes with changes in the fair value of the VIE’s net assets. To determine whether or not a variable interest we hold could potentially be significant to the VIE, we consider both qualitative and quantitative factors regarding the nature, size and form of our involvement with the VIE. We assess whether or not we are the primary beneficiary of a VIE on an on-going basis.
We have segregated our involvement with VIEs between those VIEs which we consolidate, those which we do not consolidate and those for which we account for the transfers of financial assets as secured borrowings. Secured borrowings are transactions involving transfers of our financial assets to third parties that are accounted for as financings with the assets pledged as collateral. Accordingly, the transferred assets remain recognized on our balance sheet. Subsequent tables within this Note further segregate these transactions by structure type.

190
Wells Fargo & Company
 


Table 9.1 provides the classifications of assets and liabilities in our balance sheet for our transactions with VIEs.  
 


Table 9.1: Balance Sheet Transactions with VIEs
(in millions)
VIEs that we do not consolidate 

 
VIEs that we consolidate 

 
Transfers that we account for as secured borrowings 

 
Total 

December 31, 2018
 
 
 
Cash and due from banks
$

 
139

 

 
139

Interest-earning deposits with banks

 
8

 

 
8

Debt securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  Trading debt securities
2,110

 
45

 
200

 
2,355

  Available-for-sale debt securities (1)
2,686

 

 
317

 
3,003

  Held-to-maturity debt securities
510

 

 

 
510

Loans
1,433

 
13,564

 
94

 
15,091

Mortgage servicing rights
14,761

 

 

 
14,761

Derivative assets
53

 

 

 
53

Equity securities
11,041

 
85

 

 
11,126

Other assets

 
221

 
6

 
227

Total assets
32,594

 
14,062

 
617

 
47,273

Short-term borrowings

 

 
493

 
493

Derivative liabilities
26

 

(2)

 
26

Accrued expenses and other liabilities
231

 
191

(2)
8

 
430

Long-term debt
3,870

 
816

(2)
93

 
4,779

Total liabilities
4,127

 
1,007

 
594

 
5,728

Noncontrolling interests

 
34

 

 
34

Net assets
$
28,467

 
13,021

 
23

 
41,511

December 31, 2017
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Cash and due from banks
$

 
116

 

 
116

Interest-earning deposits with banks

 
371

 

 
371

Debt securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  Trading debt securities
1,305

 

 
201

 
1,506

  Available-for-sale debt securities (1)
3,288

 

 
358

 
3,646

  Held-to-maturity debt securities
485

 

 

 
485

Loans
4,274

 
12,482

 
110

 
16,866

Mortgage servicing rights
13,628

 

 

 
13,628

Derivative assets
44

 

 

 
44

Equity securities
10,740

 
306

 

 
11,046

Other assets

 
342

 
6

 
348

Total assets
33,764

 
13,617

 
675

 
48,056

Short-term borrowings

 

 
522

 
522

Derivative liabilities
106

 
5

(2)

 
111

Accrued expenses and other liabilities
244

 
132

(2)
10

 
386

Long-term debt
3,590

 
1,479

(2)
111

 
5,180

Total liabilities
3,940

 
1,616

 
643

 
6,199

Noncontrolling interests

 
283

 

 
283

Net assets
$
29,824

 
11,718

 
32

 
41,574

(1)
Excludes certain debt securities related to loans serviced for the Federal National Mortgage Association (FNMA), Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation (FHLMC) and GNMA.
(2)
There were no VIE liabilities with recourse to the general credit of Wells Fargo for the periods presented.

Transactions with Unconsolidated VIEs
Our transactions with unconsolidated VIEs include securitizations of residential mortgage loans, CRE loans, student loans, automobile loans and leases, certain dealer floorplan loans; investment and financing activities involving collateralized debt obligations (CDOs) backed by asset-backed and CRE securities, tax credit structures, collateralized loan obligations (CLOs) backed by corporate loans, and other types of
 
structured financing. We have various forms of involvement with VIEs, including servicing, holding senior or subordinated interests, entering into liquidity arrangements, credit default swaps and other derivative contracts. Involvements with these unconsolidated VIEs are recorded on our balance sheet in debt and equity securities, loans, MSRs, derivative assets and liabilities, other assets, other liabilities, and long-term debt, as appropriate.

 
Wells Fargo & Company
191


Note 9: Securitizations and Variable Interest Entities (continued)

Table 9.2 provides a summary of unconsolidated VIEs with which we have significant continuing involvement, but we are not the primary beneficiary. We do not consider our continuing involvement in an unconsolidated VIE to be significant when it relates to third-party sponsored VIEs for which we were not the transferor (unless we are servicer and have other significant forms of involvement) or if we were the sponsor only or sponsor and servicer but do not have any other forms of significant involvement.
Significant continuing involvement includes transactions where we were the sponsor or transferor and have other significant forms of involvement. Sponsorship includes transactions with unconsolidated VIEs where we solely or materially participated in the initial design or structuring of the entity or marketing of the transaction to investors. When we transfer assets to a VIE and account for the transfer as a sale, we
 
are considered the transferor. We consider investments in securities (other than those held temporarily in trading), loans, guarantees, liquidity agreements, written options and servicing of collateral to be other forms of involvement that may be significant. We have excluded certain transactions with unconsolidated VIEs from the balances presented in the following table where we have determined that our continuing involvement is not significant due to the temporary nature and size of our variable interests, because we were not the transferor or because we were not involved in the design of the unconsolidated VIEs. We also exclude from the table secured borrowing transactions with unconsolidated VIEs (for information on these transactions, see the Transactions with Consolidated VIEs and Secured Borrowings section in this Note).
Table 9.2: Unconsolidated VIEs
 
 
 
Carrying value  asset (liability) 
 
(in millions)
Total
VIE
assets 

 
Debt and equity interests (1) 

 
Servicing assets 

 
Derivatives 

 
Other commitments and guarantees 

 
Net assets 

December 31, 2018
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Residential mortgage loan securitizations:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Conforming (2)
$
1,172,833

 
2,377

 
13,811

 

 
(171
)
 
16,017

Other/nonconforming
10,596

 
453

 
57

 

 

 
510

Commercial mortgage securitizations
153,350

 
2,409

 
893

 
(22
)
 
(40
)
 
3,240

Collateralized debt obligations:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Debt securities
659

 

 

 
5

 
(20
)
 
(15
)
Loans (3)

 

 

 

 

 

Asset-based finance structures
304

 
205

 

 

 

 
205

Tax credit structures
35,185

 
12,087

 

 

 
(3,870
)
 
8,217

Collateralized loan obligations
2

 

 

 

 

 

Investment funds
185

 
42

 

 

 

 
42

Other (4)
1,688

 
207

 

 
44

 

 
251

Total
$
1,374,802

 
17,780

 
14,761

 
27

 
(4,101
)
 
28,467

 
 
 
Maximum exposure to loss 
 
 
 
 
Debt and equity interests (1) 

 
Servicing assets 

 
Derivatives 

 
Other commitments and guarantees 

 
Total exposure 

Residential mortgage loan securitizations:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Conforming
 
 
$
2,377

 
13,811

 

 
1,183

 
17,371

Other/nonconforming
 
 
453

 
57

 

 

 
510

Commercial mortgage securitizations
 
 
2,409

 
893

 
28

 
11,563

 
14,893

Collateralized debt obligations:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Debt securities
 
 

 

 
5

 
20

 
25

Loans (3)
 
 

 

 

 

 

Asset-based finance structures
 
 
205

 

 

 
71

 
276

Tax credit structures
 
 
12,087

 

 

 
1,420

 
13,507

Collateralized loan obligations
 
 

 

 

 

 

Investment funds
 
 
42

 

 

 

 
42

Other (4)
 
 
207

 

 
45

 
158

 
410

Total


 
$
17,780

 
14,761

 
78

 
14,415

 
47,034


(continued on following page)

192
Wells Fargo & Company
 


(continued from previous page)

 
 
Carrying value - asset (liability) 
 
(in millions)
Total
VIE
assets

Debt and equity interests (1) 

 
Servicing assets 

 
Derivatives 

 
Other commitments and guarantees 

 
Net assets 

December 31, 2017
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Residential mortgage loan securitizations:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Conforming (2)
$
1,169,410

2,100

 
12,665

 

 
(190
)
 
14,575

Other/nonconforming
14,175

598

 
73

 

 

 
671

Commercial mortgage securitizations
144,650

2,198

 
890

 
28

 
(34
)
 
3,082

Collateralized debt obligations:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Debt securities
1,031


 

 
5

 
(20
)
 
(15
)
Loans (3)
1,481

1,443

 

 

 

 
1,443

Asset-based finance structures
2,333

1,867

 

 

 

 
1,867

Tax credit structures
31,852

11,258

 

 

 
(3,590
)
 
7,668

Collateralized loan obligations
23

1

 

 

 

 
1

Investment funds
225

50

 

 

 

 
50

Other (4)
2,257

577

 

 
(95
)
 

 
482

Total
$
1,367,437

20,092

 
13,628

 
(62
)
 
(3,834
)
 
29,824

 
 
Maximum exposure to loss 
 
 
 
Debt and equity interests (1) 

 
Servicing assets 

 
Derivatives 

 
Other commitments and guarantees 

 
Total exposure

Residential mortgage loan securitizations:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Conforming
 
$
2,100

 
12,665

 

 
1,137

 
15,902

Other/nonconforming
 
598

 
73

 

 

 
671

Commercial mortgage securitizations
 
2,198

 
890

 
42

 
10,202

 
13,332

Collateralized debt obligations:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Debt securities
 

 

 
5

 
20

 
25

Loans (3)
 
1,443

 

 

 

 
1,443

Asset-based finance structures
 
1,867

 

 

 
71

 
1,938

Tax credit structures
 
11,258

 

 

 
1,175

 
12,433

Collateralized loan obligations
 
1

 

 

 

 
1

Investment funds
 
50

 

 

 

 
50

Other (4)
 
577

 

 
120

 
157

 
854

Total
 
$
20,092

 
13,628

 
167

 
12,762

 
46,649

(1)
Includes total equity interests of $11.0 billion and $10.7 billion at December 31, 2018 and 2017 , respectively. Also includes debt interests in the form of both loans and securities. Excludes certain debt securities held related to loans serviced for FNMA, FHLMC and GNMA.
(2)
Excludes assets and related liabilities with a recorded carrying value on our balance sheet of $1.2 billion and $2.2 billion at December 31, 2018 and 2017 , respectively, for certain delinquent loans that are eligible for repurchase from GNMA loan securitizations. The recorded carrying value represents the amount that would be payable if the Company was to exercise the repurchase option. The carrying amounts are excluded from the table because the loans eligible for repurchase do not represent interests in the VIEs.
(3)
Represents senior loans to trusts that are collateralized by asset-backed securities. The trusts invested in senior tranches from a diversified pool of U.S. asset securitizations, of which all were current and 100% were rated as investment grade by the primary rating agencies at December 31, 2017 . These senior loans were accounted for at amortized cost and were subject to the Company’s allowance and credit charge-off policies. The securitization was terminated in first quarter 2018.
(4)
Includes structured financing and credit-linked note structures. At December 31, 2017, also contains investments in auction rate securities (ARS) issued by VIEs that we did not sponsor and, accordingly, are unable to obtain the total assets of the entity.

In Table 9.2, “Total VIE assets” represents the remaining principal balance of assets held by unconsolidated VIEs using the most current information available. For VIEs that obtain exposure to assets synthetically through derivative instruments, the remaining notional amount of the derivative is included in the asset balance. “Carrying value” is the amount in our consolidated balance sheet related to our involvement with the unconsolidated VIEs. “Maximum exposure to loss” from our involvement with off-balance sheet entities, which is a required disclosure under GAAP, is determined as the carrying value of our involvement with off-balance sheet (unconsolidated) VIEs plus the remaining undrawn liquidity and lending commitments, the notional amount of net written derivative contracts, and generally the notional amount of, or stressed loss estimate for, other commitments and guarantees. It represents estimated loss
 
that would be incurred under severe, hypothetical circumstances, for which we believe the possibility is extremely remote, such as where the value of our interests and any associated collateral declines to zero, without any consideration of recovery or offset from any economic hedges. Accordingly, this required disclosure is not an indication of expected loss.
 
RESIDENTIAL MORTGAGE LOANS   Residential mortgage loan securitizations are financed through the issuance of fixed-rate or floating-rate asset-backed securities, which are collateralized by the loans transferred to a VIE. We typically transfer loans we originated to these VIEs, account for the transfers as sales, retain the right to service the loans and may hold other beneficial interests issued by the VIEs. We also may be exposed to limited liability related to recourse agreements and repurchase

 
Wells Fargo & Company
193


Note 9: Securitizations and Variable Interest Entities (continued)

agreements we make to our issuers and purchasers, which are included in other commitments and guarantees. In certain instances, we may service residential mortgage loan securitizations structured by third parties whose loans we did not originate or transfer. Our residential mortgage loan securitizations consist of conforming and nonconforming securitizations.
Conforming residential mortgage loan securitizations are those that are guaranteed by the GSEs, including GNMA. Because of the power of the GSEs over the VIEs that hold the assets from these conforming residential mortgage loan securitizations, we do not consolidate them.
The loans sold to the VIEs in nonconforming residential mortgage loan securitizations are those that do not qualify for a GSE guarantee. We may hold variable interests issued by the VIEs, including senior securities. We do not consolidate the nonconforming residential mortgage loan securitizations included in the table because we either do not hold any variable interests, hold variable interests that we do not consider potentially significant or are not the primary servicer for a majority of the VIE assets.
Other commitments and guarantees include amounts related to loans sold that we may be required to repurchase, or otherwise indemnify or reimburse the investor or insurer for losses incurred, due to material breach of contractual representations and warranties as well as other retained recourse arrangements. The maximum exposure to loss for material breach of contractual representations and warranties represents a stressed case estimate we utilize for determining stressed case regulatory capital needs and is considered to be a remote scenario.
 
COMMERCIAL MORTGAGE LOAN SECURITIZATIONS Commercial mortgage loan securitizations are financed through the issuance of fixed or floating-rate asset-backed securities, which are collateralized by the loans transferred to the VIE. In a typical securitization, we may transfer loans we originate to these VIEs, account for the transfers as sales, retain the right to service the loans and may hold other beneficial interests issued by the VIEs. In certain instances, we may service commercial mortgage loan securitizations structured by third parties whose loans we did not originate or transfer. We typically serve as primary or master servicer of these VIEs. The primary or master servicer in a commercial mortgage loan securitization typically cannot make the most significant decisions impacting the performance of the VIE and therefore does not have power over the VIE. We do not consolidate the commercial mortgage loan securitizations included in the disclosure because we either do not have power or do not have a variable interest that could potentially be significant to the VIE.
 
COLLATERALIZED DEBT OBLIGATIONS (CDOs)   A CDO is a securitization where a VIE purchases a pool of assets consisting of asset-backed securities and issues multiple tranches of equity or notes to investors. In some CDOs, a portion of the assets are obtained synthetically through the use of derivatives such as credit default swaps or total return swaps.
In addition to our role as arranger, we may have other forms of involvement with these CDOs. Such involvement may include acting as liquidity provider, derivative counterparty, secondary market maker or investor. For certain CDOs, we may also act as the collateral manager or servicer. We receive fees in connection with our role as collateral manager or servicer.
We assess whether we are the primary beneficiary of CDOs based on our role in them in combination with the variable
 
interests we hold. Subsequently, we monitor our ongoing involvement to determine if the nature of our involvement has changed. We are not the primary beneficiary of these CDOs in most cases because we do not act as the collateral manager or servicer, which generally denotes power. In cases where we are the collateral manager or servicer, we are not the primary beneficiary because we do not hold interests that could potentially be significant to the VIE.
 
COLLATERALIZED LOAN OBLIGATIONS (CLOs)   A CLO is a securitization where an SPE purchases a pool of assets consisting of loans and issues multiple tranches of equity or notes to investors. Generally, CLOs are structured on behalf of a third-party asset manager that typically selects and manages the assets for the term of the CLO. Typically, the asset manager has the power over the significant decisions of the VIE through its discretion to manage the assets of the CLO. We assess whether we are the primary beneficiary of CLOs based on our role in them and the variable interests we hold. In most cases, we are not the primary beneficiary because we do not have the power to manage the collateral in the VIE.
In addition to our role as arranger, we may have other forms of involvement with these CLOs. Such involvement may include acting as underwriter, derivative counterparty, secondary market maker or investor. For certain CLOs, we may also act as the servicer, for which we receive fees in connection with that role. We also earn fees for arranging these CLOs and distributing the securities.
 
ASSET-BASED FINANCE STRUCTURES   We engage in various forms of structured finance arrangements with VIEs that are collateralized by various asset classes including energy contracts, automobile and other transportation loans and leases, intellectual property, equipment and general corporate credit. We typically provide senior financing, and may act as an interest rate swap or commodity derivative counterparty when necessary. In most cases, we are not the primary beneficiary of these structures because we do not have power over the significant activities of the VIEs involved in them.
For example, we have investments in asset-backed securities that are collateralized by automobile leases or loans and cash. These fixed-rate and variable-rate securities have been structured as single-tranche, fully amortizing, unrated bonds that are equivalent to investment-grade securities due to their significant overcollateralization. The securities are issued by VIEs that have been formed by third-party automobile financing institutions primarily because they require a source of liquidity to fund ongoing vehicle sales operations. The third-party automobile financing institutions manage the collateral in the VIEs, which is indicative of power in them and we therefore do not consolidate these VIEs.

TAX CREDIT STRUCTURES   We co-sponsor and make investments in affordable housing and sustainable energy projects that are designed to generate a return primarily through the realization of federal tax credits. In some instances, our investments in these structures may require that we fund future capital commitments at the discretion of the project sponsors. While the size of our investment in a single entity may at times exceed 50% of the outstanding equity interests, we do not consolidate these structures due to the project sponsor’s ability to manage the projects, which is indicative of power in them.
 

194
Wells Fargo & Company
 


INVESTMENT FUNDS   We voluntarily waived a portion of our management fees for certain money market funds that are exempt from the consolidation analysis to ensure the funds maintained a minimum level of daily net investment income. The amount of fees waived in 2018 , 2017 and 2016 was $45 million , $53 million , and $109 million , respectively.

OTHER TRANSACTIONS WITH VIEs  Other VIEs include certain entities that issue auction rate securities (ARS) which are debt instruments with long-term maturities, that re-price more frequently, and preferred equities with no maturity. At December 31, 2018 , we held no ARS issued by VIEs, compared with $400 million at December 31, 2017 . We acquired the ARS pursuant to agreements entered into in 2008 and 2009. All ARS were sold during 2018.
We did not consolidate the VIEs that issued the ARS because we did not have power over the activities of the VIEs.

TRUST PREFERRED SECURITIES   VIEs that we wholly own issue debt securities or preferred equity to third-party investors. All of the proceeds of the issuance are invested in debt securities or preferred equity that we issue to the VIEs. The VIEs’ operations and cash flows relate only to the issuance, administration and repayment of the securities held by third parties. We do not consolidate these VIEs because the sole assets of the VIEs are receivables from us, even though we own all of the voting equity shares of the VIEs, have fully guaranteed the obligations of the VIEs and may have the right to redeem the
 
third-party securities under certain circumstances. In our consolidated balance sheet at December 31, 2018 and 2017 , we reported the debt securities issued to the VIEs as long-term junior subordinated debt with a carrying value of $2.0 billion at both dates, and the preferred equity securities issued to the VIEs as preferred stock with a carrying value of $2.5 billion at both dates. These amounts are in addition to the involvements in these VIEs included in the preceding table.
In 2017, we redeemed $150 million of trust preferred securities which were partially included in Tier 2 capital (50% credit in 2017) in the transitional framework and were not included under the fully-phased framework under the Basel III standards.
 
Loan Sales and Securitization Activity
We periodically transfer consumer and CRE loans and other types of financial assets in securitization and whole loan sale transactions. We typically retain the servicing rights from these sales and may continue to hold other beneficial interests in the transferred financial assets. We may also provide liquidity to investors in the beneficial interests and credit enhancements in the form of standby letters of credit. Through these transfers we may be exposed to liability under limited amounts of recourse as well as standard representations and warranties we make to purchasers and issuers. Table 9.3 presents the cash flows for our transfers accounted for as sales in which we have a continuing involvement with the transferred financial assets.
Table 9.3: Cash Flows From Sales and Securitization Activity
 
Year ended December 31,
 
 
2018
 
 
2017
 
 
2016
 
(in millions)
Mortgage loans 

 
Other financial assets

 
Mortgage loans 

 
Other financial assets 

 
Mortgage loans 

 
Other financial assets 

Proceeds from securitizations and whole loan sales
$
193,721

 

 
228,282

 
25

 
252,723

 
347

Fees from servicing rights retained
3,337

 

 
3,352

 

 
3,492

 

Cash flows from other interests held (1)
698

 
1

 
2,218

 
1

 
2,898

 
1

Repurchases of assets/loss reimbursements (2):
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Non-agency securitizations and whole loan transactions
3

 

 
12

 

 
26

 

Agency securitizations (3)
96

 

 
92

 

 
133

 

Servicing advances, net of repayments
(154
)
 

 
(269
)
 

 
(218
)
 

(1)
Cash flows from other interests held include principal and interest payments received on retained bonds and excess cash flows received on interest-only strips.
(2)
Consists of cash paid to repurchase loans from investors and cash paid to investors to reimburse them for losses on individual loans that are already liquidated. In addition, during 2018 and 2017 , we paid nothing to third-party investors to settle repurchase liabilities on pools of loans, compared with $11 million in 2016 .
(3)
Represent loans repurchased from GNMA, FNMA, and FHLMC under representation and warranty provisions included in our loan sales contracts. Excludes $7.8 billion in delinquent insured/guaranteed loans that we service and have exercised our option to purchase out of GNMA pools in 2018 , compared with $8.6 billion and $9.9 billion in 2017 and 2016 , respectively. These loans are predominantly insured by the FHA or guaranteed by the VA.

 

 
Wells Fargo & Company
195


Note 9: Securitizations and Variable Interest Entities (continued)

In 2018 , 2017 , and 2016 , we recognized net gains of $270 million , $701 million and $524 million , respectively, from transfers accounted for as sales of financial assets, in which we have a continuing involvement with the transferred assets. These net gains largely relate to commercial mortgage securitizations, and residential mortgage securitizations where the loans were not already carried at fair value.
Sales with continuing involvement during 2018 , 2017 and 2016 largely related to securitizations of residential mortgages that are sold to the government-sponsored entities (GSEs), including FNMA, FHLMC and GNMA (conforming residential mortgage securitizations). During 2018 , 2017 and 2016 we transferred $177.8 billion , $213.6 billion and $236.6 billion , respectively, in fair value of residential mortgages to unconsolidated VIEs and third-party investors and recorded the transfers as sales. Substantially all of these transfers did not result in a gain or loss because the loans were already carried at fair value. In connection with all of these transfers, in 2018 we recorded a $1.9 billion servicing asset, measured at fair value using a Level 3 measurement technique, securities of $5.0 billion , classified as Level 2, and a $17 million liability for repurchase losses which reflects management’s estimate of probable losses related to various representations and warranties for the loans transferred, initially measured at fair value. In 2017 , we recorded a $2.1 billion servicing asset, securities of $1.4 billion and a $24 million liability. In 2016 , we recorded a $2.1 billion servicing asset, securities of $4.4 billion and a $36 million liability.
Table 9.4 presents the key weighted-average assumptions we used to measure residential mortgage servicing rights at the date of securitization.

Table 9.4: Residential Mortgage Servicing Rights
 
Residential mortgage servicing rights 
 
 
2018

 
2017

 
2016

Year ended December 31,
 
 
 
 
 
Prepayment speed (1)
10.6
%
 
11.5

 
11.7

Discount rate
7.4

 
7.0

 
6.5

Cost to service ($ per loan) (2)
$
128

 
132

 
132

(1)
The prepayment speed assumption for residential mortgage servicing rights includes a blend of prepayment speeds and default rates. Prepayment speed assumptions are influenced by mortgage interest rate inputs as well as our estimation of drivers of borrower behavior.
(2)
Includes costs to service and unreimbursed foreclosure costs, which can vary period to period depending on the mix of modified government-guaranteed loans sold to GNMA.

 
During 2018 , 2017 and 2016 , we transferred $17.9 billion , $16.7 billion and $18.3 billion , respectively, in carrying value of commercial mortgages to unconsolidated VIEs and third-party investors and recorded the transfers as sales. These transfers resulted in gains of $280 million in 2018 , $359 million in 2017 and $429 million in 2016 , respectively, because the loans were carried at lower of cost or fair value (LOCOM). In connection with these transfers, in 2018 we recorded a servicing asset of $158 million , initially measured at fair value using a Level 3 measurement technique, and securities of $81 million , classified as Level 2. In 2017 , we recorded a servicing asset of $166 million and securities of $65 million . In 2016 , we recorded a servicing asset of $270 million and securities of $258 million .

Retained Interests from Unconsolidated VIEs
Table 9.5 provides key economic assumptions and the sensitivity of the current fair value of residential mortgage servicing rights and other interests held to immediate adverse changes in those assumptions. “Other interests held” relate to residential and commercial mortgage loan securitizations. Residential mortgage-backed securities retained in securitizations issued through GSEs, such as FNMA, FHLMC and GNMA, are excluded from the table because these securities have a remote risk of credit loss due to the GSE guarantee. These securities also have economic characteristics similar to GSE mortgage-backed securities that we purchase, which are not included in the table. Subordinated interests include only those bonds whose credit rating was below AAA by a major rating agency at issuance. Senior interests include only those bonds whose credit rating was AAA by a major rating agency at issuance. The information presented excludes trading positions held in inventory.

196
Wells Fargo & Company
 


Table 9.5: Retained Interests from Unconsolidated VIEs
 
 
 
Other interests held
 
 
Residential mortgage servicing rights (1) 

 
Interest-only strips 

 
Commercial (2)
 
($ in millions, except cost to service amounts)
 
 
Subordinated bonds

 
Senior bonds

Fair value of interests held at December 31, 2018
$
14,649

 
16

 
668

 
309

Expected weighted-average life (in years)
6.5

 
3.6

 
7.0

 
5.7

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Key economic assumptions:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Prepayment speed assumption (3)
9.9
%
 
17.7

 
 
 
 
Decrease in fair value from:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
10% adverse change
$
530

 
1

 
 
 
 
25% adverse change
1,301

 
1

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Discount rate assumption
8.1
%
 
14.5

 
4.3

 
3.7

Decrease in fair value from:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
100 basis point increase
$
615

 

 
37

 
14

200 basis point increase
1,176

 
1

 
72

 
28

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Cost to service assumption ($ per loan)
106

 
 
 
 
 
 
Decrease in fair value from:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
10% adverse change
316

 
 
 
 
 
 
25% adverse change
787

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Credit loss assumption
 
 
 
 
5.1
%
 

Decrease in fair value from:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
10% higher losses
 
 
 
 
$
2

 

25% higher losses
 
 
 
 
5

 

Fair value of interests held at December 31, 2017
$
13,625

 
19

 
596

 
468

Expected weighted-average life (in years)
6.2

 
3.3

 
6.7

 
5.2

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Key economic assumptions:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Prepayment speed assumption (3)
10.5
%
 
20.0

 
 
 
 
Decrease in fair value from:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
10% adverse change
$
565

 
1

 
 
 
 
25% adverse change
1,337

 
2

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Discount rate assumption
6.9
%
 
14.8

 
4.1

 
3.1

Decrease in fair value from:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
100 basis point increase
$
652

 

 
32

 
20

200 basis point increase
1,246

 
1

 
61

 
39

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Cost to service assumption ($ per loan)
143

 
 
 
 
 
 
Decrease in fair value from:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
10% adverse change
467

 
 
 
 
 
 
25% adverse change
1,169

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Credit loss assumption
 
 
 
 
1.8
%
 

Decrease in fair value from:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
10% higher losses
 
 
 
 
$

 

25% higher losses
 
 
 
 

 

(1)
See narrative following this table for a discussion of commercial mortgage servicing rights.
(2)
Prepayment speed assumptions do not significantly impact the value of commercial mortgage securitization bonds as the underlying commercial mortgage loans experience significantly lower prepayments due to certain contractual restrictions, impacting the borrower’s ability to prepay the mortgage.
(3)
The prepayment speed assumption for residential mortgage servicing rights includes a blend of prepayment speeds and default rates. Prepayment speed assumptions are influenced by mortgage interest rate inputs as well as our estimation of drivers of borrower behavior.

 
Wells Fargo & Company
197


Note 9: Securitizations and Variable Interest Entities (continued)

In addition to residential mortgage servicing rights (MSRs) included in the previous table, we have a small portfolio of commercial MSRs with a fair value of $2.3 billion and
$2.0 billion at December 31, 2018 and 2017 , respectively. The nature of our commercial MSRs, which are carried at LOCOM, is different from our residential MSRs. Prepayment activity on serviced loans does not significantly impact the value of commercial MSRs because, unlike residential mortgages, commercial mortgages experience significantly lower prepayments due to certain contractual restrictions, impacting the borrower’s ability to prepay the mortgage. Additionally, for our commercial MSR portfolio, we are typically master/primary servicer, but not the special servicer, who is separately responsible for the servicing and workout of delinquent and foreclosed loans. It is the special servicer, similar to our role as servicer of residential mortgage loans, who is affected by higher servicing and foreclosure costs due to an increase in delinquent and foreclosed loans. Accordingly, prepayment speeds and costs to service are not key assumptions for commercial MSRs as they do not significantly impact the valuation. The primary economic driver impacting the fair value of our commercial MSRs is forward interest rates, which are derived from market observable yield curves used to price capital markets instruments. Market interest rates significantly affect interest earned on custodial deposit balances. The sensitivity of the current fair value to an immediate adverse 25% change in the assumption about interest earned on deposit balances at December 31, 2018 and 2017 , results in a decrease in fair value of $320 million and $278 million , respectively. See Note 10
 
(Mortgage Banking Activities) for further information on our commercial MSRs.
The sensitivities in the preceding paragraph and table are hypothetical and caution should be exercised when relying on this data. Changes in value based on variations in assumptions generally cannot be extrapolated because the relationship of the change in the assumption to the change in value may not be linear. Also, the effect of a variation in a particular assumption on the value of the other interests held is calculated independently without changing any other assumptions. In reality, changes in one factor may result in changes in others (for example, changes in prepayment speed estimates could result in changes in the credit losses), which might magnify or counteract the sensitivities.

Off-Balance Sheet Loans
Table 9.6 presents information about the principal balances of off-balance sheet loans that were sold or securitized, including residential mortgage loans sold to FNMA, FHLMC, GNMA and other investors, for which we have some form of continuing involvement (including servicer). Delinquent loans include loans 90 days or more past due and loans in bankruptcy, regardless of delinquency status. For loans sold or securitized where servicing is our only form of continuing involvement, we would only experience a loss if we were required to repurchase a delinquent loan or foreclosed asset due to a breach in representations and warranties associated with our loan sale or servicing contracts.

Table 9.6: Off-Balance Sheet Loans Sold or Securitized
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net charge-offs 
 
 
Total loans
 
 
Delinquent loans and foreclosed assets (1)
 
 
Year ended 
 
 
December 31, 
 
 
December 31, 
 
 
December 31, 
 
(in millions)
2018

 
2017

 
2018

 
2017

 
2018

 
2017

Commercial:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Real estate mortgage
$
105,173

 
100,875

 
1,008

 
2,839

 
739

 
1,027

Total commercial
105,173

 
100,875

 
1,008

 
2,839

 
739

 
1,027

Consumer:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Real estate 1-4 family first mortgage
1,097,128

 
1,126,208

 
8,947

 
13,393

 
466

 
735

Total consumer
1,097,128

 
1,126,208

 
8,947

 
13,393

 
466

 
735

Total off-balance sheet sold or securitized loans (2)
$
1,202,301

 
1,227,083

 
9,955

 
16,232

 
1,205

 
1,762

(1)
Includes $675 million and $1.2 billion of commercial foreclosed assets and $582 million and $879 million of consumer foreclosed assets at December 31, 2018 and 2017 , respectively.
(2)
At December 31, 2018 and 2017 , the table includes total loans of $1.1 trillion at both dates, delinquent loans of $6.4 billion and $9.1 billion , and foreclosed assets of $442 million and $619 million , respectively, for FNMA, FHLMC and GNMA. Net charge-offs exclude loans sold to FNMA, FHLMC and GNMA as we do not service or manage the underlying real estate upon foreclosure and, as such, do not have access to net charge-off information.

198
Wells Fargo & Company
 


Transactions with Consolidated VIEs and Secured Borrowings
Table 9.7 presents a summary of financial assets and liabilities for asset transfers accounted for as secured borrowings and involvements with consolidated VIEs. Carrying values of “Assets” are presented using GAAP measurement methods, which may include fair value, credit impairment or other
 
adjustments, and therefore in some instances will differ from “Total VIE assets.” For VIEs that obtain exposure synthetically through derivative instruments, the remaining notional amount of the derivative is included in “Total VIE assets.” On the consolidated balance sheet, we separately disclose the consolidated assets of certain VIEs that can only be used to settle the liabilities of those VIEs.

Table 9.7: Transactions with Consolidated VIEs and Secured Borrowings
 
 
 
Carrying value
 
(in millions)
Total VIE assets 

 
Assets

 
Liabilities 

 
Noncontrolling interests 

 
Net assets 

December 31, 2018
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Secured borrowings:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Municipal tender option bond securitizations
$
627

 
523

 
(501
)
 

 
22

Residential mortgage securitizations
95

 
94

 
(93
)
 

 
1

Total secured borrowings
722

 
617

 
(594
)
 

 
23

Consolidated VIEs:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial loans and leases
8,215

 
8,204

 
(477
)
 
(14
)
 
7,713

Nonconforming residential mortgage loan securitizations
1,947

 
1,732

 
(521
)
 

 
1,211

Commercial real estate loans
3,957

 
3,957

 

 

 
3,957

Structured asset finance

 

 

 

 

Investment funds
155

 
155

 
(5
)
 
(15
)
 
135

Other
14

 
14

 
(4
)
 
(5
)
 
5

Total consolidated VIEs
14,288

 
14,062

 
(1,007
)
 
(34
)
 
13,021

Total secured borrowings and consolidated VIEs
$
15,010

 
14,679

 
(1,601
)
 
(34
)
 
13,044

December 31, 2017
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Secured borrowings:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Municipal tender option bond securitizations
$
658

 
565

 
(532
)
 

 
33

Residential mortgage securitizations
113

 
110

 
(111
)
 

 
(1
)
Total secured borrowings
771

 
675

 
(643
)
 

 
32

Consolidated VIEs:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial loans and leases
9,116

 
8,626

 
(915
)
 
(29
)
 
7,682

Nonconforming residential mortgage loan securitizations
2,515

 
2,212

 
(694
)
 

 
1,518

Commercial real estate loans
2,378

 
2,378

 

 

 
2,378

Structured asset finance
10

 
6

 
(4
)
 

 
2

Investment funds
305

 
305

 
(2
)
 
(230
)
 
73

Other
100

 
90

 
(1
)
 
(24
)
 
65

Total consolidated VIEs
14,424

 
13,617

 
(1,616
)
 
(283
)
 
11,718

Total secured borrowings and consolidated VIEs
$
15,195

 
14,292

 
(2,259
)
 
(283
)
 
11,750

We have raised financing through the securitization of certain financial assets in transactions with VIEs accounted for as secured borrowings. We also consolidate VIEs where we are the primary beneficiary. In certain transactions, we provide contractual support in the form of limited recourse and liquidity to facilitate the remarketing of short-term securities issued to third-party investors. Other than this limited contractual support, the assets of the VIEs are the sole source of repayment of the securities held by third parties.
 
MUNICIPAL TENDER OPTION BOND SECURITIZATIONS   As part of our normal investment portfolio activities, we consolidate municipal bond trusts that hold highly rated, long-term, fixed-rate municipal bonds, the majority of which are rated AA or better. Our residual interests in these trusts generally allow us to capture the economics of owning the securities outright, and constructively make decisions that significantly impact the economic performance of the municipal bond vehicle, primarily by directing the sale of the municipal bonds owned by the
 
vehicle. In addition, the residual interest owners have the right to receive benefits and bear losses that are proportional to owning the underlying municipal bonds in the trusts. The trusts obtain financing by issuing floating-rate trust certificates that reprice on a weekly or other basis to third-party investors. Under certain conditions, if we elect to terminate the trusts and withdraw the underlying assets, the third-party investors are entitled to a small portion of any unrealized gain on the underlying assets. We may serve as remarketing agent and/or liquidity provider for the trusts. The floating-rate investors have the right to tender the certificates at specified dates, often with as little as seven days’ notice. Should we be unable to remarket the tendered certificates, we are generally obligated to purchase them at par under standby liquidity facilities unless the bond’s credit rating has declined below investment grade or there has been an event of default or bankruptcy of the issuer and insurer.
 

 
Wells Fargo & Company
199


Note 9: Securitizations and Variable Interest Entities (continued)

COMMERCIAL AND INDUSTRIAL LOANS AND LEASES In conjunction with the GE Capital business acquisitions, on March 1, 2016, we acquired certain consolidated SPE entities. The most significant of these SPEs is a revolving master trust entity that purchases dealer floorplan loans and issues senior and subordinated notes. The senior notes are held by third parties and the subordinated notes and residual equity interests are held by us. At December 31, 2018 and 2017 , total assets held by the master trust were $6.7 billion and $7.6 billion , respectively, and the outstanding senior notes were $299 million and $773 million , respectively. The other SPEs acquired included securitization term trust entities, which purchased vendor finance lease and loan assets and issued notes to investors, and an SPE that engages in leasing activities to specific vendors. The securitization term trusts were dissolved during 2017. The remaining other SPE held $1.5 billion and $1.4 billion in total assets at December 31, 2018 and 2017 , respectively. We are the primary beneficiary of these acquired SPEs due to our ability to direct the significant activities of the SPEs, such as our role as servicer, and because we hold variable interests that are considered significant.

 
NONCONFORMING RESIDENTIAL MORTGAGE LOAN SECURITIZATIONS  We have consolidated certain of our nonconforming residential mortgage loan securitizations in accordance with consolidation accounting guidance. We have determined we are the primary beneficiary of these securitizations because we have the power to direct the most significant activities of the entity through our role as primary servicer and also hold variable interests that we have determined to be significant. The nature of our variable interests in these entities may include beneficial interests issued by the VIE, mortgage servicing rights and recourse or repurchase reserve liabilities. The beneficial interests issued by the VIE that we hold include either subordinate or senior securities held in an amount that we consider potentially significant.
 



200
Wells Fargo & Company
 


Note 10:   Mortgage Banking Activities 
Mortgage banking activities, included in the Community Banking and Wholesale Banking operating segments, consist of residential and commercial mortgage originations, sale activity and servicing.
 
We apply the amortization method to commercial MSRs and apply the fair value method to residential MSRs. Table 10.1 presents the changes in MSRs measured using the fair value method.

Table 10.1: Analysis of Changes in Fair Value MSRs
 
Year ended December 31, 
 
(in millions)
2018

 
2017

 
2016

Fair value, beginning of year
$
13,625

 
12,959

 
12,415

Purchases

 
541

 

Servicing from securitizations or asset transfers (1)
2,010

 
2,263

 
2,204

Sales and other (2)
(71
)
 
(23
)
 
(65
)
Net additions
1,939

 
2,781

 
2,139

Changes in fair value:
 
 
 
 
 
Due to changes in valuation model inputs or assumptions:
 
 
 
 
 
Mortgage interest rates (3)
1,337

 
(103
)
 
543

Servicing and foreclosure costs (4)
818

 
96

 
106

Discount rates (5)
(830
)
 
13

 

Prepayment estimates and other (6)
(365
)
 
(132
)
 
(84
)
Net changes in valuation model inputs or assumptions
960

 
(126
)
 
565

Changes due to collection/realization of expected cash flows over time
(1,875
)
 
(1,989
)
 
(2,160
)
Total changes in fair value
(915
)
 
(2,115
)
 
(1,595
)
Fair value, end of year
$
14,649

 
13,625

 
12,959

(1)
Includes impacts associated with exercising our right to repurchase delinquent loans from GNMA loan securitization pools.
(2)
Includes sales and transfers of MSRs, which can result in an increase of total reported MSRs if the sales or transfers are related to nonperforming loan portfolios or portfolios with servicing liabilities.
(3)
Includes prepayment speed changes as well as other valuation changes due to changes in mortgage interest rates (such as changes in estimated interest earned on custodial deposit balances).
(4)
Includes costs to service and unreimbursed foreclosure costs. The amount for the year ended December 31, 2018, reflects updated information obtained regarding market participants’ views of servicing and foreclosure costs.
(5)
Reflects discount rate assumption change, excluding portion attributable to changes in mortgage interest rates. The amount for the year ended December 31, 2018, reflects updated information obtained regarding market participants’ views of discount rates.
(6)
Represents changes driven by other valuation model inputs or assumptions including prepayment speed estimation changes and other assumption updates. Prepayment speed estimation changes are influenced by observed changes in borrower behavior and other external factors that occur independent of interest rate changes.
Table 10.2 presents the changes in amortized MSRs.

Table 10.2: Analysis of Changes in Amortized MSRs
 
Year ended December 31, 
 
(in millions)
2018

 
2017

 
2016

Balance, beginning of year
$
1,424

 
1,406

 
1,308

Purchases
127

 
115

 
97

Servicing from securitizations or asset transfers
158

 
166

 
270

Amortization
(266
)
 
(263
)
 
(269
)
Balance, end of year (1)
$
1,443

 
1,424

 
1,406

Fair value of amortized MSRs:
 
 
 
 
 
Beginning of year
$
2,025

 
1,956

 
1,680

End of year
2,288

 
2,025

 
1,956

(1)
Commercial amortized MSRs are evaluated for impairment purposes by the following risk strata: agency (GSEs) for multi-family properties and non-agency. There was no valuation allowance recorded for the periods presented on the commercial amortized MSRs.


 
Wells Fargo & Company
201


Note 10:   Mortgage Banking Activities   (continued)

We present the components of our managed servicing portfolio in Table 10.3 at unpaid principal balance for loans serviced and subserviced for others and at book value for owned loans serviced. 

Table 10.3: Managed Servicing Portfolio
(in billions)
Dec 31, 2018

 
Dec 31, 2017

Residential mortgage servicing:
 
 
 
Serviced for others
$
1,164

 
1,209

Owned loans serviced
334

 
342

Subserviced for others
4

 
3

Total residential servicing
1,502

 
1,554

Commercial mortgage servicing:
 
 
 
Serviced for others
543

 
495

Owned loans serviced
121

 
127

Subserviced for others
9

 
9

Total commercial servicing
673

 
631

Total managed servicing portfolio
$
2,175

 
2,185

Total serviced for others
$
1,707

 
1,704

Ratio of MSRs to related loans serviced for others
0.94
%
 
0.88

 
Table 10.4 presents the components of mortgage banking noninterest income. 

Table 10.4: Mortgage Banking Noninterest Income
 
 
Year ended December 31, 
 
(in millions)
 
2018

 
2017

 
2016

Servicing income, net:
 
 
 
 
 
 
Servicing fees:
 
 
 
 
 
 
Contractually specified servicing fees
 
$
3,613

 
3,603

 
3,778

Late charges
 
162

 
172

 
180

Ancillary fees
 
182

 
199

 
229

Unreimbursed direct servicing costs (1)
 
(331
)
 
(582
)
 
(819
)
Net servicing fees
 
3,626

 
3,392

 
3,368

Changes in fair value of MSRs carried at fair value:
 
 
 
 
 
 
Due to changes in valuation model inputs or assumptions (2)
(A)
960

 
(126
)
 
565

Changes due to collection/realization of expected cash flows over time
 
(1,875
)
 
(1,989
)
 
(2,160
)
Total changes in fair value of MSRs carried at fair value
 
(915
)
 
(2,115
)
 
(1,595
)
Amortization
 
(266
)
 
(263
)
 
(269
)
Net derivative gains (losses) from economic hedges (3)
(B)
(1,072
)
 
413

 
261

Total servicing income, net
 
1,373

 
1,427

 
1,765

Net gains on mortgage loan origination/sales activities
 
1,644

 
2,923

 
4,331

Total mortgage banking noninterest income
 
$
3,017

 
4,350

 
6,096

Market-related valuation changes to MSRs, net of hedge results (2)(3)
(A)+(B)
$
(112
)
 
287

 
826

(1)
Includes costs associated with foreclosures, unreimbursed interest advances to investors, and other interest costs.
(2)
Refer to the analysis of changes in fair value MSRs presented in Table 10.1 in this Note for more detail.
(3)
Represents results from economic hedges used to hedge the risk of changes in fair value of MSRs. See Note 17 (Derivatives) for additional discussion and detail.




202
Wells Fargo & Company
 


Note 11:   Intangible Assets

Table 11.1 presents the gross carrying value of intangible assets and accumulated amortization.
 
Table 11.1: Intangible Assets
 
December 31, 2018
 
 
December 31, 2017
 
(in millions)
Gross carrying value 

 
Accumulated amortization 

 
Net carrying value 

 
Gross carrying value 

 
Accumulated amortization 

 
Net carrying value

Amortized intangible assets (1):
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
MSRs (2)
$
4,161

 
(2,718
)
 
1,443

 
3,876

 
(2,452
)
 
1,424

Core deposit intangibles
12,834

 
(12,834
)
 

 
12,834

 
(12,065
)
 
769

Customer relationship and other intangibles
3,994

 
(3,449
)
 
545

 
3,994

 
(3,153
)
 
841

Total amortized intangible assets
$
20,989

 
(19,001
)
 
1,988

 
20,704

 
(17,670
)
 
3,034

Unamortized intangible assets:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
MSRs (carried at fair value) (2)
$
14,649

 
 
 
 
 
13,625

 
 
 
 
Goodwill
26,418

 
 
 
 
 
26,587

 
 
 
 
Trademark
14

 
 
 
 
 
14

 
 
 
 
(1)
Excludes fully amortized intangible assets.
(2)
See Note 10 (Mortgage Banking Activities) for additional information on MSRs.

Table 11.2 provides the current year and estimated future amortization expense for amortized intangible assets. We based our projections of amortization expense shown below on existing
 
asset balances at December 31, 2018 . Future amortization expense may vary from these projections.

Table 11.2: Amortization Expense for Intangible Assets
(in millions)
Amortized MSRs 

 
Core deposit intangibles 

 
Customer relationship and other intangibles (1)

 
Total 

Year ended December 31, 2018 (actual)
$
266

 
769

 
299

 
1,334

Estimate for year ended December 31,
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2019
$
260

 

 
116

 
376

2020
233

 

 
97

 
330

2021
200

 

 
83

 
283

2022
178

 

 
69

 
247

2023
150

 

 
59

 
209

(1)
The year ended December 31, 2018 , balance includes $10 million for lease intangible amortization.

 
Wells Fargo & Company
203


Note 11:  Intangible Assets   (continued)

Table 11.3 shows the allocation of goodwill to our reportable operating segments.
 


Table 11.3: Goodwill
(in millions)
Community Banking 

 
Wholesale Banking 

 
Wealth and Investment Management

 
Consolidated Company 

December 31, 2016
$
16,849

 
8,585

 
1,259

 
26,693

Reclassification of goodwill held for sale to other assets (2)

 
(116
)
 

 
(116
)
Reduction in goodwill related to divested businesses and other (2)

 
(14
)
 

 
(14
)
Goodwill from business combinations

 

 
24

 
24

December 31, 2017 (1)
$
16,849

 
8,455

 
1,283

 
26,587

Reclassification of goodwill held for sale to other assets
(155
)
 

 

 
(155
)
Reduction in goodwill related to divested businesses and other
(9
)
 
(5
)
 

 
(14
)
December 31, 2018 (1)
$
16,685

 
8,450

 
1,283

 
26,418

(1)
At December 31, 2017 , other assets included Goodwill classified as held-for-sale of $13 million related to the sales agreement for Wells Fargo Shareowner Services. At December 31, 2018 , there was no Goodwill classified as held-for-sale in other assets.
(2)
The prior period has been revised to conform with the current period presentation.

We assess goodwill for impairment at a reporting unit level, which is one level below the operating segments. Our goodwill was not impaired at December 31, 2018 and 2017 . The fair values exceeded the carrying amount of our respective reporting units by approximately 42% to 544% at December 31, 2018 . See Note 26 (Operating Segments) for further information on management reporting.

204
Wells Fargo & Company
 


Note 12:   Deposits
Table 12.1 presents a summary of the time certificates of deposit (CDs) and other time deposits issued by domestic and foreign offices.

Table 12.1: Time Certificates of Deposits and Other Time Deposits
 
 
 
Dec 31,

 
Dec 31,

(in billions)
 
2018

 
2017

Total domestic and foreign
$
130.6

 
128.6

Domestic:
 
 
 
 
 
$100,000 or more
42.5

 
52.7

 
$250,000 or more
37.1

 
46.9

Foreign:
 
 
 
 
$100,000 or more
4.6

 
13.4

 
$250,000 or more
4.6

 
13.4


Substantially all CDs and other time deposits issued by domestic and foreign offices were interest bearing and a significant portion of our foreign time deposits with a denomination of $100,000 or more have maturities of less than 7 days.
The contractual maturities of these deposits are presented in Table 12.2 .

Table 12.2: Contractual Maturities of CDs and Other Time Deposits
(in millions)
December 31, 2018

2019
$
88,435

2020
25,986

2021
6,324

2022
3,320

2023
2,868

Thereafter
3,712

Total
$
130,645


 
The contractual maturities of the domestic time deposits with a denomination of $100,000 or more are presented in Table 12.3 .

Table 12.3: Contractual Maturities of Domestic Time Deposits
(in millions)
2018

Three months or less
$
13,724

After three months through six months
12,292

After six months through twelve months
12,945

After twelve months
3,504

Total
$
42,465


Demand deposit overdrafts of $624 million and $371 million were included as loan balances at December 31, 2018 and 2017 , respectively.

 
Wells Fargo & Company
205


Note 13:   Short-Term Borrowings
Table 13.1 shows selected information for short-term borrowings, which generally mature in less than 30 days . We pledge certain financial instruments that we own to collateralize repurchase agreements and other securities financings. For
 
additional information, see the “Pledged Assets” section of Note 15 (Guarantees, Pledged Assets and Collateral, and Other Commitments).

Table 13.1: Short-Term Borrowings
 
2018
 
 
2017
 
 
2016
 
(in millions)
Amount 

 
Rate 

 
Amount 

 
Rate 

 
Amount 

 
Rate 

As of December 31,
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Federal funds purchased and securities sold under agreements to repurchase
$
92,430

 
2.65
%
 
$
88,684

 
1.30
%
 
$
78,124

 
0.17
%
Commercial paper

 

 

 

 
120

 
0.93

Other short-term borrowings
13,357

 
1.63

 
14,572

 
0.72

 
18,537

 
0.28

Total
$
105,787

 
2.52

 
$
103,256

 
1.22

 
$
96,781

 
0.19

Year ended December 31,
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Average daily balance
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Federal funds purchased and securities sold under agreements to repurchase
$
90,348

 
1.78

 
$
82,507

 
0.90

 
$
99,955

 
0.33

Commercial paper

 

 
16

 
0.95

 
256

 
0.86

Other short-term borrowings
13,919

 
0.79

 
16,399

 
0.13

 
14,976

 
0.02

Total
$
104,267

 
1.65

 
$
98,922

 
0.77

 
$
115,187

 
0.29

Maximum month-end balance
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Federal funds purchased and securities sold under agreements to repurchase (1)
$
93,918

 
N/A 

 
$
91,604

 
N/A 

 
$
109,645

 
N/A 

Commercial paper (2)

 
N/A 

 
78

 
N/A 

 
519

 
N/A 

Other short-term borrowings (3)
16,924

 
N/A 

 
19,439

 
N/A 

 
18,537

 
N/A 

N/A- Not applicable
(1)
Highest month-end balance in each of the last three years was November 2018 , November 2017 and October 2016 .
(2)
There were no month-end balances in 2018; highest month-end balance in the remaining years was January 2017 and March 2016 .
(3)
Highest month-end balance in each of the last three years was January 2018 , February 2017 and December 2016 .

206
Wells Fargo & Company
 


Note 14:   Long-Term Debt

We issue long-term debt denominated in multiple currencies, largely in U.S. dollars. Our issuances have both fixed and floating interest rates. As a part of our overall interest rate risk management strategy, we often use derivatives to manage our exposure to interest rate risk. We also use derivatives to manage our exposure to foreign currency risk. As a result, approximately half of the long-term debt presented below is hedged in a fair value or cash flow hedge relationship. See Note 17 (Derivatives) for further information on qualifying hedge contracts.
 
Table 14.1 presents a summary of our long-term debt carrying values, reflecting unamortized debt discounts and premiums, and purchase accounting adjustments, where applicable. The interest rates displayed represent the range of contractual rates in effect at December 31, 2018 . These interest rates do not include the effects of any associated derivatives designated in a hedge accounting relationship. 

Table 14.1: Long-Term Debt
 
December 31,
 
 
2018
 
 
2017

(in millions)
Maturity date(s) 
 
Stated interest rate(s) 
 
 
 
 
Wells Fargo & Company (Parent only)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Senior
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Fixed-rate notes (1)
2019-2045
 
0.38-6.75%
 
$
77,742

 
84,652

Floating-rate notes
2019-2048
 
0.10-4.08%
 
19,553

 
22,463

FixFloat notes
2028
 
3.58%
 
2,901

 
2,961

Structured notes (2)
2019-2056
 

 
7,984

 
7,442

Total senior debt - Parent
 
 
 
 
108,180

 
117,518

Subordinated
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Fixed-rate notes (3)
2023-2046
 
3.45-7.57%
 
25,428

 
27,132

Total subordinated debt - Parent
 
 
 
 
25,428

 
27,132

Junior subordinated
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Fixed-rate notes - hybrid trust securities
2029-2036
 
5.95-7.95%
 
1,308

 
1,369

Floating-rate notes
2027
 
2.94-3.44%
 
308

 
299

Total junior subordinated debt - Parent (4)
 
 
 
 
1,616

 
1,668

Total long-term debt - Parent (3)
 
 
 
 
135,224

 
146,318

Wells Fargo Bank, N.A. and other bank entities (Bank)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Senior
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Fixed-rate notes
2019-2023
 
1.75-3.63%
 
14,222

 
7,732

Floating-rate notes
2019-2053
 
2.33-3.57%
 
6,617

 
4,317

FixFloat notes
2021
 
3.33%
 
1,998

 

Fixed-rate advances - Federal Home Loan Bank (FHLB) (5)
2019-2031
 
3.83-7.50%
 
51

 
62

Floating-rate advances - FHLB (5)
2019-2021
 
2.44-3.28%
 
53,825

 
47,825

Structured notes (2)
2019-2037
 

 
1,646

 
743

Capital leases
2019-2029
 
2.87-17.78%
 
36

 
39

Total senior debt - Bank
 
 
 
 
78,395

 
60,718

Subordinated
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Fixed-rate notes
2023-2038
 
5.25-7.74%
 
5,199

 
5,408

Total subordinated debt - Bank
 
 
 
 
5,199

 
5,408

Junior subordinated
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Floating-rate notes
2027
 
3.09-3.19%
 
352

 
342

Total junior subordinated debt - Bank (4)
 
 
 
 
352

 
342

Long-term debt issued by VIE - Fixed rate (6)
2020-2047
 
6.00%
 
160

 
268

Long-term debt issued by VIE - Floating rate (6)
2020-2047
 
2.46-13.02%
 
656

 
1,211

Mortgage notes and other debt (7)
2019-2057
 
0.20-9.20%
 
6,637

 
7,291

Total long-term debt - Bank
 
 
 
 
91,399

 
75,238


(continued on following page)

 
Wells Fargo & Company
207


Note 14: Long-Term Debt (continued)

(continued from previous page)
 
December 31,
 
 
2018
 
 
2017

(in millions)
Maturity date(s) 
 
Stated interest rate(s) 
 
 
 
 
Other consolidated subsidiaries
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Senior
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Fixed-rate notes
2019-2023
 
2.94-3.46%
 
2,383

 
3,390

Structured notes (2)
2021-2028
 

 
6

 
1

Total senior debt - Other consolidated subsidiaries
  
 
 
 
2,389

 
3,391

Mortgage notes and other (7)
2026
 
4.08%
 
32

 
73

Total long-term debt - Other consolidated subsidiaries
 
 
 
 
2,421

 
3,464

Total long-term debt
 
 
 
 
$
229,044

 
225,020

(1)
Includes $59 million of outstanding zero coupon callable notes at December 31, 2018.
(2)
Included in the table are certain structured notes that have coupon or repayment terms linked to the performance of debt or equity securities, an embedded equity, commodity, or currency index, or basket of indices accounted for separately from the note as a free-standing derivative, and the maturity may be accelerated based on the value of a referenced index or security. For information on embedded derivatives, see the “Derivatives Not Designated as Hedging Instruments” section in Note 17 (Derivatives). In addition, a major portion consists of zero coupon callable notes where interest is paid as part of the final redemption amount.
(3)
Includes fixed-rate subordinated notes issued by the Parent at a discount of $131 million and $133 million in 2018 and 2017 , respectively, and debt issuance costs of $2 million in both 2018 and 2017, to effect a modification of Wells Fargo Bank, NA notes. These subordinated notes are carried at their par amount on the balance sheet of the Parent presented in Note 27 (Parent-Only Financial Statements). In addition, Parent long-term debt presented in Note 27 also includes affiliate related issuance costs of $278 million and $323 million in 2018 and 2017, respectively.
(4)
Represents junior subordinated debentures held by unconsolidated wholly-owned trusts formed for the sole purpose of issuing trust preferred securities. See Note 9 (Securitizations and Variable Interest Entities) for additional information on our trust preferred security structures.
(5)
At December 31, 2018 and 2017 , FHLB advances were secured by residential loan collateral.
(6)
For additional information on VIEs, see Note 9 (Securitizations and Variable Interest Entities).
(7)
A major portion related to securitizations and secured borrowings, see Note 9 (Securitizations and Variable Interest Entities).
We issue long-term debt in a variety of maturities and currencies to achieve cost-efficient funding and to maintain an appropriate maturity profile. Long-term debt of $229.0 billion at December 31, 2018 , increased $4.0 billion from December 31, 2017. We issued $47.6 billion of long-term debt in 2018.
 
The aggregate carrying value of long-term debt that matures (based on contractual payment dates) as of December 31, 2018 , in each of the following five years and thereafter is presented in Table 14.2 .
Table 14.2: Maturity of Long-Term Debt
 
December 31, 2018
 
(in millions)
2019

 
2020

 
2021

 
2022

 
2023

 
Thereafter

 
Total

Wells Fargo & Company (Parent Only)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Senior notes
$
6,713

 
13,459

 
17,923

 
17,772

 
10,932

 
41,381

 
108,180

Subordinated notes

 

 

 

 
3,544

 
21,884

 
25,428

Junior subordinated notes

 

 

 

 

 
1,616

 
1,616

Total long-term debt - Parent
6,713

 
13,459

 
17,923

 
17,772

 
14,476

 
64,881

 
135,224

Wells Fargo Bank, N.A. and other bank entities (Bank)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Senior notes
36,653

 
18,498

 
20,218

 
40

 
2,807

 
179

 
78,395

Subordinated notes

 

 

 

 
1,043

 
4,156

 
5,199

Junior subordinated notes

 

 

 

 

 
352

 
352

Securitizations and other bank debt
2,084

 
1,647

 
574

 
268

 
119

 
2,761

 
7,453

Total long-term debt - Bank
38,737

 
20,145

 
20,792

 
308

 
3,969

 
7,448

 
91,399

Other consolidated subsidiaries
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Senior notes
1,097

 

 
920

 

 
367

 
5

 
2,389

Securitizations and other bank debt

 

 

 

 

 
32

 
32

Total long-term debt - Other consolidated subsidiaries
1,097

 

 
920

 

 
367

 
37

 
2,421

Total long-term debt
$
46,547

 
33,604

 
39,635

 
18,080

 
18,812

 
72,366

 
229,044

As part of our long-term and short-term borrowing arrangements, we are subject to various financial and operational covenants. Some of the agreements under which debt has been issued have provisions that may limit the merger or sale of certain subsidiary banks and the issuance of capital stock or convertible securities by certain subsidiary banks. At December 31, 2018 , we were in compliance with all the covenants.


208
Wells Fargo & Company
 


Note 15:   Guarantees, Pledged Assets and Collateral, and Other Commitments
Guarantees are contracts that contingently require us to make payments to a guaranteed party based on an event or a change in an underlying asset, liability, rate or index. Guarantees are generally in the form of standby letters of credit, securities
 
lending and other indemnifications, written put options, recourse obligations, and other types of arrangements. Table 15.1 shows carrying value, maximum exposure to loss on our guarantees and the related non-investment grade amounts.

Table 15.1: Guarantees – Carrying Value and Maximum Exposure to Loss
 
 
 
Maximum exposure to loss 
 
(in millions)
Carrying value of obligation (asset)

 
Expires in one year or less 

 
Expires after one year through three years 

 
Expires after three years through five years 

 
Expires after five years 

 
Total 

 
Non-investment grade 

December 31, 2018
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Standby letters of credit (1)
$
40

 
14,636

 
7,897

 
3,398

 
497

 
26,428

 
8,027

Securities lending and other indemnifications (2)

 

 
1

 

 
1,044

 
1,045

 
1

Written put options (3)
(185
)
 
17,243

 
10,502

 
3,066

 
400

 
31,211

 
21,732

Loans and MLHFS sold with recourse (4)
54

 
104

 
653

 
1,207

 
10,163

 
12,127

 
9,079

Factoring guarantees

 
889

 

 

 

 
889

 
751

Other guarantees
1

 

 

 
3

 
2,959

 
2,962

 
1

Total guarantees
$
(90
)
 
32,872

 
19,053

 
7,674

 
15,063

 
74,662

 
39,591

December 31, 2017
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Standby letters of credit (1)
$
39

 
15,357

 
7,908

 
3,068

 
645

 
26,978

 
8,773

Securities lending and other indemnifications (2)

 

 

 
2

 
809

 
811

 
2

Written put options (3)
(455
)
 
14,758

 
12,706

 
3,890

 
1,038

 
32,392

 
19,087

Loans and MLHFS sold with recourse (4)
51

 
165

 
533

 
934

 
9,385

 
11,017

 
8,155

Factoring guarantees

 
747

 

 

 

 
747

 
668

Other guarantees
1

 
7

 

 
2

 
4,175

 
4,184

 
7

Total guarantees
$
(364
)
 
31,034

 
21,147

 
7,896

 
16,052

 
76,129

 
36,692

(1)
Total maximum exposure to loss includes direct pay letters of credit (DPLCs) of $7.5 billion and $8.1 billion at December 31, 2018 and 2017 , respectively. We issue DPLCs to provide credit enhancements for certain bond issuances. Beneficiaries (bond trustees) may draw upon these instruments to make scheduled principal and interest payments, redeem all outstanding bonds because a default event has occurred, or for other reasons as permitted by the agreement. We also originate multipurpose lending commitments under which borrowers have the option to draw on the facility in one of several forms, including as a standby letter of credit. Total maximum exposure to loss includes the portion of these facilities for which we have issued standby letters of credit under the commitments.
(2)
Includes indemnifications provided to certain third-party clearing agents. Outstanding customer obligations under these arrangements were $70 million and $92 million with related collateral of $974 million and $717 million at December 31, 2018 and 2017 , respectively. Estimated maximum exposure to loss was $1.0 billion at December 31, 2018 , and $809 million at December 31, 2017 .
(3)
Written put options, which are in the form of derivatives, are also included in the derivative disclosures in Note 17 (Derivatives). Carrying value net asset position is a result of certain deferred premium option trades.
(4)
Represent recourse provided, predominantly to the GSEs, on loans sold under various programs and arrangements. Under these arrangements, we repurchased $3 million and $5 million of loans associated with these agreements during 2018 and 2017 , respectively.
“Maximum exposure to loss” and “Non-investment grade” are required disclosures under GAAP. Non-investment grade represents those guarantees on which we have a higher risk of being required to perform under the terms of the guarantee. If the underlying assets under the guarantee are non-investment grade (that is, an external rating that is below investment grade or an internal credit default grade that is equivalent to a below investment grade external rating), we consider the risk of performance to be high. Internal credit default grades are determined based upon the same credit policies that we use to evaluate the risk of payment or performance when making loans and other extensions of credit. Credit quality indicators we usually consider in evaluating risk of payments or performance are described in Note 6 (Loans and Allowance for Credit Losses).
Maximum exposure to loss represents the estimated loss that would be incurred under an assumed hypothetical circumstance, despite what we believe is a remote possibility, where the value of our interests and any associated collateral declines to zero. Maximum exposure to loss estimates in Table 15.1 do not reflect economic hedges or collateral we could use to offset or recover losses we may incur under our guarantee agreements. Accordingly, this required disclosure is not an
 
indication of expected loss. We believe the carrying value, which is either fair value for derivative-related products or the allowance for lending-related commitments, is more representative of our exposure to loss than maximum exposure to loss.
 
STANDBY LETTERS OF CREDIT   We issue standby letters of credit, which include performance and financial guarantees, for customers in connection with contracts between our customers and third parties. Standby letters of credit are agreements where we are obligated to make payment to a third party on behalf of a customer if the customer fails to meet their contractual obligations. We consider the credit risk in standby letters of credit and commercial and similar letters of credit in determining the allowance for credit losses.

SECURITIES LENDING AND OTHER INDEMNIFICATIONS  As a securities lending agent, we lend debt and equity securities from participating institutional clients’ portfolios to third-party borrowers. These arrangements are for an indefinite period of time, and we indemnify our clients against default by the borrower in returning these lent securities. This indemnity is

 
Wells Fargo & Company
209


Note 15:   Guarantees, Pledged Assets and Collateral, and Other Commitments (continued)

supported by collateral received from the borrowers and is generally in the form of cash or highly liquid securities that are marked to market daily.
We use certain third-party clearing agents to clear and settle transactions on behalf of some of our institutional brokerage customers. We indemnify the clearing agents against loss that could occur for non-performance by our customers on transactions that are not sufficiently collateralized. Transactions subject to the indemnifications may include customer obligations related to the settlement of margin accounts and short positions, such as written call options and securities borrowing transactions.
We enter into other types of indemnification agreements in the ordinary course of business under which we agree to indemnify third parties against any damages, losses and expenses incurred in connection with legal and other proceedings arising from relationships or transactions with us. These relationships or transactions include those arising from service as a director or officer of the Company, underwriting agreements relating to our securities, acquisition agreements and various other business transactions or arrangements. Because the extent of our obligations under these agreements depends entirely upon the occurrence of future events, we are unable to determine our potential future liability under these agreements. We do, however, record a liability for residential mortgage loans that we expect to repurchase pursuant to various representations and warranties.
 
WRITTEN PUT OPTIONS Written put options are contracts that give the counterparty the right to sell to us an underlying instrument held by the counterparty at a specified price and may include options, floors, caps and credit default swaps. These written put option contracts generally permit net settlement. While these derivative transactions expose us to risk if the option is exercised, we manage this risk by entering into offsetting trades or by taking short positions in the underlying instrument. We offset market risk related to put options written to customers with cash securities or other offsetting derivative transactions. Additionally, for certain of these contracts, we require the counterparty to pledge the underlying instrument as collateral for the transaction. Our ultimate obligation under written put options is based on future market conditions and is only quantifiable at settlement. See Note 17 (Derivatives) for additional information regarding written derivative contracts.
 
 
LOANS AND MLHFS SOLD WITH RECOURSE   In certain sales and securitizations of loans, including mortgage loans, we provide recourse to the buyer whereby we are required to indemnify the buyer for any loss on the loan up to par value plus accrued interest. We provide recourse, predominantly to GSEs, on loans sold under various programs and arrangements. Substantially all of these programs and arrangements require that we share in the loans’ credit exposure for their remaining life by providing recourse to the GSE, up to 33.33% of actual losses incurred on a pro-rata basis in the event of borrower default. Under the remaining recourse programs and arrangements, if certain events occur within a specified period of time from transfer date, we have to provide limited recourse to the buyer to indemnify them for losses incurred for the remaining life of the loans. The maximum exposure to loss reported in Table 15.1 represents the outstanding principal balance of the loans sold or securitized that are subject to recourse provisions or the maximum losses per the contractual agreements. However, we believe the likelihood of loss of the entire balance due to these recourse agreements is remote, and amounts paid can be recovered in whole or in part from the sale of collateral. We also provide representation and warranty guarantees on loans sold under the various recourse programs and arrangements. Our loss exposure relative to these guarantees is separately considered and provided for, as necessary, in determination of our liability for loan repurchases due to breaches of representation and warranties.

FACTORING GUARANTEES   Under certain factoring arrangements, we may be required to purchase trade receivables from third parties, if receivable debtors default on their payment obligations.
 
OTHER GUARANTEES   We are members of exchanges and clearing houses that we use to clear our trades and those of our customers. It is common that all members in these organizations are required to collectively guarantee the performance of other members. Our obligations under the guarantees are based on either a fixed amount or a multiple of the collateral we are required to maintain with these organizations. We have not recorded a liability for these arrangements as of the dates presented in Table 15.1 because we believe the likelihood of loss is remote.
We also have contingent performance arrangements related to various customer relationships and lease transactions. We are required to pay the counterparties to these agreements if third parties default on certain obligations.


210
Wells Fargo & Company
 


Pledged Assets
As part of our liquidity management strategy, we pledge various assets to secure trust and public deposits, borrowings and letters of credit from the FHLB and FRB, securities sold under agreements to repurchase (repurchase agreements), securities lending arrangements, and for other purposes as required or permitted by law or insurance statutory requirements. The types of collateral we pledge include securities issued by federal agencies, GSEs, domestic and foreign companies and various commercial and consumer loans. Table 15.2 provides the total carrying amount of pledged assets by asset type and pledged off-
 
balance sheet securities for securities financings. The table excludes pledged consolidated VIE assets of $14.1 billion and $13.6 billion at December 31, 2018 and 2017 , respectively, which can only be used to settle the liabilities of those entities. The table also excludes $617 million and $675 million in assets pledged in transactions with VIE’s accounted for as secured borrowings at December 31, 2018 and 2017 , respectively. See Note 9 (Securitizations and Variable Interest Entities) for additional information on consolidated VIE assets and secured borrowings.
 

Table 15.2: Pledged Assets
 
Dec 31,

 
Dec 31,

(in millions)
2018

 
2017

Held for trading:
 
 
 
Debt securities
$
96,616

 
96,993

Equity securities
9,695

 
12,161

       Total pledged assets held for trading (1)
106,311

 
109,154

Not held for trading:
 
 
 
Debt securities and other (2)
62,438

 
73,592

Mortgage loans held for sale and loans (3)
453,894

 
469,554

    Total pledged assets not held for trading
516,332

 
543,146

Total pledged assets
$
622,643

 
652,300

(1)
Consists of pledged assets held for trading of $45.5 billion and $41.9 billion at December 31, 2018 and 2017 , respectively, and off-balance sheet securities of $60.8 billion and $67.3 billion as of the same dates, respectively, that are pledged as collateral for repurchase agreements and other securities financings. Total pledged assets held for trading includes $106.2 billion and $109.0 billion at December 31, 2018 and 2017 , respectively, that permit the secured parties to sell or repledge the collateral.
(2)
Includes carrying value of $4.2 billion and $5.0 billion (fair value of $4.1 billion and $5.0 billion ) in collateral for repurchase agreements at December 31, 2018 and 2017 , respectively, which are pledged under agreements that do not permit the secured parties to sell or repledge the collateral. Also includes $68 million and $64 million in collateral pledged under repurchase agreements at December 31, 2018 and 2017 , respectively, that permit the secured parties to sell or repledge the collateral. Substantially all other pledged securities are pursuant to agreements that do not permit the secured party to sell or repledge the collateral.
(3)
Includes mortgage loans held for sale of $ 7.4 billion and $2.6 billion at December 31, 2018 and 2017 , respectively. Substantially all of the total mortgage loans held for sale and loans are pledged under agreements that do not permit the secured parties to sell or repledge the collateral. Amounts exclude $1.2 billion and $2.2 billion at December 31, 2018 and 2017 , respectively, of pledged loans recorded on our balance sheet representing certain delinquent loans that are eligible for repurchase from GNMA loan securitizations.
Securities Financing Activities
We enter into resale and repurchase agreements and securities borrowing and lending agreements (collectively, “securities financing activities”) typically to finance trading positions (including securities and derivatives), acquire securities to cover short trading positions, accommodate customers’ financing needs, and settle other securities obligations. These activities are conducted through our broker-dealer subsidiaries and to a lesser extent through other bank entities. Most of our securities financing activities involve high quality, liquid securities such as U.S. Treasury securities and government agency securities, and to a lesser extent, less liquid securities, including equity securities, corporate bonds and asset-backed securities. We account for these transactions as collateralized financings in which we typically receive or pledge securities as collateral. We believe these financing transactions generally do not have material credit risk given the collateral provided and the related monitoring processes.

OFFSETTING OF SECURITIES FINANCING ACTIVITIES Table 15.3 presents resale and repurchase agreements subject to master repurchase agreements (MRA) and securities borrowing and lending agreements subject to master securities lending agreements (MSLA). We account for transactions subject to these agreements as collateralized financings, and those with a single counterparty are presented net on our balance sheet, provided certain criteria are met that permit balance sheet netting. Most transactions subject to these agreements do not
 
meet those criteria and thus are not eligible for balance sheet netting.
Collateral we pledged consists of non-cash instruments, such as securities or loans, and is not netted on the balance sheet against the related liability. Collateral we received includes securities or loans and is not recognized on our balance sheet. Collateral pledged or received may be increased or decreased over time to maintain certain contractual thresholds, as the assets underlying each arrangement fluctuate in value. Generally, these agreements require collateral to exceed the asset or liability recognized on the balance sheet. The following table includes the amount of collateral pledged or received related to exposures subject to enforceable MRAs or MSLAs. While these agreements are typically over-collateralized, U.S. GAAP requires disclosure in this table to limit the reported amount of such collateral to the amount of the related recognized asset or liability for each counterparty.
In addition to the amounts included in Table 15.3 , we also have balance sheet netting related to derivatives that is disclosed in Note 17 (Derivatives).

 
Wells Fargo & Company
211


Note 15:   Guarantees, Pledged Assets and Collateral, and Other Commitments (continued)

Table 15.3: Offsetting – Securities Financing Activities
 
Dec 31,

 
Dec 31,

(in millions)
2018

 
2017

Assets:
 
 
 
Resale and securities borrowing agreements
 
 
 
Gross amounts recognized
$
112,662

 
121,135

Gross amounts offset in consolidated balance sheet (1)
(15,258
)
 
(23,188
)
Net amounts in consolidated balance sheet (2)
97,404

 
97,947

Collateral not recognized in consolidated balance sheet (3)
(96,734
)
 
(96,829
)
Net amount (4)
$
670

 
1,118

Liabilities:
 
 
 
Repurchase and securities lending agreements
 
 
 
Gross amounts recognized (5)
$
106,248

 
111,488

Gross amounts offset in consolidated balance sheet (1)
(15,258
)
 
(23,188
)
Net amounts in consolidated balance sheet (6)
90,990

 
88,300

Collateral pledged but not netted in consolidated balance sheet (7)
(90,798
)
 
(87,918
)
Net amount (8)
$
192

 
382

(1)
Represents recognized amount of resale and repurchase agreements with counterparties subject to enforceable MRAs that have been offset in the consolidated balance sheet.
(2)
At December 31, 2018 and 2017 , includes $80.1 billion and $78.9 billion , respectively, classified on our consolidated balance sheet in federal funds sold and securities purchased under resale agreements. Balance also includes securities purchased under long-term resale agreements (generally one year or more) classified in loans, which totaled $17.3 billion and $19.0 billion , at December 31, 2018 and 2017 , respectively.
(3)
Represents the fair value of collateral we have received under enforceable MRAs or MSLAs, limited for table presentation purposes to the amount of the recognized asset due from each counterparty. At December 31, 2018 and 2017 , we have received total collateral with a fair value of $123.1 billion and $130.8 billion , respectively, all of which we have the right to sell or repledge. These amounts include securities we have sold or repledged to others with a fair value of $60.8 billion at December 31, 2018 , and $66.3 billion at December 31, 2017 .
(4)
Represents the amount of our exposure that is not collateralized and/or is not subject to an enforceable MRA or MSLA.
(5)
For additional information on underlying collateral and contractual maturities, see the “Repurchase and Securities Lending Agreements” section in this Note.
(6)
Amount is classified in short-term borrowings on our consolidated balance sheet.
(7)
Represents the fair value of collateral we have pledged, related to enforceable MRAs or MSLAs, limited for table presentation purposes to the amount of the recognized liability owed to each counterparty. At December 31, 2018 and 2017 , we have pledged total collateral with a fair value of $108.8 billion and $113.6 billion , respectively, of which, the counterparty does not have the right to sell or repledge $4.4 billion as of December 31, 2018 , and $5.2 billion as of December 31, 2017 .
(8)
Represents the amount of our obligation that is not covered by pledged collateral and/or is not subject to an enforceable MRA or MSLA.
REPURCHASE AND SECURITIES LENDING AGREEMENTS Securities sold under repurchase agreements and securities lending arrangements are effectively short-term collateralized borrowings. In these transactions, we receive cash in exchange for transferring securities as collateral and recognize an obligation to reacquire the securities for cash at the transaction’s maturity. These types of transactions create risks, including (1) the counterparty may fail to return the securities at maturity, (2) the fair value of the securities transferred may decline below the amount of our obligation to reacquire the securities, and therefore create an obligation for us to pledge additional amounts, and (3) the counterparty may accelerate the maturity on demand, requiring us to reacquire the security prior to contractual maturity. We attempt to mitigate these risks by the fact that most of our securities financing activities involve highly liquid securities, we underwrite and monitor the financial strength of our counterparties, we monitor the fair value of collateral pledged relative to contractually required repurchase amounts, and we monitor that our collateral is properly returned through the clearing and settlement process in advance of our cash repayment. Table 15.4 provides the underlying collateral types of our gross obligations under repurchase and securities lending agreements.

212
Wells Fargo & Company
 


Table 15.4: Underlying Collateral Types of Gross Obligations
 
 
Dec 31,

 
Dec 31,

(in millions)
 
2018

 
2017

Repurchase agreements:
 
 
 
 
Securities of U.S. Treasury and federal agencies (1)
 
$
38,408

 
40,507

Securities of U.S. States and political subdivisions
 
159

 
92

Federal agency mortgage-backed securities (1)
 
47,241

 
45,336

Non-agency mortgage-backed securities
 
1,875

 
1,324

Corporate debt securities (1)
 
6,191

 
8,020

Asset-backed securities
 
2,074

 
2,034

Equity securities
 
992

 
838

Other (1)
 
340

 
1,602

Total repurchases
 
97,280

 
99,753

Securities lending:
 
 
 
 
Securities of U.S. Treasury and federal agencies
 
222

 
186

Federal agency mortgage-backed securities
 
2

 

Corporate debt securities
 
389

 
619

Equity securities (2)
 
8,349

 
10,930

Other
 
6

 

Total securities lending
 
8,968

 
11,735

Total repurchases and securities lending
 
$
106,248

 
111,488

(1)
Amounts for December 31, 2017, have been revised to conform with the current period classification of certain collateral.
(2)
Equity securities are generally exchange traded and either re-hypothecated under margin lending agreements or obtained through contemporaneous securities borrowing transactions with other counterparties.

Table 15.5 provides the contractual maturities of our gross obligations under repurchase and securities lending agreements.
Table 15.5: Contractual Maturities of Gross Obligations
(in millions)
Overnight/continuous

 
Up to 30 days

 
30-90 days

 
>90 days

 
Total gross obligation

December 31, 2018
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Repurchase agreements
$
86,574

 
3,244

 
2,153

 
5,309

 
97,280

Securities lending
8,669

 

 
299

 

 
8,968

Total repurchases and securities lending (1)
$
95,243

 
3,244

 
2,452

 
5,309

 
106,248

December 31, 2017
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Repurchase agreements
$
83,780

 
7,922

 
3,286

 
4,765

 
99,753

Securities lending
9,634

 
584

 
1,363

 
154

 
11,735

Total repurchases and securities lending (1)
$
93,414

 
8,506

 
4,649

 
4,919

 
111,488

(1)
Securities lending is executed under agreements that allow either party to terminate the transaction without notice, while repurchase agreements have a term structure to them that technically matures at a point in time. The overnight/continuous repurchase agreements require election of both parties to roll the trade rather than the election to terminate the arrangement as in securities lending.

OTHER COMMITMENTS To meet the financing needs of our customers, we may enter into commitments to purchase debt and equity securities to provide capital for their funding, liquidity or other future needs. As of December 31, 2018 and 2017 , we had commitments to purchase debt securities of $335 million and $194 million , respectively, and commitments to purchase equity securities of $2.5 billion and $2.2 billion , respectively.
As part of maintaining our memberships in certain clearing organizations, we are required to stand ready to provide liquidity meant to sustain market clearing activity in the event unforeseen events occur or are deemed likely to occur. This includes commitments we have entered into to purchase securities under resale agreements from a central clearing organization that, at its option, require us to provide funding under such agreements. We do not have any outstanding amounts funded, and the amount of our unfunded contractual commitment was
 
$9.8 billion and $2.8 billion as of December 31, 2018 and 2017 , respectively.
The Parent fully and unconditionally guarantees the payment of principal, interest, and any other amounts that may be due on securities that its 100% owned finance subsidiary, Wells Fargo Finance LLC, may issue. These guaranteed liabilities were $5 million and $0 million at December 31, 2018 and 2017 , respectively. These guarantees rank on parity with all of the Parent’s other unsecured and unsubordinated indebtedness.



 
Wells Fargo & Company
213


Note 16:   Legal Actions (continued)

Note 16:   Legal Actions
Wells Fargo and certain of our subsidiaries are involved in a number of judicial, regulatory, arbitration, and other proceedings concerning matters arising from the conduct of our business activities, and many of those proceedings expose Wells Fargo to potential financial loss. These proceedings include actions brought against Wells Fargo and/or our subsidiaries with respect to corporate-related matters and transactions in which Wells Fargo and/or our subsidiaries were involved. In addition, Wells Fargo and our subsidiaries may be requested to provide information or otherwise cooperate with government authorities in the conduct of investigations of other persons or industry groups.
Although there can be no assurance as to the ultimate outcome, Wells Fargo and/or our subsidiaries have generally denied, or believe we have a meritorious defense and will deny, liability in all significant legal actions pending against us, including the matters described below, and we intend to defend vigorously each case, other than matters we describe as having settled. We establish accruals for legal actions when potential losses associated with the actions become probable and the costs can be reasonably estimated. For such accruals, we record the amount we consider to be the best estimate within a range of potential losses that are both probable and estimable; however, if we cannot determine a best estimate, then we record the low end of the range of those potential losses. The actual costs of resolving legal actions may be substantially higher or lower than the amounts accrued for those actions.
ATM ACCESS FEE LITIGATION In October 2011, plaintiffs filed a putative class action, Mackmin, et al. v. Visa, Inc. et al. , against Wells Fargo & Company, Wells Fargo Bank, N.A., Visa, MasterCard, and several other banks in the United States District Court for the District of Columbia. Plaintiffs allege that the Visa and MasterCard requirement that if an ATM operator charges an access fee on Visa and MasterCard transactions, then that fee cannot be greater than the access fee charged for transactions on other networks, violates antitrust rules. Plaintiffs seek treble damages, restitution, injunctive relief, and attorneys’ fees where available under federal and state law. Two other antitrust cases that make similar allegations were filed in the same court, but these cases did not name Wells Fargo as a defendant. On February 13, 2013, the district court granted defendants’ motions to dismiss the three actions. Plaintiffs appealed the dismissals and, on August 4, 2015, the United States Court of Appeals for the District of Columbia Circuit vacated the district court’s decisions and remanded the three cases to the district court for further proceedings. On June 28, 2016, the United States Supreme Court granted defendants’ petitions for writ of certiorari to review the decisions of the United States Court of Appeals for the District of Columbia. On November 17, 2016, the United States Supreme Court dismissed the petitions as improvidently granted, and the three cases returned to the district court for further proceedings.
AUTOMOBILE LENDING MATTERS On April 20, 2018, the Company entered into consent orders with the Office of the Comptroller of the Currency (OCC) and the Consumer Financial Protection Bureau (CFPB) to resolve, among other things, investigations by the agencies into the Company’s compliance risk management program and its past practices involving certain automobile collateral protection insurance (CPI) policies and, as discussed below, certain mortgage interest rate lock
 
extensions. The consent orders require remediation to customers and the payment of a total of $1.0 billion in civil money penalties to the agencies. In July 2017, the Company announced a plan to remediate customers who may have been financially harmed due to issues related to automobile CPI policies purchased through a third-party vendor on their behalf. Multiple putative class action cases alleging, among other things, unfair and deceptive practices relating to these CPI policies, have been filed against the Company and consolidated into one multi-district litigation in the United States District Court for the Central District of California. A putative class of shareholders also filed a securities fraud class action against the Company and its executive officers alleging material misstatements and omissions of CPI-related information in the Company’s public disclosures. Former team members have also alleged retaliation for raising concerns regarding automobile lending practices. In addition, the Company has identified certain issues related to the unused portion of guaranteed automobile protection (GAP) waiver or insurance agreements between the customer and dealer and, by assignment, the lender, which will result in remediation to customers in certain states. Allegations related to the CPI and GAP programs are among the subjects of shareholder derivative lawsuits pending in federal and state court in California. The court dismissed the state court action in September 2018, but plaintiffs filed an amended complaint in November 2018. Subject to full documentation and court approval, the parties have reached agreements in principle to resolve the shareholder derivative lawsuits pursuant to which the Company will pay plaintiffs’ attorneys’ fees and undertake certain business and governance practices. These and other issues related to the origination, servicing, and/or collection of consumer automobile loans, including related insurance products, have also subjected the Company to formal or informal inquiries, investigations, or examinations from federal and state government agencies. In December 2018, the Company entered into an agreement with all 50 state Attorneys General and the District of Columbia to resolve an investigation into the Company’s retail sales practices, CPI and GAP, and mortgage interest rate lock matters, pursuant to which the Company paid $575 million .
CONSUMER DEPOSIT ACCOUNT RELATED REGULATORY INVESTIGATION The CFPB is conducting an investigation into whether customers were unduly harmed by the Company’s procedures regarding the freezing (and, in many cases, closing) of consumer deposit accounts after the Company detected suspected fraudulent activity (by third-parties or account holders) that affected those accounts. A former team member has brought a state court action alleging retaliation for raising concerns about these procedures.
FIDUCIARY AND CUSTODY ACCOUNT FEE CALCULATIONS Federal government agencies are conducting formal or informal inquiries, investigations, or examinations regarding fee calculations within certain fiduciary and custody accounts in the Company’s investment and fiduciary services business, which is part of the wealth management business within WIM. The Company has determined that there have been instances of incorrect fees being applied to certain assets and accounts, resulting in both overcharges and undercharges to customers.
FOREIGN EXCHANGE BUSINESS Federal government agencies, including the United States Department of Justice (Department of Justice), are investigating or examining certain

214
Wells Fargo & Company
 


activities in the Company’s foreign exchange business. The Company has accrued amounts to remediate customers that may have received pricing inconsistent with commitments made to those customers, and to rebate customers where historic pricing, while consistent with contracts entered into with those customers, does not conform to the Company’s recently implemented standards and pricing.
INTERCHANGE LITIGATION   Plaintiffs representing a putative class of merchants have filed putative class actions, and individual merchants have filed individual actions, against Wells Fargo Bank, N.A., Wells Fargo & Company, Wachovia Bank, N.A., and Wachovia Corporation regarding the interchange fees associated with Visa and MasterCard payment card transactions. Visa, MasterCard, and several other banks and bank holding companies are also named as defendants in these actions. These actions have been consolidated in the United States District Court for the Eastern District of New York. The amended and consolidated complaint asserts claims against defendants based on alleged violations of federal and state antitrust laws and seeks damages, as well as injunctive relief. Plaintiff merchants allege that Visa, MasterCard, and payment card issuing banks unlawfully colluded to set interchange rates. Plaintiffs also allege that enforcement of certain Visa and MasterCard rules and alleged tying and bundling of services offered to merchants are anticompetitive. Wells Fargo and Wachovia, along with other defendants and entities, are parties to Loss and Judgment Sharing Agreements, which provide that they, along with other entities, will share, based on a formula, in any losses from the Interchange Litigation. On July 13, 2012, Visa, MasterCard, and the financial institution defendants, including Wells Fargo, signed a memorandum of understanding with plaintiff merchants to resolve the consolidated class action and reached a separate settlement in principle of the consolidated individual actions. The settlement payments to be made by all defendants in the consolidated class and individual actions totaled approximately $6.6 billion before reductions applicable to certain merchants opting out of the settlement. The class settlement also provided for the distribution to class merchants of 10 basis points of default interchange across all credit rate categories for a period of 8 consecutive months. The district court granted final approval of the settlement, which was appealed to the United States Court of Appeals for the Second Circuit by settlement objector merchants. Other merchants opted out of the settlement and are pursuing several individual actions. On June 30, 2016, the Second Circuit vacated the settlement agreement and reversed and remanded the consolidated action to the United States District Court for the Eastern District of New York for further proceedings. On November 23, 2016, prior class counsel filed a petition to the United States Supreme Court, seeking review of the reversal of the settlement by the Second Circuit, and the Supreme Court denied the petition on March 27, 2017. On November 30, 2016, the district court appointed lead class counsel for a damages class and an equitable relief class. The parties have entered into a settlement agreement to resolve the money damages class claims pursuant to which defendants will pay a total of approximately $6.2 billion , which includes approximately $5.3 billion of funds remaining from the 2012 settlement and $900 million in additional funding. The Company’s allocated responsibility for the additional funding is approximately $94.5 million . The court granted preliminary approval of the settlement in January 2019, and scheduled a final approval hearing for November 7, 2019. Several of the opt-out litigations were settled during the pendency of the Second Circuit appeal
 
while others remain pending. Discovery is proceeding in the opt-out litigations and the equitable relief class case.
LOW INCOME HOUSING TAX CREDITS Federal government agencies have undertaken formal or informal inquiries or investigations regarding the manner in which the Company purchased, and negotiated the purchase of, certain federal low income housing tax credits in connection with the financing of low income housing developments.
MORTGAGE BANKRUPTCY LOAN MODIFICATION LITIGATION Plaintiffs, representing a putative class of mortgage borrowers who were debtors in Chapter 13 bankruptcy cases, filed a putative class action, Cotton, et al. v. Wells Fargo, et al. , against Wells Fargo & Company and Wells Fargo Bank, N.A. in the United States Bankruptcy Court for the Western District of North Carolina on June 7, 2017. Plaintiffs allege that Wells Fargo improperly and unilaterally modified the mortgages of borrowers who were debtors in Chapter 13 bankruptcy cases. Plaintiffs allege that Wells Fargo implemented these modifications by improperly filing mortgage payment change notices in Chapter 13 bankruptcy cases, in violation of bankruptcy rules and process. The amended complaint asserts claims based on, among other things, alleged fraud, violations of bankruptcy rules and laws, and unfair and deceptive trade practices. The amended complaint seeks monetary damages, attorneys’ fees, and declaratory and injunctive relief. The parties have entered into a settlement agreement pursuant to which the Company will pay $13.5 million to resolve the claims. On October 24, 2018, the court granted preliminary approval of the settlement and scheduled a final fairness hearing for March 4, 2019.
MORTGAGE INTEREST RATE LOCK RELATED REGULATORY INVESTIGATION On April 20, 2018, the Company entered into consent orders with the OCC and CFPB to resolve, among other things, investigations by the agencies into the Company’s compliance risk management program and its past practices involving certain automobile CPI policies and certain mortgage interest rate lock extensions. The consent orders require remediation to customers and the payment of a total of $1.0 billion in civil money penalties to the agencies. On October 4, 2017, the Company announced plans to reach out to all home lending customers who paid fees for mortgage rate lock extensions requested from September 16, 2013, through February 28, 2017, and to provide refunds, with interest, to customers who believe they should not have paid those fees. The Company was named in a putative class action, filed in the United States District Court for the Northern District of California, alleging violations of federal and state consumer fraud statutes relating to mortgage rate lock extension fees. The Company filed a motion to dismiss and the court granted the motion. Subsequently, a putative class action was filed in the United States District Court for the District of Oregon, raising similar allegations. The Company filed a motion to dismiss this action. In addition, former team members have asserted claims, including in pending litigation, that they were terminated for raising concerns regarding mortgage interest rate lock extension practices. Allegations related to mortgage interest rate lock extension fees are also among the subjects of two shareholder derivative lawsuits filed in California state court. This matter has also subjected the Company to formal or informal inquiries, investigations or examinations from other federal and state government agencies. In December 2018, the Company entered into an agreement with all 50 state Attorneys General and the

 
Wells Fargo & Company
215


Note 16:   Legal Actions (continued)

District of Columbia to resolve an investigation into the Company’s retail sales practices, CPI and GAP, and mortgage interest rate lock matters, pursuant to which the Company paid $575 million .
MORTGAGE LOAN MODIFICATION LITIGATION Plaintiffs representing a putative class of mortgage borrowers have filed separate putative class actions, Hernandez v. Wells Fargo, et al. , and Coordes v. Wells Fargo, et al. , against Wells Fargo Bank, N.A. in the United States District Court for the Northern District of California and the United States District Court for the District of Washington, respectively. Plaintiffs allege that Wells Fargo improperly denied mortgage loan modifications or repayment plans to customers in the foreclosure process due to the overstatement of foreclosure attorneys’ fees that were included for purposes of determining whether a customer in the foreclosure process qualified for a mortgage loan modification or repayment plan.
MORTGAGE RELATED REGULATORY INVESTIGATIONS  Federal and state government agencies, including the Department of Justice, have been investigating or examining certain mortgage related activities of Wells Fargo and predecessor institutions. Wells Fargo, for itself and for predecessor institutions, has responded, or continues to respond, to requests from these agencies seeking information regarding the origination, underwriting, and securitization of residential mortgages, including sub-prime mortgages. These agencies have advanced theories of purported liability with respect to certain of these activities. An agreement, pursuant to which the Company paid $2.09 billion , was reached in August 2018 to resolve the Department of Justice investigation, which related to certain 2005-2007 residential mortgage-backed securities activities. In addition, the Company reached an agreement with the Attorney General of the State of Illinois in November 2018 pursuant to which the Company paid $17 million in restitution to certain Illinois state pension funds to resolve a claim relating to certain residential mortgage-backed securities activities. Other financial institutions have entered into similar settlements with these agencies, the nature of which related to the specific activities of those financial institutions, including the imposition of significant financial penalties and remedial actions.
OFAC RELATED INVESTIGATION The Company has self-identified an issue whereby certain foreign banks utilized a Wells Fargo software-based solution to conduct import/export trade-related financing transactions with countries and entities prohibited by the Office of Foreign Assets Control (OFAC) of the United States Department of the Treasury. We do not believe any funds related to these transactions flowed through accounts at Wells Fargo as a result of the aforementioned conduct. The Company has made voluntary self-disclosures to OFAC and is cooperating with an inquiry from the Department of Justice.
ORDER OF POSTING LITIGATION  Plaintiffs filed a series of putative class actions against Wachovia Bank, N.A. and Wells Fargo Bank, N.A., as well as many other banks, challenging the “high to low” order in which the banks post debit card transactions to consumer deposit accounts. Most of these actions were consolidated in multi-district litigation proceedings (MDL proceedings) in the United States District Court for the Southern District of Florida. The court in the MDL proceedings has certified a class of putative plaintiffs, and Wells Fargo moved to compel arbitration of the claims of unnamed class members.
 
The court denied the motions to compel arbitration in October 2016, and Wells Fargo appealed this decision to the United States Court of Appeals for the Eleventh Circuit. In May 2018, the Eleventh Circuit ruled in Wells Fargo’s favor and found that Wells Fargo had not waived its arbitration rights and remanded the case to the district court for further proceedings. Plaintiffs filed a petition for rehearing to the Eleventh Circuit, which was denied in August 2018. Plaintiffs petitioned for certiorari from the United States Supreme Court, and that petition was denied in January 2019.
RETAIL SALES PRACTICES MATTERS Federal, state, and local government agencies, including the Department of Justice, the United States Securities and Exchange Commission (SEC), and the United States Department of Labor; state attorneys general, including the New York Attorney General; and prosecutors’ offices, as well as Congressional committees, have undertaken formal or informal inquiries, investigations or examinations arising out of certain retail sales practices of the Company that were the subject of settlements with the CFPB, the OCC, and the Office of the Los Angeles City Attorney announced by the Company on September 8, 2016. These matters are at varying stages. The Company has responded, and continues to respond, to requests from a number of the foregoing. In October 2018, the Company entered into an agreement to resolve the New York Attorney General’s investigation pursuant to which the Company paid $65 million to the State of New York. In December 2018, the Company entered into an agreement with all 50 state Attorneys General and the District of Columbia to resolve an investigation into the Company’s retail sales practices, CPI and GAP, and mortgage interest rate lock matters, pursuant to which the Company paid $575 million . The Company has also engaged in preliminary and/or exploratory resolution discussions with the Department of Justice and the SEC, although there can be no assurance as to the outcome of these discussions.
In addition, a number of lawsuits have also been filed by non-governmental parties seeking damages or other remedies related to these retail sales practices. First, various class plaintiffs purporting to represent consumers who allege that they received products or services without their authorization or consent have brought separate putative class actions against the Company in the United States District Court for the Northern District of California and various other jurisdictions. In April 2017, the Company entered into a settlement agreement in the first-filed action, Jabbari v. Wells Fargo Bank, N.A ., to resolve claims regarding certain products or services provided without authorization or consent for the time period May 1, 2002 to April 20, 2017. Pursuant to the settlement, the Company will pay $142 million for remediation, attorneys’ fees, and settlement fund claims administration. In the unlikely event that the $142 million settlement total is not enough to provide remediation, pay attorneys’ fees, pay settlement fund claims administration costs, and have at least $25 million left over to distribute to all class members, the Company will contribute additional funds to the settlement. In addition, in the unlikely event that the number of unauthorized accounts identified by settlement class members in the claims process and not disputed by the claims administrator exceeds plaintiffs’ 3.5 million account estimate, the Company will proportionately increase the $25 million reserve so that the ratio of reserve to unauthorized accounts is no less than what was implied by plaintiffs’ estimate at the time of the district court’s preliminary approval of the settlement in July 2017. The district court issued an order

216
Wells Fargo & Company
 


granting final approval of the settlement on June 14, 2018. Several appeals of the district court’s order granting final approval of the settlement have been filed with the United States Court of Appeals for the Ninth Circuit. Second, Wells Fargo shareholders brought a consolidated securities fraud class action in the United States District Court for the Northern District of California alleging certain misstatements and omissions in the Company’s disclosures related to sales practices matters. The Company entered into a settlement agreement to resolve this matter pursuant to which the Company paid $480 million . The district court issued an order granting final approval of the settlement on December 20, 2018. Third, Wells Fargo shareholders have brought numerous shareholder derivative lawsuits asserting breach of fiduciary duty claims, among others, against current and former directors and officers for their alleged failure to detect and prevent sales practices issues. These actions have been filed or transferred to the United States District Court for the Northern District of California and California state court for coordinated proceedings. An additional lawsuit asserting similar claims in Delaware state court has been stayed. Subject to full documentation and court approval, the parties have reached an agreement in principle to resolve the shareholder derivative lawsuits pursuant to which insurance carriers will pay the Company approximately $240 million for alleged damage to the Company, and the Company will pay plaintiffs’ attorneys’ fees. Fourth, multiple employment litigation matters have been brought against Wells Fargo, including an Employee Retirement Income Security Act (ERISA) class action in the United States District Court for the District of Minnesota on behalf of 401(k) plan participants that has been dismissed and is now on appeal; a class action in the United States District Court for the Northern District of California on behalf of team members who allege that they protested sales practice misconduct and/or were terminated for not meeting sales goals that has now been dismissed, and we have entered into a framework with plaintiffs’ counsel to address individual claims that have been asserted; various wage and hour class actions brought in federal and state court in California (which have been settled), New Jersey, and Pennsylvania on behalf of non-exempt branch based team members alleging that sales pressure resulted in uncompensated overtime; and multiple single plaintiff Sarbanes-Oxley Act complaints and state law whistleblower actions filed with the United States Department of Labor or in various state courts alleging adverse employment actions for raising sales practice misconduct issues.
RMBS TRUSTEE LITIGATION In November 2014, a group of institutional investors (Institutional Investor Plaintiffs), including funds affiliated with BlackRock, Inc., filed a putative class action in the United States District Court for the Southern District of New York against Wells Fargo Bank, N.A., alleging claims against the Company in its capacity as trustee for a number of residential mortgage-backed securities (RMBS) trusts (Federal Court Complaint). Similar complaints have been filed against other trustees in various courts, including in the Southern District of New York, in New York state court, and in other states, by RMBS investors. The Federal Court Complaint alleges that Wells Fargo Bank, N.A., as trustee, caused losses to investors and asserts causes of action based upon, among other things, the trustee’s alleged failure to notify and enforce repurchase obligations of mortgage loan sellers for purported breaches of representations and warranties, notify investors of alleged events of default, and abide by appropriate standards of care following alleged events of default. Plaintiffs seek money damages in an unspecified amount, reimbursement of expenses,
 
and equitable relief. In December 2014 and December 2015, certain other investors filed four complaints alleging similar claims against Wells Fargo Bank, N.A. in the Southern District of New York (Related Federal Cases), and the various cases pending against Wells Fargo are proceeding before the same judge. On January 19, 2016, the Southern District of New York entered an order in connection with the Federal Court Complaint dismissing claims related to certain of the trusts at issue (Dismissed Trusts). The Company’s motion to dismiss the Federal Court Complaint and the complaints for the Related Federal Cases was granted in part and denied in part in March 2017. In May 2017, the Company filed third-party complaints against certain investment advisors affiliated with the Institutional Investor Plaintiffs seeking contribution with respect to claims alleged in the Federal Court Complaint (Third-Party Claims). The investment advisors have moved to dismiss those complaints. On April 17, 2018, the Southern District of New York denied class certification in the Related Federal Case brought by Royal Park Investments SA/NV (Royal Park Action).
A complaint raising similar allegations to those in the Federal Court Complaint was filed in May 2016 in New York state court by a different plaintiff investor. In December 2016, the Institutional Investor Plaintiffs filed a new putative class action complaint in New York state court in respect of 261 RMBS trusts, including the Dismissed Trusts, for which Wells Fargo Bank, N.A. serves or served as trustee (State Court Action).
In July 2017, certain of the plaintiffs from the State Court Action filed a civil complaint relating to Wells Fargo Bank, N.A.’s setting aside reserves for legal fees and expenses in connection with the liquidation of eleven RMBS trusts at issue in the State Court Action (Declaratory Judgment Action). The complaint seeks, among other relief, declarations that Wells Fargo Bank, N.A. is not entitled to indemnification, the advancement of funds, or the taking of reserves from trust funds for legal fees and expenses it incurs in defending the claims in the State Court Action. In November 2017, the Company’s motion to dismiss the complaint was granted. Plaintiffs filed a notice of appeal in January 2018.
In November 2018, the Institutional Investor Plaintiffs and the Company entered into a settlement agreement pursuant to which, among other terms, the Company will pay $43 million to resolve the Federal Court Complaint and the State Court Action. The settlement will also resolve the Third Party Claims and the Declaratory Judgment Action. The New York state court has scheduled a fairness hearing on the settlement for May 6, 2019. In addition, Royal Park Investments SA/NV and Wells Fargo Bank, N.A. have reached an agreement resolving the Royal Park Action. Other than the Royal Park Action, the Related Federal Cases are not covered by these settlement agreements.

SEMINOLE TRIBE TRUSTEE LITIGATION The Seminole Tribe of Florida filed a complaint in Florida state court alleging that Wells Fargo, as trustee, charged excess fees in connection with the administration of a minor’s trust and failed to invest the assets of the trust prudently. The complaint was later amended to include three individual current and former beneficiaries as plaintiffs and to remove the Tribe as a party to the case. In December 2016, the Company filed a motion to dismiss the amended complaint on the grounds that the Tribe is a necessary party and that the individual beneficiaries lack standing to bring claims. The motion was denied in June 2018. Trial is scheduled for October 2019.


 
Wells Fargo & Company
217


Note 16:   Legal Actions (continued)

WHOLESALE BANKING CONSENT ORDER INVESTIGATION On November 19, 2015, the Company entered into a consent order with the OCC, pursuant to which the Wholesale Banking group was required to implement customer due diligence standards that include collection of current beneficial ownership information for certain business customers. The Company is responding to inquiries from various federal government agencies regarding potentially inappropriate conduct in connection with the collection of beneficial ownership information.
OUTLOOK   As described above, the Company establishes accruals for legal actions when potential losses associated with the actions become probable and the costs can be reasonably estimated. The high end of the range of reasonably possible potential losses in excess of the Company’s accrual for probable and estimable losses was approximately $2.7 billion as of December 31, 2018 . The increase in the high end of the range from September 30, 2018, was due to a variety of matters, including the Company’s existing retail sales practices matters. The outcomes of legal actions are unpredictable and subject to significant uncertainties, and it is inherently difficult to determine whether any loss is probable or even possible. It is also inherently difficult to estimate the amount of any loss and there may be matters for which a loss is probable or reasonably possible but not currently estimable. Accordingly, actual losses may be in excess of the established accrual or the range of reasonably possible loss. Wells Fargo is unable to determine whether the ultimate resolution of the retail sales practices matters will have a material adverse effect on its consolidated financial condition. Based on information currently available, advice of counsel, available insurance coverage, and established reserves, Wells Fargo believes that the eventual outcome of other actions against Wells Fargo and/or its subsidiaries will not, individually or in the aggregate, have a material adverse effect on Wells Fargo’s consolidated financial condition. However, it is possible that the ultimate resolution of a matter, if unfavorable, may be material to Wells Fargo’s results of operations for any particular period.

218
Wells Fargo & Company
 


Note 17:   Derivatives
We use derivatives to manage exposure to market risk, including interest rate risk, credit risk and foreign currency risk, and to assist customers with their risk management objectives. We designate certain derivatives as hedging instruments in a qualifying hedge accounting relationship (fair value or cash flow hedge). Our remaining derivatives consist of economic hedges that do not qualify for hedge accounting and derivatives held for customer accommodation trading or other purposes.
Our asset/liability management approach to interest rate, foreign currency and certain other risks includes the use of derivatives. Such derivatives are typically designated as fair value or cash flow hedges, or economic hedges. We use derivatives to help minimize significant, unplanned fluctuations in earnings, fair values of assets and liabilities, and cash flows caused by interest rate, foreign currency and other market risk volatility. This approach involves modifying the repricing characteristics of certain assets and liabilities so that changes in interest rates, foreign currency and other exposures, which may cause the hedged assets and liabilities to gain or lose fair value, do not have a significantly adverse effect on the net interest margin, cash flows and earnings. In a fair value or economic hedge, the effect of change in fair value will generally be offset by the unrealized gain or loss on the derivatives linked to the hedged assets and liabilities. In a cash flow hedge, where we manage the variability of cash payments due to interest rate fluctuations by the effective use of derivatives linked to hedged assets and liabilities, the hedged asset or liability is not adjusted and the unrealized gain or loss on the derivative is recorded in other comprehensive income.
 
We also offer various derivatives, including interest rate, commodity, equity, credit and foreign exchange contracts, as an accommodation to our customers as part of our trading businesses. These derivative transactions, which involve our engaging in market-making activities or acting as an intermediary, are conducted in an effort to help customers manage their market risks. We usually offset our exposure from such derivatives by entering into other financial contracts, such as separate derivative or security transactions. These customer accommodations and any offsetting derivatives are treated as customer accommodation trading and other derivatives in our disclosures. Additionally, embedded derivatives that are required to be accounted for separately from their host contracts are included in the customer accommodation trading and other derivatives disclosures as applicable.
Table 17.1 presents the total notional or contractual amounts and fair values for our derivatives. Derivative transactions can be measured in terms of the notional amount, but this amount is not recorded on the balance sheet and is not, when viewed in isolation, a meaningful measure of the risk profile of the instruments. The notional amount is generally not exchanged, but is used only as the basis on which interest and other payments are determined.

 
Wells Fargo & Company
219


Note 17: Derivatives (continued)

Table 17.1: Notional or Contractual Amounts and Fair Values of Derivatives
 
December 31, 2018
 
 
December 31, 2017
 
 
Notional or 

 
Fair value 
 
 
Notional or 

 
Fair value 
 
 
contractual 

 
Asset 

 
Liability 

 
contractual 

 
Asset 

 
Liability 

(in millions)
amount 

 
derivatives 

 
derivatives 

 
amount 

 
derivatives 

 
derivatives 

Derivatives designated as hedging instruments
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate contracts (1)
$
177,511

 
2,237

 
636

 
209,677

 
2,492

 
1,092

Foreign exchange contracts (1)
34,176

 
573

 
1,376

 
34,135

 
1,482

 
1,137

Total derivatives designated as
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     qualifying hedging instruments
 
 
2,810

 
2,012

 
 
 
3,974

 
2,229

Derivatives not designated as hedging instruments
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Economic hedges:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate contracts (2)
173,215

 
849

 
369

 
220,558

 
159

 
201

Equity contracts
13,920

 
1,362

 
79

 
12,315

 
716

 
138

Foreign exchange contracts
19,521

 
225

 
80

 
15,976

 
78

 
309

Credit contracts - protection purchased
100

 
27

 

 
111

 
37

 

Subtotal
 
 
2,463

 
528

 
 
 
990

 
648

Customer accommodation trading and
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
other derivatives:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate contracts
9,162,821

 
15,349

 
15,303

 
6,434,673

 
14,979

 
14,179

Commodity contracts
66,173

 
1,588

 
2,336

 
62,530

 
2,354

 
1,335

Equity contracts
217,890

 
6,183

 
5,931

 
213,750

 
6,291

 
8,363

Foreign exchange contracts
364,982

 
5,916

 
5,657

 
362,896

 
7,413

 
7,122

Credit contracts - protection sold
11,741

 
76

 
182

 
9,021

 
147

 
214

Credit contracts - protection purchased
20,880

 
175

 
98

 
17,406

 
207

 
208

Subtotal
 
 
29,287

 
29,507

 
 
 
31,391

 
31,421

Total derivatives not designated as hedging instruments
 
 
31,750

 
30,035

 
 
 
32,381

 
32,069

Total derivatives before netting
 
 
34,560

 
32,047

 
 
 
36,355

 
34,298

Netting (3)
 
 
(23,790
)
 
(23,548
)
 
 
 
(24,127
)
 
(25,502
)
Total
 
 
$
10,770

 
8,499

 
 
 
12,228

 
8,796

(1)
Notional amounts presented at December 31, 2017, exclude $500 million of interest rate contracts for certain derivatives that are combined for designation as a hedge in a single relationship. No such hedging relationships existed at December 31, 2018. The notional amount for foreign exchange contracts at December 31, 2018 and 2017 , excludes $11.2 billion and $13.5 billion , respectively for certain derivatives that are combined for designation as a hedge on a single relationship.
(2)
Includes economic hedge derivatives used to hedge the risk of changes in the fair value of residential MSRs, MLHFS, loans, derivative loan commitments and other interests held.
(3)
Represents balance sheet netting of derivative asset and liability balances, related cash collateral and portfolio level counterparty valuation adjustments. See the next table in this Note for further information.


220
Wells Fargo & Company
 


Table 17.2 provides information on the gross fair values of derivative assets and liabilities, the balance sheet netting adjustments and the resulting net fair value amount recorded on our balance sheet, as well as the non-cash collateral associated with such arrangements. We execute substantially all of our derivative transactions under master netting arrangements and reflect all derivative balances and related cash collateral subject to enforceable master netting arrangements on a net basis within the balance sheet. The “Gross amounts recognized” column in the following table includes $30.9 billion and $28.4 billion of gross derivative assets and liabilities, respectively, at December 31, 2018 , and $30.0 billion and $29.9 billion , respectively, at December 31, 2017 , with counterparties subject to enforceable master netting arrangements that are carried on the balance sheet net of offsetting amounts. The remaining gross derivative assets and liabilities of $3.7 billion and $3.6 billion , respectively, at December 31, 2018 , and $6.4 billion and $4.4 billion , respectively, at December 31, 2017 , include those with counterparties subject to master netting arrangements for which we have not assessed the enforceability because they are with counterparties where we do not currently have positions to offset, those subject to master netting arrangements where we have not been able to confirm the enforceability and those not subject to master netting arrangements. As such, we do not net derivative balances or collateral within the balance sheet for these counterparties.
We determine the balance sheet netting adjustments based on the terms specified within each master netting arrangement. We disclose the balance sheet netting amounts within the column titled “Gross amounts offset in consolidated balance sheet.” Balance sheet netting adjustments are determined at the counterparty level for which there may be multiple contract types. For disclosure purposes, we allocate these netting adjustments to the contract type for each counterparty
 
proportionally based upon the “Gross amounts recognized” by counterparty. As a result, the net amounts disclosed by contract type may not represent the actual exposure upon settlement of the contracts.
We do not net non-cash collateral that we receive and pledge on the balance sheet. For disclosure purposes, we present the fair value of this non-cash collateral in the column titled “Gross amounts not offset in consolidated balance sheet (Disclosure-only netting)” within the table. We determine and allocate the Disclosure-only netting amounts in the same manner as balance sheet netting amounts.
The “Net amounts” column within Table 17.2 represents the aggregate of our net exposure to each counterparty after considering the balance sheet and Disclosure-only netting adjustments. We manage derivative exposure by monitoring the credit risk associated with each counterparty using counterparty specific credit risk limits, using master netting arrangements and obtaining collateral. Derivative contracts executed in over-the-counter markets include bilateral contractual arrangements that are not cleared through a central clearing organization but are typically subject to master netting arrangements. The percentage of our bilateral derivative transactions outstanding at period end in such markets, based on gross fair value, is provided within the following table. Other derivative contracts executed in over-the-counter or exchange-traded markets are settled through a central clearing organization and are excluded from this percentage. In addition to the netting amounts included in the table, we also have balance sheet netting related to resale and repurchase agreements that are disclosed within Note 15 (Guarantees, Pledged Assets and Collateral, and Other Commitments).



 
Wells Fargo & Company
221


Note 17: Derivatives (continued)

Table 17.2: Gross Fair Values of Derivative Assets and Liabilities
(in millions)
Gross amounts recognized

 
Gross amounts offset in consolidated balance sheet (1)

 
Net amounts in consolidated balance sheet

 
Gross amounts not offset in consolidated balance sheet (Disclosure-only netting) (2) 

 
Net amounts 

 
Percent exchanged in over-the-counter market (3)

December 31, 2018
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Derivative assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate contracts
$
18,435

 
(12,029
)
 
6,406

 
(80
)
 
6,326

 
90
%
Commodity contracts
1,588

 
(849
)
 
739

 
(4
)
 
735

 
57

Equity contracts
7,545

 
(5,318
)
 
2,227

 
(755
)
 
1,472

 
78

Foreign exchange contracts
6,714

 
(5,355
)
 
1,359

 
(35
)
 
1,324

 
100

Credit contracts-protection sold
76

 
(73
)
 
3

 

 
3

 
12

Credit contracts-protection purchased
202

 
(166
)
 
36

 
(1
)
 
35

 
78

Total derivative assets
$
34,560

 
(23,790
)
 
10,770

 
(875
)
 
9,895

 
 
Derivative liabilities
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate contracts
$
16,308

 
(13,152
)
 
3,156

 
(567
)
 
2,589

 
92
%
Commodity contracts
2,336

 
(727
)
 
1,609

 
(8
)
 
1,601

 
85

Equity contracts
6,010

 
(3,877
)
 
2,133

 
(110
)
 
2,023

 
75

Foreign exchange contracts
7,113

 
(5,522
)
 
1,591

 
(188
)
 
1,403

 
100

Credit contracts-protection sold
182

 
(180
)
 
2

 
(2
)
 

 
67

Credit contracts-protection purchased
98

 
(90
)
 
8

 

 
8

 
11

Total derivative liabilities
$
32,047

 
(23,548
)
 
8,499

 
(875
)
 
7,624

 
 
December 31, 2017
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Derivative assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate contracts
$
17,630

 
(11,929
)
 
5,701

 
(145
)
 
5,556

 
99
%
Commodity contracts
2,354

 
(966
)
 
1,388

 
(4
)
 
1,384

 
88

Equity contracts
7,007

 
(4,233
)
 
2,774

 
(596
)
 
2,178

 
76

Foreign exchange contracts
8,973

 
(6,656
)
 
2,317

 
(25
)
 
2,292

 
100

Credit contracts-protection sold
147

 
(145
)
 
2

 

 
2

 
10

Credit contracts-protection purchased
244

 
(198
)
 
46

 
(3
)
 
43

 
89

Total derivative assets
$
36,355

 
(24,127
)
 
12,228

 
(773
)
 
11,455

 
 
Derivative liabilities
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate contracts
$
15,472

 
(13,226
)
 
2,246

 
(1,078
)
 
1,168

 
99
%
Commodity contracts
1,335

 
(648
)
 
687

 
(1
)
 
686

 
76

Equity contracts
8,501

 
(4,041
)
 
4,460

 
(400
)
 
4,060

 
85

Foreign exchange contracts
8,568

 
(7,189
)
 
1,379

 
(204
)
 
1,175

 
100

Credit contracts-protection sold
214

 
(204
)
 
10

 
(9
)
 
1

 
85

Credit contracts-protection purchased
208

 
(194
)
 
14

 

 
14

 
9

Total derivative liabilities
$
34,298

 
(25,502
)
 
8,796

 
(1,692
)
 
7,104

 
 
(1)
Represents amounts with counterparties subject to enforceable master netting arrangements that have been offset in the consolidated balance sheet, including related cash collateral and portfolio level counterparty valuation adjustments. Counterparty valuation adjustments were $353 million and $245 million related to derivative assets and $152 million and $95 million related to derivative liabilities as of December 31, 2018 and 2017 , respectively. Cash collateral totaled $3.7 billion and $3.6 billion , netted against derivative assets and liabilities, respectively, at December 31, 2018 , and $2.7 billion and $4.2 billion , respectively, at December 31, 2017 .
(2)
Represents the fair value of non-cash collateral pledged and received against derivative assets and liabilities with the same counterparty that are subject to enforceable master netting arrangements. U.S. GAAP does not permit netting of such non-cash collateral balances in the consolidated balance sheet but requires disclosure of these amounts.
(3)
Represents derivatives executed in over-the-counter markets not settled through a central clearing organization. Over-the-counter percentages are calculated based on Gross amounts recognized as of the respective balance sheet date. The remaining percentage represents derivatives settled through a central clearing organization, which are executed in either over-the-counter or exchange-traded markets.

222
Wells Fargo & Company
 


Fair Value and Cash Flow Hedges
For fair value hedges, we use interest rate swaps to convert certain of our fixed-rate long-term debt and time certificates of deposit to floating rates to hedge our exposure to interest rate risk. We also enter into cross-currency swaps, cross-currency interest rate swaps and forward contracts to hedge our exposure to foreign currency risk and interest rate risk associated with the issuance of non-U.S. dollar denominated long-term debt. In addition, we use interest rate swaps, cross-currency swaps, cross-currency interest rate swaps and forward contracts to hedge against changes in fair value of certain investments in available-for-sale debt securities due to changes in interest rates, foreign currency rates, or both. We also use interest rate swaps to hedge against changes in fair value for certain mortgage loans held for sale.
 
For cash flow hedges, we use interest rate swaps to hedge the variability in interest payments received on certain floating-rate commercial loans and paid on certain floating-rate debt due to changes in the contractually specified interest rate.
We estimate $293 million pre-tax of deferred net losses primarily related to cash flow hedges in OCI at December 31, 2018 , will be reclassified into net interest income during the next twelve months. The deferred losses expected to be reclassified into net interest income are primarily related to discontinued hedges of floating rate loans. We are hedging our foreign exposure to the variability of future cash flows for all forecasted transactions for a maximum of 8 years.
Table 17.3 shows the net gains (losses) related to derivatives in fair value and cash flow hedging relationships.

Table 17.3: Gains (Losses) Recognized in Consolidated Statement of Income on Fair Value and Cash Flow Hedging Relationships (1)
 
Net interest income
 
 
Noninterest Income

 
(in millions)
Debt securities

Loans

Mortgage loans held for sale

Deposits

Long-term debt

 
Other

Total

Year ended December 31, 2018
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total amounts presented in the consolidated statement of income
$
14,406

43,974

777

(5,622
)
(6,703
)
 
2,473

49,305

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Gains (losses) on fair value hedging relationships
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate contracts
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Amounts related to interest settlements on derivatives (2)
(187
)

(3
)
(41
)
292

 

61

Recognized on derivatives
845

1

15

27

(1,923
)
 

(1,035
)
Recognized on hedged items
(877
)
(1
)
(22
)
(33
)
1,843

 

910

Foreign exchange contracts
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Amounts related to interest settlements on derivatives (2)(3)
33




(434
)
 

(401
)
Recognized on derivatives (4)
7




135

 
(1,204
)
(1,062
)
Recognized on hedged items
(1
)



(82
)
 
1,114

1,031

Net income (expense) recognized on fair value hedges
(180
)

(10
)
(47
)
(169
)
 
(90
)
(496
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Gains (losses) on cash flow hedging relationships
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest contracts
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Realized gains (losses) (pre tax) reclassified from cumulative OCI into net income (5)

(292
)


1

 

(291
)
Foreign exchange contracts
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Realized gains (losses) (pre-tax) reclassified from cumulative OCI into net income (5)




(3
)
 

(3
)
Net income (expense) recognized on cash flow hedges
$

(292
)


(2
)
 

(294
)

(continued on following page)

 
Wells Fargo & Company
223


Note 17: Derivatives (continued)

(continued from previous page)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net interest income
 
 
Noninterest Income

 
(in millions)
Debt securities

Loans

Mortgage loans held for sale

Deposits

Long-term debt

 
Other

Total

Year ended December 31, 2017
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total amounts presented in the consolidated statement of income
$
12,946

41,388

786

(3,013
)
(5,157
)
 
1,603

48,553

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Gains (losses) on fair value hedging relationships
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate contracts
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Amounts related to interest settlements on derivatives (2)
(469
)
(1
)
(5
)
36

1,286

 

847

Recognized on derivatives
(43
)
1

(5
)
(20
)
(912
)
 

(979
)
Recognized on hedged items
(52
)
(1
)
(4
)
36

938

 

917

Foreign exchange contracts
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Amounts related to interest settlements on derivatives (2)(3)
14




(210
)
 

(196
)
Recognized on derivatives (4)
13




(230
)
 
3,118

2,901

Recognized on hedged items
(10
)



255

 
(2,855
)
(2,610
)
         Net income (expense) recognized on fair value hedges
(547
)
(1
)
(14
)
52

1,127

 
263

880

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Gains (losses) on cash flow hedging relationships
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest contracts
 
 
 
 
 
 
 


Realized gains (losses) (pre tax) reclassified from cumulative OCI into net income (5)

551



(8
)
 

543

Foreign exchange contracts
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Realized gains (losses) (pre-tax) reclassified from cumulative OCI into net income (5)





 


         Net income (expense) recognized on cash flow hedges
$

551



(8
)
 

543

Year ended December 31, 2016
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total amounts presented in the consolidated statement of income
$
11,244

39,505

784

(1,395
)
(3,830
)
 
1,289

47,597

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Gains (losses) on fair value hedging relationships
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate contracts
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Amounts related to interest settlements on derivatives (2)
(582
)

(6
)
62

1,830

 

1,304

Recognized on derivatives





 
(2,175
)
(2,175
)
Recognized on hedged items





 
2,157

2,157

Foreign exchange contracts
 
 
 
 
 
 
 


Amounts related to interest settlements on derivatives (2)(3)
9




31

 

40

Recognized on derivatives





 
(274
)
(274
)
Recognized on hedged items





 
286

286

         Net income (expense) recognized on fair value hedges
(573
)

(6
)
62

1,861

 
(6
)
1,338

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Gains (losses) on cash flow hedging relationships
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest contracts
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Realized gains (losses) (pre tax) reclassified from cumulative OCI into net income (5)

1,043



(14
)
 

1,029

Gains (losses) (before tax) recognized in income for hedge ineffectiveness





 
(1
)
(1
)
Foreign exchange contracts
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Realized gains (losses) (pre-tax) reclassified from cumulative OCI into net income (5)





 


         Net income (expense) recognized on cash flow hedges
$

1,043



(14
)
 
(1
)
1,028

(1)
Year ended December 31, 2016, gain or loss amounts and presentation location were not conformed to new hedge accounting guidance that we adopted in 2017.
(2)
Includes changes in fair value due to the passage of time associated with the non-zero fair value amount at hedge inception .
(3)
Includes $(2) million , $(3) million and $(13) million for years ended December 31, 2018 , 2017 , and 2016 , respectively, of the time value component recognized as net interest income (expense) on forward derivatives hedging foreign currency available-for-sale securities and long-term debt that were excluded from the assessment of hedge effectiveness.
(4)
For certain fair value hedges of foreign currency risk, changes in fair value of cross-currency swaps attributable to changes in cross-currency basis spreads are excluded from the assessment of hedge effectiveness and recorded in other comprehensive income. See Note 25 (Other Comprehensive Income) for the amounts recognized in other comprehensive income.
(5)
See Note 25 (Other Comprehensive Income) for details of amounts reclassified to net income.

224
Wells Fargo & Company
 


Table 17.4 shows the carrying amount and associated cumulative basis adjustment related to the application of hedge accounting that is included in the carrying amount of hedged assets and liabilities in fair value hedging relationships.
 

Table 17.4: Hedged Items in Fair Value Hedging Relationship
 
Hedged Items Currently Designated
 
 
Hedged Items No Longer Designated (1)
 
(in millions)
Carrying Amount of Assets/(Liabilities) (2)(4)

Hedge Accounting Basis Adjustment
Assets/(Liabilities) (3)

 
Carrying Amount of Assets/(Liabilities) (4)

Hedge Accounting Basis Adjustment
Assets/(Liabilities)

December 31, 2018
 
 
 
 
 
Available-for-sale debt securities (5)
$
37,857

(157
)
 
4,938

238

Loans


 


Mortgage loans held for sale
448

7

 


Deposits
(56,535
)
115

 


Long-term debt
(104,341
)
(742
)
 
(25,539
)
366

December 31, 2017
 
 
 
 
 
Available-for-sale debt securities (5)
$
32,498

870

 
5,221

343

Loans
140

(1
)
 


Mortgage loans held for sale
465

(1
)
 


Deposits
(23,679
)
158

 


Long-term debt
(128,950
)
(2,154
)
 
(1,953
)
16

(1)
Represents hedged items no longer designated in qualifying fair value hedging relationships for which an associated basis adjustment exists at the balance sheet date.
(2)
Does not include the carrying amount of hedged items where only foreign currency risk is the designated hedged risk. The carrying amount excluded for debt securities is $1.6 billion and for long-term debt is $(6.3) billion as of December 31, 2018 , and $1.5 billion for debt securities and for long-term debt is $(7.7) billion as of December 31, 2017.
(3)
The balance includes $1.4 billion and $66 million of debt securities and long-term debt cumulative basis adjustments as of December 31, 2018 , respectively, and $2.1 billion and $297 million of debt securities and long-term debt cumulative basis adjustments as of December 31, 2017, respectively, on terminated hedges whereby the hedged items have subsequently been re-designated into existing hedges.
(4)
Represents the full carrying amount of the hedged asset or liability item as of the balance sheet date, except for circumstances in which only a portion of the asset or liability was designated as the hedged item in which case only the portion designated is presented.
(5)
Carrying amount represents the amortized cost.
Derivatives Not Designated as Hedging Instruments
We use economic hedge derivatives to hedge the risk of changes in the fair value of certain residential MLHFS, residential MSRs measured at fair value, derivative loan commitments and other interests held. We also use economic hedge derivatives to mitigate the periodic earnings volatility caused by mismatches between the changes in fair value of the hedged item and hedging instrument recognized on our fair value accounting hedges. The resulting gain or loss on these economic hedge derivatives is reflected in mortgage banking noninterest income, net gains (losses) from equity securities and other noninterest income.
The derivatives used to hedge MSRs measured at fair value, which include swaps, swaptions, constant maturity mortgages, forwards, Eurodollar and Treasury futures and options contracts, resulted in net derivative gains (losses) of $(1.1) billion , $413 million , and $261 million in 2018, 2017, and 2016 , respectively, which are included in mortgage banking noninterest income. The aggregate fair value of these derivatives was a net asset of $757 million at December 31, 2018 , and a net asset of $89 million at December 31, 2017 . The change in fair value of these derivatives for each period end is due to changes in the underlying market indices and interest rates as well as the purchase and sale of derivative financial instruments throughout the period as part of our dynamic MSR risk management process.
Loan commitments for mortgage loans that we intend to sell are considered derivatives. Our interest rate exposure on these derivative loan commitments, as well as residential MLHFS, is hedged with economic hedge derivatives such as swaps, forwards and options, Eurodollar futures and options, and Treasury futures, forwards and options contracts. The derivative loan commitments, economic hedge derivatives and residential
 
MLHFS are carried at fair value with changes in fair value included in mortgage banking noninterest income. For the fair value measurement of derivative loan commitments we include, at inception and during the life of the loan commitment, the expected net future cash flows related to the associated servicing of the loan. Fair value changes subsequent to inception are based on changes in fair value of the underlying loan resulting from the exercise of the commitment and changes in the probability that the loan will not fund within the terms of the commitment (referred to as a fall-out factor). The value of the underlying loan is affected by changes in interest rates and the passage of time. However, changes in investor demand can also cause changes in the value of the underlying loan value that cannot be hedged. The aggregate fair value of derivative loan commitments on the balance sheet was a net positive fair value of $60 million and $17 million at December 31, 2018 and 2017 , respectively, and is included in the caption “Interest rate contracts” under “Customer accommodation trading and other derivatives” in Table 17.1.
We also enter into various derivatives as an accommodation to our customers as part of our trading businesses. These derivatives are not linked to specific assets and liabilities on the balance sheet or to forecasted transactions in an accounting hedge relationship and, therefore, do not qualify for hedge accounting. We also enter into derivatives for risk management that do not otherwise qualify for hedge accounting. They are carried at fair value with changes in fair value recorded in noninterest income.
Customer accommodation trading and other derivatives also include embedded derivatives that are required to be accounted for separately from their host contract. We periodically issue hybrid long-term notes and CDs where the performance of the hybrid instrument notes is linked to an equity, commodity or

 
Wells Fargo & Company
225


Note 17: Derivatives (continued)

currency index, or basket of such indices. These notes contain explicit terms that affect some or all of the cash flows or the value of the note in a manner similar to a derivative instrument and therefore are considered to contain an “embedded” derivative instrument. The indices on which the performance of the hybrid instrument is calculated are not clearly and closely related to the host debt instrument. The “embedded” derivative is separated from the host contract and accounted for as a derivative. Additionally, we may invest in hybrid instruments that contain embedded derivatives, such as credit derivatives,
 
that are not clearly and closely related to the host contract. In such instances, we either elect fair value option for the hybrid instrument or separate the embedded derivative from the host contract and account for the host contract and derivative separately.
Table 17.5 shows the net gains (losses), recognized by income statement lines, related to derivatives not designated as hedging instruments.

Table 17.5: Gains (Losses) on Derivatives Not Designated as Hedging Instruments
 
Noninterest income
 
(in millions)
Mortgage banking

Net gains (losses) from equity securities

Net gains (losses) from trading activities

Other

Total

Year ended December 31, 2018





Net gains (losses) recognized on economic hedges derivatives:





Interest rate contracts (1)
$
(215
)


(15
)
(230
)
Equity contracts

(408
)

4

(404
)
Foreign exchange contracts



669

669

Credit contracts





Subtotal (2)
(215
)
(408
)

658

35

Net gains (losses) recognized on customer accommodation trading and other derivatives:





Interest rate contracts (3)
(352
)

446


94

Equity contracts


4,499

(403
)
4,096

Foreign exchange contracts


638


638

Credit contracts


1


1

Commodity contracts


83


83

Other





Subtotal
(352
)

5,667

(403
)
4,912

Net gains (losses) recognized related to derivatives not designated as hedging instruments
$
(567
)
(408
)
5,667

255

4,947


(Continued on following page)

226
Wells Fargo & Company
 


(continued from previous page)
 
 
Noninterest income
 
(in millions)
Mortgage banking

Net gains (losses) from equity securities

Net gains (losses) from trading activities

Other

Total

Year ended December 31, 2017
 
 
 
 
 
Net gains (losses) recognized on economic hedges derivatives:
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate contracts (1)
$
448



(75
)
373

Equity contracts

(1,483
)

17

(1,466
)
Foreign exchange contracts



(866
)
(866
)
Credit contracts



5

5

Subtotal (2)
448

(1,483
)

(919
)
(1,954
)
Net gains (losses) recognized on customer accommodation trading and other derivatives:
 
 
 
 

Interest rate contracts (3)
614


160


774

Equity contracts


(3,932
)
1

(3,931
)
Foreign exchange contracts


638


638

Credit contracts


(81
)

(81
)
Commodity contracts


178


178

Other





Subtotal
614


(3,037
)
1

(2,422
)
Net gains (losses) recognized related to derivatives not designated as hedging instruments
$
1,062

(1,483
)
(3,037
)
(918
)
(4,376
)
Year ended December 31, 2016
 
 
 
 
 
Net gains (losses) recognized on economic hedges derivatives:
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate contracts (1)
$
1,029



(51
)
978

Equity contracts

125


(11
)
114

Foreign exchange contracts



954

954

Credit contracts



21

21

Subtotal (2)
1,029

125


913

2,067

Net gains (losses) recognized on customer accommodation trading and other derivatives:
 
 
 
 
 
Interest contracts (3)
818


255


1,073

Equity contracts


(1,643
)

(1,643
)
Foreign exchange contracts


1,077


1,077

Credit contracts


(105
)

(105
)
Commodity contracts


216


216

Other


11


11

Subtotal
818


(189
)

629

Net gains (losses) recognized related to derivatives not designated as hedging instruments
$
1,847

125

(189
)
913

2,696

(1)
Includes gains (losses) on the derivatives used as economic hedges of MSRs measured at fair value, derivative loan commitments and mortgages held for sale.
(2)
Includes hedging gains (losses) of $9 million , $(71) million , and $(8) million for the years ended December 31, 2018 , 2017 , and 2016 , respectively, which partially offset hedge accounting ineffectiveness.
(3)
Amounts presented in mortgage banking noninterest income are gains (losses) on derivative loan commitments.

Credit Derivatives
Credit derivative contracts are arrangements whose value is derived from the transfer of credit risk of a reference asset or entity from one party (the purchaser of credit protection) to another party (the seller of credit protection). We use credit derivatives to assist customers with their risk management objectives. We may also use credit derivatives in structured product transactions or liquidity agreements written to special purpose vehicles. The maximum exposure of sold credit derivatives is managed through posted collateral, purchased credit derivatives and similar products in order to achieve our desired credit risk profile. This credit risk management provides an ability to recover a significant portion of any amounts that would be paid under the sold credit derivatives. We would be
 
required to perform under the sold credit derivatives in the event of default by the referenced obligors. Events of default include events such as bankruptcy, capital restructuring or lack of principal and/or interest payment. In certain cases, other triggers may exist, such as the credit downgrade of the referenced obligors or the inability of the special purpose vehicle for which we have provided liquidity to obtain funding.
Table 17.6 provides details of sold and purchased credit derivatives.

 
Wells Fargo & Company
227


Note 17: Derivatives (continued)

Table 17.6: Sold and Purchased Credit Derivatives
 
 
 
Notional amount
 
 
 
(in millions)
Fair value liability 

 
Protection sold (A)

 
Protection sold - non-investment grade

 
Protection purchased with identical underlyings (B)

 
Net protection sold (A)-(B) 

 
Other protection purchased 

 
Range of maturities 
December 31, 2018
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Credit default swaps on:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Corporate bonds
$
59

 
2,037

 
441

 
1,374

 
663

 
1,460

 
2019 - 2027
Structured products
62

 
133

 
128

 
121

 
12

 
113

 
2022 - 2047
Credit protection on:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Default swap index
1

 
3,618

 
582

 
1,998

 
1,620

 
2,896

 
2019 - 2028
Commercial mortgage-backed securities index
49

 
389

 
109

 
363

 
26

 
51

 
2047 - 2058
Asset-backed securities index
9

 
42

 
42

 
42

 

 
1

 
2045 - 2046
Other
2

 
5,522

 
5,327

 

 
5,522

 
12,561

 
2018 - 2048
Total credit derivatives
$
182

 
11,741

 
6,629

 
3,898

 
7,843

 
17,082

 
 
December 31, 2017
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Credit default swaps on:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Corporate bonds
$
35

 
2,007

 
510

 
1,575

 
432

 
946

 
2018 - 2027
Structured products
86

 
267

 
252

 
232

 
35

 
153

 
2022 - 2047
Credit protection on:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Default swap index

 
2,626

 
540

 
308

 
2,318

 
3,932

 
2018 - 2027
Commercial mortgage-backed securities index
83

 
423

 

 
401

 
22

 
87

 
2047 - 2058
Asset-backed securities index
9

 
42

 

 
42

 

 
1

 
2045 - 2046
Other
1

 
3,656

 
3,306

 

 
3,656

 
9,840

 
2018 - 2031
Total credit derivatives
$
214

 
9,021

 
4,608

 
2,558

 
6,463

 
14,959

 
 

Protection sold represents the estimated maximum exposure to loss that would be incurred under an assumed hypothetical circumstance, where the value of our interests and any associated collateral declines to zero, without any consideration of recovery or offset from any economic hedges. We believe this hypothetical circumstance to be an extremely remote possibility and accordingly, this required disclosure is not an indication of expected loss. The amounts under non-investment grade represent the notional amounts of those credit derivatives on which we have a higher risk of being required to perform under the terms of the credit derivative and are a function of the underlying assets.
We consider the risk of performance to be high if the underlying assets under the credit derivative have an external rating that is below investment grade or an internal credit default grade that is equivalent thereto. We believe the net protection sold, which is representative of the net notional amount of protection sold and purchased with identical underlyings, in combination with other protection purchased, is more representative of our exposure to loss than either non-investment grade or protection sold. Other protection purchased represents additional protection, which may offset the exposure to loss for protection sold, that was not purchased with an identical underlying of the protection sold.

Credit-Risk Contingent Features
Certain of our derivative contracts contain provisions whereby if the credit rating of our debt were to be downgraded by certain major credit rating agencies, the counterparty could demand additional collateral or require termination or replacement of derivative instruments in a net liability position. The aggregate fair value of all derivative instruments with such credit-risk-related contingent features that are in a net liability position was $7.4 billion at December 31, 2018 , and $8.3 billion at December 31, 2017 , respectively, for which we posted $5.6 billion and $7.1 billion , respectively, in collateral in the normal course of business. If the credit rating of our debt had been downgraded below investment grade, which is the credit-risk-related contingent feature that if triggered requires the
 
maximum amount of collateral to be posted, on December 31, 2018 , or December 31, 2017 , we would have been required to post additional collateral of $1.8 billion or $1.2 billion , respectively, or potentially settle the contract in an amount equal to its fair value. Some contracts require that we provide more collateral than the fair value of derivatives that are in a net liability position if a downgrade occurs.

Counterparty Credit Risk
By using derivatives, we are exposed to counterparty credit risk if counterparties to the derivative contracts do not perform as expected. If a counterparty fails to perform, our counterparty credit risk is equal to the amount reported as a derivative asset on our balance sheet. The amounts reported as a derivative asset are derivative contracts in a gain position, and to the extent subject to legally enforceable master netting arrangements, net of derivatives in a loss position with the same counterparty and cash collateral received. We minimize counterparty credit risk through credit approvals, limits, monitoring procedures, executing master netting arrangements and obtaining collateral, where appropriate. To the extent the master netting arrangements and other criteria meet the applicable requirements, including determining the legal enforceability of the arrangement, it is our policy to present derivative balances and related cash collateral amounts net on the balance sheet. We incorporate credit valuation adjustments (CVA) to reflect counterparty credit risk in determining the fair value of our derivatives. Such adjustments, which consider the effects of enforceable master netting agreements and collateral arrangements, reflect market-based views of the credit quality of each counterparty. Our CVA calculation is determined based on observed credit spreads in the credit default swap market and indices indicative of the credit quality of the counterparties to our derivatives.

228
Wells Fargo & Company
 


Note 18:   Fair Values of Assets and Liabilities
We use fair value measurements to record fair value adjustments to certain assets and liabilities and to determine fair value disclosures. Assets and liabilities recorded at fair value on a recurring basis are presented in Table 18.2 in this Note. From time to time, we may be required to record fair value adjustments on a nonrecurring basis. These nonrecurring fair value adjustments typically involve application of LOCOM accounting, write-downs of individual assets or application of the measurement alternative for nonmarketable equity securities. Assets recorded on a nonrecurring basis are presented in Table 18.12 in this Note.
Following is a discussion of the fair value hierarchy and the valuation methodologies we use for assets and liabilities recorded at fair value on a recurring or nonrecurring basis and for estimating fair value for financial instruments that are not recorded at fair value.

FAIR VALUE HIERARCHY We group our assets and liabilities measured at fair value in three levels based on the markets in which the assets and liabilities are traded and the reliability of the assumptions used to determine fair value. These levels are:
Level 1 – Valuation is based upon quoted prices for identical instruments traded in active markets.
Level 2 – Valuation is based upon quoted prices for similar instruments in active markets, quoted prices for identical or similar instruments in markets that are not active, and model-based valuation techniques for which all significant assumptions are observable in the market.
Level 3 – Valuation is generated from techniques that use significant assumptions that are not observable in the market. These unobservable assumptions reflect estimates of assumptions that market participants would use in pricing the asset or liability. Valuation techniques include use of option pricing models, discounted cash flow models and similar techniques.

 We do not classify equity securities in the fair value hierarchy if we use the non-published net asset value (NAV) per share (or its equivalent) that has been communicated to us as an investor as a practical expedient to measure fair value. We generally use NAV per share as the fair value measurement for certain nonmarketable equity fund investments. Marketable equity securities with published NAVs are classified in the fair value hierarchy.
In the determination of the classification of financial instruments in Level 2 or Level 3 of the fair value hierarchy, we consider all available information, including observable market data, indications of market liquidity and orderliness, and our understanding of the valuation techniques and significant inputs used. For securities in inactive markets, we use a predetermined percentage to evaluate the impact of fair value adjustments derived from weighting both external and internal indications of value to determine if the instrument is classified as Level 2 or Level 3. Otherwise, the classification of Level 2 or Level 3 is based upon the specific facts and circumstances of each instrument or instrument category and judgments are made regarding the significance of the Level 3 inputs to the instruments’ fair value measurement in its entirety. If Level 3 inputs are considered significant, the instrument is classified as Level 3.

 
Assets
SHORT-TERM FINANCIAL ASSETS  Short-term financial assets include cash and due from banks, interest-earning deposits with banks, federal funds sold and securities purchased under resale agreements and due from customers on acceptances (classified in Other Assets). These assets are carried at historical cost. The carrying amount is a reasonable estimate of fair value because of the relatively short time between the origination of the instrument and its expected realization.

TRADING DEBT SECURITIES Trading debt securities are recorded at fair value on a recurring basis. These securities are valued using internal trader prices that are subject to price verification procedures. The fair values derived using internal valuation techniques are verified against multiple pricing sources, including prices obtained from third- party vendors. Vendors compile prices from various sources and often apply matrix pricing for similar securities when no price is observable. We review pricing methodologies provided by the vendors in order to determine if observable market information is being used versus unobservable inputs. When evaluating the appropriateness of an internal trader price compared with vendor prices, considerations include the range and quality of vendor prices. Vendor prices are used to ensure the reasonableness of a trader price; however, valuing financial instruments involves judgments acquired from knowledge of a particular market. If a trader asserts that a vendor price is not reflective of market value, justification for using the trader price, including recent sales activity where possible, must be provided to and approved by the appropriate levels of management.

AVAILABLE-FOR-SALE AND HELD-TO-MATURITY DEBT SECURITIES   Available-for-sale (AFS) debt securities are recorded at fair value on a recurring basis and held-to-maturity (HTM) debt securities are recorded at amortized cost. HTM debt securities are subject to impairment and fair value measurement is recorded if the fair value declines below amortized cost and we do not expect to recover the entire amortized cost basis of the security. Fair value measurement for AFS and HTM debt securities is based upon various sources of market pricing. We use quoted prices in active markets, where available, and classify such instruments within Level 1 of the fair value hierarchy. For example, highly liquid government securities, such as U.S. Treasuries, are classified as Level 1. When instruments are traded in secondary markets and quoted market prices do not exist for such securities, we generally rely on internal valuation techniques or on prices obtained from vendors ( predominantly third-party pricing services), and accordingly, we classify these instruments as Level 2 or 3.
AFS debt securities traded in secondary markets are typically valued using unadjusted vendor prices or vendor prices adjusted by weighting them with internal discounted cash flow techniques, these prices are reviewed and, if deemed inappropriate by a trader who has the most knowledge of a particular market, can be adjusted. These securities, which include those measured using unadjusted vendor prices, are generally classified as Level 2 and typically involve using quoted market prices for the same or similar securities, pricing models, discounted cash flow analyses using significant inputs observable in the market where available or a combination of multiple valuation techniques. Examples include certain residential and commercial MBS, other asset-backed securities

 
Wells Fargo & Company
229


Note 18: Fair Values of Assets and Liabilities (continued)

municipal bonds, U.S. government and agency MBS, and corporate debt securities.
Debt security fair value measurements using significant inputs that are unobservable in the market due to limited activity or a less liquid market are classified as Level 3 in the fair value hierarchy. Such measurements include securities valued using internal models or a combination of multiple valuation techniques where the unobservable inputs are significant to the overall fair value measurement. Securities classified as Level 3 include certain residential and commercial MBS, other asset-backed securities, CDOs and certain CLOs, and certain residual and retained interests in residential mortgage loan securitizations. We value CDOs using the prices of similar instruments, the pricing of completed or pending third-party transactions or the pricing of the underlying collateral within the CDO. Where vendor prices are not readily available, we use management’s best estimate.

MORTGAGE LOANS HELD FOR SALE (MLHFS)  MLHFS are carried at LOCOM or at fair value. We carry substantially all of our residential MLHFS portfolio at fair value. Fair value is based on quoted market prices, where available, or the prices for other mortgage whole loans with similar characteristics. As necessary, these prices are adjusted for typical securitization activities, including servicing value, portfolio composition, market conditions and liquidity. Predominantly all of our MLHFS are classified as Level 2. For the portion where market pricing data is not available, we use a discounted cash flow model to estimate fair value and, accordingly, classify as Level 3.
 
LOANS HELD FOR SALE (LHFS)  LHFS are carried at LOCOM or at fair value. Loans used in our trading business are recorded at fair value on a recurring basis, and the fair value is based on current offerings in secondary markets for loans with similar characteristics. Loans that are subject to nonrecurring fair value adjustments are classified as Level 2.
 
LOANS  For information on how we report the carrying value of loans, see Note 1 (Summary of Significant Accounting Policies). Although most loans are not recorded at fair value on a recurring basis, reverse mortgages are recorded at fair value on a recurring basis. In addition, we record nonrecurring fair value adjustments to loans to reflect partial write-downs that are based on the observable market price of the loan or current appraised value of the collateral.
We provide fair value estimates that are based on an exit price notion in this disclosure for loans that are not recorded at fair value on a recurring or nonrecurring basis. The fair value estimates of these loans are differentiated by their financial characteristics, such as product classification, loan category, pricing features and remaining maturity. Prepayment and credit loss estimates are evaluated and used in the valuation process.
 
DERIVATIVES  All derivatives are recorded at fair value on a recurring basis. Derivative valuation includes the use of available market prices for our exchange-traded derivatives, such as certain interest rate futures and option contracts, which we classify as Level 1. However, substantially all of our derivatives are traded in over-the-counter (OTC) markets where quoted market prices are not always readily available. Therefore we value most OTC derivatives using internal valuation techniques. Valuation techniques and inputs to internally-developed models depend on the type of derivative and nature of the underlying rate, price or index upon which the derivative’s value is based. Key inputs can include yield curves, credit curves, foreign
 
exchange rates, prepayment rates, volatility measurements and correlation of such inputs. Where model inputs can be observed in a liquid market and the model does not require significant judgment, such derivatives are typically classified as Level 2 of the fair value hierarchy. Examples of derivatives classified as Level 2 include generic interest rate swaps, foreign currency swaps, commodity swaps, and certain option and forward contracts. When instruments are traded in less liquid markets and significant inputs are unobservable, such derivatives are classified as Level 3. Examples of derivatives classified as Level 3 include complex and highly structured derivatives, certain credit default swaps, derivative loan commitments written for our mortgage loans that we intend to sell and long-dated equity options where volatility is not observable. Additionally, significant judgments are required when classifying financial instruments within the fair value hierarchy, particularly between Level 2 and 3, as is the case for certain derivatives.
 
MORTGAGE SERVICING RIGHTS (MSRs) AND CERTAIN OTHER INTERESTS HELD IN SECURITIZATIONS MSRs and certain other interests held in securitizations (e.g., interest-only strips) do not trade in an active market with readily observable prices. Accordingly, we determine the fair value of MSRs using a valuation model that calculates the present value of estimated future net servicing income cash flows. The model incorporates assumptions that market participants use in estimating future net servicing income cash flows, including estimates of prepayment speeds (including housing price volatility), discount rates, default rates, cost to service (including delinquency and foreclosure costs), escrow account earnings, contractual servicing fee income, ancillary income and late fees. Commercial MSRs are carried at LOCOM and, therefore, can be subject to fair value measurements on a nonrecurring basis. Changes in the fair value of MSRs occur primarily due to the collection/realization of expected cash flows as well as changes in valuation inputs and assumptions. For other interests held in securitizations (such as interest-only strips), we use a valuation model that calculates the present value of estimated future cash flows. The model incorporates our own estimates of assumptions market participants use in determining the fair value, including estimates of prepayment speeds, discount rates, defaults and contractual fee income. Interest-only strips are recorded as trading assets. Our valuation approach is validated by our internal valuation model validation group. Fair value measurements of our MSRs and interest-only strips use significant unobservable inputs and, accordingly, we classify them as Level 3. 

EQUITY SECURITIES Marketable equity securities and certain nonmarketable equity securities for which we have elected to account for under the fair value method are recorded at fair value on a recurring basis. Our remaining nonmarketable equity securities are accounted for using the equity method, cost method or measurement alternative. These securities can be subject to nonrecurring fair value adjustments to record impairment write-downs or, for equity securities accounted for under the measurement alternative, adjustments to the carrying value due to the occurrence of observable transactions.
We use quoted prices to determine the fair value of marketable equity securities as the securities are publicly traded. Quoted prices are typically not available for nonmarketable equity securities. We therefore use other methods, such as market comparable pricing or discounted cash flow valuation techniques, to determine fair value for such securities. We use all available information in making this determination, which

230
Wells Fargo & Company
 


includes observable transaction prices for the same or similar security, vendor prices, broker quotes, trading multiples of comparable public companies and discounted cash flow models. Where appropriate we make adjustments to observed market data to reflect the comparative differences between the market data and the attributes of our equity security, such as differences with public companies and other investment-specific considerations like liquidity, marketability or differences in terms of the instruments. Substantially all of our nonmarketable equity securities accounted for under the cost method include Federal Reserve Bank stock and Federal Home Loan Bank stock, of which their carrying value approximate their fair value.

FORECLOSED ASSETS  Foreclosed assets are carried at net realizable value, which represents fair value less costs to sell. Fair value is generally based upon independent market prices or appraised values of the collateral and, accordingly, we classify foreclosed assets as Level 2.
 
Liabilities
DEPOSIT AND SHORT-TERM FINANCIAL LIABILITIES  Deposit and short-term financial liabilities are recorded at historical cost. For this disclosure, we estimate the fair value of deposit liabilities with a contractual or defined maturity and short-term financial liabilities, which include federal funds purchased, securities sold under repurchase agreements, commercial paper and other short-term borrowings. The carrying value of our short-term financial liabilities is a reasonable estimate of their fair value because of the relatively short time between their origination and expected realization.
 
OTHER LIABILITIES  Other liabilities recorded at fair value on a recurring basis predominantly include short sale liabilities. Short sale liabilities are predominantly classified as either Level 1 or Level 2, generally depending upon whether the underlying securities have readily available quoted prices in active markets.
 
LONG-TERM DEBT  Long-term debt is recorded at amortized cost. For this disclosure, we estimate the fair value of our long-term debt, which is largely denominated in U.S. dollars that are issued with a fixed or floating rate at varying levels of seniority and maturity.
 
Level 3 Asset and Liability Valuation Processes
We generally determine fair value of our Level 3 assets and liabilities by using internally-developed models and, to a lesser extent, prices obtained from vendors, which predominantly consist of third-party pricing services. Our valuation processes vary depending on which approach is utilized.
 
INTERNAL MODEL VALUATIONS  Our internally-developed models largely use discounted cash flow techniques. Use of such techniques requires determining relevant inputs, some of which are unobservable. Unobservable inputs are generally derived from historic performance of similar assets or determined from previous market trades in similar instruments. These unobservable inputs usually consist of discount rates, default rates, loss severity upon default, volatilities, correlations and prepayment rates, which are inherent within our Level 3 instruments. Such inputs can be correlated to similar portfolios with known historic experience or recent trades where particular unobservable inputs may be implied, but due to the nature of various inputs being reflected within a particular trade, the value of each input is considered unobservable. We attempt to
 
correlate each unobservable input to historic experience and other third-party data where available.
Internal valuation models are subject to review prescribed within our model risk management policies and procedures, which include model validation. The purpose of model validation includes ensuring the model is appropriate for its intended use and the appropriate controls exist to help mitigate risk of invalid valuations. Model validation assesses the adequacy and appropriateness of the model, including reviewing its key components, such as inputs, processing components, logic or theory, output results and supporting model documentation. Validation also includes ensuring significant unobservable model inputs are appropriate given observable market transactions or other market data within the same or similar asset classes. This process ensures modeled approaches are appropriate given similar product valuation techniques and are in line with their intended purpose.
We have ongoing monitoring procedures in place for our Level 3 assets and liabilities that use such internal valuation models. These procedures, which are designed to provide reasonable assurance that models continue to perform as expected after approved, include:
ongoing analysis and benchmarking to market transactions and other independent market data (including pricing vendors, if available);
back-testing of modeled fair values to actual realized transactions; and
review of modeled valuation results against expectations, including review of significant or unusual value fluctuations.

We update model inputs and methodologies periodically to reflect these monitoring procedures. Additionally, procedures and controls are in place to ensure existing models are subject to periodic reviews, and we perform full model revalidations as necessary.
All internal valuation models are subject to ongoing review by business-unit-level management, and all models are subject to additional oversight by a corporate-level risk management department. Corporate oversight responsibilities include evaluating the adequacy of business unit risk management programs, maintaining company-wide model validation policies and standards and reporting the results of these activities to management and our Corporate Model Risk Committee. This committee consists of senior executive management and reports on top model risk issues to the Company’s Risk Committee of the Board.

VENDOR-DEVELOPED VALUATIONS  In certain limited circumstances, we obtain pricing from third-party vendors for the value of our Level 3 assets or liabilities. We have processes in place to approve such vendors to ensure information obtained and valuation techniques used are appropriate. Once these vendors are approved to provide pricing information, we monitor and review the results to ensure the fair values are reasonable and in line with market experience in similar asset classes. While the input amounts used by the pricing vendor in determining fair value are not provided, and therefore unavailable for our review, we do perform one or more of the following procedures to validate the prices received:
comparison to other pricing vendors (if available);
variance analysis of prices;
corroboration of pricing by reference to other independent market data, such as market transactions and relevant benchmark indices;

 
Wells Fargo & Company
231


Note 18: Fair Values of Assets and Liabilities (continued)

review of pricing by Company personnel familiar with market liquidity and other market-related conditions; and
investigation of prices on a specific instrument-by-instrument basis.

Fair Value Measurements from Vendors
For certain assets and liabilities, we obtain fair value measurements from vendors, which predominantly consist of third-party pricing services, and record the unadjusted fair value in our financial statements. For instruments where we utilize vendor prices to record the price of an instrument, we perform additional procedures (see the “Vendor-Developed Valuations”
 
section). Methodologies employed, controls relied upon and inputs used by third-party pricing vendors are subject to additional review when such services are provided. This review may consist of, in part, obtaining and evaluating control reports issued and pricing methodology materials distributed.
Table 18.1 presents unadjusted fair value measurements provided by brokers or third-party pricing services by fair value hierarchy level. Fair value measurements obtained from brokers or third-party pricing services that we have adjusted to determine the fair value recorded in our financial statements are excluded from Table 18.1 .

Table 18.1: Fair Value Measurements by Brokers or Third-Party Pricing Services
 
Brokers 
 
 
Third-party pricing services 
 
(in millions)
Level 1 

 
Level 2 

 
Level 3 

 
Level 1 

 
Level 2 

 
Level 3 

December 31, 2018
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Trading debt securities
$

 

 

 
899

 
256

 

Available-for-sale debt securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities of U.S. Treasury and federal agencies

 

 

 
10,399

 
2,949

 

Securities of U.S. states and political subdivisions

 

 

 

 
48,377

 
43

Mortgage-backed securities

 

 

 

 
160,162

 
41

Other debt securities (1)

 
45

 
129

 

 
44,292

 
758

Total available-for-sale debt securities

 
45

 
129

 
10,399

 
255,780

 
842

Equity securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Marketable

 

 

 

 
158

 

Nonmarketable

 

 

 

 
1

 

Total equity securities

 

 

 

 
159

 

Derivative assets

 

 

 
17

 

 

Derivative liabilities

 

 

 
(12
)
 

 

Other liabilities (2)

 

 

 

 

 

December 31, 2017
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Trading debt securities
$

 

 

 
926

 
215

 

Available-for-sale debt securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities of U.S. Treasury and federal agencies

 

 

 
3,389

 
2,930

 

Securities of U.S. states and political subdivisions

 

 

 

 
50,401

 
49

Mortgage-backed securities

 
33

 

 

 
168,948

 
75

Other debt securities (1)

 
307

 
1,158

 

 
44,465

 
22

Total available-for-sale debt securities

 
340

 
1,158

 
3,389

 
266,744

 
146

Equity securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Marketable

 

 

 

 
227

 

Nonmarketable

 

 

 

 

 

Total equity securities

 

 

 

 
227

 

Derivative assets

 

 

 
19

 

 

Derivative liabilities

 

 

 
(19
)
 

 

Other liabilities (2)

 

 

 

 

 

(1)
Includes corporate debt securities, collateralized loan and other debt obligations, asset-backed securities, and other debt securities.
(2)
Includes short sale liabilities and other liabilities.


232
Wells Fargo & Company
 


Assets and Liabilities Recorded at Fair Value on a Recurring Basis
Table 18.2 presents the balances of assets and liabilities recorded at fair value on a recurring basis.
 

Table 18.2: Fair Value on a Recurring Basis
(in millions)
Level 1 

 
Level 2 

 
Level 3 

 
Netting 

 
Total 

December 31, 2018
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Trading debt securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities of U.S. Treasury and federal agencies
$
20,525

 
2,892

 

 

 
23,417

Securities of U.S. states and political subdivisions

 
3,272

 
3

 

 
3,275

Collateralized loan obligations    

 
673

 
237

 

 
910

Corporate debt securities

 
10,723

 
34

 

 
10,757

Mortgage-backed securities

 
30,715

 

 

 
30,715

Asset-backed securities

 
893

 

 

 
893

Other trading debt securities

 
6

 
16

 

 
22

Total trading debt securities
20,525

 
49,174

 
290

 

 
69,989

Available-for-sale debt securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities of U.S. Treasury and federal agencies
10,399

 
2,949

 

 

 
13,348

Securities of U.S. states and political subdivisions

 
48,820

 
444

 

 
49,264

Mortgage-backed securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Federal agencies

 
153,203

 

 

 
153,203

Residential

 
2,775

 

 

 
2,775

Commercial

 
4,184

 
41

 

 
4,225

Total mortgage-backed securities

 
160,162

 
41

 

 
160,203

Corporate debt securities
34

 
5,867

 
370

 

 
6,271

Collateralized loan and other debt obligations (1) 

 
34,543

 
800

 

 
35,343

Asset-backed securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Automobile loans and leases

 
925

 

 

 
925

Home equity loans

 
112

 

 

 
112

Other asset-backed securities

 
4,056

 
389

 

 
4,445

Total asset-backed securities

 
5,093

 
389

 

 
5,482

Other debt securities

 
1

 

 

 
1

Total available-for-sale debt securities
10,433

 
257,435

 
2,044

(2)

 
269,912

Mortgage loans held for sale

 
10,774

 
997

 

 
11,771

Loans held for sale

 
1,409

 
60

 

 
1,469

Loans

 

 
244

 

 
244

Mortgage servicing rights (residential)

 

 
14,649

 

 
14,649

Derivative assets:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate contracts
46

 
18,294

 
95

 

 
18,435

Commodity contracts

 
1,535

 
53

 

 
1,588

Equity contracts
1,648

 
4,582

 
1,315

 

 
7,545

Foreign exchange contracts
17

 
6,689

 
8

 

 
6,714

Credit contracts

 
179

 
99

 

 
278

Netting

 

 

 
(23,790
)
(3)
(23,790
)
Total derivative assets 
1,711

 
31,279

 
1,570

 
(23,790
)
 
10,770

Equity securities - excluding securities at NAV:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Marketable
23,205

 
757

 

 

 
23,962

Nonmarketable

 
24

 
5,468

 

 
5,492

Total equity securities
23,205

 
781

 
5,468

 

 
29,454

 Total assets included in the fair value hierarchy
$
55,874

 
350,852

 
25,322

 
(23,790
)
 
408,258

Equity securities at NAV (4)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
102

Total assets recorded at fair value


 


 


 


 
408,360

Derivative liabilities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate contracts
$
(21
)
 
(16,217
)
 
(70
)
 

 
(16,308
)
Commodity contracts

 
(2,287
)
 
(49
)
 

 
(2,336
)
Equity contracts
(1,492
)
 
(3,186
)
 
(1,332
)
 

 
(6,010
)
Foreign exchange contracts
(12
)
 
(7,067
)
 
(34
)
 

 
(7,113
)
Credit contracts

 
(216
)
 
(64
)
 

 
(280
)
Netting

 

 

 
23,548

(3)
23,548

Total derivative liabilities 
(1,525
)
 
(28,973
)
 
(1,549
)
 
23,548

 
(8,499
)
Short sale liabilities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities of U.S. Treasury and federal agencies
(11,850
)
 
(411
)
 

 

 
(12,261
)
Mortgage-backed securities

 
(47
)
 

 


 
(47
)
Corporate debt securities

 
(4,505
)
 

 

 
(4,505
)
Equity securities
(2,902
)
 
(2
)
 

 

 
(2,904
)
Other securities

 
(3
)
 

 

 
(3
)
Total short sale liabilities
(14,752
)
 
(4,968
)
 

 

 
(19,720
)
Other liabilities

 

 
(2
)
 

 
(2
)
Total liabilities recorded at fair value
$
(16,277
)
 
(33,941
)
 
(1,551
)
 
23,548

 
(28,221
)
(1)
Includes collateralized debt obligations of $800 million .
(2)
A significant portion of the balance consists of securities that are investment grade based on ratings received from the ratings agencies or internal credit grades categorized as investment grade if external ratings are not available. The securities are classified as Level 3 due to limited market activity.
(3)
Represents balance sheet netting of derivative asset and liability balances and related cash collateral. See Note 17 (Derivatives) for additional information.
(4)
Consists of certain nonmarketable equity securities that are measured at fair value using NAV per share (or its equivalent) as a practical expedient and are excluded from the fair value hierarchy.


(continued on following page)

 
Wells Fargo & Company
233


Note 18: Fair Values of Assets and Liabilities (continued)

(continued from previous page)
(in millions)
Level 1 

 
Level 2 

 
Level 3 

 
Netting 

 
Total 

December 31, 2017
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Trading debt securities:
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities of U.S. Treasury and federal agencies
$
12,491

 
2,383

 

 

 
14,874

Securities of U.S. states and political subdivisions

 
3,732

 
3

 

 
3,735

Collateralized loan obligations    

 
565

 
354

 

 
919

Corporate debt securities

 
11,760

 
31

 

 
11,791

Mortgage-backed securities

 
25,273

 

 

 
25,273

Asset-backed securities

 
993

 

 

 
993

Other trading debt securities

 
20

 
19

 

  
39

Total trading debt securities
12,491

 
44,726

 
407

  

  
57,624

Available-for-sale debt securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities of U.S. Treasury and federal agencies
3,389

 
2,930

 

  

  
6,319

Securities of U.S. states and political subdivisions

 
50,401

 
925

 

  
51,326

Mortgage-backed securities:
  
 
  
 
  
  
  
  
 
Federal agencies

 
160,219

 

  

  
160,219

Residential

 
4,607

 
1

  

  
4,608

Commercial

 
4,490

 
75

  

  
4,565

Total mortgage-backed securities

 
169,316

 
76

  

  
169,392

Corporate debt securities
56

 
7,203

 
407

  

  
7,666

Collateralized loan and other debt obligations (1) 

 
35,036

 
1,020

 

  
36,056

Asset-backed securities:
  
 
  
 
  
  
  
  
 
Automobile loans and leases

 
553

 

 

  
553

Home equity loans

 
149

 

  

  
149

Other asset-backed securities

 
4,380

 
566

 

  
4,946

Total asset-backed securities

 
5,082

 
566

 

  
5,648

Other debt securities

 

 

  

  

Total available-for-sale debt securities
3,445

 
269,968

 
2,994

(2)

  
276,407

Mortgage loans held for sale

 
15,118

 
998

  

  
16,116

Loans held for sale

 
1,009

 
14

  

  
1,023

Loans

 

 
376

  

  
376

Mortgage servicing rights (residential)

 

 
13,625

  

  
13,625

Derivative assets:
  
 
  
 
  
  
  
  
 
Interest rate contracts
17

 
17,479

 
134

  

  
17,630

Commodity contracts

 
2,318

 
36

  

  
2,354

Equity contracts
1,698

 
3,970

 
1,339

  

  
7,007

Foreign exchange contracts
19

 
8,944

 
10

  

  
8,973

Credit contracts

 
269

 
122

  

  
391

Netting

 

 

  
(24,127
)
(3)
(24,127
)
Total derivative assets 
1,734

 
32,980

 
1,641

  
(24,127
)
  
12,228

Equity securities - excluding securities at NAV:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Marketable
33,931

 
429

 

 

 
34,360

Nonmarketable

 
46

 
4,821

 

 
4,867

Total equity securities
33,931

 
475

 
4,821

 

 
39,227

 Total assets included in the fair value hierarchy
$
51,601

 
364,276

 
24,876

 
(24,127
)
 
416,626

Equity securities at NAV (4)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

Total assets recorded at fair value


 


 


 


  
416,626

Derivative liabilities:
  
 
  
 
  
  
  
  
 
Interest rate contracts
$
(17
)
 
(15,392
)
 
(63
)
  

  
(15,472
)
Commodity contracts

 
(1,318
)
 
(17
)
  

  
(1,335
)
Equity contracts
(1,313
)
 
(5,338
)
 
(1,850
)
  

  
(8,501
)
Foreign exchange contracts
(19
)
 
(8,546
)
 
(3
)
  

  
(8,568
)
Credit contracts

 
(336
)
 
(86
)
  

  
(422
)
Netting

 

 

  
25,502

(3)
25,502

Total derivative liabilities 
(1,349
)
 
(30,930
)
 
(2,019
)
  
25,502

  
(8,796
)
Short sale liabilities:
  
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
 
Securities of U.S. Treasury and federal agencies
(10,420
)
 
(568
)
 

  

  
(10,988
)
Mortgage-backed securities

 

 

  

  

Corporate debt securities

 
(4,986
)
 

  

  
(4,986
)
Equity securities
(2,168
)
 
(45
)
 

  

  
(2,213
)
Other securities

 
(285
)
 

  

  
(285
)
Total short sale liabilities
(12,588
)
 
(5,884
)
 

  

  
(18,472
)
Other liabilities

 

 
(3
)
  

  
(3
)
Total liabilities recorded at fair value
$
(13,937
)
 
(36,814
)
 
(2,022
)
  
25,502

  
(27,271
)
(1)
Includes collateralized debt obligations of $1.0 billion
(2)
Balance primarily consists of securities that are investment grade based on ratings received from the ratings agencies or internal credit grades categorized as investment grade if external ratings are not available. The securities are classified as Level 3 due to limited market activity.
(3)
Represents balance sheet netting of derivative asset and liability balances and related cash collateral. See Note 17 (Derivatives) for additional information.
(4)
Consists of certain nonmarketable equity investments that are measured at fair value using NAV per share (or its equivalent) as a practical expedient and are excluded from the fair value hierarchy.
Changes in Fair Value Levels
We monitor the availability of observable market data to assess the appropriate classification of financial instruments within the fair value hierarchy and transfer between Level 1, Level 2, and Level 3 accordingly. Observable market data includes but is not limited to quoted prices and market transactions. Changes in economic conditions or market liquidity generally will drive
 
changes in availability of observable market data. Changes in availability of observable market data, which also may result in changing the valuation technique used, are generally the cause of transfers between Level 1, Level 2, and Level 3. The amounts reported as transfers represent the fair value as of the beginning of the quarter in which the transfer occurred.


234
Wells Fargo & Company
 


The changes in Level 3 assets and liabilities measured at fair value on a recurring basis for the year ended December 31, 2018 , are presented in Table 18.3 .

Table 18.3: Changes in Level 3 Fair Value Assets and Liabilities on a Recurring Basis – 2018
 
 
 
Total net gains 
(losses) included in 
 
 
Purchases,
sales,
issuances
and
settlements, 
net (1)

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net unrealized 
gains (losses) 
included in 
income related 
to assets and 
liabilities held 
at period end

 
(in millions)
Balance, 
beginning 
of period

 
Net
income

 
Other
compre-
hensive
income 

 
 
Transfers 
into 
Level 3 (2)

 
Transfers 
out of
Level 3 (3)

 
Balance, 
end of 
period

 
(4)
Year ended December 31, 2018
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Trading debt securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities of U.S. states and
political subdivisions
$
3

 

 

 

 

 

 
3

 

 
Collateralized loan obligations
354

 
(12
)
 

 
(101
)
 

 
(4
)
 
237

 
(14
)
 
Corporate debt securities
31

 
(1
)
 

 
16

 

 
(12
)
 
34

 
(1
)
 
Other trading debt securities
19

 
(3
)
 

 

 

 

 
16

 

 
Total trading debt securities
407

 
(16
)
 

 
(85
)
 

 
(16
)
 
290

 
(15
)
(5)
Available-for-sale debt securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities of U.S. states and
political subdivisions
925

 
8

 
(8
)
 
(137
)
 

 
(344
)
 
444

 

 
Mortgage-backed securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 


 
 
 
Residential
1

 

 

 
(1
)
 

 

 

 

 
Commercial
75

 

 
(1
)
 
(33
)
 

 

 
41

 
(1
)
 
Total mortgage-backed securities
76

 

 
(1
)
 
(34
)
 

 

 
41

 
(1
)
 
Corporate debt securities
407

 
4

 
(3
)
 
(38
)
 

 

 
370

 

 
Collateralized loan and other
debt obligations
1,020

 
72

 
5

 
(297
)
 

 

 
800

 

 
Asset-backed securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 


 
 
 
Other asset-backed securities
566

 
5

 
(11
)
 
(171
)
 

 

 
389

 
(3
)
 
Total asset-backed securities
566

 
5

 
(11
)
 
(171
)
 

 

 
389

 
(3
)
 
Total available-for-sale debt securities
2,994

 
89

 
(18
)
 
(677
)
 

 
(344
)
 
2,044

 
(4
)
(6)
Mortgage loans held for sale
998

 
(27
)
 

 
(36
)
 
72

 
(10
)
 
997

 
(22
)
(7)
Loans held for sale
14

 
2

 

 
(36
)
 
80

 

 
60

 
1

 
Loans
376

 
(1
)
 

 
(131
)
 

 

 
244

 
(11
)
(7)
Mortgage servicing rights (residential) (8)
13,625

 
(915
)
 

 
1,939

 

 

 
14,649

 
960

(7)
Net derivative assets and liabilities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 


 
 
 
Interest rate contracts
71

 
(397
)
 

 
351

 

 

 
25

 
(42
)
 
Commodity contracts
19

 
3

 

 
(11
)
 
(7
)
 

 
4

 
(1
)
 
Equity contracts
(511
)
 
(108
)
 

 
522

 
(1
)
 
81

 
(17
)
 
(169
)
 
Foreign exchange contracts
7

 
(42
)
 

 
9

 

 

 
(26
)
 
(26
)
 
Credit contracts
36

 
5

 

 
(6
)
 

 

 
35

 
(1
)
 
Other derivative contracts

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
Total derivative contracts
(378
)
 
(539
)
 

 
865

 
(8
)
 
81

 
21

 
(239
)
(9)
Equity securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Marketable

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
Nonmarketable (10)
5,203

 
703

 

 
(450
)
 
16

 
(4
)
 
5,468

 
642

 
Total equity securities
5,203

 
703

 

 
(450
)
 
16

 
(4
)
 
5,468

 
642

(11)
Short sale liabilities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(5)
Other liabilities
(3
)
 
1

 

 

 

 

 
(2
)
 

(7)
(1)
See Table 18.4 for detail.
(2)
All assets and liabilities transferred into level 3 were previously classified within level 2.
(3)
All assets and liabilities transferred out of level 3 are classified as level 2.
(4)
Represents only net gains (losses) that are due to changes in economic conditions and management’s estimates of fair value and excludes changes due to the collection/realization of cash flows over time.
(5)
Included in net gains (losses) from trading activities in the income statement.
(6)
Included in net gains (losses) from debt securities in the income statement.
(7)
Included in mortgage banking and other noninterest income in the income statement.
(8)
For more information on the changes in mortgage servicing rights, see Note 10 (Mortgage Banking Activities).
(9)
Included in mortgage banking, trading activities, equity securities and other noninterest income in the income statement.
(10)
Beginning balance includes $382 million of auction rate securities, which changed from the cost to fair value method of accounting in connection with our adoption of ASU 2016-01 in first quarter 2018.
(11)
Included in net gains (losses) from equity securities in the income statement.

(continued on following page)

 
Wells Fargo & Company
235


Note 18: Fair Values of Assets and Liabilities (continued)

(continued from previous page)
 
Table 18.4 presents gross purchases, sales, issuances and settlements related to the changes in Level 3 assets and liabilities measured at fair value on a recurring basis for the year ended December 31, 2018 .

Table 18.4: Gross Purchases, Sales, Issuances and Settlements – Level 3 – 2018
(in millions)
Purchases 

 
Sales 

 
Issuances 

 
Settlements 

 
Net 

Year ended December 31, 2018
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Trading debt securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities of U.S. states and political subdivisions
$

 

 

 

 

Collateralized loan obligations
408

 
(348
)
 

 
(161
)
 
(101
)
Corporate debt securities
20

 
(4
)
 

 

 
16

Other trading debt securities

 

 

 

 

Total trading debt securities
428

 
(352
)
 

 
(161
)
 
(85
)
Available-for-sale debt securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities of U.S. states and political subdivisions

 
(6
)
 
79

 
(210
)
 
(137
)
Mortgage-backed securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Residential

 

 

 
(1
)
 
(1
)
Commercial

 

 

 
(33
)
 
(33
)
Total mortgage-backed securities

 

 

 
(34
)
 
(34
)
Corporate debt securities
33

 

 

 
(71
)
 
(38
)
Collateralized loan and other debt obligations
61

 
(149
)
 

 
(209
)
 
(297
)
Asset-backed securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Other asset-backed securities
25

 
(12
)
 
166

 
(350
)
 
(171
)
Total asset-backed securities
25

 
(12
)
 
166

 
(350
)
 
(171
)
Total available-for-sale debt securities
119

 
(167
)
 
245

 
(874
)
 
(677
)
Mortgage loans held for sale
87

 
(320
)
 
353

 
(156
)
 
(36
)
Loans held for sale
4

 
(40
)
 

 

 
(36
)
Loans
8

 

 
17

 
(156
)
 
(131
)
Mortgage servicing rights (residential) (1)

 
(71
)
 
2,010

 

 
1,939

Net derivative assets and liabilities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate contracts

 

 

 
351

 
351

Commodity contracts

 

 

 
(11
)
 
(11
)
Equity contracts
3

 
(37
)
 

 
556

 
522

Foreign exchange contracts

 

 

 
9

 
9

Credit contracts
12

 
(7
)
 

 
(11
)
 
(6
)
Other derivative contracts

 

 

 

 

Total derivative contracts
15

 
(44
)
 

 
894

 
865

Equity securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Marketable

 

 

 

 

Nonmarketable

 
(51
)
 

 
(399
)
 
(450
)
Total equity securities

 
(51
)
 

 
(399
)
 
(450
)
Short sale liabilities

 

 

 

 

Other liabilities

 

 

 

 

(1)
For more information on the changes in mortgage servicing rights, see Note 10 (Mortgage Banking Activities).

236
Wells Fargo & Company
 


The changes in Level 3 assets and liabilities measured at fair value on a recurring basis for the year ended December 31, 2017 , are presented in Table 18.5 .

Table 18.5: Changes in Level 3 Fair Value Assets and Liabilities on a Recurring Basis – 2017
 
 
 
Total net gains 
 (losses) included in 
 
 
Purchases,
sales,
issuances
and
settlements,
net (1) 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net unrealized
gains (losses)
included in 
income related 
to assets and 
liabilities held 
at period end

 
(in millions)
Balance,
beginning
of period 

 
Net
income 

 
Other
compre-
hensive
income 

 
 
Transfers
into
Level 3  (2)

 
Transfers
out of
Level 3 (3)

 
Balance,
end of
period 

 
(4)
Year ended December 31, 2017
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Trading debt securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities of U.S. states and
political subdivisions
$
3

 

 

 

 

 

 
3

 

 
Collateralized loan obligations
309

 
3

 

 
42

 

 

 
354

 
(13
)
 
Corporate debt securities
34

 
2

 

 
(7
)
 
6

 
(4
)
 
31

 
2

 
Other trading debt securities
28

 
(9
)
 

 

 

 

 
19

 
(4
)
 
Total trading debt securities
374

 
(4
)
 

 
35

 
6

 
(4
)
 
407

 
(15
)
(5)
Available-for-sale debt securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities of U.S. states and
political subdivisions
1,140

 
4

 
5

 
1,105

 
5

 
(1,334
)
 
925

 

 
Mortgage-backed securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Residential
1

 

 

 

 

 

 
1

 

 
Commercial
91

 
(4
)
 

 
(12
)
 

 

 
75

 
(11
)
 
Total mortgage-backed securities
92

 
(4
)
 

 
(12
)
 

 

 
76

 
(11
)
 
Corporate debt securities
432

 
(1
)
 
23

 
(47
)
 

 

 
407

 

 
Collateralized loan and other
debt obligations
879

 
22

 
103

 
16

 

 

 
1,020

 

 
Asset-backed securities:

 

 

 

 
 
 
 
 

 

 
Other asset-backed securities
962

 
1

 
3

 
(400
)
 

 

 
566

 

 
Total asset-backed securities
962

 
1

 
3

 
(400
)
 

 

 
566

 

 
Total available-for-sale debt securities
3,505

 
22

 
134

 
662

 
5

 
(1,334
)
 
2,994

 
(11
)
(6)
Mortgage loans held for sale
985

 
(36
)
 

 
(75
)
 
134

 
(10
)
 
998

 
(34
)
(7)
Loans held for sale

 
1

 

 
(3
)
 
34

 
(18
)
 
14

 

 
Loans
758

 
(6
)
 

 
(376
)
 

 

 
376

 
(12
)
(7)
Mortgage servicing rights (residential) (8)
12,959

 
(2,115
)
 

 
2,781

 

 

 
13,625

 
(126
)
(7)
Net derivative assets and liabilities:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
Interest rate contracts
121

 
604

 

 
(654
)
 

 

 
71

 
(52
)
 
Commodity contracts
23

 
(17
)
 

 
13

 
2

 
(2
)
 
19

 
15

 
Equity contracts
(267
)
 
(199
)
 

 
(37
)
 
(53
)
 
45

 
(511
)
 
(259
)
 
Foreign exchange contracts
12

 
(5
)
 

 

 

 

 
7

 
6

 
Credit contracts
77

 
24

 

 
(65
)
 

 

 
36

 
(62
)
 
Other derivative contracts
(47
)
 
27

 

 
20

 

 

 

 

 
Total derivative contracts
(81
)
 
434

 

 
(723
)
 
(51
)
 
43

 
(378
)
 
(352
)
(9)
Equity securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Marketable

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
Nonmarketable
3,259

 
1,563

 

 
(2
)
 
1

 

 
4,821

 
1,569

 
Total equity securities
3,259

 
1,563

 

 
(2
)
 
1

 

 
4,821

 
1,569

(10)
Short sale liabilities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(5)
Other liabilities
(4
)
 
1

 

 

 

 

 
(3
)
 

(7)
(1)
See Table 18.6 for detail.
(2)
All assets and liabilities transferred into level 3 were previously classified within level 2.
(3)
All assets and liabilities transferred out of level 3 are classified as level 2.
(4)
Represents only net gains (losses) that are due to changes in economic conditions and management’s estimates of fair value and excludes changes due to the collection/realization of cash flows over time.
(5)
Included in net gains (losses) from trading activities in the income statement.
(6)
Included in net gains (losses) from debt securities in the income statement.
(7)
Included in mortgage banking and other noninterest income in the income statement.
(8)
For more information on the changes in mortgage servicing rights, see Note 10 (Mortgage Banking Activities)
(9)
Included in mortgage banking, trading activities, equity securities and other noninterest income in the income statement.
(10)
Included in net gains (losses) from equity securities in the income statement.

(continued on following page)

 
Wells Fargo & Company
237


Note 18: Fair Values of Assets and Liabilities (continued)

(continued from previous page)
 
Table 18.6 presents gross purchases, sales, issuances and settlements related to the changes in Level 3 assets and liabilities measured at fair value on a recurring basis for the year ended December 31, 2017 .

Table 18.6: Gross Purchases, Sales, Issuances and Settlements – Level 3 – 2017
(in millions)
Purchases 

 
Sales 

 
Issuances 

 
Settlements 

 
Net 

Year ended December 31, 2017
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Trading debt securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities of U.S. states and political subdivisions
$
37

 
(36
)
 

 
(1
)
 

Collateralized loan obligations
439

 
(250
)
 

 
(147
)
 
42

Corporate debt securities
25

 
(32
)
 

 

 
(7
)
Other trading debt securities

 

 

 

 

Total trading debt securities
501

 
(318
)
 

 
(148
)
 
35

Available-for-sale debt securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities of U.S. states and political subdivisions

 
(68
)
 
1,369

 
(196
)
 
1,105

Mortgage-backed securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Residential

 

 

 

 

Commercial

 

 

 
(12
)
 
(12
)
Total mortgage-backed securities

 

 

 
(12
)
 
(12
)
Corporate debt securities
14

 
(4
)
 

 
(57
)
 
(47
)
Collateralized loan and other debt obligations
135

 

 

 
(119
)
 
16

Asset-backed securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Other asset-backed securities

 

 
211

 
(611
)
 
(400
)
Total asset-backed securities

 

 
211

 
(611
)
 
(400
)
Total available-for-sale debt securities
149

 
(72
)
 
1,580

 
(995
)
 
662

Mortgage loans held for sale
79

 
(485
)
 
489

 
(158
)
 
(75
)
Loans held for sale

 
(2
)
 

 
(1
)
 
(3
)
Loans
6

 
(129
)
 
19

 
(272
)
 
(376
)
Mortgage servicing rights (residential) (1)
541

 
(24
)
 
2,263

 
1

 
2,781

Net derivative assets and liabilities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate contracts

 

 

 
(654
)
 
(654
)
Commodity contracts

 

 

 
13

 
13

Equity contracts

 
(118
)
 

 
81

 
(37
)
Foreign exchange contracts

 

 

 

 

Credit contracts
6

 
(3
)
 

 
(68
)
 
(65
)
Other derivative contracts

 

 

 
20

 
20

Total derivative contracts
6

 
(121
)
 

 
(608
)
 
(723
)
Equity securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 


Marketable

 

 

 

 

Nonmarketable

 
(2
)
 

 

 
(2
)
Total equity securities

 
(2
)
 

 

 
(2
)
Short sale liabilities
3

 
(3
)
 

 

 

Other liabilities

 

 

 

 

(1)
For more information on the changes in mortgage servicing rights, see Note 10 (Mortgage Banking Activities).


238
Wells Fargo & Company
 


The changes in Level 3 assets and liabilities measured at fair value on a recurring basis for the year ended December 31, 2016 , are presented in Table 18.7 .

Table 18.7: Changes in Level 3 Fair Value Assets and Liabilities on a Recurring Basis – 2016
 
 
 
Total net gains 
 (losses) included in 
 
 
Purchases,
sales,
issuances
and
settlements,
net (1) 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net unrealized
gains (losses)
included in 
income related 
to assets and 
liabilities held 
at period end

 
(in millions)
Balance,
beginning
of period 

 
Net
income 

 
Other
compre-
hensive
income 

 
 
Transfers
into
Level 3  (2)

 
Transfers
out of
Level 3  (3)

 
Balance,
end of
period 

 
(4)
Year ended December 31, 2016
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Trading debt securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities of U.S. states and
political subdivisions
$
8

 

 

 
(5
)
 

 

 
3

 

 
Collateralized loan obligations
343

 
(38
)
 

 
15

 

 
(11
)
 
309

 
(42
)
 
Corporate debt securities
56

 
(7
)
 

 
(13
)
 

 
(2
)
 
34

 

 
Other trading debt securities
34

 
(6
)
 

 
(1
)
 
1

 

 
28

 
1

 
Total trading debt securities
441

 
(51
)
 

 
(4
)
 
1

 
(13
)
 
374

 
(41
)
(5)
Available-for-sale debt securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities of U.S. states and
political subdivisions
1,500

 
6

 
(25
)
 
60

 
80

 
(481
)
 
1,140

 

 
Mortgage-backed securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Residential
1

 

 

 

 

 

 
1

 

 
Commercial
73

 

 
1

 
17

 

 

 
91

 
(1
)
 
Total mortgage-backed securities
74

 

 
1

 
17

 

 

 
92

 
(1
)
 
Corporate debt securities
405

 
21

 
35

 
(29
)
 

 

 
432

 
(2
)
 
Collateralized loan and other
debt obligations
565

 
50

 
(1
)
 
265

 

 

 
879

 

 
Asset-backed securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Other asset-backed securities
1,182

 
2

 
(8
)
 
(214
)
 

 

 
962

 
(4
)
 
Total asset-backed securities
1,182

 
2

 
(8
)
 
(214
)
 

 

 
962

 
(4
)
 
Total available-for-sale debt securities
3,726

 
79

 
2

 
99

 
80

 
(481
)
 
3,505

 
(7
)
(6)
Mortgage loans held for sale
1,082

 
(19
)
 

 
(159
)
 
98

 
(17
)
 
985

 
(24
)
(7)
Loans held for sale

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
Loans
5,316

 
(59
)
 

 
(4,499
)
 

 

 
758

 
(24
)
(7)
Mortgage servicing rights (residential) (8)
12,415

 
(1,595
)
 

 
2,139

 

 

 
12,959

 
565

(7)
Net derivative assets and liabilities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate contracts
288

 
843

 

 
(1,003
)
 

 
(7
)
 
121

 
170

 
Commodity contracts
12

 
10

 

 
(2
)
 
4

 
(1
)
 
23

 
11

 
Equity contracts
(111
)
 
(80
)
 

 
(156
)
 
21

 
59

 
(267
)
 
(176
)
 
Foreign exchange contracts

 
(3
)
 

 
(1
)
 
16

 

 
12

 
(4
)
 
Credit contracts
(3
)
 
31

 

 
49

 

 

 
77

 
26

 
Other derivative contracts
(58
)
 
11

 

 

 

 

 
(47
)
 
11

 
Total derivative contracts
128

 
812

 

 
(1,113
)
 
41

 
51

 
(81
)
 
38

(9)
Equity securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Marketable

 

 

 
(1
)
 
1

 

 

 

 
Nonmarketable
3,065

 
(30
)
 

 
224

 

 

 
3,259

 
(30
)
 
Total equity securities
3,065

 
(30
)
 

 
223

 
1

 

 
3,259

 
(30
)
(10)
Short sale liabilities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(5)
Other liabilities
(30
)
 
1

 

 
25

 

 

 
(4
)
 

(7)
 
(1)
See Table 18.8 for detail.
(2)
All assets and liabilities transferred into level 3 were previously classified within level 2.
(3)
All assets and liabilities transferred out of level 3 are classified as level 2.
(4)
Represents only net gains (losses) that are due to changes in economic conditions and management’s estimates of fair value and excludes changes due to the collection/realization of cash flows over time.
(5)
Included in net gains (losses) from trading activities in the income statement.
(6)
Included in net gains (losses) from debt securities in the income statement.
(7)
Included in mortgage banking and other noninterest income in the income statement.
(8)
For more information on the changes in mortgage servicing rights, see Note 10 (Mortgage Banking Activities).
(9)
Included in mortgage banking, trading activities, equity securities and other noninterest income in the income statement.
(10)
Included in net gains (losses) from equity securities in the income statement.
(continued on following page)

 
Wells Fargo & Company
239


Note 18: Fair Values of Assets and Liabilities (continued)

(continued from previous page)

Table 18.8 presents gross purchases, sales, issuances and settlements related to the changes in Level 3 assets and liabilities measured at fair value on a recurring basis for the year ended December 31, 2016

Table 18.8: Gross Purchases, Sales, Issuances and Settlements – Level 3 – 2016
(in millions)
Purchases 

 
Sales 

 
Issuances 

 
Settlements 

 
Net 

Year ended December 31, 2016
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Trading debt securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities of U.S. states and political subdivisions
$
2

 
(2
)
 

 
(5
)
 
(5
)
Collateralized loan obligations
372

 
(357
)
 

 

 
15

Corporate debt securities
37

 
(50
)
 

 

 
(13
)
Other trading debt securities

 
(1
)
 

 

 
(1
)
Total trading debt securities
411

 
(410
)
 

 
(5
)
 
(4
)
Available-for-sale debt securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities of U.S. states and political subdivisions
28

 
(24
)
 
547

 
(491
)
 
60

Mortgage-backed securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Residential

 

 

 

 

Commercial
22

 

 

 
(5
)
 
17

Total mortgage-backed securities
22

 

 

 
(5
)
 
17

Corporate debt securities
36

 
(12
)
 

 
(53
)
 
(29
)
Collateralized loan and other debt obligations
618

 
(54
)
 

 
(299
)
 
265

Asset-backed securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Other asset-backed securities
50

 
(28
)
 
235

 
(471
)
 
(214
)
Total asset-backed securities
50

 
(28
)
 
235

 
(471
)
 
(214
)
Total available-for-sale debt securities
754

 
(118
)
 
782

 
(1,319
)
 
99

Mortgage loans held for sale
87

 
(618
)
 
565

 
(193
)
 
(159
)
Loans held for sale

 

 

 

 

Loans
21

 
(3,791
)
 
302

 
(1,031
)
 
(4,499
)
Mortgage servicing rights (residential) (1)

 
(66
)
 
2,204

 
1

 
2,139

Net derivative assets and liabilities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate contracts

 

 

 
(1,003
)
 
(1,003
)
Commodity contracts

 

 

 
(2
)
 
(2
)
Equity contracts
29

 
(147
)
 

 
(38
)
 
(156
)
Foreign exchange contracts

 

 

 
(1
)
 
(1
)
Credit contracts
7

 
(4
)
 

 
46

 
49

Other derivative contracts

 

 

 

 

Total derivative contracts
36

 
(151
)
 

 
(998
)
 
(1,113
)
Equity securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Marketable

 
(1
)
 

 

 
(1
)
Nonmarketable
225

 

 

 
(1
)
 
224

Total equity securities
225

 
(1
)
 

 
(1
)
 
223

Short sale liabilities

 

 

 

 

Other liabilities

 

 

 
25

 
25

(1)
For more information on the changes in mortgage servicing rights, see Note 10 (Mortgage Banking Activities).

Table 18.9 and Table 18.10 provide quantitative information about the valuation techniques and significant unobservable inputs used in the valuation of substantially all of our Level 3 assets and liabilities measured at fair value on a recurring basis for which we use an internal model.
The significant unobservable inputs for Level 3 assets and liabilities that are valued using fair values obtained from third-party vendors are not included in the table, as the specific inputs applied are not provided by the vendor (see discussion regarding vendor-developed valuations within the “Level 3 Asset and Liability Valuation Processes” section previously within this Note).
 
In addition, the table excludes the valuation techniques and significant unobservable inputs for certain classes of Level 3 assets and liabilities measured using an internal model that we consider, both individually and in the aggregate, insignificant relative to our overall Level 3 assets and liabilities. We made this determination based upon an evaluation of each class, which considered the magnitude of the positions, nature of the unobservable inputs and potential for significant changes in fair value due to changes in those inputs .

240
Wells Fargo & Company
 


Table 18.9: Valuation Techniques – Recurring Basis – 2018
($ in millions, except cost to service amounts)
Fair Value Level 3

 
Valuation Technique(s)
 
Significant Unobservable Input
 
Range of Inputs 
 
 
 
Weighted
Average (1)

December 31, 2018
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Trading and available-for-sale debt securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities of U.S. states and
political subdivisions:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Government, healthcare and
other revenue bonds
$
404

 
Discounted cash flow
 
Discount rate
 
2.1

-
6.4

%
 
3.4

 
43

 
Vendor priced
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Collateralized loan and other debt
obligations (2)
298

 
Market comparable pricing
 
Comparability adjustment
 
(13.5
)
-
22.1

 
 
3.2

 
739

 
Vendor priced
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Asset-backed securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Diversified payment rights (3)
171

 
Discounted cash flow
 
Discount rate
 
3.4

-
6.2

 
 
4.4

Other commercial and consumer
198

(4)
Discounted cash flow
 
Discount rate
 
4.6

-
5.2

 
 
4.7

 
 
 
 
 
Weighted average life
 
1.1

-
1.5

yrs
 
1.1

 
20

 
Vendor priced
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Mortgage loans held for sale (residential)
982

 
Discounted cash flow
 
Default rate
 
0.0

-
15.6

%
 
0.8

 
 
 
 
 
Discount rate
 
1.1

-
6.6

 
 
5.5

 
 
 
 
 
Loss severity
 
0.0

-
43.3

 
 
23.4

 
 
 
 
 
Prepayment rate
 
3.2

-
13.4

 
 
4.6

 
15

 
Market comparable pricing
 
Comparability adjustment
 
(56.3
)
-
(6.3
)
 
 
(36.3
)
Loans
244

(5)
Discounted cash flow
 
Discount rate
 
3.4

-
6.4

 
 
4.2

 
 
 
 
 
Prepayment rate
 
2.9

-
100.0

 
 
87.2

 
 
 
 
 
Loss severity
 
0.0

-
34.8

 
 
10.2

Mortgage servicing rights (residential)
14,649

 
Discounted cash flow
 
Cost to service per loan (6)
 
$
62

-
507

 
 
106

 
 
 
 
 
Discount rate
 
7.1

-
15.3

%
 
8.1

 
 
 
 
 
Prepayment rate (7)
 
9.0

-
23.5

 
 
9.9

Net derivative assets and (liabilities):
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate contracts
(35
)
 
Discounted cash flow
 
Default rate
 
0.0

-
5.0

 
 
2.0

 
 
 
 
 
Loss severity
 
50.0

-
50.0

 
 
50.0

 
 
 
 
 
Prepayment rate
 
2.8

-
25.0

 
 
13.8

Interest rate contracts: derivative loan
commitments
60

 
Discounted cash flow
 
Fall-out factor
 
1.0

-
99.0

 
 
19.4

 
 
 
 
 
Initial-value servicing
 
(36.6
)
-
91.7

bps
 
18.5

Equity contracts
104

 
Discounted cash flow
 
Conversion factor
 
(9.3
)
-
0.0

%
 
(7.8
)
 
 
 
 
 
Weighted average life
 
1.0

-
3.0

yrs
 
1.8

 
(121
)
 
Option model
 
Correlation factor
 
(77.0
)
-
99.0

%
 
21.6

 
 
 
 
 
Volatility factor
 
6.5

-
100.0

 
 
21.8

Credit contracts
3

 
Market comparable pricing
 
Comparability adjustment
 
(15.5
)
-
40.0

 
 
3.5

 
32

 
Option model
 
Credit spread
 
0.9

-
21.5

 
 
1.3

 
 
 
 
 
Loss severity
 
13.0

-
60.0

 
 
45.2

Nonmarketable equity securities
5,468

 
Market comparable pricing
 
Comparability adjustment
 
(20.6
)
-
(4.3
)
 
 
(15.8
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Insignificant Level 3 assets, net of liabilities
497

(8)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total level 3 assets, net of liabilities
$
23,771

(9)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(1)
Weighted averages are calculated using outstanding unpaid principal balance for cash instruments, such as loans and securities, and notional amounts for derivative instruments.
(2)
Includes $800 million of collateralized debt obligations.
(3)
Securities backed by specified sources of current and future receivables generated from foreign originators.
(4)
Predominantly consists of investments in asset-backed securities that are revolving in nature, for which the timing of advances and repayments of principal are uncertain.
(5)
Consists of reverse mortgage loans.
(6)
The high end of the range of inputs is for servicing modified loans. For non-modified loans the range is $62 - $204 .
(7)
Includes a blend of prepayment speeds and expected defaults. Prepayment speeds are influenced by mortgage interest rates as well as our estimation of drivers of borrower behavior.
(8)
Represents the aggregate amount of Level 3 assets and liabilities measured at fair value on a recurring basis that are individually and in the aggregate insignificant. The amount includes corporate debt securities, mortgage-backed securities, other trading positions, loans held for sale, other liabilities and certain net derivative assets and liabilities, such as commodity contracts and foreign exchange contracts.
(9)
Consists of total Level 3 assets of $25.3 billion and total Level 3 liabilities of $1.6 billion , before netting of derivative balances.


 
Wells Fargo & Company
241


Note 18: Fair Values of Assets and Liabilities (continued)

Table 18.10: Valuation Techniques – Recurring Basis – 2017
($ in millions, except cost to service amounts)    
Fair Value
Level 3

  
Valuation Technique(s)
 
Significant
Unobservable Input
 
Range of Inputs 
 
Weighted   
Average (1)
 
December 31, 2017
  
  
  
 
  
 
  

  
  

  
 
 

Trading and available-for-sale debt securities:
  
  
  
 
  
 
  

  
  

  
 
 

Securities of U.S. states and
political subdivisions:
  
  
  
 
  
 
  

  
  

  
 
 

Government, healthcare and
other revenue bonds
$
868

  
Discounted cash flow
 
Discount rate
 
1.7

-
5.8

%
 
2.7

Other municipal bonds
11

  
Discounted cash flow
 
Discount rate
 
4.7

-
4.9

  
 
4.8

 
49

  
Vendor priced
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Collateralized loan and other debt
obligations (2)
354

  
Market comparable pricing
 
Comparability adjustment
 
(22.0
)
-
19.5

%
 
3.0

 
1,020

  
Vendor priced
 
  
 
  

  
  

  
 
  

Asset-backed securities:
  
  
  
 
  
 
  

  
  

  
 
  

Diversified payment rights (3)
292

  
Discounted cash flow
 
Discount rate
 
2.4

-
3.9

 
 
3.1

Other commercial and consumer
248

(4)
Discounted cash flow
 
Discount rate
 
3.7

-
5.2

  
 
3.9

 
  
  
  
 
Weighted average life
 
2.0

-
2.3

yrs
 
2.1

 
26

  
Vendor priced
 
  
 
  

  
  

  
 
  

Mortgage loans held for sale (residential)
974

  
Discounted cash flow
 
Default rate
 
0.0

-
7.1

%
 
1.3

  
  
  
  
 
Discount rate
 
2.6

-
7.3

  
 
5.6

  
  
  
  
 
Loss severity
 
0.1

-
41.4

  
 
19.6

  
  
  
  
 
Prepayment rate
 
6.5

-
15.9

  
 
9.1

 
24

 
Market comparable pricing
 
Comparability adjustment
 
(56.3
)
-
(6.3
)
 
 
(42.7
)
Loans
376

(5)
Discounted cash flow
 
Discount rate
 
3.1

-
7.5

  
 
4.2

 
  
  
  
 
Prepayment rate
 
8.7

-
100.0

  
 
91.9

 
  
  
  
 
Loss severity
 
0.0

-
33.9

  
 
6.6

Mortgage servicing rights (residential)
13,625

  
Discounted cash flow
 
Cost to service per
loan (6)
 
$
78

-
587

  
 
143

 
  
  
  
 
Discount rate
 
6.6

-
12.9

%
 
6.9

 
  
  
  
 
Prepayment rate (7)
 
9.7

-
20.5

  
 
10.5

Net derivative assets and (liabilities):
  
  
  
 
  
 
  

  
  

  
 
  

Interest rate contracts
54

  
Discounted cash flow
 
Default rate
 
0.0

-
5.0

  
 
2.1

  
  
  
  
 
Loss severity
 
50.0

-
50.0

  
 
50.0

 
 
 
 
 
Prepayment rate
 
2.8

-
12.5

 
 
10.5

Interest rate contracts: derivative loan
commitments
17

 
Discounted cash flow
 
Fall-out factor
 
1.0

-
99.0

  
 
15.2

 
  
  
  
 
Initial-value servicing
 
(59.9
)
-
101.1

bps
 
2.7

Equity contracts
102

  
Discounted cash flow
 
Conversion factor
 
(9.7
)
-
0.0

%
 
(7.6
)
 
  
  
  
 
Weighted average life
 
0.5

-
3.0

yrs
 
1.6

 
(613
)
  
Option model
 
Correlation factor
 
(77.0
)
-
98.0

%
 
24.2

 
  
  
  
 
Volatility factor
 
5.7

-
95.5

  
 
19.2

Credit contracts
(3
)
  
Market comparable pricing
 
Comparability adjustment
 
(29.9
)
-
17.3

  
 
(0.2
)
 
39

  
Option model
 
Credit spread
 
0.0

-
63.7

  
 
1.3

 
  
  
  
 
Loss severity
 
13.0

-
60.0

  
 
50.7

Nonmarketable equity securities
8

  
Discounted cash flow
 
Discount rate
 
10.0

-
10.0

  
 
10.0

 
 
 
 
 
Volatility Factor
 
0.5

-
1.9

 
 
1.4

 
4,813

 
Market comparable pricing
 
Comparability adjustment
 
(21.1
)
-
(5.5
)
 
 
(15.0
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Insignificant Level 3 assets, net of liabilities
570

(8)
  
 
  
 
  

  
  

  
 
 

Total level 3 assets, net of liabilities
$
22,854

(9)
  
 
  
 
  

  
  

  
 
 

(1)
Weighted averages are calculated using outstanding unpaid principal balance for cash instruments such as loans and securities, and notional amounts for derivative instruments.
(2)
Includes $1.0 billion of collateralized debt obligations.
(3)
Securities backed by specified sources of current and future receivables generated from foreign originators.
(4)
A significant portion of the balance consists of investments in asset-backed securities that are revolving in nature, for which the timing of advances and repayments of principal are uncertain.
(5)
Consists of reverse mortgage loans.
(6)
The high end of the range of inputs is for servicing modified loans. For non-modified loans the range is $78 - $252 .
(7)
Includes a blend of prepayment speeds and expected defaults. Prepayment speeds are influenced by mortgage interest rates as well as our estimation of drivers of borrower behavior.
(8)
Represents the aggregate amount of Level 3 assets and liabilities measured at fair value on a recurring basis that are individually and in the aggregate insignificant. The amount includes corporate debt securities, mortgage-backed securities, other trading positions, other liabilities and certain net derivative assets and liabilities, such as commodity contracts and foreign exchange contracts. 
(9)
Consists of total Level 3 assets of $24.9 billion and total Level 3 liabilities of $2.0 billion , before netting of derivative balances.

242
Wells Fargo & Company
 


The valuation techniques used for our Level 3 assets and liabilities, as presented in the previous tables, are described as follows: 
Discounted cash flow – Discounted cash flow valuation techniques generally consist of developing an estimate of future cash flows that are expected to occur over the life of an instrument and then discounting those cash flows at a rate of return that results in the fair value amount.
Market comparable pricing – Market comparable pricing valuation techniques are used to determine the fair value of certain instruments by incorporating known inputs, such as recent transaction prices, pending transactions, or prices of other similar investments that require significant adjustment to reflect differences in instrument characteristics.
Option model – Option model valuation techniques are generally used for instruments in which the holder has a contingent right or obligation based on the occurrence of a future event, such as the price of a referenced asset going above or below a predetermined strike price. Option models estimate the likelihood of the specified event occurring by incorporating assumptions such as volatility estimates, price of the underlying instrument and expected rate of return.
Vendor-priced  – Prices obtained from third-party pricing vendors or brokers that are used to record the fair value of the asset or liability for which the related valuation technique and significant unobservable inputs are not provided.
 
Significant unobservable inputs presented in the previous tables are those we consider significant to the fair value of the Level 3 asset or liability. We consider unobservable inputs to be significant if by their exclusion the fair value of the Level 3 asset or liability would be impacted by a predetermined percentage change. We also consider qualitative factors, such as nature of the instrument, type of valuation technique used, and the significance of the unobservable inputs relative to other inputs used within the valuation. Following is a description of the significant unobservable inputs provided in the table. 
Comparability adjustment – is an adjustment made to observed market data, such as a transaction price in order to reflect dissimilarities in underlying collateral, issuer, rating, or other factors used within a market valuation approach, expressed as a percentage of an observed price.
Conversion Factor – is the risk-adjusted rate in which a particular instrument may be exchanged for another instrument upon settlement, expressed as a percentage change from a specified rate.
Correlation factor – is the likelihood of one instrument changing in price relative to another based on an established relationship expressed as a percentage of relative change in price over a period over time.

 
Cost to service – is the expected cost per loan of servicing a portfolio of loans, which includes estimates for unreimbursed expenses (including delinquency and foreclosure costs) that may occur as a result of servicing such loan portfolios.
Credit spread – is the portion of the interest rate in excess of a benchmark interest rate, such as Overnight Index Swap (OIS), LIBOR or U.S. Treasury rates, that when applied to an investment captures changes in the obligor’s creditworthiness.
Default rate – is an estimate of the likelihood of not collecting contractual amounts owed expressed as a constant default rate (CDR).
Discount rate – is a rate of return used to calculate the present value of the future expected cash flow to arrive at the fair value of an instrument. The discount rate consists of a benchmark rate component and a risk premium component. The benchmark rate component, for example, OIS, LIBOR or U.S. Treasury rates, is generally observable within the market and is necessary to appropriately reflect the time value of money. The risk premium component reflects the amount of compensation market participants require due to the uncertainty inherent in the instruments’ cash flows resulting from risks such as credit and liquidity.
Fall-out factor – is the expected percentage of loans associated with our interest rate lock commitment portfolio that are likely of not funding.
Initial-value servicing – is the estimated value of the underlying loan, including the value attributable to the embedded servicing right, expressed in basis points of outstanding unpaid principal balance.
Loss severity – is the estimated percentage of contractual cash flows lost in the event of a default.
Prepayment rate – is the estimated rate at which forecasted prepayments of principal of the related loan or debt instrument are expected to occur, expressed as a constant prepayment rate (CPR).
Volatility factor – is the extent of change in price an item is estimated to fluctuate over a specified period of time expressed as a percentage of relative change in price over a period over time.
Weighted average life – is the weighted average number of years an investment is expected to remain outstanding based on its expected cash flows reflecting the estimated date the issuer will call or extend the maturity of the instrument or otherwise reflecting an estimate of the timing of an instrument’s cash flows whose timing is not contractually fixed.

 

 
Wells Fargo & Company
243


Note 18: Fair Values of Assets and Liabilities (continued)

Significant Recurring Level 3 Fair Value Asset and Liability Input Sensitivity
We generally use discounted cash flow or similar internal modeling techniques to determine the fair value of our Level 3 assets and liabilities. Use of these techniques requires determination of relevant inputs and assumptions, some of which represent significant unobservable inputs as indicated in the preceding tables. Accordingly, changes in these unobservable inputs may have a significant impact on fair value.
Certain of these unobservable inputs will (in isolation) have a directionally consistent impact on the fair value of the instrument for a given change in that input. Alternatively, the fair value of the instrument may move in an opposite direction for a given change in another input. Where multiple inputs are used within the valuation technique of an asset or liability, a change in one input in a certain direction may be offset by an opposite change in another input having a potentially muted impact to the overall fair value of that particular instrument. Additionally, a change in one unobservable input may result in a change to another unobservable input (that is, changes in certain inputs are interrelated to one another), which may counteract or magnify the fair value impact.
 
SECURITIES, LOANS, MORTGAGE LOANS HELD FOR SALE and NONMARKETABLE EQUITY INVESTMENTS  The fair values of predominantly all Level 3 trading securities, mortgage loans held for sale, loans, other nonmarketable equity investments, and available-for-sale securities have consistent inputs, valuation techniques and correlation to changes in underlying inputs. The internal models used to determine fair value for these Level 3 instruments use certain significant unobservable inputs within a discounted cash flow or market comparable pricing valuation technique. Such inputs include discount rate, prepayment rate, default rate, loss severity, comparability adjustment and weighted average life.
These Level 3 assets would decrease (increase) in value based upon an increase (decrease) in discount rate, default rate, loss severity, or weighted average life inputs and would generally decrease (increase) in value based upon an increase (decrease) in prepayment rate. Generally, a change in the assumption used for default rate is accompanied by a directionally similar change in the risk premium component of the discount rate (specifically, the portion related to credit risk) and a directionally opposite change in the assumption used for prepayment rates. The comparability adjustment input may have a positive or negative impact on fair value depending on the change in fair value the comparability adjustment references. Unobservable inputs for comparability adjustment, loss severity, and weighted average life do not increase or decrease based on movements in the other significant unobservable inputs for these Level 3 assets.
 
 
DERIVATIVE INSTRUMENTS   Level 3 derivative instruments are valued using market comparable pricing, option pricing and discounted cash flow valuation techniques. We utilize certain unobservable inputs within these techniques to determine the fair value of the Level 3 derivative instruments. The significant unobservable inputs consist of credit spread, a comparability adjustment, prepayment rate, default rate, loss severity, initial-value servicing, fall-out factor, volatility factor, weighted average life, conversion factor, and correlation factor.
Level 3 derivative assets (liabilities) where we are long the underlying would decrease (increase) in value upon an increase (decrease) in default rate, fall-out factor, credit spread, conversion factor, or loss severity inputs. Conversely, Level 3 derivative assets (liabilities) would generally increase (decrease) in value upon an increase (decrease) in prepayment rate, initial-value servicing, weighted average life, or volatility factor inputs. The inverse of the above relationships would occur for instruments in which we are short the underlying. The correlation factor and comparability adjustment inputs may have a positive or negative impact on the fair value of these derivative instruments depending on the change in value of the item the correlation factor and comparability adjustment is referencing. The correlation factor and comparability adjustment are considered independent from movements in other significant unobservable inputs for derivative instruments.
Generally, for derivative instruments for which we are subject to changes in the value of the underlying referenced instrument, a change in the assumption used for default rate is accompanied by directionally similar change in the risk premium component of the discount rate (specifically, the portion related to credit risk) and a directionally opposite change in the assumption used for prepayment rates. Unobservable inputs for loss severity, fall-out factor, initial-value servicing, weighted average life, conversion factor, and volatility do not increase or decrease based on movements in other significant unobservable inputs for these Level 3 instruments.
 
MORTGAGE SERVICING RIGHTS   We use a discounted cash flow valuation technique to determine the fair value of Level 3 mortgage servicing rights. These models utilize certain significant unobservable inputs including prepayment rate, discount rate and costs to service. An increase in any of these unobservable inputs will reduce the fair value of the mortgage servicing rights and alternatively, a decrease in any one of these inputs would result in the mortgage servicing rights increasing in value. Generally, a change in the assumption used for the default rate is accompanied by a directionally similar change in the assumption used for cost to service and a directionally opposite change in the assumption used for prepayment. The sensitivity of our residential MSRs is discussed further in Note 9 (Securitizations and Variable Interest Entities).


244
Wells Fargo & Company
 


Assets and Liabilities Recorded at Fair Value on a Nonrecurring Basis
We may be required, from time to time, to measure certain assets at fair value on a nonrecurring basis in accordance with GAAP. These adjustments to fair value usually result from application of LOCOM accounting, write-downs of individual assets or commencing in 2018 with our adoption of
 
ASU 2016-01, use of the measurement alternative for nonmarketable equity securities. Table 18.12 provides the fair value hierarchy and fair value at the date of the nonrecurring fair value adjustment for all assets that were still held as of December 31, 2018  and 2017 , and for which a nonrecurring fair value adjustment was recorded during the years then ended.
 

Table 18.12: Fair Value on a Nonrecurring Basis
 
December 31, 2018
 
 
December 31, 2017
 
(in millions)
Level 1 

 
Level 2 

 
Level 3 

 
Total 

 
Level 1 

 
Level 2 

 
Level 3 

 
Total 

Mortgage loans held for sale (LOCOM) (1)
$

 
1,213

 
1,233

 
2,446

 

 
1,646

 
1,333

 
2,979

Loans held for sale

 
313

 

 
313

 

 
108

 

 
108

Loans:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial

 
339

 

 
339

 

 
374

 

 
374

Consumer

 
346

 
1

 
347

 

 
502

 
10

 
512

Total loans (2)

 
685

 
1

 
686

 

 
876

 
10

 
886

Nonmarketable equity securities (3)

 
774

 
157

 
931

 

 

 
136

 
136

Other assets (4)

 
149

 
6

 
155

 

 
177

 
161

 
338

Total assets at fair value on a nonrecurring basis (5)
$

 
3,134

 
1,397

 
4,531

 

 
2,807

 
1,640

 
4,447

(1)
Consists of commercial mortgages and residential real estate 1-4 family first mortgage loans.
(2)
Represents the carrying value of loans for which nonrecurring adjustments are based on the appraised value of the collateral.
(3)
Consists of certain nonmarketable equity securities that are measured at fair value on a nonrecurring basis, including observable price adjustments for nonmarketable equity securities carried under the measurement alternative.
(4)
Includes the fair value of foreclosed real estate, other collateral owned and operating lease assets.
(5)
Prior period balances exclude $6 million of nonmarketable equity securities at NAV.
Table 18.13 presents the increase (decrease) in value of certain assets held at the end of the respective reporting periods presented for which a nonrecurring fair value adjustment was recognized during the periods presented.

Table 18.13: Change in Value of Assets with Nonrecurring Fair Value Adjustment
 
Year ended December 31,
 
(in millions)
2018

 
2017

Mortgage loans held for sale (LOCOM)
$
21

 
10

Loans held for sale
(39
)
 
(2
)
Loans:

 
 
Commercial
(221
)
 
(335
)
Consumer
(284
)
 
(424
)
Total loans (1)
(505
)
 
(759
)
Nonmarketable equity securities (2)
265

 
(178
)
Other assets (3)
(40
)
 
(121
)
Total
$
(298
)
 
(1,050
)
(1)
Represents write-downs of loans based on the appraised value of the collateral.
(2)
Includes impairment losses and observable price adjustments for certain nonmarketable equity securities.
(3)
Includes the losses on foreclosed real estate and other collateral owned that were measured at fair value subsequent to their initial classification as foreclosed assets.

 
Wells Fargo & Company
245


Note 18: Fair Values of Assets and Liabilities (continued)

Table 18.14 provides quantitative information about the valuation techniques and significant unobservable inputs used in the valuation of substantially all of our Level 3 assets that are measured at fair value on a nonrecurring basis using an internal model. The table is limited to financial instruments that had nonrecurring fair value adjustments during the periods presented.
We have excluded from the table valuation techniques and significant unobservable inputs for certain classes of Level 3
 
assets measured using an internal model that we consider, both individually and in the aggregate, insignificant relative to our overall Level 3 nonrecurring measurements. We made this determination based upon an evaluation of each class that considered the magnitude of the positions, nature of the unobservable inputs and potential for significant changes in fair value due to changes in those inputs.

Table 18.14: Valuation Techniques – Nonrecurring Basis
($ in millions)
Fair Value Level 3

 
Valuation Technique(s) (1)
 
Significant Unobservable Inputs (1)
 
Range of inputs
 
Weighted Average (2)

December 31, 2018
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Residential mortgage loans held for sale (LOCOM)
$
1,233

(3)
Discounted cash flow
 
Default rate
(4)
0.2
2.3
%
 
1.4
%
 
 
 
 
 
Discount rate
 
1.5
8.5

 
4.0

 
 
 
 
 
Loss severity
 
0.5
66.0

 
1.7

 
 
 
 
 
Prepayment rate
(5)
3.5
100.0

 
46.5

Nonmarketable equity securities
7

 
Discounted cash flow
 
Discount rate
 
10.5
10.5

 
10.5

Insignificant level 3 assets
157

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total
$
1,397

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
December 31, 2017
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Residential mortgage loans held for sale (LOCOM)
$
1,333

(3)
Discounted cash flow
 
Default rate
(4)
0.1
4.1
%
 
1.7
%
 
 
 
 
 
Discount rate
 
1.5
8.5

 
3.8

 
 
 
 
 
Loss severity
 
0.7
52.9

 
2.2

 
 
 
 
 
Prepayment rate
(5)
5.4
100.0

 
50.6

Nonmarketable equity securities
122

 
Discounted cash flow
 
Discount rate
 
5.0
10.5

 
10.2

Insignificant level 3 assets
185

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total
$
1,640

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(1)
Refer to the narrative following Table 18.10 for a definition of the valuation technique(s) and significant unobservable inputs.
(2)
For residential MLHFS, weighted averages are calculated using the outstanding unpaid principal balance of the loans.
(3)
Consists of approximately $1.2 billion and $1.3 billion of government insured/guaranteed loans purchased from GNMA-guaranteed mortgage securitizations at December 31, 2018 and 2017 , respectively, and $27 million and $26 million of other mortgage loans that are not government insured/guaranteed at December 31, 2018 and 2017 , respectively.
(4)
Applies only to non-government insured/guaranteed loans.
(5)
Includes the impact on prepayment rate of expected defaults for government insured/guaranteed loans, which impact the frequency and timing of early resolution of loans.
Fair Value Option
The fair value option is an irrevocable election, generally only permitted upon initial recognition of financial assets or liabilities, to measure eligible financial instruments at fair value with changes in fair value reflected in earnings. We may elect the fair value option to align the measurement model with how the financial assets or liabilities are managed or to reduce complexity or accounting asymmetry. Following is a discussion of the portfolios for which we elected the fair value option.

MORTGAGE LOANS HELD FOR SALE (MLHFS) We measure MLHFS at fair value for MLHFS originations for which an active secondary market and readily available market prices exist to reliably support fair value pricing models used for these loans. Loan origination fees on these loans are recorded when earned, and related direct loan origination costs are recognized when incurred. We also measure at fair value certain of our other interests held related to residential loan sales and securitizations. We believe fair value measurement for MLHFS and other interests held, which we hedge with economic hedge derivatives along with our MSRs measured at fair value, reduces certain timing differences and better matches changes in the
 
value of these assets with changes in the value of derivatives used as economic hedges for these assets.

LOANS HELD FOR SALE (LHFS) We engage in holding loans for market-making purposes to support the buying and selling demands of our customers. These loans are generally held for a short period of time and managed within parameters of internally approved market risk limits. We have elected to measure and carry them at fair value, which best aligns with our risk management practices. Fair value for these loans is generally determined using readily available market data based on recent transaction prices for similar loans.

LOANS Loans that we measure at fair value consist predominantly of reverse mortgage loans previously transferred under a GNMA reverse mortgage securitization program accounted for as a secured borrowing. Before the transfer, they were classified as MLHFS measured at fair value and, as such, remain carried on our balance sheet under the fair value option.

EQUITY SECURITIES We elected to measure at fair value certain nonmarketable equity securities that are hedged with derivative instruments to better reflect the economics of the transactions.

246
Wells Fargo & Company
 


Table 18.15 reflects differences between the fair value carrying amount of the assets for which we have elected the fair value option and the contractual aggregate unpaid principal amount at maturity.

Table 18.15: Fair Value Option
 
December 31, 2018
 
 
December 31, 2017
 
(in millions)
Fair value carrying amount 

 
Aggregate unpaid principal 

 
Fair value carrying amount less aggregate unpaid principal 

 
Fair value carrying amount 

 
Aggregate unpaid principal 

 
Fair value carrying amount less aggregate unpaid principal 

Mortgage loans held for sale:
 
 
 
 
 
 

 
 
 
 
Total loans
$
11,771

 
11,573

 
198

 
16,116

 
15,827

 
289

Nonaccrual loans
127

 
158

 
(31
)
 
127

 
165

 
(38
)
Loans 90 days or more past due and still accruing
7

 
9

 
(2
)
 
16

 
21

 
(5
)
Loans held for sale:
 
 
 
 
 
 

 
 
 
 
Total loans
1,469

 
1,536

 
(67
)
 
1,023

 
1,075

 
(52
)
Nonaccrual loans
21

 
32

 
(11
)
 
34

 
56

 
(22
)
Loans:
 
 
 
 
 
 

 
 
 
 
Total loans
244

 
274

 
(30
)
 
376

 
404

 
(28
)
Nonaccrual loans
179

 
208

 
(29
)
 
253

 
281

 
(28
)
Equity securities (1)
5,455

 
N/A

 
N/A

 
4,867

 
N/A

 
N/A

(1)
Consists of nonmarketable equity securities carried at fair value.
The assets accounted for under the fair value option are initially measured at fair value. Gains and losses from initial measurement and subsequent changes in fair value are recognized in earnings. The changes in fair value related to
 
initial measurement and subsequent changes in fair value included in earnings for these assets measured at fair value are shown in Table 18.16 by income statement line item. Amounts recorded as interest income are excluded from Table 18.16 .
Table 18.16: Fair Value Option – Changes in Fair Value Included in Earnings
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Year ended December 31,
 
 
2018
 
 
2017
 
 
2016
 
(in millions)
Mortgage banking noninterest income 

Net gains (losses) from trading activities 

Net gains (losses) from equity securities

Other noninterest income 

 
Mortgage banking noninterest income 

Net gains (losses) from trading activities 

Net gains (losses) from equity securities

Other noninterest income 

 
Mortgage banking noninterest income 

Net gains (losses) from trading activities 

Net gains (losses) from equity securities

Other noninterest income 

Mortgage loans held for sale
$
462




 
1,229




 
1,456




Loans held for sale

(1
)

1

 

45


2

 

55


3

Loans



(1
)
 




 



(60
)
Equity securities


683


 


1,592


 


(12
)

Other interests held (1)

(3
)


 

(9
)


 

(5
)


(1)
Includes retained interests in securitizations.

For performing loans, instrument-specific credit risk gains or losses were derived principally by determining the change in fair value of the loans due to changes in the observable or implied credit spread. Credit spread is the market yield on the loans less the relevant risk-free benchmark interest rate. For nonperforming loans, we attribute all changes in fair value to instrument-specific credit risk. Table 18.17 shows the estimated gains and losses from earnings attributable to instrument-specific credit risk related to assets accounted for under the fair value option.

 
Table 18.17: Fair Value Option – Gains/Losses Attributable to Instrument-Specific Credit Risk
 
Year ended December 31, 
 
(in millions)
2018

 
2017

 
2016

Gains (losses) attributable to instrument-specific credit risk:
 
 
 
 
 
Mortgage loans held for sale
$
(16
)
 
(12
)
 
3

Loans held for sale

 
45

 
55

Total
$
(16
)

33


58



 
Wells Fargo & Company
247


Note 18: Fair Values of Assets and Liabilities (continued)

Disclosures about Fair Value of Financial Instruments
Table 18.18 is a summary of fair value estimates for financial instruments, excluding financial instruments recorded at fair value on a recurring basis, as they are included within Table 18.2 in this Note. In connection with our adoption of ASU 2016-01 in first quarter 2018, the valuation methodologies for estimating the fair value of financial instruments in Table 18.18 have been changed, where necessary, to conform with an exit price notion. Under an exit price notion, fair value estimates are based upon the price that would be received to sell an asset or paid to transfer a liability in an orderly transaction between market participants at the balance sheet date. For certain loans and deposit liabilities, the estimated fair values prior to our adoption
 
of ASU 2016-01 followed an entrance price notion that based fair values on recent prices offered to customers for loans and deposits with similar characteristics. The carrying amounts in the following table are recorded on the balance sheet under the indicated captions.
We have not included assets and liabilities that are not financial instruments in our disclosure, such as the value of the long-term relationships with our deposit, credit card and trust customers, amortized MSRs, premises and equipment, goodwill and other intangibles, deferred taxes and other liabilities.
The total of the fair value calculations presented does not represent, and should not be construed to represent, the underlying value of the Company.

Table 18.18: Fair Value Estimates for Financial Instruments
 
 
 
Estimated fair value 
 
(in millions)
Carrying amount 

 
Level 1 

 
Level 2 

 
Level 3 

 
Total

December 31, 2018
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Financial assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Cash and due from banks (1)
$
23,551

 
23,551

 

 

 
23,551

Interest-earning deposits with banks (1)
149,736

 
149,542

 
194

 

 
149,736

Federal funds sold and securities purchased under resale agreements (1)
80,207

 

 
80,207

 

 
80,207

Held-to-maturity debt securities
144,788

 
44,339

 
97,275

 
501

 
142,115

Mortgage loans held for sale
3,355

 

 
2,129

 
1,233

 
3,362

Loans held for sale
572

 

 
572

 

 
572

Loans, net (2)(3)
923,703

 

 
45,190

 
872,725

 
917,915

Nonmarketable equity securities (cost method) (4)
5,643

 

 

 
5,675

 
5,675

Total financial assets
$
1,331,555


217,432


225,567


880,134

 
1,323,133

Financial liabilities
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 


Deposits (3)(5)
$
130,645

 

 
107,448

 
22,641

 
130,089

Short-term borrowings
105,787

 

 
105,789

 

 
105,789

Long-term debt (6)
229,008

 

 
225,904

 
2,230

 
228,134

Total financial liabilities
$
465,440




439,141


24,871

 
464,012

December 31, 2017
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Financial assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Cash and due from banks (1)
$
23,367

 
23,367

 

 

 
23,367

Interest-earning deposits with banks (1)
192,580

 
192,455

 
125

 

 
192,580

Federal funds sold and securities purchased under resale agreements (1)
80,025

 
1,002

 
78,954

 
69

 
80,025

Held-to-maturity debt securities
139,335

 
44,806

 
93,694

 
485

 
138,985

Mortgage loans held for sale
3,954

 

 
2,625

 
1,333

 
3,958

Loans held for sale
108

 

 
108

 

 
108

Loans, net (2)(3)
926,273

 

 
51,713

 
886,622

 
938,335

Nonmarketable equity securities (cost method)
7,136

 

 
23

 
7,605

 
7,628

Total financial assets (7)
$
1,372,778


261,630


227,242


896,114

 
1,384,986

Financial liabilities
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Deposits (3)(5)
$
128,594

 

 
108,146

 
19,768

 
127,914

Short-term borrowings
103,256

 

 
103,256

 

 
103,256

Long-term debt (6)
224,981

 

 
227,109

 
3,159

 
230,268

Total financial liabilities
$
456,831

 

 
438,511

 
22,927

 
461,438

(1)
Amounts consist of financial instruments for which carrying value approximates fair value.
(2)
Excludes lease financing with a carrying amount of $19.7 billion and $19.4 billion at December 31, 2018 and 2017 , respectively.
(3)
In connection with our adoption of ASU 2016-01, the valuation methodologies used to estimate the fair value at December 31, 2018 , for a portion of loans and deposit liabilities with a defined or contractual maturity has been changed to conform to an exit price notion. The fair value estimates at December 31, 2017 have not been revised to reflect application of the modified methodology.
(4)
Excludes $1.7 billion of nonmarketable equity securities accounted for under the measurement alternative at December 31, 2018 , that were accounted for under the cost method in prior periods.
(5)
Excludes deposit liabilities with no defined or contractual maturity of $1.2 trillion at both December 31, 2018 and 2017 .
(6)
Excludes capital lease obligations under capital leases of $36 million and $39 million at December 31, 2018 and 2017 , respectively.
(7)
Excludes $27 million of carrying value and $30 million of fair value relating to nonmarketable equity securities at NAV at December 31, 2017 .


248
Wells Fargo & Company
 


Loan commitments, standby letters of credit and commercial and similar letters of credit are not included in Table 18.18 . A reasonable estimate of the fair value of these instruments is the carrying value of deferred fees plus the allowance for unfunded credit commitments, which totaled $1.0 billion at both December 31, 2018 and 2017 .
 


Note 19:   Preferred Stock
We are authorized to issue 20 million shares of preferred stock and 4 million shares of preference stock, both without par value. Preferred shares outstanding rank senior to common shares both as to dividends and liquidation preference but have no general voting rights. We have not issued any preference shares
 
under this authorization. If issued, preference shares would be limited to one vote per share. Our total authorized, issued and outstanding preferred stock is presented in the following two tables along with the Employee Stock Ownership Plan (ESOP) Cumulative Convertible Preferred Stock.
Table 19.1: Preferred Stock Shares
 
December 31, 2018
 
 
December 31, 2017
 
 
Liquidation 
 preference 
 per share 

 
Shares 
 authorized 
and designated 

 
Liquidation 
 preference 
 per share 

 
Shares 
 authorized 
 and designated

DEP Shares
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Dividend Equalization Preferred Shares (DEP)
$
10

 
97,000

 
$
10

 
97,000

Series I
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Floating Class A Preferred Stock (1)
100,000

 
25,010

 
100,000

 
25,010

Series J
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
8.00% Non-Cumulative Perpetual Class A Preferred Stock (2)

 

 
1,000

 
2,300,000

Series K
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Floating Non-Cumulative Perpetual Class A Preferred Stock (3)
1,000

 
3,500,000

 
1,000

 
3,500,000

Series L
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
7.50% Non-Cumulative Perpetual Convertible Class A Preferred Stock
1,000

 
4,025,000

 
1,000

 
4,025,000

Series N
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
5.20% Non-Cumulative Perpetual Class A Preferred Stock
25,000

 
30,000

 
25,000

 
30,000

Series O
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
5.125% Non-Cumulative Perpetual Class A Preferred Stock
25,000

 
27,600

 
25,000

 
27,600

Series P
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
5.25% Non-Cumulative Perpetual Class A Preferred Stock
25,000

 
26,400

 
25,000

 
26,400

Series Q
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
5.85% Fixed-to-Floating Non-Cumulative Perpetual Class A Preferred Stock
25,000

 
69,000

 
25,000

 
69,000

Series R
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
6.625% Fixed-to-Floating Non-Cumulative Perpetual Class A Preferred Stock
25,000

 
34,500

 
25,000

 
34,500

Series S
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
5.90% Fixed-to-Floating Non-Cumulative Perpetual Class A Preferred Stock
25,000

 
80,000

 
25,000

 
80,000

Series T
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
6.00% Non-Cumulative Perpetual Class A Preferred Stock
25,000

 
32,200

 
25,000

 
32,200

Series U
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
5.875% Fixed-to-Floating Non-Cumulative Perpetual Class A Preferred Stock
25,000

 
80,000

 
25,000

 
80,000

Series V
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
6.00% Non-Cumulative Perpetual Class A Preferred Stock
25,000

 
40,000

 
25,000

 
40,000

Series W
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
5.70% Non-Cumulative Perpetual Class A Preferred Stock
25,000

 
40,000

 
25,000

 
40,000

Series X
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
5.50% Non-Cumulative Perpetual Class A Preferred Stock
25,000

 
46,000

 
25,000

 
46,000

Series Y
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
5.625% Non-Cumulative Perpetual Class A Preferred Stock
25,000

 
27,600

 
25,000

 
27,600

ESOP
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Cumulative Convertible Preferred Stock (4)

 
1,406,460

 

 
1,556,104

Total

 
9,586,770

 

 
12,036,414

(1)
Floating rate for Preferred Stock, Series I, is the greater of three-month LIBOR plus 0.93% and 5.56975%.
(2)
Preferred Stock, Series J, was redeemed in third quarter 2018.
(3)
Effective June 15, 2018, Preferred Stock, Series K, converted from a fixed to a floating coupon rate of three-month LIBOR plus 3.77%.
(4)
See the ESOP Cumulative Convertible Preferred Stock section in this Note for additional information about the liquidation preference for the ESOP Cumulative Convertible Preferred Stock.

 
Wells Fargo & Company
249


Note 19: Preferred Stock (continued)

Table 19.2: Preferred Stock – Shares Issued and Carrying Value
 
December 31, 2018
 
 
December 31, 2017
 
(in millions, except shares)
Shares issued and outstanding 

 
Liquidation preference value

 
Carrying
value 

 
Discount 

 
Shares  issued and outstanding

 
Liquidation preference value

 
Carrying value

 
Discount 

DEP Shares
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Dividend Equalization Preferred Shares (DEP)
96,546

 
$

 

 

 
96,546

 
$

 

 

Series I (1)(2)


 


 


 
 
 


 


 


 
 
Floating Class A Preferred Stock
25,010

 
2,501

 
2,501

 

 
25,010

 
2,501

 
2,501

 

Series J (1)(3)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
8.00% Non-Cumulative Perpetual Class A Preferred Stock

 

 

 

 
2,150,375

 
2,150

 
1,995

 
155

Series K (1)(4)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Floating Non-Cumulative Perpetual Class A Preferred Stock
3,352,000

 
3,352

 
2,876

 
476

 
3,352,000

 
3,352

 
2,876

 
476

Series L (1) 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
7.50% Non-Cumulative Perpetual Convertible Class A Preferred Stock
3,968,000

 
3,968

 
3,200

 
768

 
3,968,000

 
3,968

 
3,200

 
768

Series N (1) 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
5.20% Non-Cumulative Perpetual Class A Preferred Stock
30,000

 
750

 
750

 

 
30,000

 
750

 
750

 

Series O (1) 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
5.125% Non-Cumulative Perpetual Class A Preferred Stock
26,000

 
650

 
650

 

 
26,000

 
650

 
650

 

Series P (1) 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
5.25% Non-Cumulative Perpetual Class A Preferred Stock
25,000

 
625

 
625

 

 
25,000

 
625

 
625

 

Series Q (1)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
5.85% Fixed-to-Floating Non-Cumulative Perpetual Class A Preferred Stock
69,000

 
1,725

 
1,725

 

 
69,000

 
1,725

 
1,725

 

Series R (1)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
6.625% Fixed-to-Floating Non-Cumulative Perpetual Class A Preferred Stock
33,600

 
840

 
840

 

 
33,600

 
840

 
840

 

Series S (1)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
5.90% Fixed-to-Floating Non-Cumulative Perpetual Class A Preferred Stock
80,000

 
2,000

 
2,000

 

 
80,000

 
2,000

 
2,000

 

Series T (1)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
6.00% Non-Cumulative Perpetual Class A Preferred Stock
32,000

 
800

 
800

 

 
32,000

 
800

 
800

 

Series U (1)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
5.875% Fixed-to-Floating Non-Cumulative Perpetual Class A Preferred Stock
80,000

 
2,000

 
2,000

 

 
80,000

 
2,000

 
2,000

 

Series V (1)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
6.00% Non-Cumulative Perpetual Class A Preferred Stock
40,000

 
1,000

 
1,000

 

 
40,000

 
1,000

 
1,000

 

Series W (1)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
5.70% Non-Cumulative Perpetual Class A Preferred Stock
40,000

 
1,000

 
1,000

 

 
40,000

 
1,000

 
1,000

 

Series X  (1)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
5.50% Non-Cumulative Perpetual Class A Preferred Stock
46,000

 
1,150

 
1,150

 

 
46,000

 
1,150

 
1,150

 

Series Y  (1)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
5.625% Non-Cumulative Perpetual Class A Preferred Stock
27,600

 
690

 
690

 

 
27,600

 
690

 
690

 

ESOP
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Cumulative Convertible Preferred Stock
1,406,460

 
1,407

 
1,407

 

 
1,556,104

 
1,556

 
1,556

 

Total
9,377,216

 
$
24,458

 
23,214

 
1,244

 
11,677,235

 
$
26,757

 
25,358

 
1,399

(1)
Preferred shares qualify as Tier 1 capital.
(2)
Floating rate for Preferred Stock, Series I, is the greater of three-month LIBOR plus 0.93% and 5.56975%.
(3)
Preferred Stock, Series J, was redeemed in third quarter 2018.
(4)
Effective June 15, 2018, Preferred Stock, Series K, converted from a fixed to a floating coupon rate of three-month LIBOR plus 3.77%.

See Note 9 (Securitizations and Variable Interest Entities) for additional information on our trust preferred securities.

250
Wells Fargo & Company
 


ESOP CUMULATIVE CONVERTIBLE PREFERRED STOCK All shares of our ESOP Cumulative Convertible Preferred Stock (ESOP Preferred Stock) were issued to a trustee acting on behalf of the Wells Fargo & Company 401(k) Plan (the 401(k) Plan). Dividends on the ESOP Preferred Stock are cumulative from the date of initial issuance and are payable quarterly at annual rates based upon the year of issuance. Each share of ESOP Preferred Stock released from the unallocated reserve of the 401(k) Plan is converted into shares of our common stock based on the stated value of the ESOP Preferred Stock and the then current market
 
price of our common stock. The ESOP Preferred Stock is also convertible at the option of the holder at any time, unless previously redeemed. We have the option to redeem the ESOP Preferred Stock at any time, in whole or in part, at a redemption price per share equal to the higher of (a) $1,000 per share plus accrued and unpaid dividends or (b) the fair market value, as defined in the Certificates of Designation for the ESOP Preferred Stock.

Table 19.3: ESOP Preferred Stock
 
Shares issued and outstanding
 
 
Carrying value 
 
 
Adjustable dividend rate
 
 
Dec 31,

 
Dec 31,

 
Dec 31,

 
Dec 31,

 
 
 
 
(in millions, except shares)
2018

 
2017

 
2018

 
2017

 
Minimum 

 
Maximum 

ESOP Preferred Stock
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$1,000 liquidation preference per share
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2018
336,945

 

 
$
337

 

 
7.00
%
 
8.00
%
2017
222,210

 
273,210

 
222

 
273

 
7.00

 
8.00

2016
233,835

 
322,826

 
234

 
323

 
9.30

 
10.30

2015
144,338

 
187,436

 
144

 
187

 
8.90

 
9.90

2014
174,151

 
237,151

 
174

 
237

 
8.70

 
9.70

2013
133,948

 
201,948

 
134

 
202

 
8.50

 
9.50

2012
77,634

 
128,634

 
78

 
129

 
10.00

 
11.00

2011
61,796

 
129,296

 
62

 
129

 
9.00

 
10.00

2010
21,603

 
75,603

 
22

 
76

 
9.50

 
10.50

Total ESOP Preferred Stock (1)
1,406,460

 
1,556,104

 
$
1,407

 
1,556

 
 
 
 
Unearned ESOP shares (2)
 
 
 
 
$
(1,502
)
 
(1,678
)
 
 
 
 
(1)
At December 31, 2018 and 2017 , additional paid-in capital included $95 million and $122 million , respectively, related to ESOP preferred stock.  
(2)
We recorded a corresponding charge to unearned ESOP shares in connection with the issuance of the ESOP Preferred Stock. The unearned ESOP shares are reduced as shares of the ESOP Preferred Stock are committed to be released.



 
Wells Fargo & Company
251


Note 20: Common Stock and Stock Plans (continued)

Note 20:   Common Stock and Stock Plans
Common Stock
Table 20.1 presents our reserved, issued and authorized shares of common stock at December 31, 2018 .

Table 20.1: Common Stock Shares
 
Number of shares 

Dividend reinvestment and common stock purchase plans
9,114,931

Director plans
447,526

Stock plans (1)
369,893,237

Convertible securities and warrants
65,835,468

Total shares reserved
445,291,162

Shares issued
5,481,811,474

Shares not reserved or issued
3,072,897,364

Total shares authorized
9,000,000,000

(1)
Includes employee options, restricted shares and restricted share rights, 401(k) profit sharing and compensation deferral plans.

In connection with our participation in the Capital Purchase Program (CPP), a part of the Troubled Asset Relief Program (TARP), we issued to the U.S. Treasury Department warrants to purchase 110,261,688 shares of our common stock with an original exercise price of $34.01 per share. The warrants expired on October 29, 2018, and the holders of 110,646 unexercised warrants as of the expiration date are no longer entitled to receive any shares of our common stock. Holders exercised 23,217,208 and 9,774,052 warrants to purchase shares of our common stock in 2018 and 2017 , respectively.  
Dividend Reinvestment and Common Stock Purchase Plans
Participants in our dividend reinvestment and common stock direct purchase plans may purchase shares of our common stock at fair market value by reinvesting dividends and/or making optional cash payments, under the plan’s terms.
 
Employee Stock Plans
We offer stock-based employee compensation plans as described below. For information on our accounting for stock-based compensation plans, see Note 1 (Summary of Significant Accounting Policies).
 
LONG-TERM INCENTIVE COMPENSATION PLANS  Our Long- Term Incentive Compensation Plan (LTICP) provides for awards of incentive and nonqualified stock options, stock appreciation rights, restricted shares, restricted share rights (RSRs), performance share awards (PSAs), performance units and stock awards with or without restrictions.
Beginning in 2010, we granted RSRs and performance shares as our primary long-term incentive awards instead of stock options. Holders of RSRs are entitled to the related shares of common stock at no cost generally vesting over three to five years after the RSRs were granted. Subject to compliance with applicable laws, rules and regulations, RSRs generally continue to vest and are distributed after retirement according to the original vesting schedule. Except for retirement and other limited circumstances, RSRs are canceled when employment ends.

 
Holders of each vested PSA are entitled to the related shares of common stock at no cost. Subject to compliance with applicable laws, rules, and regulations, PSAs continue to vest and are distributed after retirement according to the original vesting schedule subject to satisfying the performance criteria and other vesting conditions.
Holders of RSRs and PSAs may be entitled to receive additional RSRs and PSAs (dividend equivalents) or cash payments equal to the cash dividends that would have been paid had the RSRs or PSAs been issued and outstanding shares of common stock. RSRs and PSAs granted as dividend equivalents are subject to the same vesting schedule and conditions as the underlying award.
Stock options must have an exercise price at or above fair market value (as defined in the plan) of the stock at the date of grant (except for substitute or replacement options granted in connection with mergers or other acquisitions) and a term of no more than 10 years . Options generally become exercisable over three years beginning on the first anniversary of the date of grant. Except as otherwise permitted under the plan, if employment is ended for reasons other than retirement, permanent disability or death, the option exercise period is reduced or the options are canceled.
Compensation expense for most of our RSRs, and PSAs granted prior to 2013 is based on the quoted market price of the related stock at the grant date; beginning in 2013 certain RSRs and all PSAs granted include discretionary conditions that can result in forfeiture and are subject to variable accounting. For these awards, the associated compensation expense fluctuates with changes in our stock price. Table 20.2 summarizes the major components of stock incentive compensation expense and the related recognized tax benefit.

Table 20.2: Stock Incentive Compensation Expense
 
Year ended December 31,
 
(in millions)
2018

 
2017

 
2016

RSRs (1)
$
1,013

 
743

 
692

Performance shares
9

 
112

 
87

Stock options

 
(6
)
 

Total stock incentive compensation expense (2)
$
1,022

 
849

 
779

Related recognized tax benefit
$
252

 
320

 
294

(1)
In February 2018, a total of 11.9 million RSRs were granted to all eligible team members in the U.S., and eligible team members outside the U.S., referred to as broad-based RSRs.
(2)
Amounts for the year-ended December 31, 2018, were net of $19 million related to reversal of previously accrued RSR costs. Year-ended December 31, 2017, were net of $26 million related to clawback credits taken against a prior PSA awarded under our LTICP.

For various acquisitions and mergers, we converted employee and director stock options of acquired or merged companies into stock options to purchase our common stock based on the terms of the original stock option plan and the agreed-upon exchange ratio. In addition, we converted restricted stock awards into awards that entitle holders to our stock after the vesting conditions are met. Holders receive cash dividends on outstanding awards if provided in the original award.
The total number of shares of common stock available for grant under the plans at December 31, 2018 , was 92 million .
 

252
Wells Fargo & Company
 


Director Awards
Beginning in 2011, we granted only common stock awards under the LTICP to non-employee directors elected or re-elected at the annual meeting of stockholders and prorated awards to directors who join the Board at any other time. Stock awards vest immediately. Options also were granted to directors prior to 2011 and can be exercised after 12 months through the tenth anniversary of the grant date.  

Restricted Share Rights
A summary of the status of our RSRs and restricted share awards at December 31, 2018 , and changes during 2018 is presented in Table 20.3 .

Table 20.3: Restricted Share Rights
 
Number 

 
Weighted- 
 average 
 grant-date 
 fair value 

Nonvested at January 1, 2018
34,894,376

 
$
50.95

Granted
28,023,158

 
58.47

Vested
(14,571,562
)
 
52.12

Canceled or forfeited
(2,773,474
)
 
56.76

Nonvested at December 31, 2018
45,572,498

 
54.85

 
 
 
 

The weighted-average grant date fair value of RSRs granted during 2017 and 2016 was $57.54 and $48.31 , respectively.
At December 31, 2018 , there was $1.1 billion of total unrecognized compensation cost related to nonvested RSRs. The cost is expected to be recognized over a weighted-average period of 2.0 years . The total fair value of RSRs that vested during 2018 , 2017 and 2016 was $824 million , $865 million and $1.1 billion , respectively.
 
 
Performance Share Awards
Holders of PSAs are entitled to the related shares of common stock at no cost subject to the Company’s achievement of specified performance criteria over a three -year period. PSAs are granted at a target number; based on the Company’s performance, the number of awards that vest can be adjusted downward to zero and upward to a maximum of either 125% or 150% of target. The awards vest in the quarter after the end of the performance period. For PSAs whose performance period ended December 31, 2018 , the determination of the number of performance shares that will vest will occur in first quarter of 2019 after review of the Company’s performance by the Human Resources Committee of the Board of Directors. Beginning in 2013, PSAs granted include discretionary conditions that can result in forfeiture and are subject to variable accounting. For these awards, the associated compensation expense fluctuates with changes in our stock price and the estimated outcome of meeting the performance conditions. The total expense that will be recognized on these awards cannot be finalized until the determination of the awards that will vest.
A summary of the status of our PSAs at December 31, 2018 , and changes during 2018 is in Table 20.4 , based on the performance adjustments recognized as of December 2018 .

Table 20.4: Performance Share Awards
 
Number 

 
Weighted- 
 average 
 grant-date 
 fair value (1)

Nonvested at January 1, 2018
5,492,104

 
$
47.81

Granted
2,570,300

 
58.62

Vested
(1,879,523
)
 
55.21

Canceled or forfeited
(198,195
)
 
54.48

Nonvested at December 31, 2018
5,984,686

 
49.91

 
 
 
 
(1)
Reflects approval date fair value for grants subject to variable accounting.

The weighted-average grant date fair value of performance awards granted during 2017 and 2016 was $57.14 and $44.73 , respectively.
At December 31, 2018 , there was $26 million of total unrecognized compensation cost related to nonvested performance awards. The cost is expected to be recognized over a weighted-average period of 1.5 years . The total fair value of PSAs that vested during 2018 , 2017 and 2016 was $107 million , $117 million , and $220 million , respectively.



 
Wells Fargo & Company
253


Note 20: Common Stock and Stock Plans (continued)

Stock Options
Table 20.5 summarizes stock option activity and related information for the stock plans. Options assumed in mergers are included in the activity and related information for Incentive
 
Compensation Plans if originally issued under an employee plan, and in the activity and related information for Director Awards if originally issued under a director plan.
 
Table 20.5: Stock Option Activity
 
Number 

 
Weighted- 
 average 
 exercise price

 
Weighted- 
 average 
 remaining contractual term (in yrs.)
 
Aggregate 
 intrinsic 
 value 
 (in millions) 

Incentive compensation plans
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Options outstanding as of December 31, 2017
20,179,179

 
$
32.80

 
 
 
 
Canceled or forfeited
(1,886,251
)
 
172.36

 
 
 
 
Exercised
(9,949,771
)
 
22.50

 
 
 
 
Options exercisable and outstanding as of December 31, 2018
8,343,157

 
13.46

 
0.2
 
$
272

Director awards
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Options outstanding as of December 31, 2017
104,900

 
29.87

 
 
 
 
Exercised
(104,900
)
 
29.88

 
 
 
 
Options exercisable and outstanding as of December 31, 2018

 

 
0.0
 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

The total intrinsic value to option holders, which is the stock market value in excess of the option exercise price, of options exercised during 2018 , 2017 and 2016 was $375 million , $623 million and $546 million , respectively.
Cash received from the exercise of stock options for 2018 , 2017 and 2016 was $227 million , $602 million and $893 million , respectively.
We do not have a specific policy on repurchasing shares to satisfy share option exercises. Rather, we have a general policy on repurchasing shares to meet common stock issuance requirements for our benefit plans (including share option exercises), conversion of our convertible securities, acquisitions and other corporate purposes. Various factors determine the amount and timing of our share repurchases, including our capital requirements, the number of shares we expect to issue for acquisitions and employee benefit plans, market conditions (including the trading price of our stock), and regulatory and legal considerations. These factors can change at any time, and there can be no assurance as to the number of shares we will repurchase or when we will repurchase them.
 
Employee Stock Ownership Plan
The Wells Fargo & Company 401(k) Plan (401(k) Plan) is a defined contribution plan with an Employee Stock Ownership Plan (ESOP) feature. The ESOP feature enables the 401(k) Plan to borrow money to purchase our preferred or common stock. From 1994 through 2018 , with the exception of 2009, we loaned money to the 401(k) Plan to purchase shares of our ESOP preferred stock. As our employer contributions are made to the 401(k) Plan and are used by the 401(k) Plan to make ESOP loan payments, the ESOP preferred stock in the 401(k) Plan is released and converted into our common stock shares. Dividends on the common stock shares allocated as a result of the release and conversion of the ESOP preferred stock reduce retained earnings, and the shares are considered outstanding for computing earnings per share. Dividends on the unallocated ESOP preferred stock do not reduce retained earnings, and the shares are not considered to be common stock equivalents for computing earnings per share. Loan principal and interest payments are made from our employer contributions to the 401(k) Plan, along with dividends paid on the ESOP preferred stock. With each principal and interest payment, a portion of the ESOP preferred stock is released and converted to common stock shares, which are allocated to the 401(k) Plan participants and invested in the Wells Fargo ESOP Fund within the 401(k) Plan.

254
Wells Fargo & Company
 


Table 20.6 presents the balance of common stock and unreleased preferred stock held in the Wells Fargo ESOP fund, the fair value of unreleased ESOP preferred stock and the
 
dividends on allocated shares of common stock and unreleased ESOP Preferred Stock paid to the 401(k) Plan.

Table 20.6: Common Stock and Unreleased Preferred Stock in the Wells Fargo ESOP Fund
 
Shares outstanding
 
 
December 31,
 
(in millions, except shares)
2018

 
2017

 
2016

Allocated shares (common)
138,182,911

 
124,670,717

 
128,189,305

Unreleased shares (preferred)
1,406,460

 
1,556,104

 
1,439,181

Fair value of unreleased ESOP preferred shares
$
1,407

 
1,556

 
1,439

 
Dividends paid
 
 
Year ended December 31,
 
 
2018

 
2017

 
2016

Allocated shares (common)
$
213

 
195

 
208

Unreleased shares (preferred)
159

 
166

 
169


Deferred Compensation Plan for Independent Sales Agents
WF Deferred Compensation Holdings, Inc. is a wholly-owned subsidiary of the Parent formed solely to sponsor a deferred compensation plan for independent sales agents who provide investment, financial and other qualifying services for or with respect to participating affiliates.

 
The Nonqualified Deferred Compensation Plan for Independent Contractors, which became effective January 1, 2002, allowed participants to defer all or part of their eligible compensation payable to them by a participating affiliate. The plan was frozen for new compensation deferrals effective January 1, 2012. The Parent has fully and unconditionally guaranteed the deferred compensation obligations of WF Deferred Compensation Holdings, Inc. under the plan.

 
Wells Fargo & Company
255


Note 21: Revenue from Contracts with Customers (continued)


Note 21:   Revenue from Contracts with Customers
Our revenue includes net interest income on financial instruments and noninterest income. Table 21.1 presents our revenue by operating segment. The “Other” segment for each of the tables below includes the elimination of certain items that are included in more than one business segment, most of which represents products and services for WIM customers served through Community Banking distribution channels. For additional description of our operating segments, including additional financial information and the underlying management accounting process, see Note 26 (Operating Segments) to Financial Statements in this Report.
 
We adopted ASU 2014-09 – Revenue from Contracts with Customers ( the new revenue recognition guidance”) on a modified retrospective basis as of January 1, 2018. Under this method of adoption, prior period financial information for 2017 and 2016 was not adjusted. Rather, this ASU resulted in a cumulative-effect adjustment that decreased the beginning balance of retained earnings by $32 million on January 1, 2018, and changed the presentation of certain revenues and expenses prospectively. For details on the impact of the adoption of this ASU, see Note 1 (Summary of Significant Accounting Policies).

Table 21.1 : Revenue by Operating Segment
 
Year ended December 31, 2018
 
(in millions)
Community Banking

 
Wholesale Banking

 
Wealth and Investment Management

 
Other (3)

 
Consolidated
Company

Net interest income (1)
$
29,219

 
18,690

 
4,441

 
(2,355
)
 
49,995

Noninterest income:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Service charges on deposit accounts
2,641

 
2,074

 
16

 
(15
)
 
4,716

Trust and investment fees:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Brokerage advisory, commissions and other fees
1,887

 
317

 
9,161

 
(1,929
)
 
9,436

Trust and investment management
910

 
445

 
2,893

 
(932
)
 
3,316

Investment banking
(35
)
 
1,783

 
9

 

 
1,757

Total trust and investment fees
2,762

 
2,545

 
12,063

 
(2,861
)
 
14,509

Card fees
3,543

 
362

 
6

 
(4
)
 
3,907

Other fees:
 
 
 
 
 
 

 
 
Lending related charges and fees (1)(2)
278

 
1,247

 
7

 
(6
)
 
1,526

Cash network fees
478

 
3

 

 

 
481

Commercial real estate brokerage commissions

 
468

 

 

 
468

Wire transfer and other remittance fees
264

 
209

 
8

 
(4
)
 
477

All other fees (1)
339

 
92

 
2

 
(1
)
 
432

Total other fees
1,359

 
2,019

 
17

 
(11
)
 
3,384

Mortgage banking (1)
2,659

 
362

 
(11
)
 
7

 
3,017

Insurance (1)
83

 
312

 
82

 
(48
)
 
429

Net gains from trading activities (1)
28

 
516

 
57

 
1

 
602

Net gains (losses) on debt securities (1)
(3
)
 
102

 
9

 

 
108

Net gains from equity investments (1)
1,505

 
293

 
(283
)
 

 
1,515

Lease income (1)

 
1,753

 

 

 
1,753

Other income of the segment (1)
3,117

 
(322
)
 
(21
)
 
(301
)
 
2,473

Total noninterest income
17,694

 
10,016


11,935

 
(3,232
)
 
36,413

Revenue
$
46,913

 
28,706

 
16,376

 
(5,587
)
 
86,408

Year ended December 31, 2017
 
Net interest income (1)
$
28,658

 
18,810

 
4,641

 
(2,552
)
 
49,557

Noninterest income:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Service charges on deposit accounts
2,909

 
2,201

 
17

 
(16
)
 
5,111

Trust and investment fees:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Brokerage advisory, commissions and other fees
1,830

 
304

 
9,072

 
(1,848
)
 
9,358

Trust and investment management
889

 
523

 
2,877

 
(917
)
 
3,372

Investment banking
(59
)
 
1,827

 
(2
)
 
(1
)
 
1,765

Total trust and investment fees
2,660

 
2,654

 
11,947

 
(2,766
)
 
14,495

Card fees
3,613

 
345

 
6

 
(4
)
 
3,960

Other fees:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Lending related charges and fees (1)(2)
311

 
1,257

 
8

 
(8
)
 
1,568

Cash network fees
498

 
8

 

 

 
506

Commercial real estate brokerage commissions
1

 
461

 

 

 
462

Wire transfer and other remittance fees
239

 
204

 
9

 
(4
)
 
448

All other fees (1)
448

 
124

 
1

 

 
573

Total other fees
1,497

 
2,054

 
18

 
(12
)
 
3,557

Mortgage banking (1)
3,895

 
458

 
(10
)
 
7

 
4,350

Insurance (1)
139

 
872

 
88

 
(50
)
 
1,049

Net gains from trading activities (1)
(251
)
 
701

 
92

 

 
542

Net gains (losses) on debt securities (1)
709

 
(232
)
 
2

 

 
479

Net gains from equity investments (1)
1,455

 
116

 
208

 

 
1,779

Lease income (1)

 
1,907

 

 

 
1,907

Other income of the segment (1)
1,734

 
114

 
63

 
(308
)
 
1,603

Total noninterest income
18,360

 
11,190

 
12,431

 
(3,149
)
 
38,832

Revenue
$
47,018

 
30,000

 
17,072

 
(5,701
)
 
88,389

(continued on following page)

256
Wells Fargo & Company
 


(continued from previous page)
Year ended December 31, 2016
 
 
Community Banking

 
Wholesale Banking

 
Wealth and Investment Management

 
Other (3)

 
Consolidated
Company

Net interest income (1)
$
27,333

 
18,699

 
4,249

 
(2,527
)
 
47,754

Noninterest income:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Service charges on deposit accounts
3,111

 
2,260

 
19

 
(18
)
 
5,372

Trust and investment fees:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Brokerage advisory, commissions and other fees
1,854

 
368

 
8,870

 
(1,876
)
 
9,216

Trust and investment management
849

 
473

 
2,891

 
(877
)
 
3,336

Investment banking
(141
)
 
1,833

 
(1
)
 

 
1,691

Total trust and investment fees
2,562

 
2,674

 
11,760

 
(2,753
)
 
14,243

Card fees
3,598

 
336

 
6

 
(4
)
 
3,936

Other fees:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Lending related charges and fees (1)(2)
364

 
1,198

 
8

 
(8
)
 
1,562

Cash network fees
528

 
9

 

 

 
537

Commercial real estate brokerage commissions

 
494

 

 

 
494

Wire transfer and other remittance fees
219

 
178

 
8

 
(4
)
 
401

All other fees (1)
525

 
206

 
2

 

 
733

Total other fees
1,636

 
2,085

 
18

 
(12
)
 
3,727

Mortgage banking (1)
5,624

 
475

 
(9
)
 
6

 
6,096

Insurance (1)
112

 
1,156

 

 

 
1,268

Net gains from trading activities (1)
(148
)
 
677

 
81

 

 
610

Net gains (losses) on debt securities (1)
933

 
8

 
1

 

 
942

Net gains from equity investments (1)
804

 
199

 
100

 

 
1,103

Lease income (1)

 
1,927

 

 

 
1,927

Other income of the segment (1)
948

 
551

 
53

 
(263
)
 
1,289

Total noninterest income
19,180

 
12,348

 
12,029

 
(3,044
)
 
40,513

Revenue
$
46,513

 
31,047

 
16,278

 
(5,571
)
 
88,267

(1)
Most of our revenue is not within the scope of Accounting Standards Update (ASU) 2014-09 – Revenue from Contracts with Customers, and additional details are included in other footnotes to our financial statements. The scope explicitly excludes net interest income as well as many other revenues for financial assets and liabilities, including loans, leases, securities, and derivatives.
(2)
Represents combined amount of previously reported “Charges and fees on loans” and “Letters of credit fees”.
(3)
Includes the elimination of certain items that are included in more than one business segment, most of which represents products and services for WIM customers served through Community Banking distribution channels.
We provide services to customers which have related performance obligations that we complete to recognize revenue. Our revenues are generally recognized either immediately upon the completion of our service or over time as we perform services. Any services performed over time generally require that we render services each period and therefore we measure our progress in completing these services based upon the passage of time.

SERVICE CHARGES ON DEPOSIT ACCOUNTS are earned on depository accounts for commercial and consumer customers and include fees for account and overdraft services. Account
 
charges include fees for periodic account maintenance activities and event-driven services such as stop payment fees. Our obligation for event-driven services is satisfied at the time of the event when the service is delivered, while our obligation for maintenance services is satisfied over the course of each month. Our obligation for overdraft services is satisfied at the time of the overdraft.
Table 21.2 presents our service charges on deposit accounts by operating segment.

Table 21.2 : Service Charges on Deposit Accounts by Operating Segment
 
 
 
 
Year ended December 31,
 
 
Community Banking
 
Wholesale Banking
 
Wealth and Investment Management
 
Other
 
Consolidated
Company
 
(in millions)
2018

2017

2016

2018

2017

2016

2018

2017

2016

2018

2017

2016

2018

2017

2016

Overdraft fees
$
1,776

1,941

2,024

5

6

6

1

1





1,782

1,948

2,030

Account charges
865

968

1,087

2,069

2,195

2,254

15

16

19

(15
)
(16
)
(18
)
2,934

3,163

3,342

Service charges on deposit accounts
$
2,641

2,909

3,111

2,074

2,201

2,260

16

17

19

(15
)
(16
)
(18
)
4,716

5,111

5,372

BROKERAGE ADVISORY, COMMISSIONS AND OTHER FEES are earned for providing full-service and discount brokerage services predominantly to retail brokerage clients. These revenues include fees earned on asset-based and transactional accounts and other brokerage advisory services.
Asset-based revenues are charged based on the market value of the client’s assets. The services and related obligations associated with certain of these revenues, which include investment advice, active management of client assets, or assistance with selecting and engaging a third-party advisory
 
manager, are generally satisfied over a month or quarter. The remaining revenues include trailing commissions which are earned for selling shares to investors. Our obligation associated with earning trailing commissions is satisfied at the time shares are sold. However, these fees are received and recognized over time during the period the customer owns the shares and we remain the broker of record. The amount of trailing commissions is variable based on the length of time the customer holds the shares and on changes in the value of the underlying assets.

 
Wells Fargo & Company
257


Note 21: Revenue from Contracts with Customers (continued)


Transactional revenues are earned for executing transactions at the client’s direction. Our obligation is generally satisfied upon the execution of the transaction and the fees are based on the size and number of transactions executed.
Other revenues earned from other brokerage advisory services include omnibus and networking fees received from
 
mutual fund companies in return for providing record keeping and other administrative services, and annual account maintenance fees charged to customers.
Table 21.3 presents our brokerage advisory, commissions and other fees by operating segment.
Table 21.3 : Brokerage Advisory, Commissions and Other Fees by Operating Segment
 
 
 
 
Year ended December 31,
 
 
Community Banking
 
Wholesale Banking
 
Wealth and Investment Management
 
Other
 
Consolidated
Company
 
(in millions)
2018

2017

2016

2018

2017

2016

2018

2017

2016

2018

2017

2016

2018

2017

2016

Asset-based revenue (1)
$
1,482

1,372

1,243

1

1

2

6,899

6,630

6,164

(1,484
)
(1,371
)
(1,241
)
6,898

6,632

6,168

Transactional revenue
340

382

454

70

40

55

1,618

1,802

2,032

(380
)
(400
)
(477
)
1,648

1,824

2,064

Other revenue
65

76

157

246

263

311

644

640

674

(65
)
(77
)
(158
)
890

902

984

Brokerage advisory, commissions and other fees
$
1,887

1,830

1,854

317

304

368

9,161

9,072

8,870

(1,929
)
(1,848
)
(1,876
)
9,436

9,358

9,216

(1)
We earned trailing commissions of $1.3 billion for each of the years ended December 31, 2018 , 2017 , and 2016 .
TRUST AND INVESTMENT MANAGEMENT FEES are earned for providing trust, investment management and other related services.
Investment management services include managing and administering assets, including mutual funds, and institutional separate accounts. Fees for these services are generally determined based on a tiered scale relative to the market value of assets under management (AUM). In addition to AUM we have client assets under administration (AUA) that earn various administrative fees which are generally based on the extent of the services provided to administer the account. Services with AUM and AUA-based fees are generally performed over time.
 
Trust services include acting as a trustee or agent for corporate trust, personal trust, and agency assets. Obligations for trust services are generally satisfied over time, while obligations for activities that are transactional in nature are satisfied at the time of the transaction.
Other related services include the custody and safekeeping of accounts. Our obligation for these services is generally satisfied over time.
Table 21.4 presents our trust and investment management fees by operating segment.

Table 21.4 : Trust and Investment Management Fees by Operating Segment
 
 
 
 
Year ended December 31,
 
 
Community Banking
 
Wholesale Banking
 
Wealth and Investment Management
 
Other
 
Consolidated
Company
 
(in millions)
2018

2017

2016

2018

2017

2016

2018

2017

2016

2018

2017

2016

2018

2017

2016

Investment management fees
$

1





2,087

2,053

2,079




2,087

2,054

2,079

Trust fees
908

887

847

329

421

399

728

757

738

(932
)
(916
)
(875
)
1,033

1,149

1,109

Other revenue
2

1

2

116

102

74

78

67

74


(1
)
(2
)
196

169

148

Trust and investment management fees
$
910

889

849

445

523

473

2,893

2,877

2,891

(932
)
(917
)
(877
)
3,316

3,372

3,336


258
Wells Fargo & Company
 


INVESTMENT BANKING FEES are earned for underwriting debt and equity securities, arranging loan syndications and performing other advisory services. Our obligation for these services is generally satisfied at closing of the transaction. Substantially all of these fees are in the Wholesale Banking operating segment.

CARD FEES include credit and debit card interchange and network revenues and various card-related fees. Credit and debit
 
card interchange and network revenues are earned on credit and debit card transactions conducted through payment networks such as Visa, MasterCard, and American Express. Our obligation is satisfied concurrently with the delivery of services on a daily basis.
Table 21.5 presents our card fees by operating segment.

Table 21.5 : Card Fees by Operating Segment
 
 
 
 
Year ended December 31,
 
 
Community Banking
 
Wholesale Banking
 
Wealth and Investment Management
 
Other
 
Consolidated
Company
 
(in millions)
2018

2017

2016

2018

2017

2016

2018

2017

2016

2018

2017

2016

2018

2017

2016

Credit card interchange and network revenues (1)
$
792

944

959

361

345

329

6

6

6

(4
)
(4
)
(4
)
1,155

1,291

1,290

Debit card interchange and network revenues
2,053

1,964

1,889



7







2,053

1,964

1,896

Late fees, cash advance fees, balance transfer fees, and annual fees
698

705

750

1









699

705

750

Card fees (1)
$
3,543

3,613

3,598

362

345

336

6

6

6

(4
)
(4
)
(4
)
3,907

3,960

3,936

(1)
The cost of credit card rewards and rebates of $1.4 billion , $1.2 billion and $1.0 billion for the years ended December 31, 2018 , 2017 and 2016 , respectively, are presented net against the related revenues.
CASH NETWORK FEES are earned for processing ATM transactions. Our obligation is completed daily upon settlement of ATM transactions. Substantially all of these fees are in the Community Banking operating segment.

COMMERCIAL REAL ESTATE BROKERAGE COMMISSIONS are earned for assisting customers in the sale of real estate property. Our obligation is satisfied upon the successful brokering of a transaction. Fees are based on a fixed percentage of the sales price. All of these fees are in the Wholesale Banking operating segment.
 
WIRE TRANSFER AND OTHER REMITTANCE FEES consist of fees earned for funds transfer services and issuing cashier’s checks and money orders. Our obligation is satisfied at the time of the funds transfer services or upon issuance of the cashier’s check or money order. Substantially all of these fees are in the Community Banking and Wholesale Banking operating segments.

ALL OTHER FEES include various types of fees earned on services to customers which have related performance obligations that we complete to recognize revenue. A significant portion of the revenue is earned from providing business payroll services and merchant services, which are generally recognized over time as we perform the services. Most of these fees are in the Community Banking operating segment.



 
Wells Fargo & Company
259


Note 22: Employee Benefits and Other Expenses (continued)

Note 22:   Employee Benefits and Other Expenses
Pension and Postretirement Plans
We sponsor a frozen noncontributory qualified defined benefit retirement plan, the Wells Fargo & Company Cash Balance Plan (Cash Balance Plan), which covers eligible employees of Wells Fargo. The Cash Balance Plan was frozen on July 1, 2009, and no new benefits accrue after that date.
Prior to July 1, 2009, eligible employees’ Cash Balance Plan accounts were allocated a compensation credit based on a percentage of their certified compensation; the freeze discontinued the allocation of compensation credits after June 30, 2009. Investment credits continue to be allocated to participants’ accounts based on their accumulated balances.
We did not make a contribution to our Cash Balance Plan in 2018 . We do not expect that we will be required to make a contribution to the Cash Balance Plan in 2019 ; however, this is dependent on the finalization of the actuarial valuation in 2019 . Our decision of whether to make a contribution in 2019 will be based on various factors including the actual investment performance of plan assets during 2019 . Given these uncertainties, we cannot estimate at this time the amount, if any, that we will contribute in 2019 to the Cash Balance Plan. For the nonqualified pension plans and postretirement benefit plans, there is no minimum required contribution beyond the amount needed to fund benefit payments; we may contribute more to our postretirement benefit plans dependent on various factors.
We recognize settlement losses for our Cash Balance Plan based on assessing whether lump sum payments will, in aggregate for the year, exceed the sum of its annual service and interest cost (threshold). In 2018, lump sum payments (included in the “Benefits paid” line in Table 22.1) exceeded this threshold. Settlement losses of $134 million were recognized in 2018 , representing the pro rata portion of the net loss in cumulative other comprehensive income based on the percentage reduction in the Cash Balance Plan’s projected benefit obligation attributable to 2018 lump sum payments.
 
We sponsored the Pension and Life Assurance Plan of Wachovia Bank to employees in the United Kingdom (UK Pension Plan). In September 2017, an annuity contract was entered into that effected a full settlement of this UK Pension Plan, resulting in a plan settlement of $ 74 million and a settlement loss of $ 7 million .
Our nonqualified defined benefit plans are unfunded and provide supplemental defined benefit pension benefits to certain eligible employees. The benefits under these plans were frozen in prior years.
We provide health care and life insurance benefits for certain retired employees, and we reserve the right to amend, modify or terminate any of the benefits at any time.
The benefit obligation for the qualified plans, nonqualified plans and other benefits plans was $10.1 billion , $557 million and $555 million , respectively, at December 31, 2018, a decrease from $11.1 billion , $621 million and $611 million , respectively, at December 31, 2017. The decreases were primarily due to benefits paid (net of participant contributions), and actuarial gains, reflecting an increase in the discount rates, see Table 22.5 . The information set forth in the following tables is based on current actuarial reports using the measurement date of December 31 for our pension and postretirement benefit plans.

260
Wells Fargo & Company
 


Table 22.1 presents the changes in the benefit obligation and the fair value of plan assets, the funded status, and the amounts recognized on the balance sheet.
 


Table 22.1: Changes in Benefit Obligation and Fair Value of Plan Assets
 
December 31, 2018
 
 
December 31, 2017
 
 
Pension benefits 
 
 
 
 
Pension benefits 
 
 
 
(in millions)
Qualified 

 
Non- 
qualified 

 
Other 
benefits 

 
Qualified 

 
Non- 
qualified 

 
Other 
benefits 

Change in benefit obligation:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Benefit obligation at beginning of year
$
11,110

 
621

 
611

 
10,774

 
630

 
731

Service cost
11

 

 

 
5

 

 

Interest cost
392

 
21

 
21

 
412

 
24

 
28

Plan participants’ contributions

 

 
48

 

 

 
40

Actuarial loss (gain)
(674
)
 
(27
)
 
(33
)
 
634

 
46

 
(102
)
Benefits paid
(719
)
 
(57
)
 
(92
)
 
(651
)
 
(79
)
 
(88
)
Medicare Part D subsidy

 

 
2

 

 

 
1

Amendment
1

 

 

 

 

 

Settlement

 

 

 
(74
)
 

 

Other
13

 

 

 

 

 

Foreign exchange impact
(5
)
 
(1
)
 
(2
)
 
10

 

 
1

Benefit obligation at end of year
10,129

 
557

 
555

 
11,110

 
621

 
611

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Change in plan assets:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Fair value of plan assets at beginning of year
10,667

 

 
565

 
10,120

 

 
549

Actual return on plan assets
(478
)
 

 
(17
)
 
1,253

 

 
56

Employer contribution
10

 
57

 
5

 
11

 
79

 
7

Plan participants’ contributions

 

 
48

 

 

 
40

Benefits paid
(719
)
 
(57
)
 
(92
)
 
(651
)
 
(79
)
 
(88
)
Medicare Part D subsidy

 

 
2

 

 

 
1

Settlement

 

 

 
(74
)
 

 

Other
1

 

 

 

 

 

Foreign exchange impact
(4
)
 

 

 
8

 

 

Fair value of plan assets at end of year
9,477

 

 
511

 
10,667

 

 
565

Funded status at end of year
$
(652
)
 
(557
)
 
(44
)
 
(443
)
 
(621
)
 
(46
)
Amounts recognized on the balance sheet at end of year:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Assets
$
1

 

 

 

 

 

Liabilities
(653
)
 
(557
)
 
(44
)
 
(443
)
 
(621
)
 
(46
)
Table 22.2 provides information for pension and post retirement plans with benefit obligations in excess of plan assets.
 

Table 22.2: Plans with Benefit Obligations in Excess of Plan Assets
 
December 31, 2018
 
 
December 31, 2017
 
(in millions)
Pension Benefits

 
Other Benefits

 
Pension Benefits

 
Other Benefits

Projected benefit obligation
$
10,640

 
N/A

 
11,721

 
N/A

Accumulated benefit obligation
10,627

 
555

 
11,717

 
611

Fair value of plan assets
9,429

 
511

 
10,656

 
565



 
Wells Fargo & Company
261


Note 22: Employee Benefits and Other Expenses (continued)

Table 22.3 presents the components of net periodic benefit cost and other comprehensive income (OCI).
 


Table 22.3: Net Periodic Benefit Cost and Other Comprehensive Income
 
December 31, 2018
 
 
December 31, 2017
 
 
December 31, 2016
 
 
Pension benefits 
 
 
 
 
Pension benefits 
 
 
 
 
Pension benefits 
 
 
 
(in millions)
Qualified 

 
Non- 
qualified 

 
Other 
benefits 

 
Qualified 

 
Non- 
qualified 

 
Other 
benefits 

 
Qualified 

 
Non- 
qualified 

 
Other 
 benefits 

Service cost
$
11

 

 

 
5

 

 

 
3

 

 

Interest cost (1)
392

 
21

 
21

 
412

 
24

 
28

 
422

 
26

 
39

Expected return on plan assets (1)
(641
)
 

 
(31
)
 
(652
)
 

 
(30
)
 
(608
)
 

 
(30
)
Amortization of net actuarial loss (gain) (1)
131

 
14

 
(18
)
 
148

 
11

 
(9
)
 
146

 
12

 
(5
)
Amortization of prior service credit (1)

 

 
(10
)
 

 

 
(10
)
 

 

 
(2
)
Settlement loss (1)
134

 
2

 

 
7

 
6

 

 
5

 
2

 

Net periodic benefit cost
27

 
37

 
(38
)
 
(80
)
 
41

 
(21
)
 
(32
)
 
40

 
2

Other changes in plan assets and benefit obligations recognized in other comprehensive income:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net actuarial loss (gain)
445

 
(27
)
 
15

 
33

 
46

 
(128
)
 
302

 
9

 
(82
)
Amortization of net actuarial gain (loss)
(131
)
 
(14
)
 
18

 
(148
)
 
(11
)
 
9

 
(146
)
 
(12
)
 
5

Prior service cost (credit) (2)
1

 

 

 
1

 

 

 

 

 
(177
)
Amortization of prior service credit

 

 
10

 

 

 
10

 

 

 
2

Settlement
(134
)
 
(2
)
 

 
(8
)
 
(6
)
 

 
(5
)
 
(2
)
 

Total recognized in other comprehensive income
181

 
(43
)
 
43

 
(122
)
 
29

 
(109
)
 
151

 
(5
)
 
(252
)
Total recognized in net periodic benefit cost and other comprehensive income
$
208

 
(6
)
 
5

 
(202
)
 
70

 
(130
)
 
119

 
35

 
(250
)
(1)
Effective January 1, 2018, we adopted ASU 2017-07 – Improving the Presentation of Net Periodic Pension Cost and Net Periodic Postretirement Benefit Cost. Accordingly, 2018 balances are reported in other noninterest expense on the consolidated statement of income. For 2017 and 2016 , these balances were reported in employee benefits.
(2)
In 2016, a prior service credit of $177 million was recognized for an amendment that reduced the Wells Fargo & Company Retiree Plan obligation.
Table 22.4 provides the amounts recognized in cumulative OCI (pre tax).

Table 22.4: Benefits Recognized in Cumulative OCI
 
December 31, 2018
 
 
December 31, 2017
 
 
Pension benefits 
 
 
 
 
Pension benefits 
 
 
 
(in millions)
Qualified 

 
Non- 
qualified 

 
Other 
benefits 

 
Qualified 

 
Non- 
qualified 

 
Other 
benefits 

Net actuarial loss (gain)
$
3,336

 
149

 
(327
)
 
3,156

 
192

 
(360
)
Net prior service cost (credit)
1

 

 
(156
)
 

 

 
(166
)
Total
$
3,337

 
149

 
(483
)
 
3,156


192

 
(526
)


262
Wells Fargo & Company
 


Plan Assumptions
For additional information on our pension accounting assumptions, see Note 1 (Summary of Significant Accounting Policies). Table 22.5 presents the weighted-average assumptions used to estimate the projected benefit obligation for pension benefits.
 


Table 22.5: Weighted-Average Assumptions Used to Estimate Projected Benefit Obligation
 
December 31, 2018
 
December 31, 2017
 
Pension benefits 
 
 
 
Pension benefits 
 
 
 
Qualified 

 
Non- 
qualified 
 
Other 
benefits 
 
Qualified 
 
Non- 
qualified 
 
Other 
benefits 
Discount rate
4.30
%
 
4.20
 
4.24
 
3.65
 
3.55
 
3.54
Interest crediting rate
3.22

 
2.18
 
N/A
 
2.74
 
1.54
 
N/A

Table 22.6 presents the weighted-average assumptions used to determine the net periodic benefit cost.

Table 22.6: Weighted-Average Assumptions Used to Determine Net Periodic Benefit Cost
 
December 31, 2018
 
December 31, 2017
 
December 31, 2016
 
Pension benefits 
 
 
 
Pension benefits 
 
 
 
Pension benefits 
 
 
 
Qualified 

 
Non- 
qualified 
 
Other 
benefits 
 
Qualified 
 
Non- 
qualified 
 
Other 
benefits 
 
Qualified 
 
Non- 
qualified 
 
Other 
 benefits 
Discount rate (1)
3.65
%
 
3.65
 
3.54
 
3.98
 
3.93
 
4.00
 
3.99
 
4.11
 
4.16
Interest crediting rate (1)
2.74

 
1.68
 
N/A
 
2.92
 
1.85
 
N/A
 
3.03
 
2.02
 
N/A
Expected return on plan assets
6.24

 
N/A
 
5.75
 
6.70
 
N/A
 
5.75
 
6.75
 
N/A
 
5.75
(1)
Includes the impact of interim re-measurements as applicable.

To account for postretirement health care plans, we used health care cost trend rates to recognize the effect of expected changes in future health care costs due to medical inflation, utilization changes, new technology, regulatory requirements and Medicare cost shifting. In determining the end of year benefit obligation, we assumed an average annual increase of approximately 8.40% for health care costs in 2019 . This rate is assumed to trend down 0.50% - 0.60% per year until the trend rate reaches an ultimate rate of 4.50% in 2026 . The 2018 periodic benefit cost was determined using an initial annual trend rate of 9.00% . This rate was assumed to decrease 0.40% - 0.70% per year until the trend rate reached an ultimate rate of 4.50% in 2026 .

Investment Strategy and Asset Allocation
We seek to achieve the expected long-term rate of return with a prudent level of risk, given the benefit obligations of the pension plans and their funded status. Our overall investment strategy is designed to provide our Cash Balance Plan with long-term growth opportunities while ensuring that risk is mitigated through diversification across numerous asset classes and various investment strategies. We target the asset allocation for our Cash Balance Plan at a target mix range of 25% - 45% equities, 45% - 65% fixed income, and approximately 10% in real estate, venture capital, private equity and other investments. The Employee Benefit Review Committee (EBRC), which includes several members of senior management, formally reviews the investment risk and performance of our Cash Balance Plan on a quarterly basis. Annual Plan liability analysis and periodic asset/liability evaluations are also conducted.
 
Other benefit plan assets include (1) assets held in a 401(h) trust, which are invested with a target mix of 40% - 60% for both equities and fixed income, and (2) assets held in the Retiree Medical Plan Voluntary Employees’ Beneficiary Association (VEBA) trust, which are invested with a general target asset mix of 20% - 40% equities and 60% - 80% fixed income. Members of the EBRC formally review the investment risk and performance of these assets on a quarterly basis.

Projected Benefit Payments
Future benefits that we expect to pay under the pension and other benefit plans are presented in Table 22.7 .
 
Table 22.7: Projected Benefit Payments
 
Pension benefits
 
 
 
(in millions)
Qualified 

 
Non- 
qualified 

 
Other Benefits

Year ended December 31,
 
 
 
 
 
2019
$
784

 
52

 
46

2020
771

 
50

 
48

2021
767

 
49

 
48

2022
759

 
46

 
47

2023
711

 
44

 
46

2024-2028
3,381

 
199

 
198



 
Wells Fargo & Company
263


Note 22: Employee Benefits and Other Expenses (continued)

Fair Value of Plan Assets
Table 22.8 presents the balances of pension plan assets and other benefit plan assets measured at fair value. See Note 18 (Fair Values of Assets and Liabilities) for fair value hierarchy level definitions.
 




Table 22.8: Pension and Other Benefit Plan Assets
 
Carrying value at year end
 
 
Pension plan assets
 
 
Other benefits plan assets
 
(in millions)
Level 1 

 
Level 2 

 
Level 3 

 
Total 

 
Level 1 

 
Level 2

 
Level 3 

 
Total 

December 31, 2018
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Cash and cash equivalents
$
2

 
284

 

 
286

 
69

 
22

 

 
91

Long duration fixed income (1) 
902

 
4,414

 

 
5,316

 

 

 

 

Intermediate (core) fixed income (2) 

 
118

 

 
118

 

 
183

 

 
183

High-yield fixed income

 
114

 

 
114

 

 

 

 

International fixed income
55

 
186

 

 
241

 

 

 

 

Domestic large-cap stocks (3) 
582

 
238

 

 
820

 

 
115

 

 
115

Domestic mid-cap stocks
167

 
89

 

 
256

 

 
28

 

 
28

Domestic small-cap stocks
141

 
7

 

 
148

 

 
17

 

 
17

Global stocks (4)
72

 
357

 

 
429

 

 

 

 

International stocks (5) 
449

 
110

 

 
559

 
9

 
40

 

 
49

Emerging market stocks

 
205

 

 
205

 

 

 

 

Real estate
148

 
33

 
14

 
195

 

 

 

 

Hedge funds/absolute return
63

 
32

 

 
95

 

 

 

 

Other
34

 
44

 
8

 
86

 
4

 

 
24

 
28

Plan investments - excluding investments at NAV
$
2,615

 
6,231

 
22

 
8,868

 
82

 
405

 
24

 
511

Investments at NAV (6)
 
 
 
 
 
 
566

 
 
 
 
 
 
 

Net receivables
 
 
 
 
 
 
43

 
 
 
 
 
 
 

Total plan assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
$
9,477

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
511

December 31, 2017
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Cash and cash equivalents
$
1

 
234

 

 
235

 
85

 
23

 

 
108

Long duration fixed income (1)
875

 
4,424

 

 
5,299

 

 

 

 

Intermediate (core) fixed income (2)

 
255

 

 
255

 

 
185

 

 
185

High-yield fixed income

 
267

 

 
267

 

 

 

 

International fixed income
60

 
223

 

 
283

 

 

 

 

Domestic large-cap stocks (3)
825

 
300

 

 
1,125

 

 
130

 

 
130

Domestic mid-cap stocks
227

 
133

 

 
360

 

 
34

 

 
34

Domestic small-cap stocks
224

 
12

 

 
236

 

 
20

 

 
20

Global stocks (4)
89

 
391

 

 
480

 

 

 

 

International stocks (5)
542

 
257

 

 
799

 
23

 
38

 

 
61

Emerging market stocks

 
305

 

 
305

 

 

 

 

Real estate
157

 
31

 
20

 
208

 

 

 

 

Hedge funds/absolute return
62

 
28

 

 
90

 

 

 

 

Other

 
72

 
8

 
80

 
3

 

 
23

 
26

Plan investments - excluding investments at NAV
$
3,062

 
6,932

 
28

 
10,022

 
111

 
430

 
23

 
564

Investments at NAV (6)
 
 
 
 
 
 
594

 
 
 
 
 
 
 

Net receivables
 
 
 
 
 
 
51

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1

Total plan assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
$
10,667

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
565

(1)
This category includes a diversified mix of assets, which are being managed in accordance with a duration target of approximately 10 years and an emphasis on corporate credit bonds combined with investments in U.S. Treasury securities and other U.S. agency and non-agency bonds.
(2)
This category includes assets that are intermediate duration, investment grade bonds held in investment strategies benchmarked to the Bloomberg Barclays Capital U.S. Aggregate Bond Index, including U.S. Treasury securities, agency and non-agency asset-backed bonds and corporate bonds.
(3)
This category covers a broad range of investment styles, including active, enhanced index and passive approaches, as well as style characteristics of value, core and growth emphasized strategies. Assets in this category are currently diversified across eight unique investment strategies with no single investment manager strategy representing more than 2.0% of total plan assets.
(4)
This category consists of five unique investment strategies providing exposure to broadly diversified, global equity investments, which generally have an allocation of 40 - 60% in U.S. domiciled equities and an equivalent allocation range in non-U.S. equities, with no single strategy representing more than 1.5% of total Plan assets.
(5)
This category includes assets diversified across four unique investment strategies providing exposure to companies in developed market, non-U.S. countries with no single strategy representing more than 2.5% of total plan assets.
(6)
Consists of certain investments that are measured at fair value using NAV per share (or its equivalent) as a practical expedient and are excluded from the fair value hierarchy.

264
Wells Fargo & Company
 


Table 22.9 presents the changes in Level 3 pension plan and other benefit plan assets measured at fair value.

Table 22.9: Fair Value Level 3 Pension and Other Benefit Plan Assets
 
Balance beginning 
 of year

 
Gains (losses) 
 
 
Purchases, 
 sales 
 and  
settlements (net)

 
Transfers 
 Into/
(Out of) 
 Level 3

 
Balance 
 end of 
 year 

(in millions)
 
Realized 

 
Unrealized (1) 

 
 
 
Quarter ended December 31, 2018
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Pension plan assets:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Real estate
$
20

 
(2
)
 
(1
)
 
(3
)
 

 
14

Other
8

 

 

 

 

 
8

Total pension plan assets
$
28

 
(2
)
 
(1
)
 
(3
)
 

 
22

Other benefits plan assets:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Other
$
23

 
1

 

 

 

 
24

Total other benefit plan assets
$
23


1








24

Quarter ended December 31, 2017
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Pension plan assets:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Long duration fixed income
$
19

 

 

 

 
(19
)
 

Real estate
25

 
(3
)
 
5

 
(4
)
 
(3
)
 
20

Other
8

 

 

 

 

 
8

Total pension plan assets
$
52

 
(3
)
 
5

 
(4
)
 
(22
)
 
28

Other benefits plan assets:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Other
$
23

 

 

 

 

 
23

Total other benefit plan assets
$
23

 

 

 

 

 
23

(1)
All unrealized gains (losses) relate to instruments held at period end.

VALUATION METHODOLOGIES   Following is a description of the valuation methodologies used for assets measured at fair value.
Cash and Cash Equivalents – includes investments in collective investment funds valued at fair value based upon the fund’s NAV per share held at year-end. The NAV per share is quoted on a private market that is not active; however, the NAV per share is based on underlying investments traded on an active market. This group of assets also includes investments in registered investment companies valued at the NAV per share held at year-end and in interest-bearing bank accounts.
Long Duration, Intermediate (Core), High-Yield, and International Fixed Income – includes investments traded on the secondary markets; prices are measured by using quoted market prices for similar securities, pricing models, and discounted cash flow analyses using significant inputs observable in the market where available, or a combination of multiple valuation techniques. This group of assets also includes highly liquid government securities such as U.S. Treasuries, limited partnerships valued at the NAV, registered investment companies and collective investment funds described above.
Domestic, Global, International and Emerging Market Stocks – investments in exchange-traded equity securities are valued at quoted market values. This group of assets also includes investments in registered investment companies and collective investment funds described above.
 
Real Estate – includes investments in real estate, which are valued at fair value based on an income capitalization valuation approach. Market values are estimates, and the actual market price of the real estate can only be determined by negotiation between independent third parties in sales transactions. This group of assets also includes investments in exchange-traded equity securities and collective investment funds described above.
Hedge Funds / Absolute Return – includes investments in registered investment companies, and limited partnerships, as described above.
Other – insurance contracts that are stated at cash surrender value. This group of assets also includes investments in registered investment companies and collective investment funds described above.
The methods described above may produce a fair value calculation that may not be indicative of net realizable value or reflective of future fair values. While we believe our valuation methods are appropriate and consistent with other market participants, the use of different methodologies or assumptions to determine the fair value of certain financial instruments could result in a different fair value measurement at the reporting date.

 
Wells Fargo & Company
265


Note 22: Employee Benefits and Other Expenses (continued)

Defined Contribution Retirement Plans
We sponsor a qualified defined contribution retirement plan, the Wells Fargo & Company 401(k) Plan (401(k) Plan). Under the 401(k) Plan, after one month of service, eligible employees may contribute up to 50% of their certified compensation, subject to statutory limits. Eligible employees who complete one year of service are eligible for quarterly company matching contributions, which are generally dollar for dollar up to 6% of an employee’s eligible certified compensation. Matching contributions are 100% vested. The 401(k) Plan includes an employer discretionary profit sharing contribution feature to allow us to make a contribution to eligible employees’ 401(k) Plan accounts for a plan year. Eligible employees who complete one year of service are eligible for profit sharing contributions. Profit sharing contributions are vested after three years of service. Total defined contribution retirement plan expenses were $1.2 billion in each of the following years, 2018 , 2017 and 2016 .
 
Other Expenses
Table 22.10 presents expenses exceeding 1% of total interest income and noninterest income in any of the years presented that are not otherwise shown separately in the financial statements or Notes to Financial Statements.
 
Table 22.10: Other Expenses
 
Year ended December 31, 
 
(in millions)
2018

 
2017

 
2016

Outside professional services
$
3,306

 
3,813

 
3,138

Operating losses
3,124

 
5,492

 
1,608

Contract services (1)
2,192

 
1,638

 
1,497

Credit card rewards and rebates (2)
1,401

 
1,201

 
1,047

Operating leases
1,334

 
1,351

 
1,329

Outside data processing
660

 
891

 
888

(1)
The periods prior to 2018 have been revised to conform with the current period presentation whereby temporary help is included in contract services rather than in all other noninterest expense.
(2)
Noninterest income from card fees is net of cardholder rewards and rebates expense.




266
Wells Fargo & Company
 


Note 23:   Income Taxes
On December 22, 2017, the Tax Cuts & Jobs Act (Tax Act) was enacted resulting in significant changes to both domestic tax law and the U.S taxation of foreign subsidiaries. In 2018 , we re-measured our provisional estimates of the tax impacts that were recorded in 2017 . As a result, during 2018 the Company recognized a $164 million discrete tax expense for adjustments to the provisional tax impacts of the Tax Act included in its consolidated financial statement for the year ended December 31, 2017 . The accounting was completed in fourth quarter 2018.
Table 23.1 presents the components of income tax expense.

Table 23.1: Income Tax Expense
 
Year ended December 31, 
 
(in millions)
2018

 
2017

 
2016

Current:
 
 
 
 
 
Federal
$
2,382

 
3,507

 
6,712

State and local
1,140

 
561

 
1,395

Foreign
170

 
183

 
175

Total current
3,692

 
4,251

 
8,282

Deferred:
 
 
 
 
 
Federal
1,706

 
156

 
1,498

State and local
236

 
564

 
296

Foreign
28

 
(54
)
 
(1
)
Total deferred
1,970

 
666

 
1,793

Total
$
5,662

 
4,917

 
10,075

 
The tax effects of our temporary differences that gave rise to significant portions of our deferred tax assets and liabilities are presented in Table 23.2 .

Table 23.2: Net Deferred Tax Liability
 
Dec 31,

 
Dec 31,

(in millions)
2018

 
2017

Deferred tax assets
 
 
 
Allowance for loan losses
$
2,644

 
2,816

Deferred compensation and employee benefits
2,893

 
2,377

Accrued expenses
815

 
722

PCI loans
467

 
1,057

Net unrealized losses on debt securities
1,022

 

Net operating loss and tax credit carry forwards
366

 
341

Other
1,272

 
986

Total deferred tax assets
9,479

 
8,299

Deferred tax assets valuation allowance
(315
)
 
(397
)
Deferred tax liabilities
 
 
 
Mortgage servicing rights
(3,475
)
 
(3,421
)
Leasing
(4,271
)
 
(4,084
)
Basis difference in investments
(1,203
)
 
(577
)
Mark to market, net
(7,252
)
 
(5,816
)
Intangible assets
(427
)
 
(539
)
Net unrealized gains on debt securities

 
(55
)
Insurance reserves
(696
)
 
(750
)
Other
(831
)
 
(821
)
Total deferred tax liabilities
(18,155
)
 
(16,063
)
Net deferred tax liability (1)
$
(8,991
)
 
(8,161
)
(1)
The net deferred tax liability is included in accrued expenses and other liabilities.

 
Wells Fargo & Company
267


Note 23:   Income Taxes  (continued)

Deferred taxes related to net unrealized gains (losses) on debt securities, net unrealized gains (losses) on derivatives, foreign currency translation, and employee benefit plan adjustments are recorded in cumulative OCI (see Note 25 (Other Comprehensive Income)). These associated adjustments increased OCI by $1.1 billion in 2018 . In 2018, we adopted ASU 2018-02 – Income Statement-Reporting Comprehensive Income (Topic 220): Reclassification of Certain Tax Effects from Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income, and reclassified $400 million from OCI to retained earnings. See Note 1 (Summary of Significant Accounting Policies) and Note 25 (Other Comprehensive Income) for more information.
We have determined that a valuation allowance is required for 2018 in the amount of $315 million , predominantly attributable to deferred tax assets in various state and foreign jurisdictions where we believe it is more likely than not that these deferred tax assets will not be realized. In these jurisdictions, carry back limitations, lack of sources of taxable income, and tax planning strategy limitations contributed to our conclusion that the deferred tax assets would not be realizable. We have concluded that it is more likely than not that the remaining deferred tax assets will be realized based on our history of earnings, sources of taxable income in carry back periods, and our ability to implement tax planning strategies.
 
At December 31, 2018 , we had net operating loss carry forwards with related deferred tax assets of $366 million . If these carry forwards are not utilized, they will mostly expire in varying amounts through December 31, 2038 .
In 2018, we finalized the recognition of the U.S. tax expense associated with the deemed repatriation of undistributed earnings of certain non-U.S. subsidiaries as required under the 2017 Tax Act. We do not intend to distribute these earnings in a taxable manner, and therefore intend to limit distributions to foreign earnings previously taxed in the U.S., that would qualify for the 100% dividends received deduction, and that would not result in any significant state or foreign taxes. All other undistributed foreign earnings will continue to be permanently reinvested outside the U.S. and the related tax liability on these earnings is insignificant.
Table 23.3 reconciles the statutory federal income tax expense and rate to the effective income tax expense and rate. Our effective tax rate is calculated by dividing income tax expense by income before income tax expense less the net income from noncontrolling interests.

Table 23.3: Effective Income Tax Expense and Rate
 
December 31,
 
 
2018
 
 
2017
 
 
2016
 
(in millions)
Amount 

 
Rate 

 
Amount 

 
Rate 

 
Amount 

 
Rate 

Statutory federal income tax expense and rate
$
5,892

 
21.0
 %
 
$
9,485

 
35.0
 %
 
$
11,204

 
35.0
 %
Change in tax rate resulting from:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
State and local taxes on income, net of federal income tax benefit
1,076

 
3.9

 
926

 
3.4

 
1,004

 
3.1

Tax-exempt interest
(494
)
 
(1.8
)
 
(812
)
 
(3.0
)
 
(725
)
 
(2.2
)
Tax credits
(1,537
)
 
(5.5
)
 
(1,419
)
 
(5.2
)
 
(1,251
)
 
(3.9
)
 Non-deductible accruals
236

 
0.8

 
1,320

 
4.9

 
81

 
0.3

 Tax reform
164

 
0.6

 
(3,713
)
 
(13.7
)
 

 

Other
325

 
1.2

 
(870
)
 
(3.3
)
 
(238
)
 
(0.8
)
Effective income tax expense and rate
$
5,662

 
20.2
 %
 
$
4,917

 
18.1
 %
 
$
10,075

 
31.5
 %

The 2018 effective income tax rate was 20.2% , compared with 18.1% in 2017 and 31.5% in 2016 . The 2018 effective income tax rate reflected the reduction to the U.S. federal income tax rate from 35% to 21% resulting from the 2017 Tax Act. It also included income tax expense related to non-deductible litigation accruals and the reconsideration of reserves for state income taxes following the U.S. Supreme Court opinion in South Dakota v. Wayfair, Inc . In addition, we recognized $164 million of income tax expense associated with the final re-measurement of our initial estimates for the impacts of the Tax Act, in accordance with ASC Topic 740, Income Taxes and SEC Accounting Bulletin 118.
 
The 2017 effective income tax rate included an estimated impact of the Tax Act, including a benefit of $3.9 billion resulting from the re-measurement of the Company’s estimated net deferred tax liability as of December 31, 2017 , partially offset by $173 million of income tax expense for the estimated deemed repatriation of the Company’s previously undistributed foreign earnings. The 2017 effective income tax rate also included income tax expense of $1.3 billion related to the effect of discrete non tax-deductible items, predominantly consisting of litigation accruals. The effective income tax rate for 2016 included net reductions in reserves for uncertain tax positions resulting from settlements with tax authorities, partially offset by a net increase in tax benefits related to tax credit investments.


268
Wells Fargo & Company
 


Table 23.4 presents the change in unrecognized tax benefits.

Table 23.4: Change in Unrecognized Tax Benefits
 
Year ended 
 December 31, 
 
(in millions)
2018

 
2017

Balance at beginning of year
$
5,167

 
5,029

Additions:
 
 
 
For tax positions related to the current year
393

 
367

For tax positions related to prior years
503

 
158

Reductions:
 
 
 
For tax positions related to prior years
(262
)
 
(319
)
Lapse of statute of limitations
(7
)
 
(48
)
Settlements with tax authorities
(44
)
 
(20
)
Balance at end of year
$
5,750

 
5,167


Of the $5.8 billion of unrecognized tax benefits at December 31, 2018 , approximately $3.9 billion would, if recognized, affect the effective tax rate. The remaining $1.9 billion of unrecognized tax benefits relates to income tax positions on temporary differences.
We recognize interest and penalties related to unrecognized tax benefits as a component of income tax expense. As of December 31, 2018 and 2017 , we have accrued approximately $968 million and $726 million , respectively, for the payment of interest and penalties. In 2018 , we recognized in income tax expense a net tax expense related to interest and penalties of $200 million . In 2017 , we recognized in income tax expense a net tax expense related to interest and penalties of $96 million .
 
We are subject to U.S. federal income tax as well as income tax in numerous state and foreign jurisdictions. We are routinely examined by tax authorities in these various jurisdictions. The IRS is currently examining the 2013 through 2016 consolidated U.S. federal income tax returns of Wells Fargo & Company and its subsidiaries. In addition, we are currently subject to examination by various state, local and foreign taxing authorities. With few exceptions, Wells Fargo and its subsidiaries are not subject to federal, state, local and foreign income tax examinations for taxable years prior to 2007.
We are litigating or appealing various issues related to prior IRS examinations for the periods 2003 through 2012. For the 2003 through 2006 periods, we have paid the IRS the contested income tax and interest associated with these issues and refund claims have been filed for the respective years. It is possible that one or more of these examinations, appeals or litigation may be resolved within the next twelve months resulting in a decrease of up to $700 million to our gross unrecognized tax benefits.



 
Wells Fargo & Company
269


Note 24:   Earnings and Dividends Per Common Share
Table 24.1 shows earnings per common share and diluted earnings per common share and reconciles the numerator and denominator of both earnings per common share calculations. See Note 1 (Summary of Significant Accounting Policies) for
 
discussion of private share repurchases, and the Consolidated Statement of Changes in Equity and Note 20 (Common Stock and Stock Plans) for information about stock and options activity and terms and conditions of warrants.

Table 24.1: Earnings Per Common Share Calculations
 
 
Year ended December 31,
 
(in millions, except per share amounts)
2018

 
2017

 
2016

Wells Fargo net income
$
22,393

 
22,183

 
21,938

Less: Preferred stock dividends and other (1)
1,704

 
1,629

 
1,565

Wells Fargo net income applicable to common stock (numerator)
$
20,689

 
20,554

 
20,373

Earnings per common share
 
 
 
 
 
Average common shares outstanding (denominator)
4,799.7

 
4,964.6

 
5,052.8

Per share
$
4.31

 
4.14

 
4.03

Diluted earnings per common share
 
 
 
 
 
Average common shares outstanding
4,799.7

 
4,964.6

 
5,052.8

Add:
Stock options
8.0

 
17.1

 
18.9

 
Restricted share rights
26.3

 
24.7

 
25.9

 
Warrants
4.4

 
10.9

 
10.7

Diluted average common shares outstanding (denominator)
4,838.4

 
5,017.3

 
5,108.3

Per share
$
4.28

 
4.10

 
3.99

(1)
The year ended December 31, 2018, includes $ 155 million as a result of eliminating the discount on our Series J Preferred Stock, which was redeemed on September 17, 2018.
Table 24.2 presents the outstanding options to purchase shares of common stock that were anti-dilutive (the exercise price was higher than the weighted-average market price), and therefore not included in the calculation of diluted earnings per common share.
Table 24.2: Outstanding Anti-Dilutive Options
 
Weighted-average shares
 
 
Year ended December 31,
 
(in millions)
2018

 
2017

 
2016

Options
0.3

 
1.9

 
3.2

Table 24.3 presents dividends declared per common share.
Table 24.3: Dividends Declared Per Common Share
 
Year ended December 31,
 
 
2018

 
2017

 
2016

Per common share
$
1.640

 
1.540

 
1.515


270
Wells Fargo & Company
 


Note 25:   Other Comprehensive Income 
Table 25.1 provides the components of other comprehensive income (OCI), reclassifications to net income by income statement line item, and the related tax effects.
 



Table 25.1: Summary of Other Comprehensive Income
 
Year ended December 31,
 
 
2018
 
 
2017
 
 
2016
 
(in millions)
Before 
 tax 

 
Tax 
 effect 

 
Net of 
 tax 

 
Before 
 tax 

 
Tax 
 effect 

 
Net of 
 tax 

 
Before 
 tax 

 
Tax 
 effect 

 
Net of 
 tax 

Debt securities (1):
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net unrealized gains (losses) arising during the period
$
(4,493
)
 
1,100

 
(3,393
)
 
2,719

 
(1,056
)
 
1,663

 
(3,458
)
 
1,302

 
(2,156
)
Reclassification of net (gains) losses to net income:
 
 
 
 


 
 
 
 
 


 
 
 
 
 


Interest income on debt securities (2)
357

 
(88
)
 
269

 
198

 
(75
)
 
123

 
7

 
(3
)
 
4

Net gains on debt securities
(108
)
 
27

 
(81
)
 
(479
)
 
181

 
(298
)
 
(942
)
 
355

 
(587
)
Net gains from equity securities (3)

 

 

 
(456
)
 
172

 
(284
)
 
(300
)
 
113

 
(187
)
Other noninterest income
(1
)
 

 
(1
)
 

 

 

 
(5
)
 
2

 
(3
)
Subtotal reclassifications to net income
248

 
(61
)

187


(737
)

278


(459
)

(1,240
)

467


(773
)
Net change
(4,245
)
 
1,039


(3,206
)
 
1,982

 
(778
)
 
1,204

 
(4,698
)
 
1,769

 
(2,929
)
Derivatives and hedging activities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Fair Value Hedges:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Change in fair value of excluded components on fair value hedges (4)
(254
)
 
63

 
(191
)
 
(253
)
 
95

 
(158
)
 

 

 

Cash Flow Hedges:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net unrealized gains (losses) arising during the period on cash flow hedges
(278
)
 
67

 
(211
)
 
(287
)
 
108

 
(179
)
 
177

 
(67
)
 
110

Reclassification of net (gains) losses to net income:
 
 
 
 


 
 
 
 
 


 
 
 
 
 


Interest income on loans
292

 
(72
)
 
220

 
(551
)
 
208

 
(343
)
 
(1,043
)
 
393

 
(650
)
Interest expense on long-term debt
2

 

 
2

 
8

 
(3
)
 
5

 
14

 
(5
)
 
9

Subtotal reclassifications
 to net income
294

 
(72
)

222


(543
)

205


(338
)

(1,029
)

388


(641
)
Net change
(238
)
 
58

 
(180
)
 
(1,083
)
 
408

 
(675
)
 
(852
)
 
321

 
(531
)
Defined benefit plans adjustments:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net actuarial and prior service gains (losses) arising during the period
(434
)
 
106

 
(328
)
 
49

 
(12
)
 
37

 
(52
)
 
(40
)
 
(92
)
Reclassification of amounts to noninterest expense and employee benefits (5):
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Amortization of net actuarial loss
127

 
(31
)
 
96

 
150

 
(57
)
 
93

 
153

 
(57
)
 
96

Settlements and other
126

 
(29
)
 
97

 
3

 
2

 
5

 
5

 
(1
)
 
4

Subtotal reclassifications to noninterest expense and employee benefits
253

 
(60
)
 
193

 
153

 
(55
)
 
98

 
158

 
(58
)
 
100

Net change
(181
)
 
46

 
(135
)
 
202

 
(67
)
 
135

 
106

 
(98
)
 
8

Foreign currency translation adjustments:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net unrealized gains (losses) arising during the period
(156
)
 
1

 
(155
)
 
96

 
3

 
99

 
(3
)
 
4

 
1

Net change
(156
)
 
1

 
(155
)
 
96

 
3

 
99

 
(3
)
 
4

 
1

Other comprehensive income (loss)
$
(4,820
)
 
1,144

 
(3,676
)
 
1,197

 
(434
)
 
763

 
(5,447
)
 
1,996

 
(3,451
)
Less: Other comprehensive loss from noncontrolling interests, net of tax
 
 
 
 
(2
)
 
 
 
 
 
(62
)
 
 
 
 
 
(17
)
Wells Fargo other comprehensive income (loss), net of tax
 
 
 
 
$
(3,674
)
 
 
 
 
 
825

 
 
 
 
 
(3,434
)
(1)
The years ended December 31, 2017 and 2016, include net unrealized gains (losses) arising during the period from equity securities of $81 million and $259 million and reclassification of net (gains) losses to net income related to equity securities of $(456) million and $(300) million , respectively. In connection with our adoption in first quarter 2018 of ASU 2016-01 – Financial Instruments – Overall (Subtopic 825-10): Recognition and Measurement of Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities , the year ended December 31, 2018, reflects net unrealized gains (losses) arising during the period and reclassification of net (gains) losses to net income from only debt securities.
(2)
Represents net unrealized gains and losses amortized over the remaining lives of securities that were transferred from the available-for-sale portfolio to the held-to-maturity portfolio.
(3)
Net gains from equity securities is presented for table presentation purposes. After our adoption of ASU 2016-01 – Financial Instruments – Overall (Subtopic 825-10): Recognition and Measurement of Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities on January 1, 2018, this line will not contain balances as realized and unrealized gains and losses on marketable equity investments will be recorded in earnings.
(4)
Represents changes in fair value of cross-currency swaps attributable to changes in cross-currency basis spreads, which are excluded from the assessment of hedge effectiveness and recorded in other comprehensive income.
(5)
Effective January 1, 2018, we adopted ASU 2017-07 – Improving the Presentation of Net Periodic Pension Cost and Net Periodic Postretirement Benefit Cost . Accordingly, 2018 balances are reclassified to other noninterest expense on the consolidated statement of income. For 2017 and 2016, these balances were reclassified to employee benefits.


 
Wells Fargo & Company
271


Note 25: Other Comprehensive Income (continued)

Table 25.2 provides the cumulative OCI balance activity on an after-tax basis.
 


Table 25.2: Cumulative OCI Balances
(in millions)
Debt
securities (1)

 
Derivatives 
 and 
 hedging 
 activities 

 
Defined 
 benefit 
 plans 
 adjustments 

 
Foreign 
 currency 
 translation 
adjustments 

 
Cumulative 
 other 
comprehensive 
 income (loss)

Balance, December 31, 2015
$
1,813

 
620

 
(1,951
)
 
(185
)
 
297

Net unrealized gains (losses) arising during the period
(2,156
)
 
110

 
(92
)
 
1

 
(2,137
)
Amounts reclassified from accumulated other comprehensive income
(773
)
 
(641
)
 
100

 

 
(1,314
)
Net change
(2,929
)
 
(531
)
 
8

 
1

 
(3,451
)
Less: Other comprehensive loss from noncontrolling interests
(17
)
 

 

 

 
(17
)
Balance, December 31, 2016
(1,099
)

89


(1,943
)

(184
)

(3,137
)
Transition adjustment (2)

 
168

 

 

 
168

Balance, January 1, 2017
(1,099
)
 
257

 
(1,943
)
 
(184
)
 
(2,969
)
Net unrealized gains (losses) arising during the period
1,663

 
(337
)
 
37

 
99

 
1,462

Amounts reclassified from accumulated other comprehensive income
(459
)
 
(338
)
 
98

 

 
(699
)
Net change
1,204

 
(675
)
 
135

 
99

 
763

Less: Other comprehensive income (loss) from noncontrolling interests
(66
)
 

 

 
4

 
(62
)
Balance, December 31, 2017
171


(418
)

(1,808
)

(89
)

(2,144
)
Transition adjustment (3)
(118
)
 

 

 

 
(118
)
Balance, January 1, 2018
53

 
(418
)
 
(1,808
)
 
(89
)
 
(2,262
)
Reclassification of certain tax effects to retained earnings (4)
31

 
(87
)
 
(353
)
 
9

 
(400
)
Net unrealized losses arising during the period
(3,393
)
 
(402
)
 
(328
)
 
(155
)
 
(4,278
)
Amounts reclassified from accumulated other comprehensive income
187

 
222

 
193

 

 
602

Net change
(3,175
)

(267
)

(488
)

(146
)

(4,076
)
Less: Other comprehensive loss from noncontrolling interests

 

 

 
(2
)
 
(2
)
Balance, December 31, 2018
$
(3,122
)

(685
)

(2,296
)

(233
)

(6,336
)
(1)
The years ended December 31, 2017 and 2016, include net unrealized gains (losses) arising during the period from equity securities of $81 million and $259 million and reclassification of net (gains) losses to net income related to equity securities of $(456) million and $(300) million , respectively. In connection with our adoption in first quarter 2018 of ASU 2016-01 – Financial Instruments – Overall (Subtopic 825-10): Recognition and Measurement of Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities , the year ended December 31, 2018, reflects net unrealized gains (losses) arising during the period and reclassification of net (gains) losses to net income from only debt securities.
(2)
Transition adjustment relates to our adoption of ASU 2017-12 – Derivatives and Hedging (Topic 815): Targeted Improvements to Accounting for Hedging Activities . See Note 1 (Summary of Significant Accounting Policies) for more information.
(3)
The transition adjustment relates to our adoption of ASU 2016-01 – Financial Instruments – Overall (Subtopic 825-10): Recognition and Measurement of Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities . See Note 1 (Summary of Significant Accounting Policies) for more information.
(4)
Represents the reclassification from other comprehensive income to retained earnings as a result of our adoption of ASU 2018-02 – Income Statement-Reporting Comprehensive Income (Topic 220): Reclassification of Certain Tax Effects from Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income in third quarter 2018. See Note 1 (Summary of Significant Accounting Policies) for more information.

272
Wells Fargo & Company
 



Note 26:   Operating Segments
We have three reportable operating segments: Community Banking; Wholesale Banking; and Wealth and Investment Management (WIM). We define our operating segments by product type and customer segment and their results are based on our management accounting process, for which there is no comprehensive, authoritative guidance equivalent to GAAP for financial accounting. The management accounting process measures the performance of the operating segments based on our management structure and is not necessarily comparable with similar information for other financial services companies. If the management structure and/or the allocation process changes, allocations, transfers and assignments may change. Effective first quarter 2018, we adopted a new funds transfer pricing methodology to allow for better comparability of performance across the Company. Under the new methodology, assets and liabilities receive a funding charge or credit that considers interest rate risk, liquidity risk, and other product characteristics on a more granular level. This methodology change affects results across all three of our reportable operating segments and prior period operating segment results have been revised to reflect this methodology change. Our previously reported consolidated financial results were not impacted by the methodology change; however, in connection with our adoption of ASU 2016-01 in first quarter 2018, certain reclassifications have occurred within noninterest income.

Community Banking offers a complete line of diversified financial products and services for consumers and small businesses with annual sales generally up to $5 million in which the owner generally is the financial decision maker. These financial products and services include checking and savings accounts, credit and debit cards, and automobile, student, mortgage, home equity and small business lending, as well as referrals to Wholesale Banking and WIM business partners.
Community Banking serves customers through a complete range of channels, including traditional and in-supermarket and other small format branches, ATMs, digital (online, mobile, and social), and contact centers (phone, email and correspondence).
The Community Banking segment also includes the results of our Corporate Treasury activities net of allocations (including funds transfer pricing, capital, liquidity and certain corporate expenses) in support of other segments and results of investments in our affiliated venture capital and private equity partnerships.
 
 
Wholesale Banking provides financial solutions to businesses across the United States with annual sales generally in excess of $5 million and to financial institutions globally. Wholesale Banking provides a complete line of commercial, corporate, capital markets, cash management and real estate banking products and services. These include traditional commercial loans and lines of credit, letters of credit, asset-based lending, equipment leasing, international trade facilities, trade financing, collection services, foreign exchange services, treasury management, merchant payment processing, institutional fixed-income sales, interest rate, commodity and equity risk management, online/electronic products such as the Commercial Electronic Office ® ( CEO ® ) portal, corporate trust fiduciary and agency services, and investment banking services. Wholesale Banking also supports the CRE market with products and services such as construction loans for commercial and residential development, land acquisition and development loans, secured and unsecured lines of credit, interim financing arrangements for completed structures, rehabilitation loans, affordable housing loans and letters of credit, permanent loans for securitization, CRE loan servicing and real estate and mortgage brokerage services.
 
Wealth and Investment Management provides a full range of personalized wealth management, investment and retirement products and services to clients across U.S. based businesses including Wells Fargo Advisors, The Private Bank, Abbot Downing, Wells Fargo Institutional Retirement and Trust, and Wells Fargo Asset Management. We deliver financial planning, private banking, credit, investment management and fiduciary services to high-net worth and ultra-high-net worth individuals and families. We also serve clients’ brokerage needs, supply retirement and trust services to institutional clients and provide investment management capabilities delivered to global institutional clients through separate accounts and the Wells Fargo Funds.
 
Other includes the elimination of certain items that are included in more than one business segment, most of which represents products and services for Wealth and Investment Management customers served through Community Banking distribution channels.


 
Wells Fargo & Company
273


Note 26: Operating Segments (continued)

Table 26.1 presents our results by operating segment.
Table 26.1: Operating Segments
(income/expense in millions, average balances in billions)
Community 
 Banking 

 
Wholesale 
 Banking 

 
Wealth and Investment Management

 
Other (1) 

 
Consolidated
 Company 

2018
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net interest income (2) 
$
29,219

 
18,690

 
4,441

 
(2,355
)
 
49,995

Provision (reversal of provision) for credit losses
1,783

 
(58
)
 
(5
)
 
24

 
1,744

Noninterest income
17,694

 
10,016

 
11,935

 
(3,232
)
 
36,413

Noninterest expense
30,491

 
16,157

 
12,938

 
(3,460
)
 
56,126

Income (loss) before income tax expense (benefit)
14,639

 
12,607


3,443


(2,151
)

28,538

Income tax expense (benefit)
3,784

 
1,555

 
861

 
(538
)
 
5,662

Net income (loss) before noncontrolling interests
10,855

 
11,052

 
2,582

 
(1,613
)
 
22,876

Less: Net income from noncontrolling interests
461

 
20

 
2

 

 
483

Net income (loss) (3) 
$
10,394

 
11,032

 
2,580

 
(1,613
)
 
22,393

2017 (4)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net interest income (2)
$
28,658

 
18,810

 
4,641

 
(2,552
)
 
49,557

Provision (reversal of provision) for credit losses
2,555

 
(19
)
 
(5
)
 
(3
)
 
2,528

Noninterest income
18,360

 
11,190

 
12,431

 
(3,149
)
 
38,832

Noninterest expense
32,615

 
16,624

 
12,623

 
(3,378
)
 
58,484

Income (loss) before income tax expense (benefit)
11,848

 
13,395

 
4,454

 
(2,320
)
 
27,377

Income tax expense (benefit)
634

 
3,496

 
1,668

 
(881
)
 
4,917

Net income (loss) before noncontrolling interests
11,214

 
9,899

 
2,786

 
(1,439
)
 
22,460

Less: Net income (loss) from noncontrolling interests
276

 
(15
)
 
16

 

 
277

Net income (loss) (3)
$
10,938

 
9,914

 
2,770

 
(1,439
)
 
22,183

2016 (4)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net interest income (2)
$
27,333

 
18,699

 
4,249

 
(2,527
)
 
47,754

Provision (reversal of provision) for credit losses
2,691

 
1,073

 
(5
)
 
11

 
3,770

Noninterest income
19,180

 
12,348

 
12,029

 
(3,044
)
 
40,513

Noninterest expense
27,655

 
15,901

 
12,051

 
(3,230
)
 
52,377

Income (loss) before income tax expense (benefit)
16,167

 
14,073

 
4,232

 
(2,352
)
 
32,120

Income tax expense (benefit)
5,213

 
4,159

 
1,596

 
(893
)
 
10,075

Net income (loss) before noncontrolling interests
10,954

 
9,914

 
2,636

 
(1,459
)
 
22,045

Less: Net income (loss) from noncontrolling interests
136

 
(28
)
 
(1
)
 

 
107

Net income (loss) (3)
$
10,818

 
9,942

 
2,637

 
(1,459
)
 
21,938

2018
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Average loans
$
463.7

 
465.7

 
74.6

 
(58.8
)
 
945.2

Average assets
1,034.1

 
830.5

 
83.9

 
(59.6
)
 
1,888.9

Average deposits
757.2

 
423.7

 
165.0

 
(70.0
)
 
1,275.9

2017 (4)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Average loans
475.7

 
465.6

 
71.9

 
(57.1
)
 
956.1

Average assets
1,085.5

 
822.8

 
82.8

 
(58.1
)
 
1,933.0

Average deposits
729.6

 
464.2

 
189.0

 
(78.2
)
 
1,304.6

(1)
Includes the elimination of certain items that are included in more than one business segment, most of which represents products and services for Wealth and Investment Management customers served through Community Banking distribution channels. 
(2)
Net interest income is the difference between interest earned on assets and the cost of liabilities to fund those assets. Interest earned includes actual interest earned on segment assets as well as as interest credits for any funding of a segment available to be provided to other segments. The cost of liabilities includes actual interest expense on segment liabilities as well as funding charges for any funding provided from other segments.
(3)
Represents segment net income (loss) for Community Banking; Wholesale Banking; and Wealth and Investment Management segments and Wells Fargo net income for the consolidated company.
(4)
Prior period operating segment results have been revised to reflect a methodology change of allocating funding charges and credits.

274
Wells Fargo & Company
 


Note 27:   Parent-Only Financial Statements
The following tables present Parent-only condensed financial statements.

Table 27.1: Parent-Only Statement of Income
 
Year ended December 31,
 
(in millions)
2018

 
2017

 
2016

Income
 
 
 
 
 
Dividends from subsidiaries (1)
$
22,427

 
20,746

 
12,776

Interest income from subsidiaries
3,298

 
1,984

 
1,615

Other interest income
49

 
146

 
155

Other income
(424
)
 
1,238

 
177

Total income
25,350

 
24,114

 
14,723

Expense
 
 
 
 
 
Interest expense:
 
 
 
 
 
Indebtedness to nonbank subsidiaries
644

 
189

 
387

Short-term borrowings
2

 

 

Long-term debt
4,541

 
3,595

 
2,619

Other
3

 
5

 
19

Noninterest expense
286

 
1,888

 
1,300

Total expense
5,476

 
5,677

 
4,325

Income before income tax benefit and
 
 
 
 
 
equity in undistributed income of subsidiaries
19,874

 
18,437

 
10,398

Income tax benefit
(544
)
 
(319
)
 
(1,152
)
Equity in undistributed income of subsidiaries
1,975

 
3,427

 
10,388

Net income
$
22,393

 
22,183

 
21,938

(1)
Includes dividends paid from indirect bank subsidiaries of $20.8 billion , $17.9 billion and $12.5 billion in 2018 , 2017 and 2016 , respectively.
Table 27.2: Parent-Only Statement of Comprehensive Income
 
Year ended December 31,
 
(in millions)
2018

 
2017

 
2016

Net income
$
22,393

 
22,183

 
21,938

Other comprehensive income (loss), net of tax:
 
 
 
 
 
Debt securities (1)
(12
)
 
94

 
(76
)
Derivatives and hedging activities
(198
)
 
(158
)
 

Defined benefit plans adjustment
(132
)
 
118

 
(20
)
Equity in other comprehensive income (loss) of subsidiaries
(3,332
)
 
771

 
(3,338
)
Other comprehensive income (loss), net of tax:
(3,674
)
 
825

 
(3,434
)
Total comprehensive income
$
18,719

 
23,008

 
18,504

(1)
The years ended December 31, 2017 and 2016 , includes net unrealized gains arising during the period from equity securities of $ 3 million and $ 7 million and reclassification of net (gains) to net income related to equity securities of $ (21) million and $ (30) million , respectively. In connection with our adoption in first quarter 2018 of ASU 2016-01 – Financial Instruments – Overall (Subtopic 825-10): Recognition and Measurement of Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities , the year ended December 31, 2018 , reflects net unrealized gains (losses) arising during the period and reclassification of net (gains) losses to net income from only debt securities.



 
Wells Fargo & Company
275


Note 27: Parent-Only Financial Statements (continued)

Table 27.3: Parent-Only Balance Sheet
 
Dec 31,

 
Dec 31,

(in millions)
2018

 
2017

Assets
 
 
 
Cash, cash equivalents, and restricted cash due from (1):
 
 
 
Subsidiary banks
$
16,301

 
23,180

Nonaffiliates

 
1

Debt securities:
 
 
 
Trading, at fair value (2)

 
24

Available-for-sale, at fair value (2)
1

 
5

Loans to nonbank subsidiaries
139,163

 
138,681

Investments in subsidiaries (3)
202,695

 
206,367

Equity securities (2)
2,164

 
2,414

Other assets (2)
4,639

 
4,731

Total assets
$
364,963

 
375,403

Liabilities and equity
 
 
 
Accrued expenses and other liabilities
$
6,986

 
$
7,902

Long-term debt
135,079

 
146,130

Indebtedness to nonbank subsidiaries
26,732

 
14,435

Total liabilities
168,797

 
168,467

Stockholders’ equity
196,166

 
206,936

Total liabilities and equity
$
364,963

 
375,403

(1)
Financial information has been revised to reflect the impact of our adoption in first quarter 2018 of ASU 2016-18 – Statement of Cash Flows (Topic 230): Restricted Cash in which we changed the presentation of our cash and cash equivalents to include both cash and due from banks as well as interest-earning deposits with banks, which are inclusive of restricted cash. See Note 1 (Summary of Significant Accounting Policies) for more information.    
(2)
Financial information for the prior period has been revised to reflect presentation changes made in connection with our adoption in first quarter 2018 of ASU 2016-01 – Financial Instruments – Overall (Subtopic 825-10): Recognition and Measurement of Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities . See Note 1 (Summary of Significant Accounting Policies) for more information.
(3)
The years ended December 31, 2018 , and December 31, 2017 , include indirect ownership of bank subsidiaries with equity of $167.6 billion and $170.5 billion , respectively.

276
Wells Fargo & Company
 


Table 27.4: Parent-Only Statement of Cash Flows
 
Year ended December 31,
 
(in millions)
2018

 
2017

 
2016

Cash flows from operating activities:
 
 
 
 
 
Net cash provided by operating activities (1)
$
19,024

 
22,233

 
10,654

Cash flows from investing activities:
 
 
 
 
 
Available-for-sale debt securities:
 
 
 
 
 
Proceeds from sales:
 
 
 
 
 
     Subsidiary banks

 
8,658

 

     Nonaffiliates (1)

 
8,824

 
5,201

Prepayments and maturities:
 
 
 
 
 
     Subsidiary banks

 
10,250

 
15,000

Purchases:
 
 
 
 
 
Subsidiary banks

 
(3,900
)
 
(15,000
)
Nonaffiliates

 

 
(6,544
)
Equity securities, not held for trading:
 
 
 
 
 
Proceeds from sales and capital returns (1)
355

 
743

 
583

Purchases (1)
(220
)
 
(215
)
 
(314
)
Loans:
 
 
 
 
 
Net repayments from (advances to) subsidiaries
(7
)
 
(35,876
)
 
3,174

Capital notes and term loans made to subsidiaries
(2,441
)
 
(73,729
)
 
(32,641
)
Principal collected on notes/loans made to subsidiaries
756

 
69,286

 
15,164

Net decrease (increase) in investment in subsidiaries
2,407

 
(2,029
)
 
(606
)
Other, net
109

 
113

 
18

Net cash provided (used) by investing activities
959

 
(17,875
)
 
(15,965
)
Cash flows from financing activities:
 
 
 
 
 
Net increase (decrease) in short-term borrowings and indebtedness to subsidiaries
12,467

 
(8,685
)
 
789

Long-term debt:
 
 
 
 
 
Proceeds from issuance
1,876

 
22,217

 
34,362

Repayment
(9,162
)
 
(13,709
)
 
(15,096
)
Preferred stock:
 
 
 
 
 
Proceeds from issuance

 
677

 
2,101

Redeemed
(2,150
)
 

 

Cash dividends paid
(1,622
)
 
(1,629
)
 
(1,566
)
Common stock:
 
 
 
 
 
Proceeds from issuance
632

 
1,211

 
1,415

Stock tendered for payment of withholding taxes
(331
)
 
(393
)
 
(494
)
Repurchased
(20,633
)
 
(9,908
)
 
(8,116
)
Cash dividends paid
(7,692
)
 
(7,480
)
 
(7,472
)
Other, net
(248
)
 
(138
)
 
(118
)
Net cash provided (used) by financing activities
(26,863
)
 
(17,837
)
 
5,805

Net change in cash, cash equivalents, and restricted cash (2)
(6,880
)

(13,479
)

494

Cash, cash equivalents, and restricted cash at beginning of year (2)
23,181

 
36,660

 
36,166

Cash, cash equivalents, and restricted cash at end of year (2)
$
16,301

 
23,181

 
36,660

(1)
Financial information for the prior period has been revised to reflect presentation changes made in connection with our adoption in first quarter 2018 of ASU 2016-01 – Financial Instruments – Overall (Subtopic 825-10): Recognition and Measurement of Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities . See Note 1 (Summary of Significant Accounting Policies) for more information.
(2)
Financial information has been revised to reflect the impact of our adoption in first quarter 2018 of ASU 2016-18 – Statement of Cash Flows (Topic 230): Restricted Cash in which we changed the presentation of our cash and cash equivalents to include both cash and due from banks as well as interest-earning deposits with banks, which are inclusive of restricted cash. See Note 1 (Summary of Significant Accounting Policies) for more information.


 
Wells Fargo & Company
277


Note 28:   Regulatory and Agency Capital Requirements
The Company and each of its subsidiary banks are subject to regulatory capital adequacy requirements promulgated by federal bank regulatory agencies. The Federal Reserve establishes capital requirements for the consolidated financial holding company, and the OCC has similar requirements for the Company’s national banks, including Wells Fargo Bank, N.A. (the Bank).
Table 28.1 presents regulatory capital information for Wells Fargo & Company and the Bank using Basel III, which increased minimum required capital ratios, and introduced a minimum Common Equity Tier 1 (CET1) ratio. We must report the lower of our CET1, tier 1 and total capital ratios calculated under the Standardized Approach and under the Advanced Approach in the assessment of our capital adequacy. The Standardized Approach applies assigned risk weights to broad risk categories, while the calculation of risk-weighted assets (RWAs) under the Advanced Approach differs by requiring applicable banks to utilize a risk-sensitive methodology, which relies upon the use of internal credit models, and includes an operational risk component. The Basel III capital rules are being
 
phased-in effective January 1, 2014, through the end of 2021. Beginning January 1, 2018, the requirements for calculating CET1 and tier 1 capital, along with RWAs, became fully phased-in. Accordingly, the information presented reflects fully phased-in CET1 capital, tier 1 capital, and RWAs, but reflects total capital still in accordance with Transition Requirements.
The Bank is an approved seller/servicer of mortgage loans and is required to maintain minimum levels of shareholders’ equity, as specified by various agencies, including the United States Department of Housing and Urban Development, GNMA, FHLMC and FNMA. At December 31, 2018 , the Bank met these requirements. Other subsidiaries, including the Company’s insurance and broker-dealer subsidiaries, are also subject to various minimum capital levels, as defined by applicable industry regulations. The minimum capital levels for these subsidiaries, and related restrictions, are not significant to our consolidated operations.
 

Table 28.1: Regulatory Capital Information
 
Wells Fargo & Company
 
Wells Fargo Bank, N.A.
 
December 31, 2018
 
 
 
December 31, 2017
 
 
 
December 31, 2018
 
 
 
December 31, 2017
 
 
(in millions, except ratios)
Advanced Approach

 
Standardized
Approach

 
 
Advanced Approach

 
Standardized
Approach

 
 
Advanced Approach

 
Standardized
Approach

 
 
Advanced Approach

 
Standardized
Approach

 
Regulatory capital:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Common equity tier 1
$
146,363

 
146,363

 
 
154,765

 
154,765

 
 
142,685

 
142,685

 
 
143,292

 
143,292

 
Tier 1
167,866

 
167,866

 
 
178,209

 
178,209

 
 
142,685

 
142,685

 
 
143,292

 
143,292

 
Total
198,798

 
207,041

 
 
210,333

 
220,097

 
 
155,558

 
163,380

 
 
156,661

 
165,734

 
Assets:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Risk-weighted assets
$
1,177,350

 
1,247,210

 
 
1,199,545

 
1,260,663

 
 
1,058,653

 
1,154,182

 
 
1,090,360

 
1,169,863

 
Adjusted average assets (1)
1,850,299

 
1,850,299

 
 
1,905,568

 
1,905,568

 
 
1,652,009

 
1,652,009

 
 
1,708,828

 
1,708,828

 
Regulatory capital ratios:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Common equity tier 1 capital
12.43
%

11.74

*
 
12.90

 
12.28

*
 
13.48


12.36

*
 
13.14


12.25

*
Tier 1 capital
14.26


13.46

*
 
14.86

 
14.14

*
 
13.48


12.36

*
 
13.14


12.25

*
Total capital
16.89


16.60

*
 
17.53

 
17.46

*
 
14.69


14.16

*
 
14.37


14.17

*
Tier 1 leverage (1)
9.07

 
9.07

 
 
9.35

 
9.35

 
 
8.64

 
8.64

 
 
8.39

 
8.39

 
*Denotes the lowest capital ratio as determined under the Advanced and Standardized Approaches.
(1)
The leverage ratio consists of Tier 1 capital divided by quarterly average total assets, excluding goodwill and certain other items.
Table 28.2 presents the minimum required regulatory capital ratios under Transition Requirements to which the Company and the Bank were subject as of December 31, 2018 , and December 31, 2017 .
 

Table 28.2: Minimum Required Regulatory Capital Ratios – Transition Requirements (1)
  
Wells Fargo & Company
 
Wells Fargo Bank, N.A.
 
December 31, 2018

 
December 31, 2017
 
December 31, 2018
 
December 31, 2017
Regulatory capital ratios:
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
Common equity tier 1 capital
7.875
%
 
6.750
 
6.375
 
5.750
Tier 1 capital
9.375

 
8.250
 
7.875
 
7.250
Total capital
11.375

 
10.250
 
9.875
 
9.250
Tier 1 leverage
4.000

 
4.000
 
4.000
 
4.000
(1)
At December 31, 2018 , under transition requirements, the CET1, tier 1 and total capital minimum ratio requirements for Wells Fargo & Company include a capital conservation buffer of 1.875% and a global systemically important bank (G-SIB) surcharge of 1.500% . Only the 1.875% capital conservation buffer applies to the Bank at December 31, 2018 .

278
Wells Fargo & Company
 


Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm 
The Stockholders and Board of Directors
Wells Fargo & Company:

Opinion on the Consolidated Financial Statements
We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of Wells Fargo & Company and Subsidiaries (the Company) as of December 31, 2018 and 2017 , the related consolidated statements of income, comprehensive income, changes in equity, and cash flows for each of the years in the three-year period ended December 31, 2018 , and the related notes (collectively, the consolidated financial statements). In our opinion, the consolidated financial statements present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of the Company as of December 31, 2018 and 2017 , and the results of its operations and its cash flows for each of the years in the three-year period ended December 31, 2018 , in conformity with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles.

We also have audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States) (PCAOB), the Company’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2018 , based on criteria established in Internal Control – Integrated Framework (2013) issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission, and our report dated February 27, 2019 , expressed an unqualified opinion on the effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting.

Basis for Opinion
These consolidated financial statements are the responsibility of the Company’s management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these consolidated financial statements based on our audits. We are a public accounting firm registered with the PCAOB and are required to be independent with respect to the Company in accordance with the U.S. federal securities laws and the applicable rules and regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission and the PCAOB.
 
We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the PCAOB. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the consolidated financial statements are free of material misstatement, whether due to error or fraud. Our audits included performing procedures to assess the risks of material misstatement of the consolidated financial statements, whether due to error or fraud, and performing procedures that respond to those risks. Such procedures included examining, on a test basis, evidence regarding the amounts and disclosures in the consolidated financial statements. Our audits also included evaluating the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall presentation of the consolidated financial statements. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.


 


 
/s/ KPMG LLP                        
 
We have served as the Company’s auditor since 1931.

San Francisco, California
February 27, 2019

 
Wells Fargo & Company
279


Quarterly Financial Data
Condensed Consolidated Statement of Income - Quarterly (Unaudited)
 
2018
 
 
2017
 
 
Quarter ended 
 
 
Quarter ended 
 
(in millions, except per share amounts)
Dec 31,

 
Sep 30,

 
Jun 30,

 
Mar 31,

 
Dec 31,

 
Sep 30,

 
Jun 30,

 
Mar 31,

Interest income
$
16,921

 
16,364

 
16,015

 
15,347

 
14,958

 
15,044

 
14,694

 
14,213

Interest expense
4,277

 
3,792

 
3,474

 
3,109

 
2,645

 
2,595

 
2,223

 
1,889

Net interest income
12,644

 
12,572

 
12,541

 
12,238

 
12,313


12,449


12,471


12,324

Provision for credit losses
521

 
580

 
452

 
191

 
651

 
717

 
555

 
605

Net interest income after provision for credit losses
12,123

 
11,992

 
12,089

 
12,047

 
11,662


11,732


11,916


11,719

Noninterest income
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Service charges on deposit accounts
1,176

 
1,204

 
1,163

 
1,173

 
1,246

 
1,276

 
1,276

 
1,313

Trust and investment fees
3,520

 
3,631

 
3,675

 
3,683

 
3,687

 
3,609

 
3,629

 
3,570

Card fees
981

 
1,017

 
1,001

 
908

 
996

 
1,000

 
1,019

 
945

Other fees
888

 
850

 
846

 
800

 
913

 
877

 
902

 
865

Mortgage banking
467

 
846

 
770

 
934

 
928

 
1,046

 
1,148

 
1,228

Insurance
109

 
104

 
102

 
114

 
223

 
269

 
280

 
277

Net gains (losses) from trading activities (1)
10

 
158

 
191

 
243

 
(1
)
 
120

 
151

 
272

Net gains on debt securities
9

 
57

 
41

 
1

 
157

 
166

 
120

 
36

Net gains from equity securities (1)
21

 
416

 
295

 
783

 
572

 
363

 
274

 
570

Lease income
402

 
453

 
443

 
455

 
458

 
475

 
493

 
481

Other
753

 
633

 
485

 
602

 
558

 
199

 
472

 
374

Total noninterest income
8,336

 
9,369

 
9,012

 
9,696

 
9,737

 
9,400


9,764


9,931

Noninterest expense
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Salaries
4,545

 
4,461

 
4,465

 
4,363

 
4,403

 
4,356

 
4,343

 
4,261

Commission and incentive compensation
2,427

 
2,427

 
2,642

 
2,768

 
2,665

 
2,553

 
2,499

 
2,725

Employee benefits
706

 
1,377

 
1,245

 
1,598

 
1,293

 
1,279

 
1,308

 
1,686

Equipment
643

 
634

 
550

 
617

 
608

 
523

 
529

 
577

Net occupancy
735

 
718

 
722

 
713

 
715

 
716

 
706

 
712

Core deposit and other intangibles
264

 
264

 
265

 
265

 
288

 
288

 
287

 
289

FDIC and other deposit assessments
153

 
336

 
297

 
324

 
312

 
314

 
328

 
333

Other
3,866

 
3,546

 
3,796

 
4,394

 
6,516

 
4,322

 
3,541

 
3,209

Total noninterest expense
13,339

 
13,763

 
13,982

 
15,042

 
16,800

 
14,351

 
13,541

 
13,792

Income before income tax expense
7,120

 
7,598

 
7,119

 
6,701

 
4,599

 
6,781

 
8,139

 
7,858

Income tax expense (benefit)
966

 
1,512

 
1,810

 
1,374

 
(1,642
)
 
2,181

 
2,245

 
2,133

Net income before noncontrolling interests
6,154

 
6,086

 
5,309

 
5,327

 
6,241

 
4,600

 
5,894

 
5,725

Less: Net income from noncontrolling interests
90

 
79

 
123

 
191

 
90

 
58

 
38

 
91

Wells Fargo net income
$
6,064

 
6,007

 
5,186

 
5,136

 
6,151

 
4,542

 
5,856

 
5,634

Less: Preferred stock dividends and other
353

 
554

 
394

 
403

 
411

 
411

 
406

 
401

Wells Fargo net income applicable to common stock
$
5,711

 
5,453

 
4,792

 
4,733

 
5,740

 
4,131

 
5,450

 
5,233

Per share information
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Earnings per common share
$
1.22

 
1.14

 
0.98

 
0.97

 
1.17

 
0.83

 
1.09

 
1.05

Diluted earnings per common share
1.21

 
1.13

 
0.98

 
0.96

 
1.16

 
0.83

 
1.08

 
1.03

Average common shares outstanding
4,665.8

 
4,784.0

 
4,865.8

 
4,885.7

 
4,912.5

 
4,948.6

 
4,989.9

 
5,008.6

Diluted average common shares outstanding
4,700.8

 
4,823.2

 
4,899.8

 
4,930.7

 
4,963.1

 
4,996.8

 
5,037.7

 
5,070.4

(1)
Financial information for the prior periods of 2017 has been revised to reflect presentation changes made in connection with our adoption in first quarter 2018 of Accounting Standards Update (ASU) 2016-01 – Financial Instruments – Overall (Subtopic 825-10): Recognition and Measurement of Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities . See Note 1 (Summary of Significant Accounting Policies) for more information.



280
Wells Fargo & Company
 


Average Balances, Yields and Rates Paid (Taxable-Equivalent basis) - Quarterly (1)(2) - (Unaudited)
 
Quarter ended December 31,
 
 
2018
 
 
2017
 
(in millions)
Average
balance

 
Yields/
rates

 
Interest
income/
expense

 
Average
balance

 
Yields/
rates

 
Interest
income/
expense

Earning assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest-earning deposits with banks (3)
$
150,091

 
2.18
%
 
$
825

 
189,114

 
1.27
%
 
$
605

Federal funds sold and securities purchased under resale agreements (3)
76,108

 
2.22

 
426

 
75,826

 
1.20
%
 
230

Debt securities (4):
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Trading debt securities (5)
90,110

 
3.52

 
794

 
81,580

 
3.17

 
647

Available-for-sale debt securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities of U.S. Treasury and federal agencies
7,195

 
1.80

 
32

 
6,423

 
1.66

 
27

Securities of U.S. states and political subdivisions
47,618

 
4.05

 
483

 
52,390

 
3.91

 
513

Mortgage-backed securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Federal agencies
155,322

 
2.91

 
1,128

 
152,910

 
2.62

 
1,000

Residential and commercial
6,666

 
4.87

 
81

 
9,371

 
4.85

 
114

Total mortgage-backed securities
161,988

 
2.99

 
1,209

 
162,281

 
2.75

 
1,114

Other debt securities (5)
46,072

 
4.46

 
518

 
48,679

 
3.62

 
443

Total available-for-sale debt securities (5)
262,873

 
3.41

 
2,242

 
269,773

 
3.10

 
2,097

Held-to-maturity debt securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities of U.S. Treasury and federal agencies
44,747

 
2.19

 
247

 
44,716

 
2.19

 
246

Securities of U.S. states and political subdivisions
6,247

 
4.34

 
67

 
6,263

 
5.26

 
83

Federal agency and other mortgage-backed securities
95,748

 
2.46

 
589

 
89,622

 
2.25

 
503

Other debt securities
68

 
3.65

 
1

 
1,194

 
2.64

 
8

Total held-to-maturity debt securities
146,810

 
2.46

 
904

 
141,795

 
2.36

 
840

Total debt securities (5)
499,793

 
3.15

 
3,940

 
493,148

 
2.90

 
3,584

Mortgages loans held for sale (6)
17,044

 
4.46

 
190

 
20,517

 
3.82

 
196

Loans held for sale (5)(6)
1,992

 
6.69

 
33

 
1,490

 
3.19

 
12

Commercial loans:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial - U.S.
281,431

 
4.40

 
3,115

 
270,294

 
3.89

 
2,649

Commercial and industrial - Non-U.S.
62,035

 
3.73

 
584

 
59,233

 
2.96

 
442

Real estate mortgage
120,404

 
4.51

 
1,369

 
127,199

 
3.88

 
1,244

Real estate construction
23,090

 
5.32

 
310

 
24,408

 
4.38

 
270

Lease financing
19,519

 
4.48

 
219

 
19,226

 
0.62

 
31

Total commercial loans
506,479

 
4.39

 
5,597

 
500,360

 
3.68

 
4,636

Consumer loans:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Real estate 1-4 family first mortgage
285,260

 
4.02

 
2,868

 
281,966

 
4.01

 
2,826

Real estate 1-4 family junior lien mortgage
34,844

 
5.60

 
491

 
40,379

 
4.96

 
505

Credit card
37,858

 
12.69

 
1,211

 
36,428

 
12.37

 
1,136

Automobile
45,536

 
5.16

 
592

 
54,323

 
5.13

 
702

Other revolving credit and installment
36,359

 
6.95

 
637

 
38,366

 
6.28

 
607

Total consumer loans
439,857

 
5.25

 
5,799

 
451,462

 
5.10

 
5,776

Total loans (6)
946,336

 
4.79

 
11,396

 
951,822

 
4.35

 
10,412

Equity securities (5)
37,412

 
2.79

 
261

 
38,001

 
2.60

 
246

Other (5)
4,074

 
1.78

 
18

 
7,103

 
0.88

 
16

Total earning assets (5)
$
1,732,850

 
3.93
%
 
$
17,089

 
1,777,021

 
3.43
%
 
$
15,301

Funding sources
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Deposits:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest-bearing checking
$
53,983

 
1.21
%
 
$
165

 
50,483

 
0.68
%
 
$
86

Market rate and other savings
689,639

 
0.43

 
741

 
679,893

 
0.19

 
319

Savings certificates
21,955

 
0.87

 
48

 
20,920

 
0.31

 
17

Other time deposits
92,676

 
2.46

 
575

 
68,187

 
1.49

 
255

Deposits in foreign offices
56,098

 
1.66

 
236

 
124,597

 
0.81

 
254

Total interest-bearing deposits
914,351

 
0.77

 
1,765

 
944,080

 
0.39

 
931

Short-term borrowings
105,962

 
2.04

 
546

 
102,142

 
0.99

 
256

Long-term debt
226,591

 
3.17

 
1,802

 
231,598

 
2.32

 
1,344

Other liabilities
27,365

 
2.41

 
164

 
24,728

 
1.86

 
115

Total interest-bearing liabilities
1,274,269

 
1.34

 
4,277

 
1,302,548

 
0.81

 
2,646

Portion of noninterest-bearing funding sources (5)
458,581

 

 

 
474,473

 

 

Total funding sources (5)
$
1,732,850

 
0.99

 
4,277

 
1,777,021

 
0.59

 
2,646

Net interest margin and net interest income on a taxable-equivalent basis (7)
 
 
2.94
%
 
$
12,812

 
 
 
2.84
%
 
$
12,655

Noninterest-earning assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Cash and due from banks
$
19,288

 
 
 
 
 
19,152

 
 
 
 
Goodwill
26,423

 
 
 
 
 
26,579

 
 
 
 
Other (5)
100,486

 
 
 
 
 
112,566

 
 
 
 
Total noninterest-earning assets (5)
$
146,197

 
 
 
 
 
158,297

 
 
 
 
Noninterest-bearing funding sources
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Deposits
$
354,597

 
 
 
 
 
367,512

 
 
 
 
Other liabilities
51,739

 
 
 
 
 
57,845

 
 
 
 
Total equity
198,442

 
 
 
 
 
207,413

 
 
 
 
Noninterest-bearing funding sources used to fund earning assets (5)
(458,581
)
 
 
 
 
 
(474,473
)
 
 
 
 
Net noninterest-bearing funding sources (5)
$
146,197

 
 
 
 
 
158,297

 
 
 
 
Total assets
$
1,879,047

 
 
 
 
 
1,935,318

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(1)
Our average prime rate was 5.28% and 4.30% for the quarters ended December 31, 2018 and 2017 , respectively. The average three-month London Interbank Offered Rate (LIBOR) was 2.62% and 1.46% for the same quarters, respectively.
(2)
Yield/rates and amounts include the effects of hedge and risk management activities associated with the respective asset and liability categories.
(3)
Financial information for the prior period has been revised to reflect the impact of our adoption of Accounting Standards Update (ASU) 2016-18 Statement of Cash Flows (Topic 230): Restricted Cash in which we changed the presentation of our cash and cash equivalents to include both cash and due from banks as well as interest-earning deposits with banks, which are inclusive of any restricted cash.
(4)
Yields and rates are based on interest income/expense amounts for the period, annualized based on the accrual basis for the respective accounts. The average balance amounts represent amortized cost for the periods presented.
(5)
Financial information for the prior period has been revised to reflect presentation changes made in connection with our adoption in first quarter 2018 of ASU 2016-01 Financial Instruments Overall (Subtopic 825-10): Recognition and Measurement of Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities.
(6)
Nonaccrual loans and related income are included in their respective loan categories.
(7)
Includes taxable-equivalent adjustments of $168 million and $342 million for the quarters ended December 31, 2018 and 2017 , respectively, predominantly related to tax-exempt income on certain loans and securities. The federal statutory tax rate was 21% and 35% for the periods ended December 31, 2018 and 2017 , respectively.

 
Wells Fargo & Company
281


Glossary of Acronyms
 
 
 
 
ABS
Asset-backed security
HAMP
Home Affordability Modification Program
ACL
Allowance for credit losses
HUD
U.S. Department of Housing and Urban Development
ALCO
Asset/Liability Management Committee
LCR
Liquidity coverage ratio
ARM
Adjustable-rate mortgage
LHFS
Loans held for sale
ASC
Accounting Standards Codification
LIBOR
London Interbank Offered Rate
ASU
Accounting Standards Update
LIHTC
Low income housing tax credit
AUA
Assets under administration
LOCOM
Lower of cost or market value
AUM
Assets under management
LTV
Loan-to-value
AVM
Automated valuation model
MBS
Mortgage-backed security
BCBS
Basel Committee on Bank Supervision
MHA
Making Home Affordable programs
BHC
Bank holding company
MLHFS
Mortgage loans held for sale
CCAR
Comprehensive Capital Analysis and Review
MSR
Mortgage servicing right
CD
Certificate of deposit
MTN
Medium-term note
CDO
Collateralized debt obligation
NAV
Net asset value
CDS
Credit default swaps
NPA
Nonperforming asset
CECL
Current expected credit loss
OCC
Office of the Comptroller of the Currency
CET1
Common Equity Tier 1
OCI
Other comprehensive income
CFPB
Consumer Financial Protection Bureau
OTC
Over-the-counter
CLO
Collateralized loan obligation
OTTI
Other-than-temporary impairment
CLTV
Combined loan-to-value
PCI Loans
Purchased credit-impaired loans
CMBS
Commercial mortgage-backed securities
PTPP
Pre-tax pre-provision profit
CPI
Collateral protection insurance
RBC
Risk-based capital
CPP
Capital Purchase Program
RMBS
Residential mortgage-backed securities
CRE
Commercial real estate
ROA
Wells Fargo net income to average total assets
DPD
Days past due
ROE
Wells Fargo net income applicable to common stock
ESOP
Employee Stock Ownership Plan
 
to average Wells Fargo common stockholders’ equity
FAS
Statement of Financial Accounting Standards
ROTCE
Return on average tangible common equity
FASB
Financial Accounting Standards Board
RWAs
Risk-weighted assets
FDIC
Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation
SEC
Securities and Exchange Commission
FFELP
Federal Family Education Loan Program
S&P
Standard & Poor’s Ratings Services
FHA
Federal Housing Administration
SLR
Supplementary leverage ratio
FHLB
Federal Home Loan Bank
SOFR
Secured Overnight Financing Rate
FHLMC
Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation
SPE
Special purpose entity
FICO
Fair Isaac Corporation (credit rating)
TARP
Troubled Asset Relief Program
FNMA
Federal National Mortgage Association
TDR
Troubled debt restructuring
FRB
Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System
TLAC
Total Loss Absorbing Capacity
GAAP
Generally accepted accounting principles
VA
Department of Veterans Affairs
GNMA
Government National Mortgage Association
VaR
Value-at-Risk
GSE
Government-sponsored entity
VIE
Variable interest entity
G-SIB
Globally systemic important bank
WIM
Wealth and Investment Management


282
Wells Fargo & Company
 


Exhibit 21
SUBSIDIARIES OF THE PARENT
 
 
 
The table below is a list of direct and indirect subsidiaries of the Parent as of December 31, 2018, and the state or jurisdiction in which the subsidiaries are organized. Pursuant to Item 601(b)(21)(ii) of Regulation S-K, certain subsidiaries of the Parent have been omitted from this list because, considered in the aggregate as a single subsidiary, such subsidiaries would not constitute a “significant subsidiary” as that term is defined in Rule 1-02(w) of Regulation S-X.
 
 
 
Subsidiary
 
Jurisdiction of Incorporation or Organization
Danube Holdings I C.V.
 
Netherlands
Danube I Limited Partner, LLC
 
Delaware
Eastdil Secured Broker Services, Inc.
 
Delaware
EVEREN Capital Corporation
 
Delaware
Norwest Venture Partners XI, LP
 
Delaware
Norwest Venture Partners XII, LP
 
Delaware
Norwest Venture Partners XIII, LP
 
Delaware
NVP Associates, LLC
 
Delaware
OmniPlus Capital Corporation
 
Delaware
Peony Asset Management, Inc.
 
Delaware
PRN Holdings, LLC
 
Delaware
Reliable Financial Services, Inc.
 
Puerto Rico
Silver Asset Management, Inc.
 
Delaware
Sparta GP Holding REO Corp
 
Delaware
Union Hamilton Reinsurance, Ltd.
 
Bermuda
Wells Capital Management Incorporated
 
California
Wells Fargo Affordable Housing Community Development Corporation
 
North Carolina
Wells Fargo Asset Management Holdings, LLC
 
Delaware
Wells Fargo Bank International Unlimited Company
 
Ireland
Wells Fargo Bank South Central, National Association
 
United States
Wells Fargo Bank, National Association
 
United States
Wells Fargo Capital Finance, LLC
 
Delaware
Wells Fargo Central Pacific Holdings, Inc.
 
California
Wells Fargo Clearing Services, LLC
 
Delaware
Wells Fargo Commercial Distribution Finance, LLC
 
Delaware
Wells Fargo Community Development Corporation
 
Nevada
Wells Fargo Dealer Floorplan Master Note Trust
 
Delaware
Wells Fargo Equipment Finance, Inc.
 
Minnesota
Wells Fargo Financial Leasing, Inc.
 
Iowa
Wells Fargo Financial National Bank
 
United States
Wells Fargo Funding, Inc.
 
Minnesota
Wells Fargo Funds Management, LLC
 
Delaware
Wells Fargo Insurance Re, Inc.
 
Vermont
Wells Fargo Municipal Capital Strategies, LLC
 
Delaware
Wells Fargo Rail Corporation
 
North Carolina
Wells Fargo Real Estate Investment Corporation
 
Delaware
Wells Fargo Securities, LLC
 
Delaware
Wells Fargo USA Holdings, Inc.
 
New Jersey
Wells Fargo Vendor Financial Services, LLC
 
California
WFC Holdings, LLC
 
Delaware


Exhibit 23
Consent of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm
The Board of Directors
Wells Fargo & Company:
We consent to the incorporation by reference in the registration statements noted below on Forms S‑3, S-4, and S‑8 of Wells Fargo & Company of our reports dated February 27, 2019 , with respect to the consolidated balance sheet of Wells Fargo & Company and Subsidiaries as of December 31, 2018 and 2017 , and the related consolidated statements of income, comprehensive income, changes in equity, and cash flows for each of the years in the three-year period ended December 31, 2018 , and the related notes (collectively, the “consolidated financial statements”), and the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2018 , which reports appear in the December 31, 2018 Annual Report on Form 10-K of Wells Fargo & Company.
Registration Statement Number
Form
Description
333-221324
333-221324-01
S-3
Debt Shelf 2017
333-216234
S-3
Universal Shelf 2017
333-223517
S-3
Wells Fargo Direct Purchase and Dividend Reinvestment Plan
333-154879
S-4/S-8
Wachovia Corporation
333-168819
S-8
Long-Term Incentive Compensation Plan
333-192903
S-8
Long-Term Incentive Compensation Plan
333-211639
S-8
401(k) Plan
333-180997
S-8
Directors Stock Compensation and Deferral Plan
333-176266
S-8
Special Deferral Plan for Select Employees and Special Award Plan
333-142941
S-8
Deferred Compensation Plan
333-207636
S-8
Deferred Compensation Plan
333-211638
S-8
Wells Fargo Stock Purchase Plan
333-161529
S-8
Wachovia Deferred Compensation Obligations
333-200400
S-8
Supplemental 401(k) Plan


/s/ KPMG LLP         

San Francisco, California
February 27, 2019






Exhibit 24
 
WELLS FARGO & COMPANY
 
Power of Attorney of Director
 
KNOW ALL MEN BY THESE PRESENTS, that the undersigned director of WELLS FARGO & COMPANY, a Delaware corporation, does hereby make, constitute, and appoint JAMES H. QUIGLEY, a director and Chairman of the Audit and Examination Committee of the Board of Directors, and JOHN D. BAKER II, THEODORE F. CRAVER, JR., and RONALD L. SARGENT, directors and members of the Audit and Examination Committee of the Board of Directors, and each or any of them, the undersigned’s true and lawful attorneys-in-fact, with power of substitution, for the undersigned and in the undersigned’s name, place, and stead, to sign and affix the undersigned’s name as such director of said Company to an Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2018 , and all amendments thereto, to be filed by said Company with the Securities and Exchange Commission, Washington, D.C. under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, and the rules and regulations of said Commission, and to file the same, with all exhibits thereto and other supporting documents, with said Commission, granting unto said attorneys-in-fact, and each or either of them, full power and authority to do and perform any and all acts necessary or incidental to the performance and execution of the powers herein expressly granted.
 
IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the undersigned has executed this power of attorney this 26th day of February, 2019.
  
/s/ JOHN D. BAKER II
/s/ KAREN B. PEETZ
/s/ CELESTE A. CLARK
/s/ JUAN A. PUJADAS
/s/ THEODORE F. CRAVER, JR.
/s/ JAMES H. QUIGLEY
/s/ ELIZABETH A. DUKE
/s/ RONALD L. SARGENT
/s/ WAYNE M. HEWETT
/s/ TIMOTHY J. SLOAN
/s/ DONALD M. JAMES
/s/ SUZANNE M. VAUTRINOT
/s/ MARIA R. MORRIS
 





Exhibit 31(a)
 
CERTIFICATION
 
I, Timothy J. Sloan, certify that:
 
1.        I have reviewed this Annual Report on Form 10-K for the period ended December 31, 2018 , of Wells Fargo & Company;
2.        Based on my knowledge, this report does not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact necessary to make the statements made, in light of the circumstances under which such statements were made, not misleading with respect to the period covered by this report;
3.        Based on my knowledge, the financial statements, and other financial information included in this report, fairly present in all material respects the financial condition, results of operations and cash flows of the registrant as of, and for, the periods presented in this report;
4.        The registrant’s other certifying officer(s) and I are responsible for establishing and maintaining disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e)) and internal control over financial reporting (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f)) for the registrant and have:
(a) 
Designed such disclosure controls and procedures, or caused such disclosure controls and procedures to be designed under our supervision, to ensure that material information relating to the registrant, including its consolidated subsidiaries, is made known to us by others within those entities, particularly during the period in which this report is being prepared;
(b)  
Designed such internal control over financial reporting, or caused such internal control over financial reporting to be designed under our supervision, to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles;
(c) 
Evaluated the effectiveness of the registrant’s disclosure controls and procedures and presented in this report our conclusions about the effectiveness of the disclosure controls and procedures, as of the end of the period covered by this report based on such evaluation; and
(d)  
Disclosed in this report any change in the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting that occurred during the registrant’s most recent fiscal quarter (the registrant’s fourth fiscal quarter in the case of an annual report) that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting; and
5.        The registrant’s other certifying officer(s) and I have disclosed, based on our most recent evaluation of internal control over financial reporting, to the registrant’s auditors and the audit committee of the registrant’s board of directors (or persons performing the equivalent functions):
(a) 
All significant deficiencies and material weaknesses in the design or operation of internal control over financial reporting which are reasonably likely to adversely affect the registrant’s ability to record, process, summarize and report financial information; and
(b) 
Any fraud, whether or not material, that involves management or other employees who have a significant role in the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting.
 
Date: February 27, 2019
/s/ TIMOTHY J. SLOAN        
Timothy J. Sloan
Chief Executive Officer





Exhibit 31(b)
 
CERTIFICATION
 
I, John R. Shrewsberry, certify that:
 
1.        I have reviewed this Annual Report on Form 10-K for the period ended December 31, 2018 , of Wells Fargo & Company;
2.        Based on my knowledge, this report does not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact necessary to make the statements made, in light of the circumstances under which such statements were made, not misleading with respect to the period covered by this report;
3.        Based on my knowledge, the financial statements, and other financial information included in this report, fairly present in all material respects the financial condition, results of operations and cash flows of the registrant as of, and for, the periods presented in this report;
4.        The registrant’s other certifying officer(s) and I are responsible for establishing and maintaining disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e)) and internal control over financial reporting (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f)) for the registrant and have:
(a) 
Designed such disclosure controls and procedures, or caused such disclosure controls and procedures to be designed under our supervision, to ensure that material information relating to the registrant, including its consolidated subsidiaries, is made known to us by others within those entities, particularly during the period in which this report is being prepared;
(b)  
Designed such internal control over financial reporting, or caused such internal control over financial reporting to be designed under our supervision, to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles;  
(c) 
Evaluated the effectiveness of the registrant’s disclosure controls and procedures and presented in this report our conclusions about the effectiveness of the disclosure controls and procedures, as of the end of the period covered by this report based on such evaluation; and
(d)  
Disclosed in this report any change in the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting that occurred during the registrant’s most recent fiscal quarter (the registrant’s fourth fiscal quarter in the case of an annual report) that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting; and
5.        The registrant’s other certifying officer(s) and I have disclosed, based on our most recent evaluation of internal control over financial reporting, to the registrant’s auditors and the audit committee of the registrant’s board of directors (or persons performing the equivalent functions):
(a) 
All significant deficiencies and material weaknesses in the design or operation of internal control over financial reporting which are reasonably likely to adversely affect the registrant’s ability to record, process, summarize and report financial information; and
(b) 
Any fraud, whether or not material, that involves management or other employees who have a significant role in the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting.
 
Date: February 27, 2019
/s/ JOHN R. SHREWSBERRY               
John R. Shrewsberry
Chief Financial Officer





Exhibit 32(a)
 
 
Certifications Pursuant to
18 U.S.C. Section 1350,
As Adopted Pursuant to
Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002  
  
In connection with the Annual Report on Form 10-K of Wells Fargo & Company (the “Company”) for the period ended December 31, 2018 , as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on the date hereof (the “Report”), I, Timothy J. Sloan, Chief Executive Officer of the Company, certify, pursuant to 18 U.S.C. §1350, as adopted pursuant to §906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002, that:
 
(1)    
The Report fully complies with the requirements of Section 13(a) or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934; and  
 
(2)    
The information contained in the Report fairly presents, in all material respects, the financial condition and results of operations of the Company.
 
 
 
 
/s/ TIMOTHY J. SLOAN        
Timothy J. Sloan
Chief Executive Officer
Wells Fargo & Company
February 27, 2019





Exhibit 32(b)
 
 
Certifications Pursuant to
18 U.S.C. Section 1350,
As Adopted Pursuant to
Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002
  
In connection with the Annual Report on Form 10-K of Wells Fargo & Company (the “Company”) for the period ended December 31, 2018 , as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on the date hereof (the “Report”), I, John R. Shrewsberry, Chief Financial Officer of the Company, certify, pursuant to 18 U.S.C. §1350, as adopted pursuant to §906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002, that:
 
(1)    
The Report fully complies with the requirements of Section 13(a) or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934; and  
 
(2)    
The information contained in the Report fairly presents, in all material respects, the financial condition and results of operations of the Company.
 
 
 
 
/s/ JOHN R. SHREWSBERRY                 
John R. Shrewsberry
Chief Financial Officer
Wells Fargo & Company
February 27, 2019